From ebe124eacd7c3faa36ed358e7cc1d7c5b419e5f6 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: Daniel Baumann Date: Sat, 4 May 2024 14:18:09 +0200 Subject: Merging upstream version 15.6. Signed-off-by: Daniel Baumann --- doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 39 +- doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml | 17 +- doc/src/sgml/glossary.sgml | 21 +- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/acronyms.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/admin.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/adminpack.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/amcheck.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-clusterdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-createdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-createuser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropuser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-ecpg.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-initdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-ctl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-dumpall.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-isready.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgamcheck.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgbasebackup.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgchecksums.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgconfig.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgcontroldata.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgdump.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivewal.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivexlog.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrecvlogical.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetwal.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetxlog.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrestore.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrewind.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgverifybackup.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-postgres.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-postmaster.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-psql.html | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-reindexdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/app-vacuumdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/appendix-obsolete.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/appendixes.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/applevel-consistency.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-callbacks.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-init.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/archive-modules.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/arrays.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-bsd.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-cert.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-delay.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ident.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ldap.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-methods.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pam.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-password.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-peer.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pg-hba-conf.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-radius.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-trust.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auth-username-maps.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/auto-explain.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/backup-dump.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/backup-file.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-files.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-format.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-toplevel.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-wal-ranges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/backup.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/basebackup-to-shell.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/basic-archive.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bgworker.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/biblio.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bki-commands.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bki-example.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bki-format.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bki-structure.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bki.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bloom.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bookindex.html | 18 +- doc/src/sgml/html/brin-builtin-opclasses.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/brin-extensibility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/brin-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/brin.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/btree-behavior.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gin.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gist.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/btree-implementation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/btree-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/btree-support-funcs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/btree.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/bug-reporting.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-aggregate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-am.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amop.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amproc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attrdef.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attribute.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-auth-members.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-authid.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-cast.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-class.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-collation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-constraint.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-conversion.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-database.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-db-role-setting.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-default-acl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-depend.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-description.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-enum.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-event-trigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-extension.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-data-wrapper.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-server.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-table.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-index.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-inherits.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-init-privs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-language.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject-metadata.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-namespace.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opclass.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-operator.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opfamily.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-parameter-acl.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/catalog-pg-partitioned-table.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-policy.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-proc.html | 4 +- .../html/catalog-pg-publication-namespace.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-rel.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-range.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/catalog-pg-replication-origin.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-rewrite.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-seclabel.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-sequence.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdepend.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdescription.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shseclabel.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext-data.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription-rel.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-tablespace.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-transform.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-trigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config-map.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-dict.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-parser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-template.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-type.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-user-mapping.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/charset.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/checksums.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/citext.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/client-authentication-problems.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/client-interfaces.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/collation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/color-when.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/color-which.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/color.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/config-setting.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/connect-estab.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/continuous-archiving.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-delete.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-insert.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-update.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-cancel-query.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-close.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect-u.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-disconnect.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/contrib-dblink-error-message.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-exec.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-fetch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-function.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-connections.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-notify.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-pkey.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-result.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-is-busy.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-open.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-send-query.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-client.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-server.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-spi.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/contrib.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/creating-cluster.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/cube.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/custom-rmgr.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-execution.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-path.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-plan.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/database-roles.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-binary.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-bit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-boolean.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-character.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-datetime.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-enum.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-geometric.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-json.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-money.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-net-types.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-numeric.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-oid.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pg-lsn.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pseudo.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-textsearch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-uuid.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-xml.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datatype.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-appendix.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-config-files.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-input-rules.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-invalid-input.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-julian-dates.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-keywords.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/datetime-posix-timezone-specs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-units-history.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dblink.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-alter.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-basics.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-constraints.html | 24 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-default.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-depend.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-foreign-data.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-generated-columns.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-inherit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-others.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-partitioning.html | 10 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-priv.html | 17 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-rowsecurity.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-schemas.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-system-columns.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ddl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/default-roles.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dict-int.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dict-xsyn.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/different-replication-solutions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/disk-full.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/disk-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/diskusage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dml-delete.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dml-insert.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dml-returning.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dml-update.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dml.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-authoring.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-build.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-docbook.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-style.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-toolsets.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/docguide.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/domains.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/dynamic-trace.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/earthdistance.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-commands.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-concept.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-connect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-cpp.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-descriptors.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-develop.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-dynamic.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-errors.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-informix-compat.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-library.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-lo.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-oracle-compat.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-pgtypes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-preproc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-process.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-commands.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-connect.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/ecpg-sql-deallocate-descriptor.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare-statement.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-describe.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-disconnect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-execute-immediate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-get-descriptor.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-open.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-prepare.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-autocommit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-connection.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-descriptor.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-type.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-var.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-whenever.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-variables.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/encryption-options.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/errcodes-appendix.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/error-message-reporting.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/error-style-guide.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/event-log-registration.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-definition.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-example.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-interface.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-matrix.html | 4 +- .../html/event-trigger-table-rewrite-example.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/event-triggers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/executor.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-joins.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-locking.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/extend-extensions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/extend-how.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/extend-pgxs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/extend-type-system.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/extend.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/external-admin-tools.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/external-extensions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/external-interfaces.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/external-pl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/external-projects.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-callbacks.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-functions.html | 15 +- doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-helpers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-planning.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-row-locking.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/fdwhandler.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/features-sql-standard.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/features.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/file-fdw.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-admin.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-aggregate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-array.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-binarystring.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-bitstring.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparison.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparisons.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-conditional.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-datetime.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-enum.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-event-triggers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-formatting.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-geometry.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-info.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-json.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-logical.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-matching.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-math.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-net.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-range.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-sequence.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-srf.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-statistics.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-string.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-subquery.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-textsearch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-trigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-uuid.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-window.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions-xml.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/functions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/fuzzystrmatch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/generic-wal.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-biblio.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro2.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-pg-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/geqo.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin-builtin-opclasses.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin-examples.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin-extensibility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin-implementation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin-limit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin-tips.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gin.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gist-builtin-opclasses.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gist-examples.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gist-extensibility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gist-implementation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gist-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gist.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/git.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/glossary.html | 17 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-auth.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-enc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/hash-implementation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/hash-index.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/hash-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/high-availability.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/history.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/hot-standby.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/how-parallel-query-works.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/hstore.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/index-api.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/index-cost-estimation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/index-functions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/index-locking.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/index-scanning.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/index-unique-checks.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/index.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexam.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-bitmap-scans.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-collations.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-examine.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-expressional.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-index-only-scans.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-intro.html | 33 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-multicolumn.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-opclass.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-ordering.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-partial.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-types.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-unique.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/indexes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/information-schema.html | 4 +- ...foschema-administrable-role-authorizations.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-applicable-roles.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-attributes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-character-sets.html | 8 +- .../infoschema-check-constraint-routine-usage.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraints.html | 4 +- ...nfoschema-collation-character-set-applicab.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collations.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-column-column-usage.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-column-domain-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-options.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-column-privileges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-udt-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-columns.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-constraint-column-usage.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-constraint-table-usage.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-data-type-privileges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-datatypes.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-domain-constraints.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-udt-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domains.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-element-types.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-enabled-roles.html | 4 +- .../infoschema-foreign-data-wrapper-options.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrappers.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-foreign-server-options.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-servers.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-foreign-table-options.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-tables.html | 4 +- ...infoschema-information-schema-catalog-name.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-key-column-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-parameters.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-referential-constraints.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-role-column-grants.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-role-routine-grants.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-role-table-grants.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-udt-grants.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-role-usage-grants.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-routine-column-usage.html | 12 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-routine-privileges.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-routine-routine-usage.html | 16 +- .../html/infoschema-routine-sequence-usage.html | 14 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-routine-table-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routines.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schema.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schemata.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sequences.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-features.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-sql-implementation-info.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-parts.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-sizing.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-table-constraints.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-privileges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-tables.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-transforms.html | 4 +- .../html/infoschema-triggered-update-columns.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-udt-privileges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-usage-privileges.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-user-defined-types.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-user-mapping-options.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mappings.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-view-column-usage.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/infoschema-view-routine-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-table-usage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-views.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-binaries.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-getsource.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-post.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-procedure.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-requirements.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-short.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows-full.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/installation-platform-notes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/installation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/intagg.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/intarray.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/internals.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/intro-whatis.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/isn.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/jit-configuration.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/jit-decision.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/jit-extensibility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/jit-reason.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/jit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/kernel-resources.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/largeobjects.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/legalnotice.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-async.html | 11 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-build.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-cancel.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-connect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-control.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-copy.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-envars.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-events.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-example.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-exec.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-fastpath.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-ldap.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-misc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-notice-processing.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-notify.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-pgpass.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-pgservice.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-pipeline-mode.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-single-row-mode.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-ssl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-status.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq-threading.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/libpq.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/limits.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/lo-examplesect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/lo-funcs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/lo-implementation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/lo-interfaces.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/lo-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/lo.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/locale.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/locking-indexes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logfile-maintenance.html | 4 +- .../html/logical-replication-architecture.html | 7 +- .../sgml/html/logical-replication-col-lists.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logical-replication-config.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/logical-replication-conflicts.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/logical-replication-monitoring.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/logical-replication-publication.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/logical-replication-quick-setup.html | 4 +- .../html/logical-replication-restrictions.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/logical-replication-row-filter.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/logical-replication-security.html | 4 +- .../html/logical-replication-subscription.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logical-replication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-catalogs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-example.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-explanation.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/logicaldecoding-output-plugin.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-sql.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-streaming.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-synchronous.html | 4 +- .../html/logicaldecoding-two-phase-commits.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-walsender.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding-writer.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/logicaldecoding.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ltree.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/maintenance.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/manage-ag-config.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/manage-ag-createdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/manage-ag-dropdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/manage-ag-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/manage-ag-tablespaces.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/manage-ag-templatedbs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/managing-databases.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring-locks.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring-ps.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring-stats.html | 7 +- doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/multibyte.html | 4 +- .../html/multivariate-statistics-examples.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-caveats.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-intro.html | 4 +- .../html/mvcc-serialization-failure-handling.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/nls-programmer.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/nls-translator.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/nls.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/non-durability.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/notation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/oid2name.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/oldsnapshot.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pageinspect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-plans.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-query.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-safety.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/parser-stage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/passwordcheck.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/performance-tips.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/perm-functions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgarchivecleanup.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgbench.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgbuffercache.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgcrypto.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgfreespacemap.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgprewarm.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgrowlocks.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgstatstatements.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgstattuple.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgsurgery.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgtestfsync.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgtesttiming.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgtrgm.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgupgrade.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgvisibility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgwaldump.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgwalinspect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pgxlogdump.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/planner-optimizer.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-details.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-security.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plhandler.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-builtins.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-data.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-event-triggers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-funcs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-global.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-triggers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-trusted.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-under-the-hood.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plperl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-control-structures.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-cursors.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-declarations.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-development-tips.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-errors-and-messages.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-expressions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-implementation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-porting.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-statements.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-structure.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-transactions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-trigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-data.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-database.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-do.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-envar.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-funcs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-python23.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-sharing.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-subtransaction.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-transactions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-trigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-util.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/plpython.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-config.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-data.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-dbaccess.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-error-handling.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-event-trigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-functions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-global.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-procnames.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-subtransactions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-transactions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-trigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/populate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-fdw.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-user.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/predefined-roles.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/preface.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/preventing-server-spoofing.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/progress-reporting.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-changes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-error-fields.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-flow.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/protocol-logical-replication.html | 35 +- .../html/protocol-logicalrep-message-formats.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-formats.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-types.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-replication.html | 9 +- doc/src/sgml/html/protocol.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-limit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-order.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-select-lists.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-table-expressions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-union.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-values.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries-with.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/queries.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/query-path.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/querytree.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rangetypes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/recovery-config.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/reference-client.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/reference-server.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/reference.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/regress-coverage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/regress-evaluation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/regress-run.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/regress-tap.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/regress-variant.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/regress.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-1.html | 10 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-2.html | 12 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-3.html | 12 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-4.html | 14 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-5.html | 12 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-6.html | 454 +++++++ doc/src/sgml/html/release-15.html | 60 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release-prior.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/release.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/replication-origins.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/resources.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/role-attributes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/role-membership.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/role-removal.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/routine-reindex.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/routine-vacuuming.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/row-estimation-examples.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rowtypes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rule-system.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rules-materializedviews.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rules-privileges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rules-status.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rules-triggers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rules-update.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rules-views.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/rules.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-autovacuum.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-client.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-compatible.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-connection.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-custom.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-developer.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/runtime-config-error-handling.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/runtime-config-file-locations.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-locks.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-logging.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-preset.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-query.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-replication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-resource.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-short.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-statistics.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-wal.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/runtime.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sasl-authentication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/seg.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sepgsql.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/server-programming.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/server-shutdown.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/server-start.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/source-conventions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/source-format.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/source.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sourcerepo.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-builtin-opclasses.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-examples.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-extensibility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-implementation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spgist.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-examples.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface-support.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-memory.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-realloc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-commit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-connect.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-copytuple.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-close.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-fetch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-find.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-move.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-args.html | 4 +- .../html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-paramlist.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-parse-open.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-exec.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execp.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-extended.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-extended.html | 4 +- .../html/spi-spi-execute-plan-with-paramlist.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-with-args.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-finish.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fname.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fnumber.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freeplan.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetuple.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetupletable.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargcount.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargtypeid.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getbinval.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getnspname.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getrelname.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettype.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettypeid.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getvalue.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-is-cursor-plan.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-keepplan.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-modifytuple.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-palloc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-pfree.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-cursor.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-extended.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-params.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-relation.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/spi-spi-register-trigger-data.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-result-code-string.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-returntuple.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-rollback.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-saveplan.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-fetch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-move.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-start-transaction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-unregister-relation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-transaction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi-visibility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/spi.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-abort.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteraggregate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altercollation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterconversion.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdatabase.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdefaultprivileges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdomain.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altereventtrigger.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterextension.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigndatawrapper.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigntable.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterfunction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altergroup.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterindex.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlanguage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlargeobject.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altermaterializedview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropclass.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteroperator.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropfamily.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpolicy.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterprocedure.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpublication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrole.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterroutine.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrule.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterschema.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersequence.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterserver.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterstatistics.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersubscription.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersystem.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertable.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertablespace.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertrigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsconfig.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsdictionary.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsparser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertstemplate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertype.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteruser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterusermapping.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-analyze.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-begin.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-call.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-checkpoint.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-close.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-cluster.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commands.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-comment.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit-prepared.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-copy.html | 12 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-create-access-method.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createaggregate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcast.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcollation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createconversion.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdatabase.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdomain.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createeventtrigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createextension.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/sql-createforeigndatawrapper.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigntable.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createfunction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creategroup.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createindex.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createlanguage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creatematerializedview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopclass.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createoperator.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopfamily.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpolicy.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createprocedure.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpublication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrole.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrule.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createschema.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsequence.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createserver.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createstatistics.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsubscription.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtable.html | 21 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtableas.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtablespace.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtransform.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtrigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsconfig.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsdictionary.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsparser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtstemplate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtype.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createuser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createusermapping.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-deallocate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-declare.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-delete.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-discard.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-do.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-access-method.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-owned.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropaggregate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcast.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcollation.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropconversion.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdatabase.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdomain.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropeventtrigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropextension.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigndatawrapper.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigntable.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropfunction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropgroup.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropindex.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droplanguage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropmaterializedview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopclass.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropoperator.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopfamily.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppolicy.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropprocedure.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppublication.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprole.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droproutine.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprule.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropschema.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsequence.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropserver.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropstatistics.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsubscription.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptable.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptablespace.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptransform.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptrigger.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsconfig.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsdictionary.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsparser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptstemplate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptype.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropuser.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropusermapping.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-end.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-execute.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-explain.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-expressions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-fetch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-grant.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-importforeignschema.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-insert.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-keywords-appendix.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-listen.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-load.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-lock.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-merge.html | 18 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-move.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-notify.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare-transaction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reassign-owned.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-refreshmaterializedview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reindex.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-release-savepoint.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reset.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-revoke.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-prepared.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-to.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-savepoint.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-security-label.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-select.html | 7 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-selectinto.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-constraints.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-role.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/sql-set-session-authorization.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-transaction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-show.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-start-transaction.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-calling-funcs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-lexical.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-truncate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-unlisten.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-update.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-vacuum.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql-values.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sql.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ssh-tunnels.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/ssl-tcp.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sslinfo.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/sspi-auth.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage-file-layout.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage-fsm.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage-hot.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage-init.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage-page-layout.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage-toast.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage-vm.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/storage.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/supported-platforms.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-declarations.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-initial-data.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tableam.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tablefunc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-method.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/tablesample-support-functions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tcn.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/test-decoding.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-configuration.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-controls.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-debugging.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-dictionaries.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-features.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-indexes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-limitations.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-parsers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-psql.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-tables.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/transaction-iso.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-datachanges.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-definition.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-example.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-interface.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/triggers.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-rows.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-time.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-accessdb.html | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-agg.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-arch.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-concepts.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-conclusion.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-createdb.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-delete.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-fk.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-inheritance.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-install.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-join.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-populate.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-select.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-start.html | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-table.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-transactions.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-update.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-views.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-window.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-func.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-oper.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-query.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-select.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-union-case.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/unaccent.html | 4 +- .../html/unsupported-features-sql-standard.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/upgrading.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/user-manag.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/using-explain.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/uuid-ossp.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/vacuumlo.html | 4 +- .../html/view-pg-available-extension-versions.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/view-pg-available-extensions.html | 4 +- .../sgml/html/view-pg-backend-memory-contexts.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-config.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-cursors.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-file-settings.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-group.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-hba-file-rules.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-ident-file-mappings.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-indexes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-locks.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-matviews.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-policies.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-statements.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-xacts.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-publication-tables.html | 4 +- .../html/view-pg-replication-origin-status.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-slots.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-roles.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-rules.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-seclabels.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-sequences.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-settings.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shadow.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shmem-allocations.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext-exprs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-tables.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-abbrevs.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-names.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user-mappings.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-views.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/views-overview.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/views.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/wal-async-commit.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/wal-configuration.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/wal-internals.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/wal-intro.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/wal-reliability.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/wal.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby-failover.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby.html | 6 +- .../sgml/html/when-can-parallel-query-be-used.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xaggr.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-c.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-internal.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-optimization.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-overload.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-pl.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-sql.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-volatility.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xindex.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xml-limits-conformance.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xml2.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xoper-optimization.html | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xoper.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xplang-install.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xplang.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xproc.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/html/xtypes.html | 4 +- doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml | 35 +- doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml | 34 +- doc/src/sgml/legal.sgml | 6 +- doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml | 7 +- doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml | 3 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/clusterdb.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/createdb.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/createuser.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/dropdb.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/dropuser.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/ecpg.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/initdb.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/oid2name.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_amcheck.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_archivecleanup.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_basebackup.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_checksums.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_config.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_controldata.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_ctl.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dump.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dumpall.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_isready.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_receivewal.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_recvlogical.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_resetwal.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_restore.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_rewind.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_fsync.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_timing.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_upgrade.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_verifybackup.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_waldump.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/pgbench.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/postgres.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/postmaster.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/psql.1 | 12 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/reindexdb.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumdb.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumlo.1 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_commit.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_connect.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_copytuple.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_close.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_fetch.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_find.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_move.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_args.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_parse_open.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_exec.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execp.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_extended.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_extended.3 | 8 +- .../sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_with_args.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_finish.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fname.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fnumber.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freeplan.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuple.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuptable.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargcount.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargtypeid.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getbinval.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getnspname.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getrelname.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettype.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettypeid.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getvalue.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_is_cursor_plan.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_keepplan.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_modifytuple.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_palloc.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_pfree.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_cursor.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_extended.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_params.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_relation.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_trigger_data.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_repalloc.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_result_code_string.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_returntuple.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_rollback.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_saveplan.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_move.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_start_transaction.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_unregister_relation.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_delete.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_insert.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_update.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_cancel_query.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_close.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect_u.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_disconnect.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_error_message.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_exec.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_fetch.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_connections.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_notify.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_pkey.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_result.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_is_busy.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_open.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_send_query.3 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ABORT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_AGGREGATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_COLLATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_CONVERSION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DATABASE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DEFAULT_PRIVILEGES.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DOMAIN.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 | 10 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EXTENSION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 | 10 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FUNCTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_GROUP.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_INDEX.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LANGUAGE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LARGE_OBJECT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_POLICY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PROCEDURE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PUBLICATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROUTINE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_RULE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SCHEMA.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SEQUENCE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SERVER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_STATISTICS.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SUBSCRIPTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SYSTEM.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLESPACE.7 | 8 +- .../sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TRIGGER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TYPE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER_MAPPING.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_VIEW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ANALYZE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/BEGIN.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CALL.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CHECKPOINT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CLOSE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CLUSTER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMENT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT_PREPARED.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/COPY.7 | 12 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ACCESS_METHOD.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_AGGREGATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CAST.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_COLLATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CONVERSION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DATABASE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DOMAIN.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EXTENSION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FUNCTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_GROUP.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_INDEX.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_LANGUAGE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_POLICY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PROCEDURE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PUBLICATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ROLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_RULE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SCHEMA.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SEQUENCE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SERVER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_STATISTICS.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SUBSCRIPTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE.7 | 20 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLESPACE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE_AS.7 | 8 +- .../sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRANSFORM.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRIGGER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TYPE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER_MAPPING.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_VIEW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DEALLOCATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DECLARE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DELETE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DISCARD.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DO.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ACCESS_METHOD.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_AGGREGATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CAST.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_COLLATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CONVERSION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DATABASE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DOMAIN.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EXTENSION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FUNCTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_GROUP.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_INDEX.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_LANGUAGE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OWNED.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_POLICY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PROCEDURE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PUBLICATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROUTINE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_RULE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SCHEMA.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SEQUENCE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SERVER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_STATISTICS.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SUBSCRIPTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLESPACE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRANSFORM.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRIGGER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TYPE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER_MAPPING.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_VIEW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/END.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/EXECUTE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/EXPLAIN.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/FETCH.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/GRANT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/IMPORT_FOREIGN_SCHEMA.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/INSERT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/LISTEN.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/LOAD.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/LOCK.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/MERGE.7 | 24 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/MOVE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/NOTIFY.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE_TRANSACTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/REASSIGN_OWNED.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/REFRESH_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/REINDEX.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/RELEASE_SAVEPOINT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/RESET.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/REVOKE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_PREPARED.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_TO_SAVEPOINT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SAVEPOINT.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SECURITY_LABEL.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT.7 | 11 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT_INTO.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SET.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_CONSTRAINTS.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_ROLE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_SESSION_AUTHORIZATION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_TRANSACTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/SHOW.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/START_TRANSACTION.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/TRUNCATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/UNLISTEN.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/UPDATE.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/VACUUM.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/man7/VALUES.7 | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml | 5 + doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml | 66 +- doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml | 2 +- doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml | 8 +- doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml | 19 +- doc/src/sgml/ref/merge.sgml | 14 +- doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml | 3 +- doc/src/sgml/release-15.sgml | 1347 +++++++++++++++++++- doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml | 12 + doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml | 2 +- 1467 files changed, 5730 insertions(+), 3692 deletions(-) create mode 100644 doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-6.html (limited to 'doc/src') diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml index 20d0c31..68e73b9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/client-auth.sgml @@ -631,7 +631,7 @@ hostnogssenc database userDN of a client certificate in this format, do -openssl x509 -in myclient.crt -noout --subject -nameopt RFC2253 | sed "s/^subject=//" +openssl x509 -in myclient.crt -noout -subject -nameopt RFC2253 | sed "s/^subject=//" Care needs to be taken when using this option, especially when using regular expression matching against the DN. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index cfe3dcb..efe68fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -1154,16 +1154,16 @@ CREATE TABLE posts ( A foreign key must reference columns that either are a primary key or - form a unique constraint. This means that the referenced columns always - have an index (the one underlying the primary key or unique constraint); - so checks on whether a referencing row has a match will be efficient. - Since a DELETE of a row from the referenced table - or an UPDATE of a referenced column will require - a scan of the referencing table for rows matching the old value, it - is often a good idea to index the referencing columns too. Because this - is not always needed, and there are many choices available on how - to index, declaration of a foreign key constraint does not - automatically create an index on the referencing columns. + form a unique constraint, or are columns from a non-partial unique index. + This means that the referenced columns always have an index to allow + efficient lookups on whether a referencing row has a match. Since a + DELETE of a row from the referenced table or an + UPDATE of a referenced column will require a scan of + the referencing table for rows matching the old value, it is often a good + idea to index the referencing columns too. Because this is not always + needed, and there are many choices available on how to index, the + declaration of a foreign key constraint does not automatically create an + index on the referencing columns. @@ -2253,9 +2253,16 @@ REVOKE ALL ON accounts FROM PUBLIC; aclitem The privileges that have been granted for a particular object are - displayed as a list of aclitem entries, where each - aclitem describes the permissions of one grantee that - have been granted by a particular grantor. For example, + displayed as a list of aclitem entries, each having the + format: + +grantee=privilege-abbreviation*.../grantor + + Each aclitem lists all the permissions of one grantee that + have been granted by a particular grantor. Specific privileges are + represented by one-letter abbreviations from + , with * + appended if the privilege was granted with grant option. For example, calvin=r*w/hobbes specifies that the role calvin has the privilege SELECT (r) with grant option @@ -4150,7 +4157,7 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 CREATE INDEX measurement_usls_idx ON ONLY measurement (unitsales); -CREATE INDEX measurement_usls_200602_idx +CREATE INDEX CONCURRENTLY measurement_usls_200602_idx ON measurement_y2006m02 (unitsales); ALTER INDEX measurement_usls_idx ATTACH PARTITION measurement_usls_200602_idx; @@ -4267,7 +4274,9 @@ ALTER INDEX measurement_city_id_logdate_key Using ONLY to add or drop a constraint on only the partitioned table is supported as long as there are no partitions. Once partitions exist, using ONLY - will result in an error. Instead, constraints on the partitions + will result in an error for any constraints other than + UNIQUE and PRIMARY KEY. + Instead, constraints on the partitions themselves can be added and (if they are not present in the parent table) dropped. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml index d0b5951..7653bbf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/fdwhandler.sgml @@ -67,13 +67,16 @@ foreign tables using the wrapper. The validator function must be registered as taking two arguments, a text array containing the options to be validated, and an OID - representing the type of object the options are associated with (in - the form of the OID of the system catalog the object would be stored - in, either - ForeignDataWrapperRelationId, - ForeignServerRelationId, - UserMappingRelationId, - or ForeignTableRelationId). + representing the type of object the options are associated with. The + latter corresponds to the OID of the system catalog the object + would be stored in, one of: + + AttributeRelationId + ForeignDataWrapperRelationId + ForeignServerRelationId + ForeignTableRelationId + UserMappingRelationId + If no validator function is supplied, options are not checked at object creation time or object alteration time. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/glossary.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/glossary.sgml index d6d0a3a..ada723a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/glossary.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/glossary.sgml @@ -990,8 +990,8 @@ (just like a view), but stores data in the same way that a table does. It cannot be - modified via INSERT, UPDATE, or - DELETE operations. + modified via INSERT, UPDATE, + DELETE, or MERGE operations. For more information, see @@ -1000,6 +1000,23 @@ + + Merge + + + An SQL command used to conditionally add, modify, + or remove rows + in a given table, + using data from a source + relation. + + + For more information, see + . + + + + Multi-version concurrency control (MVCC) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index e4f4903..7aa6fef 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -648,7 +648,7 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. later disconnected, the standby goes back to step 1 and tries to restore the file from the archive again. This loop of retries from the archive, pg_wal, and via streaming replication goes on until the server - is stopped or failover is triggered by a trigger file. + is stopped or is promoted. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/acronyms.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/acronyms.html index 94dfb64..a732381 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/acronyms.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/acronyms.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix L. Acronyms

Appendix L. Acronyms

+Appendix L. Acronyms

Appendix L. Acronyms

This is a list of acronyms commonly used in the PostgreSQL documentation and in discussions about PostgreSQL. @@ -137,7 +137,7 @@ Pluggable Authentication Modules

PGSQL

- PostgreSQL + PostgreSQL

PGXS

PostgreSQL Extension System

PID

@@ -216,4 +216,4 @@ Extensible Markup Language

-

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/admin.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/admin.html index 3653cc1..592bbaa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/admin.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/admin.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Part III. Server Administration

Part III. Server Administration

+Part III. Server Administration

Part III. Server Administration

This part covers topics that are of interest to a PostgreSQL database administrator. This includes installation of the software, set up and configuration of the @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ the PostgreSQL database system. Readers are encouraged to look at Part I and Part II for additional information.

Table of Contents

16. Installation from Binaries
17. Installation from Source Code
17.1. Short Version
17.2. Requirements
17.3. Getting the Source
17.4. Installation Procedure
17.5. Post-Installation Setup
17.6. Supported Platforms
17.7. Platform-Specific Notes
18. Installation from Source Code on Windows
18.1. Building with Visual C++ or the - Microsoft Windows SDK
19. Server Setup and Operation
19.1. The PostgreSQL User Account
19.2. Creating a Database Cluster
19.3. Starting the Database Server
19.4. Managing Kernel Resources
19.5. Shutting Down the Server
19.6. Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
19.7. Preventing Server Spoofing
19.8. Encryption Options
19.9. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL
19.10. Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption
19.11. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels
19.12. Registering Event Log on Windows
20. Server Configuration
20.1. Setting Parameters
20.2. File Locations
20.3. Connections and Authentication
20.4. Resource Consumption
20.5. Write Ahead Log
20.6. Replication
20.7. Query Planning
20.8. Error Reporting and Logging
20.9. Run-time Statistics
20.10. Automatic Vacuuming
20.11. Client Connection Defaults
20.12. Lock Management
20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility
20.14. Error Handling
20.15. Preset Options
20.16. Customized Options
20.17. Developer Options
20.18. Short Options
21. Client Authentication
21.1. The pg_hba.conf File
21.2. User Name Maps
21.3. Authentication Methods
21.4. Trust Authentication
21.5. Password Authentication
21.6. GSSAPI Authentication
21.7. SSPI Authentication
21.8. Ident Authentication
21.9. Peer Authentication
21.10. LDAP Authentication
21.11. RADIUS Authentication
21.12. Certificate Authentication
21.13. PAM Authentication
21.14. BSD Authentication
21.15. Authentication Problems
22. Database Roles
22.1. Database Roles
22.2. Role Attributes
22.3. Role Membership
22.4. Dropping Roles
22.5. Predefined Roles
22.6. Function Security
23. Managing Databases
23.1. Overview
23.2. Creating a Database
23.3. Template Databases
23.4. Database Configuration
23.5. Destroying a Database
23.6. Tablespaces
24. Localization
24.1. Locale Support
24.2. Collation Support
24.3. Character Set Support
25. Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
25.1. Routine Vacuuming
25.2. Routine Reindexing
25.3. Log File Maintenance
26. Backup and Restore
26.1. SQL Dump
26.2. File System Level Backup
26.3. Continuous Archiving and Point-in-Time Recovery (PITR)
27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
27.1. Comparison of Different Solutions
27.2. Log-Shipping Standby Servers
27.3. Failover
27.4. Hot Standby
28. Monitoring Database Activity
28.1. Standard Unix Tools
28.2. The Cumulative Statistics System
28.3. Viewing Locks
28.4. Progress Reporting
28.5. Dynamic Tracing
29. Monitoring Disk Usage
29.1. Determining Disk Usage
29.2. Disk Full Failure
30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log
30.1. Reliability
30.2. Data Checksums
30.3. Write-Ahead Logging (WAL)
30.4. Asynchronous Commit
30.5. WAL Configuration
30.6. WAL Internals
31. Logical Replication
31.1. Publication
31.2. Subscription
31.3. Row Filters
31.4. Column Lists
31.5. Conflicts
31.6. Restrictions
31.7. Architecture
31.8. Monitoring
31.9. Security
31.10. Configuration Settings
31.11. Quick Setup
32. Just-in-Time Compilation (JIT)
32.1. What Is JIT compilation?
32.2. When to JIT?
32.3. Configuration
32.4. Extensibility
33. Regression Tests
33.1. Running the Tests
33.2. Test Evaluation
33.3. Variant Comparison Files
33.4. TAP Tests
33.5. Test Coverage Examination
\ No newline at end of file + Microsoft Windows SDK
19. Server Setup and Operation
19.1. The PostgreSQL User Account
19.2. Creating a Database Cluster
19.3. Starting the Database Server
19.4. Managing Kernel Resources
19.5. Shutting Down the Server
19.6. Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
19.7. Preventing Server Spoofing
19.8. Encryption Options
19.9. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL
19.10. Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption
19.11. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels
19.12. Registering Event Log on Windows
20. Server Configuration
20.1. Setting Parameters
20.2. File Locations
20.3. Connections and Authentication
20.4. Resource Consumption
20.5. Write Ahead Log
20.6. Replication
20.7. Query Planning
20.8. Error Reporting and Logging
20.9. Run-time Statistics
20.10. Automatic Vacuuming
20.11. Client Connection Defaults
20.12. Lock Management
20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility
20.14. Error Handling
20.15. Preset Options
20.16. Customized Options
20.17. Developer Options
20.18. Short Options
21. Client Authentication
21.1. The pg_hba.conf File
21.2. User Name Maps
21.3. Authentication Methods
21.4. Trust Authentication
21.5. Password Authentication
21.6. GSSAPI Authentication
21.7. SSPI Authentication
21.8. Ident Authentication
21.9. Peer Authentication
21.10. LDAP Authentication
21.11. RADIUS Authentication
21.12. Certificate Authentication
21.13. PAM Authentication
21.14. BSD Authentication
21.15. Authentication Problems
22. Database Roles
22.1. Database Roles
22.2. Role Attributes
22.3. Role Membership
22.4. Dropping Roles
22.5. Predefined Roles
22.6. Function Security
23. Managing Databases
23.1. Overview
23.2. Creating a Database
23.3. Template Databases
23.4. Database Configuration
23.5. Destroying a Database
23.6. Tablespaces
24. Localization
24.1. Locale Support
24.2. Collation Support
24.3. Character Set Support
25. Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
25.1. Routine Vacuuming
25.2. Routine Reindexing
25.3. Log File Maintenance
26. Backup and Restore
26.1. SQL Dump
26.2. File System Level Backup
26.3. Continuous Archiving and Point-in-Time Recovery (PITR)
27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
27.1. Comparison of Different Solutions
27.2. Log-Shipping Standby Servers
27.3. Failover
27.4. Hot Standby
28. Monitoring Database Activity
28.1. Standard Unix Tools
28.2. The Cumulative Statistics System
28.3. Viewing Locks
28.4. Progress Reporting
28.5. Dynamic Tracing
29. Monitoring Disk Usage
29.1. Determining Disk Usage
29.2. Disk Full Failure
30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log
30.1. Reliability
30.2. Data Checksums
30.3. Write-Ahead Logging (WAL)
30.4. Asynchronous Commit
30.5. WAL Configuration
30.6. WAL Internals
31. Logical Replication
31.1. Publication
31.2. Subscription
31.3. Row Filters
31.4. Column Lists
31.5. Conflicts
31.6. Restrictions
31.7. Architecture
31.8. Monitoring
31.9. Security
31.10. Configuration Settings
31.11. Quick Setup
32. Just-in-Time Compilation (JIT)
32.1. What Is JIT compilation?
32.2. When to JIT?
32.3. Configuration
32.4. Extensibility
33. Regression Tests
33.1. Running the Tests
33.2. Test Evaluation
33.3. Variant Comparison Files
33.4. TAP Tests
33.5. Test Coverage Examination
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/adminpack.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/adminpack.html index ef27467..974ee3d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/adminpack.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/adminpack.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.1. adminpack

F.1. adminpack

+F.1. adminpack

F.1. adminpack

adminpack provides a number of support functions which pgAdmin and other administration and management tools can use to provide additional functionality, such as remote management @@ -86,4 +86,4 @@ directory. The log_filename parameter must have its default setting (postgresql-%Y-%m-%d_%H%M%S.log) to use this function. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/amcheck.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/amcheck.html index 97a929a..a896fdc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/amcheck.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/amcheck.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.2. amcheck

F.2. amcheck

+F.2. amcheck

F.2. amcheck

The amcheck module provides functions that allow you to verify the logical consistency of the structure of relations.

@@ -374,4 +374,4 @@ SET client_min_messages = DEBUG1; an invariant violation should be sought. pageinspect may play a useful role in diagnosing corruption that amcheck detects. A REINDEX may not be effective in repairing corruption. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-clusterdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-clusterdb.html index 83df6df..f0821fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-clusterdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-clusterdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -clusterdb

clusterdb

clusterdb — cluster a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

clusterdb [connection-option...] [ --verbose | -v ] +clusterdb

clusterdb

clusterdb — cluster a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

clusterdb [connection-option...] [ --verbose | -v ] [ --table | -t table @@ -119,4 +119,4 @@ xyzzy:

 $ clusterdb --table=foo xyzzy
-

See Also

CLUSTER
\ No newline at end of file +

See Also

CLUSTER
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createdb.html index aad42a6..f54a08f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -createdb

createdb

createdb — create a new PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

createdb [connection-option...] [option...] [dbname +createdb

createdb

createdb — create a new PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

createdb [connection-option...] [option...] [dbname [description]]

Description

createdb creates a new PostgreSQL database. @@ -146,4 +146,4 @@

 $ createdb -p 5000 -h eden -T template0 -e demo
 CREATE DATABASE demo TEMPLATE template0;
-
\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createuser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createuser.html index 3e4d5be..7663ceb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createuser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-createuser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -createuser

createuser

createuser — define a new PostgreSQL user account

Synopsis

createuser [connection-option...] [option...] [username]

Description

+createuser

createuser

createuser — define a new PostgreSQL user account

Synopsis

createuser [connection-option...] [option...] [username]

Description

createuser creates a new PostgreSQL user (or more precisely, a role). Only superusers and users with CREATEROLE privilege can create @@ -187,4 +187,4 @@ In the above example, the new password isn't actually echoed when typed, but we show what was typed for clarity. As you see, the password is encrypted before it is sent to the client. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropdb.html index 16be89b..122227e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dropdb

dropdb

dropdb — remove a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

dropdb [connection-option...] [option...] dbname

Description

+dropdb

dropdb

dropdb — remove a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

dropdb [connection-option...] [option...] dbname

Description

dropdb destroys an existing PostgreSQL database. The user who executes this command must be a database @@ -108,4 +108,4 @@ Database "demo" will be permanently deleted. Are you sure? (y/n) y DROP DATABASE demo; -

\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropuser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropuser.html index 11fb25c..795d411 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropuser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-dropuser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dropuser

dropuser

dropuser — remove a PostgreSQL user account

Synopsis

dropuser [connection-option...] [option...] [username]

Description

+dropuser

dropuser

dropuser — remove a PostgreSQL user account

Synopsis

dropuser [connection-option...] [option...] [username]

Description

dropuser removes an existing PostgreSQL user. Only superusers and users with the CREATEROLE privilege can @@ -100,4 +100,4 @@ Role "joe" will be permanently removed. Are you sure? (y/n) y DROP ROLE joe; -

\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-ecpg.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-ecpg.html index 377e376..2b48acf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-ecpg.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-ecpg.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ecpg

ecpg

ecpg — embedded SQL C preprocessor

Synopsis

ecpg [option...] file...

Description

+ecpg

ecpg

ecpg — embedded SQL C preprocessor

Synopsis

ecpg [option...] file...

Description

ecpg is the embedded SQL preprocessor for C programs. It converts C programs with embedded SQL statements to normal C code by replacing the SQL invocations with special @@ -103,4 +103,4 @@ ecpg prog1.pgc cc -I/usr/local/pgsql/include -c prog1.c cc -o prog1 prog1.o -L/usr/local/pgsql/lib -lecpg -

\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-initdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-initdb.html index 00f2877..b02c604 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-initdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-initdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -initdb

initdb

initdb — create a new PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

initdb [option...] [ --pgdata | -D ] directory

Description

+initdb

initdb

initdb — create a new PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

initdb [option...] [ --pgdata | -D ] directory

Description

initdb creates a new PostgreSQL database cluster. A database cluster is a collection of databases that are managed by a single @@ -248,4 +248,4 @@

Notes

initdb can also be invoked via pg_ctl initdb. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-ctl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-ctl.html index dafbad2..aa490cd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-ctl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-ctl.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_ctl

pg_ctl

pg_ctl — initialize, start, stop, or control a PostgreSQL server

Synopsis

pg_ctl init[db] [-D datadir] [-s] [-o initdb-options]

pg_ctl start [-D datadir] [-l filename] [-W] [-t seconds] [-s] [-o options] [-p path] [-c]

pg_ctl stop [-D datadir] [-m +pg_ctl

pg_ctl

pg_ctl — initialize, start, stop, or control a PostgreSQL server

Synopsis

pg_ctl init[db] [-D datadir] [-s] [-o initdb-options]

pg_ctl start [-D datadir] [-l filename] [-W] [-t seconds] [-s] [-o options] [-p path] [-c]

pg_ctl stop [-D datadir] [-m s[mart] | f[ast] | i[mmediate] ] [-W] [-t seconds] [-s]

pg_ctl restart [-D datadir] [-m s[mart] | f[ast] | i[mmediate] @@ -285,4 +285,4 @@ pg_ctl: server is running (PID: 13718) /usr/local/pgsql/bin/postgres "-D" "/usr/local/pgsql/data" "-p" "5433" "-B" "128"

The second line is the command that would be invoked in restart mode. -

See Also

initdb, postgres
\ No newline at end of file +

See Also

initdb, postgres
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-dumpall.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-dumpall.html index 3c574b4..1d374d6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-dumpall.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-dumpall.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_dumpall

pg_dumpall

pg_dumpall — extract a PostgreSQL database cluster into a script file

Synopsis

pg_dumpall [connection-option...] [option...]

Description

+pg_dumpall

pg_dumpall

pg_dumpall — extract a PostgreSQL database cluster into a script file

Synopsis

pg_dumpall [connection-option...] [option...]

Description

pg_dumpall is a utility for writing out (dumping) all PostgreSQL databases of a cluster into one script file. The script file contains @@ -361,4 +361,4 @@

See Also

Check pg_dump for details on possible error conditions. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-isready.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-isready.html index b193fc5..31a2f67 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-isready.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pg-isready.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_isready

pg_isready

pg_isready — check the connection status of a PostgreSQL server

Synopsis

pg_isready [connection-option...] [option...]

Description

+pg_isready

pg_isready

pg_isready — check the connection status of a PostgreSQL server

Synopsis

pg_isready [connection-option...] [option...]

Description

pg_isready is a utility for checking the connection status of a PostgreSQL database server. The exit status specifies the result of the connection check. @@ -76,4 +76,4 @@ $ echo $? 2

-

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgamcheck.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgamcheck.html index 8096ada..1fdcc18 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgamcheck.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgamcheck.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_amcheck

pg_amcheck

pg_amcheck — checks for corruption in one or more +pg_amcheck

pg_amcheck

pg_amcheck — checks for corruption in one or more PostgreSQL databases

Synopsis

pg_amcheck [option...] [dbname]

Description

pg_amcheck supports running amcheck's corruption checking functions against one or @@ -292,4 +292,4 @@

Notes

pg_amcheck is designed to work with PostgreSQL 14.0 and later. -

See Also

amcheck
\ No newline at end of file +

See Also

amcheck
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgbasebackup.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgbasebackup.html index 16a5f66..c987d24 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgbasebackup.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgbasebackup.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_basebackup

pg_basebackup

pg_basebackup — take a base backup of a PostgreSQL cluster

Synopsis

pg_basebackup [option...]

Description

+pg_basebackup

pg_basebackup

pg_basebackup — take a base backup of a PostgreSQL cluster

Synopsis

pg_basebackup [option...]

Description

pg_basebackup is used to take a base backup of a running PostgreSQL database cluster. The backup is taken without affecting other clients of the database, and can be used @@ -547,4 +547,4 @@ directory backup:

 $ pg_basebackup -D backup -Ft --compress=gzip:9
-
\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgchecksums.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgchecksums.html index 8e940c1..bc90b0e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgchecksums.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgchecksums.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_checksums

pg_checksums

pg_checksums — enable, disable or check data checksums in a PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

pg_checksums [option...] [[ -D | --pgdata ]datadir]

Description

+pg_checksums

pg_checksums

pg_checksums — enable, disable or check data checksums in a PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

pg_checksums [option...] [[ -D | --pgdata ]datadir]

Description

pg_checksums checks, enables or disables data checksums in a PostgreSQL cluster. The server must be shut down cleanly before running @@ -72,4 +72,4 @@ enabling or disabling checksums, the cluster's data checksum configuration remains unchanged, and pg_checksums can be re-run to perform the same operation. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgconfig.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgconfig.html index e37f8de..124c73d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgconfig.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgconfig.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_config

pg_config

pg_config — retrieve information about the installed version of PostgreSQL

Synopsis

pg_config [option...]

Description

+pg_config

pg_config

pg_config — retrieve information about the installed version of PostgreSQL

Synopsis

pg_config [option...]

Description

The pg_config utility prints configuration parameters of the currently installed version of PostgreSQL. It is intended, for example, to be used by software packages that want to interface @@ -107,4 +107,4 @@ eval ./configure `pg_config --configure` shell quotation marks so arguments with spaces are represented correctly. Therefore, using eval is required for proper results. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgcontroldata.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgcontroldata.html index 79f6509..cccb75e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgcontroldata.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgcontroldata.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_controldata

pg_controldata

pg_controldata — display control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

pg_controldata [option] [[ -D | --pgdata ]datadir]

Description

+pg_controldata

pg_controldata

pg_controldata — display control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

pg_controldata [option] [[ -D | --pgdata ]datadir]

Description

pg_controldata prints information initialized during initdb, such as the catalog version. It also shows information about write-ahead logging and checkpoint @@ -20,4 +20,4 @@ Specifies whether to use color in diagnostic messages. Possible values are always, auto and never. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgdump.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgdump.html index a27bd9a..0add9b8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgdump.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgdump.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_dump

pg_dump

pg_dump — +pg_dump

pg_dump

pg_dump — extract a PostgreSQL database into a script file or other archive file

Synopsis

pg_dump [connection-option...] [option...] [dbname]

Description

pg_dump is a utility for backing up a @@ -821,4 +821,4 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0;

 $ pg_dump -t "\"MixedCaseName\"" mydb > mytab.sql
-
\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivewal.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivewal.html index c5e6b06..e82e98b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivewal.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivewal.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_receivewal

pg_receivewal

pg_receivewal — stream write-ahead logs from a PostgreSQL server

Synopsis

pg_receivewal [option...]

Description

+pg_receivewal

pg_receivewal

pg_receivewal — stream write-ahead logs from a PostgreSQL server

Synopsis

pg_receivewal [option...]

Description

pg_receivewal is used to stream the write-ahead log from a running PostgreSQL cluster. The write-ahead log is streamed using the streaming replication protocol, and is written @@ -246,4 +246,4 @@ /usr/local/pgsql/archive:

 $ pg_receivewal -h mydbserver -D /usr/local/pgsql/archive
-
\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivexlog.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivexlog.html index 459f79e..18edb30 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivexlog.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgreceivexlog.html @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ -O.5. pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal

O.5. pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal

+O.5. pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal

O.5. pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal

PostgreSQL 9.6 and below provided a command named pg_receivexlog to fetch write-ahead-log (WAL) files. This command was renamed to pg_receivewal, see pg_receivewal for documentation of pg_receivewal and see - the release notes for PostgreSQL 10 for details + the release notes for PostgreSQL 10 for details on this change. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrecvlogical.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrecvlogical.html index a6d0c79..3e547c2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrecvlogical.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrecvlogical.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_recvlogical

pg_recvlogical

pg_recvlogical — control PostgreSQL logical decoding streams

Synopsis

pg_recvlogical [option...]

Description

+pg_recvlogical

pg_recvlogical

pg_recvlogical — control PostgreSQL logical decoding streams

Synopsis

pg_recvlogical [option...]

Description

pg_recvlogical controls logical decoding replication slots and streams data from such replication slots.

@@ -174,4 +174,4 @@ cluster.

Examples

See Section 49.1 for an example. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetwal.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetwal.html index d8014dc..12f6173 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetwal.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetwal.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_resetwal

pg_resetwal

pg_resetwal — reset the write-ahead log and other control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

pg_resetwal [ -f | --force ] [ -n | --dry-run ] [option...] [ -D | --pgdata ]datadir

Description

+pg_resetwal

pg_resetwal

pg_resetwal — reset the write-ahead log and other control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster

Synopsis

pg_resetwal [ -f | --force ] [ -n | --dry-run ] [option...] [ -D | --pgdata ]datadir

Description

pg_resetwal clears the write-ahead log (WAL) and optionally resets some other control information stored in the pg_control file. This function is sometimes needed @@ -166,4 +166,4 @@

pg_resetwal works only with servers of the same major version. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetxlog.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetxlog.html index 227bf0b..12a52d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetxlog.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgresetxlog.html @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ -O.4. pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal

O.4. pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal

+O.4. pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal

O.4. pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal

PostgreSQL 9.6 and below provided a command named pg_resetxlog to reset the write-ahead-log (WAL) files. This command was renamed to pg_resetwal, see pg_resetwal for documentation of pg_resetwal and see - the release notes for PostgreSQL 10 for details + the release notes for PostgreSQL 10 for details on this change. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrestore.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrestore.html index 1c0034d..29f8ab4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrestore.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrestore.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_restore

pg_restore

pg_restore — +pg_restore

pg_restore

pg_restore — restore a PostgreSQL database from an archive file created by pg_dump

Synopsis

pg_restore [connection-option...] [option...] [filename]

Description

@@ -501,4 +501,4 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0; items 10 and 6, in that order:

 $ pg_restore -L db.list db.dump
-
\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrewind.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrewind.html index c23f061..3ef9414 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrewind.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgrewind.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_rewind

pg_rewind

pg_rewind — synchronize a PostgreSQL data directory with another data directory that was forked from it

Synopsis

pg_rewind [option...] { -D | --target-pgdata } directory { --source-pgdata=directory | --source-server=connstr }

Description

+pg_rewind

pg_rewind

pg_rewind — synchronize a PostgreSQL data directory with another data directory that was forked from it

Synopsis

pg_rewind [option...] { -D | --target-pgdata } directory { --source-pgdata=directory | --source-server=connstr }

Description

pg_rewind is a tool for synchronizing a PostgreSQL cluster with another copy of the same cluster, after the clusters' timelines have diverged. A typical scenario is to bring an old primary server back online @@ -213,4 +213,4 @@ GRANT EXECUTE ON function pg_catalog.pg_read_binary_file(text, bigint, bigint, b When starting the target, PostgreSQL replays all the required WAL, resulting in a data directory in a consistent state. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgverifybackup.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgverifybackup.html index 058b47b..b2ced0f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgverifybackup.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-pgverifybackup.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_verifybackup

pg_verifybackup

pg_verifybackup — verify the integrity of a base backup of a +pg_verifybackup

pg_verifybackup

pg_verifybackup — verify the integrity of a base backup of a PostgreSQL cluster

Synopsis

pg_verifybackup [option...]

Description

pg_verifybackup is used to check the integrity of a database cluster backup taken using @@ -141,4 +141,4 @@ $ pg_basebackup -h mydbserver -D /usr/local/pgsql/data $ edit /usr/local/pgsql/data/note.to.self $ pg_verifybackup --ignore=note.to.self --skip-checksums /usr/local/pgsql/data -

\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postgres.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postgres.html index 8c896c9..8b834d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postgres.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postgres.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -postgres

postgres

postgres — PostgreSQL database server

Synopsis

postgres [option...]

Description

+postgres

postgres

postgres — PostgreSQL database server

Synopsis

postgres [option...]

Description

postgres is the PostgreSQL database server. In order for a client application to access a database it connects (over a @@ -429,4 +429,4 @@

See Also

initdb, pg_ctl -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postmaster.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postmaster.html index d29a306..ceb75e8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postmaster.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-postmaster.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ -postmaster

postmaster

postmaster — PostgreSQL database server

Synopsis

postmaster [option...]

Description

+postmaster

postmaster

postmaster — PostgreSQL database server

Synopsis

postmaster [option...]

Description

postmaster is a deprecated alias of postgres.

See Also

postgres -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-psql.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-psql.html index 783b3c4..c3f9696 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-psql.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-psql.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -psql

psql

psql — +psql

psql

psqlPostgreSQL interactive terminal

Synopsis

psql [option...] [dbname [username]]

Description

@@ -345,7 +345,7 @@ $ psql postgresql://dbmaster:5433/mydb?sslmode=r the string =>. For example:

 $ psql testdb
-psql (15.5)
+psql (15.6)
 Type "help" for help.
 
 testdb=>
@@ -2725,7 +2725,7 @@ PSQL_EDITOR_LINENUMBER_ARG='--line '
      by appending a dash and the PostgreSQL
      major or minor release identifier to the file name,
      for example ~/.psqlrc-15 or
-     ~/.psqlrc-15.5.
+     ~/.psqlrc-15.6.
      The most specific version-matching file will be read in preference
      to a non-version-specific file.
      These version suffixes are added after determining the file path
@@ -2956,4 +2956,4 @@ testdb(> \crosstabview "A" "B" "AxB" ord
\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-reindexdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-reindexdb.html index 1295f0a..f339b67 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-reindexdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-reindexdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -reindexdb

reindexdb

reindexdb — reindex a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

reindexdb [connection-option...] [option...] +reindexdb

reindexdb

reindexdb — reindex a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

reindexdb [connection-option...] [option...] [ -S | --schema schema @@ -161,4 +161,4 @@ bar in a database named abcd:

 $ reindexdb --table=foo --index=bar abcd
-

See Also

REINDEX
\ No newline at end of file +

See Also

REINDEX
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-vacuumdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-vacuumdb.html index c3fc6e5..3dd8984 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/app-vacuumdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/app-vacuumdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -vacuumdb

vacuumdb

vacuumdb — garbage-collect and analyze a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

vacuumdb [connection-option...] [option...] +vacuumdb

vacuumdb

vacuumdb — garbage-collect and analyze a PostgreSQL database

Synopsis

vacuumdb [connection-option...] [option...] [ -t | --table table @@ -241,4 +241,4 @@ bar of the table for the optimizer:

 $ vacuumdb --analyze --verbose --table='foo(bar)' xyzzy
-

See Also

VACUUM
\ No newline at end of file +

See Also

VACUUM
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/appendix-obsolete.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/appendix-obsolete.html index 8a07dd0..db375f2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/appendix-obsolete.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/appendix-obsolete.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -Appendix O. Obsolete or Renamed Features

Appendix O. Obsolete or Renamed Features

+Appendix O. Obsolete or Renamed Features

Appendix O. Obsolete or Renamed Features

Functionality is sometimes removed from PostgreSQL, feature, setting and file names sometimes change, or documentation moves to different places. This section directs users coming from old versions of the documentation or from external links to the appropriate new location for the information they need. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/appendixes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/appendixes.html index 9b2c6f1..fed3a4c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/appendixes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/appendixes.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Part VIII. Appendixes

Part VIII. Appendixes

Table of Contents

A. PostgreSQL Error Codes
B. Date/Time Support
B.1. Date/Time Input Interpretation
B.2. Handling of Invalid or Ambiguous Timestamps
B.3. Date/Time Key Words
B.4. Date/Time Configuration Files
B.5. POSIX Time Zone Specifications
B.6. History of Units
B.7. Julian Dates
C. SQL Key Words
D. SQL Conformance
D.1. Supported Features
D.2. Unsupported Features
D.3. XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML
E. Release Notes
E.1. Release 15.5
E.2. Release 15.4
E.3. Release 15.3
E.4. Release 15.2
E.5. Release 15.1
E.6. Release 15
E.7. Prior Releases
F. Additional Supplied Modules
F.1. adminpack
F.2. amcheck
F.3. auth_delay
F.4. auto_explain
F.5. basebackup_to_shell
F.6. basic_archive
F.7. bloom
F.8. btree_gin
F.9. btree_gist
F.10. citext
F.11. cube
F.12. dblink
F.13. dict_int
F.14. dict_xsyn
F.15. earthdistance
F.16. file_fdw
F.17. fuzzystrmatch
F.18. hstore
F.19. intagg
F.20. intarray
F.21. isn
F.22. lo
F.23. ltree
F.24. old_snapshot
F.25. pageinspect
F.26. passwordcheck
F.27. pg_buffercache
F.28. pgcrypto
F.29. pg_freespacemap
F.30. pg_prewarm
F.31. pgrowlocks
F.32. pg_stat_statements
F.33. pgstattuple
F.34. pg_surgery
F.35. pg_trgm
F.36. pg_visibility
F.37. pg_walinspect
F.38. postgres_fdw
F.39. seg
F.40. sepgsql
F.41. spi
F.42. sslinfo
F.43. tablefunc
F.44. tcn
F.45. test_decoding
F.46. tsm_system_rows
F.47. tsm_system_time
F.48. unaccent
F.49. uuid-ossp
F.50. xml2
G. Additional Supplied Programs
G.1. Client Applications
G.2. Server Applications
H. External Projects
H.1. Client Interfaces
H.2. Administration Tools
H.3. Procedural Languages
H.4. Extensions
I. The Source Code Repository
I.1. Getting the Source via Git
J. Documentation
J.1. DocBook
J.2. Tool Sets
J.3. Building the Documentation
J.4. Documentation Authoring
J.5. Style Guide
K. PostgreSQL Limits
L. Acronyms
M. Glossary
N. Color Support
N.1. When Color is Used
N.2. Configuring the Colors
O. Obsolete or Renamed Features
O.1. recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf
O.2. Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles
O.3. pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump
O.4. pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal
O.5. pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal
\ No newline at end of file +Part VIII. Appendixes

Part VIII. Appendixes

Table of Contents

A. PostgreSQL Error Codes
B. Date/Time Support
B.1. Date/Time Input Interpretation
B.2. Handling of Invalid or Ambiguous Timestamps
B.3. Date/Time Key Words
B.4. Date/Time Configuration Files
B.5. POSIX Time Zone Specifications
B.6. History of Units
B.7. Julian Dates
C. SQL Key Words
D. SQL Conformance
D.1. Supported Features
D.2. Unsupported Features
D.3. XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML
E. Release Notes
E.1. Release 15.6
E.2. Release 15.5
E.3. Release 15.4
E.4. Release 15.3
E.5. Release 15.2
E.6. Release 15.1
E.7. Release 15
E.8. Prior Releases
F. Additional Supplied Modules
F.1. adminpack
F.2. amcheck
F.3. auth_delay
F.4. auto_explain
F.5. basebackup_to_shell
F.6. basic_archive
F.7. bloom
F.8. btree_gin
F.9. btree_gist
F.10. citext
F.11. cube
F.12. dblink
F.13. dict_int
F.14. dict_xsyn
F.15. earthdistance
F.16. file_fdw
F.17. fuzzystrmatch
F.18. hstore
F.19. intagg
F.20. intarray
F.21. isn
F.22. lo
F.23. ltree
F.24. old_snapshot
F.25. pageinspect
F.26. passwordcheck
F.27. pg_buffercache
F.28. pgcrypto
F.29. pg_freespacemap
F.30. pg_prewarm
F.31. pgrowlocks
F.32. pg_stat_statements
F.33. pgstattuple
F.34. pg_surgery
F.35. pg_trgm
F.36. pg_visibility
F.37. pg_walinspect
F.38. postgres_fdw
F.39. seg
F.40. sepgsql
F.41. spi
F.42. sslinfo
F.43. tablefunc
F.44. tcn
F.45. test_decoding
F.46. tsm_system_rows
F.47. tsm_system_time
F.48. unaccent
F.49. uuid-ossp
F.50. xml2
G. Additional Supplied Programs
G.1. Client Applications
G.2. Server Applications
H. External Projects
H.1. Client Interfaces
H.2. Administration Tools
H.3. Procedural Languages
H.4. Extensions
I. The Source Code Repository
I.1. Getting the Source via Git
J. Documentation
J.1. DocBook
J.2. Tool Sets
J.3. Building the Documentation
J.4. Documentation Authoring
J.5. Style Guide
K. PostgreSQL Limits
L. Acronyms
M. Glossary
N. Color Support
N.1. When Color is Used
N.2. Configuring the Colors
O. Obsolete or Renamed Features
O.1. recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf
O.2. Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles
O.3. pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump
O.4. pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal
O.5. pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/applevel-consistency.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/applevel-consistency.html index 4c502b9..dc66d8f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/applevel-consistency.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/applevel-consistency.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -13.4. Data Consistency Checks at the Application Level

13.4. Data Consistency Checks at the Application Level

+13.4. Data Consistency Checks at the Application Level

13.4. Data Consistency Checks at the Application Level

It is very difficult to enforce business rules regarding data integrity using Read Committed transactions because the view of the data is shifting with each statement, and even a single statement may not @@ -111,4 +111,4 @@ UPDATE, DELETE, or MERGE), so it is possible to obtain locks explicitly before the snapshot is frozen. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-callbacks.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-callbacks.html index 7b64ad3..4b3517b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-callbacks.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-callbacks.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -51.2. Archive Module Callbacks

51.2. Archive Module Callbacks

+51.2. Archive Module Callbacks

51.2. Archive Module Callbacks

The archive callbacks define the actual archiving behavior of the module. The server will call them as required to process each individual WAL file.

51.2.1. Check Callback

@@ -47,4 +47,4 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path);

 typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void);
 

-

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-init.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-init.html index 1486928..9623dcc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-init.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-module-init.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -51.1. Initialization Functions

51.1. Initialization Functions

+51.1. Initialization Functions

51.1. Initialization Functions

An archive library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the archive_library's name as the library base name. The normal library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the @@ -21,4 +21,4 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the archive_file_cb callback is required. The others are optional. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-modules.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-modules.html index 2431fa9..6f72471 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-modules.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/archive-modules.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 51. Archive Modules

Chapter 51. Archive Modules

+Chapter 51. Archive Modules

Chapter 51. Archive Modules

PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous archiving (see Section 26.3). While archiving via a shell command (i.e., archive_command) is much @@ -21,4 +21,4 @@

The contrib/basic_archive module contains a working example, which demonstrates some useful techniques. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/arrays.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/arrays.html index 8795041..091b1f5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/arrays.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/arrays.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.15. Arrays

8.15. Arrays

+8.15. Arrays

8.15. Arrays

PostgreSQL allows columns of a table to be defined as variable-length multidimensional arrays. Arrays of any built-in or user-defined base type, enum type, composite type, range type, @@ -644,4 +644,4 @@ SELECT f1[1][-2][3] AS e1, f1[1][-1][5] AS e2 with than the array-literal syntax when writing array values in SQL commands. In ARRAY, individual element values are written the same way they would be written when not members of an array. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-bsd.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-bsd.html index f8247af..1f5c038 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-bsd.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-bsd.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.14. BSD Authentication

21.14. BSD Authentication

+21.14. BSD Authentication

21.14. BSD Authentication

This authentication method operates similarly to password except that it uses BSD Authentication to verify the password. BSD Authentication is used only @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ operating system user running the server) must first be added to the auth group. The auth group exists by default on OpenBSD systems. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-cert.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-cert.html index 95506b2..781da73 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-cert.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-cert.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.12. Certificate Authentication

21.12. Certificate Authentication

+21.12. Certificate Authentication

21.12. Certificate Authentication

This authentication method uses SSL client certificates to perform authentication. It is therefore only available for SSL connections; see Section 19.9.2 for SSL configuration instructions. @@ -22,4 +22,4 @@ cert authentication because cert authentication is effectively trust authentication with clientcert=verify-full. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-delay.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-delay.html index f4fa997..2d7addb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-delay.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-delay.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.3. auth_delay

F.3. auth_delay

+F.3. auth_delay

F.3. auth_delay

auth_delay causes the server to pause briefly before reporting authentication failure, to make brute-force attacks on database passwords more difficult. Note that it does nothing to prevent @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ shared_preload_libraries = 'auth_delay' auth_delay.milliseconds = '500'

F.3.2. Author

KaiGai Kohei -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ident.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ident.html index e2999e7..fcf6b20 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ident.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ident.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.8. Ident Authentication

21.8. Ident Authentication

+21.8. Ident Authentication

21.8. Ident Authentication

The ident authentication method works by obtaining the client's operating system user name from an ident server and using it as the allowed database user name (with an optional user name mapping). @@ -49,4 +49,4 @@ used when using the ident server with PostgreSQL, since PostgreSQL does not have any way to decrypt the returned string to determine the actual user name. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ldap.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ldap.html index 22b7a56..5f87020 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ldap.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-ldap.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.10. LDAP Authentication

21.10. LDAP Authentication

+21.10. LDAP Authentication

21.10. LDAP Authentication

This authentication method operates similarly to password except that it uses LDAP as the password verification method. LDAP is used only to validate @@ -187,4 +187,4 @@ host ... ldap ldapbasedn="dc=example,dc=net" Since LDAP often uses commas and spaces to separate the different parts of a DN, it is often necessary to use double-quoted parameter values when configuring LDAP options, as shown in the examples. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-methods.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-methods.html index 52df71b..0f6f712 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-methods.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-methods.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.3. Authentication Methods

21.3. Authentication Methods

+21.3. Authentication Methods

21.3. Authentication Methods

PostgreSQL provides various methods for authenticating users: @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@

The following sections describe each of these authentication methods in more detail. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pam.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pam.html index 6096e60..4e5c411 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pam.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pam.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.13. PAM Authentication

21.13. PAM Authentication

+21.13. PAM Authentication

21.13. PAM Authentication

This authentication method operates similarly to password except that it uses PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) as the authentication mechanism. The @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ will fail because the PostgreSQL server is started by a non-root user. However, this is not an issue when PAM is configured to use LDAP or other authentication methods. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-password.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-password.html index f30a8bd..afa7927 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-password.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-password.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.5. Password Authentication

21.5. Password Authentication

+21.5. Password Authentication

21.5. Password Authentication

There are several password-based authentication methods. These methods operate similarly but differ in how the users' passwords are stored on the server and how the password provided by a client is sent across the @@ -77,4 +77,4 @@ in postgresql.conf, make all users set new passwords, and change the authentication method specifications in pg_hba.conf to scram-sha-256. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-peer.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-peer.html index ddb598c..01c76d5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-peer.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-peer.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.9. Peer Authentication

21.9. Peer Authentication

+21.9. Peer Authentication

21.9. Peer Authentication

The peer authentication method works by obtaining the client's operating system user name from the kernel and using it as the allowed database user name (with optional user name mapping). This @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ most flavors of BSD including macOS, and Solaris. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pg-hba-conf.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pg-hba-conf.html index 4ac90fb..c1adeb4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pg-hba-conf.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-pg-hba-conf.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.1. The pg_hba.conf File

21.1. The pg_hba.conf File

+21.1. The pg_hba.conf File

21.1. The pg_hba.conf File

Client authentication is controlled by a configuration file, which traditionally is named pg_hba.conf and is stored in the database @@ -341,7 +341,7 @@ hostnogssenc database DN of a client certificate in this format, do

-openssl x509 -in myclient.crt -noout --subject -nameopt RFC2253 | sed "s/^subject=//"
+openssl x509 -in myclient.crt -noout -subject -nameopt RFC2253 | sed "s/^subject=//"
 

Care needs to be taken when using this option, especially when using regular expression matching against the DN. @@ -489,4 +489,4 @@ local all @admins,+support md5 # The database column can also use lists and file names: local db1,db2,@demodbs all md5 -


\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-radius.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-radius.html index e75890d..733297e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-radius.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-radius.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.11. RADIUS Authentication

21.11. RADIUS Authentication

+21.11. RADIUS Authentication

21.11. RADIUS Authentication

This authentication method operates similarly to password except that it uses RADIUS as the password verification method. RADIUS is used only to validate @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@

 host ... radius radiusservers="server1,server2" radiussecrets="""secret one"",""secret two"""
 

-

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-trust.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-trust.html index 3f911e2..c1a3abf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-trust.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-trust.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.4. Trust Authentication

21.4. Trust Authentication

+21.4. Trust Authentication

21.4. Trust Authentication

When trust authentication is specified, PostgreSQL assumes that anyone who can connect to the server is authorized to access the database with @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ to the server by the pg_hba.conf lines that specify trust. It is seldom reasonable to use trust for any TCP/IP connections other than those from localhost (127.0.0.1). -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-username-maps.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-username-maps.html index 9e9d9c8..d7c2575 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-username-maps.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auth-username-maps.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.2. User Name Maps

21.2. User Name Maps

+21.2. User Name Maps

21.2. User Name Maps

When using an external authentication system such as Ident or GSSAPI, the name of the operating system user that initiated the connection might not be the same as the database user (role) that is to be used. @@ -99,4 +99,4 @@ omicron ann ann omicron robert bob # bryanh can also connect as guest1 omicron bryanh guest1 -


\ No newline at end of file +
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/auto-explain.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/auto-explain.html index f94ea4b..8132672 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/auto-explain.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/auto-explain.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.4. auto_explain

F.4. auto_explain

+F.4. auto_explain

F.4. auto_explain

The auto_explain module provides a means for logging execution plans of slow statements automatically, without having to run EXPLAIN @@ -186,4 +186,4 @@ LOG: duration: 3.651 ms plan: Filter: indisunique

F.4.3. Author

Takahiro Itagaki -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-dump.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-dump.html index 4515c67..4bdd695 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-dump.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-dump.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -26.1. SQL Dump

26.1. SQL Dump

+26.1. SQL Dump

26.1. SQL Dump

The idea behind this dump method is to generate a file with SQL commands that, when fed back to the server, will recreate the database in the same state as it was at the time of the dump. @@ -244,4 +244,4 @@ pg_dump -j num -F d -f pg_restore -j to restore a dump in parallel. This will work for any archive of either the "custom" or the "directory" archive mode, whether or not it has been created with pg_dump -j. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-file.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-file.html index cdc50c2..6e460b1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-file.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-file.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -26.2. File System Level Backup

26.2. File System Level Backup

+26.2. File System Level Backup

26.2. File System Level Backup

An alternative backup strategy is to directly copy the files that PostgreSQL uses to store the data in the database; Section 19.2 explains where these files @@ -88,4 +88,4 @@ tar -cf backup.tar /usr/local/pgsql/data than an SQL dump. (pg_dump does not need to dump the contents of indexes for example, just the commands to recreate them.) However, taking a file system backup might be faster. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-files.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-files.html index b2f9d43..5ab0d3d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-files.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-files.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -76.2. Backup Manifest File Object

76.2. Backup Manifest File Object

+76.2. Backup Manifest File Object

76.2. Backup Manifest File Object

The object which describes a single file contains either a Path key or an Encoded-Path key. Normally, the Path key will be present. The @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@

Checksum

The checksum computed for this file, stored as a series of hexadecimal characters, two for each byte of the checksum. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-format.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-format.html index ea78388..7d5fd40 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-format.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-format.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 76. Backup Manifest Format

Chapter 76. Backup Manifest Format

+Chapter 76. Backup Manifest Format

Chapter 76. Backup Manifest Format

The backup manifest generated by pg_basebackup is primarily intended to permit the backup to be verified using pg_verifybackup. However, it is @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ supported server encoding. There is no similar exception for backup manifests.) The JSON document is always an object; the keys that are present in this object are described in the next section. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-toplevel.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-toplevel.html index 88642c8..71300d5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-toplevel.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-toplevel.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -76.1. Backup Manifest Top-level Object

76.1. Backup Manifest Top-level Object

+76.1. Backup Manifest Top-level Object

76.1. Backup Manifest Top-level Object

The backup manifest JSON document contains the following keys.

PostgreSQL-Backup-Manifest-Version

The associated value is always the integer 1. @@ -22,4 +22,4 @@ is significantly more expensive than a CRC32C checksum, the manifest should normally be small enough that the extra computation won't matter very much. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-wal-ranges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-wal-ranges.html index 29889a6..d5248b2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-wal-ranges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup-manifest-wal-ranges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -76.3. Backup Manifest WAL Range Object

76.3. Backup Manifest WAL Range Object

+76.3. Backup Manifest WAL Range Object

76.3. Backup Manifest WAL Range Object

The object which describes a WAL range always has three keys:

Timeline

The timeline for this range of WAL records, as an integer. @@ -19,4 +19,4 @@ upstream promotion, it is possible for multiple ranges to be present, each with a different timeline. There will never be multiple WAL ranges present for the same timeline. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup.html index 33cdfb5..8ee82fe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/backup.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/backup.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 26. Backup and Restore

Chapter 26. Backup and Restore

+Chapter 26. Backup and Restore

Chapter 26. Backup and Restore

As with everything that contains valuable data, PostgreSQL databases should be backed up regularly. While the procedure is essentially simple, it is important to have a clear understanding of @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@

  • SQL dump

  • File system level backup

  • Continuous archiving

Each has its own strengths and weaknesses; each is discussed in turn in the following sections. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/basebackup-to-shell.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/basebackup-to-shell.html index 764c210..19b4283 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/basebackup-to-shell.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/basebackup-to-shell.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.5. basebackup_to_shell

F.5. basebackup_to_shell

+F.5. basebackup_to_shell

F.5. basebackup_to_shell

basebackup_to_shell adds a custom basebackup target called shell. This makes it possible to run pg_basebackup --target=shell or, depending on how this @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ the shell backup target.

F.5.2. Author

Robert Haas -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/basic-archive.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/basic-archive.html index a8b4081..6baee14 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/basic-archive.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/basic-archive.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.6. basic_archive

F.6. basic_archive

+F.6. basic_archive

F.6. basic_archive

basic_archive is an example of an archive module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' doing so.

F.6.3. Author

Nathan Bossart -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bgworker.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bgworker.html index 52cd297..75af21c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bgworker.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bgworker.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 48. Background Worker Processes

Chapter 48. Background Worker Processes

+Chapter 48. Background Worker Processes

Chapter 48. Background Worker Processes

PostgreSQL can be extended to run user-supplied code in separate processes. Such processes are started, stopped and monitored by postgres, which permits them to have a lifetime closely linked to the server's status. @@ -228,4 +228,4 @@ typedef struct BackgroundWorker

The maximum number of registered background workers is limited by max_worker_processes. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/biblio.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/biblio.html index f3815db..ea909fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/biblio.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/biblio.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Bibliography

Bibliography

+Bibliography

Bibliography

Selected references and readings for SQL and PostgreSQL.

@@ -20,4 +20,4 @@ system”. M. Stonebraker, M. Hearst, and S. Potamianos. SIGMOD Record 18(3). Sept. 1989.

[ston89b] The case for partial indexes”. M. Stonebraker. SIGMOD Record 18(4). Dec. 1989. 4–11.

[ston90a] The implementation of POSTGRES”. M. Stonebraker, L. A. Rowe, and M. Hirohama. Transactions on Knowledge and Data Engineering 2(1). IEEE. March 1990.

[ston90b] On - Rules, Procedures, Caching and Views in Database Systems”. M. Stonebraker, A. Jhingran, J. Goh, and S. Potamianos. ACM-SIGMOD Conference on Management of Data, June 1990.

\ No newline at end of file + Rules, Procedures, Caching and Views in Database Systems”. M. Stonebraker, A. Jhingran, J. Goh, and S. Potamianos. ACM-SIGMOD Conference on Management of Data, June 1990.

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-commands.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-commands.html index 2809143..722bd78 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-commands.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-commands.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -74.4. BKI Commands

74.4. BKI Commands

+74.4. BKI Commands

74.4. BKI Commands

create tablename tableoid @@ -108,4 +108,4 @@ is postponed.

build indices

Fill in the indices that have previously been declared. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-example.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-example.html index df92e68..941ec24 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-example.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-example.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -74.6. BKI Example

74.6. BKI Example

+74.6. BKI Example

74.6. BKI Example

The following sequence of commands will create the table test_table with OID 420, having three columns oid, cola and colb @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ insert ( 421 1 'value 1' ) insert ( 422 2 _null_ ) close test_table

-

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-format.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-format.html index aaeddb7..8bf3865 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-format.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-format.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -74.3. BKI File Format

74.3. BKI File Format

+74.3. BKI File Format

74.3. BKI File Format

This section describes how the PostgreSQL backend interprets BKI files. This description will be easier to understand if the postgres.bki @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ single-quoted strings. Everything is case sensitive.

Lines starting with # are ignored. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-structure.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-structure.html index 2ad533d..841f335 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-structure.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki-structure.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -74.5. Structure of the Bootstrap BKI File

74.5. Structure of the Bootstrap BKI File

+74.5. Structure of the Bootstrap BKI File

74.5. Structure of the Bootstrap BKI File

The open command cannot be used until the tables it uses exist and have entries for the table that is to be opened. (These minimum tables are pg_class, @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@

There are doubtless other, undocumented ordering dependencies. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki.html index aa9c479..b0993ef 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bki.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bki.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 74. System Catalog Declarations and Initial Contents

Chapter 74. System Catalog Declarations and Initial Contents

+Chapter 74. System Catalog Declarations and Initial Contents

Chapter 74. System Catalog Declarations and Initial Contents

PostgreSQL uses many different system catalogs to keep track of the existence and properties of database objects, such as tables and functions. Physically there is no difference between a system @@ -53,4 +53,4 @@ and/or initial data files. The rest of this chapter gives some information about that, and for completeness describes the BKI file format. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bloom.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bloom.html index 6f2361d..71a879f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bloom.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bloom.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.7. bloom

F.7. bloom

+F.7. bloom

F.7. bloom

bloom provides an index access method based on Bloom filters.

@@ -187,4 +187,4 @@ DEFAULT FOR TYPE text USING bloom AS

Oleg Bartunov , Postgres Professional, Moscow, Russia -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bookindex.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bookindex.html index af8450b..35d7413 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bookindex.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bookindex.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Index

Index

Index

A

abbrev, Network Address Functions and Operators
ABORT, ABORT
abs, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ACL, Privileges
aclcontains, System Information Functions and Operators
acldefault, System Information Functions and Operators
aclexplode, System Information Functions and Operators
aclitem, Privileges
aclitemeq, System Information Functions and Operators
acos, Mathematical Functions and Operators
acosd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
acosh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
administration tools
externally maintained, Administration Tools
adminpack, adminpack
advisory lock, Advisory Locks
age, Date/Time Functions and Operators
aggregate function, Aggregate Functions, Aggregate Expressions, Aggregate Functions, User-Defined Aggregates
built-in, Aggregate Functions
invocation, Aggregate Expressions
moving aggregate, Moving-Aggregate Mode
ordered set, Ordered-Set Aggregates
partial aggregation, Partial Aggregation
polymorphic, Polymorphic and Variadic Aggregates
support functions for, Support Functions for Aggregates
user-defined, User-Defined Aggregates
variadic, Polymorphic and Variadic Aggregates
AIX, AIX
installation on, AIX
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
akeys, hstore Operators and Functions
alias, Table and Column Aliases, Column Labels
for table name in query, Joins Between Tables
in the FROM clause, Table and Column Aliases
in the select list, Column Labels
ALL, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP, DISTINCT, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
GROUP BY ALL, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
SELECT ALL, DISTINCT
allow_in_place_tablespaces configuration parameter, Developer Options
allow_system_table_mods configuration parameter, Developer Options
ALTER AGGREGATE, ALTER AGGREGATE
ALTER COLLATION, ALTER COLLATION
ALTER CONVERSION, ALTER CONVERSION
ALTER DATABASE, ALTER DATABASE
ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES, ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES
ALTER DOMAIN, ALTER DOMAIN
ALTER EVENT TRIGGER, ALTER EVENT TRIGGER
ALTER EXTENSION, ALTER EXTENSION
ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER, ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER
ALTER FOREIGN TABLE, ALTER FOREIGN TABLE
ALTER FUNCTION, ALTER FUNCTION
ALTER GROUP, ALTER GROUP
ALTER INDEX, ALTER INDEX
ALTER LANGUAGE, ALTER LANGUAGE
ALTER LARGE OBJECT, ALTER LARGE OBJECT
ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW, ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW
ALTER OPERATOR, ALTER OPERATOR
ALTER OPERATOR CLASS, ALTER OPERATOR CLASS
ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY, ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY
ALTER POLICY, ALTER POLICY
ALTER PROCEDURE, ALTER PROCEDURE
ALTER PUBLICATION, ALTER PUBLICATION
ALTER ROLE, Role Attributes, ALTER ROLE
ALTER ROUTINE, ALTER ROUTINE
ALTER RULE, ALTER RULE
ALTER SCHEMA, ALTER SCHEMA
ALTER SEQUENCE, ALTER SEQUENCE
ALTER SERVER, ALTER SERVER
ALTER STATISTICS, ALTER STATISTICS
ALTER SUBSCRIPTION, ALTER SUBSCRIPTION
ALTER SYSTEM, ALTER SYSTEM
ALTER TABLE, ALTER TABLE
ALTER TABLESPACE, ALTER TABLESPACE
ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION, ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION
ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY, ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY
ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER, ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER
ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE, ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE
ALTER TRIGGER, ALTER TRIGGER
ALTER TYPE, ALTER TYPE
ALTER USER, ALTER USER
ALTER USER MAPPING, ALTER USER MAPPING
ALTER VIEW, ALTER VIEW
amcheck, amcheck
ANALYZE, Updating Planner Statistics, ANALYZE
AND (operator), Logical Operators
anonymous code blocks, DO
any, Pseudo-Types
ANY, Aggregate Functions, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
anyarray, Pseudo-Types
anycompatible, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblearray, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblemultirange, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblenonarray, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblerange, Pseudo-Types
anyelement, Pseudo-Types
anyenum, Pseudo-Types
anymultirange, Pseudo-Types
anynonarray, Pseudo-Types
anyrange, Pseudo-Types
applicable role, applicable_roles
application_name configuration parameter, What to Log
arbitrary precision numbers, Arbitrary Precision Numbers
Archive Modules, Archive Modules
archive_cleanup_command configuration parameter, Archive Recovery
archive_command configuration parameter, Archiving
archive_library configuration parameter, Archiving
archive_mode configuration parameter, Archiving
archive_timeout configuration parameter, Archiving
area, Geometric Functions and Operators
armor, armor(), dearmor()
array, Arrays
accessing, Accessing Arrays
constant, Array Value Input
constructor, Array Constructors
declaration, Declaration of Array Types
I/O, Array Input and Output Syntax
modifying, Modifying Arrays
of user-defined type, User-Defined Types
searching, Searching in Arrays
ARRAY, Array Constructors, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
array_agg, Aggregate Functions, Functions
array_append, Array Functions and Operators
array_cat, Array Functions and Operators
array_dims, Array Functions and Operators
array_fill, Array Functions and Operators
array_length, Array Functions and Operators
array_lower, Array Functions and Operators
array_ndims, Array Functions and Operators
array_nulls configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
array_position, Array Functions and Operators
array_positions, Array Functions and Operators
array_prepend, Array Functions and Operators
array_remove, Array Functions and Operators
array_replace, Array Functions and Operators
array_to_json, Processing and Creating JSON Data
array_to_string, Array Functions and Operators
array_to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
array_upper, Array Functions and Operators
ascii, String Functions and Operators
asin, Mathematical Functions and Operators
asind, Mathematical Functions and Operators
asinh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ASSERT
in PL/pgSQL, Checking Assertions
assertions
in PL/pgSQL, Checking Assertions
asynchronous commit, Asynchronous Commit
AT TIME ZONE, AT TIME ZONE
atan, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atan2, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atan2d, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atand, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atanh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
authentication_timeout configuration parameter, Authentication
auth_delay, auth_delay
auth_delay.milliseconds configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto-increment (see serial)
autocommit
bulk-loading data, Disable Autocommit
psql, Variables
autosummarize storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
autovacuum
configuration parameters, Automatic Vacuuming
general information, The Autovacuum Daemon
autovacuum configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
autovacuum_analyze_scale_factor
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_analyze_threshold
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_enabled storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_freeze_max_age
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_freeze_min_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_freeze_table_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_max_workers configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
autovacuum_multixact_freeze_max_age
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_multixact_freeze_min_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_multixact_freeze_table_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_naptime configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
autovacuum_vacuum_cost_delay
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_cost_limit
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_insert_scale_factor
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_insert_threshold
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_scale_factor
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_threshold
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
auto_explain, auto_explain
auto_explain.log_analyze configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_buffers configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_format configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_level configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_min_duration configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_nested_statements configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_settings configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_timing configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_triggers configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_verbose configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_wal configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.sample_rate configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
avals, hstore Operators and Functions
average, Aggregate Functions
avg, Aggregate Functions

B

B-Tree (see index)
backend_flush_after configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
Background workers, Background Worker Processes
backslash escapes, String Constants with C-Style Escapes
backslash_quote configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
backtrace_functions configuration parameter, Developer Options
backup, Backup Control Functions, Backup and Restore
Backup Manifest, Backup Manifest Format
base type, The PostgreSQL Type System
base64 format, Binary String Functions and Operators
basebackup_to_shell, basebackup_to_shell
basebackup_to_shell.command configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
basebackup_to_shell.required_role configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
BASE_BACKUP, Streaming Replication Protocol
basic_archive, basic_archive
basic_archive.archive_directory configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
batch mode, Pipeline Mode
in libpq, Pipeline Mode
BEGIN, BEGIN
BETWEEN, Comparison Functions and Operators
BETWEEN SYMMETRIC, Comparison Functions and Operators
BGWORKER_BACKEND_​DATABASE_CONNECTION, Background Worker Processes
BGWORKER_SHMEM_ACCESS, Background Worker Processes
bgwriter_delay configuration parameter, Background Writer
bgwriter_flush_after configuration parameter, Background Writer
bgwriter_lru_maxpages configuration parameter, Background Writer
bgwriter_lru_multiplier configuration parameter, Background Writer
bigint, Numeric Constants, Integer Types
bigserial, Serial Types
binary data, Binary Data Types, Binary String Functions and Operators
functions, Binary String Functions and Operators
binary string
concatenation, Binary String Functions and Operators
converting to character string, Binary String Functions and Operators
length, Binary String Functions and Operators
bison, Requirements
bit string, Bit-String Constants, Bit String Types
constant, Bit-String Constants
data type, Bit String Types
length, Bit String Functions and Operators
bit strings, Bit String Functions and Operators
functions, Bit String Functions and Operators
bitmap scan, Combining Multiple Indexes, Planner Method Configuration
bit_and, Aggregate Functions
bit_count, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
bit_length, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
bit_or, Aggregate Functions
bit_xor, Aggregate Functions
BLOB (see large object)
block_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
bloom, bloom
bonjour configuration parameter, Connection Settings
bonjour_name configuration parameter, Connection Settings
Boolean, Boolean Type
data type, Boolean Type
operators (see operators, logical)
bool_and, Aggregate Functions
bool_or, Aggregate Functions
booting
starting the server during, Starting the Database Server
bound_box, Geometric Functions and Operators
box, Geometric Functions and Operators
box (data type), Boxes
BRIN (see index)
brin_desummarize_range, Index Maintenance Functions
brin_metapage_info, BRIN Functions
brin_page_items, BRIN Functions
brin_page_type, BRIN Functions
brin_revmap_data, BRIN Functions
brin_summarize_new_values, Index Maintenance Functions
brin_summarize_range, Index Maintenance Functions
broadcast, Network Address Functions and Operators
BSD Authentication, BSD Authentication
btree_gin, btree_gin
btree_gist, btree_gist
btrim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
bt_index_check, Functions
bt_index_parent_check, Functions
bt_metap, B-Tree Functions
bt_page_items, B-Tree Functions
bt_page_stats, B-Tree Functions
buffering storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
bytea, Binary Data Types
bytea_output configuration parameter, Statement Behavior

C

C, libpq — C Library, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
C++, Using C++ for Extensibility
CALL, CALL
canceling, Canceling Queries in Progress
SQL command, Canceling Queries in Progress
cardinality, Array Functions and Operators
CASCADE, Dependency Tracking
with DROP, Dependency Tracking
foreign key action, Foreign Keys
Cascading Replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
CASE, Conditional Expressions, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
case sensitivity
of SQL commands, Identifiers and Key Words
cast, CREATE CAST
I/O conversion, CREATE CAST
cbrt, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ceil, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ceiling, Mathematical Functions and Operators
center, Geometric Functions and Operators
Certificate, Certificate Authentication
chained transactions, Transaction Management, Parameters, Parameters
in PL/pgSQL, Transaction Management
char, Character Types
character, Character Types
character set, Locale and Formatting, Preset Options, Character Set Support
character string, String Constants, Character Types
concatenation, String Functions and Operators
constant, String Constants
converting to binary string, Binary String Functions and Operators
data types, Character Types
length, String Functions and Operators
prefix test, String Functions and Operators
character varying, Character Types
character_length, String Functions and Operators
char_length, String Functions and Operators
check constraint, Check Constraints
CHECK OPTION, CREATE VIEW
checkpoint, WAL Configuration
CHECKPOINT, CHECKPOINT
checkpoint_completion_target configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checkpoint_flush_after configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checkpoint_timeout configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checkpoint_warning configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checksums, Data Checksums
check_function_bodies configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
chr, String Functions and Operators
cid, Object Identifier Types
cidr, cidr
circle, Circles, Geometric Functions and Operators
citext, citext
client authentication, Client Authentication
timeout during, Authentication
client_connection_check_interval configuration parameter, Connection Settings
client_encoding configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
client_min_messages configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
clock_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
CLOSE, CLOSE
cluster
of databases (see database cluster)
CLUSTER, CLUSTER
clusterdb, clusterdb
clustering, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
cluster_name configuration parameter, Process Title
cmax, System Columns
cmin, System Columns
COALESCE, COALESCE
COLLATE, Collation Expressions
collation, Collation Support
in PL/pgSQL, Collation of PL/pgSQL Variables
in SQL functions, SQL Functions with Collations
COLLATION FOR, System Information Functions and Operators
color, Color Support
column, Concepts, Table Basics
adding, Adding a Column
removing, Removing a Column
renaming, Renaming a Column
system column, System Columns
column data type
changing, Changing a Column's Data Type
column reference, Column References
col_description, System Information Functions and Operators
comment, Comments
about database objects, System Information Functions and Operators
in SQL, Comments
COMMENT, COMMENT
COMMIT, COMMIT
COMMIT PREPARED, COMMIT PREPARED
commit_delay configuration parameter, Settings
commit_siblings configuration parameter, Settings
common table expression (see WITH)
comparison, Comparison Functions and Operators, Subquery Expressions
composite type, Row and Array Comparisons
operators, Comparison Functions and Operators
row constructor, Row and Array Comparisons
subquery result row, Subquery Expressions
compiling, Building libpq Programs
libpq applications, Building libpq Programs
composite type, Composite Types, The PostgreSQL Type System
comparison, Row and Array Comparisons
constant, Constructing Composite Values
constructor, Row Constructors
computed field, Using Composite Types in Queries
compute_query_id configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
concat, String Functions and Operators
concat_ws, String Functions and Operators
concurrency, Concurrency Control
conditional expression, Conditional Expressions
configuration
of recovery
general settings, Recovery
of a standby server, Archive Recovery
of the server, Server Configuration
of the server
functions, Configuration Settings Functions
configure, Installation Procedure
configure environment variables, configure Environment Variables
configure options, configure Options
config_file configuration parameter, File Locations
conjunction, Logical Operators
connectby, Functions Provided, connectby
connection service file, The Connection Service File
conninfo, Connection Strings
constant, Constants
constraint, Constraints
adding, Adding a Constraint
check, Check Constraints
exclusion, Exclusion Constraints
foreign key, Foreign Keys
name, Check Constraints
NOT NULL, Not-Null Constraints
primary key, Primary Keys
removing, Removing a Constraint
unique, Unique Constraints
constraint exclusion, Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion, Other Planner Options
constraint_exclusion configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
container type, The PostgreSQL Type System
CONTINUE
in PL/pgSQL, CONTINUE
continuous archiving, Backup and Restore
in standby, Continuous Archiving in Standby
control file, Extension Files
convert, Binary String Functions and Operators
convert_from, Binary String Functions and Operators
convert_to, Binary String Functions and Operators
COPY, Populating a Table With Rows, Functions Associated with the COPY Command, COPY
with libpq, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
corr, Aggregate Functions
correlation, Aggregate Functions
in the query planner, Extended Statistics
cos, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cosd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cosh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cot, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cotd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
count, Aggregate Functions
covariance
population, Aggregate Functions
sample, Aggregate Functions
covar_pop, Aggregate Functions
covar_samp, Aggregate Functions
covering index, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
cpu_index_tuple_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
cpu_operator_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
cpu_tuple_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
CREATE ACCESS METHOD, CREATE ACCESS METHOD
CREATE AGGREGATE, CREATE AGGREGATE
CREATE CAST, CREATE CAST
CREATE COLLATION, CREATE COLLATION
CREATE CONVERSION, CREATE CONVERSION
CREATE DATABASE, Creating a Database, CREATE DATABASE
CREATE DOMAIN, CREATE DOMAIN
CREATE EVENT TRIGGER, CREATE EVENT TRIGGER
CREATE EXTENSION, CREATE EXTENSION
CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER, CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER
CREATE FOREIGN TABLE, CREATE FOREIGN TABLE
CREATE FUNCTION, CREATE FUNCTION
CREATE GROUP, CREATE GROUP
CREATE INDEX, CREATE INDEX
CREATE LANGUAGE, CREATE LANGUAGE
CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW, CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW
CREATE OPERATOR, CREATE OPERATOR
CREATE OPERATOR CLASS, CREATE OPERATOR CLASS
CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY, CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY
CREATE POLICY, CREATE POLICY
CREATE PROCEDURE, CREATE PROCEDURE
CREATE PUBLICATION, CREATE PUBLICATION
CREATE ROLE, Database Roles, CREATE ROLE
CREATE RULE, CREATE RULE
CREATE SCHEMA, CREATE SCHEMA
CREATE SEQUENCE, CREATE SEQUENCE
CREATE SERVER, CREATE SERVER
CREATE STATISTICS, CREATE STATISTICS
CREATE SUBSCRIPTION, CREATE SUBSCRIPTION
CREATE TABLE, Creating a New Table, CREATE TABLE
CREATE TABLE AS, CREATE TABLE AS
CREATE TABLESPACE, Tablespaces, CREATE TABLESPACE
CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION, CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION
CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY, CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY
CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER, CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER
CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE, CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE
CREATE TRANSFORM, CREATE TRANSFORM
CREATE TRIGGER, CREATE TRIGGER
CREATE TYPE, CREATE TYPE
CREATE USER, CREATE USER
CREATE USER MAPPING, CREATE USER MAPPING
CREATE VIEW, CREATE VIEW
createdb, Creating a Database, Creating a Database, createdb
createuser, Database Roles, createuser
CREATE_REPLICATION_SLOT, Streaming Replication Protocol
cross compilation, Build Process Details
cross join, Joined Tables
crosstab, crosstab(text), crosstabN(text), crosstab(text, text)
crypt, crypt()
cstring, Pseudo-Types
CSV (Comma-Separated Values) format
in psql, Meta-Commands
ctid, System Columns
CTID, View Rules in Non-SELECT Statements
CUBE, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
cube (extension), cube
cume_dist, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
current_catalog, System Information Functions and Operators
current_database, System Information Functions and Operators
current_date, Date/Time Functions and Operators
current_logfiles
and the log_destination configuration parameter, Where to Log
and the pg_current_logfile function, System Information Functions and Operators
current_query, System Information Functions and Operators
current_role, System Information Functions and Operators
current_schema, System Information Functions and Operators
current_schemas, System Information Functions and Operators
current_setting, Configuration Settings Functions
current_time, Date/Time Functions and Operators
current_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
current_user, System Information Functions and Operators
currval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
cursor, Cursors, CLOSE, DECLARE, EXPLAIN, FETCH, MOVE
CLOSE, CLOSE
DECLARE, DECLARE
FETCH, FETCH
in PL/pgSQL, Cursors
MOVE, MOVE
showing the query plan, EXPLAIN
cursor_tuple_fraction configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
custom scan provider, Writing a Custom Scan Provider
handler for, Writing a Custom Scan Provider
Cygwin, Cygwin
installation on, Cygwin

D

data area (see database cluster)
data partitioning, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
data type, Data Types, Numeric Types, Enumerated Types, Domain Types, Type Conversion, The PostgreSQL Type System, The PostgreSQL Type System, The PostgreSQL Type System, Polymorphic Types, Base Types in C-Language Functions, User-Defined Types
base, The PostgreSQL Type System
category, Overview
composite, The PostgreSQL Type System
constant, Constants of Other Types
container, The PostgreSQL Type System
conversion, Type Conversion
domain, Domain Types
enumerated (enum), Enumerated Types
internal organization, Base Types in C-Language Functions
numeric, Numeric Types
polymorphic, Polymorphic Types
type cast, Type Casts
user-defined, User-Defined Types
database, Creating a Database, Managing Databases
creating, Creating a Database
privilege to create, Role Attributes
database activity, Monitoring Database Activity
monitoring, Monitoring Database Activity
database cluster, Concepts, Creating a Database Cluster
data_checksums configuration parameter, Preset Options
data_directory configuration parameter, File Locations
data_directory_mode configuration parameter, Preset Options
data_sync_retry configuration parameter, Error Handling
date, Date/Time Types, Dates
constants, Special Values
current, Current Date/Time
output format, Date/Time Output
(see also formatting)
DateStyle configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
date_bin, date_bin
date_part, Date/Time Functions and Operators, EXTRACT, date_part
date_trunc, Date/Time Functions and Operators, date_trunc
dblink, dblink, dblink
dblink_build_sql_delete, dblink_build_sql_delete
dblink_build_sql_insert, dblink_build_sql_insert
dblink_build_sql_update, dblink_build_sql_update
dblink_cancel_query, dblink_cancel_query
dblink_close, dblink_close
dblink_connect, dblink_connect
dblink_connect_u, dblink_connect_u
dblink_disconnect, dblink_disconnect
dblink_error_message, dblink_error_message
dblink_exec, dblink_exec
dblink_fetch, dblink_fetch
dblink_get_connections, dblink_get_connections
dblink_get_notify, dblink_get_notify
dblink_get_pkey, dblink_get_pkey
dblink_get_result, dblink_get_result
dblink_is_busy, dblink_is_busy
dblink_open, dblink_open
dblink_send_query, dblink_send_query
db_user_namespace configuration parameter, Authentication
deadlock, Deadlocks
timeout during, Lock Management
deadlock_timeout configuration parameter, Lock Management
DEALLOCATE, DEALLOCATE
dearmor, armor(), dearmor()
debug_assertions configuration parameter, Preset Options
debug_deadlocks configuration parameter, Developer Options
debug_discard_caches configuration parameter, Developer Options
debug_pretty_print configuration parameter, What to Log
debug_print_parse configuration parameter, What to Log
debug_print_plan configuration parameter, What to Log
debug_print_rewritten configuration parameter, What to Log
decimal (see numeric)
DECLARE, DECLARE
decode, Binary String Functions and Operators
decode_bytea
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
decrypt, Raw Encryption Functions
decrypt_iv, Raw Encryption Functions
deduplicate_items storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
default value, Default Values
changing, Changing a Column's Default Value
default-roles, Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles
default_statistics_target configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
default_tablespace configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_table_access_method configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_text_search_config configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
default_toast_compression configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_transaction_deferrable configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_transaction_isolation configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_transaction_read_only configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
deferrable transaction, Statement Behavior
setting, SET TRANSACTION
setting default, Statement Behavior
defined, hstore Operators and Functions
degrees, Mathematical Functions and Operators
delay, Delaying Execution
DELETE, Deletions, Deleting Data, Returning Data from Modified Rows, DELETE
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
delete, hstore Operators and Functions
deleting, Deleting Data
dense_rank, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
diagonal, Geometric Functions and Operators
diameter, Geometric Functions and Operators
dict_int, dict_int
dict_xsyn, dict_xsyn
difference, Soundex
digest, digest()
dirty read, Transaction Isolation
DISCARD, DISCARD
disjunction, Logical Operators
disk drive, WAL Internals
disk space, Recovering Disk Space
disk usage, Determining Disk Usage
DISTINCT, Querying a Table, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP, DISTINCT
GROUP BY DISTINCT, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
SELECT DISTINCT, DISTINCT
div, Mathematical Functions and Operators
dmetaphone, Double Metaphone
dmetaphone_alt, Double Metaphone
DO, DO
document, What Is a Document?
text search, What Is a Document?
dollar quoting, Dollar-Quoted String Constants
domain, Domain Types
double precision, Floating-Point Types
DROP ACCESS METHOD, DROP ACCESS METHOD
DROP AGGREGATE, DROP AGGREGATE
DROP CAST, DROP CAST
DROP COLLATION, DROP COLLATION
DROP CONVERSION, DROP CONVERSION
DROP DATABASE, Destroying a Database, DROP DATABASE
DROP DOMAIN, DROP DOMAIN
DROP EVENT TRIGGER, DROP EVENT TRIGGER
DROP EXTENSION, DROP EXTENSION
DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER, DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER
DROP FOREIGN TABLE, DROP FOREIGN TABLE
DROP FUNCTION, DROP FUNCTION
DROP GROUP, DROP GROUP
DROP INDEX, DROP INDEX
DROP LANGUAGE, DROP LANGUAGE
DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW, DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW
DROP OPERATOR, DROP OPERATOR
DROP OPERATOR CLASS, DROP OPERATOR CLASS
DROP OPERATOR FAMILY, DROP OPERATOR FAMILY
DROP OWNED, DROP OWNED
DROP POLICY, DROP POLICY
DROP PROCEDURE, DROP PROCEDURE
DROP PUBLICATION, DROP PUBLICATION
DROP ROLE, Database Roles, DROP ROLE
DROP ROUTINE, DROP ROUTINE
DROP RULE, DROP RULE
DROP SCHEMA, DROP SCHEMA
DROP SEQUENCE, DROP SEQUENCE
DROP SERVER, DROP SERVER
DROP STATISTICS, DROP STATISTICS
DROP SUBSCRIPTION, DROP SUBSCRIPTION
DROP TABLE, Creating a New Table, DROP TABLE
DROP TABLESPACE, DROP TABLESPACE
DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION, DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION
DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY, DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY
DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER, DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER
DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE, DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE
DROP TRANSFORM, DROP TRANSFORM
DROP TRIGGER, DROP TRIGGER
DROP TYPE, DROP TYPE
DROP USER, DROP USER
DROP USER MAPPING, DROP USER MAPPING
DROP VIEW, DROP VIEW
dropdb, Destroying a Database, dropdb
dropuser, Database Roles, dropuser
DROP_REPLICATION_SLOT, Streaming Replication Protocol
DTD, Creating XML Values
DTrace, Developer Options, Dynamic Tracing
duplicate, Querying a Table
duplicates, DISTINCT
dynamic loading, Other Defaults, Dynamic Loading
dynamic_library_path, Dynamic Loading
dynamic_library_path configuration parameter, Other Defaults
dynamic_shared_memory_type configuration parameter, Memory

E

each, hstore Operators and Functions
earth, Cube-Based Earth Distances
earthdistance, earthdistance
earth_box, Cube-Based Earth Distances
earth_distance, Cube-Based Earth Distances
ECPG, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
ecpg, ecpg
effective_cache_size configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
effective_io_concurrency configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
elog, Reporting Errors Within the Server
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
in PL/Python, Utility Functions
in PL/Tcl, Database Access from PL/Tcl
embedded SQL, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
in C, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
enabled role, enabled_roles
enable_async_append configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_bitmapscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_gathermerge configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_hashagg configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_hashjoin configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_incremental_sort configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_indexonlyscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_indexscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_material configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_memoize configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_mergejoin configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_nestloop configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_parallel_append configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_parallel_hash configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_partitionwise_aggregate configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_partitionwise_join configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_partition_pruning configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_seqscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_sort configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_tidscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
encode, Binary String Functions and Operators
encode_array_constructor
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encode_array_literal
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encode_bytea
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encode_typed_literal
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encrypt, Raw Encryption Functions
encryption, Encryption Options, pgcrypto
for specific columns, pgcrypto
encrypt_iv, Raw Encryption Functions
END, END
enumerated types, Enumerated Types
enum_first, Enum Support Functions
enum_last, Enum Support Functions
enum_range, Enum Support Functions
environment variable, Environment Variables
ephemeral named relation
registering with SPI, SPI_register_relation, SPI_register_trigger_data
unregistering from SPI, SPI_unregister_relation
ereport, Reporting Errors Within the Server
error codes, PostgreSQL Error Codes
libpq, Main Functions
list of, PostgreSQL Error Codes
error message, Connection Status Functions
escape format, Binary String Functions and Operators
escape string syntax, String Constants with C-Style Escapes
escape_string_warning configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
escaping strings, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
in libpq, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
event log, Registering Event Log on Windows
event log, Registering Event Log on Windows
event trigger, Event Triggers, Writing Event Trigger Functions in C
in C, Writing Event Trigger Functions in C
in PL/Tcl, Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
event_source configuration parameter, Where to Log
event_trigger, Pseudo-Types
every, Aggregate Functions
EXCEPT, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
exceptions
in PL/pgSQL, Trapping Errors
in PL/Tcl, Error Handling in PL/Tcl
exclusion constraint, Exclusion Constraints
EXECUTE, EXECUTE
exist, hstore Operators and Functions
EXISTS, Subquery Expressions
EXIT
in PL/pgSQL, EXIT
exit_on_error configuration parameter, Error Handling
exp, Mathematical Functions and Operators
EXPLAIN, Using EXPLAIN, EXPLAIN
expression, Value Expressions
order of evaluation, Expression Evaluation Rules
syntax, Value Expressions
extending SQL, Extending SQL
extension, Packaging Related Objects into an Extension
externally maintained, Extensions
external_pid_file configuration parameter, File Locations
extract, Date/Time Functions and Operators, EXTRACT, date_part
extra_float_digits configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting

F

factorial, Mathematical Functions and Operators
failover, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
false, Boolean Type
family, Network Address Functions and Operators
fast path, The Fast-Path Interface
fastupdate storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
fdw_handler, Pseudo-Types
FETCH, FETCH
field
computed, Using Composite Types in Queries
field selection, Field Selection
file system mount points, Use of Secondary File Systems
file_fdw, file_fdw
fillfactor storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters, Storage Parameters
FILTER, Aggregate Expressions
first_value, Window Functions
flex, Requirements
float4 (see real)
float8 (see double precision)
floating point, Floating-Point Types
floating-point
display, Locale and Formatting
floor, Mathematical Functions and Operators
force_parallel_mode configuration parameter, Developer Options
foreign data, Foreign Data
foreign data wrapper, Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper
handler for, Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper
foreign key, Foreign Keys, Foreign Keys
self-referential, Foreign Keys
foreign table, Foreign Data
format, String Functions and Operators, format
use in PL/pgSQL, Executing Dynamic Commands
formatting, Data Type Formatting Functions
format_type, System Information Functions and Operators
Free Space Map, Free Space Map
FreeBSD
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
from_collapse_limit configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
FSM (see Free Space Map)
fsm_page_contents, General Functions
fsync configuration parameter, Settings
full text search, Text Search Types, Text Search Types, Full Text Search
data types, Text Search Types
functions and operators, Text Search Types
full_page_writes configuration parameter, Settings
function, Table Functions, Functions and Operators, Statistics Information Functions, Functions, Polymorphic Types, User-Defined Functions, Query Language (SQL) Functions, Internal Functions, C-Language Functions
default values for arguments, SQL Functions with Default Values for Arguments
in the FROM clause, Table Functions
internal, Internal Functions
invocation, Function Calls
mixed notation, Using Mixed Notation
named argument, Arguments for SQL Functions
named notation, Using Named Notation
output parameter, SQL Functions with Output Parameters
polymorphic, Polymorphic Types
positional notation, Using Positional Notation
RETURNS TABLE, SQL Functions Returning TABLE
statistics, Statistics Information Functions
type resolution in an invocation, Functions
user-defined, User-Defined Functions, Query Language (SQL) Functions, C-Language Functions
in C, C-Language Functions
in SQL, Query Language (SQL) Functions
variadic, SQL Functions with Variable Numbers of Arguments
with SETOF, SQL Functions Returning Sets
functional dependency, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
fuzzystrmatch, fuzzystrmatch

G

gcd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
gc_to_sec, Cube-Based Earth Distances
generated column, Generated Columns, Parameters, Parameters
in - triggers, Overview of Trigger Behavior
generate_series, Set Returning Functions
generate_subscripts, Set Returning Functions
genetic query optimization, Genetic Query Optimizer
gen_random_bytes, Random-Data Functions
gen_random_uuid, UUID Functions, Random-Data Functions
gen_salt, gen_salt()
GEQO (see genetic query optimization)
geqo configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_effort configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_generations configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_pool_size configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_seed configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_selection_bias configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_threshold configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
get_bit, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
get_byte, Binary String Functions and Operators
get_current_ts_config, Text Search Functions and Operators
get_raw_page, General Functions
GIN (see index)
gin_clean_pending_list, Index Maintenance Functions
gin_fuzzy_search_limit configuration parameter, Other Defaults
gin_leafpage_items, GIN Functions
gin_metapage_info, GIN Functions
gin_page_opaque_info, GIN Functions
gin_pending_list_limit
configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
GiST (see index)
gist_page_items, GiST Functions
gist_page_items_bytea, GiST Functions
gist_page_opaque_info, GiST Functions
global data, Global Data in PL/Tcl
in PL/Python, Sharing Data
in PL/Tcl, Global Data in PL/Tcl
GRANT, Privileges, GRANT
GREATEST, GREATEST and LEAST, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
Gregorian calendar, History of Units
GROUP BY, Aggregate Functions, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
grouping, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
GROUPING, Aggregate Functions
GROUPING SETS, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
gssapi, Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption
GSSAPI, GSSAPI Authentication
with - libpq, Parameter Key Words
GUID, UUID Type

H

hash (see index)
hash_bitmap_info, Hash Functions
hash_mem_multiplier configuration parameter, Memory
hash_metapage_info, Hash Functions
hash_page_items, Hash Functions
hash_page_stats, Hash Functions
hash_page_type, Hash Functions
has_any_column_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_column_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_database_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_foreign_data_wrapper_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_function_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_language_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_parameter_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_schema_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_sequence_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_server_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_tablespace_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_table_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_type_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
HAVING, Aggregate Functions, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
hba_file configuration parameter, File Locations
heap_page_items, Heap Functions
heap_page_item_attrs, Heap Functions
heap_tuple_infomask_flags, Heap Functions
height, Geometric Functions and Operators
hex format, Binary String Functions and Operators
hierarchical database, Concepts
high availability, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
history, A Brief History of PostgreSQL
of PostgreSQL, A Brief History of PostgreSQL
hmac, hmac()
host, Network Address Functions and Operators
host - name, Parameter Key Words
hostmask, Network Address Functions and Operators
hot standby, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
hot_standby configuration parameter, Standby Servers
hot_standby_feedback configuration parameter, Standby Servers
HP-UX
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
hstore, hstore, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_array, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_json, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_jsonb, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_jsonb_loose, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_json_loose, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_matrix, hstore Operators and Functions
huge_pages configuration parameter, Memory
huge_page_size configuration parameter, Memory
hypothetical-set aggregate
built-in, Aggregate Functions

I

icount, intarray Functions and Operators
ICU, PostgreSQL Features, Locale Providers, Managing Collations, Parameters, Parameters
ident, Ident Authentication
identifier, Identifiers and Key Words
length, Identifiers and Key Words
syntax of, Identifiers and Key Words
IDENTIFY_SYSTEM, Streaming Replication Protocol
ident_file configuration parameter, File Locations
idle_in_transaction_session_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
idle_session_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
idx, intarray Functions and Operators
IFNULL, COALESCE
ignore_checksum_failure configuration parameter, Developer Options
ignore_invalid_pages configuration parameter, Developer Options
ignore_system_indexes configuration parameter, Developer Options
IMMUTABLE, Function Volatility Categories
IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA, IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA
IN, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
INCLUDE
in index definitions, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
include
in configuration file, Managing Configuration File Contents
include_dir
in configuration file, Managing Configuration File Contents
include_if_exists
in configuration file, Managing Configuration File Contents
index, Indexes, Multicolumn Indexes, Indexes and ORDER BY, Combining Multiple Indexes, Unique Indexes, Indexes on Expressions, Partial Indexes, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes, Examining Index Usage, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, Locking and Indexes, Interfacing Extensions to Indexes, Building Indexes Concurrently, Rebuilding Indexes Concurrently, Operators and Functions
and ORDER BY, Indexes and ORDER BY
B-Tree, B-Tree, B-Tree Indexes
BRIN, BRIN, BRIN Indexes
building concurrently, Building Indexes Concurrently
combining multiple indexes, Combining Multiple Indexes
covering, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
examining usage, Examining Index Usage
on expressions, Indexes on Expressions
for user-defined data type, Interfacing Extensions to Indexes
GIN, GIN, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, GIN Indexes
text search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
GiST, GiST, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, GiST Indexes
text search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
hash, Hash
Hash, Hash Indexes
index-only scans, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
locks, Locking and Indexes
multicolumn, Multicolumn Indexes
partial, Partial Indexes
rebuilding concurrently, Rebuilding Indexes Concurrently
SP-GiST, SP-GiST, SP-GiST Indexes
unique, Unique Indexes
Index Access Method, Index Access Method Interface Definition
index scan, Planner Method Configuration
index-only scan, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
indexam
Index Access Method, Index Access Method Interface Definition
index_am_handler, Pseudo-Types
inet (data type), inet
inet_client_addr, System Information Functions and Operators
inet_client_port, System Information Functions and Operators
inet_merge, Network Address Functions and Operators
inet_same_family, Network Address Functions and Operators
inet_server_addr, System Information Functions and Operators
inet_server_port, System Information Functions and Operators
infinity
floating point, Floating-Point Types
numeric (data type), Arbitrary Precision Numbers
information schema, The Information Schema
inheritance, Inheritance, Inheritance
initcap, String Functions and Operators
initdb, Creating a Database Cluster, initdb
Initialization Fork, The Initialization Fork
input function, User-Defined Types
INSERT, Populating a Table With Rows, Inserting Data, Returning Data from Modified Rows, INSERT
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
inserting, Inserting Data
installation, Installation from Source Code
binaries, Installation from Binaries
on Windows, Installation from Source Code on Windows
instr function, Appendix
int2 (see smallint)
int4 (see integer)
int8 (see bigint)
intagg, intagg
intarray, intarray
integer, Numeric Constants, Integer Types
integer_datetimes configuration parameter, Preset Options
interfaces
externally maintained, Client Interfaces
internal, Pseudo-Types
INTERSECT, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
interval, Date/Time Types, Interval Input
output format, Interval Output
(see also formatting)
IntervalStyle configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
intset, intarray Functions and Operators
int_array_aggregate, Functions
int_array_enum, Functions
inverse distribution, Aggregate Functions
in_hot_standby configuration parameter, Preset Options
in_range support functions, B-Tree Support Functions
IS DISTINCT FROM, Comparison Functions and Operators, Row and Array Comparisons
IS DOCUMENT, IS DOCUMENT
IS FALSE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT DISTINCT FROM, Comparison Functions and Operators, Row and Array Comparisons
IS NOT DOCUMENT, IS NOT DOCUMENT
IS NOT FALSE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT NULL, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT TRUE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT UNKNOWN, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NULL, Comparison Functions and Operators, Platform and Client Compatibility
IS TRUE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS UNKNOWN, Comparison Functions and Operators
isclosed, Geometric Functions and Operators
isempty, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
isfinite, Date/Time Functions and Operators
isn, isn
ISNULL, Comparison Functions and Operators
isn_weak, Functions and Operators
isopen, Geometric Functions and Operators
is_array_ref
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
is_valid, Functions and Operators

J

JIT, Just-in-Time Compilation (JIT)
jit configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
jit_above_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
jit_debugging_support configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_dump_bitcode configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_expressions configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_inline_above_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
jit_optimize_above_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
jit_profiling_support configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_provider configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
jit_tuple_deforming configuration parameter, Developer Options
join, Joins Between Tables, Joined Tables, Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses
controlling the order, Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses
cross, Joined Tables
left, Joined Tables
natural, Joined Tables
outer, Joins Between Tables, Joined Tables
right, Joined Tables
self, Joins Between Tables
join_collapse_limit configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
JSON, JSON Types, JSON Functions and Operators
functions and operators, JSON Functions and Operators
JSONB, JSON Types
jsonb
containment, jsonb Containment and Existence
existence, jsonb Containment and Existence
indexes on, jsonb Indexing
jsonb_agg, Aggregate Functions
jsonb_array_elements, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_array_elements_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_array_length, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_build_array, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_build_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_each, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_each_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_extract_path, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_extract_path_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_insert, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_object_agg, Aggregate Functions
jsonb_object_keys, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_exists, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_exists_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_match, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_match_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_array, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_array_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_first, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_first_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_populate_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_populate_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_pretty, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_set, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_set_lax, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_strip_nulls, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_to_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_to_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
jsonb_typeof, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonpath, jsonpath Type
json_agg, Aggregate Functions
json_array_elements, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_array_elements_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_array_length, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_build_array, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_build_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_each, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_each_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_extract_path, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_extract_path_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_object_agg, Aggregate Functions
json_object_keys, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_populate_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_populate_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_strip_nulls, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_to_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_to_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
json_typeof, Processing and Creating JSON Data
Julian date, Julian Dates
Just-In-Time compilation (see JIT)
justify_days, Date/Time Functions and Operators
justify_hours, Date/Time Functions and Operators
justify_interval, Date/Time Functions and Operators

K

key word, Identifiers and Key Words, SQL Key Words
list of, SQL Key Words
syntax of, Identifiers and Key Words
krb_caseins_users configuration parameter, Authentication
krb_server_keyfile configuration parameter, Authentication

L

label (see alias)
lag, Window Functions
language_handler, Pseudo-Types
large object, Large Objects
lastval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
last_value, Window Functions
LATERAL, LATERAL Subqueries
in the FROM clause, LATERAL Subqueries
latitude, Cube-Based Earth Distances
lca, Operators and Functions
lcm, Mathematical Functions and Operators
lc_collate configuration parameter, Preset Options
lc_ctype configuration parameter, Preset Options
lc_messages configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
lc_monetary configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
lc_numeric configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
lc_time configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
LDAP, PostgreSQL Features, LDAP Authentication
LDAP connection parameter lookup, LDAP Lookup of Connection Parameters
ldconfig, Shared Libraries
lead, Window Functions
LEAST, GREATEST and LEAST, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
left, String Functions and Operators
left join, Joined Tables
length, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators, Geometric Functions and Operators, Text Search Functions and Operators
of a binary string (see binary strings, length)
of a character string (see character string, length)
length(tsvector), Manipulating Documents
levenshtein, Levenshtein
levenshtein_less_equal, Levenshtein
lex, Requirements
libedit, Requirements
in psql, Command-Line Editing
libperl, Requirements
libpq, libpq — C Library, Pipeline Mode, Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
pipeline mode, Pipeline Mode
single-row mode, Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
libpq-fe.h, libpq — C Library, Connection Status Functions
libpq-int.h, Connection Status Functions
libpython, Requirements
library initialization function, Dynamic Loading
LIKE, LIKE
and locales, Behavior
LIKE_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery, SQL/JSON Regular Expressions
in SQL/JSON, SQL/JSON Regular Expressions
LIMIT, LIMIT and OFFSET
line, Lines, Geometric Functions and Operators
line segment, Line Segments
linear regression, Aggregate Functions
Linux
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
LISTEN, LISTEN
listen_addresses configuration parameter, Connection Settings
llvm-config, PostgreSQL Features
ll_to_earth, Cube-Based Earth Distances
ln, Mathematical Functions and Operators
lo, lo
LOAD, LOAD
load balancing, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
locale, Creating a Database Cluster, Locale Support
localtime, Date/Time Functions and Operators
localtimestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
local_preload_libraries configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
lock, Explicit Locking, Advisory Locks, Viewing Locks
advisory, Advisory Locks
monitoring, Viewing Locks
LOCK, Table-Level Locks, LOCK
lock_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
log, Mathematical Functions and Operators
log shipping, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
log10, Mathematical Functions and Operators
Logging
current_logfiles file and the pg_current_logfile - function, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_logfile function, System Information Functions and Operators
logging_collector configuration parameter, Where to Log
Logical Decoding, Logical Decoding, Logical Decoding
logical_decoding_work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
login privilege, Role Attributes
log_autovacuum_min_duration
configuration parameter, What to Log
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
log_btree_build_stats configuration parameter, Developer Options
log_checkpoints configuration parameter, What to Log
log_connections configuration parameter, What to Log
log_destination configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_directory configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_disconnections configuration parameter, What to Log
log_duration configuration parameter, What to Log
log_error_verbosity configuration parameter, What to Log
log_executor_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_filename configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_file_mode configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_hostname configuration parameter, What to Log
log_line_prefix configuration parameter, What to Log
log_lock_waits configuration parameter, What to Log
log_min_duration_sample configuration parameter, When to Log
log_min_duration_statement configuration parameter, When to Log
log_min_error_statement configuration parameter, When to Log
log_min_messages configuration parameter, When to Log
log_parameter_max_length configuration parameter, What to Log
log_parameter_max_length_on_error configuration parameter, What to Log
log_parser_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_planner_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_recovery_conflict_waits configuration parameter, What to Log
log_replication_commands configuration parameter, What to Log
log_rotation_age configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_rotation_size configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_startup_progress_interval configuration parameter, When to Log
log_statement configuration parameter, What to Log
log_statement_sample_rate configuration parameter, When to Log
log_statement_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_temp_files configuration parameter, What to Log
log_timezone configuration parameter, What to Log
log_transaction_sample_rate configuration parameter, When to Log
log_truncate_on_rotation configuration parameter, Where to Log
longitude, Cube-Based Earth Distances
looks_like_number
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
loop, Simple Loops
in PL/pgSQL, Simple Loops
lower, String Functions and Operators, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
and locales, Behavior
lower_inc, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
lower_inf, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
lo_close, Closing a Large Object Descriptor
lo_compat_privileges configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
lo_creat, Creating a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_create, Creating a Large Object
lo_export, Exporting a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_from_bytea, Server-Side Functions
lo_get, Server-Side Functions
lo_import, Importing a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_import_with_oid, Importing a Large Object
lo_lseek, Seeking in a Large Object
lo_lseek64, Seeking in a Large Object
lo_open, Opening an Existing Large Object
lo_put, Server-Side Functions
lo_read, Reading Data from a Large Object
lo_tell, Obtaining the Seek Position of a Large Object
lo_tell64, Obtaining the Seek Position of a Large Object
lo_truncate, Truncating a Large Object
lo_truncate64, Truncating a Large Object
lo_unlink, Removing a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_write, Writing Data to a Large Object
lpad, String Functions and Operators
lseg, Line Segments, Geometric Functions and Operators
LSN, WAL Internals
ltree, ltree
ltree2text, Operators and Functions
ltrim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators

M

MAC address (see macaddr)
MAC address (EUI-64 format) (see macaddr)
macaddr (data type), macaddr
macaddr8 (data type), macaddr8
macaddr8_set7bit, Network Address Functions and Operators
macOS, macOS
installation on, macOS
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
magic block, Dynamic Loading
maintenance, Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
maintenance_io_concurrency configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
maintenance_work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
make, Requirements
makeaclitem, System Information Functions and Operators
make_date, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_interval, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_time, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_timestamptz, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_valid, Functions and Operators
MANPATH, Environment Variables
masklen, Network Address Functions and Operators
materialized view, Materialized Views
implementation through rules, Materialized Views
materialized views, pg_matviews
max, Aggregate Functions
max_connections configuration parameter, Connection Settings
max_files_per_process configuration parameter, Kernel Resource Usage
max_function_args configuration parameter, Preset Options
max_identifier_length configuration parameter, Preset Options
max_index_keys configuration parameter, Preset Options
max_locks_per_transaction configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_logical_replication_workers configuration parameter, Subscribers
max_parallel_maintenance_workers configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
max_parallel_workers configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
max_parallel_workers_per_gather configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
max_pred_locks_per_page configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_pred_locks_per_relation configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_pred_locks_per_transaction configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_prepared_transactions configuration parameter, Memory
max_replication_slots configuration parameter, Sending Servers
max_slot_wal_keep_size configuration parameter, Sending Servers
max_stack_depth configuration parameter, Memory
max_standby_archive_delay configuration parameter, Standby Servers
max_standby_streaming_delay configuration parameter, Standby Servers
max_sync_workers_per_subscription configuration parameter, Subscribers
max_wal_senders configuration parameter, Sending Servers
max_wal_size configuration parameter, Checkpoints
max_worker_processes configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
md5, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
MD5, Password Authentication
median, Aggregate Expressions
(see also percentile)
memory context
in SPI, Memory Management
memory overcommit, Linux Memory Overcommit
MERGE, MERGE
metaphone, Metaphone
min, Aggregate Functions
MinGW, MinGW/Native Windows
installation on, MinGW/Native Windows
min_dynamic_shared_memory configuration parameter, Memory
min_parallel_index_scan_size configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
min_parallel_table_scan_size configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
min_scale, Mathematical Functions and Operators
min_wal_size configuration parameter, Checkpoints
mod, Mathematical Functions and Operators
mode
statistical, Aggregate Functions
monitoring, Monitoring Database Activity
database activity, Monitoring Database Activity
MOVE, MOVE
moving-aggregate mode, Moving-Aggregate Mode
multirange (function), Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
multirange type, Range Types
Multiversion Concurrency Control, Introduction
MultiXactId, Multixacts and Wraparound
MVCC, Introduction

N

name, Identifiers and Key Words
qualified, Creating a Schema
syntax of, Identifiers and Key Words
unqualified, The Schema Search Path
NaN (see not a number)
natural join, Joined Tables
negation, Logical Operators
NetBSD
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
netmask, Network Address Functions and Operators
network, Network Address Types, Network Address Functions and Operators
data types, Network Address Types
nextval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
NFS, NFS
nlevel, Operators and Functions
non-durable, Non-Durable Settings
nonblocking connection, Database Connection Control Functions, Asynchronous Command Processing
nonrepeatable read, Transaction Isolation
normalize, String Functions and Operators
normalized, String Functions and Operators
normal_rand, normal_rand
NOT (operator), Logical Operators
not a number
floating point, Floating-Point Types
numeric (data type), Arbitrary Precision Numbers
NOT IN, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
not-null constraint, Not-Null Constraints
notation, Calling Functions
functions, Calling Functions
notice processing, Notice Processing
in libpq, Notice Processing
notice processor, Notice Processing
notice receiver, Notice Processing
NOTIFY, Asynchronous Notification, NOTIFY
in libpq, Asynchronous Notification
NOTNULL, Comparison Functions and Operators
now, Date/Time Functions and Operators
npoints, Geometric Functions and Operators
nth_value, Window Functions
ntile, Window Functions
null value
with check constraints, Check Constraints
comparing, Comparison Functions and Operators
default value, Default Values
in DISTINCT, DISTINCT
in libpq, Retrieving Query Result Information
in PL/Perl, PL/Perl Functions and Arguments
in PL/Python, Null, None
with unique constraints, Unique Constraints
NULLIF, NULLIF
number
constant, Numeric Constants
numeric, Numeric Constants
numeric (data type), Arbitrary Precision Numbers
numnode, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Queries
num_nonnulls, Comparison Functions and Operators
num_nulls, Comparison Functions and Operators
NVL, COALESCE

O

object identifier, Object Identifier Types
data type, Object Identifier Types
object-oriented database, Concepts
obj_description, System Information Functions and Operators
OCCURRENCES_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
octet_length, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
OFFSET, LIMIT and OFFSET
oid, Object Identifier Types
OID
in libpq, Retrieving Other Result Information
oid2name, oid2name
old_snapshot, old_snapshot
old_snapshot_threshold configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
ON CONFLICT, INSERT
ONLY, The FROM Clause
OOM, Linux Memory Overcommit
OpenBSD
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
OpenSSL, PostgreSQL Features
(see also SSL)
operator, Operators, Operator Precedence, Functions and Operators, Logical Operators, Operators, User-Defined Operators
invocation, Operator Invocations
logical, Logical Operators
precedence, Operator Precedence
syntax, Operators
type resolution in an invocation, Operators
user-defined, User-Defined Operators
operator class, Operator Classes and Operator Families, Index Methods and Operator Classes
operator family, Operator Classes and Operator Families, Operator Classes and Operator Families
optimization information, Function Optimization Information, Operator Optimization Information
for functions, Function Optimization Information
for operators, Operator Optimization Information
OR (operator), Logical Operators
Oracle, Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
porting from PL/SQL to PL/pgSQL, Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
ORDER BY, Querying a Table, Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)
and locales, Behavior
ordered-set aggregate, Aggregate Expressions
built-in, Aggregate Functions
ordering operator, System Dependencies on Operator Classes
ordinality, Set Returning Functions
outer join, Joined Tables
output function, User-Defined Types
OVER clause, Window Function Calls
overcommit, Linux Memory Overcommit
OVERLAPS, Date/Time Functions and Operators
overlay, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
overloading, Function Overloading
functions, Function Overloading
operators, User-Defined Operators
owner, Privileges

P

pageinspect, pageinspect
pages_per_range storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
page_checksum, General Functions
page_header, General Functions
palloc, Writing Code
PAM, PostgreSQL Features, PAM Authentication
parallel query, Parallel Query
parallel_leader_participation configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
parallel_setup_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
parallel_tuple_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
parallel_workers storage parameter, Storage Parameters
parameter
syntax, Positional Parameters
parenthesis, Value Expressions
parse_ident, String Functions and Operators
partition pruning, Partition Pruning
partitioned table, Table Partitioning
partitioning, Table Partitioning
password, Role Attributes
authentication, Password Authentication
of the superuser, Creating a Database Cluster
password file, The Password File
passwordcheck, passwordcheck
password_encryption configuration parameter, Authentication
path, Geometric Functions and Operators
for schemas, Statement Behavior
PATH, Environment Variables
path (data type), Paths
pattern matching, Pattern Matching
patterns
in psql and pg_dump, Patterns
pclose, Geometric Functions and Operators
peer, Peer Authentication
percentile
continuous, Aggregate Functions
discrete, Aggregate Functions
percent_rank, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
performance, Performance Tips
perl, Requirements
Perl, PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
permission (see privilege)
pfree, Writing Code
PGAPPNAME, Environment Variables
pgbench, pgbench
PGcancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PGCHANNELBINDING, Environment Variables
PGCLIENTENCODING, Environment Variables
PGconn, Database Connection Control Functions
PGCONNECT_TIMEOUT, Environment Variables
pgcrypto, pgcrypto
PGDATA, Creating a Database Cluster
PGDATABASE, Environment Variables
PGDATESTYLE, Environment Variables
PGEventProc, Event Callback Procedure
PGGEQO, Environment Variables
PGGSSENCMODE, Environment Variables
PGGSSLIB, Environment Variables
PGHOST, Environment Variables
PGHOSTADDR, Environment Variables
PGKRBSRVNAME, Environment Variables
PGLOCALEDIR, Environment Variables
PGOPTIONS, Environment Variables
PGPASSFILE, Environment Variables
PGPASSWORD, Environment Variables
PGPORT, Environment Variables
pgp_armor_headers, pgp_armor_headers
pgp_key_id, pgp_key_id()
pgp_pub_decrypt, pgp_pub_decrypt()
pgp_pub_decrypt_bytea, pgp_pub_decrypt()
pgp_pub_encrypt, pgp_pub_encrypt()
pgp_pub_encrypt_bytea, pgp_pub_encrypt()
pgp_sym_decrypt, pgp_sym_decrypt()
pgp_sym_decrypt_bytea, pgp_sym_decrypt()
pgp_sym_encrypt, pgp_sym_encrypt()
pgp_sym_encrypt_bytea, pgp_sym_encrypt()
PGREQUIREPEER, Environment Variables
PGREQUIRESSL, Environment Variables
PGresult, Main Functions
pgrowlocks, pgrowlocks, Overview
PGSERVICE, Environment Variables
PGSERVICEFILE, Environment Variables
PGSSLCERT, Environment Variables
PGSSLCOMPRESSION, Environment Variables
PGSSLCRL, Environment Variables
PGSSLCRLDIR, Environment Variables
PGSSLKEY, Environment Variables
PGSSLMAXPROTOCOLVERSION, Environment Variables
PGSSLMINPROTOCOLVERSION, Environment Variables
PGSSLMODE, Environment Variables
PGSSLROOTCERT, Environment Variables
PGSSLSNI, Environment Variables
pgstatginindex, Functions
pgstathashindex, Functions
pgstatindex, Functions
pgstattuple, pgstattuple, Functions
pgstattuple_approx, Functions
PGSYSCONFDIR, Environment Variables
PGTARGETSESSIONATTRS, Environment Variables
PGTZ, Environment Variables
PGUSER, Environment Variables
pgxs, Extension Building Infrastructure
pg_advisory_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_unlock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_unlock_all, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_unlock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_xact_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_xact_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_aggregate, pg_aggregate
pg_am, pg_am
pg_amcheck, pg_amcheck
pg_amop, pg_amop
pg_amproc, pg_amproc
pg_archivecleanup, pg_archivecleanup
pg_attrdef, pg_attrdef
pg_attribute, pg_attribute
pg_authid, pg_authid
pg_auth_members, pg_auth_members
pg_available_extensions, pg_available_extensions
pg_available_extension_versions, pg_available_extension_versions
pg_backend_memory_contexts, pg_backend_memory_contexts
pg_backend_pid, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_backup_start, Backup Control Functions
pg_backup_stop, Backup Control Functions
pg_basebackup, pg_basebackup
pg_blocking_pids, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_buffercache, pg_buffercache
pg_buffercache_pages, pg_buffercache
pg_cancel_backend, Server Signaling Functions
pg_cast, pg_cast
pg_char_to_encoding, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_checksums, pg_checksums
pg_class, pg_class
pg_client_encoding, String Functions and Operators
pg_collation, pg_collation
pg_collation_actual_version, Database Object Management Functions
pg_collation_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
PG_COLOR, When Color is Used
PG_COLORS, Configuring the Colors
pg_column_compression, Database Object Management Functions
pg_column_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_config, pg_config, pg_config
with - ecpg, Processing Embedded SQL Programs
with libpq, Building libpq Programs
with user-defined C functions, Writing Code
pg_conf_load_time, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_constraint, pg_constraint
pg_controldata, pg_controldata
pg_control_checkpoint, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_control_init, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_control_recovery, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_control_system, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_conversion, pg_conversion
pg_conversion_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_copy_logical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_copy_physical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_create_logical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_create_physical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_create_restore_point, Backup Control Functions
pg_ctl, Creating a Database Cluster, Starting the Database Server, pg_ctl
pg_current_logfile, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_wal_flush_lsn, Backup Control Functions
pg_current_wal_insert_lsn, Backup Control Functions
pg_current_wal_lsn, Backup Control Functions
pg_current_xact_id, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_xact_id_if_assigned, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_cursors, pg_cursors
pg_database, Template Databases, pg_database
pg_database_collation_actual_version, Database Object Management Functions
pg_database_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_db_role_setting, pg_db_role_setting
pg_ddl_command, Pseudo-Types
pg_default_acl, pg_default_acl
pg_depend, pg_depend
pg_describe_object, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_description, pg_description
pg_drop_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_dump, pg_dump
pg_dumpall, pg_dumpall
use during upgrade, Upgrading Data via pg_dumpall
pg_encoding_to_char, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_enum, pg_enum
pg_event_trigger, pg_event_trigger
pg_event_trigger_ddl_commands, Capturing Changes at Command End
pg_event_trigger_dropped_objects, Processing Objects Dropped by a DDL Command
pg_event_trigger_table_rewrite_oid, Handling a Table Rewrite Event
pg_event_trigger_table_rewrite_reason, Handling a Table Rewrite Event
pg_export_snapshot, Snapshot Synchronization Functions
pg_extension, pg_extension
pg_extension_config_dump, Extension Configuration Tables
pg_filenode_relation, Database Object Management Functions
pg_file_rename, adminpack
pg_file_settings, pg_file_settings
pg_file_sync, adminpack
pg_file_unlink, adminpack
pg_file_write, adminpack
pg_foreign_data_wrapper, pg_foreign_data_wrapper
pg_foreign_server, pg_foreign_server
pg_foreign_table, pg_foreign_table
pg_freespace, Functions
pg_freespacemap, pg_freespacemap
pg_function_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_catalog_foreign_keys, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_constraintdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_expr, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_functiondef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_function_arguments, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_function_identity_arguments, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_function_result, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_indexdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_keywords, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_object_address, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_ruledef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_serial_sequence, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_statisticsobjdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_triggerdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_userbyid, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_viewdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_wal_replay_pause_state, Recovery Control Functions
pg_get_wal_resource_managers, Recovery Control Functions
pg_group, pg_group
pg_has_role, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_hba.conf, The pg_hba.conf File
pg_hba_file_rules, pg_hba_file_rules
pg_ident.conf, User Name Maps
pg_identify_object, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_identify_object_as_address, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ident_file_mappings, pg_ident_file_mappings
pg_import_system_collations, Database Object Management Functions
pg_index, pg_index
pg_indexam_has_property, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_indexes, pg_indexes
pg_indexes_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_index_column_has_property, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_index_has_property, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_inherits, pg_inherits
pg_init_privs, pg_init_privs
pg_isready, pg_isready
pg_is_in_recovery, Recovery Control Functions
pg_is_other_temp_schema, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_is_wal_replay_paused, Recovery Control Functions
pg_jit_available, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_language, pg_language
pg_largeobject, pg_largeobject
pg_largeobject_metadata, pg_largeobject_metadata
pg_last_committed_xact, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_last_wal_receive_lsn, Recovery Control Functions
pg_last_wal_replay_lsn, Recovery Control Functions
pg_last_xact_replay_timestamp, Recovery Control Functions
pg_listening_channels, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_locks, pg_locks
pg_logdir_ls, adminpack
pg_logical_emit_message, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_get_binary_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_get_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_peek_binary_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_peek_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_log_backend_memory_contexts, Server Signaling Functions
pg_lsn, pg_lsn Type
pg_ls_archive_statusdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_dir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_logdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_logicalmapdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_logicalsnapdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_replslotdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_tmpdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_waldir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_matviews, pg_matviews
pg_mcv_list_items, Inspecting MCV Lists
pg_my_temp_schema, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_namespace, pg_namespace
pg_notification_queue_usage, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_notify, pg_notify
pg_opclass, pg_opclass
pg_opclass_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_operator, pg_operator
pg_operator_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_opfamily, pg_opfamily
pg_opfamily_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_options_to_table, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_parameter_acl, pg_parameter_acl
pg_partitioned_table, pg_partitioned_table
pg_partition_ancestors, Database Object Management Functions
pg_partition_root, Database Object Management Functions
pg_partition_tree, Database Object Management Functions
pg_policies, pg_policies
pg_policy, pg_policy
pg_postmaster_start_time, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_prepared_statements, pg_prepared_statements
pg_prepared_xacts, pg_prepared_xacts
pg_prewarm, pg_prewarm
pg_prewarm.autoprewarm configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_prewarm.autoprewarm_interval configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_proc, pg_proc
pg_promote, Recovery Control Functions
pg_publication, pg_publication
pg_publication_namespace, pg_publication_namespace
pg_publication_rel, pg_publication_rel
pg_publication_tables, pg_publication_tables
pg_range, pg_range
pg_read_binary_file, Generic File Access Functions
pg_read_file, Generic File Access Functions
pg_receivewal, pg_receivewal
pg_receivexlog, pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal (see pg_receivewal)
pg_recvlogical, pg_recvlogical
pg_relation_filenode, Database Object Management Functions
pg_relation_filepath, Database Object Management Functions
pg_relation_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_reload_conf, Server Signaling Functions
pg_relpages, Functions
pg_replication_origin, pg_replication_origin
pg_replication_origin_advance, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_create, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_drop, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_oid, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_progress, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_is_setup, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_progress, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_reset, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_setup, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_status, pg_replication_origin_status
pg_replication_origin_xact_reset, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_xact_setup, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_slots, pg_replication_slots
pg_replication_slot_advance, Replication Management Functions
pg_resetwal, pg_resetwal
pg_resetxlog, pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal (see pg_resetwal)
pg_restore, pg_restore
pg_rewind, pg_rewind
pg_rewrite, pg_rewrite
pg_roles, pg_roles
pg_rotate_logfile, Server Signaling Functions
pg_rules, pg_rules
pg_safe_snapshot_blocking_pids, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_seclabel, pg_seclabel
pg_seclabels, pg_seclabels
pg_sequence, pg_sequence
pg_sequences, pg_sequences
pg_service.conf, The Connection Service File
pg_settings, pg_settings
pg_settings_get_flags, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_shadow, pg_shadow
pg_shdepend, pg_shdepend
pg_shdescription, pg_shdescription
pg_shmem_allocations, pg_shmem_allocations
pg_shseclabel, pg_shseclabel
pg_size_bytes, Database Object Management Functions
pg_size_pretty, Database Object Management Functions
pg_sleep, Delaying Execution
pg_sleep_for, Delaying Execution
pg_sleep_until, Delaying Execution
pg_snapshot_xip, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_snapshot_xmax, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_snapshot_xmin, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_statio_all_indexes, Viewing Statistics, pg_statio_all_indexes
pg_statio_all_sequences, Viewing Statistics, pg_statio_all_sequences
pg_statio_all_tables, Viewing Statistics, pg_statio_all_tables
pg_statio_sys_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_sys_sequences, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_sys_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_user_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_user_sequences, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_user_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_statistic, Single-Column Statistics, pg_statistic
pg_statistics_obj_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_statistic_ext, Extended Statistics, pg_statistic_ext
pg_statistic_ext_data, Extended Statistics, pg_statistic_ext
pg_stats, Single-Column Statistics, pg_stats
pg_stats_ext, pg_stats_ext
pg_stats_ext_exprs, pg_stats_ext_exprs
pg_stat_activity, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_activity
pg_stat_all_indexes, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_all_indexes
pg_stat_all_tables, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_all_tables
pg_stat_archiver, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_archiver
pg_stat_bgwriter, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_bgwriter
pg_stat_clear_snapshot, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_database, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_database
pg_stat_database_conflicts, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_database_conflicts
pg_stat_file, Generic File Access Functions
pg_stat_get_activity, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_activity, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_activity_start, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_client_addr, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_client_port, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_dbid, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_idset, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_pid, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_start, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_userid, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_wait_event, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_wait_event_type, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_xact_start, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_snapshot_timestamp, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_xact_blocks_fetched, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_xact_blocks_hit, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_gssapi, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_gssapi
pg_stat_progress_analyze, Viewing Statistics, ANALYZE Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_basebackup, Viewing Statistics, Base Backup Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_cluster, Viewing Statistics, CLUSTER Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_copy, Viewing Statistics, COPY Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_create_index, Viewing Statistics, CREATE INDEX Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_vacuum, Viewing Statistics, VACUUM Progress Reporting
pg_stat_recovery_prefetch, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_recovery_prefetch
pg_stat_replication, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_replication
pg_stat_replication_slots, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_replication_slots
pg_stat_reset, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_replication_slot, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_shared, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_single_function_counters, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_single_table_counters, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_slru, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_subscription_stats, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_slru, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_slru
pg_stat_ssl, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_ssl
pg_stat_statements, pg_stat_statements
function, Functions
pg_stat_statements.max configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.save configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.track configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.track_planning configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.track_utility configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements_info, The pg_stat_statements_info View
pg_stat_statements_reset, Functions
pg_stat_subscription, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_subscription
pg_stat_subscription_stats, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_subscription_stats
pg_stat_sys_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_sys_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_user_functions, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_user_functions
pg_stat_user_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_user_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_wal, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_wal
pg_stat_wal_receiver, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_wal_receiver
pg_stat_xact_all_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_xact_sys_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_xact_user_functions, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_xact_user_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_subscription, pg_subscription
pg_subscription_rel, pg_subscription_rel
pg_surgery, pg_surgery
pg_switch_wal, Backup Control Functions
pg_tables, pg_tables
pg_tablespace, pg_tablespace
pg_tablespace_databases, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_tablespace_location, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_tablespace_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_table_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_table_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_temp, Statement Behavior
securing functions, Writing SECURITY DEFINER Functions Safely
pg_terminate_backend, Server Signaling Functions
pg_test_fsync, pg_test_fsync
pg_test_timing, pg_test_timing
pg_timezone_abbrevs, pg_timezone_abbrevs
pg_timezone_names, pg_timezone_names
pg_total_relation_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_transform, pg_transform
pg_trgm, pg_trgm
pg_trgm.similarity_threshold configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
pg_trgm.strict_word_similarity_threshold configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
pg_trgm.word_similarity_threshold configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
pg_trigger, pg_trigger
pg_trigger_depth, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_try_advisory_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_try_advisory_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_try_advisory_xact_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_try_advisory_xact_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_ts_config, pg_ts_config
pg_ts_config_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ts_config_map, pg_ts_config_map
pg_ts_dict, pg_ts_dict
pg_ts_dict_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ts_parser, pg_ts_parser
pg_ts_parser_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ts_template, pg_ts_template
pg_ts_template_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_type, pg_type
pg_typeof, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_type_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_upgrade, pg_upgrade
pg_user, pg_user
pg_user_mapping, pg_user_mapping
pg_user_mappings, pg_user_mappings
pg_verifybackup, pg_verifybackup
pg_views, pg_views
pg_visibility, pg_visibility
pg_visible_in_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_waldump, pg_waldump
pg_walfile_name, Backup Control Functions
pg_walfile_name_offset, Backup Control Functions
pg_walinspect, pg_walinspect
pg_wal_lsn_diff, Backup Control Functions
pg_wal_replay_pause, Recovery Control Functions
pg_wal_replay_resume, Recovery Control Functions
pg_xact_commit_timestamp, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_xact_commit_timestamp_origin, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_xact_status, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_xlogdump, pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump (see pg_waldump)
phantom read, Transaction Isolation
phraseto_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Queries
pi, Mathematical Functions and Operators
PIC, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
PID
determining PID of server process
in libpq, Connection Status Functions
pipelining, Pipeline Mode, Pipelining
in libpq, Pipeline Mode
protocol specification, Pipelining
PITR, Backup and Restore
PITR standby, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
pkg-config, PostgreSQL Features
with + Z

A

abbrev, Network Address Functions and Operators
ABORT, ABORT
abs, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ACL, Privileges
aclcontains, System Information Functions and Operators
acldefault, System Information Functions and Operators
aclexplode, System Information Functions and Operators
aclitem, Privileges
aclitemeq, System Information Functions and Operators
acos, Mathematical Functions and Operators
acosd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
acosh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
administration tools
externally maintained, Administration Tools
adminpack, adminpack
advisory lock, Advisory Locks
age, Date/Time Functions and Operators
aggregate function, Aggregate Functions, Aggregate Expressions, Aggregate Functions, User-Defined Aggregates
built-in, Aggregate Functions
invocation, Aggregate Expressions
moving aggregate, Moving-Aggregate Mode
ordered set, Ordered-Set Aggregates
partial aggregation, Partial Aggregation
polymorphic, Polymorphic and Variadic Aggregates
support functions for, Support Functions for Aggregates
user-defined, User-Defined Aggregates
variadic, Polymorphic and Variadic Aggregates
AIX, AIX
installation on, AIX
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
akeys, hstore Operators and Functions
alias, Table and Column Aliases, Column Labels
for table name in query, Joins Between Tables
in the FROM clause, Table and Column Aliases
in the select list, Column Labels
ALL, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP, DISTINCT, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
GROUP BY ALL, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
SELECT ALL, DISTINCT
allow_in_place_tablespaces configuration parameter, Developer Options
allow_system_table_mods configuration parameter, Developer Options
ALTER AGGREGATE, ALTER AGGREGATE
ALTER COLLATION, ALTER COLLATION
ALTER CONVERSION, ALTER CONVERSION
ALTER DATABASE, ALTER DATABASE
ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES, ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES
ALTER DOMAIN, ALTER DOMAIN
ALTER EVENT TRIGGER, ALTER EVENT TRIGGER
ALTER EXTENSION, ALTER EXTENSION
ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER, ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER
ALTER FOREIGN TABLE, ALTER FOREIGN TABLE
ALTER FUNCTION, ALTER FUNCTION
ALTER GROUP, ALTER GROUP
ALTER INDEX, ALTER INDEX
ALTER LANGUAGE, ALTER LANGUAGE
ALTER LARGE OBJECT, ALTER LARGE OBJECT
ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW, ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW
ALTER OPERATOR, ALTER OPERATOR
ALTER OPERATOR CLASS, ALTER OPERATOR CLASS
ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY, ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY
ALTER POLICY, ALTER POLICY
ALTER PROCEDURE, ALTER PROCEDURE
ALTER PUBLICATION, ALTER PUBLICATION
ALTER ROLE, Role Attributes, ALTER ROLE
ALTER ROUTINE, ALTER ROUTINE
ALTER RULE, ALTER RULE
ALTER SCHEMA, ALTER SCHEMA
ALTER SEQUENCE, ALTER SEQUENCE
ALTER SERVER, ALTER SERVER
ALTER STATISTICS, ALTER STATISTICS
ALTER SUBSCRIPTION, ALTER SUBSCRIPTION
ALTER SYSTEM, ALTER SYSTEM
ALTER TABLE, ALTER TABLE
ALTER TABLESPACE, ALTER TABLESPACE
ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION, ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION
ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY, ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY
ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER, ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER
ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE, ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE
ALTER TRIGGER, ALTER TRIGGER
ALTER TYPE, ALTER TYPE
ALTER USER, ALTER USER
ALTER USER MAPPING, ALTER USER MAPPING
ALTER VIEW, ALTER VIEW
amcheck, amcheck
ANALYZE, Updating Planner Statistics, ANALYZE
AND (operator), Logical Operators
anonymous code blocks, DO
any, Pseudo-Types
ANY, Aggregate Functions, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
anyarray, Pseudo-Types
anycompatible, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblearray, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblemultirange, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblenonarray, Pseudo-Types
anycompatiblerange, Pseudo-Types
anyelement, Pseudo-Types
anyenum, Pseudo-Types
anymultirange, Pseudo-Types
anynonarray, Pseudo-Types
anyrange, Pseudo-Types
applicable role, applicable_roles
application_name configuration parameter, What to Log
arbitrary precision numbers, Arbitrary Precision Numbers
Archive Modules, Archive Modules
archive_cleanup_command configuration parameter, Archive Recovery
archive_command configuration parameter, Archiving
archive_library configuration parameter, Archiving
archive_mode configuration parameter, Archiving
archive_timeout configuration parameter, Archiving
area, Geometric Functions and Operators
armor, armor(), dearmor()
array, Arrays
accessing, Accessing Arrays
constant, Array Value Input
constructor, Array Constructors
declaration, Declaration of Array Types
I/O, Array Input and Output Syntax
modifying, Modifying Arrays
of user-defined type, User-Defined Types
searching, Searching in Arrays
ARRAY, Array Constructors, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
array_agg, Aggregate Functions, Functions
array_append, Array Functions and Operators
array_cat, Array Functions and Operators
array_dims, Array Functions and Operators
array_fill, Array Functions and Operators
array_length, Array Functions and Operators
array_lower, Array Functions and Operators
array_ndims, Array Functions and Operators
array_nulls configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
array_position, Array Functions and Operators
array_positions, Array Functions and Operators
array_prepend, Array Functions and Operators
array_remove, Array Functions and Operators
array_replace, Array Functions and Operators
array_to_json, Processing and Creating JSON Data
array_to_string, Array Functions and Operators
array_to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
array_upper, Array Functions and Operators
ascii, String Functions and Operators
asin, Mathematical Functions and Operators
asind, Mathematical Functions and Operators
asinh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ASSERT
in PL/pgSQL, Checking Assertions
assertions
in PL/pgSQL, Checking Assertions
asynchronous commit, Asynchronous Commit
AT TIME ZONE, AT TIME ZONE
atan, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atan2, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atan2d, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atand, Mathematical Functions and Operators
atanh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
authentication_timeout configuration parameter, Authentication
auth_delay, auth_delay
auth_delay.milliseconds configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto-increment (see serial)
autocommit
bulk-loading data, Disable Autocommit
psql, Variables
autosummarize storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
autovacuum
configuration parameters, Automatic Vacuuming
general information, The Autovacuum Daemon
autovacuum configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
autovacuum_analyze_scale_factor
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_analyze_threshold
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_enabled storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_freeze_max_age
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_freeze_min_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_freeze_table_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_max_workers configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
autovacuum_multixact_freeze_max_age
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_multixact_freeze_min_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_multixact_freeze_table_age storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_naptime configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
autovacuum_vacuum_cost_delay
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_cost_limit
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_insert_scale_factor
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_insert_threshold
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_scale_factor
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_vacuum_threshold
configuration parameter, Automatic Vacuuming
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
autovacuum_work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
auto_explain, auto_explain
auto_explain.log_analyze configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_buffers configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_format configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_level configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_min_duration configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_nested_statements configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_settings configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_timing configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_triggers configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_verbose configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.log_wal configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
auto_explain.sample_rate configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
avals, hstore Operators and Functions
average, Aggregate Functions
avg, Aggregate Functions

B

B-Tree (see index)
backend_flush_after configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
Background workers, Background Worker Processes
backslash escapes, String Constants with C-Style Escapes
backslash_quote configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
backtrace_functions configuration parameter, Developer Options
backup, Backup Control Functions, Backup and Restore
Backup Manifest, Backup Manifest Format
base type, The PostgreSQL Type System
base64 format, Binary String Functions and Operators
basebackup_to_shell, basebackup_to_shell
basebackup_to_shell.command configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
basebackup_to_shell.required_role configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
BASE_BACKUP, Streaming Replication Protocol
basic_archive, basic_archive
basic_archive.archive_directory configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
batch mode, Pipeline Mode
in libpq, Pipeline Mode
BEGIN, BEGIN
BETWEEN, Comparison Functions and Operators
BETWEEN SYMMETRIC, Comparison Functions and Operators
BGWORKER_BACKEND_​DATABASE_CONNECTION, Background Worker Processes
BGWORKER_SHMEM_ACCESS, Background Worker Processes
bgwriter_delay configuration parameter, Background Writer
bgwriter_flush_after configuration parameter, Background Writer
bgwriter_lru_maxpages configuration parameter, Background Writer
bgwriter_lru_multiplier configuration parameter, Background Writer
bigint, Numeric Constants, Integer Types
bigserial, Serial Types
binary data, Binary Data Types, Binary String Functions and Operators
functions, Binary String Functions and Operators
binary string
concatenation, Binary String Functions and Operators
converting to character string, Binary String Functions and Operators
length, Binary String Functions and Operators
bison, Requirements
bit string, Bit-String Constants, Bit String Types
constant, Bit-String Constants
data type, Bit String Types
length, Bit String Functions and Operators
bit strings, Bit String Functions and Operators
functions, Bit String Functions and Operators
bitmap scan, Combining Multiple Indexes, Planner Method Configuration
bit_and, Aggregate Functions
bit_count, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
bit_length, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
bit_or, Aggregate Functions
bit_xor, Aggregate Functions
BLOB (see large object)
block_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
bloom, bloom
bonjour configuration parameter, Connection Settings
bonjour_name configuration parameter, Connection Settings
Boolean, Boolean Type
data type, Boolean Type
operators (see operators, logical)
bool_and, Aggregate Functions
bool_or, Aggregate Functions
booting
starting the server during, Starting the Database Server
bound_box, Geometric Functions and Operators
box, Geometric Functions and Operators
box (data type), Boxes
BRIN (see index)
brin_desummarize_range, Index Maintenance Functions
brin_metapage_info, BRIN Functions
brin_page_items, BRIN Functions
brin_page_type, BRIN Functions
brin_revmap_data, BRIN Functions
brin_summarize_new_values, Index Maintenance Functions
brin_summarize_range, Index Maintenance Functions
broadcast, Network Address Functions and Operators
BSD Authentication, BSD Authentication
btree_gin, btree_gin
btree_gist, btree_gist
btrim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
bt_index_check, Functions
bt_index_parent_check, Functions
bt_metap, B-Tree Functions
bt_page_items, B-Tree Functions
bt_page_stats, B-Tree Functions
buffering storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
bytea, Binary Data Types
bytea_output configuration parameter, Statement Behavior

C

C, libpq — C Library, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
C++, Using C++ for Extensibility
CALL, CALL
canceling, Canceling Queries in Progress
SQL command, Canceling Queries in Progress
cardinality, Array Functions and Operators
CASCADE, Dependency Tracking
with DROP, Dependency Tracking
foreign key action, Foreign Keys
Cascading Replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
CASE, Conditional Expressions, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
case sensitivity
of SQL commands, Identifiers and Key Words
cast, CREATE CAST
I/O conversion, CREATE CAST
cbrt, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ceil, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ceiling, Mathematical Functions and Operators
center, Geometric Functions and Operators
Certificate, Certificate Authentication
chained transactions, Transaction Management, Parameters, Parameters
in PL/pgSQL, Transaction Management
char, Character Types
character, Character Types
character set, Locale and Formatting, Preset Options, Character Set Support
character string, String Constants, Character Types
concatenation, String Functions and Operators
constant, String Constants
converting to binary string, Binary String Functions and Operators
data types, Character Types
length, String Functions and Operators
prefix test, String Functions and Operators
character varying, Character Types
character_length, String Functions and Operators
char_length, String Functions and Operators
check constraint, Check Constraints
CHECK OPTION, CREATE VIEW
checkpoint, WAL Configuration
CHECKPOINT, CHECKPOINT
checkpoint_completion_target configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checkpoint_flush_after configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checkpoint_timeout configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checkpoint_warning configuration parameter, Checkpoints
checksums, Data Checksums
check_function_bodies configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
chr, String Functions and Operators
cid, Object Identifier Types
cidr, cidr
circle, Circles, Geometric Functions and Operators
citext, citext
client authentication, Client Authentication
timeout during, Authentication
client_connection_check_interval configuration parameter, Connection Settings
client_encoding configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
client_min_messages configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
clock_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
CLOSE, CLOSE
cluster
of databases (see database cluster)
CLUSTER, CLUSTER
clusterdb, clusterdb
clustering, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
cluster_name configuration parameter, Process Title
cmax, System Columns
cmin, System Columns
COALESCE, COALESCE
COLLATE, Collation Expressions
collation, Collation Support
in PL/pgSQL, Collation of PL/pgSQL Variables
in SQL functions, SQL Functions with Collations
COLLATION FOR, System Information Functions and Operators
color, Color Support
column, Concepts, Table Basics
adding, Adding a Column
removing, Removing a Column
renaming, Renaming a Column
system column, System Columns
column data type
changing, Changing a Column's Data Type
column reference, Column References
col_description, System Information Functions and Operators
comment, Comments
about database objects, System Information Functions and Operators
in SQL, Comments
COMMENT, COMMENT
COMMIT, COMMIT
COMMIT PREPARED, COMMIT PREPARED
commit_delay configuration parameter, Settings
commit_siblings configuration parameter, Settings
common table expression (see WITH)
comparison, Comparison Functions and Operators, Subquery Expressions
composite type, Row and Array Comparisons
operators, Comparison Functions and Operators
row constructor, Row and Array Comparisons
subquery result row, Subquery Expressions
compiling, Building libpq Programs
libpq applications, Building libpq Programs
composite type, Composite Types, The PostgreSQL Type System
comparison, Row and Array Comparisons
constant, Constructing Composite Values
constructor, Row Constructors
computed field, Using Composite Types in Queries
compute_query_id configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
concat, String Functions and Operators
concat_ws, String Functions and Operators
concurrency, Concurrency Control
conditional expression, Conditional Expressions
configuration
of recovery
general settings, Recovery
of a standby server, Archive Recovery
of the server, Server Configuration
of the server
functions, Configuration Settings Functions
configure, Installation Procedure
configure environment variables, configure Environment Variables
configure options, configure Options
config_file configuration parameter, File Locations
conjunction, Logical Operators
connectby, Functions Provided, connectby
connection service file, The Connection Service File
conninfo, Connection Strings
constant, Constants
constraint, Constraints
adding, Adding a Constraint
check, Check Constraints
exclusion, Exclusion Constraints
foreign key, Foreign Keys
name, Check Constraints
NOT NULL, Not-Null Constraints
primary key, Primary Keys
removing, Removing a Constraint
unique, Unique Constraints
constraint exclusion, Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion, Other Planner Options
constraint_exclusion configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
container type, The PostgreSQL Type System
CONTINUE
in PL/pgSQL, CONTINUE
continuous archiving, Backup and Restore
in standby, Continuous Archiving in Standby
control file, Extension Files
convert, Binary String Functions and Operators
convert_from, Binary String Functions and Operators
convert_to, Binary String Functions and Operators
COPY, Populating a Table With Rows, Functions Associated with the COPY Command, COPY
with libpq, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
corr, Aggregate Functions
correlation, Aggregate Functions
in the query planner, Extended Statistics
cos, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cosd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cosh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cot, Mathematical Functions and Operators
cotd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
count, Aggregate Functions
covariance
population, Aggregate Functions
sample, Aggregate Functions
covar_pop, Aggregate Functions
covar_samp, Aggregate Functions
covering index, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
cpu_index_tuple_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
cpu_operator_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
cpu_tuple_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
CREATE ACCESS METHOD, CREATE ACCESS METHOD
CREATE AGGREGATE, CREATE AGGREGATE
CREATE CAST, CREATE CAST
CREATE COLLATION, CREATE COLLATION
CREATE CONVERSION, CREATE CONVERSION
CREATE DATABASE, Creating a Database, CREATE DATABASE
CREATE DOMAIN, CREATE DOMAIN
CREATE EVENT TRIGGER, CREATE EVENT TRIGGER
CREATE EXTENSION, CREATE EXTENSION
CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER, CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER
CREATE FOREIGN TABLE, CREATE FOREIGN TABLE
CREATE FUNCTION, CREATE FUNCTION
CREATE GROUP, CREATE GROUP
CREATE INDEX, CREATE INDEX
CREATE LANGUAGE, CREATE LANGUAGE
CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW, CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW
CREATE OPERATOR, CREATE OPERATOR
CREATE OPERATOR CLASS, CREATE OPERATOR CLASS
CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY, CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY
CREATE POLICY, CREATE POLICY
CREATE PROCEDURE, CREATE PROCEDURE
CREATE PUBLICATION, CREATE PUBLICATION
CREATE ROLE, Database Roles, CREATE ROLE
CREATE RULE, CREATE RULE
CREATE SCHEMA, CREATE SCHEMA
CREATE SEQUENCE, CREATE SEQUENCE
CREATE SERVER, CREATE SERVER
CREATE STATISTICS, CREATE STATISTICS
CREATE SUBSCRIPTION, CREATE SUBSCRIPTION
CREATE TABLE, Creating a New Table, CREATE TABLE
CREATE TABLE AS, CREATE TABLE AS
CREATE TABLESPACE, Tablespaces, CREATE TABLESPACE
CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION, CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION
CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY, CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY
CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER, CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER
CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE, CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE
CREATE TRANSFORM, CREATE TRANSFORM
CREATE TRIGGER, CREATE TRIGGER
CREATE TYPE, CREATE TYPE
CREATE USER, CREATE USER
CREATE USER MAPPING, CREATE USER MAPPING
CREATE VIEW, CREATE VIEW
createdb, Creating a Database, Creating a Database, createdb
createuser, Database Roles, createuser
CREATE_REPLICATION_SLOT, Streaming Replication Protocol
cross compilation, Build Process Details
cross join, Joined Tables
crosstab, crosstab(text), crosstabN(text), crosstab(text, text)
crypt, crypt()
cstring, Pseudo-Types
CSV (Comma-Separated Values) format
in psql, Meta-Commands
ctid, System Columns
CTID, View Rules in Non-SELECT Statements
CUBE, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
cube (extension), cube
cume_dist, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
current_catalog, System Information Functions and Operators
current_database, System Information Functions and Operators
current_date, Date/Time Functions and Operators
current_logfiles
and the log_destination configuration parameter, Where to Log
and the pg_current_logfile function, System Information Functions and Operators
current_query, System Information Functions and Operators
current_role, System Information Functions and Operators
current_schema, System Information Functions and Operators
current_schemas, System Information Functions and Operators
current_setting, Configuration Settings Functions
current_time, Date/Time Functions and Operators
current_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
current_user, System Information Functions and Operators
currval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
cursor, Cursors, CLOSE, DECLARE, EXPLAIN, FETCH, MOVE
CLOSE, CLOSE
DECLARE, DECLARE
FETCH, FETCH
in PL/pgSQL, Cursors
MOVE, MOVE
showing the query plan, EXPLAIN
cursor_tuple_fraction configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
custom scan provider, Writing a Custom Scan Provider
handler for, Writing a Custom Scan Provider
Cygwin, Cygwin
installation on, Cygwin

D

data area (see database cluster)
data partitioning, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
data type, Data Types, Numeric Types, Enumerated Types, Domain Types, Type Conversion, The PostgreSQL Type System, The PostgreSQL Type System, The PostgreSQL Type System, Polymorphic Types, Base Types in C-Language Functions, User-Defined Types
base, The PostgreSQL Type System
category, Overview
composite, The PostgreSQL Type System
constant, Constants of Other Types
container, The PostgreSQL Type System
conversion, Type Conversion
domain, Domain Types
enumerated (enum), Enumerated Types
internal organization, Base Types in C-Language Functions
numeric, Numeric Types
polymorphic, Polymorphic Types
type cast, Type Casts
user-defined, User-Defined Types
database, Creating a Database, Managing Databases
creating, Creating a Database
privilege to create, Role Attributes
database activity, Monitoring Database Activity
monitoring, Monitoring Database Activity
database cluster, Concepts, Creating a Database Cluster
data_checksums configuration parameter, Preset Options
data_directory configuration parameter, File Locations
data_directory_mode configuration parameter, Preset Options
data_sync_retry configuration parameter, Error Handling
date, Date/Time Types, Dates
constants, Special Values
current, Current Date/Time
output format, Date/Time Output
(see also formatting)
DateStyle configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
date_bin, date_bin
date_part, Date/Time Functions and Operators, EXTRACT, date_part
date_trunc, Date/Time Functions and Operators, date_trunc
dblink, dblink, dblink
dblink_build_sql_delete, dblink_build_sql_delete
dblink_build_sql_insert, dblink_build_sql_insert
dblink_build_sql_update, dblink_build_sql_update
dblink_cancel_query, dblink_cancel_query
dblink_close, dblink_close
dblink_connect, dblink_connect
dblink_connect_u, dblink_connect_u
dblink_disconnect, dblink_disconnect
dblink_error_message, dblink_error_message
dblink_exec, dblink_exec
dblink_fetch, dblink_fetch
dblink_get_connections, dblink_get_connections
dblink_get_notify, dblink_get_notify
dblink_get_pkey, dblink_get_pkey
dblink_get_result, dblink_get_result
dblink_is_busy, dblink_is_busy
dblink_open, dblink_open
dblink_send_query, dblink_send_query
db_user_namespace configuration parameter, Authentication
deadlock, Deadlocks
timeout during, Lock Management
deadlock_timeout configuration parameter, Lock Management
DEALLOCATE, DEALLOCATE
dearmor, armor(), dearmor()
debug_assertions configuration parameter, Preset Options
debug_deadlocks configuration parameter, Developer Options
debug_discard_caches configuration parameter, Developer Options
debug_pretty_print configuration parameter, What to Log
debug_print_parse configuration parameter, What to Log
debug_print_plan configuration parameter, What to Log
debug_print_rewritten configuration parameter, What to Log
decimal (see numeric)
DECLARE, DECLARE
decode, Binary String Functions and Operators
decode_bytea
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
decrypt, Raw Encryption Functions
decrypt_iv, Raw Encryption Functions
deduplicate_items storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
default value, Default Values
changing, Changing a Column's Default Value
default-roles, Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles
default_statistics_target configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
default_tablespace configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_table_access_method configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_text_search_config configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
default_toast_compression configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_transaction_deferrable configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_transaction_isolation configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
default_transaction_read_only configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
deferrable transaction, Statement Behavior
setting, SET TRANSACTION
setting default, Statement Behavior
defined, hstore Operators and Functions
degrees, Mathematical Functions and Operators
delay, Delaying Execution
DELETE, Deletions, Deleting Data, Returning Data from Modified Rows, DELETE
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
delete, hstore Operators and Functions
deleting, Deleting Data
dense_rank, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
diagonal, Geometric Functions and Operators
diameter, Geometric Functions and Operators
dict_int, dict_int
dict_xsyn, dict_xsyn
difference, Soundex
digest, digest()
dirty read, Transaction Isolation
DISCARD, DISCARD
disjunction, Logical Operators
disk drive, WAL Internals
disk space, Recovering Disk Space
disk usage, Determining Disk Usage
DISTINCT, Querying a Table, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP, DISTINCT
GROUP BY DISTINCT, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
SELECT DISTINCT, DISTINCT
div, Mathematical Functions and Operators
dmetaphone, Double Metaphone
dmetaphone_alt, Double Metaphone
DO, DO
document, What Is a Document?
text search, What Is a Document?
dollar quoting, Dollar-Quoted String Constants
domain, Domain Types
double precision, Floating-Point Types
DROP ACCESS METHOD, DROP ACCESS METHOD
DROP AGGREGATE, DROP AGGREGATE
DROP CAST, DROP CAST
DROP COLLATION, DROP COLLATION
DROP CONVERSION, DROP CONVERSION
DROP DATABASE, Destroying a Database, DROP DATABASE
DROP DOMAIN, DROP DOMAIN
DROP EVENT TRIGGER, DROP EVENT TRIGGER
DROP EXTENSION, DROP EXTENSION
DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER, DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER
DROP FOREIGN TABLE, DROP FOREIGN TABLE
DROP FUNCTION, DROP FUNCTION
DROP GROUP, DROP GROUP
DROP INDEX, DROP INDEX
DROP LANGUAGE, DROP LANGUAGE
DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW, DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW
DROP OPERATOR, DROP OPERATOR
DROP OPERATOR CLASS, DROP OPERATOR CLASS
DROP OPERATOR FAMILY, DROP OPERATOR FAMILY
DROP OWNED, DROP OWNED
DROP POLICY, DROP POLICY
DROP PROCEDURE, DROP PROCEDURE
DROP PUBLICATION, DROP PUBLICATION
DROP ROLE, Database Roles, DROP ROLE
DROP ROUTINE, DROP ROUTINE
DROP RULE, DROP RULE
DROP SCHEMA, DROP SCHEMA
DROP SEQUENCE, DROP SEQUENCE
DROP SERVER, DROP SERVER
DROP STATISTICS, DROP STATISTICS
DROP SUBSCRIPTION, DROP SUBSCRIPTION
DROP TABLE, Creating a New Table, DROP TABLE
DROP TABLESPACE, DROP TABLESPACE
DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION, DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION
DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY, DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY
DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER, DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER
DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE, DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE
DROP TRANSFORM, DROP TRANSFORM
DROP TRIGGER, DROP TRIGGER
DROP TYPE, DROP TYPE
DROP USER, DROP USER
DROP USER MAPPING, DROP USER MAPPING
DROP VIEW, DROP VIEW
dropdb, Destroying a Database, dropdb
dropuser, Database Roles, dropuser
DROP_REPLICATION_SLOT, Streaming Replication Protocol
DTD, Creating XML Values
DTrace, Developer Options, Dynamic Tracing
duplicate, Querying a Table
duplicates, DISTINCT
dynamic loading, Other Defaults, Dynamic Loading
dynamic_library_path, Dynamic Loading
dynamic_library_path configuration parameter, Other Defaults
dynamic_shared_memory_type configuration parameter, Memory

E

each, hstore Operators and Functions
earth, Cube-Based Earth Distances
earthdistance, earthdistance
earth_box, Cube-Based Earth Distances
earth_distance, Cube-Based Earth Distances
ECPG, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
ecpg, ecpg
effective_cache_size configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
effective_io_concurrency configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
elog, Reporting Errors Within the Server
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
in PL/Python, Utility Functions
in PL/Tcl, Database Access from PL/Tcl
embedded SQL, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
in C, ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
enabled role, enabled_roles
enable_async_append configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_bitmapscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_gathermerge configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_hashagg configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_hashjoin configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_incremental_sort configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_indexonlyscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_indexscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_material configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_memoize configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_mergejoin configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_nestloop configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_parallel_append configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_parallel_hash configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_partitionwise_aggregate configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_partitionwise_join configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_partition_pruning configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_seqscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_sort configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
enable_tidscan configuration parameter, Planner Method Configuration
encode, Binary String Functions and Operators
encode_array_constructor
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encode_array_literal
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encode_bytea
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encode_typed_literal
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
encrypt, Raw Encryption Functions
encryption, Encryption Options, pgcrypto
for specific columns, pgcrypto
encrypt_iv, Raw Encryption Functions
END, END
enumerated types, Enumerated Types
enum_first, Enum Support Functions
enum_last, Enum Support Functions
enum_range, Enum Support Functions
environment variable, Environment Variables
ephemeral named relation
registering with SPI, SPI_register_relation, SPI_register_trigger_data
unregistering from SPI, SPI_unregister_relation
ereport, Reporting Errors Within the Server
error codes, PostgreSQL Error Codes
libpq, Main Functions
list of, PostgreSQL Error Codes
error message, Connection Status Functions
escape format, Binary String Functions and Operators
escape string syntax, String Constants with C-Style Escapes
escape_string_warning configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
escaping strings, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
in libpq, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
event log, Registering Event Log on Windows
event log, Registering Event Log on Windows
event trigger, Event Triggers, Writing Event Trigger Functions in C
in C, Writing Event Trigger Functions in C
in PL/Tcl, Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
event_source configuration parameter, Where to Log
event_trigger, Pseudo-Types
every, Aggregate Functions
EXCEPT, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
exceptions
in PL/pgSQL, Trapping Errors
in PL/Tcl, Error Handling in PL/Tcl
exclusion constraint, Exclusion Constraints
EXECUTE, EXECUTE
exist, hstore Operators and Functions
EXISTS, Subquery Expressions
EXIT
in PL/pgSQL, EXIT
exit_on_error configuration parameter, Error Handling
exp, Mathematical Functions and Operators
EXPLAIN, Using EXPLAIN, EXPLAIN
expression, Value Expressions
order of evaluation, Expression Evaluation Rules
syntax, Value Expressions
extending SQL, Extending SQL
extension, Packaging Related Objects into an Extension
externally maintained, Extensions
external_pid_file configuration parameter, File Locations
extract, Date/Time Functions and Operators, EXTRACT, date_part
extra_float_digits configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting

F

factorial, Mathematical Functions and Operators
failover, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
false, Boolean Type
family, Network Address Functions and Operators
fast path, The Fast-Path Interface
fastupdate storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
fdw_handler, Pseudo-Types
FETCH, FETCH
field
computed, Using Composite Types in Queries
field selection, Field Selection
file system mount points, Use of Secondary File Systems
file_fdw, file_fdw
fillfactor storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters, Storage Parameters
FILTER, Aggregate Expressions
first_value, Window Functions
flex, Requirements
float4 (see real)
float8 (see double precision)
floating point, Floating-Point Types
floating-point
display, Locale and Formatting
floor, Mathematical Functions and Operators
force_parallel_mode configuration parameter, Developer Options
foreign data, Foreign Data
foreign data wrapper, Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper
handler for, Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper
foreign key, Foreign Keys, Foreign Keys
self-referential, Foreign Keys
foreign table, Foreign Data
format, String Functions and Operators, format
use in PL/pgSQL, Executing Dynamic Commands
formatting, Data Type Formatting Functions
format_type, System Information Functions and Operators
Free Space Map, Free Space Map
FreeBSD
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
from_collapse_limit configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
FSM (see Free Space Map)
fsm_page_contents, General Functions
fsync configuration parameter, Settings
full text search, Text Search Types, Text Search Types, Full Text Search
data types, Text Search Types
functions and operators, Text Search Types
full_page_writes configuration parameter, Settings
function, Table Functions, Functions and Operators, Statistics Information Functions, Functions, Polymorphic Types, User-Defined Functions, Query Language (SQL) Functions, Internal Functions, C-Language Functions
default values for arguments, SQL Functions with Default Values for Arguments
in the FROM clause, Table Functions
internal, Internal Functions
invocation, Function Calls
mixed notation, Using Mixed Notation
named argument, Arguments for SQL Functions
named notation, Using Named Notation
output parameter, SQL Functions with Output Parameters
polymorphic, Polymorphic Types
positional notation, Using Positional Notation
RETURNS TABLE, SQL Functions Returning TABLE
statistics, Statistics Information Functions
type resolution in an invocation, Functions
user-defined, User-Defined Functions, Query Language (SQL) Functions, C-Language Functions
in C, C-Language Functions
in SQL, Query Language (SQL) Functions
variadic, SQL Functions with Variable Numbers of Arguments
with SETOF, SQL Functions Returning Sets
functional dependency, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
fuzzystrmatch, fuzzystrmatch

G

gcd, Mathematical Functions and Operators
gc_to_sec, Cube-Based Earth Distances
generated column, Generated Columns, Parameters, Parameters
in + triggers, Overview of Trigger Behavior
generate_series, Set Returning Functions
generate_subscripts, Set Returning Functions
genetic query optimization, Genetic Query Optimizer
gen_random_bytes, Random-Data Functions
gen_random_uuid, UUID Functions, Random-Data Functions
gen_salt, gen_salt()
GEQO (see genetic query optimization)
geqo configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_effort configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_generations configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_pool_size configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_seed configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_selection_bias configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
geqo_threshold configuration parameter, Genetic Query Optimizer
get_bit, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
get_byte, Binary String Functions and Operators
get_current_ts_config, Text Search Functions and Operators
get_raw_page, General Functions
GIN (see index)
gin_clean_pending_list, Index Maintenance Functions
gin_fuzzy_search_limit configuration parameter, Other Defaults
gin_leafpage_items, GIN Functions
gin_metapage_info, GIN Functions
gin_page_opaque_info, GIN Functions
gin_pending_list_limit
configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
GiST (see index)
gist_page_items, GiST Functions
gist_page_items_bytea, GiST Functions
gist_page_opaque_info, GiST Functions
global data, Global Data in PL/Tcl
in PL/Python, Sharing Data
in PL/Tcl, Global Data in PL/Tcl
GRANT, Privileges, GRANT
GREATEST, GREATEST and LEAST, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
Gregorian calendar, History of Units
GROUP BY, Aggregate Functions, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
grouping, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
GROUPING, Aggregate Functions
GROUPING SETS, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
gssapi, Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption
GSSAPI, GSSAPI Authentication
with + libpq, Parameter Key Words
GUID, UUID Type

H

hash (see index)
hash_bitmap_info, Hash Functions
hash_mem_multiplier configuration parameter, Memory
hash_metapage_info, Hash Functions
hash_page_items, Hash Functions
hash_page_stats, Hash Functions
hash_page_type, Hash Functions
has_any_column_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_column_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_database_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_foreign_data_wrapper_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_function_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_language_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_parameter_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_schema_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_sequence_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_server_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_tablespace_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_table_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
has_type_privilege, System Information Functions and Operators
HAVING, Aggregate Functions, The GROUP BY and HAVING Clauses
hba_file configuration parameter, File Locations
heap_page_items, Heap Functions
heap_page_item_attrs, Heap Functions
heap_tuple_infomask_flags, Heap Functions
height, Geometric Functions and Operators
hex format, Binary String Functions and Operators
hierarchical database, Concepts
high availability, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
history, A Brief History of PostgreSQL
of PostgreSQL, A Brief History of PostgreSQL
hmac, hmac()
host, Network Address Functions and Operators
host + name, Parameter Key Words
hostmask, Network Address Functions and Operators
hot standby, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
hot_standby configuration parameter, Standby Servers
hot_standby_feedback configuration parameter, Standby Servers
HP-UX
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
hstore, hstore, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_array, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_json, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_jsonb, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_jsonb_loose, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_json_loose, hstore Operators and Functions
hstore_to_matrix, hstore Operators and Functions
huge_pages configuration parameter, Memory
huge_page_size configuration parameter, Memory
hypothetical-set aggregate
built-in, Aggregate Functions

I

icount, intarray Functions and Operators
ICU, PostgreSQL Features, Locale Providers, Managing Collations, Parameters, Parameters
ident, Ident Authentication
identifier, Identifiers and Key Words
length, Identifiers and Key Words
syntax of, Identifiers and Key Words
IDENTIFY_SYSTEM, Streaming Replication Protocol
ident_file configuration parameter, File Locations
idle_in_transaction_session_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
idle_session_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
idx, intarray Functions and Operators
IFNULL, COALESCE
ignore_checksum_failure configuration parameter, Developer Options
ignore_invalid_pages configuration parameter, Developer Options
ignore_system_indexes configuration parameter, Developer Options
IMMUTABLE, Function Volatility Categories
IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA, IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA
IN, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
INCLUDE
in index definitions, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
include
in configuration file, Managing Configuration File Contents
include_dir
in configuration file, Managing Configuration File Contents
include_if_exists
in configuration file, Managing Configuration File Contents
index, Indexes, Multicolumn Indexes, Indexes and ORDER BY, Combining Multiple Indexes, Unique Indexes, Indexes on Expressions, Partial Indexes, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes, Examining Index Usage, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, Locking and Indexes, Interfacing Extensions to Indexes, Building Indexes Concurrently, Rebuilding Indexes Concurrently, Operators and Functions
and ORDER BY, Indexes and ORDER BY
B-Tree, B-Tree, B-Tree Indexes
BRIN, BRIN, BRIN Indexes
building concurrently, Building Indexes Concurrently
combining multiple indexes, Combining Multiple Indexes
covering, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
examining usage, Examining Index Usage
on expressions, Indexes on Expressions
for user-defined data type, Interfacing Extensions to Indexes
GIN, GIN, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, GIN Indexes
text search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
GiST, GiST, Preferred Index Types for Text Search, GiST Indexes
text search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
hash, Hash
Hash, Hash Indexes
index-only scans, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
locks, Locking and Indexes
multicolumn, Multicolumn Indexes
partial, Partial Indexes
rebuilding concurrently, Rebuilding Indexes Concurrently
SP-GiST, SP-GiST, SP-GiST Indexes
unique, Unique Indexes
Index Access Method, Index Access Method Interface Definition
index scan, Planner Method Configuration
index-only scan, Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
indexam
Index Access Method, Index Access Method Interface Definition
index_am_handler, Pseudo-Types
inet (data type), inet
inet_client_addr, System Information Functions and Operators
inet_client_port, System Information Functions and Operators
inet_merge, Network Address Functions and Operators
inet_same_family, Network Address Functions and Operators
inet_server_addr, System Information Functions and Operators
inet_server_port, System Information Functions and Operators
infinity
floating point, Floating-Point Types
numeric (data type), Arbitrary Precision Numbers
information schema, The Information Schema
inheritance, Inheritance, Inheritance
initcap, String Functions and Operators
initdb, Creating a Database Cluster, initdb
Initialization Fork, The Initialization Fork
input function, User-Defined Types
INSERT, Populating a Table With Rows, Inserting Data, Returning Data from Modified Rows, INSERT
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
inserting, Inserting Data
installation, Installation from Source Code
binaries, Installation from Binaries
on Windows, Installation from Source Code on Windows
instr function, Appendix
int2 (see smallint)
int4 (see integer)
int8 (see bigint)
intagg, intagg
intarray, intarray
integer, Numeric Constants, Integer Types
integer_datetimes configuration parameter, Preset Options
interfaces
externally maintained, Client Interfaces
internal, Pseudo-Types
INTERSECT, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
interval, Date/Time Types, Interval Input
output format, Interval Output
(see also formatting)
IntervalStyle configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
intset, intarray Functions and Operators
int_array_aggregate, Functions
int_array_enum, Functions
inverse distribution, Aggregate Functions
in_hot_standby configuration parameter, Preset Options
in_range support functions, B-Tree Support Functions
IS DISTINCT FROM, Comparison Functions and Operators, Row and Array Comparisons
IS DOCUMENT, IS DOCUMENT
IS FALSE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT DISTINCT FROM, Comparison Functions and Operators, Row and Array Comparisons
IS NOT DOCUMENT, IS NOT DOCUMENT
IS NOT FALSE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT NULL, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT TRUE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NOT UNKNOWN, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS NULL, Comparison Functions and Operators, Platform and Client Compatibility
IS TRUE, Comparison Functions and Operators
IS UNKNOWN, Comparison Functions and Operators
isclosed, Geometric Functions and Operators
isempty, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
isfinite, Date/Time Functions and Operators
isn, isn
ISNULL, Comparison Functions and Operators
isn_weak, Functions and Operators
isopen, Geometric Functions and Operators
is_array_ref
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
is_valid, Functions and Operators

J

JIT, Just-in-Time Compilation (JIT)
jit configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
jit_above_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
jit_debugging_support configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_dump_bitcode configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_expressions configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_inline_above_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
jit_optimize_above_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
jit_profiling_support configuration parameter, Developer Options
jit_provider configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
jit_tuple_deforming configuration parameter, Developer Options
join, Joins Between Tables, Joined Tables, Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses
controlling the order, Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses
cross, Joined Tables
left, Joined Tables
natural, Joined Tables
outer, Joins Between Tables, Joined Tables
right, Joined Tables
self, Joins Between Tables
join_collapse_limit configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
JSON, JSON Types, JSON Functions and Operators
functions and operators, JSON Functions and Operators
JSONB, JSON Types
jsonb
containment, jsonb Containment and Existence
existence, jsonb Containment and Existence
indexes on, jsonb Indexing
jsonb_agg, Aggregate Functions
jsonb_array_elements, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_array_elements_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_array_length, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_build_array, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_build_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_each, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_each_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_extract_path, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_extract_path_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_insert, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_object_agg, Aggregate Functions
jsonb_object_keys, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_exists, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_exists_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_match, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_match_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_array, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_array_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_first, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_first_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_path_query_tz, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_populate_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_populate_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_pretty, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_set, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_set_lax, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_strip_nulls, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_to_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_to_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonb_to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
jsonb_typeof, Processing and Creating JSON Data
jsonpath, jsonpath Type
json_agg, Aggregate Functions
json_array_elements, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_array_elements_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_array_length, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_build_array, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_build_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_each, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_each_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_extract_path, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_extract_path_text, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_object, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_object_agg, Aggregate Functions
json_object_keys, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_populate_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_populate_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_strip_nulls, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_to_record, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_to_recordset, Processing and Creating JSON Data
json_to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
json_typeof, Processing and Creating JSON Data
Julian date, Julian Dates
Just-In-Time compilation (see JIT)
justify_days, Date/Time Functions and Operators
justify_hours, Date/Time Functions and Operators
justify_interval, Date/Time Functions and Operators

K

key word, Identifiers and Key Words, SQL Key Words
list of, SQL Key Words
syntax of, Identifiers and Key Words
krb_caseins_users configuration parameter, Authentication
krb_server_keyfile configuration parameter, Authentication

L

label (see alias)
lag, Window Functions
language_handler, Pseudo-Types
large object, Large Objects
lastval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
last_value, Window Functions
LATERAL, LATERAL Subqueries
in the FROM clause, LATERAL Subqueries
latitude, Cube-Based Earth Distances
lca, Operators and Functions
lcm, Mathematical Functions and Operators
lc_collate configuration parameter, Preset Options
lc_ctype configuration parameter, Preset Options
lc_messages configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
lc_monetary configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
lc_numeric configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
lc_time configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
LDAP, PostgreSQL Features, LDAP Authentication
LDAP connection parameter lookup, LDAP Lookup of Connection Parameters
ldconfig, Shared Libraries
lead, Window Functions
LEAST, GREATEST and LEAST, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
left, String Functions and Operators
left join, Joined Tables
length, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators, Geometric Functions and Operators, Text Search Functions and Operators
of a binary string (see binary strings, length)
of a character string (see character string, length)
length(tsvector), Manipulating Documents
levenshtein, Levenshtein
levenshtein_less_equal, Levenshtein
lex, Requirements
libedit, Requirements
in psql, Command-Line Editing
libperl, Requirements
libpq, libpq — C Library, Pipeline Mode, Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
pipeline mode, Pipeline Mode
single-row mode, Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
libpq-fe.h, libpq — C Library, Connection Status Functions
libpq-int.h, Connection Status Functions
libpython, Requirements
library initialization function, Dynamic Loading
LIKE, LIKE
and locales, Behavior
LIKE_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery, SQL/JSON Regular Expressions
in SQL/JSON, SQL/JSON Regular Expressions
LIMIT, LIMIT and OFFSET
line, Lines, Geometric Functions and Operators
line segment, Line Segments
linear regression, Aggregate Functions
Linux
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
LISTEN, LISTEN
listen_addresses configuration parameter, Connection Settings
llvm-config, PostgreSQL Features
ll_to_earth, Cube-Based Earth Distances
ln, Mathematical Functions and Operators
lo, lo
LOAD, LOAD
load balancing, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
locale, Creating a Database Cluster, Locale Support
localtime, Date/Time Functions and Operators
localtimestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
local_preload_libraries configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
lock, Explicit Locking, Advisory Locks, Viewing Locks
advisory, Advisory Locks
monitoring, Viewing Locks
LOCK, Table-Level Locks, LOCK
lock_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
log, Mathematical Functions and Operators
log shipping, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
log10, Mathematical Functions and Operators
Logging
current_logfiles file and the pg_current_logfile + function, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_logfile function, System Information Functions and Operators
logging_collector configuration parameter, Where to Log
Logical Decoding, Logical Decoding, Logical Decoding
logical_decoding_work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
login privilege, Role Attributes
log_autovacuum_min_duration
configuration parameter, What to Log
storage parameter, Storage Parameters
log_btree_build_stats configuration parameter, Developer Options
log_checkpoints configuration parameter, What to Log
log_connections configuration parameter, What to Log
log_destination configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_directory configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_disconnections configuration parameter, What to Log
log_duration configuration parameter, What to Log
log_error_verbosity configuration parameter, What to Log
log_executor_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_filename configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_file_mode configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_hostname configuration parameter, What to Log
log_line_prefix configuration parameter, What to Log
log_lock_waits configuration parameter, What to Log
log_min_duration_sample configuration parameter, When to Log
log_min_duration_statement configuration parameter, When to Log
log_min_error_statement configuration parameter, When to Log
log_min_messages configuration parameter, When to Log
log_parameter_max_length configuration parameter, What to Log
log_parameter_max_length_on_error configuration parameter, What to Log
log_parser_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_planner_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_recovery_conflict_waits configuration parameter, What to Log
log_replication_commands configuration parameter, What to Log
log_rotation_age configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_rotation_size configuration parameter, Where to Log
log_startup_progress_interval configuration parameter, When to Log
log_statement configuration parameter, What to Log
log_statement_sample_rate configuration parameter, When to Log
log_statement_stats configuration parameter, Statistics Monitoring
log_temp_files configuration parameter, What to Log
log_timezone configuration parameter, What to Log
log_transaction_sample_rate configuration parameter, When to Log
log_truncate_on_rotation configuration parameter, Where to Log
longitude, Cube-Based Earth Distances
looks_like_number
in PL/Perl, Utility Functions in PL/Perl
loop, Simple Loops
in PL/pgSQL, Simple Loops
lower, String Functions and Operators, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
and locales, Behavior
lower_inc, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
lower_inf, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
lo_close, Closing a Large Object Descriptor
lo_compat_privileges configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
lo_creat, Creating a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_create, Creating a Large Object
lo_export, Exporting a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_from_bytea, Server-Side Functions
lo_get, Server-Side Functions
lo_import, Importing a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_import_with_oid, Importing a Large Object
lo_lseek, Seeking in a Large Object
lo_lseek64, Seeking in a Large Object
lo_open, Opening an Existing Large Object
lo_put, Server-Side Functions
lo_read, Reading Data from a Large Object
lo_tell, Obtaining the Seek Position of a Large Object
lo_tell64, Obtaining the Seek Position of a Large Object
lo_truncate, Truncating a Large Object
lo_truncate64, Truncating a Large Object
lo_unlink, Removing a Large Object, Server-Side Functions
lo_write, Writing Data to a Large Object
lpad, String Functions and Operators
lseg, Line Segments, Geometric Functions and Operators
LSN, WAL Internals
ltree, ltree
ltree2text, Operators and Functions
ltrim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators

M

MAC address (see macaddr)
MAC address (EUI-64 format) (see macaddr)
macaddr (data type), macaddr
macaddr8 (data type), macaddr8
macaddr8_set7bit, Network Address Functions and Operators
macOS, macOS
installation on, macOS
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
magic block, Dynamic Loading
maintenance, Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
maintenance_io_concurrency configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
maintenance_work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
make, Requirements
makeaclitem, System Information Functions and Operators
make_date, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_interval, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_time, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_timestamptz, Date/Time Functions and Operators
make_valid, Functions and Operators
MANPATH, Environment Variables
masklen, Network Address Functions and Operators
materialized view, Materialized Views
implementation through rules, Materialized Views
materialized views, pg_matviews
max, Aggregate Functions
max_connections configuration parameter, Connection Settings
max_files_per_process configuration parameter, Kernel Resource Usage
max_function_args configuration parameter, Preset Options
max_identifier_length configuration parameter, Preset Options
max_index_keys configuration parameter, Preset Options
max_locks_per_transaction configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_logical_replication_workers configuration parameter, Subscribers
max_parallel_maintenance_workers configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
max_parallel_workers configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
max_parallel_workers_per_gather configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
max_pred_locks_per_page configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_pred_locks_per_relation configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_pred_locks_per_transaction configuration parameter, Lock Management
max_prepared_transactions configuration parameter, Memory
max_replication_slots configuration parameter, Sending Servers
max_slot_wal_keep_size configuration parameter, Sending Servers
max_stack_depth configuration parameter, Memory
max_standby_archive_delay configuration parameter, Standby Servers
max_standby_streaming_delay configuration parameter, Standby Servers
max_sync_workers_per_subscription configuration parameter, Subscribers
max_wal_senders configuration parameter, Sending Servers
max_wal_size configuration parameter, Checkpoints
max_worker_processes configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
md5, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
MD5, Password Authentication
median, Aggregate Expressions
(see also percentile)
memory context
in SPI, Memory Management
memory overcommit, Linux Memory Overcommit
MERGE, MERGE
metaphone, Metaphone
min, Aggregate Functions
MinGW, MinGW/Native Windows
installation on, MinGW/Native Windows
min_dynamic_shared_memory configuration parameter, Memory
min_parallel_index_scan_size configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
min_parallel_table_scan_size configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
min_scale, Mathematical Functions and Operators
min_wal_size configuration parameter, Checkpoints
mod, Mathematical Functions and Operators
mode
statistical, Aggregate Functions
monitoring, Monitoring Database Activity
database activity, Monitoring Database Activity
MOVE, MOVE
moving-aggregate mode, Moving-Aggregate Mode
multirange (function), Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
multirange type, Range Types
Multiversion Concurrency Control, Introduction
MultiXactId, Multixacts and Wraparound
MVCC, Introduction

N

name, Identifiers and Key Words
qualified, Creating a Schema
syntax of, Identifiers and Key Words
unqualified, The Schema Search Path
NaN (see not a number)
natural join, Joined Tables
negation, Logical Operators
NetBSD
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
netmask, Network Address Functions and Operators
network, Network Address Types, Network Address Functions and Operators
data types, Network Address Types
nextval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
NFS, NFS
nlevel, Operators and Functions
non-durable, Non-Durable Settings
nonblocking connection, Database Connection Control Functions, Asynchronous Command Processing
nonrepeatable read, Transaction Isolation
normalize, String Functions and Operators
normalized, String Functions and Operators
normal_rand, normal_rand
NOT (operator), Logical Operators
not a number
floating point, Floating-Point Types
numeric (data type), Arbitrary Precision Numbers
NOT IN, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
not-null constraint, Not-Null Constraints
notation, Calling Functions
functions, Calling Functions
notice processing, Notice Processing
in libpq, Notice Processing
notice processor, Notice Processing
notice receiver, Notice Processing
NOTIFY, Asynchronous Notification, NOTIFY
in libpq, Asynchronous Notification
NOTNULL, Comparison Functions and Operators
now, Date/Time Functions and Operators
npoints, Geometric Functions and Operators
nth_value, Window Functions
ntile, Window Functions
null value
with check constraints, Check Constraints
comparing, Comparison Functions and Operators
default value, Default Values
in DISTINCT, DISTINCT
in libpq, Retrieving Query Result Information
in PL/Perl, PL/Perl Functions and Arguments
in PL/Python, Null, None
with unique constraints, Unique Constraints
NULLIF, NULLIF
number
constant, Numeric Constants
numeric, Numeric Constants
numeric (data type), Arbitrary Precision Numbers
numnode, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Queries
num_nonnulls, Comparison Functions and Operators
num_nulls, Comparison Functions and Operators
NVL, COALESCE

O

object identifier, Object Identifier Types
data type, Object Identifier Types
object-oriented database, Concepts
obj_description, System Information Functions and Operators
OCCURRENCES_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
octet_length, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
OFFSET, LIMIT and OFFSET
oid, Object Identifier Types
OID
in libpq, Retrieving Other Result Information
oid2name, oid2name
old_snapshot, old_snapshot
old_snapshot_threshold configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
ON CONFLICT, INSERT
ONLY, The FROM Clause
OOM, Linux Memory Overcommit
OpenBSD
IPC configuration, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
OpenSSL, PostgreSQL Features
(see also SSL)
operator, Operators, Operator Precedence, Functions and Operators, Logical Operators, Operators, User-Defined Operators
invocation, Operator Invocations
logical, Logical Operators
precedence, Operator Precedence
syntax, Operators
type resolution in an invocation, Operators
user-defined, User-Defined Operators
operator class, Operator Classes and Operator Families, Index Methods and Operator Classes
operator family, Operator Classes and Operator Families, Operator Classes and Operator Families
optimization information, Function Optimization Information, Operator Optimization Information
for functions, Function Optimization Information
for operators, Operator Optimization Information
OR (operator), Logical Operators
Oracle, Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
porting from PL/SQL to PL/pgSQL, Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
ORDER BY, Querying a Table, Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)
and locales, Behavior
ordered-set aggregate, Aggregate Expressions
built-in, Aggregate Functions
ordering operator, System Dependencies on Operator Classes
ordinality, Set Returning Functions
outer join, Joined Tables
output function, User-Defined Types
OVER clause, Window Function Calls
overcommit, Linux Memory Overcommit
OVERLAPS, Date/Time Functions and Operators
overlay, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
overloading, Function Overloading
functions, Function Overloading
operators, User-Defined Operators
owner, Privileges

P

pageinspect, pageinspect
pages_per_range storage parameter, Index Storage Parameters
page_checksum, General Functions
page_header, General Functions
palloc, Writing Code
PAM, PostgreSQL Features, PAM Authentication
parallel query, Parallel Query
parallel_leader_participation configuration parameter, Asynchronous Behavior
parallel_setup_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
parallel_tuple_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
parallel_workers storage parameter, Storage Parameters
parameter
syntax, Positional Parameters
parenthesis, Value Expressions
parse_ident, String Functions and Operators
partition pruning, Partition Pruning
partitioned table, Table Partitioning
partitioning, Table Partitioning
password, Role Attributes
authentication, Password Authentication
of the superuser, Creating a Database Cluster
password file, The Password File
passwordcheck, passwordcheck
password_encryption configuration parameter, Authentication
path, Geometric Functions and Operators
for schemas, Statement Behavior
PATH, Environment Variables
path (data type), Paths
pattern matching, Pattern Matching
patterns
in psql and pg_dump, Patterns
pclose, Geometric Functions and Operators
peer, Peer Authentication
percentile
continuous, Aggregate Functions
discrete, Aggregate Functions
percent_rank, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
performance, Performance Tips
perl, Requirements
Perl, PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
permission (see privilege)
pfree, Writing Code
PGAPPNAME, Environment Variables
pgbench, pgbench
PGcancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PGCHANNELBINDING, Environment Variables
PGCLIENTENCODING, Environment Variables
PGconn, Database Connection Control Functions
PGCONNECT_TIMEOUT, Environment Variables
pgcrypto, pgcrypto
PGDATA, Creating a Database Cluster
PGDATABASE, Environment Variables
PGDATESTYLE, Environment Variables
PGEventProc, Event Callback Procedure
PGGEQO, Environment Variables
PGGSSENCMODE, Environment Variables
PGGSSLIB, Environment Variables
PGHOST, Environment Variables
PGHOSTADDR, Environment Variables
PGKRBSRVNAME, Environment Variables
PGLOCALEDIR, Environment Variables
PGOPTIONS, Environment Variables
PGPASSFILE, Environment Variables
PGPASSWORD, Environment Variables
PGPORT, Environment Variables
pgp_armor_headers, pgp_armor_headers
pgp_key_id, pgp_key_id()
pgp_pub_decrypt, pgp_pub_decrypt()
pgp_pub_decrypt_bytea, pgp_pub_decrypt()
pgp_pub_encrypt, pgp_pub_encrypt()
pgp_pub_encrypt_bytea, pgp_pub_encrypt()
pgp_sym_decrypt, pgp_sym_decrypt()
pgp_sym_decrypt_bytea, pgp_sym_decrypt()
pgp_sym_encrypt, pgp_sym_encrypt()
pgp_sym_encrypt_bytea, pgp_sym_encrypt()
PGREQUIREPEER, Environment Variables
PGREQUIRESSL, Environment Variables
PGresult, Main Functions
pgrowlocks, pgrowlocks, Overview
PGSERVICE, Environment Variables
PGSERVICEFILE, Environment Variables
PGSSLCERT, Environment Variables
PGSSLCOMPRESSION, Environment Variables
PGSSLCRL, Environment Variables
PGSSLCRLDIR, Environment Variables
PGSSLKEY, Environment Variables
PGSSLMAXPROTOCOLVERSION, Environment Variables
PGSSLMINPROTOCOLVERSION, Environment Variables
PGSSLMODE, Environment Variables
PGSSLROOTCERT, Environment Variables
PGSSLSNI, Environment Variables
pgstatginindex, Functions
pgstathashindex, Functions
pgstatindex, Functions
pgstattuple, pgstattuple, Functions
pgstattuple_approx, Functions
PGSYSCONFDIR, Environment Variables
PGTARGETSESSIONATTRS, Environment Variables
PGTZ, Environment Variables
PGUSER, Environment Variables
pgxs, Extension Building Infrastructure
pg_advisory_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_unlock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_unlock_all, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_unlock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_xact_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_advisory_xact_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_aggregate, pg_aggregate
pg_am, pg_am
pg_amcheck, pg_amcheck
pg_amop, pg_amop
pg_amproc, pg_amproc
pg_archivecleanup, pg_archivecleanup
pg_attrdef, pg_attrdef
pg_attribute, pg_attribute
pg_authid, pg_authid
pg_auth_members, pg_auth_members
pg_available_extensions, pg_available_extensions
pg_available_extension_versions, pg_available_extension_versions
pg_backend_memory_contexts, pg_backend_memory_contexts
pg_backend_pid, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_backup_start, Backup Control Functions
pg_backup_stop, Backup Control Functions
pg_basebackup, pg_basebackup
pg_blocking_pids, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_buffercache, pg_buffercache
pg_buffercache_pages, pg_buffercache
pg_cancel_backend, Server Signaling Functions
pg_cast, pg_cast
pg_char_to_encoding, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_checksums, pg_checksums
pg_class, pg_class
pg_client_encoding, String Functions and Operators
pg_collation, pg_collation
pg_collation_actual_version, Database Object Management Functions
pg_collation_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
PG_COLOR, When Color is Used
PG_COLORS, Configuring the Colors
pg_column_compression, Database Object Management Functions
pg_column_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_config, pg_config, pg_config
with + ecpg, Processing Embedded SQL Programs
with libpq, Building libpq Programs
with user-defined C functions, Writing Code
pg_conf_load_time, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_constraint, pg_constraint
pg_controldata, pg_controldata
pg_control_checkpoint, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_control_init, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_control_recovery, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_control_system, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_conversion, pg_conversion
pg_conversion_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_copy_logical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_copy_physical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_create_logical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_create_physical_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_create_restore_point, Backup Control Functions
pg_ctl, Creating a Database Cluster, Starting the Database Server, pg_ctl
pg_current_logfile, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_wal_flush_lsn, Backup Control Functions
pg_current_wal_insert_lsn, Backup Control Functions
pg_current_wal_lsn, Backup Control Functions
pg_current_xact_id, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_current_xact_id_if_assigned, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_cursors, pg_cursors
pg_database, Template Databases, pg_database
pg_database_collation_actual_version, Database Object Management Functions
pg_database_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_db_role_setting, pg_db_role_setting
pg_ddl_command, Pseudo-Types
pg_default_acl, pg_default_acl
pg_depend, pg_depend
pg_describe_object, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_description, pg_description
pg_drop_replication_slot, Replication Management Functions
pg_dump, pg_dump
pg_dumpall, pg_dumpall
use during upgrade, Upgrading Data via pg_dumpall
pg_encoding_to_char, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_enum, pg_enum
pg_event_trigger, pg_event_trigger
pg_event_trigger_ddl_commands, Capturing Changes at Command End
pg_event_trigger_dropped_objects, Processing Objects Dropped by a DDL Command
pg_event_trigger_table_rewrite_oid, Handling a Table Rewrite Event
pg_event_trigger_table_rewrite_reason, Handling a Table Rewrite Event
pg_export_snapshot, Snapshot Synchronization Functions
pg_extension, pg_extension
pg_extension_config_dump, Extension Configuration Tables
pg_filenode_relation, Database Object Management Functions
pg_file_rename, adminpack
pg_file_settings, pg_file_settings
pg_file_sync, adminpack
pg_file_unlink, adminpack
pg_file_write, adminpack
pg_foreign_data_wrapper, pg_foreign_data_wrapper
pg_foreign_server, pg_foreign_server
pg_foreign_table, pg_foreign_table
pg_freespace, Functions
pg_freespacemap, pg_freespacemap
pg_function_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_catalog_foreign_keys, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_constraintdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_expr, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_functiondef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_function_arguments, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_function_identity_arguments, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_function_result, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_indexdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_keywords, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_object_address, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_ruledef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_serial_sequence, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_statisticsobjdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_triggerdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_userbyid, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_viewdef, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_get_wal_replay_pause_state, Recovery Control Functions
pg_get_wal_resource_managers, Recovery Control Functions
pg_group, pg_group
pg_has_role, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_hba.conf, The pg_hba.conf File
pg_hba_file_rules, pg_hba_file_rules
pg_ident.conf, User Name Maps
pg_identify_object, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_identify_object_as_address, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ident_file_mappings, pg_ident_file_mappings
pg_import_system_collations, Database Object Management Functions
pg_index, pg_index
pg_indexam_has_property, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_indexes, pg_indexes
pg_indexes_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_index_column_has_property, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_index_has_property, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_inherits, pg_inherits
pg_init_privs, pg_init_privs
pg_isready, pg_isready
pg_is_in_recovery, Recovery Control Functions
pg_is_other_temp_schema, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_is_wal_replay_paused, Recovery Control Functions
pg_jit_available, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_language, pg_language
pg_largeobject, pg_largeobject
pg_largeobject_metadata, pg_largeobject_metadata
pg_last_committed_xact, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_last_wal_receive_lsn, Recovery Control Functions
pg_last_wal_replay_lsn, Recovery Control Functions
pg_last_xact_replay_timestamp, Recovery Control Functions
pg_listening_channels, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_locks, pg_locks
pg_logdir_ls, adminpack
pg_logical_emit_message, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_get_binary_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_get_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_peek_binary_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_logical_slot_peek_changes, Replication Management Functions
pg_log_backend_memory_contexts, Server Signaling Functions
pg_lsn, pg_lsn Type
pg_ls_archive_statusdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_dir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_logdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_logicalmapdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_logicalsnapdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_replslotdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_tmpdir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_ls_waldir, Generic File Access Functions
pg_matviews, pg_matviews
pg_mcv_list_items, Inspecting MCV Lists
pg_my_temp_schema, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_namespace, pg_namespace
pg_notification_queue_usage, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_notify, pg_notify
pg_opclass, pg_opclass
pg_opclass_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_operator, pg_operator
pg_operator_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_opfamily, pg_opfamily
pg_opfamily_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_options_to_table, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_parameter_acl, pg_parameter_acl
pg_partitioned_table, pg_partitioned_table
pg_partition_ancestors, Database Object Management Functions
pg_partition_root, Database Object Management Functions
pg_partition_tree, Database Object Management Functions
pg_policies, pg_policies
pg_policy, pg_policy
pg_postmaster_start_time, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_prepared_statements, pg_prepared_statements
pg_prepared_xacts, pg_prepared_xacts
pg_prewarm, pg_prewarm
pg_prewarm.autoprewarm configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_prewarm.autoprewarm_interval configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_proc, pg_proc
pg_promote, Recovery Control Functions
pg_publication, pg_publication
pg_publication_namespace, pg_publication_namespace
pg_publication_rel, pg_publication_rel
pg_publication_tables, pg_publication_tables
pg_range, pg_range
pg_read_binary_file, Generic File Access Functions
pg_read_file, Generic File Access Functions
pg_receivewal, pg_receivewal
pg_receivexlog, pg_receivexlog renamed to pg_receivewal (see pg_receivewal)
pg_recvlogical, pg_recvlogical
pg_relation_filenode, Database Object Management Functions
pg_relation_filepath, Database Object Management Functions
pg_relation_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_reload_conf, Server Signaling Functions
pg_relpages, Functions
pg_replication_origin, pg_replication_origin
pg_replication_origin_advance, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_create, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_drop, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_oid, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_progress, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_is_setup, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_progress, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_reset, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_session_setup, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_status, pg_replication_origin_status
pg_replication_origin_xact_reset, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_origin_xact_setup, Replication Management Functions
pg_replication_slots, pg_replication_slots
pg_replication_slot_advance, Replication Management Functions
pg_resetwal, pg_resetwal
pg_resetxlog, pg_resetxlog renamed to pg_resetwal (see pg_resetwal)
pg_restore, pg_restore
pg_rewind, pg_rewind
pg_rewrite, pg_rewrite
pg_roles, pg_roles
pg_rotate_logfile, Server Signaling Functions
pg_rules, pg_rules
pg_safe_snapshot_blocking_pids, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_seclabel, pg_seclabel
pg_seclabels, pg_seclabels
pg_sequence, pg_sequence
pg_sequences, pg_sequences
pg_service.conf, The Connection Service File
pg_settings, pg_settings
pg_settings_get_flags, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_shadow, pg_shadow
pg_shdepend, pg_shdepend
pg_shdescription, pg_shdescription
pg_shmem_allocations, pg_shmem_allocations
pg_shseclabel, pg_shseclabel
pg_size_bytes, Database Object Management Functions
pg_size_pretty, Database Object Management Functions
pg_sleep, Delaying Execution
pg_sleep_for, Delaying Execution
pg_sleep_until, Delaying Execution
pg_snapshot_xip, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_snapshot_xmax, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_snapshot_xmin, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_statio_all_indexes, Viewing Statistics, pg_statio_all_indexes
pg_statio_all_sequences, Viewing Statistics, pg_statio_all_sequences
pg_statio_all_tables, Viewing Statistics, pg_statio_all_tables
pg_statio_sys_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_sys_sequences, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_sys_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_user_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_user_sequences, Viewing Statistics
pg_statio_user_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_statistic, Single-Column Statistics, pg_statistic
pg_statistics_obj_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_statistic_ext, Extended Statistics, pg_statistic_ext
pg_statistic_ext_data, Extended Statistics, pg_statistic_ext
pg_stats, Single-Column Statistics, pg_stats
pg_stats_ext, pg_stats_ext
pg_stats_ext_exprs, pg_stats_ext_exprs
pg_stat_activity, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_activity
pg_stat_all_indexes, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_all_indexes
pg_stat_all_tables, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_all_tables
pg_stat_archiver, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_archiver
pg_stat_bgwriter, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_bgwriter
pg_stat_clear_snapshot, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_database, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_database
pg_stat_database_conflicts, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_database_conflicts
pg_stat_file, Generic File Access Functions
pg_stat_get_activity, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_activity, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_activity_start, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_client_addr, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_client_port, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_dbid, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_idset, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_pid, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_start, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_userid, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_wait_event, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_wait_event_type, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_backend_xact_start, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_snapshot_timestamp, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_xact_blocks_fetched, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_get_xact_blocks_hit, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_gssapi, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_gssapi
pg_stat_progress_analyze, Viewing Statistics, ANALYZE Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_basebackup, Viewing Statistics, Base Backup Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_cluster, Viewing Statistics, CLUSTER Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_copy, Viewing Statistics, COPY Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_create_index, Viewing Statistics, CREATE INDEX Progress Reporting
pg_stat_progress_vacuum, Viewing Statistics, VACUUM Progress Reporting
pg_stat_recovery_prefetch, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_recovery_prefetch
pg_stat_replication, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_replication
pg_stat_replication_slots, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_replication_slots
pg_stat_reset, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_replication_slot, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_shared, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_single_function_counters, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_single_table_counters, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_slru, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_reset_subscription_stats, Statistics Functions
pg_stat_slru, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_slru
pg_stat_ssl, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_ssl
pg_stat_statements, pg_stat_statements
function, Functions
pg_stat_statements.max configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.save configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.track configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.track_planning configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements.track_utility configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
pg_stat_statements_info, The pg_stat_statements_info View
pg_stat_statements_reset, Functions
pg_stat_subscription, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_subscription
pg_stat_subscription_stats, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_subscription_stats
pg_stat_sys_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_sys_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_user_functions, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_user_functions
pg_stat_user_indexes, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_user_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_wal, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_wal
pg_stat_wal_receiver, Viewing Statistics, pg_stat_wal_receiver
pg_stat_xact_all_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_xact_sys_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_xact_user_functions, Viewing Statistics
pg_stat_xact_user_tables, Viewing Statistics
pg_subscription, pg_subscription
pg_subscription_rel, pg_subscription_rel
pg_surgery, pg_surgery
pg_switch_wal, Backup Control Functions
pg_tables, pg_tables
pg_tablespace, pg_tablespace
pg_tablespace_databases, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_tablespace_location, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_tablespace_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_table_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_table_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_temp, Statement Behavior
securing functions, Writing SECURITY DEFINER Functions Safely
pg_terminate_backend, Server Signaling Functions
pg_test_fsync, pg_test_fsync
pg_test_timing, pg_test_timing
pg_timezone_abbrevs, pg_timezone_abbrevs
pg_timezone_names, pg_timezone_names
pg_total_relation_size, Database Object Management Functions
pg_transform, pg_transform
pg_trgm, pg_trgm
pg_trgm.similarity_threshold configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
pg_trgm.strict_word_similarity_threshold configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
pg_trgm.word_similarity_threshold configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
pg_trigger, pg_trigger
pg_trigger_depth, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_try_advisory_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_try_advisory_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_try_advisory_xact_lock, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_try_advisory_xact_lock_shared, Advisory Lock Functions
pg_ts_config, pg_ts_config
pg_ts_config_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ts_config_map, pg_ts_config_map
pg_ts_dict, pg_ts_dict
pg_ts_dict_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ts_parser, pg_ts_parser
pg_ts_parser_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_ts_template, pg_ts_template
pg_ts_template_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_type, pg_type
pg_typeof, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_type_is_visible, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_upgrade, pg_upgrade
pg_user, pg_user
pg_user_mapping, pg_user_mapping
pg_user_mappings, pg_user_mappings
pg_verifybackup, pg_verifybackup
pg_views, pg_views
pg_visibility, pg_visibility
pg_visible_in_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_waldump, pg_waldump
pg_walfile_name, Backup Control Functions
pg_walfile_name_offset, Backup Control Functions
pg_walinspect, pg_walinspect
pg_wal_lsn_diff, Backup Control Functions
pg_wal_replay_pause, Recovery Control Functions
pg_wal_replay_resume, Recovery Control Functions
pg_xact_commit_timestamp, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_xact_commit_timestamp_origin, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_xact_status, System Information Functions and Operators
pg_xlogdump, pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump (see pg_waldump)
phantom read, Transaction Isolation
phraseto_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Queries
pi, Mathematical Functions and Operators
PIC, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
PID
determining PID of server process
in libpq, Connection Status Functions
pipelining, Pipeline Mode, Pipelining
in libpq, Pipeline Mode
protocol specification, Pipelining
PITR, Backup and Restore
PITR standby, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
pkg-config, PostgreSQL Features
with ecpg, Processing Embedded SQL Programs
with - libpq, Building libpq Programs
PL/Perl, PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
PL/PerlU, Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
PL/pgSQL, PL/pgSQL — SQL Procedural Language
PL/Python, PL/Python — Python Procedural Language
PL/SQL (Oracle), Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
porting to PL/pgSQL, Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
PL/Tcl, PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
plainto_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Queries
plan_cache_mode configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
plperl.on_init configuration parameter, Configuration
plperl.on_plperlu_init configuration parameter, Configuration
plperl.on_plperl_init configuration parameter, Configuration
plperl.use_strict configuration parameter, Configuration
plpgsql.check_asserts configuration parameter, Checking Assertions
plpgsql.variable_conflict configuration parameter, Variable Substitution
pltcl.start_proc configuration parameter, PL/Tcl Configuration
pltclu.start_proc configuration parameter, PL/Tcl Configuration
point, Points, Geometric Functions and Operators
point-in-time recovery, Backup and Restore
policy, Row Security Policies
polygon, Polygons, Geometric Functions and Operators
polymorphic function, Polymorphic Types
polymorphic type, Polymorphic Types
popcount (see bit_count)
popen, Geometric Functions and Operators
populate_record, hstore Operators and Functions
port, Parameter Key Words
port configuration parameter, Connection Settings
position, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
POSITION_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
POSTGRES, The Berkeley POSTGRES Project
postgres, Architectural Fundamentals, Starting the Database Server, Creating a Database, postgres
postgres user, The PostgreSQL User Account
Postgres95, Postgres95
postgresql.auto.conf, Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File
postgresql.conf, Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File
postgres_fdw, postgres_fdw
postgres_fdw.application_name configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
postmaster, postmaster
post_auth_delay configuration parameter, Developer Options
power, Mathematical Functions and Operators
PQbackendPID, Connection Status Functions
PQbinaryTuples, Retrieving Query Result Information
with COPY, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
PQcancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQclear, Main Functions
PQclientEncoding, Control Functions
PQcmdStatus, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQcmdTuples, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQconndefaults, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectdb, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectdbParams, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectionNeedsPassword, Connection Status Functions
PQconnectionUsedPassword, Connection Status Functions
PQconnectPoll, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectStart, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectStartParams, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconninfo, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconninfoFree, Miscellaneous Functions
PQconninfoParse, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconsumeInput, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQcopyResult, Miscellaneous Functions
PQdb, Connection Status Functions
PQdescribePortal, Main Functions
PQdescribePrepared, Main Functions
PQencryptPassword, Miscellaneous Functions
PQencryptPasswordConn, Miscellaneous Functions
PQendcopy, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQenterPipelineMode, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQerrorMessage, Connection Status Functions
PQescapeBytea, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeByteaConn, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeIdentifier, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeLiteral, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeString, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeStringConn, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQexec, Main Functions
PQexecParams, Main Functions
PQexecPrepared, Main Functions
PQexitPipelineMode, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQfformat, Retrieving Query Result Information
with COPY, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
PQfinish, Database Connection Control Functions
PQfireResultCreateEvents, Miscellaneous Functions
PQflush, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQfmod, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQfn, The Fast-Path Interface
PQfname, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQfnumber, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQfreeCancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQfreemem, Miscellaneous Functions
PQfsize, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQftable, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQftablecol, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQftype, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQgetCancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQgetCopyData, Functions for Receiving COPY Data
PQgetisnull, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQgetlength, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQgetline, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQgetlineAsync, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQgetResult, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQgetssl, Connection Status Functions
PQgetSSLKeyPassHook_OpenSSL, Database Connection Control Functions
PQgetvalue, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQhost, Connection Status Functions
PQhostaddr, Connection Status Functions
PQinitOpenSSL, SSL Library Initialization
PQinitSSL, SSL Library Initialization
PQinstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQisBusy, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQisnonblocking, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQisthreadsafe, Behavior in Threaded Programs
PQlibVersion, Miscellaneous Functions
(see also PQserverVersion)
PQmakeEmptyPGresult, Miscellaneous Functions
PQnfields, Retrieving Query Result Information
with COPY, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
PQnotifies, Asynchronous Notification
PQnparams, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQntuples, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQoidStatus, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQoidValue, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQoptions, Connection Status Functions
PQparameterStatus, Connection Status Functions
PQparamtype, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQpass, Connection Status Functions
PQping, Database Connection Control Functions
PQpingParams, Database Connection Control Functions
PQpipelineStatus, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQpipelineSync, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQport, Connection Status Functions
PQprepare, Main Functions
PQprint, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQprotocolVersion, Connection Status Functions
PQputCopyData, Functions for Sending COPY Data
PQputCopyEnd, Functions for Sending COPY Data
PQputline, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQputnbytes, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQregisterEventProc, Event Support Functions
PQrequestCancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQreset, Database Connection Control Functions
PQresetPoll, Database Connection Control Functions
PQresetStart, Database Connection Control Functions
PQresStatus, Main Functions
PQresultAlloc, Miscellaneous Functions
PQresultErrorField, Main Functions
PQresultErrorMessage, Main Functions
PQresultInstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQresultMemorySize, Miscellaneous Functions
PQresultSetInstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQresultStatus, Main Functions
PQresultVerboseErrorMessage, Main Functions
PQsendDescribePortal, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendDescribePrepared, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendFlushRequest, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQsendPrepare, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendQuery, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendQueryParams, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendQueryPrepared, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQserverVersion, Connection Status Functions
PQsetClientEncoding, Control Functions
PQsetdb, Database Connection Control Functions
PQsetdbLogin, Database Connection Control Functions
PQsetErrorContextVisibility, Control Functions
PQsetErrorVerbosity, Control Functions
PQsetInstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQsetnonblocking, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsetNoticeProcessor, Notice Processing
PQsetNoticeReceiver, Notice Processing
PQsetResultAttrs, Miscellaneous Functions
PQsetSingleRowMode, Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
PQsetSSLKeyPassHook_OpenSSL, Database Connection Control Functions
PQsetTraceFlags, Control Functions
PQsetvalue, Miscellaneous Functions
PQsocket, Connection Status Functions
PQsslAttribute, Connection Status Functions
PQsslAttributeNames, Connection Status Functions
PQsslInUse, Connection Status Functions
PQsslStruct, Connection Status Functions
PQstatus, Connection Status Functions
PQtrace, Control Functions
PQtransactionStatus, Connection Status Functions
PQtty, Connection Status Functions
PQunescapeBytea, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQuntrace, Control Functions
PQuser, Connection Status Functions
predicate locking, Serializable Isolation Level
PREPARE, PREPARE
PREPARE TRANSACTION, PREPARE TRANSACTION
prepared statements, DEALLOCATE, EXECUTE, EXPLAIN, PREPARE
creating, PREPARE
executing, EXECUTE
removing, DEALLOCATE
showing the query plan, EXPLAIN
preparing a query
in PL/pgSQL, Plan Caching
in PL/Python, Database Access Functions
in PL/Tcl, Database Access from PL/Tcl
pre_auth_delay configuration parameter, Developer Options
primary key, Primary Keys
primary_conninfo configuration parameter, Standby Servers
primary_slot_name configuration parameter, Standby Servers
privilege, Privileges, Schemas and Privileges, Rules and Privileges, Rules and Privileges
querying, System Information Functions and Operators
with rules, Rules and Privileges
for schemas, Schemas and Privileges
with views, Rules and Privileges
procedural language, Procedural Languages, Writing a Procedural Language Handler
externally maintained, Procedural Languages
handler for, Writing a Procedural Language Handler
procedure, User-Defined Procedures
user-defined, User-Defined Procedures
procedures
output parameter, SQL Procedures with Output Parameters
promote_trigger_file configuration parameter, Standby Servers
protocol, Frontend/Backend Protocol
frontend-backend, Frontend/Backend Protocol
ps, Standard Unix Tools
to monitor activity, Standard Unix Tools
psql, Accessing a Database, psql
Python, PL/Python — Python Procedural Language

R

radians, Mathematical Functions and Operators
radius, Geometric Functions and Operators
RADIUS, RADIUS Authentication
RAISE
in PL/pgSQL, Reporting Errors and Messages
random, Mathematical Functions and Operators
random_page_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
range table, The Query Tree
range type, Range Types
exclude, Constraints on Ranges
indexes on, Indexing
range_agg, Aggregate Functions
range_intersect_agg, Aggregate Functions
range_merge, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
rank, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
read committed, Read Committed Isolation Level
read-only transaction, Statement Behavior
setting, SET TRANSACTION
setting default, Statement Behavior
readline, Requirements
Readline
in psql, Command-Line Editing
READ_REPLICATION_SLOT, Streaming Replication Protocol
real, Floating-Point Types
REASSIGN OWNED, REASSIGN OWNED
record, Pseudo-Types
recovery.conf, recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf
recovery.signal, Archive Recovery
recovery_end_command configuration parameter, Archive Recovery
recovery_init_sync_method configuration parameter, Error Handling
recovery_min_apply_delay configuration parameter, Standby Servers
recovery_prefetch configuration parameter, Recovery
recovery_target configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_action configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_inclusive configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_lsn configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_name configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_time configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_timeline configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_xid configuration parameter, Recovery Target
rectangle, Boxes
RECURSIVE, CREATE VIEW
in common table expressions, Recursive Queries
in views, CREATE VIEW
recursive_worktable_factor configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
referential integrity, Foreign Keys, Foreign Keys
REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW, REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW
regclass, Object Identifier Types
regcollation, Object Identifier Types
regconfig, Object Identifier Types
regdictionary, Object Identifier Types
regexp_count, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_instr, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_like, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_match, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_matches, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_replace, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_split_to_array, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_split_to_table, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_substr, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regnamespace, Object Identifier Types
regoper, Object Identifier Types
regoperator, Object Identifier Types
regproc, Object Identifier Types
regprocedure, Object Identifier Types
regression intercept, Aggregate Functions
regression slope, Aggregate Functions
regression test, Installation Procedure
regression tests, Regression Tests
regrole, Object Identifier Types
regr_avgx, Aggregate Functions
regr_avgy, Aggregate Functions
regr_count, Aggregate Functions
regr_intercept, Aggregate Functions
regr_r2, Aggregate Functions
regr_slope, Aggregate Functions
regr_sxx, Aggregate Functions
regr_sxy, Aggregate Functions
regr_syy, Aggregate Functions
regtype, Object Identifier Types
regular expression, SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions, POSIX Regular Expressions
(see also pattern matching)
regular expressions
and locales, Behavior
reindex, Routine Reindexing
REINDEX, REINDEX
reindexdb, reindexdb
relation, Concepts
relational database, Concepts
RELEASE SAVEPOINT, RELEASE SAVEPOINT
remove_temp_files_after_crash configuration parameter, Developer Options
repeat, String Functions and Operators
repeatable read, Repeatable Read Isolation Level
replace, String Functions and Operators
replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
Replication Origins, Replication Progress Tracking
Replication Progress Tracking, Replication Progress Tracking
replication slot
logical replication, Replication Slots
streaming replication, Replication Slots
reporting errors
in PL/pgSQL, Reporting Errors and Messages
RESET, RESET
restartpoint, WAL Configuration
restart_after_crash configuration parameter, Error Handling
restore_command configuration parameter, Archive Recovery
RESTRICT, Dependency Tracking
with DROP, Dependency Tracking
foreign key action, Foreign Keys
retryable error, Serialization Failure Handling
RETURN NEXT
in PL/pgSQL, RETURN NEXT and RETURN QUERY
RETURN QUERY
in PL/pgSQL, RETURN NEXT and RETURN QUERY
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
RETURNING INTO, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result
in PL/pgSQL, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result
reverse, String Functions and Operators
REVOKE, Privileges, REVOKE
right, String Functions and Operators
right join, Joined Tables
role, Database Roles, Role Membership, Predefined Roles
applicable, applicable_roles
enabled, enabled_roles
membership in, Role Membership
privilege to bypass, Role Attributes
privilege to create, Role Attributes
privilege to inherit, Role Attributes
privilege to initiate replication, Role Attributes
privilege to limit connection, Role Attributes
ROLLBACK, ROLLBACK
rollback
psql, Variables
ROLLBACK PREPARED, ROLLBACK PREPARED
ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT, ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT
ROLLUP, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
round, Mathematical Functions and Operators
routine, User-Defined Procedures
routine maintenance, Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
row, Concepts, Table Basics
ROW, Row Constructors
row estimation, Row Estimation Examples
multivariate, Multivariate Statistics Examples
planner, Row Estimation Examples
row type, Composite Types
constructor, Row Constructors
row-level security, Row Security Policies
row-wise comparison, Row and Array Comparisons
row_number, Window Functions
row_security configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
row_security_active, System Information Functions and Operators
row_to_json, Processing and Creating JSON Data
rpad, String Functions and Operators
rtrim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
rule, The Rule System, Views and the Rule System, How SELECT Rules Work, Materialized Views, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE, Rules Versus Triggers
and materialized views, Materialized Views
and views, Views and the Rule System
for DELETE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE
for INSERT, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE
for SELECT, How SELECT Rules Work
compared with triggers, Rules Versus Triggers
for UPDATE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE

S

SAVEPOINT, SAVEPOINT
savepoints, RELEASE SAVEPOINT, ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT, SAVEPOINT
defining, SAVEPOINT
releasing, RELEASE SAVEPOINT
rolling back, ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT
scalar (see expression)
scale, Mathematical Functions and Operators
schema, Schemas, Creating a Schema, The Public Schema, Overview
creating, Creating a Schema
current, The Schema Search Path, System Information Functions and Operators
public, The Public Schema
removing, Creating a Schema
SCRAM, Password Authentication
search path, The Schema Search Path
current, System Information Functions and Operators
object visibility, System Information Functions and Operators
search_path configuration parameter, The Schema Search Path, Statement Behavior
use in securing functions, Writing SECURITY DEFINER Functions Safely
SECURITY LABEL, SECURITY LABEL
sec_to_gc, Cube-Based Earth Distances
seg, seg
segment_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
SELECT, Querying a Table, Queries, SELECT Output Columns, SELECT
determination of result type, SELECT Output Columns
select list, Select Lists
SELECT INTO, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result, SELECT INTO
in PL/pgSQL, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result
semaphores, Shared Memory and Semaphores
sepgsql, sepgsql
sepgsql.debug_audit configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
sepgsql.permissive configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
sequence, Sequence Manipulation Functions
and serial type, Serial Types
sequential scan, Planner Method Configuration
seq_page_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
serial, Serial Types
serial2, Serial Types
serial4, Serial Types
serial8, Serial Types
serializable, Serializable Isolation Level
Serializable Snapshot Isolation, Introduction
serialization anomaly, Transaction Isolation, Serializable Isolation Level
serialization failure, Serialization Failure Handling
server log, Error Reporting and Logging, Log File Maintenance
log file maintenance, Log File Maintenance
Server Name Indication, Parameter Key Words
server spoofing, Preventing Server Spoofing
server_encoding configuration parameter, Preset Options
server_version configuration parameter, Preset Options
server_version_num configuration parameter, Preset Options
session_preload_libraries configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
session_replication_role configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
session_user, System Information Functions and Operators
SET, Configuration Settings Functions, SET
SET CONSTRAINTS, SET CONSTRAINTS
set difference, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
set intersection, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
set operation, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
set returning functions, Set Returning Functions
functions, Set Returning Functions
SET ROLE, SET ROLE
SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION, SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION
SET TRANSACTION, SET TRANSACTION
set union, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
SET XML OPTION, Statement Behavior
setseed, Mathematical Functions and Operators
setval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
setweight, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Documents
setweight for specific lexeme(s), Text Search Functions and Operators
set_bit, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
set_byte, Binary String Functions and Operators
set_config, Configuration Settings Functions
set_limit, Functions and Operators
set_masklen, Network Address Functions and Operators
sha224, Binary String Functions and Operators
sha256, Binary String Functions and Operators
sha384, Binary String Functions and Operators
sha512, Binary String Functions and Operators
shared library, Shared Libraries, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
shared memory, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared_buffers configuration parameter, Memory
shared_memory_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
shared_memory_size_in_huge_pages configuration parameter, Preset Options
shared_memory_type configuration parameter, Memory
shared_preload_libraries, Shared Memory and LWLocks
shared_preload_libraries configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
shobj_description, System Information Functions and Operators
SHOW, Configuration Settings Functions, SHOW, Streaming Replication Protocol
show_limit, Functions and Operators
show_trgm, Functions and Operators
shutdown, Shutting Down the Server
SIGHUP, Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File, The pg_hba.conf File, User Name Maps
SIGINT, Shutting Down the Server
sign, Mathematical Functions and Operators
signal
backend processes, Server Signaling Functions
significant digits, Locale and Formatting
SIGQUIT, Shutting Down the Server
SIGTERM, Shutting Down the Server
SIMILAR TO, SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions
similarity, Functions and Operators
sin, Mathematical Functions and Operators
sind, Mathematical Functions and Operators
single-user mode, Options for Single-User Mode
sinh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
skeys, hstore Operators and Functions
sleep, Delaying Execution
slice, hstore Operators and Functions
sliced bread (see TOAST)
slope, Geometric Functions and Operators
SLRU, pg_stat_slru
smallint, Integer Types
smallserial, Serial Types
Solaris, Solaris
installation on, Solaris
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
SOME, Aggregate Functions, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
sort, intarray Functions and Operators
sorting, Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)
sort_asc, intarray Functions and Operators
sort_desc, intarray Functions and Operators
soundex, Soundex
SP-GiST (see index)
SPI, Server Programming Interface, spi
examples, spi
spi_commit
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_commit, SPI_commit
SPI_commit_and_chain, SPI_commit
SPI_connect, SPI_connect
SPI_connect_ext, SPI_connect
SPI_copytuple, SPI_copytuple
spi_cursor_close
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_cursor_close, SPI_cursor_close
SPI_cursor_fetch, SPI_cursor_fetch
SPI_cursor_find, SPI_cursor_find
SPI_cursor_move, SPI_cursor_move
SPI_cursor_open, SPI_cursor_open
SPI_cursor_open_with_args, SPI_cursor_open_with_args
SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist, SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist
SPI_cursor_parse_open, SPI_cursor_parse_open
SPI_exec, SPI_exec
SPI_execp, SPI_execp
SPI_execute, SPI_execute
SPI_execute_extended, SPI_execute_extended
SPI_execute_plan, SPI_execute_plan
SPI_execute_plan_extended, SPI_execute_plan_extended
SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist, SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist
SPI_execute_with_args, SPI_execute_with_args
spi_exec_prepared
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
spi_exec_query
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
spi_fetchrow
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_finish, SPI_finish
SPI_fname, SPI_fname
SPI_fnumber, SPI_fnumber
spi_freeplan
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_freeplan, SPI_freeplan
SPI_freetuple, SPI_freetuple
SPI_freetuptable, SPI_freetuptable
SPI_getargcount, SPI_getargcount
SPI_getargtypeid, SPI_getargtypeid
SPI_getbinval, SPI_getbinval
SPI_getnspname, SPI_getnspname
SPI_getrelname, SPI_getrelname
SPI_gettype, SPI_gettype
SPI_gettypeid, SPI_gettypeid
SPI_getvalue, SPI_getvalue
SPI_is_cursor_plan, SPI_is_cursor_plan
SPI_keepplan, SPI_keepplan
SPI_modifytuple, SPI_modifytuple
SPI_palloc, SPI_palloc
SPI_pfree, SPI_pfree
spi_prepare
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_prepare, SPI_prepare
SPI_prepare_cursor, SPI_prepare_cursor
SPI_prepare_extended, SPI_prepare_extended
SPI_prepare_params, SPI_prepare_params
spi_query
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
spi_query_prepared
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_register_relation, SPI_register_relation
SPI_register_trigger_data, SPI_register_trigger_data
SPI_repalloc, SPI_repalloc
SPI_result_code_string, SPI_result_code_string
SPI_returntuple, SPI_returntuple
spi_rollback
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_rollback, SPI_rollback
SPI_rollback_and_chain, SPI_rollback
SPI_saveplan, SPI_saveplan
SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch, SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch
SPI_scroll_cursor_move, SPI_scroll_cursor_move
SPI_start_transaction, SPI_start_transaction
SPI_unregister_relation, SPI_unregister_relation
split_part, String Functions and Operators
SQL/CLI, SQL Conformance
SQL/Foundation, SQL Conformance
SQL/Framework, SQL Conformance
SQL/JRT, SQL Conformance
SQL/JSON path language, The SQL/JSON Path Language
SQL/MDA, SQL Conformance
SQL/MED, SQL Conformance
SQL/OLB, SQL Conformance
SQL/PSM, SQL Conformance
SQL/Schemata, SQL Conformance
SQL/XML, SQL Conformance
limits and conformance, XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML
sqrt, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ssh, Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels
SSI, Introduction
SSL, Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL, SSL Support
in libpq, Connection Status Functions
with libpq, Parameter Key Words
TLS, Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL, SSL Support
ssl configuration parameter, SSL
sslinfo, sslinfo
ssl_ca_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_cert_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_cipher, Functions Provided
ssl_ciphers configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_client_cert_present, Functions Provided
ssl_client_dn, Functions Provided
ssl_client_dn_field, Functions Provided
ssl_client_serial, Functions Provided
ssl_crl_dir configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_crl_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_dh_params_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_ecdh_curve configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_extension_info, Functions Provided
ssl_issuer_dn, Functions Provided
ssl_issuer_field, Functions Provided
ssl_is_used, Functions Provided
ssl_key_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_library configuration parameter, Preset Options
ssl_max_protocol_version configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_min_protocol_version configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_passphrase_command configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_passphrase_command_supports_reload configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_prefer_server_ciphers configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_version, Functions Provided
SSPI, SSPI Authentication
STABLE, Function Volatility Categories
standard deviation, Aggregate Functions
population, Aggregate Functions
sample, Aggregate Functions
standard_conforming_strings configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
standby server, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
standby.signal, Archive Recovery, Standby Server Operation, Setting Up a Standby Server
for hot standby, Administrator's Overview
pg_basebackup --write-recovery-conf, Options
standby_mode (see standby.signal)
START TRANSACTION, START TRANSACTION
starts_with, String Functions and Operators
START_REPLICATION, Streaming Replication Protocol
statement_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
statement_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
statistics, Aggregate Functions, Statistics Used by the Planner, Extended Statistics, Updating Planner Statistics, The Cumulative Statistics System
of the planner, Statistics Used by the Planner, Extended Statistics, Updating Planner Statistics
stats_fetch_consistency configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
stddev, Aggregate Functions
stddev_pop, Aggregate Functions
stddev_samp, Aggregate Functions
STONITH, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
storage parameters, Storage Parameters
Streaming Replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
strict_word_similarity, Functions and Operators
string (see character string)
strings
backslash quotes, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
escape warning, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
standard conforming, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
string_agg, Aggregate Functions
string_to_array, String Functions and Operators
string_to_table, String Functions and Operators
strip, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Documents
strpos, String Functions and Operators
subarray, intarray Functions and Operators
subltree, Operators and Functions
subpath, Operators and Functions
subquery, Aggregate Functions, Scalar Subqueries, Subqueries, Subquery Expressions
subscript, Subscripts
substr, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
substring, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators, SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions, POSIX Regular Expressions
SUBSTRING_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
subtransactions
in PL/Tcl, Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl
sum, Aggregate Functions
superuser, Accessing a Database, Role Attributes
superuser_reserved_connections configuration parameter, Connection Settings
support functions
in_range, B-Tree Support Functions
suppress_redundant_updates_trigger, Trigger Functions
svals, hstore Operators and Functions
synchronize_seqscans configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
synchronous commit, Asynchronous Commit
Synchronous Replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
synchronous_commit configuration parameter, Settings
synchronous_standby_names configuration parameter, Primary Server
syntax, SQL Syntax
SQL, SQL Syntax
syslog_facility configuration parameter, Where to Log
syslog_ident configuration parameter, Where to Log
syslog_sequence_numbers configuration parameter, Where to Log
syslog_split_messages configuration parameter, Where to Log
system catalog, The System Catalog Schema
schema, The System Catalog Schema
systemd, PostgreSQL Features, Starting the Database Server
RemoveIPC, systemd RemoveIPC

T

table, Concepts, Table Basics, Modifying Tables
creating, Table Basics
inheritance, Inheritance
modifying, Modifying Tables
partitioning, Table Partitioning
removing, Table Basics
renaming, Renaming a Table
Table Access Method, Table Access Method Interface Definition
TABLE command, SELECT
table expression, Table Expressions
table function, Table Functions, xmltable
XMLTABLE, xmltable
table sampling method, Writing a Table Sampling Method
tableam
Table Access Method, Table Access Method Interface Definition
tablefunc, tablefunc
tableoid, System Columns
TABLESAMPLE method, Writing a Table Sampling Method
tablespace, Tablespaces
default, Statement Behavior
temporary, Statement Behavior
table_am_handler, Pseudo-Types
tan, Mathematical Functions and Operators
tand, Mathematical Functions and Operators
tanh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
target list, The Query Tree
Tcl, PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
tcn, tcn
tcp_keepalives_count configuration parameter, Connection Settings
tcp_keepalives_idle configuration parameter, Connection Settings
tcp_keepalives_interval configuration parameter, Connection Settings
tcp_user_timeout configuration parameter, Connection Settings
template0, Creating a Database, Template Databases
template1, Creating a Database, Template Databases
temp_buffers configuration parameter, Memory
temp_file_limit configuration parameter, Disk
temp_tablespaces configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
test, Regression Tests
test_decoding, test_decoding
text, Character Types, Network Address Functions and Operators
text search, Text Search Types, Text Search Types, Full Text Search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
data types, Text Search Types
functions and operators, Text Search Types
indexes, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
text2ltree, Operators and Functions
threads, Behavior in Threaded Programs
with libpq, Behavior in Threaded Programs
tid, Object Identifier Types
time, Date/Time Types, Times
constants, Special Values
current, Current Date/Time
output format, Date/Time Output
(see also formatting)
time span, Date/Time Types
time with time zone, Date/Time Types, Times
time without time zone, Date/Time Types, Times
time zone, Time Zones, Locale and Formatting, POSIX Time Zone Specifications
conversion, AT TIME ZONE
input abbreviations, Date/Time Configuration Files
POSIX-style specification, POSIX Time Zone Specifications
time zone data, Build Process Details
time zone names, Locale and Formatting
timelines, Backup and Restore
TIMELINE_HISTORY, Streaming Replication Protocol
timeofday, Date/Time Functions and Operators
timeout
client authentication, Authentication
deadlock, Lock Management
timestamp, Date/Time Types, Time Stamps
timestamp with time zone, Date/Time Types, Time Stamps
timestamp without time zone, Date/Time Types, Time Stamps
timestamptz, Date/Time Types
TimeZone configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
timezone_abbreviations configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
TOAST, TOAST
and user-defined types, TOAST Considerations
per-column storage settings, Description
per-type storage settings, Description
versus large objects, Introduction
toast_tuple_target storage parameter, Storage Parameters
token, Lexical Structure
to_ascii, String Functions and Operators
to_char, Data Type Formatting Functions
and locales, Behavior
to_date, Data Type Formatting Functions
to_hex, String Functions and Operators
to_json, Processing and Creating JSON Data
to_jsonb, Processing and Creating JSON Data
to_number, Data Type Formatting Functions
to_regclass, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regcollation, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regnamespace, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regoper, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regoperator, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regproc, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regprocedure, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regrole, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regtype, System Information Functions and Operators
to_timestamp, Data Type Formatting Functions, Date/Time Functions and Operators
to_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Queries
to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Documents
trace_locks configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_lock_oidmin configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_lock_table configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_lwlocks configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_notify configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_recovery_messages configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_sort configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_userlocks configuration parameter, Developer Options
track_activities configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_activity_query_size configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_commit_timestamp configuration parameter, Sending Servers
track_counts configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_functions configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_io_timing configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_wal_io_timing configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
transaction, Transactions
transaction ID, Preventing Transaction ID Wraparound Failures
wraparound, Preventing Transaction ID Wraparound Failures
transaction isolation, Transaction Isolation
transaction isolation level, Transaction Isolation, Statement Behavior
read committed, Read Committed Isolation Level
repeatable read, Repeatable Read Isolation Level
serializable, Serializable Isolation Level
setting, SET TRANSACTION
setting default, Statement Behavior
transaction log (see WAL)
transaction_deferrable configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
transaction_isolation configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
transaction_read_only configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
transaction_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
transform_null_equals configuration parameter, Platform and Client Compatibility
transition tables, CREATE TRIGGER
(see also ephemeral named relation)
implementation in PLs, SPI_register_trigger_data
referencing from C trigger, Writing Trigger Functions in C
translate, String Functions and Operators
TRANSLATE_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
transparent - huge pages, Memory
trigger, Pseudo-Types, Triggers, Writing Trigger Functions in C, Rules Versus Triggers, Trigger Functions, Trigger Functions
arguments for trigger functions, Overview of Trigger Behavior
constraint trigger, Description
for updating a derived tsvector column, Triggers for Automatic Updates
in C, Writing Trigger Functions in C
in PL/pgSQL, Trigger Functions
in PL/Python, Trigger Functions
in PL/Tcl, Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
compared with rules, Rules Versus Triggers
triggered_change_notification, tcn
trigger_file (see promote_trigger_file)
trim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
trim_array, Array Functions and Operators
trim_scale, Mathematical Functions and Operators
true, Boolean Type
trunc, Mathematical Functions and Operators, Network Address Functions and Operators
TRUNCATE, TRUNCATE
trusted, Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
PL/Perl, Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
tsm_handler, Pseudo-Types
tsm_system_rows, tsm_system_rows
tsm_system_time, tsm_system_time
tsquery (data type), tsquery
tsquery_phrase, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Queries
tsvector (data type), tsvector
tsvector concatenation, Manipulating Documents
tsvector_to_array, Text Search Functions and Operators
tsvector_update_trigger, Trigger Functions
tsvector_update_trigger_column, Trigger Functions
ts_debug, Text Search Functions and Operators, Configuration Testing
ts_delete, Text Search Functions and Operators
ts_filter, Text Search Functions and Operators
ts_headline, Text Search Functions and Operators, Highlighting Results
ts_lexize, Text Search Functions and Operators, Dictionary Testing
ts_parse, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parser Testing
ts_rank, Text Search Functions and Operators, Ranking Search Results
ts_rank_cd, Text Search Functions and Operators, Ranking Search Results
ts_rewrite, Text Search Functions and Operators, Query Rewriting
ts_stat, Text Search Functions and Operators, Gathering Document Statistics
ts_token_type, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parser Testing
tuple_data_split, Heap Functions
txid_current, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_current_if_assigned, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_current_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_snapshot_xip, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_snapshot_xmax, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_snapshot_xmin, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_status, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_visible_in_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
type (see data type)
type cast, Numeric Constants, Type Casts

U

UESCAPE, Identifiers and Key Words, String Constants with Unicode Escapes
unaccent, unaccent, Functions
Unicode escape, String Constants with Unicode Escapes
in identifiers, Identifiers and Key Words
in string constants, String Constants with Unicode Escapes
Unicode normalization, String Functions and Operators
UNION, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT), UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
uniq, intarray Functions and Operators
unique constraint, Unique Constraints
unistr, String Functions and Operators
Unix domain socket, Parameter Key Words
unix_socket_directories configuration parameter, Connection Settings
unix_socket_group configuration parameter, Connection Settings
unix_socket_permissions configuration parameter, Connection Settings
unknown, Pseudo-Types
UNLISTEN, UNLISTEN
unnest, Array Functions and Operators
for multirange, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
for tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
unqualified name, The Schema Search Path
updatable views, Updatable Views
UPDATE, Updates, Updating Data, Returning Data from Modified Rows, UPDATE
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
update_process_title configuration parameter, Process Title
updating, Updating Data
upgrading, Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
upper, String Functions and Operators, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
and locales, Behavior
upper_inc, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
upper_inf, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
UPSERT, INSERT
URI, Connection Strings
user, System Information Functions and Operators, Database Roles
current, System Information Functions and Operators
user mapping, Foreign Data
User name maps, User Name Maps
user_catalog_table storage parameter, Storage Parameters
UUID, UUID Type, UUID Type, PostgreSQL Features
generating, UUID Type
uuid-ossp, uuid-ossp
uuid_generate_v1, uuid-ossp Functions
uuid_generate_v1mc, uuid-ossp Functions
uuid_generate_v3, uuid-ossp Functions

V

vacuum, Routine Vacuuming
VACUUM, VACUUM
vacuumdb, vacuumdb
vacuumlo, vacuumlo
vacuum_cost_delay configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_limit configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_page_dirty configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_page_hit configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_page_miss configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_defer_cleanup_age configuration parameter, Primary Server
vacuum_failsafe_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_freeze_min_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_freeze_table_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_index_cleanup storage parameter, Storage Parameters
vacuum_multixact_failsafe_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_multixact_freeze_min_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_multixact_freeze_table_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_truncate storage parameter, Storage Parameters
value expression, Value Expressions
VALUES, VALUES Lists, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs, VALUES
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
varchar, Character Types
variadic function, SQL Functions with Variable Numbers of Arguments
variance, Aggregate Functions
population, Aggregate Functions
sample, Aggregate Functions
var_pop, Aggregate Functions
var_samp, Aggregate Functions
version, Accessing a Database, System Information Functions and Operators, Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
compatibility, Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
view, Views, Views and the Rule System, Materialized Views, Cooperation with Views
implementation through rules, Views and the Rule System
materialized, Materialized Views
updating, Cooperation with Views
Visibility Map, Visibility Map
VM (see Visibility Map)
void, Pseudo-Types
VOLATILE, Function Volatility Categories
volatility, Function Volatility Categories
functions, Function Volatility Categories
VPATH, Installation Procedure, Extension Building Infrastructure

W

WAL, Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log
wal_block_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
wal_buffers configuration parameter, Settings
wal_compression configuration parameter, Settings
wal_consistency_checking configuration parameter, Developer Options
wal_debug configuration parameter, Developer Options
wal_decode_buffer_size configuration parameter, Recovery
wal_init_zero configuration parameter, Settings
wal_keep_size configuration parameter, Sending Servers
wal_level configuration parameter, Settings
wal_log_hints configuration parameter, Settings
wal_receiver_create_temp_slot configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_receiver_status_interval configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_receiver_timeout configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_recycle configuration parameter, Settings
wal_retrieve_retry_interval configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_segment_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
wal_sender_timeout configuration parameter, Sending Servers
wal_skip_threshold configuration parameter, Settings
wal_sync_method configuration parameter, Settings
wal_writer_delay configuration parameter, Settings
wal_writer_flush_after configuration parameter, Settings
warm standby, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
websearch_to_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators
WHERE, The WHERE Clause
where to log, Where to Log
WHILE
in PL/pgSQL, WHILE
width, Geometric Functions and Operators
width_bucket, Mathematical Functions and Operators
window function, Window Functions, Window Function Calls, Window Function Processing, Window Functions
built-in, Window Functions
invocation, Window Function Calls
order of execution, Window Function Processing
WITH, WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions), SELECT
in SELECT, WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions), SELECT
WITH CHECK OPTION, CREATE VIEW
WITHIN GROUP, Aggregate Expressions
witness server, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
word_similarity, Functions and Operators
work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
wraparound
of multixact IDs, Multixacts and Wraparound
of transaction IDs, Preventing Transaction ID Wraparound Failures

X

xid, Object Identifier Types
xid8, Object Identifier Types
xmax, System Columns
xmin, System Columns
XML, XML Type
XML export, Mapping Tables to XML
XML Functions, XML Functions
XML option, Creating XML Values, Statement Behavior
xml2, xml2
xmlagg, xmlagg, Aggregate Functions
xmlbinary configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
xmlcomment, xmlcomment
xmlconcat, xmlconcat
xmlelement, xmlelement
XMLEXISTS, XMLEXISTS
xmlforest, xmlforest
xmloption configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
xmlparse, Creating XML Values
xmlpi, xmlpi
xmlroot, xmlroot
xmlserialize, Creating XML Values
xmltable, xmltable
xml_is_well_formed, xml_is_well_formed
xml_is_well_formed_content, xml_is_well_formed
xml_is_well_formed_document, xml_is_well_formed
XPath, xpath
xpath_exists, xpath_exists
xpath_table, xpath_table
XQuery regular expressions, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
xslt_process, xslt_process

Z

zero_damaged_pages configuration parameter, Developer Options
zlib, Requirements, Anti-Features
\ No newline at end of file + libpq, Building libpq Programs
PL/Perl, PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
PL/PerlU, Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
PL/pgSQL, PL/pgSQL — SQL Procedural Language
PL/Python, PL/Python — Python Procedural Language
PL/SQL (Oracle), Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
porting to PL/pgSQL, Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
PL/Tcl, PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
plainto_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Queries
plan_cache_mode configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
plperl.on_init configuration parameter, Configuration
plperl.on_plperlu_init configuration parameter, Configuration
plperl.on_plperl_init configuration parameter, Configuration
plperl.use_strict configuration parameter, Configuration
plpgsql.check_asserts configuration parameter, Checking Assertions
plpgsql.variable_conflict configuration parameter, Variable Substitution
pltcl.start_proc configuration parameter, PL/Tcl Configuration
pltclu.start_proc configuration parameter, PL/Tcl Configuration
point, Points, Geometric Functions and Operators
point-in-time recovery, Backup and Restore
policy, Row Security Policies
polygon, Polygons, Geometric Functions and Operators
polymorphic function, Polymorphic Types
polymorphic type, Polymorphic Types
popcount (see bit_count)
popen, Geometric Functions and Operators
populate_record, hstore Operators and Functions
port, Parameter Key Words
port configuration parameter, Connection Settings
position, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
POSITION_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
POSTGRES, The Berkeley POSTGRES Project
postgres, Architectural Fundamentals, Starting the Database Server, Creating a Database, postgres
postgres user, The PostgreSQL User Account
Postgres95, Postgres95
postgresql.auto.conf, Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File
postgresql.conf, Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File
postgres_fdw, postgres_fdw
postgres_fdw.application_name configuration parameter, Configuration Parameters
postmaster, postmaster
post_auth_delay configuration parameter, Developer Options
power, Mathematical Functions and Operators
PQbackendPID, Connection Status Functions
PQbinaryTuples, Retrieving Query Result Information
with COPY, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
PQcancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQclear, Main Functions
PQclientEncoding, Control Functions
PQcmdStatus, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQcmdTuples, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQconndefaults, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectdb, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectdbParams, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectionNeedsPassword, Connection Status Functions
PQconnectionUsedPassword, Connection Status Functions
PQconnectPoll, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectStart, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconnectStartParams, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconninfo, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconninfoFree, Miscellaneous Functions
PQconninfoParse, Database Connection Control Functions
PQconsumeInput, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQcopyResult, Miscellaneous Functions
PQdb, Connection Status Functions
PQdescribePortal, Main Functions
PQdescribePrepared, Main Functions
PQencryptPassword, Miscellaneous Functions
PQencryptPasswordConn, Miscellaneous Functions
PQendcopy, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQenterPipelineMode, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQerrorMessage, Connection Status Functions
PQescapeBytea, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeByteaConn, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeIdentifier, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeLiteral, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeString, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQescapeStringConn, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQexec, Main Functions
PQexecParams, Main Functions
PQexecPrepared, Main Functions
PQexitPipelineMode, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQfformat, Retrieving Query Result Information
with COPY, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
PQfinish, Database Connection Control Functions
PQfireResultCreateEvents, Miscellaneous Functions
PQflush, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQfmod, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQfn, The Fast-Path Interface
PQfname, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQfnumber, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQfreeCancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQfreemem, Miscellaneous Functions
PQfsize, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQftable, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQftablecol, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQftype, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQgetCancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQgetCopyData, Functions for Receiving COPY Data
PQgetisnull, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQgetlength, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQgetline, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQgetlineAsync, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQgetResult, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQgetssl, Connection Status Functions
PQgetSSLKeyPassHook_OpenSSL, Database Connection Control Functions
PQgetvalue, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQhost, Connection Status Functions
PQhostaddr, Connection Status Functions
PQinitOpenSSL, SSL Library Initialization
PQinitSSL, SSL Library Initialization
PQinstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQisBusy, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQisnonblocking, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQisthreadsafe, Behavior in Threaded Programs
PQlibVersion, Miscellaneous Functions
(see also PQserverVersion)
PQmakeEmptyPGresult, Miscellaneous Functions
PQnfields, Retrieving Query Result Information
with COPY, Functions Associated with the COPY Command
PQnotifies, Asynchronous Notification
PQnparams, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQntuples, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQoidStatus, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQoidValue, Retrieving Other Result Information
PQoptions, Connection Status Functions
PQparameterStatus, Connection Status Functions
PQparamtype, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQpass, Connection Status Functions
PQping, Database Connection Control Functions
PQpingParams, Database Connection Control Functions
PQpipelineStatus, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQpipelineSync, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQport, Connection Status Functions
PQprepare, Main Functions
PQprint, Retrieving Query Result Information
PQprotocolVersion, Connection Status Functions
PQputCopyData, Functions for Sending COPY Data
PQputCopyEnd, Functions for Sending COPY Data
PQputline, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQputnbytes, Obsolete Functions for COPY
PQregisterEventProc, Event Support Functions
PQrequestCancel, Canceling Queries in Progress
PQreset, Database Connection Control Functions
PQresetPoll, Database Connection Control Functions
PQresetStart, Database Connection Control Functions
PQresStatus, Main Functions
PQresultAlloc, Miscellaneous Functions
PQresultErrorField, Main Functions
PQresultErrorMessage, Main Functions
PQresultInstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQresultMemorySize, Miscellaneous Functions
PQresultSetInstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQresultStatus, Main Functions
PQresultVerboseErrorMessage, Main Functions
PQsendDescribePortal, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendDescribePrepared, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendFlushRequest, Functions Associated with Pipeline Mode
PQsendPrepare, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendQuery, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendQueryParams, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsendQueryPrepared, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQserverVersion, Connection Status Functions
PQsetClientEncoding, Control Functions
PQsetdb, Database Connection Control Functions
PQsetdbLogin, Database Connection Control Functions
PQsetErrorContextVisibility, Control Functions
PQsetErrorVerbosity, Control Functions
PQsetInstanceData, Event Support Functions
PQsetnonblocking, Asynchronous Command Processing
PQsetNoticeProcessor, Notice Processing
PQsetNoticeReceiver, Notice Processing
PQsetResultAttrs, Miscellaneous Functions
PQsetSingleRowMode, Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
PQsetSSLKeyPassHook_OpenSSL, Database Connection Control Functions
PQsetTraceFlags, Control Functions
PQsetvalue, Miscellaneous Functions
PQsocket, Connection Status Functions
PQsslAttribute, Connection Status Functions
PQsslAttributeNames, Connection Status Functions
PQsslInUse, Connection Status Functions
PQsslStruct, Connection Status Functions
PQstatus, Connection Status Functions
PQtrace, Control Functions
PQtransactionStatus, Connection Status Functions
PQtty, Connection Status Functions
PQunescapeBytea, Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands
PQuntrace, Control Functions
PQuser, Connection Status Functions
predicate locking, Serializable Isolation Level
PREPARE, PREPARE
PREPARE TRANSACTION, PREPARE TRANSACTION
prepared statements, DEALLOCATE, EXECUTE, EXPLAIN, PREPARE
creating, PREPARE
executing, EXECUTE
removing, DEALLOCATE
showing the query plan, EXPLAIN
preparing a query
in PL/pgSQL, Plan Caching
in PL/Python, Database Access Functions
in PL/Tcl, Database Access from PL/Tcl
pre_auth_delay configuration parameter, Developer Options
primary key, Primary Keys
primary_conninfo configuration parameter, Standby Servers
primary_slot_name configuration parameter, Standby Servers
privilege, Privileges, Schemas and Privileges, Rules and Privileges, Rules and Privileges
querying, System Information Functions and Operators
with rules, Rules and Privileges
for schemas, Schemas and Privileges
with views, Rules and Privileges
procedural language, Procedural Languages, Writing a Procedural Language Handler
externally maintained, Procedural Languages
handler for, Writing a Procedural Language Handler
procedure, User-Defined Procedures
user-defined, User-Defined Procedures
procedures
output parameter, SQL Procedures with Output Parameters
promote_trigger_file configuration parameter, Standby Servers
protocol, Frontend/Backend Protocol
frontend-backend, Frontend/Backend Protocol
ps, Standard Unix Tools
to monitor activity, Standard Unix Tools
psql, Accessing a Database, psql
Python, PL/Python — Python Procedural Language

R

radians, Mathematical Functions and Operators
radius, Geometric Functions and Operators
RADIUS, RADIUS Authentication
RAISE
in PL/pgSQL, Reporting Errors and Messages
random, Mathematical Functions and Operators
random_page_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
range table, The Query Tree
range type, Range Types
exclude, Constraints on Ranges
indexes on, Indexing
range_agg, Aggregate Functions
range_intersect_agg, Aggregate Functions
range_merge, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
rank, Window Functions
hypothetical, Aggregate Functions
read committed, Read Committed Isolation Level
read-only transaction, Statement Behavior
setting, SET TRANSACTION
setting default, Statement Behavior
readline, Requirements
Readline
in psql, Command-Line Editing
READ_REPLICATION_SLOT, Streaming Replication Protocol
real, Floating-Point Types
REASSIGN OWNED, REASSIGN OWNED
record, Pseudo-Types
recovery.conf, recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf
recovery.signal, Archive Recovery
recovery_end_command configuration parameter, Archive Recovery
recovery_init_sync_method configuration parameter, Error Handling
recovery_min_apply_delay configuration parameter, Standby Servers
recovery_prefetch configuration parameter, Recovery
recovery_target configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_action configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_inclusive configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_lsn configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_name configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_time configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_timeline configuration parameter, Recovery Target
recovery_target_xid configuration parameter, Recovery Target
rectangle, Boxes
RECURSIVE, CREATE VIEW
in common table expressions, Recursive Queries
in views, CREATE VIEW
recursive_worktable_factor configuration parameter, Other Planner Options
referential integrity, Foreign Keys, Foreign Keys
REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW, REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW
regclass, Object Identifier Types
regcollation, Object Identifier Types
regconfig, Object Identifier Types
regdictionary, Object Identifier Types
regexp_count, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_instr, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_like, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_match, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_matches, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_replace, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_split_to_array, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_split_to_table, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regexp_substr, String Functions and Operators, POSIX Regular Expressions
regnamespace, Object Identifier Types
regoper, Object Identifier Types
regoperator, Object Identifier Types
regproc, Object Identifier Types
regprocedure, Object Identifier Types
regression intercept, Aggregate Functions
regression slope, Aggregate Functions
regression test, Installation Procedure
regression tests, Regression Tests
regrole, Object Identifier Types
regr_avgx, Aggregate Functions
regr_avgy, Aggregate Functions
regr_count, Aggregate Functions
regr_intercept, Aggregate Functions
regr_r2, Aggregate Functions
regr_slope, Aggregate Functions
regr_sxx, Aggregate Functions
regr_sxy, Aggregate Functions
regr_syy, Aggregate Functions
regtype, Object Identifier Types
regular expression, SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions, POSIX Regular Expressions
(see also pattern matching)
regular expressions
and locales, Behavior
reindex, Routine Reindexing
REINDEX, REINDEX
reindexdb, reindexdb
relation, Concepts
relational database, Concepts
RELEASE SAVEPOINT, RELEASE SAVEPOINT
remove_temp_files_after_crash configuration parameter, Developer Options
repeat, String Functions and Operators
repeatable read, Repeatable Read Isolation Level
replace, String Functions and Operators
replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
Replication Origins, Replication Progress Tracking
Replication Progress Tracking, Replication Progress Tracking
replication slot
logical replication, Replication Slots
streaming replication, Replication Slots
reporting errors
in PL/pgSQL, Reporting Errors and Messages
RESET, RESET
restartpoint, WAL Configuration
restart_after_crash configuration parameter, Error Handling
restore_command configuration parameter, Archive Recovery
RESTRICT, Dependency Tracking
with DROP, Dependency Tracking
foreign key action, Foreign Keys
retryable error, Serialization Failure Handling
RETURN NEXT
in PL/pgSQL, RETURN NEXT and RETURN QUERY
RETURN QUERY
in PL/pgSQL, RETURN NEXT and RETURN QUERY
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
RETURNING INTO, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result
in PL/pgSQL, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result
reverse, String Functions and Operators
REVOKE, Privileges, REVOKE
right, String Functions and Operators
right join, Joined Tables
role, Database Roles, Role Membership, Predefined Roles
applicable, applicable_roles
enabled, enabled_roles
membership in, Role Membership
privilege to bypass, Role Attributes
privilege to create, Role Attributes
privilege to inherit, Role Attributes
privilege to initiate replication, Role Attributes
privilege to limit connection, Role Attributes
ROLLBACK, ROLLBACK
rollback
psql, Variables
ROLLBACK PREPARED, ROLLBACK PREPARED
ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT, ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT
ROLLUP, GROUPING SETS, CUBE, and ROLLUP
round, Mathematical Functions and Operators
routine, User-Defined Procedures
routine maintenance, Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
row, Concepts, Table Basics
ROW, Row Constructors
row estimation, Row Estimation Examples
multivariate, Multivariate Statistics Examples
planner, Row Estimation Examples
row type, Composite Types
constructor, Row Constructors
row-level security, Row Security Policies
row-wise comparison, Row and Array Comparisons
row_number, Window Functions
row_security configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
row_security_active, System Information Functions and Operators
row_to_json, Processing and Creating JSON Data
rpad, String Functions and Operators
rtrim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
rule, The Rule System, Views and the Rule System, How SELECT Rules Work, Materialized Views, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE, Rules Versus Triggers
and materialized views, Materialized Views
and views, Views and the Rule System
for DELETE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE
for INSERT, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE
for SELECT, How SELECT Rules Work
compared with triggers, Rules Versus Triggers
for UPDATE, Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE

S

SAVEPOINT, SAVEPOINT
savepoints, RELEASE SAVEPOINT, ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT, SAVEPOINT
defining, SAVEPOINT
releasing, RELEASE SAVEPOINT
rolling back, ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT
scalar (see expression)
scale, Mathematical Functions and Operators
schema, Schemas, Creating a Schema, The Public Schema, Overview
creating, Creating a Schema
current, The Schema Search Path, System Information Functions and Operators
public, The Public Schema
removing, Creating a Schema
SCRAM, Password Authentication
search path, The Schema Search Path
current, System Information Functions and Operators
object visibility, System Information Functions and Operators
search_path configuration parameter, The Schema Search Path, Statement Behavior
use in securing functions, Writing SECURITY DEFINER Functions Safely
SECURITY LABEL, SECURITY LABEL
sec_to_gc, Cube-Based Earth Distances
seg, seg
segment_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
SELECT, Querying a Table, Queries, SELECT Output Columns, SELECT
determination of result type, SELECT Output Columns
select list, Select Lists
SELECT INTO, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result, SELECT INTO
in PL/pgSQL, Executing a Command with a Single-Row Result
semaphores, Shared Memory and Semaphores
sepgsql, sepgsql
sepgsql.debug_audit configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
sepgsql.permissive configuration parameter, GUC Parameters
sequence, Sequence Manipulation Functions
and serial type, Serial Types
sequential scan, Planner Method Configuration
seq_page_cost configuration parameter, Planner Cost Constants
serial, Serial Types
serial2, Serial Types
serial4, Serial Types
serial8, Serial Types
serializable, Serializable Isolation Level
Serializable Snapshot Isolation, Introduction
serialization anomaly, Transaction Isolation, Serializable Isolation Level
serialization failure, Serialization Failure Handling
server log, Error Reporting and Logging, Log File Maintenance
log file maintenance, Log File Maintenance
Server Name Indication, Parameter Key Words
server spoofing, Preventing Server Spoofing
server_encoding configuration parameter, Preset Options
server_version configuration parameter, Preset Options
server_version_num configuration parameter, Preset Options
session_preload_libraries configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
session_replication_role configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
session_user, System Information Functions and Operators
SET, Configuration Settings Functions, SET
SET CONSTRAINTS, SET CONSTRAINTS
set difference, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
set intersection, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
set operation, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
set returning functions, Set Returning Functions
functions, Set Returning Functions
SET ROLE, SET ROLE
SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION, SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION
SET TRANSACTION, SET TRANSACTION
set union, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
SET XML OPTION, Statement Behavior
setseed, Mathematical Functions and Operators
setval, Sequence Manipulation Functions
setweight, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Documents
setweight for specific lexeme(s), Text Search Functions and Operators
set_bit, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators
set_byte, Binary String Functions and Operators
set_config, Configuration Settings Functions
set_limit, Functions and Operators
set_masklen, Network Address Functions and Operators
sha224, Binary String Functions and Operators
sha256, Binary String Functions and Operators
sha384, Binary String Functions and Operators
sha512, Binary String Functions and Operators
shared library, Shared Libraries, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
shared memory, Shared Memory and Semaphores
shared_buffers configuration parameter, Memory
shared_memory_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
shared_memory_size_in_huge_pages configuration parameter, Preset Options
shared_memory_type configuration parameter, Memory
shared_preload_libraries, Shared Memory and LWLocks
shared_preload_libraries configuration parameter, Shared Library Preloading
shobj_description, System Information Functions and Operators
SHOW, Configuration Settings Functions, SHOW, Streaming Replication Protocol
show_limit, Functions and Operators
show_trgm, Functions and Operators
shutdown, Shutting Down the Server
SIGHUP, Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File, The pg_hba.conf File, User Name Maps
SIGINT, Shutting Down the Server
sign, Mathematical Functions and Operators
signal
backend processes, Server Signaling Functions
significant digits, Locale and Formatting
SIGQUIT, Shutting Down the Server
SIGTERM, Shutting Down the Server
SIMILAR TO, SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions
similarity, Functions and Operators
sin, Mathematical Functions and Operators
sind, Mathematical Functions and Operators
single-user mode, Options for Single-User Mode
sinh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
skeys, hstore Operators and Functions
sleep, Delaying Execution
slice, hstore Operators and Functions
sliced bread (see TOAST)
slope, Geometric Functions and Operators
SLRU, pg_stat_slru
smallint, Integer Types
smallserial, Serial Types
Solaris, Solaris
installation on, Solaris
shared library, Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
start script, Starting the Database Server
SOME, Aggregate Functions, Subquery Expressions, Row and Array Comparisons
sort, intarray Functions and Operators
sorting, Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)
sort_asc, intarray Functions and Operators
sort_desc, intarray Functions and Operators
soundex, Soundex
SP-GiST (see index)
SPI, Server Programming Interface, spi
examples, spi
spi_commit
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_commit, SPI_commit
SPI_commit_and_chain, SPI_commit
SPI_connect, SPI_connect
SPI_connect_ext, SPI_connect
SPI_copytuple, SPI_copytuple
spi_cursor_close
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_cursor_close, SPI_cursor_close
SPI_cursor_fetch, SPI_cursor_fetch
SPI_cursor_find, SPI_cursor_find
SPI_cursor_move, SPI_cursor_move
SPI_cursor_open, SPI_cursor_open
SPI_cursor_open_with_args, SPI_cursor_open_with_args
SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist, SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist
SPI_cursor_parse_open, SPI_cursor_parse_open
SPI_exec, SPI_exec
SPI_execp, SPI_execp
SPI_execute, SPI_execute
SPI_execute_extended, SPI_execute_extended
SPI_execute_plan, SPI_execute_plan
SPI_execute_plan_extended, SPI_execute_plan_extended
SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist, SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist
SPI_execute_with_args, SPI_execute_with_args
spi_exec_prepared
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
spi_exec_query
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
spi_fetchrow
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_finish, SPI_finish
SPI_fname, SPI_fname
SPI_fnumber, SPI_fnumber
spi_freeplan
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_freeplan, SPI_freeplan
SPI_freetuple, SPI_freetuple
SPI_freetuptable, SPI_freetuptable
SPI_getargcount, SPI_getargcount
SPI_getargtypeid, SPI_getargtypeid
SPI_getbinval, SPI_getbinval
SPI_getnspname, SPI_getnspname
SPI_getrelname, SPI_getrelname
SPI_gettype, SPI_gettype
SPI_gettypeid, SPI_gettypeid
SPI_getvalue, SPI_getvalue
SPI_is_cursor_plan, SPI_is_cursor_plan
SPI_keepplan, SPI_keepplan
SPI_modifytuple, SPI_modifytuple
SPI_palloc, SPI_palloc
SPI_pfree, SPI_pfree
spi_prepare
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_prepare, SPI_prepare
SPI_prepare_cursor, SPI_prepare_cursor
SPI_prepare_extended, SPI_prepare_extended
SPI_prepare_params, SPI_prepare_params
spi_query
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
spi_query_prepared
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_register_relation, SPI_register_relation
SPI_register_trigger_data, SPI_register_trigger_data
SPI_repalloc, SPI_repalloc
SPI_result_code_string, SPI_result_code_string
SPI_returntuple, SPI_returntuple
spi_rollback
in PL/Perl, Database Access from PL/Perl
SPI_rollback, SPI_rollback
SPI_rollback_and_chain, SPI_rollback
SPI_saveplan, SPI_saveplan
SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch, SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch
SPI_scroll_cursor_move, SPI_scroll_cursor_move
SPI_start_transaction, SPI_start_transaction
SPI_unregister_relation, SPI_unregister_relation
split_part, String Functions and Operators
SQL/CLI, SQL Conformance
SQL/Foundation, SQL Conformance
SQL/Framework, SQL Conformance
SQL/JRT, SQL Conformance
SQL/JSON path language, The SQL/JSON Path Language
SQL/MDA, SQL Conformance
SQL/MED, SQL Conformance
SQL/OLB, SQL Conformance
SQL/PSM, SQL Conformance
SQL/Schemata, SQL Conformance
SQL/XML, SQL Conformance
limits and conformance, XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML
sqrt, Mathematical Functions and Operators
ssh, Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels
SSI, Introduction
SSL, Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL, SSL Support
in libpq, Connection Status Functions
with libpq, Parameter Key Words
TLS, Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL, SSL Support
ssl configuration parameter, SSL
sslinfo, sslinfo
ssl_ca_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_cert_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_cipher, Functions Provided
ssl_ciphers configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_client_cert_present, Functions Provided
ssl_client_dn, Functions Provided
ssl_client_dn_field, Functions Provided
ssl_client_serial, Functions Provided
ssl_crl_dir configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_crl_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_dh_params_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_ecdh_curve configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_extension_info, Functions Provided
ssl_issuer_dn, Functions Provided
ssl_issuer_field, Functions Provided
ssl_is_used, Functions Provided
ssl_key_file configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_library configuration parameter, Preset Options
ssl_max_protocol_version configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_min_protocol_version configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_passphrase_command configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_passphrase_command_supports_reload configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_prefer_server_ciphers configuration parameter, SSL
ssl_version, Functions Provided
SSPI, SSPI Authentication
STABLE, Function Volatility Categories
standard deviation, Aggregate Functions
population, Aggregate Functions
sample, Aggregate Functions
standard_conforming_strings configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
standby server, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
standby.signal, Archive Recovery, Standby Server Operation, Setting Up a Standby Server
for hot standby, Administrator's Overview
pg_basebackup --write-recovery-conf, Options
standby_mode (see standby.signal)
START TRANSACTION, START TRANSACTION
starts_with, String Functions and Operators
START_REPLICATION, Streaming Replication Protocol
statement_timeout configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
statement_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
statistics, Aggregate Functions, Statistics Used by the Planner, Extended Statistics, Updating Planner Statistics, The Cumulative Statistics System
of the planner, Statistics Used by the Planner, Extended Statistics, Updating Planner Statistics
stats_fetch_consistency configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
stddev, Aggregate Functions
stddev_pop, Aggregate Functions
stddev_samp, Aggregate Functions
STONITH, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
storage parameters, Storage Parameters
Streaming Replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
strict_word_similarity, Functions and Operators
string (see character string)
strings
backslash quotes, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
escape warning, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
standard conforming, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
string_agg, Aggregate Functions
string_to_array, String Functions and Operators
string_to_table, String Functions and Operators
strip, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Documents
strpos, String Functions and Operators
subarray, intarray Functions and Operators
subltree, Operators and Functions
subpath, Operators and Functions
subquery, Aggregate Functions, Scalar Subqueries, Subqueries, Subquery Expressions
subscript, Subscripts
substr, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
substring, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators, Bit String Functions and Operators, SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions, POSIX Regular Expressions
SUBSTRING_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
subtransactions
in PL/Tcl, Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl
sum, Aggregate Functions
superuser, Accessing a Database, Role Attributes
superuser_reserved_connections configuration parameter, Connection Settings
support functions
in_range, B-Tree Support Functions
suppress_redundant_updates_trigger, Trigger Functions
svals, hstore Operators and Functions
synchronize_seqscans configuration parameter, Previous PostgreSQL Versions
synchronous commit, Asynchronous Commit
Synchronous Replication, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
synchronous_commit configuration parameter, Settings
synchronous_standby_names configuration parameter, Primary Server
syntax, SQL Syntax
SQL, SQL Syntax
syslog_facility configuration parameter, Where to Log
syslog_ident configuration parameter, Where to Log
syslog_sequence_numbers configuration parameter, Where to Log
syslog_split_messages configuration parameter, Where to Log
system catalog, The System Catalog Schema
schema, The System Catalog Schema
systemd, PostgreSQL Features, Starting the Database Server
RemoveIPC, systemd RemoveIPC

T

table, Concepts, Table Basics, Modifying Tables
creating, Table Basics
inheritance, Inheritance
modifying, Modifying Tables
partitioning, Table Partitioning
removing, Table Basics
renaming, Renaming a Table
Table Access Method, Table Access Method Interface Definition
TABLE command, SELECT
table expression, Table Expressions
table function, Table Functions, xmltable
XMLTABLE, xmltable
table sampling method, Writing a Table Sampling Method
tableam
Table Access Method, Table Access Method Interface Definition
tablefunc, tablefunc
tableoid, System Columns
TABLESAMPLE method, Writing a Table Sampling Method
tablespace, Tablespaces
default, Statement Behavior
temporary, Statement Behavior
table_am_handler, Pseudo-Types
tan, Mathematical Functions and Operators
tand, Mathematical Functions and Operators
tanh, Mathematical Functions and Operators
target list, The Query Tree
Tcl, PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
tcn, tcn
tcp_keepalives_count configuration parameter, Connection Settings
tcp_keepalives_idle configuration parameter, Connection Settings
tcp_keepalives_interval configuration parameter, Connection Settings
tcp_user_timeout configuration parameter, Connection Settings
template0, Creating a Database, Template Databases
template1, Creating a Database, Template Databases
temp_buffers configuration parameter, Memory
temp_file_limit configuration parameter, Disk
temp_tablespaces configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
test, Regression Tests
test_decoding, test_decoding
text, Character Types, Network Address Functions and Operators
text search, Text Search Types, Text Search Types, Full Text Search, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
data types, Text Search Types
functions and operators, Text Search Types
indexes, Preferred Index Types for Text Search
text2ltree, Operators and Functions
threads, Behavior in Threaded Programs
with libpq, Behavior in Threaded Programs
tid, Object Identifier Types
time, Date/Time Types, Times
constants, Special Values
current, Current Date/Time
output format, Date/Time Output
(see also formatting)
time span, Date/Time Types
time with time zone, Date/Time Types, Times
time without time zone, Date/Time Types, Times
time zone, Time Zones, Locale and Formatting, POSIX Time Zone Specifications
conversion, AT TIME ZONE
input abbreviations, Date/Time Configuration Files
POSIX-style specification, POSIX Time Zone Specifications
time zone data, Build Process Details
time zone names, Locale and Formatting
timelines, Backup and Restore
TIMELINE_HISTORY, Streaming Replication Protocol
timeofday, Date/Time Functions and Operators
timeout
client authentication, Authentication
deadlock, Lock Management
timestamp, Date/Time Types, Time Stamps
timestamp with time zone, Date/Time Types, Time Stamps
timestamp without time zone, Date/Time Types, Time Stamps
timestamptz, Date/Time Types
TimeZone configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
timezone_abbreviations configuration parameter, Locale and Formatting
TOAST, TOAST
and user-defined types, TOAST Considerations
per-column storage settings, Description
per-type storage settings, Description
versus large objects, Introduction
toast_tuple_target storage parameter, Storage Parameters
token, Lexical Structure
to_ascii, String Functions and Operators
to_char, Data Type Formatting Functions
and locales, Behavior
to_date, Data Type Formatting Functions
to_hex, String Functions and Operators
to_json, Processing and Creating JSON Data
to_jsonb, Processing and Creating JSON Data
to_number, Data Type Formatting Functions
to_regclass, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regcollation, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regnamespace, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regoper, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regoperator, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regproc, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regprocedure, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regrole, System Information Functions and Operators
to_regtype, System Information Functions and Operators
to_timestamp, Data Type Formatting Functions, Date/Time Functions and Operators
to_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Queries
to_tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parsing Documents
trace_locks configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_lock_oidmin configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_lock_table configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_lwlocks configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_notify configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_recovery_messages configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_sort configuration parameter, Developer Options
trace_userlocks configuration parameter, Developer Options
track_activities configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_activity_query_size configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_commit_timestamp configuration parameter, Sending Servers
track_counts configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_functions configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_io_timing configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
track_wal_io_timing configuration parameter, Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
transaction, Transactions
transaction ID, Preventing Transaction ID Wraparound Failures
wraparound, Preventing Transaction ID Wraparound Failures
transaction isolation, Transaction Isolation
transaction isolation level, Transaction Isolation, Statement Behavior
read committed, Read Committed Isolation Level
repeatable read, Repeatable Read Isolation Level
serializable, Serializable Isolation Level
setting, SET TRANSACTION
setting default, Statement Behavior
transaction log (see WAL)
transaction_deferrable configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
transaction_isolation configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
transaction_read_only configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
transaction_timestamp, Date/Time Functions and Operators
transform_null_equals configuration parameter, Platform and Client Compatibility
transition tables, CREATE TRIGGER
(see also ephemeral named relation)
implementation in PLs, SPI_register_trigger_data
referencing from C trigger, Writing Trigger Functions in C
translate, String Functions and Operators
TRANSLATE_REGEX, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
transparent + huge pages, Memory
trigger, Pseudo-Types, Triggers, Writing Trigger Functions in C, Rules Versus Triggers, Trigger Functions, Trigger Functions
arguments for trigger functions, Overview of Trigger Behavior
constraint trigger, Description
for updating a derived tsvector column, Triggers for Automatic Updates
in C, Writing Trigger Functions in C
in PL/pgSQL, Trigger Functions
in PL/Python, Trigger Functions
in PL/Tcl, Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
compared with rules, Rules Versus Triggers
triggered_change_notification, tcn
trigger_file (see promote_trigger_file)
trim, String Functions and Operators, Binary String Functions and Operators
trim_array, Array Functions and Operators
trim_scale, Mathematical Functions and Operators
true, Boolean Type
trunc, Mathematical Functions and Operators, Network Address Functions and Operators
TRUNCATE, TRUNCATE
trusted, Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
PL/Perl, Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
tsm_handler, Pseudo-Types
tsm_system_rows, tsm_system_rows
tsm_system_time, tsm_system_time
tsquery (data type), tsquery
tsquery_phrase, Text Search Functions and Operators, Manipulating Queries
tsvector (data type), tsvector
tsvector concatenation, Manipulating Documents
tsvector_to_array, Text Search Functions and Operators
tsvector_update_trigger, Trigger Functions
tsvector_update_trigger_column, Trigger Functions
ts_debug, Text Search Functions and Operators, Configuration Testing
ts_delete, Text Search Functions and Operators
ts_filter, Text Search Functions and Operators
ts_headline, Text Search Functions and Operators, Highlighting Results
ts_lexize, Text Search Functions and Operators, Dictionary Testing
ts_parse, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parser Testing
ts_rank, Text Search Functions and Operators, Ranking Search Results
ts_rank_cd, Text Search Functions and Operators, Ranking Search Results
ts_rewrite, Text Search Functions and Operators, Query Rewriting
ts_stat, Text Search Functions and Operators, Gathering Document Statistics
ts_token_type, Text Search Functions and Operators, Parser Testing
tuple_data_split, Heap Functions
txid_current, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_current_if_assigned, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_current_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_snapshot_xip, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_snapshot_xmax, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_snapshot_xmin, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_status, System Information Functions and Operators
txid_visible_in_snapshot, System Information Functions and Operators
type (see data type)
type cast, Numeric Constants, Type Casts

U

UESCAPE, Identifiers and Key Words, String Constants with Unicode Escapes
unaccent, unaccent, Functions
Unicode escape, String Constants with Unicode Escapes
in identifiers, Identifiers and Key Words
in string constants, String Constants with Unicode Escapes
Unicode normalization, String Functions and Operators
UNION, Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT), UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
uniq, intarray Functions and Operators
unique constraint, Unique Constraints
unistr, String Functions and Operators
Unix domain socket, Parameter Key Words
unix_socket_directories configuration parameter, Connection Settings
unix_socket_group configuration parameter, Connection Settings
unix_socket_permissions configuration parameter, Connection Settings
unknown, Pseudo-Types
UNLISTEN, UNLISTEN
unnest, Array Functions and Operators
for multirange, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
for tsvector, Text Search Functions and Operators
unqualified name, The Schema Search Path
updatable views, Updatable Views
UPDATE, Updates, Updating Data, Returning Data from Modified Rows, UPDATE
RETURNING, Returning Data from Modified Rows
update_process_title configuration parameter, Process Title
updating, Updating Data
upgrading, Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
upper, String Functions and Operators, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
and locales, Behavior
upper_inc, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
upper_inf, Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
UPSERT, INSERT
URI, Connection Strings
user, System Information Functions and Operators, Database Roles
current, System Information Functions and Operators
user mapping, Foreign Data
User name maps, User Name Maps
user_catalog_table storage parameter, Storage Parameters
UUID, UUID Type, UUID Type, PostgreSQL Features
generating, UUID Type
uuid-ossp, uuid-ossp
uuid_generate_v1, uuid-ossp Functions
uuid_generate_v1mc, uuid-ossp Functions
uuid_generate_v3, uuid-ossp Functions

V

vacuum, Routine Vacuuming
VACUUM, VACUUM
vacuumdb, vacuumdb
vacuumlo, vacuumlo
vacuum_cost_delay configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_limit configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_page_dirty configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_page_hit configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_cost_page_miss configuration parameter, Cost-based Vacuum Delay
vacuum_defer_cleanup_age configuration parameter, Primary Server
vacuum_failsafe_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_freeze_min_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_freeze_table_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_index_cleanup storage parameter, Storage Parameters
vacuum_multixact_failsafe_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_multixact_freeze_min_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_multixact_freeze_table_age configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
vacuum_truncate storage parameter, Storage Parameters
value expression, Value Expressions
VALUES, VALUES Lists, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs, VALUES
determination of result type, UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
varchar, Character Types
variadic function, SQL Functions with Variable Numbers of Arguments
variance, Aggregate Functions
population, Aggregate Functions
sample, Aggregate Functions
var_pop, Aggregate Functions
var_samp, Aggregate Functions
version, Accessing a Database, System Information Functions and Operators, Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
compatibility, Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster
view, Views, Views and the Rule System, Materialized Views, Cooperation with Views
implementation through rules, Views and the Rule System
materialized, Materialized Views
updating, Cooperation with Views
Visibility Map, Visibility Map
VM (see Visibility Map)
void, Pseudo-Types
VOLATILE, Function Volatility Categories
volatility, Function Volatility Categories
functions, Function Volatility Categories
VPATH, Installation Procedure, Extension Building Infrastructure

W

WAL, Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log
wal_block_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
wal_buffers configuration parameter, Settings
wal_compression configuration parameter, Settings
wal_consistency_checking configuration parameter, Developer Options
wal_debug configuration parameter, Developer Options
wal_decode_buffer_size configuration parameter, Recovery
wal_init_zero configuration parameter, Settings
wal_keep_size configuration parameter, Sending Servers
wal_level configuration parameter, Settings
wal_log_hints configuration parameter, Settings
wal_receiver_create_temp_slot configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_receiver_status_interval configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_receiver_timeout configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_recycle configuration parameter, Settings
wal_retrieve_retry_interval configuration parameter, Standby Servers
wal_segment_size configuration parameter, Preset Options
wal_sender_timeout configuration parameter, Sending Servers
wal_skip_threshold configuration parameter, Settings
wal_sync_method configuration parameter, Settings
wal_writer_delay configuration parameter, Settings
wal_writer_flush_after configuration parameter, Settings
warm standby, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
websearch_to_tsquery, Text Search Functions and Operators
WHERE, The WHERE Clause
where to log, Where to Log
WHILE
in PL/pgSQL, WHILE
width, Geometric Functions and Operators
width_bucket, Mathematical Functions and Operators
window function, Window Functions, Window Function Calls, Window Function Processing, Window Functions
built-in, Window Functions
invocation, Window Function Calls
order of execution, Window Function Processing
WITH, WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions), SELECT
in SELECT, WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions), SELECT
WITH CHECK OPTION, CREATE VIEW
WITHIN GROUP, Aggregate Expressions
witness server, High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
word_similarity, Functions and Operators
work_mem configuration parameter, Memory
wraparound
of multixact IDs, Multixacts and Wraparound
of transaction IDs, Preventing Transaction ID Wraparound Failures

X

xid, Object Identifier Types
xid8, Object Identifier Types
xmax, System Columns
xmin, System Columns
XML, XML Type
XML export, Mapping Tables to XML
XML Functions, XML Functions
XML option, Creating XML Values, Statement Behavior
xml2, xml2
xmlagg, xmlagg, Aggregate Functions
xmlbinary configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
xmlcomment, xmlcomment
xmlconcat, xmlconcat
xmlelement, xmlelement
XMLEXISTS, XMLEXISTS
xmlforest, xmlforest
xmloption configuration parameter, Statement Behavior
xmlparse, Creating XML Values
xmlpi, xmlpi
xmlroot, xmlroot
xmlserialize, Creating XML Values
xmltable, xmltable
xml_is_well_formed, xml_is_well_formed
xml_is_well_formed_content, xml_is_well_formed
xml_is_well_formed_document, xml_is_well_formed
XPath, xpath
xpath_exists, xpath_exists
xpath_table, xpath_table
XQuery regular expressions, Differences from SQL Standard and XQuery
xslt_process, xslt_process

Z

zero_damaged_pages configuration parameter, Developer Options
zlib, Requirements, Anti-Features
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-builtin-opclasses.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-builtin-opclasses.html index 50dfb55..13252c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-builtin-opclasses.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-builtin-opclasses.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -71.2. Built-in Operator Classes

71.2. Built-in Operator Classes

+71.2. Built-in Operator Classes

71.2. Built-in Operator Classes

The core PostgreSQL distribution includes the BRIN operator classes shown in Table 71.1. @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@ minmax indexes to summarize a block range. Each value may represent either a point, or a boundary of an interval. Values must be between 8 and 256, and the default value is 32. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-extensibility.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-extensibility.html index 206afcf..9ac0995 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-extensibility.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-extensibility.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -71.3. Extensibility

71.3. Extensibility

+71.3. Extensibility

71.3. Extensibility

The BRIN interface has a high level of abstraction, requiring the access method implementer only to implement the semantics of the data type being accessed. The BRIN layer @@ -165,4 +165,4 @@ typedef struct BrinOpcInfo right-hand-side argument of the supported operator. See float4_minmax_ops as an example of minmax, and box_inclusion_ops as an example of inclusion. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-intro.html index 8f56f6d..2b4a11f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -71.1. Introduction

71.1. Introduction

+71.1. Introduction

71.1. Introduction

BRIN stands for Block Range Index. BRIN is designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns have some natural correlation with their @@ -96,4 +96,4 @@ LOG: request for BRIN range summarization for index "brin_wi_idx" page 128 was which is useful when the index tuple is no longer a very good representation because the existing values have changed. See Section 9.27.8 for details. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin.html index 6e33cac..d5cd72b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/brin.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/brin.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 71. BRIN Indexes \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 71. BRIN Indexes \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-behavior.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-behavior.html index b70228b..ae71a0b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-behavior.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-behavior.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -67.2. Behavior of B-Tree Operator Classes

67.2. Behavior of B-Tree Operator Classes

+67.2. Behavior of B-Tree Operator Classes

67.2. Behavior of B-Tree Operator Classes

As shown in Table 38.3, a btree operator class must provide five comparison operators, <, @@ -115,4 +115,4 @@ data types. The extensions to three or more data types within a family are not strictly required by the btree index mechanism itself, but the planner relies on them for optimization purposes. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gin.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gin.html index f79c46f..990b8ba 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gin.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gin.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.8. btree_gin

F.8. btree_gin

+F.8. btree_gin

F.8. btree_gin

btree_gin provides sample GIN operator classes that implement B-tree equivalent behavior for the data types int2, int4, int8, float4, @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ SELECT * FROM test WHERE a < 10; Oleg Bartunov (). See http://www.sai.msu.su/~megera/oddmuse/index.cgi/Gin for additional information. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gist.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gist.html index 56aa8db..c7cf399 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gist.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-gist.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.9. btree_gist

F.9. btree_gist

+F.9. btree_gist

F.9. btree_gist

btree_gist provides GiST index operator classes that implement B-tree equivalent behavior for the data types int2, int4, int8, float4, @@ -77,4 +77,4 @@ INSERT 0 1 Paul Jungwirth (). See http://www.sai.msu.su/~megera/postgres/gist/ for additional information. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-implementation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-implementation.html index d575eb1..96eecba 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-implementation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-implementation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -67.4. Implementation

67.4. Implementation

+67.4. Implementation

67.4. Implementation

This section covers B-Tree index implementation details that may be of use to advanced users. See src/backend/access/nbtree/README in the source @@ -251,4 +251,4 @@

  • INCLUDE indexes can never use deduplication.

-

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-intro.html index 20796ba..4423300 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -67.1. Introduction

67.1. Introduction

+67.1. Introduction

67.1. Introduction

PostgreSQL includes an implementation of the standard btree (multi-way balanced tree) index data structure. Any data type that can be sorted into a well-defined linear @@ -14,4 +14,4 @@ some features that go beyond what would be needed just to support btree indexes, and parts of the system that are quite distant from the btree AM make use of them. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-support-funcs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-support-funcs.html index 72310b2..a9e7cee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-support-funcs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree-support-funcs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -67.3. B-Tree Support Functions

67.3. B-Tree Support Functions

+67.3. B-Tree Support Functions

67.3. B-Tree Support Functions

As shown in Table 38.9, btree defines one required and four optional support functions. The five user-defined methods are: @@ -288,4 +288,4 @@ options(relopts loc access method. Nevertheless, this support function was added to B-tree for uniformity, and will probably find uses during further evolution of B-tree in PostgreSQL. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree.html index 1871b85..ed4ecbd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/btree.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/btree.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 67. B-Tree Indexes \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 67. B-Tree Indexes \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/bug-reporting.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/bug-reporting.html index ed250ab..77f198c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/bug-reporting.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/bug-reporting.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5. Bug Reporting Guidelines

5. Bug Reporting Guidelines

+5. Bug Reporting Guidelines

5. Bug Reporting Guidelines

When you find a bug in PostgreSQL we want to hear about it. Your bug reports play an important part in making PostgreSQL more reliable because even the utmost @@ -154,7 +154,7 @@ subversion the package might have. If you are talking about a Git snapshot, mention that, including the commit hash.

- If your version is older than 15.5 we will almost certainly + If your version is older than 15.6 we will almost certainly tell you to upgrade. There are many bug fixes and improvements in each new release, so it is quite possible that a bug you have encountered in an older release of PostgreSQL @@ -245,4 +245,4 @@ will be some delay before the email is delivered. If you wish to subscribe to the lists, please visit https://lists.postgresql.org/ for instructions. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-aggregate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-aggregate.html index 8b38ccd..ae4b7cd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-aggregate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-aggregate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.2. pg_aggregate

53.2. pg_aggregate

+53.2. pg_aggregate

53.2. pg_aggregate

The catalog pg_aggregate stores information about aggregate functions. An aggregate function is a function that operates on a set of values (typically one column from each row @@ -167,4 +167,4 @@ command. See Section 38.12 for more information about writing aggregate functions and the meaning of the transition functions, etc. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-am.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-am.html index 48e8cae..01b7476 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-am.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-am.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.3. pg_am

53.3. pg_am

+53.3. pg_am

53.3. pg_am

The catalog pg_am stores information about relation access methods. There is one row for each access method supported by the system. @@ -41,4 +41,4 @@ However, pg_index_column_has_property() and related functions have been added to allow SQL queries to inspect index access method properties; see Table 9.71. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amop.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amop.html index c43164e..0882002 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amop.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amop.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.4. pg_amop

53.4. pg_amop

+53.4. pg_amop

53.4. pg_amop

The catalog pg_amop stores information about operators associated with access method operator families. There is one row for each operator that is a member of an operator family. A family @@ -101,4 +101,4 @@ amoplefttype and amoprighttype must match the oprleft and oprright fields of the referenced pg_operator entry. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amproc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amproc.html index f2b1604..7bb2479 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amproc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-amproc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.5. pg_amproc

53.5. pg_amproc

+53.5. pg_amproc

53.5. pg_amproc

The catalog pg_amproc stores information about support functions associated with access method operator families. There is one row for each support function belonging to an operator family. @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@ an index, which are those with amproclefttype and amprocrighttype both equal to the index operator class's opcintype. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attrdef.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attrdef.html index 6f9afd5..1cea5a6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attrdef.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attrdef.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.6. pg_attrdef

53.6. pg_attrdef

+53.6. pg_attrdef

53.6. pg_attrdef

The catalog pg_attrdef stores column default values. The main information about columns is stored in pg_attribute. @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ The column default value, in nodeToString() representation. Use pg_get_expr(adbin, adrelid) to convert it to an SQL expression. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attribute.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attribute.html index 75b840f..fcff141 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attribute.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-attribute.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.7. pg_attribute

53.7. pg_attribute

+53.7. pg_attribute

53.7. pg_attribute

The catalog pg_attribute stores information about table columns. There will be exactly one pg_attribute row for every column in every @@ -208,4 +208,4 @@ later dropped, and so there is no pg_type row anymore. attlen and the other fields can be used to interpret the contents of a row of the table. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-auth-members.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-auth-members.html index 014acb5..9a3b7b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-auth-members.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-auth-members.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.9. pg_auth_members

53.9. pg_auth_members

+53.9. pg_auth_members

53.9. pg_auth_members

The catalog pg_auth_members shows the membership relations between roles. Any non-circular set of relationships is allowed.

@@ -37,4 +37,4 @@

True if member can grant membership in roleid to others -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-authid.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-authid.html index d45b1f7..290ef27 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-authid.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-authid.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.8. pg_authid

53.8. pg_authid

+53.8. pg_authid

53.8. pg_authid

The catalog pg_authid contains information about database authorization identifiers (roles). A role subsumes the concepts of users and groups. A user is essentially just a @@ -110,4 +110,4 @@ SCRAM-SHA-256$<iteration count>:

A password that does not follow either of those formats is assumed to be unencrypted. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-cast.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-cast.html index 84762e5..116d34c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-cast.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-cast.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.10. pg_cast

53.10. pg_cast

+53.10. pg_cast

53.10. pg_cast

The catalog pg_cast stores data type conversion paths, both built-in and user-defined.

@@ -83,4 +83,4 @@ coercion in a single step. When no such entry is available, coercion to a type that uses a type modifier involves two steps, one to convert between data types and a second to apply the modifier. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-class.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-class.html index 15bb128..620aef8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-class.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-class.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.11. pg_class

53.11. pg_class

+53.11. pg_class

53.11. pg_class

The catalog pg_class describes tables and other objects that have columns or are otherwise similar to a table. This includes indexes (but see also pg_index), @@ -261,4 +261,4 @@ DROP INDEX. Instead, VACUUM clears relhasindex if it finds the table has no indexes. This arrangement avoids race conditions and improves concurrency. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-collation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-collation.html index 65e8e82..e8223d6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-collation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-collation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.12. pg_collation

53.12. pg_collation

+53.12. pg_collation

53.12. pg_collation

The catalog pg_collation describes the available collations, which are essentially mappings from an SQL name to operating system locale categories. @@ -90,4 +90,4 @@ collations whose encoding does not match the database encoding, since they could match the encodings of databases later cloned from template0. This would currently have to be done manually. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-constraint.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-constraint.html index 3ddeeb9..f7ec105 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-constraint.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-constraint.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.13. pg_constraint

53.13. pg_constraint

+53.13. pg_constraint

53.13. pg_constraint

The catalog pg_constraint stores check, primary key, unique, foreign key, and exclusion constraints on tables. (Column constraints are not treated specially. Every column constraint is @@ -203,4 +203,4 @@ pg_class.relchecks needs to agree with the number of check-constraint entries found in this table for each relation. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-conversion.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-conversion.html index 953bf19..525043c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-conversion.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-conversion.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.14. pg_conversion

53.14. pg_conversion

+53.14. pg_conversion

53.14. pg_conversion

The catalog pg_conversion describes encoding conversion functions. See CREATE CONVERSION for more information. @@ -53,4 +53,4 @@

True if this is the default conversion -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-database.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-database.html index 9346423..3e34e04 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-database.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-database.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.15. pg_database

53.15. pg_database

+53.15. pg_database

53.15. pg_database

The catalog pg_database stores information about the available databases. Databases are created with the CREATE DATABASE command. Consult Chapter 23 for details about the meaning @@ -121,4 +121,4 @@

Access privileges; see Section 5.7 for details -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-db-role-setting.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-db-role-setting.html index b139f76..441b48f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-db-role-setting.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-db-role-setting.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.16. pg_db_role_setting

53.16. pg_db_role_setting

+53.16. pg_db_role_setting

53.16. pg_db_role_setting

The catalog pg_db_role_setting records the default values that have been set for run-time configuration variables, for each role and database combination. @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@

Defaults for run-time configuration variables -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-default-acl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-default-acl.html index 9787142..28f972a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-default-acl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-default-acl.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.17. pg_default_acl

53.17. pg_default_acl

+53.17. pg_default_acl

53.17. pg_default_acl

The catalog pg_default_acl stores initial privileges to be assigned to newly created objects.

Table 53.17. pg_default_acl Columns

@@ -55,4 +55,4 @@ not whatever might be in pg_default_acl at the moment. pg_default_acl is only consulted during object creation. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-depend.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-depend.html index adf6a59..e0cdc38 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-depend.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-depend.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.18. pg_depend

53.18. pg_depend

+53.18. pg_depend

53.18. pg_depend

The catalog pg_depend records the dependency relationships between database objects. This information allows DROP commands to find which other objects must be dropped @@ -172,4 +172,4 @@ a NORMAL dependency on the numeric data type, but no such entry actually appears in pg_depend. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-description.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-description.html index 83cda40..585a597 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-description.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-description.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.19. pg_description

53.19. pg_description

+53.19. pg_description

53.19. pg_description

The catalog pg_description stores optional descriptions (comments) for each database object. Descriptions can be manipulated with the COMMENT command and viewed with @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@

Arbitrary text that serves as the description of this object -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-enum.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-enum.html index 504a1dd..812c987 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-enum.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-enum.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.20. pg_enum

53.20. pg_enum

+53.20. pg_enum

53.20. pg_enum

The pg_enum catalog contains entries showing the values and labels for each enum type. The internal representation of a given enum value is actually the OID @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ negative or fractional values of enumsortorder. The only requirement on these values is that they be correctly ordered and unique within each enum type. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-event-trigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-event-trigger.html index ad892a2..495f0b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-event-trigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-event-trigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.21. pg_event_trigger

53.21. pg_event_trigger

+53.21. pg_event_trigger

53.21. pg_event_trigger

The catalog pg_event_trigger stores event triggers. See Chapter 40 for more information.

Table 53.21. pg_event_trigger Columns

@@ -50,4 +50,4 @@

Command tags for which this trigger will fire. If NULL, the firing of this trigger is not restricted on the basis of the command tag. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-extension.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-extension.html index 0a71cf4..4013e76 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-extension.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-extension.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.22. pg_extension

53.22. pg_extension

+53.22. pg_extension

53.22. pg_extension

The catalog pg_extension stores information about the installed extensions. See Section 38.17 for details about extensions. @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ objects. If extrelocatable is true, then this schema must in fact contain all schema-qualifiable objects belonging to the extension. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-data-wrapper.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-data-wrapper.html index 7b7daa7..565a6d8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-data-wrapper.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-data-wrapper.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.23. pg_foreign_data_wrapper

53.23. pg_foreign_data_wrapper

+53.23. pg_foreign_data_wrapper

53.23. pg_foreign_data_wrapper

The catalog pg_foreign_data_wrapper stores foreign-data wrapper definitions. A foreign-data wrapper is the mechanism by which external data, residing on foreign servers, is @@ -53,4 +53,4 @@

Foreign-data wrapper specific options, as keyword=value strings -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-server.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-server.html index 3ea5002..f094cca 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-server.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-server.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.24. pg_foreign_server

53.24. pg_foreign_server

+53.24. pg_foreign_server

53.24. pg_foreign_server

The catalog pg_foreign_server stores foreign server definitions. A foreign server describes a source of external data, such as a remote server. Foreign @@ -51,4 +51,4 @@

Foreign server specific options, as keyword=value strings -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-table.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-table.html index 2146cf9..7bd5b93 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-table.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-foreign-table.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.25. pg_foreign_table

53.25. pg_foreign_table

+53.25. pg_foreign_table

53.25. pg_foreign_table

The catalog pg_foreign_table contains auxiliary information about foreign tables. A foreign table is primarily represented by a @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@

Foreign table options, as keyword=value strings -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-index.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-index.html index 313f973..083c36e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-index.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-index.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.26. pg_index

53.26. pg_index

+53.26. pg_index

53.26. pg_index

The catalog pg_index contains part of the information about indexes. The rest is mostly in pg_class. @@ -160,4 +160,4 @@ Expression tree (in nodeToString() representation) for partial index predicate. Null if not a partial index. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-inherits.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-inherits.html index 7d02903..545beb9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-inherits.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-inherits.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.27. pg_inherits

53.27. pg_inherits

+53.27. pg_inherits

53.27. pg_inherits

The catalog pg_inherits records information about table and index inheritance hierarchies. There is one entry for each direct parent-child table or index relationship in the database. (Indirect @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@

true for a partition that is in the process of being detached; false otherwise. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-init-privs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-init-privs.html index e6f7697..af3c4ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-init-privs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-init-privs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.28. pg_init_privs

53.28. pg_init_privs

+53.28. pg_init_privs

53.28. pg_init_privs

The catalog pg_init_privs records information about the initial privileges of objects in the system. There is one entry for each object in the database which has a non-default (non-NULL) @@ -58,4 +58,4 @@

The initial access privileges; see Section 5.7 for details -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-language.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-language.html index ea5a2e8..b527065 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-language.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-language.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.29. pg_language

53.29. pg_language

+53.29. pg_language

53.29. pg_language

The catalog pg_language registers languages in which you can write functions or stored procedures. See CREATE LANGUAGE @@ -73,4 +73,4 @@

Access privileges; see Section 5.7 for details -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject-metadata.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject-metadata.html index 7bd9453..61a1dbf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject-metadata.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject-metadata.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.31. pg_largeobject_metadata

53.31. pg_largeobject_metadata

+53.31. pg_largeobject_metadata

53.31. pg_largeobject_metadata

The catalog pg_largeobject_metadata holds metadata associated with large objects. The actual large object data is stored in @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@

Access privileges; see Section 5.7 for details -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject.html index 0149154..ae4ffe8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-largeobject.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.30. pg_largeobject

53.30. pg_largeobject

+53.30. pg_largeobject

53.30. pg_largeobject

The catalog pg_largeobject holds the data making up large objects. A large object is identified by an OID assigned when it is created. Each large object is broken into @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ allows sparse storage: pages might be missing, and might be shorter than LOBLKSIZE bytes even if they are not the last page of the object. Missing regions within a large object read as zeroes. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-namespace.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-namespace.html index b16d623..5fd2aff 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-namespace.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-namespace.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.32. pg_namespace

53.32. pg_namespace

+53.32. pg_namespace

53.32. pg_namespace

The catalog pg_namespace stores namespaces. A namespace is the structure underlying SQL schemas: each namespace can have a separate collection of relations, types, etc. without name @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@

Access privileges; see Section 5.7 for details -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opclass.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opclass.html index 57f3ffe..6909f84 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opclass.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opclass.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.33. pg_opclass

53.33. pg_opclass

+53.33. pg_opclass

53.33. pg_opclass

The catalog pg_opclass defines index access method operator classes. Each operator class defines semantics for index columns of a particular data type and a particular @@ -72,4 +72,4 @@ Also, there must be no more than one pg_opclass row having opcdefault true for any given combination of opcmethod and opcintype. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-operator.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-operator.html index e99413e..face19d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-operator.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-operator.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.34. pg_operator

53.34. pg_operator

+53.34. pg_operator

53.34. pg_operator

The catalog pg_operator stores information about operators. See CREATE OPERATOR and Section 38.14 for more information. @@ -98,4 +98,4 @@

Join selectivity estimation function for this operator (zero if none) -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opfamily.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opfamily.html index 65ab26f..a29f068 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opfamily.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-opfamily.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.35. pg_opfamily

53.35. pg_opfamily

+53.35. pg_opfamily

53.35. pg_opfamily

The catalog pg_opfamily defines operator families. Each operator family is a collection of operators and associated support routines that implement the semantics specified for a particular @@ -50,4 +50,4 @@ pg_amproc, and pg_opclass. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-parameter-acl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-parameter-acl.html index 181cc67..79fdf07 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-parameter-acl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-parameter-acl.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.36. pg_parameter_acl

53.36. pg_parameter_acl

+53.36. pg_parameter_acl

53.36. pg_parameter_acl

The catalog pg_parameter_acl records configuration parameters for which privileges have been granted to one or more roles. No entry is made for parameters that have default privileges. @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@

Access privileges; see Section 5.7 for details -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-partitioned-table.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-partitioned-table.html index 6c1b582..0ef28a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-partitioned-table.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-partitioned-table.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.37. pg_partitioned_table

53.37. pg_partitioned_table

+53.37. pg_partitioned_table

53.37. pg_partitioned_table

The catalog pg_partitioned_table stores information about how tables are partitioned.

Table 53.37. pg_partitioned_table Columns

@@ -68,4 +68,4 @@ references. This is a list with one element for each zero entry in partattrs. Null if all partition key columns are simple references. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-policy.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-policy.html index 60dd14f..bab4e6f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-policy.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-policy.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.38. pg_policy

53.38. pg_policy

+53.38. pg_policy

53.38. pg_policy

The catalog pg_policy stores row-level security policies for tables. A policy includes the kind of command that it applies to (possibly all commands), the roles that it @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ Policies stored in pg_policy are applied only when pg_class.relrowsecurity is set for their table. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-proc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-proc.html index 9c29fc4..8783850 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-proc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-proc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.39. pg_proc

53.39. pg_proc

+53.39. pg_proc

53.39. pg_proc

The catalog pg_proc stores information about functions, procedures, aggregate functions, and window functions (collectively also known as routines). See CREATE FUNCTION, CREATE PROCEDURE, and @@ -253,4 +253,4 @@ text. probin is null except for dynamically-loaded C functions, for which it gives the name of the shared library file containing the function. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-namespace.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-namespace.html index 8965e2d..8d19494 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-namespace.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-namespace.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.41. pg_publication_namespace

53.41. pg_publication_namespace

+53.41. pg_publication_namespace

53.41. pg_publication_namespace

The catalog pg_publication_namespace contains the mapping between schemas and publications in the database. This is a many-to-many mapping. @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@

Reference to schema -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-rel.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-rel.html index a3cd9c6..c81398b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-rel.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication-rel.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.42. pg_publication_rel

53.42. pg_publication_rel

+53.42. pg_publication_rel

53.42. pg_publication_rel

The catalog pg_publication_rel contains the mapping between relations and publications in the database. This is a many-to-many mapping. See also Section 54.17 @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ part of the publication. For example, a value of 1 3 would mean that the first and the third table columns are published. A null value indicates that all columns are published. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication.html index 5d9ab24..75a04f3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-publication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.40. pg_publication

53.40. pg_publication

+53.40. pg_publication

53.40. pg_publication

The catalog pg_publication contains all publications created in the database. For more on publications see Section 31.1. @@ -61,4 +61,4 @@ If true, operations on a leaf partition are replicated using the identity and schema of its topmost partitioned ancestor mentioned in the publication instead of its own. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-range.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-range.html index 69d0327..df9bfe5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-range.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-range.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.43. pg_range

53.43. pg_range

+53.43. pg_range

53.43. pg_range

The catalog pg_range stores information about range types. This is in addition to the types' entries in pg_type. @@ -58,4 +58,4 @@ type. rngcanonical is used when the element type is discrete. rngsubdiff is optional but should be supplied to improve performance of GiST indexes on the range type. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-replication-origin.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-replication-origin.html index 66167a0..299e305 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-replication-origin.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-replication-origin.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.44. pg_replication_origin

53.44. pg_replication_origin

+53.44. pg_replication_origin

53.44. pg_replication_origin

The pg_replication_origin catalog contains all replication origins created. For more on replication origins see Chapter 50. @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@

The external, user defined, name of a replication origin. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-rewrite.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-rewrite.html index e610f4e..7c9f11d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-rewrite.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-rewrite.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.45. pg_rewrite

53.45. pg_rewrite

+53.45. pg_rewrite

53.45. pg_rewrite

The catalog pg_rewrite stores rewrite rules for tables and views.

Table 53.45. pg_rewrite Columns

Column Type @@ -61,4 +61,4 @@


Note

pg_class.relhasrules must be true if a table has any rules in this catalog. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-seclabel.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-seclabel.html index be5afa1..a6dd2a3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-seclabel.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-seclabel.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.46. pg_seclabel

53.46. pg_seclabel

+53.46. pg_seclabel

53.46. pg_seclabel

The catalog pg_seclabel stores security labels on database objects. Security labels can be manipulated with the SECURITY LABEL command. For an easier @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@

The security label applied to this object. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-sequence.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-sequence.html index e3351e8..8b4a76a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-sequence.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-sequence.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.47. pg_sequence

53.47. pg_sequence

+53.47. pg_sequence

53.47. pg_sequence

The catalog pg_sequence contains information about sequences. Some of the information about sequences, such as the name and the schema, is in @@ -51,4 +51,4 @@

Whether the sequence cycles -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdepend.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdepend.html index 0cf67cf..a3aaef0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdepend.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdepend.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.48. pg_shdepend

53.48. pg_shdepend

+53.48. pg_shdepend

53.48. pg_shdepend

The catalog pg_shdepend records the dependency relationships between database objects and shared objects, such as roles. This information allows @@ -95,4 +95,4 @@ considered pinned. No entries are made in pg_shdepend that would have a pinned object as either referenced or dependent object. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdescription.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdescription.html index c4a53be..54d9e48 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdescription.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shdescription.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.49. pg_shdescription

53.49. pg_shdescription

+53.49. pg_shdescription

53.49. pg_shdescription

The catalog pg_shdescription stores optional descriptions (comments) for shared database objects. Descriptions can be manipulated with the COMMENT command and viewed with @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@

Arbitrary text that serves as the description of this object -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shseclabel.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shseclabel.html index 2daa59d..52d91ee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shseclabel.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-shseclabel.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.50. pg_shseclabel

53.50. pg_shseclabel

+53.50. pg_shseclabel

53.50. pg_shseclabel

The catalog pg_shseclabel stores security labels on shared database objects. Security labels can be manipulated with the SECURITY LABEL command. For an easier @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@

The security label applied to this object. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext-data.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext-data.html index 37d2257..5860d87 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext-data.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext-data.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.53. pg_statistic_ext_data

53.53. pg_statistic_ext_data

+53.53. pg_statistic_ext_data

53.53. pg_statistic_ext_data

The catalog pg_statistic_ext_data holds data for extended planner statistics defined in pg_statistic_ext. @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@

Per-expression statistics, serialized as an array of pg_statistic type -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext.html index 1a9b500..5123439 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic-ext.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.52. pg_statistic_ext

53.52. pg_statistic_ext

+53.52. pg_statistic_ext

53.52. pg_statistic_ext

The catalog pg_statistic_ext holds definitions of extended planner statistics. Each row in this catalog corresponds to a statistics object @@ -85,4 +85,4 @@ and populate an entry in the pg_statistic_ext_data catalog. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic.html index b991189..cb4bca1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-statistic.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.51. pg_statistic

53.51. pg_statistic

+53.51. pg_statistic

53.51. pg_statistic

The catalog pg_statistic stores statistical data about the contents of the database. Entries are created by ANALYZE @@ -131,4 +131,4 @@ values are actually of the specific column's data type, or a related type such as an array's element type, so there is no way to define these columns' type more specifically than anyarray. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription-rel.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription-rel.html index 39260a0..b84860d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription-rel.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription-rel.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.55. pg_subscription_rel

53.55. pg_subscription_rel

+53.55. pg_subscription_rel

53.55. pg_subscription_rel

The catalog pg_subscription_rel contains the state for each replicated relation in each subscription. This is a many-to-many mapping. @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ Remote LSN of the state change used for synchronization coordination when in s or r states, otherwise null -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription.html index 4400b09..057f1ab 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-subscription.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.54. pg_subscription

53.54. pg_subscription

+53.54. pg_subscription

53.54. pg_subscription

The catalog pg_subscription contains all existing logical replication subscriptions. For more information about logical replication see Chapter 31. @@ -100,4 +100,4 @@ Array of subscribed publication names. These reference publications defined in the upstream database. For more on publications see Section 31.1. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-tablespace.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-tablespace.html index eb13f76..5bdec93 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-tablespace.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-tablespace.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.56. pg_tablespace

53.56. pg_tablespace

+53.56. pg_tablespace

53.56. pg_tablespace

The catalog pg_tablespace stores information about the available tablespaces. Tables can be placed in particular tablespaces to aid administration of disk layout. @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@

Tablespace-level options, as keyword=value strings -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-transform.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-transform.html index a22ba51..d7169e9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-transform.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-transform.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.57. pg_transform

53.57. pg_transform

+53.57. pg_transform

53.57. pg_transform

The catalog pg_transform stores information about transforms, which are a mechanism to adapt data types to procedural languages. See CREATE TRANSFORM for more information. @@ -41,4 +41,4 @@ The OID of the function to use when converting output from the procedural language (e.g., return values) to the data type. Zero is stored if the default behavior should be used. -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-trigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-trigger.html index da92ff0..ce4212d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-trigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-trigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.58. pg_trigger

53.58. pg_trigger

+53.58. pg_trigger

53.58. pg_trigger

The catalog pg_trigger stores triggers on tables and views. See CREATE TRIGGER @@ -145,4 +145,4 @@

Note

pg_class.relhastriggers must be true if a relation has any triggers in this catalog. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config-map.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config-map.html index 33a26ec..9e7d34f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config-map.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config-map.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.60. pg_ts_config_map

53.60. pg_ts_config_map

+53.60. pg_ts_config_map

53.60. pg_ts_config_map

The pg_ts_config_map catalog contains entries showing which text search dictionaries should be consulted, and in what order, for each output token type of each text search configuration's @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@

The OID of the text search dictionary to consult -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config.html index 6ff3a84..17d31f6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-config.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.59. pg_ts_config

53.59. pg_ts_config

+53.59. pg_ts_config

53.59. pg_ts_config

The pg_ts_config catalog contains entries representing text search configurations. A configuration specifies a particular text search parser and a list of dictionaries to use @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@

The OID of the text search parser for this configuration -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-dict.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-dict.html index f35bea4..703fdc7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-dict.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-dict.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.61. pg_ts_dict

53.61. pg_ts_dict

+53.61. pg_ts_dict

53.61. pg_ts_dict

The pg_ts_dict catalog contains entries defining text search dictionaries. A dictionary depends on a text search template, which specifies all the implementation functions @@ -49,4 +49,4 @@

Initialization option string for the template -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-parser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-parser.html index 0a56d1f..1342510 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-parser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-parser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.62. pg_ts_parser

53.62. pg_ts_parser

+53.62. pg_ts_parser

53.62. pg_ts_parser

The pg_ts_parser catalog contains entries defining text search parsers. A parser is responsible for splitting input text into lexemes and assigning a token type to each lexeme. @@ -59,4 +59,4 @@

OID of the parser's lextype function -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-template.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-template.html index 7802b78..4b794b9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-template.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-ts-template.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.63. pg_ts_template

53.63. pg_ts_template

+53.63. pg_ts_template

53.63. pg_ts_template

The pg_ts_template catalog contains entries defining text search templates. A template is the implementation skeleton for a class of text search dictionaries. @@ -41,4 +41,4 @@

OID of the template's lexize function -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-type.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-type.html index 93b96cf..6361d4a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-type.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-type.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.64. pg_type

53.64. pg_type

+53.64. pg_type

53.64. pg_type

The catalog pg_type stores information about data types. Base types and enum types (scalar types) are created with CREATE TYPE, and @@ -307,4 +307,4 @@ of typcategory. Any future additions to this list will also be upper-case ASCII letters. All other ASCII characters are reserved for user-defined categories. -

Table 53.65. typcategory Codes

CodeCategory
AArray types
BBoolean types
CComposite types
DDate/time types
EEnum types
GGeometric types
INetwork address types
NNumeric types
PPseudo-types
RRange types
SString types
TTimespan types
UUser-defined types
VBit-string types
Xunknown type
ZInternal-use types

\ No newline at end of file +

Table 53.65. typcategory Codes

CodeCategory
AArray types
BBoolean types
CComposite types
DDate/time types
EEnum types
GGeometric types
INetwork address types
NNumeric types
PPseudo-types
RRange types
SString types
TTimespan types
UUser-defined types
VBit-string types
Xunknown type
ZInternal-use types

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-user-mapping.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-user-mapping.html index dd350c5..ec8887f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-user-mapping.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalog-pg-user-mapping.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.65. pg_user_mapping

53.65. pg_user_mapping

+53.65. pg_user_mapping

53.65. pg_user_mapping

The catalog pg_user_mapping stores the mappings from local user to remote. Access to this catalog is restricted from normal users, use the view @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@

User mapping specific options, as keyword=value strings -


\ No newline at end of file +


\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs-overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs-overview.html index 0d7ad11..41ac125 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs-overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs-overview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -53.1. Overview

53.1. Overview

+53.1. Overview

53.1. Overview

Table 53.1 lists the system catalogs. More detailed documentation of each catalog follows below.

@@ -7,4 +7,4 @@ database creation and are thereafter database-specific. A few catalogs are physically shared across all databases in a cluster; these are noted in the descriptions of the individual catalogs. -

Table 53.1. System Catalogs

Catalog NamePurpose
pg_aggregateaggregate functions
pg_amrelation access methods
pg_amopaccess method operators
pg_amprocaccess method support functions
pg_attrdefcolumn default values
pg_attributetable columns (attributes)
pg_authidauthorization identifiers (roles)
pg_auth_membersauthorization identifier membership relationships
pg_castcasts (data type conversions)
pg_classtables, indexes, sequences, views (relations)
pg_collationcollations (locale information)
pg_constraintcheck constraints, unique constraints, primary key constraints, foreign key constraints
pg_conversionencoding conversion information
pg_databasedatabases within this database cluster
pg_db_role_settingper-role and per-database settings
pg_default_acldefault privileges for object types
pg_dependdependencies between database objects
pg_descriptiondescriptions or comments on database objects
pg_enumenum label and value definitions
pg_event_triggerevent triggers
pg_extensioninstalled extensions
pg_foreign_data_wrapperforeign-data wrapper definitions
pg_foreign_serverforeign server definitions
pg_foreign_tableadditional foreign table information
pg_indexadditional index information
pg_inheritstable inheritance hierarchy
pg_init_privsobject initial privileges
pg_languagelanguages for writing functions
pg_largeobjectdata pages for large objects
pg_largeobject_metadatametadata for large objects
pg_namespaceschemas
pg_opclassaccess method operator classes
pg_operatoroperators
pg_opfamilyaccess method operator families
pg_parameter_aclconfiguration parameters for which privileges have been granted
pg_partitioned_tableinformation about partition key of tables
pg_policyrow-security policies
pg_procfunctions and procedures
pg_publicationpublications for logical replication
pg_publication_namespaceschema to publication mapping
pg_publication_relrelation to publication mapping
pg_rangeinformation about range types
pg_replication_originregistered replication origins
pg_rewritequery rewrite rules
pg_seclabelsecurity labels on database objects
pg_sequenceinformation about sequences
pg_shdependdependencies on shared objects
pg_shdescriptioncomments on shared objects
pg_shseclabelsecurity labels on shared database objects
pg_statisticplanner statistics
pg_statistic_extextended planner statistics (definition)
pg_statistic_ext_dataextended planner statistics (built statistics)
pg_subscriptionlogical replication subscriptions
pg_subscription_relrelation state for subscriptions
pg_tablespacetablespaces within this database cluster
pg_transformtransforms (data type to procedural language conversions)
pg_triggertriggers
pg_ts_configtext search configurations
pg_ts_config_maptext search configurations' token mappings
pg_ts_dicttext search dictionaries
pg_ts_parsertext search parsers
pg_ts_templatetext search templates
pg_typedata types
pg_user_mappingmappings of users to foreign servers

\ No newline at end of file +

Table 53.1. System Catalogs

Catalog NamePurpose
pg_aggregateaggregate functions
pg_amrelation access methods
pg_amopaccess method operators
pg_amprocaccess method support functions
pg_attrdefcolumn default values
pg_attributetable columns (attributes)
pg_authidauthorization identifiers (roles)
pg_auth_membersauthorization identifier membership relationships
pg_castcasts (data type conversions)
pg_classtables, indexes, sequences, views (relations)
pg_collationcollations (locale information)
pg_constraintcheck constraints, unique constraints, primary key constraints, foreign key constraints
pg_conversionencoding conversion information
pg_databasedatabases within this database cluster
pg_db_role_settingper-role and per-database settings
pg_default_acldefault privileges for object types
pg_dependdependencies between database objects
pg_descriptiondescriptions or comments on database objects
pg_enumenum label and value definitions
pg_event_triggerevent triggers
pg_extensioninstalled extensions
pg_foreign_data_wrapperforeign-data wrapper definitions
pg_foreign_serverforeign server definitions
pg_foreign_tableadditional foreign table information
pg_indexadditional index information
pg_inheritstable inheritance hierarchy
pg_init_privsobject initial privileges
pg_languagelanguages for writing functions
pg_largeobjectdata pages for large objects
pg_largeobject_metadatametadata for large objects
pg_namespaceschemas
pg_opclassaccess method operator classes
pg_operatoroperators
pg_opfamilyaccess method operator families
pg_parameter_aclconfiguration parameters for which privileges have been granted
pg_partitioned_tableinformation about partition key of tables
pg_policyrow-security policies
pg_procfunctions and procedures
pg_publicationpublications for logical replication
pg_publication_namespaceschema to publication mapping
pg_publication_relrelation to publication mapping
pg_rangeinformation about range types
pg_replication_originregistered replication origins
pg_rewritequery rewrite rules
pg_seclabelsecurity labels on database objects
pg_sequenceinformation about sequences
pg_shdependdependencies on shared objects
pg_shdescriptioncomments on shared objects
pg_shseclabelsecurity labels on shared database objects
pg_statisticplanner statistics
pg_statistic_extextended planner statistics (definition)
pg_statistic_ext_dataextended planner statistics (built statistics)
pg_subscriptionlogical replication subscriptions
pg_subscription_relrelation state for subscriptions
pg_tablespacetablespaces within this database cluster
pg_transformtransforms (data type to procedural language conversions)
pg_triggertriggers
pg_ts_configtext search configurations
pg_ts_config_maptext search configurations' token mappings
pg_ts_dicttext search dictionaries
pg_ts_parsertext search parsers
pg_ts_templatetext search templates
pg_typedata types
pg_user_mappingmappings of users to foreign servers

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs.html index ccdbaad..61c0135 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/catalogs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 53. System Catalogs

Chapter 53. System Catalogs

+Chapter 53. System Catalogs

Chapter 53. System Catalogs

The system catalogs are the place where a relational database management system stores schema metadata, such as information about tables and columns, and internal bookkeeping information. @@ -14,4 +14,4 @@ particularly esoteric operations, but many of those have been made available as SQL commands over time, and so the need for direct manipulation of the system catalogs is ever decreasing. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/charset.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/charset.html index 4808158..b236814 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/charset.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/charset.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 24. Localization \ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/checksums.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/checksums.html index 8d2e9d5..3b93b09 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/checksums.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/checksums.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -30.2. Data Checksums

30.2. Data Checksums

+30.2. Data Checksums

30.2. Data Checksums

By default, data pages are not protected by checksums, but this can optionally be enabled for a cluster. When enabled, each data page includes a checksum that is updated when the page is written and verified each time @@ -22,4 +22,4 @@ The pg_checksums application can be used to enable or disable data checksums, as well as verify checksums, on an offline cluster. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/citext.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/citext.html index f0dbd60..40ec3aa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/citext.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/citext.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.10. citext

F.10. citext

+F.10. citext

F.10. citext

The citext module provides a case-insensitive character string type, citext. Essentially, it internally calls lower when comparing values. Otherwise, it behaves almost @@ -163,4 +163,4 @@ SELECT * FROM users WHERE nick = 'Larry'; David E. Wheeler

Inspired by the original citext module by Donald Fraser. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication-problems.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication-problems.html index 2157438..f17bfed 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication-problems.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication-problems.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.15. Authentication Problems

21.15. Authentication Problems

+21.15. Authentication Problems

21.15. Authentication Problems

Authentication failures and related problems generally manifest themselves through error messages like the following:

@@ -37,4 +37,4 @@ FATAL: database "testdb" does not exist The server log might contain more information about an authentication failure than is reported to the client. If you are confused about the reason for a failure, check the server log. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication.html index 2e7fe0f..685d3d2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/client-authentication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 21. Client Authentication

Chapter 21. Client Authentication

+Chapter 21. Client Authentication

Chapter 21. Client Authentication

When a client application connects to the database server, it specifies which PostgreSQL database user name it wants to connect as, much the same way one logs into a Unix computer @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ operating system account, and in such cases there need be no connection between database user names and OS user names. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/client-interfaces.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/client-interfaces.html index 9cbb83c..1ce7191 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/client-interfaces.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/client-interfaces.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Part IV. Client Interfaces

Part IV. Client Interfaces

+Part IV. Client Interfaces

Part IV. Client Interfaces

This part describes the client programming interfaces distributed with PostgreSQL. Each of these chapters can be read independently. Note that there are many other programming @@ -9,4 +9,4 @@ familiar with using SQL commands to manipulate and query the database (see Part II) and of course with the programming language that the interface uses. -

Table of Contents

34. libpq — C Library
34.1. Database Connection Control Functions
34.2. Connection Status Functions
34.3. Command Execution Functions
34.4. Asynchronous Command Processing
34.5. Pipeline Mode
34.6. Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
34.7. Canceling Queries in Progress
34.8. The Fast-Path Interface
34.9. Asynchronous Notification
34.10. Functions Associated with the COPY Command
34.11. Control Functions
34.12. Miscellaneous Functions
34.13. Notice Processing
34.14. Event System
34.15. Environment Variables
34.16. The Password File
34.17. The Connection Service File
34.18. LDAP Lookup of Connection Parameters
34.19. SSL Support
34.20. Behavior in Threaded Programs
34.21. Building libpq Programs
34.22. Example Programs
35. Large Objects
35.1. Introduction
35.2. Implementation Features
35.3. Client Interfaces
35.4. Server-Side Functions
35.5. Example Program
36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
36.1. The Concept
36.2. Managing Database Connections
36.3. Running SQL Commands
36.4. Using Host Variables
36.5. Dynamic SQL
36.6. pgtypes Library
36.7. Using Descriptor Areas
36.8. Error Handling
36.9. Preprocessor Directives
36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs
36.11. Library Functions
36.12. Large Objects
36.13. C++ Applications
36.14. Embedded SQL Commands
36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode
36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode
36.17. Internals
37. The Information Schema
37.1. The Schema
37.2. Data Types
37.3. information_schema_catalog_name
37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations
37.5. applicable_roles
37.6. attributes
37.7. character_sets
37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage
37.9. check_constraints
37.10. collations
37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability
37.12. column_column_usage
37.13. column_domain_usage
37.14. column_options
37.15. column_privileges
37.16. column_udt_usage
37.17. columns
37.18. constraint_column_usage
37.19. constraint_table_usage
37.20. data_type_privileges
37.21. domain_constraints
37.22. domain_udt_usage
37.23. domains
37.24. element_types
37.25. enabled_roles
37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options
37.27. foreign_data_wrappers
37.28. foreign_server_options
37.29. foreign_servers
37.30. foreign_table_options
37.31. foreign_tables
37.32. key_column_usage
37.33. parameters
37.34. referential_constraints
37.35. role_column_grants
37.36. role_routine_grants
37.37. role_table_grants
37.38. role_udt_grants
37.39. role_usage_grants
37.40. routine_column_usage
37.41. routine_privileges
37.42. routine_routine_usage
37.43. routine_sequence_usage
37.44. routine_table_usage
37.45. routines
37.46. schemata
37.47. sequences
37.48. sql_features
37.49. sql_implementation_info
37.50. sql_parts
37.51. sql_sizing
37.52. table_constraints
37.53. table_privileges
37.54. tables
37.55. transforms
37.56. triggered_update_columns
37.57. triggers
37.58. udt_privileges
37.59. usage_privileges
37.60. user_defined_types
37.61. user_mapping_options
37.62. user_mappings
37.63. view_column_usage
37.64. view_routine_usage
37.65. view_table_usage
37.66. views
\ No newline at end of file +

Table of Contents

34. libpq — C Library
34.1. Database Connection Control Functions
34.2. Connection Status Functions
34.3. Command Execution Functions
34.4. Asynchronous Command Processing
34.5. Pipeline Mode
34.6. Retrieving Query Results Row-by-Row
34.7. Canceling Queries in Progress
34.8. The Fast-Path Interface
34.9. Asynchronous Notification
34.10. Functions Associated with the COPY Command
34.11. Control Functions
34.12. Miscellaneous Functions
34.13. Notice Processing
34.14. Event System
34.15. Environment Variables
34.16. The Password File
34.17. The Connection Service File
34.18. LDAP Lookup of Connection Parameters
34.19. SSL Support
34.20. Behavior in Threaded Programs
34.21. Building libpq Programs
34.22. Example Programs
35. Large Objects
35.1. Introduction
35.2. Implementation Features
35.3. Client Interfaces
35.4. Server-Side Functions
35.5. Example Program
36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
36.1. The Concept
36.2. Managing Database Connections
36.3. Running SQL Commands
36.4. Using Host Variables
36.5. Dynamic SQL
36.6. pgtypes Library
36.7. Using Descriptor Areas
36.8. Error Handling
36.9. Preprocessor Directives
36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs
36.11. Library Functions
36.12. Large Objects
36.13. C++ Applications
36.14. Embedded SQL Commands
36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode
36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode
36.17. Internals
37. The Information Schema
37.1. The Schema
37.2. Data Types
37.3. information_schema_catalog_name
37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations
37.5. applicable_roles
37.6. attributes
37.7. character_sets
37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage
37.9. check_constraints
37.10. collations
37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability
37.12. column_column_usage
37.13. column_domain_usage
37.14. column_options
37.15. column_privileges
37.16. column_udt_usage
37.17. columns
37.18. constraint_column_usage
37.19. constraint_table_usage
37.20. data_type_privileges
37.21. domain_constraints
37.22. domain_udt_usage
37.23. domains
37.24. element_types
37.25. enabled_roles
37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options
37.27. foreign_data_wrappers
37.28. foreign_server_options
37.29. foreign_servers
37.30. foreign_table_options
37.31. foreign_tables
37.32. key_column_usage
37.33. parameters
37.34. referential_constraints
37.35. role_column_grants
37.36. role_routine_grants
37.37. role_table_grants
37.38. role_udt_grants
37.39. role_usage_grants
37.40. routine_column_usage
37.41. routine_privileges
37.42. routine_routine_usage
37.43. routine_sequence_usage
37.44. routine_table_usage
37.45. routines
37.46. schemata
37.47. sequences
37.48. sql_features
37.49. sql_implementation_info
37.50. sql_parts
37.51. sql_sizing
37.52. table_constraints
37.53. table_privileges
37.54. tables
37.55. transforms
37.56. triggered_update_columns
37.57. triggers
37.58. udt_privileges
37.59. usage_privileges
37.60. user_defined_types
37.61. user_mapping_options
37.62. user_mappings
37.63. view_column_usage
37.64. view_routine_usage
37.65. view_table_usage
37.66. views
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/collation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/collation.html index 505d76a..2eeb947 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/collation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/collation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -24.2. Collation Support

24.2. Collation Support

+24.2. Collation Support

24.2. Collation Support

The collation feature allows specifying the sort order and character classification behavior of data per-column, or even per-operation. This alleviates the restriction that the @@ -414,4 +414,4 @@ CREATE COLLATION ignore_accents (provider = icu, locale = 'und-u-ks-level1-kc-tr normalize and is normalized to preprocess or check the strings, instead of using nondeterministic collations. There are different trade-offs for each approach. -

\ No newline at end of file +

\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/color-when.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/color-when.html index 8f68af8..8197e68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/color-when.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/color-when.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -N.1. When Color is Used

N.1. When Color is Used

+N.1. When Color is Used

N.1. When Color is Used

To use colorized output, set the environment variable PG_COLOR as follows: @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@

  • Otherwise, color is not used.

  • -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/color-which.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/color-which.html index eea1c4f..f3d6829 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/color-which.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/color-which.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -N.2. Configuring the Colors

    N.2. Configuring the Colors

    +N.2. Configuring the Colors

    N.2. Configuring the Colors

    The actual colors to be used are configured using the environment variable PG_COLORS (note plural). The value is a colon-separated list of @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ This color specification format is also used by other software packages such as GCC, GNU coreutils, and GNU grep. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/color.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/color.html index 5b3f280..0b5c321 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/color.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/color.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix N. Color Support

    Appendix N. Color Support

    +Appendix N. Color Support

    Appendix N. Color Support

    Most programs in the PostgreSQL package can produce colorized console output. This appendix describes how that is configured. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/config-setting.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/config-setting.html index a5d68b7..06f6339 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/config-setting.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/config-setting.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.1. Setting Parameters

    20.1. Setting Parameters

    20.1.1. Parameter Names and Values

    +20.1. Setting Parameters

    20.1. Setting Parameters

    20.1.1. Parameter Names and Values

    All parameter names are case-insensitive. Every parameter takes a value of one of five types: boolean, string, integer, floating point, or enumerated (enum). The type determines the syntax for setting the @@ -333,4 +333,4 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' their configurations all stored in one place, such as in a version control repository. (Storing database configuration files under version control is another good practice to consider.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/connect-estab.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/connect-estab.html index 87e3a8b..c1d4192 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/connect-estab.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/connect-estab.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -52.2. How Connections Are Established

    52.2. How Connections Are Established

    +52.2. How Connections Are Established

    52.2. How Connections Are Established

    PostgreSQL implements a process per user client/server model. In this model, every @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ process parses the query, creates an execution plan, executes the plan, and returns the retrieved rows to the client by transmitting them over the established connection. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/continuous-archiving.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/continuous-archiving.html index adc7ae7..a25d960 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/continuous-archiving.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/continuous-archiving.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -26.3. Continuous Archiving and Point-in-Time Recovery (PITR)

    26.3. Continuous Archiving and Point-in-Time Recovery (PITR)

    +26.3. Continuous Archiving and Point-in-Time Recovery (PITR)

    26.3. Continuous Archiving and Point-in-Time Recovery (PITR)

    At all times, PostgreSQL maintains a write ahead log (WAL) in the pg_wal/ subdirectory of the cluster's data directory. The log records @@ -754,4 +754,4 @@ archive_command = 'local_backup_script.sh "%p" "%f"' on. In the meantime, administrators might wish to reduce the number of page snapshots included in WAL by increasing the checkpoint interval parameters as much as feasible. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-delete.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-delete.html index 6dcc48a..16f026c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-delete.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-delete.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_build_sql_delete \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-insert.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-insert.html index d1158a0..6e137ff 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-insert.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-insert.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_build_sql_insert \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-update.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-update.html index 7b8d343..29a8f68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-update.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-build-sql-update.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_build_sql_update \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-cancel-query.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-cancel-query.html index 96d6294..a83a5d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-cancel-query.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-cancel-query.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_cancel_query \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-close.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-close.html index 5263873..1a44973 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-close.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-close.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_close \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect-u.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect-u.html index e2ca67b..83168b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect-u.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect-u.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_connect_u \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect.html index a07fdc4..0510872 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-connect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_connect \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-disconnect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-disconnect.html index 1a0a625..45e680f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-disconnect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-disconnect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_disconnect \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-error-message.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-error-message.html index ae55b48..496906b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-error-message.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-error-message.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_error_message \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-exec.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-exec.html index 8a25864..aaea2f6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-exec.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-exec.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_exec \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-fetch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-fetch.html index 68d2c12..a2f9e35 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-fetch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-fetch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_fetch \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-function.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-function.html index 0dfe220..bf95197 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-function.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-function.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-connections.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-connections.html index 049c21e..08019eb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-connections.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-connections.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -dblink_get_connections \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-notify.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-notify.html index 6051896..69406a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-notify.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-notify.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_get_notify \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-pkey.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-pkey.html index 579a8bc..986bca9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-pkey.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-pkey.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_get_pkey \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-result.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-result.html index 5bbea8e..aa5710e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-result.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-get-result.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_get_result \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-is-busy.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-is-busy.html index 3645e3e..9926f6e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-is-busy.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-is-busy.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_is_busy \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-open.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-open.html index 518b0f3..c18d744 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-open.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-open.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_open \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-send-query.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-send-query.html index 0fb28ee..1813448 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-send-query.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-dblink-send-query.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -dblink_send_query \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-client.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-client.html index 67cdca5..e0f0372 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-client.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-client.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -G.1. Client Applications

    G.1. Client Applications

    oid2name — resolve OIDs and file nodes in a PostgreSQL data directory
    vacuumlo — remove orphaned large objects from a PostgreSQL database

    +G.1. Client Applications

    G.1. Client Applications

    oid2name — resolve OIDs and file nodes in a PostgreSQL data directory
    vacuumlo — remove orphaned large objects from a PostgreSQL database

    This section covers PostgreSQL client applications in contrib. They can be run from anywhere, independent of where the database server resides. See also PostgreSQL Client Applications for information about client applications that are part of the core PostgreSQL distribution. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-server.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-server.html index 234af5f..42e6f1d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-server.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog-server.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -G.2. Server Applications

    G.2. Server Applications

    +G.2. Server Applications

    G.2. Server Applications

    Some applications run on the PostgreSQL server itself. Currently, no such applications are included in the contrib directory. See also PostgreSQL Server Applications for information about server applications that are part of the core PostgreSQL distribution. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog.html index c35e4fc..685da92 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-prog.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix G. Additional Supplied Programs

    Appendix G. Additional Supplied Programs

    Table of Contents

    G.1. Client Applications
    oid2name — resolve OIDs and file nodes in a PostgreSQL data directory
    vacuumlo — remove orphaned large objects from a PostgreSQL database
    G.2. Server Applications

    +Appendix G. Additional Supplied Programs

    Appendix G. Additional Supplied Programs

    Table of Contents

    G.1. Client Applications
    oid2name — resolve OIDs and file nodes in a PostgreSQL data directory
    vacuumlo — remove orphaned large objects from a PostgreSQL database
    G.2. Server Applications

    This appendix and the previous one contain information regarding the modules that can be found in the contrib directory of the PostgreSQL distribution. See Appendix F for @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ the bin directory of the PostgreSQL installation and can be used like any other program. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-spi.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-spi.html index 86764ae..c9febd9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-spi.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib-spi.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.41. spi
    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib.html index 4fd5858..1f0f43b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/contrib.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix F. Additional Supplied Modules

    Appendix F. Additional Supplied Modules

    Table of Contents

    F.1. adminpack
    F.2. amcheck
    F.2.1. Functions
    F.2.2. Optional heapallindexed Verification
    F.2.3. Using amcheck Effectively
    F.2.4. Repairing Corruption
    F.3. auth_delay
    F.3.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.3.2. Author
    F.4. auto_explain
    F.4.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.4.2. Example
    F.4.3. Author
    F.5. basebackup_to_shell
    F.5.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.5.2. Author
    F.6. basic_archive
    F.6.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.6.2. Notes
    F.6.3. Author
    F.7. bloom
    F.7.1. Parameters
    F.7.2. Examples
    F.7.3. Operator Class Interface
    F.7.4. Limitations
    F.7.5. Authors
    F.8. btree_gin
    F.8.1. Example Usage
    F.8.2. Authors
    F.9. btree_gist
    F.9.1. Example Usage
    F.9.2. Authors
    F.10. citext
    F.10.1. Rationale
    F.10.2. How to Use It
    F.10.3. String Comparison Behavior
    F.10.4. Limitations
    F.10.5. Author
    F.11. cube
    F.11.1. Syntax
    F.11.2. Precision
    F.11.3. Usage
    F.11.4. Defaults
    F.11.5. Notes
    F.11.6. Credits
    F.12. dblink
    dblink_connect — opens a persistent connection to a remote database
    dblink_connect_u — opens a persistent connection to a remote database, insecurely
    dblink_disconnect — closes a persistent connection to a remote database
    dblink — executes a query in a remote database
    dblink_exec — executes a command in a remote database
    dblink_open — opens a cursor in a remote database
    dblink_fetch — returns rows from an open cursor in a remote database
    dblink_close — closes a cursor in a remote database
    dblink_get_connections — returns the names of all open named dblink connections
    dblink_error_message — gets last error message on the named connection
    dblink_send_query — sends an async query to a remote database
    dblink_is_busy — checks if connection is busy with an async query
    dblink_get_notify — retrieve async notifications on a connection
    dblink_get_result — gets an async query result
    dblink_cancel_query — cancels any active query on the named connection
    dblink_get_pkey — returns the positions and field names of a relation's +Appendix F. Additional Supplied Modules

    Appendix F. Additional Supplied Modules

    Table of Contents

    F.1. adminpack
    F.2. amcheck
    F.2.1. Functions
    F.2.2. Optional heapallindexed Verification
    F.2.3. Using amcheck Effectively
    F.2.4. Repairing Corruption
    F.3. auth_delay
    F.3.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.3.2. Author
    F.4. auto_explain
    F.4.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.4.2. Example
    F.4.3. Author
    F.5. basebackup_to_shell
    F.5.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.5.2. Author
    F.6. basic_archive
    F.6.1. Configuration Parameters
    F.6.2. Notes
    F.6.3. Author
    F.7. bloom
    F.7.1. Parameters
    F.7.2. Examples
    F.7.3. Operator Class Interface
    F.7.4. Limitations
    F.7.5. Authors
    F.8. btree_gin
    F.8.1. Example Usage
    F.8.2. Authors
    F.9. btree_gist
    F.9.1. Example Usage
    F.9.2. Authors
    F.10. citext
    F.10.1. Rationale
    F.10.2. How to Use It
    F.10.3. String Comparison Behavior
    F.10.4. Limitations
    F.10.5. Author
    F.11. cube
    F.11.1. Syntax
    F.11.2. Precision
    F.11.3. Usage
    F.11.4. Defaults
    F.11.5. Notes
    F.11.6. Credits
    F.12. dblink
    dblink_connect — opens a persistent connection to a remote database
    dblink_connect_u — opens a persistent connection to a remote database, insecurely
    dblink_disconnect — closes a persistent connection to a remote database
    dblink — executes a query in a remote database
    dblink_exec — executes a command in a remote database
    dblink_open — opens a cursor in a remote database
    dblink_fetch — returns rows from an open cursor in a remote database
    dblink_close — closes a cursor in a remote database
    dblink_get_connections — returns the names of all open named dblink connections
    dblink_error_message — gets last error message on the named connection
    dblink_send_query — sends an async query to a remote database
    dblink_is_busy — checks if connection is busy with an async query
    dblink_get_notify — retrieve async notifications on a connection
    dblink_get_result — gets an async query result
    dblink_cancel_query — cancels any active query on the named connection
    dblink_get_pkey — returns the positions and field names of a relation's primary key fields
    dblink_build_sql_insert — builds an INSERT statement using a local tuple, replacing the @@ -84,4 +84,4 @@ CREATE EXTENSION module_name; by way of shared_preload_libraries. See the documentation of each module for details. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/creating-cluster.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/creating-cluster.html index 3d87f20..182603c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/creating-cluster.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/creating-cluster.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.2. Creating a Database Cluster

    19.2. Creating a Database Cluster

    +19.2. Creating a Database Cluster

    19.2. Creating a Database Cluster

    Before you can do anything, you must initialize a database storage area on disk. We call this a database cluster. (The SQL standard uses the term catalog cluster.) A @@ -200,4 +200,4 @@ postgres$ initdb -D /usr/local/pgsql/data it. That approach might relieve the DBA from having to deal with some of the idiosyncrasies of NFS, but of course the complexity of managing remote storage then happens at other levels. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/cube.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/cube.html index 19db46a..a73f02e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/cube.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/cube.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.11. cube

    F.11. cube

    +F.11. cube

    F.11. cube

    This module implements a data type cube for representing multidimensional cubes.

    @@ -388,4 +388,4 @@ t July 2006. These include cube(float8[], float8[]) and cleaning up the code to use the V1 call protocol instead of the deprecated V0 protocol. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-rmgr.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-rmgr.html index 6126fe8..462d875 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-rmgr.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-rmgr.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 66. Custom WAL Resource Managers

    Chapter 66. Custom WAL Resource Managers

    +Chapter 66. Custom WAL Resource Managers

    Chapter 66. Custom WAL Resource Managers

    This chapter explains the interface between the core PostgreSQL system and custom WAL resource managers, which enable extensions to integrate directly with the WAL. @@ -78,4 +78,4 @@ extern void RegisterCustomRmgr(RmgrId rmid, RmgrData *rmgr); custom WAL records may exist in the system. Otherwise PostgreSQL will not be able to apply or decode the custom WAL records, which may prevent the server from starting. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-execution.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-execution.html index 9a32f38..a18841f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-execution.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-execution.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -61.3. Executing Custom Scans

    61.3. Executing Custom Scans

    +61.3. Executing Custom Scans

    61.3. Executing Custom Scans

    When a CustomScan is executed, its execution state is represented by a CustomScanState, which is declared as follows: @@ -136,4 +136,4 @@ void (*ExplainCustomScan) (CustomScanState *node, ScanState, such as the target list and scan relation, will be shown even without this callback, but the callback allows the display of additional, private state. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-path.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-path.html index bb0fc6d..a1f9924 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-path.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-path.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -61.1. Creating Custom Scan Paths

    61.1. Creating Custom Scan Paths

    +61.1. Creating Custom Scan Paths

    61.1. Creating Custom Scan Paths

    A custom scan provider will typically add paths for a base relation by setting the following hook, which is called after the core code has generated all the access paths it can for the relation (except for @@ -98,4 +98,4 @@ List *(*ReparameterizeCustomPathByChild) (PlannerInfo *root, reparameterize_path_by_child, adjust_appendrel_attrs or adjust_appendrel_attrs_multilevel as required. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-plan.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-plan.html index a253e4d..b16656f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-plan.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan-plan.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -61.2. Creating Custom Scan Plans

    61.2. Creating Custom Scan Plans

    +61.2. Creating Custom Scan Plans

    61.2. Creating Custom Scan Plans

    A custom scan is represented in a finished plan tree using the following structure:

    @@ -64,4 +64,4 @@ Node *(*CreateCustomScanState) (CustomScan *cscan);
         stage; after ExecInitCustomScan performs basic initialization,
         the BeginCustomScan callback will be invoked to give the
         custom scan provider a chance to do whatever else is needed.
    -   

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan.html index 76e8b9c..4a57578 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/custom-scan.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 61. Writing a Custom Scan Provider

    Chapter 61. Writing a Custom Scan Provider

    +Chapter 61. Writing a Custom Scan Provider

    Chapter 61. Writing a Custom Scan Provider

    PostgreSQL supports a set of experimental facilities which are intended to allow extension modules to add new scan types to the system. Unlike a foreign data wrapper, which is only @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ Finally, it must be possible to execute the plan and generate the same results that would have been generated for any other access path targeting the same relation. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/database-roles.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/database-roles.html index 919b371..48a7f8b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/database-roles.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/database-roles.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -22.1. Database Roles

    22.1. Database Roles

    +22.1. Database Roles

    22.1. Database Roles

    Database roles are conceptually completely separate from operating system users. In practice it might be convenient to maintain a correspondence, but this is not required. Database roles @@ -67,4 +67,4 @@ SELECT rolname FROM pg_roles; identity determines the set of privileges available to a connected client, it is important to carefully configure privileges when setting up a multiuser environment. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-binary.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-binary.html index 624fca7..4020ebe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-binary.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-binary.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.4. Binary Data Types

    8.4. Binary Data Types

    +8.4. Binary Data Types

    8.4. Binary Data Types

    The bytea data type allows storage of binary strings; see Table 8.6.

    Table 8.6. Binary Data Types

    NameStorage SizeDescription
    bytea1 or 4 bytes plus the actual binary stringvariable-length binary string

    @@ -129,4 +129,4 @@ SELECT 'abc \153\154\155 \052\251\124'::bytea; unescaping bytea strings. For example, you might also have to escape line feeds and carriage returns if your interface automatically translates these. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-bit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-bit.html index 5fdaabc..03992d5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-bit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-bit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.10. Bit String Types

    8.10. Bit String Types

    +8.10. Bit String Types

    8.10. Bit String Types

    Bit strings are strings of 1's and 0's. They can be used to store or visualize bit masks. There are two SQL bit types: bit(n) and bit @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ SELECT * FROM test; 5 or 8 bytes overhead depending on the length of the string (but long values may be compressed or moved out-of-line, as explained in Section 8.3 for character strings). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-boolean.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-boolean.html index b833b9c..2e58a8b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-boolean.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-boolean.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.6. Boolean Type

    8.6. Boolean Type

    +8.6. Boolean Type

    8.6. Boolean Type

    PostgreSQL provides the standard SQL type boolean; see Table 8.19. @@ -55,4 +55,4 @@ SELECT * FROM test1 WHERE a; example NULL::boolean. Conversely, the cast can be omitted from a string-literal Boolean value in contexts where the parser can deduce that the literal must be of type boolean. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-character.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-character.html index 4e127d0..b1b9a10 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-character.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-character.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.3. Character Types

    8.3. Character Types

    Table 8.4. Character Types

    NameDescription
    character varying(n), varchar(n)variable-length with limit
    character(n), char(n)fixed-length, blank padded
    textvariable unlimited length

    +8.3. Character Types

    8.3. Character Types

    Table 8.4. Character Types

    NameDescription
    character varying(n), varchar(n)variable-length with limit
    character(n), char(n)fixed-length, blank padded
    textvariable unlimited length

    Table 8.4 shows the general-purpose character types available in PostgreSQL. @@ -139,4 +139,4 @@ SELECT b, char_length(b) FROM test2; only uses one byte of storage, and therefore can store only a single ASCII character. It is used in the system catalogs as a simplistic enumeration type. -

    Table 8.5. Special Character Types

    NameStorage SizeDescription
    "char"1 bytesingle-byte internal type
    name64 bytesinternal type for object names

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table 8.5. Special Character Types

    NameStorage SizeDescription
    "char"1 bytesingle-byte internal type
    name64 bytesinternal type for object names

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-datetime.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-datetime.html index f16f5fe..8a4534d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-datetime.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-datetime.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.5. Date/Time Types

    8.5. Date/Time Types

    +8.5. Date/Time Types

    8.5. Date/Time Types

    PostgreSQL supports the full set of SQL date and time types, shown in Table 8.9. The operations available on these data types are described in @@ -547,4 +547,4 @@ SELECT EXTRACT(days from '80 hours'::interval); The output of the iso_8601 style matches the format with designators described in section 4.4.3.2 of the ISO 8601 standard. -

    Table 8.18. Interval Output Style Examples

    Style SpecificationYear-Month IntervalDay-Time IntervalMixed Interval
    sql_standard1-23 4:05:06-1-2 +3 -4:05:06
    postgres1 year 2 mons3 days 04:05:06-1 year -2 mons +3 days -04:05:06
    postgres_verbose@ 1 year 2 mons@ 3 days 4 hours 5 mins 6 secs@ 1 year 2 mons -3 days 4 hours 5 mins 6 secs ago
    iso_8601P1Y2MP3DT4H5M6SP-1Y-2M3D​T-4H-5M-6S

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table 8.18. Interval Output Style Examples

    Style SpecificationYear-Month IntervalDay-Time IntervalMixed Interval
    sql_standard1-23 4:05:06-1-2 +3 -4:05:06
    postgres1 year 2 mons3 days 04:05:06-1 year -2 mons +3 days -04:05:06
    postgres_verbose@ 1 year 2 mons@ 3 days 4 hours 5 mins 6 secs@ 1 year 2 mons -3 days 4 hours 5 mins 6 secs ago
    iso_8601P1Y2MP3DT4H5M6SP-1Y-2M3D​T-4H-5M-6S

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-enum.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-enum.html index 33952e9..c54620c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-enum.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-enum.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.7. Enumerated Types

    8.7. Enumerated Types

    +8.7. Enumerated Types

    8.7. Enumerated Types

    Enumerated (enum) types are data types that comprise a static, ordered set of values. They are equivalent to the enum @@ -112,4 +112,4 @@ SELECT person.name, holidays.num_weeks FROM person, holidays kept in the system catalog pg_enum. Querying this catalog directly can be useful. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-geometric.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-geometric.html index db70aa6..2f876e2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-geometric.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-geometric.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.8. Geometric Types

    8.8. Geometric Types

    +8.8. Geometric Types

    8.8. Geometric Types

    Geometric data types represent two-dimensional spatial objects. Table 8.20 shows the geometric types available in PostgreSQL. @@ -149,4 +149,4 @@ circle.

    Circles are output using the first syntax. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-json.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-json.html index 2fb1553..54cab9a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-json.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-json.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.14. JSON Types

    8.14. JSON Types

    +8.14. JSON Types

    8.14. JSON Types

    JSON data types are for storing JSON (JavaScript Object Notation) data, as specified in RFC 7159. Such data can also be stored as text, but @@ -727,4 +727,4 @@ UPDATE table_name SET jsonb_field[1]['a'] = '1'; For this purpose, the term value includes array elements, though JSON terminology sometimes considers array elements distinct from values within objects. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-money.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-money.html index 9aa7a96..7b78270 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-money.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-money.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.2. Monetary Types

    8.2. Monetary Types

    +8.2. Monetary Types

    8.2. Monetary Types

    The money type stores a currency amount with a fixed fractional precision; see Table 8.3. The fractional precision is determined by the database's lc_monetary setting. @@ -41,4 +41,4 @@ SELECT '52093.89'::money::numeric::float8; When a money value is divided by another money value, the result is double precision (i.e., a pure number, not money); the currency units cancel each other out in the division. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-net-types.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-net-types.html index 3a8ef3c..5392173 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-net-types.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-net-types.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.9. Network Address Types

    8.9. Network Address Types

    +8.9. Network Address Types

    8.9. Network Address Types

    PostgreSQL offers data types to store IPv4, IPv6, and MAC addresses, as shown in Table 8.21. It is better to use these types instead of plain text types to store @@ -129,4 +129,4 @@ SELECT macaddr8_set7bit('08:00:2b:01:02:03');

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-numeric.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-numeric.html index e8df3c1..b9bf037 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-numeric.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-numeric.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.1. Numeric Types

    8.1. Numeric Types

    +8.1. Numeric Types

    8.1. Numeric Types

    Numeric types consist of two-, four-, and eight-byte integers, four- and eight-byte floating-point numbers, and selectable-precision decimals. Table 8.2 lists the @@ -367,4 +367,4 @@ ALTER SEQUENCE tablename_


    Prev Up Next
    Chapter 8. Data Types Home 8.2. Monetary Types
    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-oid.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-oid.html index 8e20ff7..679085f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-oid.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-oid.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.19. Object Identifier Types

    8.19. Object Identifier Types

    +8.19. Object Identifier Types

    8.19. Object Identifier Types

    Object identifiers (OIDs) are used internally by PostgreSQL as primary keys for various system tables. @@ -163,4 +163,4 @@ WHERE ... physical location of the row within its table.

    (The system columns are further explained in Section 5.5.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pg-lsn.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pg-lsn.html index ba8fa84..ab31591 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pg-lsn.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pg-lsn.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.20. pg_lsn Type

    8.20. pg_lsn Type

    +8.20. pg_lsn Type

    8.20. pg_lsn Type

    The pg_lsn data type can be used to store LSN (Log Sequence Number) data which is a pointer to a location in the WAL. This type is a representation of XLogRecPtr and an internal system type of @@ -19,4 +19,4 @@ the calculated LSN should be in the range of pg_lsn type, i.e., between 0/0 and FFFFFFFF/FFFFFFFF. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pseudo.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pseudo.html index 6c24833..43be0c8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pseudo.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-pseudo.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.21. Pseudo-Types

    8.21. Pseudo-Types

    +8.21. Pseudo-Types

    8.21. Pseudo-Types

    The PostgreSQL type system contains a number of special-purpose entries that are collectively called pseudo-types. A pseudo-type cannot be used as a @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@ follow this coding rule: do not create any function that is declared to return internal unless it has at least one internal argument. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-textsearch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-textsearch.html index 2f4e4a9..521ca4a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-textsearch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-textsearch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.11. Text Search Types

    8.11. Text Search Types

    +8.11. Text Search Types

    8.11. Text Search Types

    PostgreSQL provides two data types that are designed to support full text search, which is the activity of searching through a collection of natural-language documents @@ -193,4 +193,4 @@ SELECT to_tsvector( 'postgraduate' ), to_tsquery( 'postgres:*' ); 'postgradu':1 | 'postgr':*

    which will match the stemmed form of postgraduate. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-uuid.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-uuid.html index 63b2e43..34c23be 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-uuid.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-uuid.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.12. UUID Type

    8.12. UUID Type

    +8.12. UUID Type

    8.12. UUID Type

    The data type uuid stores Universally Unique Identifiers (UUID) as defined by RFC 4122, ISO/IEC 9834-8:2005, and related standards. @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@ a0ee-bc99-9c0b-4ef8-bb6d-6bb9-bd38-0a11

    See Section 9.14 for how to generate a UUID in PostgreSQL. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-xml.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-xml.html index 4acc1c6..8d33bc2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-xml.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype-xml.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.13. XML Type

    8.13. XML Type

    +8.13. XML Type

    8.13. XML Type

    The xml data type can be used to store XML data. Its advantage over storing XML data in a text field is that it checks the input values for well-formedness, and there are support @@ -148,4 +148,4 @@ SET xmloption TO { DOCUMENT | CONTENT }; up full-document searches of XML data. The necessary preprocessing support is, however, not yet available in the PostgreSQL distribution. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype.html index a0bdb87..0cd966d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datatype.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 8. Data Types

    Chapter 8. Data Types

    Table of Contents

    8.1. Numeric Types
    8.1.1. Integer Types
    8.1.2. Arbitrary Precision Numbers
    8.1.3. Floating-Point Types
    8.1.4. Serial Types
    8.2. Monetary Types
    8.3. Character Types
    8.4. Binary Data Types
    8.4.1. bytea Hex Format
    8.4.2. bytea Escape Format
    8.5. Date/Time Types
    8.5.1. Date/Time Input
    8.5.2. Date/Time Output
    8.5.3. Time Zones
    8.5.4. Interval Input
    8.5.5. Interval Output
    8.6. Boolean Type
    8.7. Enumerated Types
    8.7.1. Declaration of Enumerated Types
    8.7.2. Ordering
    8.7.3. Type Safety
    8.7.4. Implementation Details
    8.8. Geometric Types
    8.8.1. Points
    8.8.2. Lines
    8.8.3. Line Segments
    8.8.4. Boxes
    8.8.5. Paths
    8.8.6. Polygons
    8.8.7. Circles
    8.9. Network Address Types
    8.9.1. inet
    8.9.2. cidr
    8.9.3. inet vs. cidr
    8.9.4. macaddr
    8.9.5. macaddr8
    8.10. Bit String Types
    8.11. Text Search Types
    8.11.1. tsvector
    8.11.2. tsquery
    8.12. UUID Type
    8.13. XML Type
    8.13.1. Creating XML Values
    8.13.2. Encoding Handling
    8.13.3. Accessing XML Values
    8.14. JSON Types
    8.14.1. JSON Input and Output Syntax
    8.14.2. Designing JSON Documents
    8.14.3. jsonb Containment and Existence
    8.14.4. jsonb Indexing
    8.14.5. jsonb Subscripting
    8.14.6. Transforms
    8.14.7. jsonpath Type
    8.15. Arrays
    8.15.1. Declaration of Array Types
    8.15.2. Array Value Input
    8.15.3. Accessing Arrays
    8.15.4. Modifying Arrays
    8.15.5. Searching in Arrays
    8.15.6. Array Input and Output Syntax
    8.16. Composite Types
    8.16.1. Declaration of Composite Types
    8.16.2. Constructing Composite Values
    8.16.3. Accessing Composite Types
    8.16.4. Modifying Composite Types
    8.16.5. Using Composite Types in Queries
    8.16.6. Composite Type Input and Output Syntax
    8.17. Range Types
    8.17.1. Built-in Range and Multirange Types
    8.17.2. Examples
    8.17.3. Inclusive and Exclusive Bounds
    8.17.4. Infinite (Unbounded) Ranges
    8.17.5. Range Input/Output
    8.17.6. Constructing Ranges and Multiranges
    8.17.7. Discrete Range Types
    8.17.8. Defining New Range Types
    8.17.9. Indexing
    8.17.10. Constraints on Ranges
    8.18. Domain Types
    8.19. Object Identifier Types
    8.20. pg_lsn Type
    8.21. Pseudo-Types

    +Chapter 8. Data Types

    Chapter 8. Data Types

    Table of Contents

    8.1. Numeric Types
    8.1.1. Integer Types
    8.1.2. Arbitrary Precision Numbers
    8.1.3. Floating-Point Types
    8.1.4. Serial Types
    8.2. Monetary Types
    8.3. Character Types
    8.4. Binary Data Types
    8.4.1. bytea Hex Format
    8.4.2. bytea Escape Format
    8.5. Date/Time Types
    8.5.1. Date/Time Input
    8.5.2. Date/Time Output
    8.5.3. Time Zones
    8.5.4. Interval Input
    8.5.5. Interval Output
    8.6. Boolean Type
    8.7. Enumerated Types
    8.7.1. Declaration of Enumerated Types
    8.7.2. Ordering
    8.7.3. Type Safety
    8.7.4. Implementation Details
    8.8. Geometric Types
    8.8.1. Points
    8.8.2. Lines
    8.8.3. Line Segments
    8.8.4. Boxes
    8.8.5. Paths
    8.8.6. Polygons
    8.8.7. Circles
    8.9. Network Address Types
    8.9.1. inet
    8.9.2. cidr
    8.9.3. inet vs. cidr
    8.9.4. macaddr
    8.9.5. macaddr8
    8.10. Bit String Types
    8.11. Text Search Types
    8.11.1. tsvector
    8.11.2. tsquery
    8.12. UUID Type
    8.13. XML Type
    8.13.1. Creating XML Values
    8.13.2. Encoding Handling
    8.13.3. Accessing XML Values
    8.14. JSON Types
    8.14.1. JSON Input and Output Syntax
    8.14.2. Designing JSON Documents
    8.14.3. jsonb Containment and Existence
    8.14.4. jsonb Indexing
    8.14.5. jsonb Subscripting
    8.14.6. Transforms
    8.14.7. jsonpath Type
    8.15. Arrays
    8.15.1. Declaration of Array Types
    8.15.2. Array Value Input
    8.15.3. Accessing Arrays
    8.15.4. Modifying Arrays
    8.15.5. Searching in Arrays
    8.15.6. Array Input and Output Syntax
    8.16. Composite Types
    8.16.1. Declaration of Composite Types
    8.16.2. Constructing Composite Values
    8.16.3. Accessing Composite Types
    8.16.4. Modifying Composite Types
    8.16.5. Using Composite Types in Queries
    8.16.6. Composite Type Input and Output Syntax
    8.17. Range Types
    8.17.1. Built-in Range and Multirange Types
    8.17.2. Examples
    8.17.3. Inclusive and Exclusive Bounds
    8.17.4. Infinite (Unbounded) Ranges
    8.17.5. Range Input/Output
    8.17.6. Constructing Ranges and Multiranges
    8.17.7. Discrete Range Types
    8.17.8. Defining New Range Types
    8.17.9. Indexing
    8.17.10. Constraints on Ranges
    8.18. Domain Types
    8.19. Object Identifier Types
    8.20. pg_lsn Type
    8.21. Pseudo-Types

    PostgreSQL has a rich set of native data types available to users. Users can add new types to PostgreSQL using the CREATE TYPE command. @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ Some of the input and output functions are not invertible, i.e., the result of an output function might lose accuracy when compared to the original input. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-appendix.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-appendix.html index cc5651d..c2cfe11 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-appendix.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-appendix.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix B. Date/Time Support

    Appendix B. Date/Time Support

    +Appendix B. Date/Time Support

    Appendix B. Date/Time Support

    PostgreSQL uses an internal heuristic parser for all date/time input support. Dates and times are input as strings, and are broken up into distinct fields with a preliminary @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ This appendix includes information on the content of these lookup tables and describes the steps used by the parser to decode dates and times. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-config-files.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-config-files.html index b3877d3..2b670c9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-config-files.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-config-files.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -B.4. Date/Time Configuration Files

    B.4. Date/Time Configuration Files

    +B.4. Date/Time Configuration Files

    B.4. Date/Time Configuration Files

    Since timezone abbreviations are not well standardized, PostgreSQL provides a means to customize the set of abbreviations accepted by the server. The @@ -95,4 +95,4 @@ If you modify files in .../share/timezonesets/, it is up to you to make backups — a normal database dump will not include this directory. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-input-rules.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-input-rules.html index 0dbac90..1cc9c93 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-input-rules.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-input-rules.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -B.1. Date/Time Input Interpretation

    B.1. Date/Time Input Interpretation

    +B.1. Date/Time Input Interpretation

    B.1. Date/Time Input Interpretation

    Date/time input strings are decoded using the following procedure.

    1. Break the input string into tokens and categorize each token as @@ -71,4 +71,4 @@ Gregorian years AD 1–99 can be entered by using 4 digits with leading zeros (e.g., 0099 is AD 99).

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-invalid-input.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-invalid-input.html index 16a0330..fb438fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-invalid-input.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-invalid-input.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -B.2. Handling of Invalid or Ambiguous Timestamps

    B.2. Handling of Invalid or Ambiguous Timestamps

    +B.2. Handling of Invalid or Ambiguous Timestamps

    B.2. Handling of Invalid or Ambiguous Timestamps

    Ordinarily, if a date/time string is syntactically valid but contains out-of-range field values, an error will be thrown. For example, input specifying the 31st of February will be rejected. @@ -59,4 +59,4 @@ abbreviation that corresponds to a fixed UTC offset. The rule just given applies only when it is necessary to infer a UTC offset for a time zone in which the offset varies. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-julian-dates.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-julian-dates.html index dea1b65..b9710f3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-julian-dates.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-julian-dates.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -B.7. Julian Dates

    B.7. Julian Dates

    +B.7. Julian Dates

    B.7. Julian Dates

    The Julian Date system is a method for numbering days. It is unrelated to the Julian calendar, though it is confusingly @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ 2459389 (1 row)

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-keywords.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-keywords.html index ff0cd34..11bc78a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-keywords.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-keywords.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -B.3. Date/Time Key Words

    B.3. Date/Time Key Words

    +B.3. Date/Time Key Words

    B.3. Date/Time Key Words

    Table B.1 shows the tokens that are recognized as names of months.

    Table B.1. Month Names

    MonthAbbreviations
    JanuaryJan
    FebruaryFeb
    MarchMar
    AprilApr
    May 
    JuneJun
    JulyJul
    AugustAug
    SeptemberSep, Sept
    OctoberOct
    NovemberNov
    DecemberDec

    @@ -8,4 +8,4 @@

    Table B.2. Day of the Week Names

    DayAbbreviations
    SundaySun
    MondayMon
    TuesdayTue, Tues
    WednesdayWed, Weds
    ThursdayThu, Thur, Thurs
    FridayFri
    SaturdaySat

    Table B.3 shows the tokens that serve various modifier purposes. -

    Table B.3. Date/Time Field Modifiers

    IdentifierDescription
    AMTime is before 12:00
    ATIgnored
    JULIAN, JD, JNext field is Julian Date
    ONIgnored
    PMTime is on or after 12:00
    TNext field is time

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table B.3. Date/Time Field Modifiers

    IdentifierDescription
    AMTime is before 12:00
    ATIgnored
    JULIAN, JD, JNext field is Julian Date
    ONIgnored
    PMTime is on or after 12:00
    TNext field is time

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-posix-timezone-specs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-posix-timezone-specs.html index 1b0bcaf..77792c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-posix-timezone-specs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-posix-timezone-specs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -B.5. POSIX Time Zone Specifications

    B.5. POSIX Time Zone Specifications

    +B.5. POSIX Time Zone Specifications

    B.5. POSIX Time Zone Specifications

    PostgreSQL can accept time zone specifications that are written according to the POSIX standard's rules for the TZ environment @@ -132,4 +132,4 @@ zone abbreviation(s). For example, SET TIMEZONE TO FOOBAR0 will work, leaving the system effectively using a rather peculiar abbreviation for UTC. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-units-history.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-units-history.html index 023f4cf..d42e3ed 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-units-history.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/datetime-units-history.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -B.6. History of Units

    B.6. History of Units

    +B.6. History of Units

    B.6. History of Units

    The SQL standard states that Within the definition of a datetime literal, the datetime values are constrained by the natural rules for dates and @@ -84,4 +84,4 @@ $ cal 9 1752 The People's Republic of China uses the Gregorian calendar for civil purposes. The Chinese calendar is used for determining festivals. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dblink.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dblink.html index ca4f244..28e3a3a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dblink.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dblink.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.12. dblink \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-basics.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-basics.html index 81e8632..272487d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-basics.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-basics.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.1. Table Basics

    5.1. Table Basics

    +5.1. Table Basics

    5.1. Table Basics

    A table in a relational database is much like a table on paper: It consists of rows and columns. The number and order of the columns is fixed, and each column has a name. The number of rows is @@ -98,4 +98,4 @@ DROP TABLE products; security, or convenience. If you are eager to fill your tables with data now you can skip ahead to Chapter 6 and read the rest of this chapter later. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-constraints.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-constraints.html index b567f7c..80315b2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-constraints.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-constraints.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.4. Constraints

    5.4. Constraints

    +5.4. Constraints

    5.4. Constraints

    Data types are a way to limit the kind of data that can be stored in a table. For many applications, however, the constraint they provide is too coarse. For example, a column containing a product @@ -573,16 +573,16 @@ CREATE TABLE posts ( referencing column(s) as NOT NULL.

    A foreign key must reference columns that either are a primary key or - form a unique constraint. This means that the referenced columns always - have an index (the one underlying the primary key or unique constraint); - so checks on whether a referencing row has a match will be efficient. - Since a DELETE of a row from the referenced table - or an UPDATE of a referenced column will require - a scan of the referencing table for rows matching the old value, it - is often a good idea to index the referencing columns too. Because this - is not always needed, and there are many choices available on how - to index, declaration of a foreign key constraint does not - automatically create an index on the referencing columns. + form a unique constraint, or are columns from a non-partial unique index. + This means that the referenced columns always have an index to allow + efficient lookups on whether a referencing row has a match. Since a + DELETE of a row from the referenced table or an + UPDATE of a referenced column will require a scan of + the referencing table for rows matching the old value, it is often a good + idea to index the referencing columns too. Because this is not always + needed, and there are many choices available on how to index, the + declaration of a foreign key constraint does not automatically create an + index on the referencing columns.

    More information about updating and deleting data is in Chapter 6. Also see the description of foreign key constraint syntax in the reference documentation for @@ -604,4 +604,4 @@ CREATE TABLE circles (

    Adding an exclusion constraint will automatically create an index of the type specified in the constraint declaration. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-default.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-default.html index 43c7883..1ee15e6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-default.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-default.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.2. Default Values

    5.2. Default Values

    +5.2. Default Values

    5.2. Default Values

    A column can be assigned a default value. When a new row is created and no values are specified for some of the columns, those columns will be filled with their respective default values. A @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ CREATE TABLE products ( );

    The SERIAL shorthand is discussed further in Section 8.1.4. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-depend.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-depend.html index ed1be7d..f529e15 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-depend.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-depend.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.14. Dependency Tracking

    5.14. Dependency Tracking

    +5.14. Dependency Tracking

    5.14. Dependency Tracking

    When you create complex database structures involving many tables with foreign key constraints, views, triggers, functions, etc. you implicitly create a net of dependencies between the objects. @@ -96,4 +96,4 @@ END; then the function's dependency on the my_colors table will be known and enforced by DROP. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-foreign-data.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-foreign-data.html index e3b2ed9..764476c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-foreign-data.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-foreign-data.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.12. Foreign Data

    5.12. Foreign Data

    +5.12. Foreign Data

    5.12. Foreign Data

    PostgreSQL implements portions of the SQL/MED specification, allowing you to access data that resides outside PostgreSQL using regular SQL queries. Such data is referred to as @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@ CREATE USER MAPPING, CREATE FOREIGN TABLE, and IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-generated-columns.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-generated-columns.html index 707b52a..f621792 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-generated-columns.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-generated-columns.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.3. Generated Columns

    5.3. Generated Columns

    +5.3. Generated Columns

    5.3. Generated Columns

    A generated column is a special column that is always computed from other columns. Thus, it is for columns what a view is for tables. There are two kinds of generated columns: stored and virtual. A stored generated column @@ -82,4 +82,4 @@ CREATE TABLE people ( generated columns. But conversely, it is not allowed to access generated columns in BEFORE triggers.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-inherit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-inherit.html index c2e7efa..beeeb0f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-inherit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-inherit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.10. Inheritance

    5.10. Inheritance

    +5.10. Inheritance

    5.10. Inheritance

    PostgreSQL implements table inheritance, which can be a useful tool for database designers. (SQL:1999 and later define a type inheritance feature, which differs in many @@ -286,4 +286,4 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); implemented for declarative partitioning. Considerable care is needed in deciding whether partitioning with legacy inheritance is useful for your application. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-others.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-others.html index 58a9b7a..b1566be 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-others.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-others.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.13. Other Database Objects

    5.13. Other Database Objects

    +5.13. Other Database Objects

    5.13. Other Database Objects

    Tables are the central objects in a relational database structure, because they hold your data. But they are not the only objects that exist in a database. Many other kinds of objects can be @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@

    Detailed information on these topics appears in Part V. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-partitioning.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-partitioning.html index d818fe4..7b3d0fd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-partitioning.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-partitioning.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.11. Table Partitioning

    5.11. Table Partitioning

    +5.11. Table Partitioning

    5.11. Table Partitioning

    PostgreSQL supports basic table partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement partitioning as part of your database design. @@ -368,7 +368,7 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02

     CREATE INDEX measurement_usls_idx ON ONLY measurement (unitsales);
     
    -CREATE INDEX measurement_usls_200602_idx
    +CREATE INDEX CONCURRENTLY measurement_usls_200602_idx
         ON measurement_y2006m02 (unitsales);
     ALTER INDEX measurement_usls_idx
         ATTACH PARTITION measurement_usls_200602_idx;
    @@ -449,7 +449,9 @@ ALTER INDEX measurement_city_id_logdate_key
             Using ONLY to add or drop a constraint on only
             the partitioned table is supported as long as there are no
             partitions.  Once partitions exist, using ONLY
    -        will result in an error.  Instead, constraints on the partitions
    +        will result in an error for any constraints other than
    +        UNIQUE and PRIMARY KEY.
    +        Instead, constraints on the partitions
             themselves can be added and (if they are not present in the parent
             table) dropped.
            

  • @@ -989,4 +991,4 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; painfully slow. Simulations of the intended workload are often beneficial for optimizing the partitioning strategy. Never just assume that more partitions are better than fewer partitions, nor vice-versa. -

  • \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-priv.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-priv.html index c19149c..05bd49f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-priv.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-priv.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.7. Privileges

    5.7. Privileges

    +5.7. Privileges

    5.7. Privileges

    When an object is created, it is assigned an owner. The owner is normally the role that executed the creation statement. For most kinds of objects, the initial state is that only the owner @@ -249,9 +249,16 @@ REVOKE ALL ON accounts FROM PUBLIC;

    Table 5.2. Summary of Access Privileges

    Object TypeAll PrivilegesDefault PUBLIC Privilegespsql Command
    DATABASECTcTc\l
    DOMAINUU\dD+
    FUNCTION or PROCEDUREXX\df+
    FOREIGN DATA WRAPPERUnone\dew+
    FOREIGN SERVERUnone\des+
    LANGUAGEUU\dL+
    LARGE OBJECTrwnone\dl+
    PARAMETERsAnone\dconfig+
    SCHEMAUCnone\dn+
    SEQUENCErwUnone\dp
    TABLE (and table-like objects)arwdDxtnone\dp
    Table columnarwxnone\dp
    TABLESPACECnone\db+
    TYPEUU\dT+

    The privileges that have been granted for a particular object are - displayed as a list of aclitem entries, where each - aclitem describes the permissions of one grantee that - have been granted by a particular grantor. For example, + displayed as a list of aclitem entries, each having the + format: +

    +grantee=privilege-abbreviation[*].../grantor
    +

    + Each aclitem lists all the permissions of one grantee that + have been granted by a particular grantor. Specific privileges are + represented by one-letter abbreviations from + Table 5.1, with * + appended if the privilege was granted with grant option. For example, calvin=r*w/hobbes specifies that the role calvin has the privilege SELECT (r) with grant option @@ -304,4 +311,4 @@ GRANT SELECT (col1), UPDATE (col1) ON mytable TO miriam_rw; Notice that the owner's implicit grant options are not marked in the access privileges display. A * will appear only when grant options have been explicitly granted to someone. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-rowsecurity.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-rowsecurity.html index 41ef466..f119529 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-rowsecurity.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-rowsecurity.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.8. Row Security Policies

    5.8. Row Security Policies

    +5.8. Row Security Policies

    5.8. Row Security Policies

    In addition to the SQL-standard privilege system available through GRANT, tables can have row security policies that restrict, @@ -379,4 +379,4 @@ SELECT * FROM information WHERE group_id = 2 FOR UPDATE;

    For additional details see CREATE POLICY and ALTER TABLE. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-schemas.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-schemas.html index 6b7491c..2a29b0d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-schemas.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-schemas.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.9. Schemas

    5.9. Schemas

    +5.9. Schemas

    5.9. Schemas

    A PostgreSQL database cluster contains one or more named databases. Roles and a few other object types are shared across the entire cluster. A client connection to the server @@ -326,4 +326,4 @@ REVOKE CREATE ON SCHEMA public FROM PUBLIC; limited) cross-database access. If you need to work with those systems, then maximum portability would be achieved by not using schemas at all. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-system-columns.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-system-columns.html index ab773d3..67bf8bb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-system-columns.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl-system-columns.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -5.5. System Columns

    5.5. System Columns

    +5.5. System Columns

    5.5. System Columns

    Every table has several system columns that are implicitly defined by the system. Therefore, these names cannot be used as names of user-defined columns. (Note that these @@ -55,4 +55,4 @@ SQL commands, not the number of rows processed. Also, only commands that actually modify the database contents will consume a command identifier. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl.html index 14ec801..894714a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ddl.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 5. Data Definition

    Chapter 5. Data Definition

    +Chapter 5. Data Definition

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/default-roles.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/default-roles.html index 03ff13e..2ac8ef0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/default-roles.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/default-roles.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -O.2. Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles

    O.2. Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles

    +O.2. Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles

    O.2. Default Roles Renamed to Predefined Roles

    PostgreSQL 13 and below used the term Default Roles. However, as these roles are not able to actually be changed and are installed as part of the system at initialization time, the more appropriate term to use is Predefined Roles. See Section 22.5 for current documentation regarding - Predefined Roles, and the release notes for + Predefined Roles, and the release notes for PostgreSQL 14 for details on this change. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-int.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-int.html index 0c14420..2fccb86 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-int.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-int.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.13. dict_int

    F.13. dict_int

    +F.13. dict_int

    F.13. dict_int

    dict_int is an example of an add-on dictionary template for full-text search. The motivation for this example dictionary is to control the indexing of integers (signed and unsigned), allowing such @@ -59,4 +59,4 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION english ALTER MAPPING FOR int, uint WITH intdict;

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-xsyn.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-xsyn.html index a9c392a..96d8cad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-xsyn.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dict-xsyn.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.14. dict_xsyn

    F.14. dict_xsyn

    +F.14. dict_xsyn

    F.14. dict_xsyn

    dict_xsyn (Extended Synonym Dictionary) is an example of an add-on dictionary template for full-text search. This dictionary type replaces words with groups of their synonyms, and so makes it possible to @@ -94,4 +94,4 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION english ALTER MAPPING FOR word, asciiword WITH xsyn, english_stem;

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/different-replication-solutions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/different-replication-solutions.html index 4919117..d4eb03d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/different-replication-solutions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/different-replication-solutions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -27.1. Comparison of Different Solutions

    27.1. Comparison of Different Solutions

    Shared Disk Failover

    +27.1. Comparison of Different Solutions

    27.1. Comparison of Different Solutions

    Shared Disk Failover

    Shared disk failover avoids synchronization overhead by having only one copy of the database. It uses a single disk array that is shared by multiple servers. If the main database server fails, the standby server @@ -134,4 +134,4 @@ taken PostgreSQL and created commercial closed-source solutions with unique failover, replication, and load balancing capabilities. These are not discussed here. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-full.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-full.html index ded5362..514f81f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-full.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-full.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -29.2. Disk Full Failure

    29.2. Disk Full Failure

    +29.2. Disk Full Failure

    29.2. Disk Full Failure

    The most important disk monitoring task of a database administrator is to make sure the disk doesn't become full. A filled data disk will not result in data corruption, but it might prevent useful activity @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ will naturally be subject to whatever quota is placed on the user the server runs as. Exceeding the quota will have the same bad effects as running out of disk space entirely. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-usage.html index 3646fe6..9f58475 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/disk-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -29.1. Determining Disk Usage

    29.1. Determining Disk Usage

    +29.1. Determining Disk Usage

    29.1. Determining Disk Usage

    Each table has a primary heap disk file where most of the data is stored. If the table has any columns with potentially-wide values, there also might be a TOAST file associated with the table, @@ -80,4 +80,4 @@ ORDER BY relpages DESC; bigtable | 3290 customer | 3144

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/diskusage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/diskusage.html index 4668950..a790fb7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/diskusage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/diskusage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 29. Monitoring Disk Usage

    Chapter 29. Monitoring Disk Usage

    +Chapter 29. Monitoring Disk Usage

    Chapter 29. Monitoring Disk Usage

    This chapter discusses how to monitor the disk usage of a PostgreSQL database system. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-delete.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-delete.html index 69c651c..48a6038 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-delete.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-delete.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -6.3. Deleting Data

    6.3. Deleting Data

    +6.3. Deleting Data

    6.3. Deleting Data

    So far we have explained how to add data to tables and how to change data. What remains is to discuss how to remove data that is no longer needed. Just as adding data is only possible in whole @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ DELETE FROM products WHERE price = 10; DELETE FROM products;

    then all rows in the table will be deleted! Caveat programmer. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-insert.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-insert.html index 6b24930..e578794 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-insert.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-insert.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -6.1. Inserting Data

    6.1. Inserting Data

    +6.1. Inserting Data

    6.1. Inserting Data

    When a table is created, it contains no data. The first thing to do before a database can be of much use is to insert data. Data is inserted one row at a time. You can also insert more than one row @@ -78,4 +78,4 @@ INSERT INTO products (product_no, name, price) command, but is more efficient. Refer to Section 14.4 for more information on improving bulk loading performance. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-returning.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-returning.html index 7bb12b2..3ff5d5a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-returning.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-returning.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -6.4. Returning Data from Modified Rows

    6.4. Returning Data from Modified Rows

    +6.4. Returning Data from Modified Rows

    6.4. Returning Data from Modified Rows

    Sometimes it is useful to obtain data from modified rows while they are being manipulated. The INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE commands all have an @@ -50,4 +50,4 @@ DELETE FROM products the data available to RETURNING is the row as modified by the triggers. Thus, inspecting columns computed by triggers is another common use-case for RETURNING. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-update.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-update.html index f7748cd..c08a771 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-update.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml-update.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -6.2. Updating Data

    6.2. Updating Data

    +6.2. Updating Data

    6.2. Updating Data

    The modification of data that is already in the database is referred to as updating. You can update individual rows, all the rows in a table, or a subset of all rows. Each column can be @@ -58,4 +58,4 @@ UPDATE products SET price = price * 1.10;

     UPDATE mytable SET a = 5, b = 3, c = 1 WHERE a > 0;
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml.html index 34fd93d..0341892 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dml.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dml.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -Chapter 6. Data Manipulation

    Chapter 6. Data Manipulation

    +Chapter 6. Data Manipulation

    Chapter 6. Data Manipulation

    The previous chapter discussed how to create tables and other structures to hold your data. Now it is time to fill the tables with data. This chapter covers how to insert, update, and delete table data. The chapter after this will finally explain how to extract your long-lost data from the database. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-authoring.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-authoring.html index c696bfe..dcf94c6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-authoring.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-authoring.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -J.4. Documentation Authoring

    J.4. Documentation Authoring

    +J.4. Documentation Authoring

    J.4. Documentation Authoring

    The documentation sources are most conveniently modified with an editor that has a mode for editing XML, and even more so if it has some awareness of XML schema languages so that it can know about @@ -20,4 +20,4 @@

    src/tools/editors/emacs.samples contains recommended settings for this mode. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-build.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-build.html index f26f676..ffb8bee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-build.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-build.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -J.3. Building the Documentation

    J.3. Building the Documentation

    +J.3. Building the Documentation

    J.3. Building the Documentation

    Once you have everything set up, change to the directory doc/src/sgml and run one of the commands described in the following subsections to build the @@ -88,4 +88,4 @@ ADDITIONAL_FLAGS='-Xmx1500m'

     doc/src/sgml$ make check
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-docbook.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-docbook.html index 40a366d..7d92851 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-docbook.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-docbook.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -J.1. DocBook

    J.1. DocBook

    +J.1. DocBook

    J.1. DocBook

    The documentation sources are written in DocBook, which is a markup language defined in XML. In what @@ -20,4 +20,4 @@ FreeBSD Documentation Project also uses DocBook and has some good information, including a number of style guidelines that might be worth considering. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-style.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-style.html index 611927e..5257714 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-style.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-style.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -J.5. Style Guide

    J.5. Style Guide

    J.5.1. Reference Pages

    +J.5. Style Guide

    J.5. Style Guide

    J.5.1. Reference Pages

    Reference pages should follow a standard layout. This allows users to find the desired information more quickly, and it also encourages writers to document all relevant aspects of a command. @@ -86,4 +86,4 @@ database system it is compatible. The See Also section of SQL commands should list SQL commands before cross-references to programs. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-toolsets.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-toolsets.html index 1b217ab..6facf81 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-toolsets.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide-toolsets.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -J.2. Tool Sets

    J.2. Tool Sets

    +J.2. Tool Sets

    J.2. Tool Sets

    The following tools are used to process the documentation. Some might be optional, as noted. @@ -112,4 +112,4 @@ checking for dbtoepub... dbtoepub

     ./configure ... XMLLINT=/opt/local/bin/xmllint ...
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide.html index 4bec9e2..727d474 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/docguide.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix J. Documentation \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/domains.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/domains.html index 8ac9c05..fa56076 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/domains.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/domains.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.18. Domain Types

    8.18. Domain Types

    +8.18. Domain Types

    8.18. Domain Types

    A domain is a user-defined data type that is based on another underlying type. Optionally, it can have constraints that restrict its valid values to a subset of @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ INSERT INTO mytable VALUES(-1); -- fails domain's constraints will be checked.

    For additional information see CREATE DOMAIN. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/dynamic-trace.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/dynamic-trace.html index 42690bf..9f1b1c7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/dynamic-trace.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/dynamic-trace.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -28.5. Dynamic Tracing

    28.5. Dynamic Tracing

    +28.5. Dynamic Tracing

    28.5. Dynamic Tracing

    PostgreSQL provides facilities to support dynamic tracing of the database server. This allows an external utility to be called at specific points in the code and thereby trace @@ -298,4 +298,4 @@ if (TRACE_POSTGRESQL_TRANSACTION_START_ENABLED()) Each trace macro has a corresponding ENABLED macro.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/earthdistance.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/earthdistance.html index ebfb48f..55206f0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/earthdistance.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/earthdistance.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.15. earthdistance

    F.15. earthdistance

    +F.15. earthdistance

    F.15. earthdistance

    The earthdistance module provides two different approaches to calculating great circle distances on the surface of the Earth. The one described first depends on the cube module. @@ -155,4 +155,4 @@ you need to be careful about the edge conditions near the poles and near +/- 180 degrees of longitude. The cube-based representation avoids these discontinuities. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-commands.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-commands.html index bf3ef1a..82ace84 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-commands.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-commands.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.3. Running SQL Commands

    36.3. Running SQL Commands

    +36.3. Running SQL Commands

    36.3. Running SQL Commands

    Any SQL command can be run from within an embedded SQL application. Below are some examples of how to do that.

    36.3.1. Executing SQL Statements

    @@ -160,4 +160,4 @@ EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE PREPARE name; see PREPARE. Also see Section 36.5 for more details about using placeholders and input parameters. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-concept.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-concept.html index 8b3d8ea..04e5164 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-concept.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-concept.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.1. The Concept

    36.1. The Concept

    +36.1. The Concept

    36.1. The Concept

    An embedded SQL program consists of code written in an ordinary programming language, in this case C, mixed with SQL commands in specially marked sections. To build the program, the source code (*.pgc) @@ -49,4 +49,4 @@ EXEC SQL ...; Of course, the C part of the program follows C quoting rules.

    The following sections explain all the embedded SQL statements. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-connect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-connect.html index 0310976..3728bd8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-connect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-connect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.2. Managing Database Connections

    36.2. Managing Database Connections

    +36.2. Managing Database Connections

    36.2. Managing Database Connections

    This section describes how to open, close, and switch database connections.

    36.2.1. Connecting to the Database Server

    @@ -244,4 +244,4 @@ EXEC SQL DISCONNECT [connec

    It is good style that an application always explicitly disconnect from every connection it opened. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-cpp.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-cpp.html index 3a54306..242bd59 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-cpp.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-cpp.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.13. C++ Applications

    36.13. C++ Applications

    +36.13. C++ Applications

    36.13. C++ Applications

    ECPG has some limited support for C++ applications. This section describes some caveats.

    @@ -225,4 +225,4 @@ c++ -c test_cpp.cpp -o test_cpp.o

     c++ test_cpp.o test_mod.o -lecpg -o test_cpp
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-descriptors.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-descriptors.html index a93f57e..f0a452b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-descriptors.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-descriptors.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.7. Using Descriptor Areas

    36.7. Using Descriptor Areas

    +36.7. Using Descriptor Areas

    36.7. Using Descriptor Areas

    An SQL descriptor area is a more sophisticated method for processing the result of a SELECT, FETCH or a DESCRIBE statement. An SQL descriptor area groups @@ -707,4 +707,4 @@ tup_fetched = 3253694 (type: 9) tup_inserted = 0 (type: 9) tup_updated = 0 (type: 9) tup_deleted = 0 (type: 9) -


    \ No newline at end of file +
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-develop.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-develop.html index a643bdb..7d0aa69 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-develop.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-develop.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.17. Internals

    36.17. Internals

    +36.17. Internals

    36.17. Internals

    This section explains how ECPG works internally. This information can occasionally be useful to help users understand how to use ECPG. @@ -121,4 +121,4 @@ ECPGdo(__LINE__, NULL, "SELECT res FROM mytable WHERE index = ? ",

    (The indentation here is added for readability and not something the preprocessor does.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-dynamic.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-dynamic.html index fb9b2f6..9ce0c74 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-dynamic.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-dynamic.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.5. Dynamic SQL

    36.5. Dynamic SQL

    +36.5. Dynamic SQL

    36.5. Dynamic SQL

    In many cases, the particular SQL statements that an application has to execute are known at the time the application is written. In some cases, however, the SQL statements are composed at run time @@ -100,4 +100,4 @@ EXEC SQL CLOSE cursor1; EXEC SQL COMMIT; EXEC SQL DISCONNECT ALL;

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-errors.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-errors.html index d1d4486..02caf51 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-errors.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-errors.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.8. Error Handling

    36.8. Error Handling

    +36.8. Error Handling

    36.8. Error Handling

    This section describes how you can handle exceptional conditions and warnings in an embedded SQL program. There are two nonexclusive facilities for this. @@ -438,4 +438,4 @@ while (1)

    -605 (ECPG_WARNING_PORTAL_EXISTS)

    An existing cursor name was specified. (SQLSTATE 42P03)

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-informix-compat.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-informix-compat.html index a11a001..a6cc793 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-informix-compat.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-informix-compat.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode

    36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode

    +36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode

    36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode

    ecpg can be run in a so-called Informix compatibility mode. If this mode is active, it tries to behave as if it were the Informix precompiler for Informix E/SQL. Generally spoken this will allow you to use @@ -889,4 +889,4 @@ risnull(CINTTYPE, (char *) &i); characters it cannot parse. Internally it is defined as -1264 (the Informix definition).

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-library.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-library.html index 24b374b..66a9a05 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-library.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-library.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.11. Library Functions

    36.11. Library Functions

    +36.11. Library Functions

    36.11. Library Functions

    The libecpg library primarily contains hidden functions that are used to implement the functionality expressed by the embedded SQL commands. But there @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@ returns true if you are connected to a database and false if not. connection_name can be NULL if a single connection is being used. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-lo.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-lo.html index bf9e1b1..4cf471b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-lo.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-lo.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.12. Large Objects

    36.12. Large Objects

    +36.12. Large Objects

    36.12. Large Objects

    Large objects are not directly supported by ECPG, but ECPG application can manipulate large objects through the libpq large object functions, obtaining the necessary PGconn @@ -97,4 +97,4 @@ main(void) EXEC SQL DISCONNECT ALL; return 0; } -


    \ No newline at end of file +
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-oracle-compat.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-oracle-compat.html index 372b09f..b4bc14a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-oracle-compat.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-oracle-compat.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode

    36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode

    +36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode

    36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode

    ecpg can be run in a so-called Oracle compatibility mode. If this mode is active, it tries to behave as if it were Oracle Pro*C. @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ Set the null indicator to -1 when character arrays receive empty character string types

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-pgtypes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-pgtypes.html index 3ec3666..abeded5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-pgtypes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-pgtypes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.6. pgtypes Library

    36.6. pgtypes Library

    +36.6. pgtypes Library

    36.6. pgtypes Library

    The pgtypes library maps PostgreSQL database types to C equivalents that can be used in C programs. It also offers functions to do basic calculations with those types within C, i.e., without @@ -762,4 +762,4 @@ void PGTYPESdecimal_free(decimal *var); errno != 0 after each call to PGTYPEStimestamp_from_asc.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-preproc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-preproc.html index 951dbf3..d46411d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-preproc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-preproc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.9. Preprocessor Directives

    36.9. Preprocessor Directives

    +36.9. Preprocessor Directives

    36.9. Preprocessor Directives

    Several preprocessor directives are available that modify how the ecpg preprocessor parses and processes a file. @@ -126,4 +126,4 @@ EXEC SQL else; EXEC SQL SET TIMEZONE TO 'GMT'; EXEC SQL endif;

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-process.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-process.html index f7bcd5a..81c376d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-process.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-process.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs

    36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs

    +36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs

    36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs

    Now that you have an idea how to form embedded SQL C programs, you probably want to know how to compile them. Before compiling you run the file through the embedded SQL @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ ECPG = ecpg The ecpg library is thread-safe by default. However, you might need to use some threading command-line options to compile your client code. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor.html index 3634450..f6d1b23 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-allocate-descriptor.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — allocate an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

    +ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — allocate an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

     ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR name
     

    Description

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR allocates a new named SQL @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ EXEC SQL ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR mydesc;

    Compatibility

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-commands.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-commands.html index 0fea995..3bf2626 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-commands.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-commands.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -36.14. Embedded SQL Commands

    36.14. Embedded SQL Commands

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — allocate an SQL descriptor area
    CONNECT — establish a database connection
    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — deallocate an SQL descriptor area
    DECLARE — define a cursor
    DECLARE STATEMENT — declare SQL statement identifier
    DESCRIBE — obtain information about a prepared statement or result set
    DISCONNECT — terminate a database connection
    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE — dynamically prepare and execute a statement
    GET DESCRIPTOR — get information from an SQL descriptor area
    OPEN — open a dynamic cursor
    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution
    SET AUTOCOMMIT — set the autocommit behavior of the current session
    SET CONNECTION — select a database connection
    SET DESCRIPTOR — set information in an SQL descriptor area
    TYPE — define a new data type
    VAR — define a variable
    WHENEVER — specify the action to be taken when an SQL statement causes a specific class condition to be raised

    +36.14. Embedded SQL Commands

    36.14. Embedded SQL Commands

    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — allocate an SQL descriptor area
    CONNECT — establish a database connection
    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — deallocate an SQL descriptor area
    DECLARE — define a cursor
    DECLARE STATEMENT — declare SQL statement identifier
    DESCRIBE — obtain information about a prepared statement or result set
    DISCONNECT — terminate a database connection
    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE — dynamically prepare and execute a statement
    GET DESCRIPTOR — get information from an SQL descriptor area
    OPEN — open a dynamic cursor
    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution
    SET AUTOCOMMIT — set the autocommit behavior of the current session
    SET CONNECTION — select a database connection
    SET DESCRIPTOR — set information in an SQL descriptor area
    TYPE — define a new data type
    VAR — define a variable
    WHENEVER — specify the action to be taken when an SQL statement causes a specific class condition to be raised

    This section describes all SQL commands that are specific to embedded SQL. Also refer to the SQL commands listed in SQL Commands, which can also be used in embedded SQL, unless stated otherwise. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-connect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-connect.html index e77c748..99efc30 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-connect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-connect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CONNECT

    CONNECT

    CONNECT — establish a database connection

    Synopsis

    +CONNECT

    CONNECT

    CONNECT — establish a database connection

    Synopsis

     CONNECT TO connection_target [ AS connection_name ] [ USER connection_user ]
     CONNECT TO DEFAULT
     CONNECT connection_user
    @@ -106,4 +106,4 @@ EXEC SQL END DECLARE SECTION;
          CONNECT is specified in the SQL standard, but
          the format of the connection parameters is
          implementation-specific.
    -    

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-deallocate-descriptor.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-deallocate-descriptor.html index 8999924..8a2db13 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-deallocate-descriptor.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-deallocate-descriptor.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — deallocate an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

    +DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR

    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — deallocate an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

     DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR name
     

    Description

    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR deallocates a named SQL @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR mydesc;

    Compatibility

    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare-statement.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare-statement.html index cf236b2..f3a29f3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare-statement.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare-statement.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DECLARE STATEMENT

    DECLARE STATEMENT

    DECLARE STATEMENT — declare SQL statement identifier

    Synopsis

    +DECLARE STATEMENT

    DECLARE STATEMENT

    DECLARE STATEMENT — declare SQL statement identifier

    Synopsis

     EXEC SQL [ AT connection_name ] DECLARE statement_name STATEMENT
     

    Description

    DECLARE STATEMENT declares an SQL statement identifier. @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@ EXEC SQL CLOSE cursor_name;

    Compatibility

    DECLARE STATEMENT is an extension of the SQL standard, but can be used in famous DBMSs. -

    See Also

    CONNECT, DECLARE, OPEN
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CONNECT, DECLARE, OPEN
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare.html index 037f5ae..b2e2080 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-declare.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DECLARE

    DECLARE

    DECLARE — define a cursor

    Synopsis

    +DECLARE

    DECLARE

    DECLARE — define a cursor

    Synopsis

     DECLARE cursor_name [ BINARY ] [ ASENSITIVE | INSENSITIVE ] [ [ NO ] SCROLL ] CURSOR [ { WITH | WITHOUT } HOLD ] FOR prepared_name
     DECLARE cursor_name [ BINARY ] [ ASENSITIVE | INSENSITIVE ] [ [ NO ] SCROLL ] CURSOR [ { WITH | WITHOUT } HOLD ] FOR query
     

    Description

    @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ EXEC SQL DECLARE cur1 CURSOR FOR stmt1;

    Compatibility

    DECLARE is specified in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    OPEN, CLOSE, DECLARE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    OPEN, CLOSE, DECLARE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-describe.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-describe.html index c82ee5e..f784d9d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-describe.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-describe.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DESCRIBE

    DESCRIBE

    DESCRIBE — obtain information about a prepared statement or result set

    Synopsis

    +DESCRIBE

    DESCRIBE

    DESCRIBE — obtain information about a prepared statement or result set

    Synopsis

     DESCRIBE [ OUTPUT ] prepared_name USING [ SQL ] DESCRIPTOR descriptor_name
     DESCRIBE [ OUTPUT ] prepared_name INTO [ SQL ] DESCRIPTOR descriptor_name
     DESCRIBE [ OUTPUT ] prepared_name INTO sqlda_name
    @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ EXEC SQL GET DESCRIPTOR mydesc VALUE 1 :charvar = NAME;
     EXEC SQL DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR mydesc;
     

    Compatibility

    DESCRIBE is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-disconnect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-disconnect.html index 7528efc..b51aa77 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-disconnect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-disconnect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DISCONNECT

    DISCONNECT

    DISCONNECT — terminate a database connection

    Synopsis

    +DISCONNECT

    DISCONNECT

    DISCONNECT — terminate a database connection

    Synopsis

     DISCONNECT connection_name
     DISCONNECT [ CURRENT ]
     DISCONNECT ALL
    @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ main(void)
     }
     

    Compatibility

    DISCONNECT is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-execute-immediate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-execute-immediate.html index 97c822a..3aa521a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-execute-immediate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-execute-immediate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -EXECUTE IMMEDIATE

    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE

    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE — dynamically prepare and execute a statement

    Synopsis

    +EXECUTE IMMEDIATE

    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE

    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE — dynamically prepare and execute a statement

    Synopsis

     EXECUTE IMMEDIATE string
     

    Description

    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE immediately prepares and @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ EXEC SQL EXECUTE IMMEDIATE :command;

    Compatibility

    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-get-descriptor.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-get-descriptor.html index 3cfb91f..ec402e9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-get-descriptor.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-get-descriptor.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -GET DESCRIPTOR

    GET DESCRIPTOR

    GET DESCRIPTOR — get information from an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

    +GET DESCRIPTOR

    GET DESCRIPTOR

    GET DESCRIPTOR — get information from an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

     GET DESCRIPTOR descriptor_name :cvariable = descriptor_header_item [, ... ]
     GET DESCRIPTOR descriptor_name VALUE column_number :cvariable = descriptor_item [, ... ]
     

    Description

    @@ -101,4 +101,4 @@ d_data = testdb

    Compatibility

    GET DESCRIPTOR is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-open.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-open.html index 51c323c..5cf0669 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-open.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-open.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -OPEN

    OPEN

    OPEN — open a dynamic cursor

    Synopsis

    +OPEN

    OPEN

    OPEN — open a dynamic cursor

    Synopsis

     OPEN cursor_name
     OPEN cursor_name USING value [, ... ]
     OPEN cursor_name USING SQL DESCRIPTOR descriptor_name
    @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ EXEC SQL OPEN c1 USING SQL DESCRIPTOR mydesc;
     EXEC SQL OPEN :curname1;
     

    Compatibility

    OPEN is specified in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    DECLARE, CLOSE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    DECLARE, CLOSE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-prepare.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-prepare.html index f650222..9f4dba9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-prepare.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-prepare.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -PREPARE

    PREPARE

    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution

    Synopsis

    +PREPARE

    PREPARE

    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution

    Synopsis

     PREPARE prepared_name FROM string
     

    Description

    PREPARE prepares a statement dynamically @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ EXEC SQL PREPARE foo FROM :stmt; EXEC SQL EXECUTE foo USING SQL DESCRIPTOR indesc INTO SQL DESCRIPTOR outdesc;

    Compatibility

    PREPARE is specified in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    EXECUTE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    EXECUTE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-autocommit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-autocommit.html index 3f25e10..1eb449c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-autocommit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-autocommit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET AUTOCOMMIT

    SET AUTOCOMMIT

    SET AUTOCOMMIT — set the autocommit behavior of the current session

    Synopsis

    +SET AUTOCOMMIT

    SET AUTOCOMMIT

    SET AUTOCOMMIT — set the autocommit behavior of the current session

    Synopsis

     SET AUTOCOMMIT { = | TO } { ON | OFF }
     

    Description

    SET AUTOCOMMIT sets the autocommit behavior of @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ SET AUTOCOMMIT { = | TO } { ON | OFF } where each individual statement is committed implicitly.

    Compatibility

    SET AUTOCOMMIT is an extension of PostgreSQL ECPG. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-connection.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-connection.html index 0b53774..d0e4746 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-connection.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-connection.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET CONNECTION

    SET CONNECTION

    SET CONNECTION — select a database connection

    Synopsis

    +SET CONNECTION

    SET CONNECTION

    SET CONNECTION — select a database connection

    Synopsis

     SET CONNECTION [ TO | = ] connection_name
     

    Description

    SET CONNECTION sets the current @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ EXEC SQL SET CONNECTION TO con2; EXEC SQL SET CONNECTION = con1;

    Compatibility

    SET CONNECTION is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-descriptor.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-descriptor.html index d770b67..44b06b9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-descriptor.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-set-descriptor.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET DESCRIPTOR

    SET DESCRIPTOR

    SET DESCRIPTOR — set information in an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

    +SET DESCRIPTOR

    SET DESCRIPTOR

    SET DESCRIPTOR — set information in an SQL descriptor area

    Synopsis

     SET DESCRIPTOR descriptor_name descriptor_header_item = value [, ... ]
     SET DESCRIPTOR descriptor_name VALUE number descriptor_item = value [, ...]
     

    Description

    @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ EXEC SQL SET DESCRIPTOR indesc VALUE 2 INDICATOR = :val1, DATA = 'some string'; EXEC SQL SET DESCRIPTOR indesc VALUE 2 INDICATOR = :val2null, DATA = :val2;

    Compatibility

    SET DESCRIPTOR is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-type.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-type.html index 9ae97fa..b10af95 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-type.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-type.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -TYPE

    TYPE

    TYPE — define a new data type

    Synopsis

    +TYPE

    TYPE

    TYPE — define a new data type

    Synopsis

     TYPE type_name IS ctype
     

    Description

    The TYPE command defines a new C type. It is @@ -85,4 +85,4 @@ t_ind.i_ind = 0

    Compatibility

    The TYPE command is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-var.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-var.html index 5bee6c5..c43580e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-var.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-var.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -VAR

    VAR

    VAR — define a variable

    Synopsis

    +VAR

    VAR

    VAR — define a variable

    Synopsis

     VAR varname IS ctype
     

    Description

    The VAR command assigns a new C data type @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ exec sql end declare section; EXEC SQL VAR a IS int;

    Compatibility

    The VAR command is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-whenever.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-whenever.html index 3d739ef..bccda8a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-whenever.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-sql-whenever.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -WHENEVER

    WHENEVER

    WHENEVER — specify the action to be taken when an SQL statement causes a specific class condition to be raised

    Synopsis

    +WHENEVER

    WHENEVER

    WHENEVER — specify the action to be taken when an SQL statement causes a specific class condition to be raised

    Synopsis

     WHENEVER { NOT FOUND | SQLERROR | SQLWARNING } action
     

    Description

    Define a behavior which is called on the special cases (Rows not @@ -54,4 +54,4 @@ main(void)

    Compatibility

    WHENEVER is specified in the SQL standard, but most of the actions are PostgreSQL extensions. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-variables.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-variables.html index e19508f..a0e86d3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-variables.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg-variables.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -36.4. Using Host Variables

    36.4. Using Host Variables

    +36.4. Using Host Variables

    36.4. Using Host Variables

    In Section 36.3 you saw how you can execute SQL statements from an embedded SQL program. Some of those statements only used fixed values and did not provide a way to insert @@ -878,4 +878,4 @@ EXEC SQL SELECT b INTO :val :val_ind FROM test1; input and output) for character string types as empty string and for integer types as the lowest possible value for type (for example, INT_MIN for int). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg.html index 816e0ec..aa8e833 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ecpg.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C

    Chapter 36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C

    Table of Contents

    36.1. The Concept
    36.2. Managing Database Connections
    36.2.1. Connecting to the Database Server
    36.2.2. Choosing a Connection
    36.2.3. Closing a Connection
    36.3. Running SQL Commands
    36.3.1. Executing SQL Statements
    36.3.2. Using Cursors
    36.3.3. Managing Transactions
    36.3.4. Prepared Statements
    36.4. Using Host Variables
    36.4.1. Overview
    36.4.2. Declare Sections
    36.4.3. Retrieving Query Results
    36.4.4. Type Mapping
    36.4.5. Handling Nonprimitive SQL Data Types
    36.4.6. Indicators
    36.5. Dynamic SQL
    36.5.1. Executing Statements without a Result Set
    36.5.2. Executing a Statement with Input Parameters
    36.5.3. Executing a Statement with a Result Set
    36.6. pgtypes Library
    36.6.1. Character Strings
    36.6.2. The numeric Type
    36.6.3. The date Type
    36.6.4. The timestamp Type
    36.6.5. The interval Type
    36.6.6. The decimal Type
    36.6.7. errno Values of pgtypeslib
    36.6.8. Special Constants of pgtypeslib
    36.7. Using Descriptor Areas
    36.7.1. Named SQL Descriptor Areas
    36.7.2. SQLDA Descriptor Areas
    36.8. Error Handling
    36.8.1. Setting Callbacks
    36.8.2. sqlca
    36.8.3. SQLSTATE vs. SQLCODE
    36.9. Preprocessor Directives
    36.9.1. Including Files
    36.9.2. The define and undef Directives
    36.9.3. ifdef, ifndef, elif, else, and endif Directives
    36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs
    36.11. Library Functions
    36.12. Large Objects
    36.13. C++ Applications
    36.13.1. Scope for Host Variables
    36.13.2. C++ Application Development with External C Module
    36.14. Embedded SQL Commands
    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — allocate an SQL descriptor area
    CONNECT — establish a database connection
    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — deallocate an SQL descriptor area
    DECLARE — define a cursor
    DECLARE STATEMENT — declare SQL statement identifier
    DESCRIBE — obtain information about a prepared statement or result set
    DISCONNECT — terminate a database connection
    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE — dynamically prepare and execute a statement
    GET DESCRIPTOR — get information from an SQL descriptor area
    OPEN — open a dynamic cursor
    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution
    SET AUTOCOMMIT — set the autocommit behavior of the current session
    SET CONNECTION — select a database connection
    SET DESCRIPTOR — set information in an SQL descriptor area
    TYPE — define a new data type
    VAR — define a variable
    WHENEVER — specify the action to be taken when an SQL statement causes a specific class condition to be raised
    36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode
    36.15.1. Additional Types
    36.15.2. Additional/Missing Embedded SQL Statements
    36.15.3. Informix-compatible SQLDA Descriptor Areas
    36.15.4. Additional Functions
    36.15.5. Additional Constants
    36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode
    36.17. Internals

    +Chapter 36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C

    Chapter 36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C

    Table of Contents

    36.1. The Concept
    36.2. Managing Database Connections
    36.2.1. Connecting to the Database Server
    36.2.2. Choosing a Connection
    36.2.3. Closing a Connection
    36.3. Running SQL Commands
    36.3.1. Executing SQL Statements
    36.3.2. Using Cursors
    36.3.3. Managing Transactions
    36.3.4. Prepared Statements
    36.4. Using Host Variables
    36.4.1. Overview
    36.4.2. Declare Sections
    36.4.3. Retrieving Query Results
    36.4.4. Type Mapping
    36.4.5. Handling Nonprimitive SQL Data Types
    36.4.6. Indicators
    36.5. Dynamic SQL
    36.5.1. Executing Statements without a Result Set
    36.5.2. Executing a Statement with Input Parameters
    36.5.3. Executing a Statement with a Result Set
    36.6. pgtypes Library
    36.6.1. Character Strings
    36.6.2. The numeric Type
    36.6.3. The date Type
    36.6.4. The timestamp Type
    36.6.5. The interval Type
    36.6.6. The decimal Type
    36.6.7. errno Values of pgtypeslib
    36.6.8. Special Constants of pgtypeslib
    36.7. Using Descriptor Areas
    36.7.1. Named SQL Descriptor Areas
    36.7.2. SQLDA Descriptor Areas
    36.8. Error Handling
    36.8.1. Setting Callbacks
    36.8.2. sqlca
    36.8.3. SQLSTATE vs. SQLCODE
    36.9. Preprocessor Directives
    36.9.1. Including Files
    36.9.2. The define and undef Directives
    36.9.3. ifdef, ifndef, elif, else, and endif Directives
    36.10. Processing Embedded SQL Programs
    36.11. Library Functions
    36.12. Large Objects
    36.13. C++ Applications
    36.13.1. Scope for Host Variables
    36.13.2. C++ Application Development with External C Module
    36.14. Embedded SQL Commands
    ALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — allocate an SQL descriptor area
    CONNECT — establish a database connection
    DEALLOCATE DESCRIPTOR — deallocate an SQL descriptor area
    DECLARE — define a cursor
    DECLARE STATEMENT — declare SQL statement identifier
    DESCRIBE — obtain information about a prepared statement or result set
    DISCONNECT — terminate a database connection
    EXECUTE IMMEDIATE — dynamically prepare and execute a statement
    GET DESCRIPTOR — get information from an SQL descriptor area
    OPEN — open a dynamic cursor
    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution
    SET AUTOCOMMIT — set the autocommit behavior of the current session
    SET CONNECTION — select a database connection
    SET DESCRIPTOR — set information in an SQL descriptor area
    TYPE — define a new data type
    VAR — define a variable
    WHENEVER — specify the action to be taken when an SQL statement causes a specific class condition to be raised
    36.15. Informix Compatibility Mode
    36.15.1. Additional Types
    36.15.2. Additional/Missing Embedded SQL Statements
    36.15.3. Informix-compatible SQLDA Descriptor Areas
    36.15.4. Additional Functions
    36.15.5. Additional Constants
    36.16. Oracle Compatibility Mode
    36.17. Internals

    This chapter describes the embedded SQL package for PostgreSQL. It was written by Linus Tolke () and Michael Meskes @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ This documentation is quite incomplete. But since this interface is standardized, additional information can be found in many resources about SQL. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/encryption-options.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/encryption-options.html index fc578d8..d6d9b2f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/encryption-options.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/encryption-options.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.8. Encryption Options

    19.8. Encryption Options

    +19.8. Encryption Options

    19.8. Encryption Options

    PostgreSQL offers encryption at several levels, and provides flexibility in protecting data from disclosure due to database server theft, unscrupulous administrators, and @@ -81,4 +81,4 @@ never appears on the database server. Data is encrypted on the client before being sent to the server, and database results have to be decrypted on the client before being used. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/errcodes-appendix.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/errcodes-appendix.html index 02abbc8..0b15510 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/errcodes-appendix.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/errcodes-appendix.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix A. PostgreSQL Error Codes

    Appendix A. PostgreSQL Error Codes

    +Appendix A. PostgreSQL Error Codes

    Appendix A. PostgreSQL Error Codes

    All messages emitted by the PostgreSQL server are assigned five-character error codes that follow the SQL standard's conventions for SQLSTATE codes. Applications @@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ what to do from the error class.

    Table A.1 lists all the error codes defined in - PostgreSQL 15.5. (Some are not actually + PostgreSQL 15.6. (Some are not actually used at present, but are defined by the SQL standard.) The error classes are also shown. For each error class there is a standard error code having the last three characters @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ As of PostgreSQL 9.3, complete coverage for this feature exists only for errors in SQLSTATE class 23 (integrity constraint violation), but this is likely to be expanded in future. -

    Table A.1. PostgreSQL Error Codes

    Error CodeCondition Name
    Class 00 — Successful Completion
    00000successful_completion
    Class 01 — Warning
    01000warning
    0100Cdynamic_result_sets_returned
    01008implicit_zero_bit_padding
    01003null_value_eliminated_in_set_function
    01007privilege_not_granted
    01006privilege_not_revoked
    01004string_data_right_truncation
    01P01deprecated_feature
    Class 02 — No Data (this is also a warning class per the SQL standard)
    02000no_data
    02001no_additional_dynamic_result_sets_returned
    Class 03 — SQL Statement Not Yet Complete
    03000sql_statement_not_yet_complete
    Class 08 — Connection Exception
    08000connection_exception
    08003connection_does_not_exist
    08006connection_failure
    08001sqlclient_unable_to_establish_sqlconnection
    08004sqlserver_rejected_establishment_of_sqlconnection
    08007transaction_resolution_unknown
    08P01protocol_violation
    Class 09 — Triggered Action Exception
    09000triggered_action_exception
    Class 0A — Feature Not Supported
    0A000feature_not_supported
    Class 0B — Invalid Transaction Initiation
    0B000invalid_transaction_initiation
    Class 0F — Locator Exception
    0F000locator_exception
    0F001invalid_locator_specification
    Class 0L — Invalid Grantor
    0L000invalid_grantor
    0LP01invalid_grant_operation
    Class 0P — Invalid Role Specification
    0P000invalid_role_specification
    Class 0Z — Diagnostics Exception
    0Z000diagnostics_exception
    0Z002stacked_diagnostics_accessed_without_active_handler
    Class 20 — Case Not Found
    20000case_not_found
    Class 21 — Cardinality Violation
    21000cardinality_violation
    Class 22 — Data Exception
    22000data_exception
    2202Earray_subscript_error
    22021character_not_in_repertoire
    22008datetime_field_overflow
    22012division_by_zero
    22005error_in_assignment
    2200Bescape_character_conflict
    22022indicator_overflow
    22015interval_field_overflow
    2201Einvalid_argument_for_logarithm
    22014invalid_argument_for_ntile_function
    22016invalid_argument_for_nth_value_function
    2201Finvalid_argument_for_power_function
    2201Ginvalid_argument_for_width_bucket_function
    22018invalid_character_value_for_cast
    22007invalid_datetime_format
    22019invalid_escape_character
    2200Dinvalid_escape_octet
    22025invalid_escape_sequence
    22P06nonstandard_use_of_escape_character
    22010invalid_indicator_parameter_value
    22023invalid_parameter_value
    22013invalid_preceding_or_following_size
    2201Binvalid_regular_expression
    2201Winvalid_row_count_in_limit_clause
    2201Xinvalid_row_count_in_result_offset_clause
    2202Hinvalid_tablesample_argument
    2202Ginvalid_tablesample_repeat
    22009invalid_time_zone_displacement_value
    2200Cinvalid_use_of_escape_character
    2200Gmost_specific_type_mismatch
    22004null_value_not_allowed
    22002null_value_no_indicator_parameter
    22003numeric_value_out_of_range
    2200Hsequence_generator_limit_exceeded
    22026string_data_length_mismatch
    22001string_data_right_truncation
    22011substring_error
    22027trim_error
    22024unterminated_c_string
    2200Fzero_length_character_string
    22P01floating_point_exception
    22P02invalid_text_representation
    22P03invalid_binary_representation
    22P04bad_copy_file_format
    22P05untranslatable_character
    2200Lnot_an_xml_document
    2200Minvalid_xml_document
    2200Ninvalid_xml_content
    2200Sinvalid_xml_comment
    2200Tinvalid_xml_processing_instruction
    22030duplicate_json_object_key_value
    22031invalid_argument_for_sql_json_datetime_function
    22032invalid_json_text
    22033invalid_sql_json_subscript
    22034more_than_one_sql_json_item
    22035no_sql_json_item
    22036non_numeric_sql_json_item
    22037non_unique_keys_in_a_json_object
    22038singleton_sql_json_item_required
    22039sql_json_array_not_found
    2203Asql_json_member_not_found
    2203Bsql_json_number_not_found
    2203Csql_json_object_not_found
    2203Dtoo_many_json_array_elements
    2203Etoo_many_json_object_members
    2203Fsql_json_scalar_required
    2203Gsql_json_item_cannot_be_cast_to_target_type
    Class 23 — Integrity Constraint Violation
    23000integrity_constraint_violation
    23001restrict_violation
    23502not_null_violation
    23503foreign_key_violation
    23505unique_violation
    23514check_violation
    23P01exclusion_violation
    Class 24 — Invalid Cursor State
    24000invalid_cursor_state
    Class 25 — Invalid Transaction State
    25000invalid_transaction_state
    25001active_sql_transaction
    25002branch_transaction_already_active
    25008held_cursor_requires_same_isolation_level
    25003inappropriate_access_mode_for_branch_transaction
    25004inappropriate_isolation_level_for_branch_transaction
    25005no_active_sql_transaction_for_branch_transaction
    25006read_only_sql_transaction
    25007schema_and_data_statement_mixing_not_supported
    25P01no_active_sql_transaction
    25P02in_failed_sql_transaction
    25P03idle_in_transaction_session_timeout
    Class 26 — Invalid SQL Statement Name
    26000invalid_sql_statement_name
    Class 27 — Triggered Data Change Violation
    27000triggered_data_change_violation
    Class 28 — Invalid Authorization Specification
    28000invalid_authorization_specification
    28P01invalid_password
    Class 2B — Dependent Privilege Descriptors Still Exist
    2B000dependent_privilege_descriptors_still_exist
    2BP01dependent_objects_still_exist
    Class 2D — Invalid Transaction Termination
    2D000invalid_transaction_termination
    Class 2F — SQL Routine Exception
    2F000sql_routine_exception
    2F005function_executed_no_return_statement
    2F002modifying_sql_data_not_permitted
    2F003prohibited_sql_statement_attempted
    2F004reading_sql_data_not_permitted
    Class 34 — Invalid Cursor Name
    34000invalid_cursor_name
    Class 38 — External Routine Exception
    38000external_routine_exception
    38001containing_sql_not_permitted
    38002modifying_sql_data_not_permitted
    38003prohibited_sql_statement_attempted
    38004reading_sql_data_not_permitted
    Class 39 — External Routine Invocation Exception
    39000external_routine_invocation_exception
    39001invalid_sqlstate_returned
    39004null_value_not_allowed
    39P01trigger_protocol_violated
    39P02srf_protocol_violated
    39P03event_trigger_protocol_violated
    Class 3B — Savepoint Exception
    3B000savepoint_exception
    3B001invalid_savepoint_specification
    Class 3D — Invalid Catalog Name
    3D000invalid_catalog_name
    Class 3F — Invalid Schema Name
    3F000invalid_schema_name
    Class 40 — Transaction Rollback
    40000transaction_rollback
    40002transaction_integrity_constraint_violation
    40001serialization_failure
    40003statement_completion_unknown
    40P01deadlock_detected
    Class 42 — Syntax Error or Access Rule Violation
    42000syntax_error_or_access_rule_violation
    42601syntax_error
    42501insufficient_privilege
    42846cannot_coerce
    42803grouping_error
    42P20windowing_error
    42P19invalid_recursion
    42830invalid_foreign_key
    42602invalid_name
    42622name_too_long
    42939reserved_name
    42804datatype_mismatch
    42P18indeterminate_datatype
    42P21collation_mismatch
    42P22indeterminate_collation
    42809wrong_object_type
    428C9generated_always
    42703undefined_column
    42883undefined_function
    42P01undefined_table
    42P02undefined_parameter
    42704undefined_object
    42701duplicate_column
    42P03duplicate_cursor
    42P04duplicate_database
    42723duplicate_function
    42P05duplicate_prepared_statement
    42P06duplicate_schema
    42P07duplicate_table
    42712duplicate_alias
    42710duplicate_object
    42702ambiguous_column
    42725ambiguous_function
    42P08ambiguous_parameter
    42P09ambiguous_alias
    42P10invalid_column_reference
    42611invalid_column_definition
    42P11invalid_cursor_definition
    42P12invalid_database_definition
    42P13invalid_function_definition
    42P14invalid_prepared_statement_definition
    42P15invalid_schema_definition
    42P16invalid_table_definition
    42P17invalid_object_definition
    Class 44 — WITH CHECK OPTION Violation
    44000with_check_option_violation
    Class 53 — Insufficient Resources
    53000insufficient_resources
    53100disk_full
    53200out_of_memory
    53300too_many_connections
    53400configuration_limit_exceeded
    Class 54 — Program Limit Exceeded
    54000program_limit_exceeded
    54001statement_too_complex
    54011too_many_columns
    54023too_many_arguments
    Class 55 — Object Not In Prerequisite State
    55000object_not_in_prerequisite_state
    55006object_in_use
    55P02cant_change_runtime_param
    55P03lock_not_available
    55P04unsafe_new_enum_value_usage
    Class 57 — Operator Intervention
    57000operator_intervention
    57014query_canceled
    57P01admin_shutdown
    57P02crash_shutdown
    57P03cannot_connect_now
    57P04database_dropped
    57P05idle_session_timeout
    Class 58 — System Error (errors external to PostgreSQL itself)
    58000system_error
    58030io_error
    58P01undefined_file
    58P02duplicate_file
    Class 72 — Snapshot Failure
    72000snapshot_too_old
    Class F0 — Configuration File Error
    F0000config_file_error
    F0001lock_file_exists
    Class HV — Foreign Data Wrapper Error (SQL/MED)
    HV000fdw_error
    HV005fdw_column_name_not_found
    HV002fdw_dynamic_parameter_value_needed
    HV010fdw_function_sequence_error
    HV021fdw_inconsistent_descriptor_information
    HV024fdw_invalid_attribute_value
    HV007fdw_invalid_column_name
    HV008fdw_invalid_column_number
    HV004fdw_invalid_data_type
    HV006fdw_invalid_data_type_descriptors
    HV091fdw_invalid_descriptor_field_identifier
    HV00Bfdw_invalid_handle
    HV00Cfdw_invalid_option_index
    HV00Dfdw_invalid_option_name
    HV090fdw_invalid_string_length_or_buffer_length
    HV00Afdw_invalid_string_format
    HV009fdw_invalid_use_of_null_pointer
    HV014fdw_too_many_handles
    HV001fdw_out_of_memory
    HV00Pfdw_no_schemas
    HV00Jfdw_option_name_not_found
    HV00Kfdw_reply_handle
    HV00Qfdw_schema_not_found
    HV00Rfdw_table_not_found
    HV00Lfdw_unable_to_create_execution
    HV00Mfdw_unable_to_create_reply
    HV00Nfdw_unable_to_establish_connection
    Class P0 — PL/pgSQL Error
    P0000plpgsql_error
    P0001raise_exception
    P0002no_data_found
    P0003too_many_rows
    P0004assert_failure
    Class XX — Internal Error
    XX000internal_error
    XX001data_corrupted
    XX002index_corrupted

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table A.1. PostgreSQL Error Codes

    Error CodeCondition Name
    Class 00 — Successful Completion
    00000successful_completion
    Class 01 — Warning
    01000warning
    0100Cdynamic_result_sets_returned
    01008implicit_zero_bit_padding
    01003null_value_eliminated_in_set_function
    01007privilege_not_granted
    01006privilege_not_revoked
    01004string_data_right_truncation
    01P01deprecated_feature
    Class 02 — No Data (this is also a warning class per the SQL standard)
    02000no_data
    02001no_additional_dynamic_result_sets_returned
    Class 03 — SQL Statement Not Yet Complete
    03000sql_statement_not_yet_complete
    Class 08 — Connection Exception
    08000connection_exception
    08003connection_does_not_exist
    08006connection_failure
    08001sqlclient_unable_to_establish_sqlconnection
    08004sqlserver_rejected_establishment_of_sqlconnection
    08007transaction_resolution_unknown
    08P01protocol_violation
    Class 09 — Triggered Action Exception
    09000triggered_action_exception
    Class 0A — Feature Not Supported
    0A000feature_not_supported
    Class 0B — Invalid Transaction Initiation
    0B000invalid_transaction_initiation
    Class 0F — Locator Exception
    0F000locator_exception
    0F001invalid_locator_specification
    Class 0L — Invalid Grantor
    0L000invalid_grantor
    0LP01invalid_grant_operation
    Class 0P — Invalid Role Specification
    0P000invalid_role_specification
    Class 0Z — Diagnostics Exception
    0Z000diagnostics_exception
    0Z002stacked_diagnostics_accessed_without_active_handler
    Class 20 — Case Not Found
    20000case_not_found
    Class 21 — Cardinality Violation
    21000cardinality_violation
    Class 22 — Data Exception
    22000data_exception
    2202Earray_subscript_error
    22021character_not_in_repertoire
    22008datetime_field_overflow
    22012division_by_zero
    22005error_in_assignment
    2200Bescape_character_conflict
    22022indicator_overflow
    22015interval_field_overflow
    2201Einvalid_argument_for_logarithm
    22014invalid_argument_for_ntile_function
    22016invalid_argument_for_nth_value_function
    2201Finvalid_argument_for_power_function
    2201Ginvalid_argument_for_width_bucket_function
    22018invalid_character_value_for_cast
    22007invalid_datetime_format
    22019invalid_escape_character
    2200Dinvalid_escape_octet
    22025invalid_escape_sequence
    22P06nonstandard_use_of_escape_character
    22010invalid_indicator_parameter_value
    22023invalid_parameter_value
    22013invalid_preceding_or_following_size
    2201Binvalid_regular_expression
    2201Winvalid_row_count_in_limit_clause
    2201Xinvalid_row_count_in_result_offset_clause
    2202Hinvalid_tablesample_argument
    2202Ginvalid_tablesample_repeat
    22009invalid_time_zone_displacement_value
    2200Cinvalid_use_of_escape_character
    2200Gmost_specific_type_mismatch
    22004null_value_not_allowed
    22002null_value_no_indicator_parameter
    22003numeric_value_out_of_range
    2200Hsequence_generator_limit_exceeded
    22026string_data_length_mismatch
    22001string_data_right_truncation
    22011substring_error
    22027trim_error
    22024unterminated_c_string
    2200Fzero_length_character_string
    22P01floating_point_exception
    22P02invalid_text_representation
    22P03invalid_binary_representation
    22P04bad_copy_file_format
    22P05untranslatable_character
    2200Lnot_an_xml_document
    2200Minvalid_xml_document
    2200Ninvalid_xml_content
    2200Sinvalid_xml_comment
    2200Tinvalid_xml_processing_instruction
    22030duplicate_json_object_key_value
    22031invalid_argument_for_sql_json_datetime_function
    22032invalid_json_text
    22033invalid_sql_json_subscript
    22034more_than_one_sql_json_item
    22035no_sql_json_item
    22036non_numeric_sql_json_item
    22037non_unique_keys_in_a_json_object
    22038singleton_sql_json_item_required
    22039sql_json_array_not_found
    2203Asql_json_member_not_found
    2203Bsql_json_number_not_found
    2203Csql_json_object_not_found
    2203Dtoo_many_json_array_elements
    2203Etoo_many_json_object_members
    2203Fsql_json_scalar_required
    2203Gsql_json_item_cannot_be_cast_to_target_type
    Class 23 — Integrity Constraint Violation
    23000integrity_constraint_violation
    23001restrict_violation
    23502not_null_violation
    23503foreign_key_violation
    23505unique_violation
    23514check_violation
    23P01exclusion_violation
    Class 24 — Invalid Cursor State
    24000invalid_cursor_state
    Class 25 — Invalid Transaction State
    25000invalid_transaction_state
    25001active_sql_transaction
    25002branch_transaction_already_active
    25008held_cursor_requires_same_isolation_level
    25003inappropriate_access_mode_for_branch_transaction
    25004inappropriate_isolation_level_for_branch_transaction
    25005no_active_sql_transaction_for_branch_transaction
    25006read_only_sql_transaction
    25007schema_and_data_statement_mixing_not_supported
    25P01no_active_sql_transaction
    25P02in_failed_sql_transaction
    25P03idle_in_transaction_session_timeout
    Class 26 — Invalid SQL Statement Name
    26000invalid_sql_statement_name
    Class 27 — Triggered Data Change Violation
    27000triggered_data_change_violation
    Class 28 — Invalid Authorization Specification
    28000invalid_authorization_specification
    28P01invalid_password
    Class 2B — Dependent Privilege Descriptors Still Exist
    2B000dependent_privilege_descriptors_still_exist
    2BP01dependent_objects_still_exist
    Class 2D — Invalid Transaction Termination
    2D000invalid_transaction_termination
    Class 2F — SQL Routine Exception
    2F000sql_routine_exception
    2F005function_executed_no_return_statement
    2F002modifying_sql_data_not_permitted
    2F003prohibited_sql_statement_attempted
    2F004reading_sql_data_not_permitted
    Class 34 — Invalid Cursor Name
    34000invalid_cursor_name
    Class 38 — External Routine Exception
    38000external_routine_exception
    38001containing_sql_not_permitted
    38002modifying_sql_data_not_permitted
    38003prohibited_sql_statement_attempted
    38004reading_sql_data_not_permitted
    Class 39 — External Routine Invocation Exception
    39000external_routine_invocation_exception
    39001invalid_sqlstate_returned
    39004null_value_not_allowed
    39P01trigger_protocol_violated
    39P02srf_protocol_violated
    39P03event_trigger_protocol_violated
    Class 3B — Savepoint Exception
    3B000savepoint_exception
    3B001invalid_savepoint_specification
    Class 3D — Invalid Catalog Name
    3D000invalid_catalog_name
    Class 3F — Invalid Schema Name
    3F000invalid_schema_name
    Class 40 — Transaction Rollback
    40000transaction_rollback
    40002transaction_integrity_constraint_violation
    40001serialization_failure
    40003statement_completion_unknown
    40P01deadlock_detected
    Class 42 — Syntax Error or Access Rule Violation
    42000syntax_error_or_access_rule_violation
    42601syntax_error
    42501insufficient_privilege
    42846cannot_coerce
    42803grouping_error
    42P20windowing_error
    42P19invalid_recursion
    42830invalid_foreign_key
    42602invalid_name
    42622name_too_long
    42939reserved_name
    42804datatype_mismatch
    42P18indeterminate_datatype
    42P21collation_mismatch
    42P22indeterminate_collation
    42809wrong_object_type
    428C9generated_always
    42703undefined_column
    42883undefined_function
    42P01undefined_table
    42P02undefined_parameter
    42704undefined_object
    42701duplicate_column
    42P03duplicate_cursor
    42P04duplicate_database
    42723duplicate_function
    42P05duplicate_prepared_statement
    42P06duplicate_schema
    42P07duplicate_table
    42712duplicate_alias
    42710duplicate_object
    42702ambiguous_column
    42725ambiguous_function
    42P08ambiguous_parameter
    42P09ambiguous_alias
    42P10invalid_column_reference
    42611invalid_column_definition
    42P11invalid_cursor_definition
    42P12invalid_database_definition
    42P13invalid_function_definition
    42P14invalid_prepared_statement_definition
    42P15invalid_schema_definition
    42P16invalid_table_definition
    42P17invalid_object_definition
    Class 44 — WITH CHECK OPTION Violation
    44000with_check_option_violation
    Class 53 — Insufficient Resources
    53000insufficient_resources
    53100disk_full
    53200out_of_memory
    53300too_many_connections
    53400configuration_limit_exceeded
    Class 54 — Program Limit Exceeded
    54000program_limit_exceeded
    54001statement_too_complex
    54011too_many_columns
    54023too_many_arguments
    Class 55 — Object Not In Prerequisite State
    55000object_not_in_prerequisite_state
    55006object_in_use
    55P02cant_change_runtime_param
    55P03lock_not_available
    55P04unsafe_new_enum_value_usage
    Class 57 — Operator Intervention
    57000operator_intervention
    57014query_canceled
    57P01admin_shutdown
    57P02crash_shutdown
    57P03cannot_connect_now
    57P04database_dropped
    57P05idle_session_timeout
    Class 58 — System Error (errors external to PostgreSQL itself)
    58000system_error
    58030io_error
    58P01undefined_file
    58P02duplicate_file
    Class 72 — Snapshot Failure
    72000snapshot_too_old
    Class F0 — Configuration File Error
    F0000config_file_error
    F0001lock_file_exists
    Class HV — Foreign Data Wrapper Error (SQL/MED)
    HV000fdw_error
    HV005fdw_column_name_not_found
    HV002fdw_dynamic_parameter_value_needed
    HV010fdw_function_sequence_error
    HV021fdw_inconsistent_descriptor_information
    HV024fdw_invalid_attribute_value
    HV007fdw_invalid_column_name
    HV008fdw_invalid_column_number
    HV004fdw_invalid_data_type
    HV006fdw_invalid_data_type_descriptors
    HV091fdw_invalid_descriptor_field_identifier
    HV00Bfdw_invalid_handle
    HV00Cfdw_invalid_option_index
    HV00Dfdw_invalid_option_name
    HV090fdw_invalid_string_length_or_buffer_length
    HV00Afdw_invalid_string_format
    HV009fdw_invalid_use_of_null_pointer
    HV014fdw_too_many_handles
    HV001fdw_out_of_memory
    HV00Pfdw_no_schemas
    HV00Jfdw_option_name_not_found
    HV00Kfdw_reply_handle
    HV00Qfdw_schema_not_found
    HV00Rfdw_table_not_found
    HV00Lfdw_unable_to_create_execution
    HV00Mfdw_unable_to_create_reply
    HV00Nfdw_unable_to_establish_connection
    Class P0 — PL/pgSQL Error
    P0000plpgsql_error
    P0001raise_exception
    P0002no_data_found
    P0003too_many_rows
    P0004assert_failure
    Class XX — Internal Error
    XX000internal_error
    XX001data_corrupted
    XX002index_corrupted

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/error-message-reporting.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/error-message-reporting.html index b14244f..b0e42dc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/error-message-reporting.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/error-message-reporting.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -56.2. Reporting Errors Within the Server

    56.2. Reporting Errors Within the Server

    +56.2. Reporting Errors Within the Server

    56.2. Reporting Errors Within the Server

    Error, warning, and log messages generated within the server code should be created using ereport, or its older cousin elog. The use of this function is complex enough to @@ -247,4 +247,4 @@ ereport(level, errmsg_internal("format string", ...)); routines will not affect it. That would not be true if you were to write strerror(errno) explicitly in errmsg's parameter list; accordingly, do not do so. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/error-style-guide.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/error-style-guide.html index 2d6861b..03bf135 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/error-style-guide.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/error-style-guide.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -56.3. Error Message Style Guide

    56.3. Error Message Style Guide

    +56.3. Error Message Style Guide

    56.3. Error Message Style Guide

    This style guide is offered in the hope of maintaining a consistent, user-friendly style throughout all the messages generated by PostgreSQL. @@ -247,4 +247,4 @@ BETTER: unrecognized node type: 42 Keep in mind that error message texts need to be translated into other languages. Follow the guidelines in Section 57.2.2 to avoid making life difficult for translators. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-log-registration.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-log-registration.html index 6fa0914..a1d2194 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-log-registration.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-log-registration.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.12. Registering Event Log on Windows

    19.12. Registering Event Log on Windows

    +19.12. Registering Event Log on Windows

    19.12. Registering Event Log on Windows

    To register a Windows event log library with the operating system, issue this command: @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ To enable event logging in the database server, modify log_destination to include eventlog in postgresql.conf. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-definition.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-definition.html index 83f7ca0..157311e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-definition.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-definition.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -40.1. Overview of Event Trigger Behavior

    40.1. Overview of Event Trigger Behavior

    +40.1. Overview of Event Trigger Behavior

    40.1. Overview of Event Trigger Behavior

    An event trigger fires whenever the event with which it is associated occurs in the database in which it is defined. Currently, the only supported events are @@ -75,4 +75,4 @@ trigger can be fired only for particular commands which the user wishes to intercept. A common use of such triggers is to restrict the range of DDL operations which users may perform. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-example.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-example.html index 6c279b7..a0be26e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-example.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-example.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -40.4. A Complete Event Trigger Example

    40.4. A Complete Event Trigger Example

    +40.4. A Complete Event Trigger Example

    40.4. A Complete Event Trigger Example

    Here is a very simple example of an event trigger function written in C. (Examples of triggers written in procedural languages can be found in the documentation of the procedural languages.) @@ -75,4 +75,4 @@ COMMIT;

    (Recall that DDL commands on event triggers themselves are not affected by event triggers.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-interface.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-interface.html index 1374d38..e047c2b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-interface.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-interface.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -40.3. Writing Event Trigger Functions in C

    40.3. Writing Event Trigger Functions in C

    +40.3. Writing Event Trigger Functions in C

    40.3. Writing Event Trigger Functions in C

    This section describes the low-level details of the interface to an event trigger function. This information is only needed when writing event trigger functions in C. If you are using a higher-level language @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ typedef struct EventTriggerData An event trigger function must return a NULL pointer (not an SQL null value, that is, do not set isNull true). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-matrix.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-matrix.html index fdfe8c9..909298d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-matrix.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-matrix.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -40.2. Event Trigger Firing Matrix

    40.2. Event Trigger Firing Matrix

    +40.2. Event Trigger Firing Matrix

    40.2. Event Trigger Firing Matrix

    Table 40.1 lists all commands for which event triggers are supported. -

    Table 40.1. Event Trigger Support by Command Tag

    Command Tagddl_​command_​startddl_​command_​endsql_​droptable_​rewriteNotes
    ALTER AGGREGATEXX-- 
    ALTER COLLATIONXX-- 
    ALTER CONVERSIONXX-- 
    ALTER DOMAINXX-- 
    ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGESXX-- 
    ALTER EXTENSIONXX-- 
    ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPERXX-- 
    ALTER FOREIGN TABLEXXX- 
    ALTER FUNCTIONXX-- 
    ALTER LANGUAGEXX-- 
    ALTER LARGE OBJECTXX-- 
    ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEWXX-X 
    ALTER OPERATORXX-- 
    ALTER OPERATOR CLASSXX-- 
    ALTER OPERATOR FAMILYXX-- 
    ALTER POLICYXX-- 
    ALTER PROCEDUREXX-- 
    ALTER PUBLICATIONXX-- 
    ALTER ROUTINEXX-- 
    ALTER SCHEMAXX-- 
    ALTER SEQUENCEXX-- 
    ALTER SERVERXX-- 
    ALTER STATISTICSXX-- 
    ALTER SUBSCRIPTIONXX-- 
    ALTER TABLEXXXX 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATIONXX-- 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARYXX-- 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSERXX-- 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATEXX-- 
    ALTER TRIGGERXX-- 
    ALTER TYPEXX-X 
    ALTER USER MAPPINGXX-- 
    ALTER VIEWXX-- 
    COMMENTXX--Only for local objects
    CREATE ACCESS METHODXX-- 
    CREATE AGGREGATEXX-- 
    CREATE CASTXX-- 
    CREATE COLLATIONXX-- 
    CREATE CONVERSIONXX-- 
    CREATE DOMAINXX-- 
    CREATE EXTENSIONXX-- 
    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPERXX-- 
    CREATE FOREIGN TABLEXX-- 
    CREATE FUNCTIONXX-- 
    CREATE INDEXXX-- 
    CREATE LANGUAGEXX-- 
    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEWXX-- 
    CREATE OPERATORXX-- 
    CREATE OPERATOR CLASSXX-- 
    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILYXX-- 
    CREATE POLICYXX-- 
    CREATE PROCEDUREXX-- 
    CREATE PUBLICATIONXX-- 
    CREATE RULEXX-- 
    CREATE SCHEMAXX-- 
    CREATE SEQUENCEXX-- 
    CREATE SERVERXX-- 
    CREATE STATISTICSXX-- 
    CREATE SUBSCRIPTIONXX-- 
    CREATE TABLEXX-- 
    CREATE TABLE ASXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATIONXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARYXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSERXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATEXX-- 
    CREATE TRIGGERXX-- 
    CREATE TYPEXX-- 
    CREATE USER MAPPINGXX-- 
    CREATE VIEWXX-- 
    DROP ACCESS METHODXXX- 
    DROP AGGREGATEXXX- 
    DROP CASTXXX- 
    DROP COLLATIONXXX- 
    DROP CONVERSIONXXX- 
    DROP DOMAINXXX- 
    DROP EXTENSIONXXX- 
    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPERXXX- 
    DROP FOREIGN TABLEXXX- 
    DROP FUNCTIONXXX- 
    DROP INDEXXXX- 
    DROP LANGUAGEXXX- 
    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEWXXX- 
    DROP OPERATORXXX- 
    DROP OPERATOR CLASSXXX- 
    DROP OPERATOR FAMILYXXX- 
    DROP OWNEDXXX- 
    DROP POLICYXXX- 
    DROP PROCEDUREXXX- 
    DROP PUBLICATIONXXX- 
    DROP ROUTINEXXX- 
    DROP RULEXXX- 
    DROP SCHEMAXXX- 
    DROP SEQUENCEXXX- 
    DROP SERVERXXX- 
    DROP STATISTICSXXX- 
    DROP SUBSCRIPTIONXXX- 
    DROP TABLEXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATIONXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARYXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSERXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATEXXX- 
    DROP TRIGGERXXX- 
    DROP TYPEXXX- 
    DROP USER MAPPINGXXX- 
    DROP VIEWXXX- 
    GRANTXX--Only for local objects
    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMAXX-- 
    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEWXX-- 
    REVOKEXX--Only for local objects
    SECURITY LABELXX--Only for local objects
    SELECT INTOXX-- 

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table 40.1. Event Trigger Support by Command Tag

    Command Tagddl_​command_​startddl_​command_​endsql_​droptable_​rewriteNotes
    ALTER AGGREGATEXX-- 
    ALTER COLLATIONXX-- 
    ALTER CONVERSIONXX-- 
    ALTER DOMAINXX-- 
    ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGESXX-- 
    ALTER EXTENSIONXX-- 
    ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPERXX-- 
    ALTER FOREIGN TABLEXXX- 
    ALTER FUNCTIONXX-- 
    ALTER LANGUAGEXX-- 
    ALTER LARGE OBJECTXX-- 
    ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEWXX-X 
    ALTER OPERATORXX-- 
    ALTER OPERATOR CLASSXX-- 
    ALTER OPERATOR FAMILYXX-- 
    ALTER POLICYXX-- 
    ALTER PROCEDUREXX-- 
    ALTER PUBLICATIONXX-- 
    ALTER ROUTINEXX-- 
    ALTER SCHEMAXX-- 
    ALTER SEQUENCEXX-- 
    ALTER SERVERXX-- 
    ALTER STATISTICSXX-- 
    ALTER SUBSCRIPTIONXX-- 
    ALTER TABLEXXXX 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATIONXX-- 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARYXX-- 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSERXX-- 
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATEXX-- 
    ALTER TRIGGERXX-- 
    ALTER TYPEXX-X 
    ALTER USER MAPPINGXX-- 
    ALTER VIEWXX-- 
    COMMENTXX--Only for local objects
    CREATE ACCESS METHODXX-- 
    CREATE AGGREGATEXX-- 
    CREATE CASTXX-- 
    CREATE COLLATIONXX-- 
    CREATE CONVERSIONXX-- 
    CREATE DOMAINXX-- 
    CREATE EXTENSIONXX-- 
    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPERXX-- 
    CREATE FOREIGN TABLEXX-- 
    CREATE FUNCTIONXX-- 
    CREATE INDEXXX-- 
    CREATE LANGUAGEXX-- 
    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEWXX-- 
    CREATE OPERATORXX-- 
    CREATE OPERATOR CLASSXX-- 
    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILYXX-- 
    CREATE POLICYXX-- 
    CREATE PROCEDUREXX-- 
    CREATE PUBLICATIONXX-- 
    CREATE RULEXX-- 
    CREATE SCHEMAXX-- 
    CREATE SEQUENCEXX-- 
    CREATE SERVERXX-- 
    CREATE STATISTICSXX-- 
    CREATE SUBSCRIPTIONXX-- 
    CREATE TABLEXX-- 
    CREATE TABLE ASXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATIONXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARYXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSERXX-- 
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATEXX-- 
    CREATE TRIGGERXX-- 
    CREATE TYPEXX-- 
    CREATE USER MAPPINGXX-- 
    CREATE VIEWXX-- 
    DROP ACCESS METHODXXX- 
    DROP AGGREGATEXXX- 
    DROP CASTXXX- 
    DROP COLLATIONXXX- 
    DROP CONVERSIONXXX- 
    DROP DOMAINXXX- 
    DROP EXTENSIONXXX- 
    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPERXXX- 
    DROP FOREIGN TABLEXXX- 
    DROP FUNCTIONXXX- 
    DROP INDEXXXX- 
    DROP LANGUAGEXXX- 
    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEWXXX- 
    DROP OPERATORXXX- 
    DROP OPERATOR CLASSXXX- 
    DROP OPERATOR FAMILYXXX- 
    DROP OWNEDXXX- 
    DROP POLICYXXX- 
    DROP PROCEDUREXXX- 
    DROP PUBLICATIONXXX- 
    DROP ROUTINEXXX- 
    DROP RULEXXX- 
    DROP SCHEMAXXX- 
    DROP SEQUENCEXXX- 
    DROP SERVERXXX- 
    DROP STATISTICSXXX- 
    DROP SUBSCRIPTIONXXX- 
    DROP TABLEXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATIONXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARYXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSERXXX- 
    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATEXXX- 
    DROP TRIGGERXXX- 
    DROP TYPEXXX- 
    DROP USER MAPPINGXXX- 
    DROP VIEWXXX- 
    GRANTXX--Only for local objects
    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMAXX-- 
    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEWXX-- 
    REVOKEXX--Only for local objects
    SECURITY LABELXX--Only for local objects
    SELECT INTOXX-- 

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-table-rewrite-example.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-table-rewrite-example.html index a007ffc..7786a58 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-table-rewrite-example.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-trigger-table-rewrite-example.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -40.5. A Table Rewrite Event Trigger Example

    40.5. A Table Rewrite Event Trigger Example

    +40.5. A Table Rewrite Event Trigger Example

    40.5. A Table Rewrite Event Trigger Example

    Thanks to the table_rewrite event, it is possible to implement a table rewriting policy only allowing the rewrite in maintenance windows.

    @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER no_rewrite_allowed ON table_rewrite EXECUTE FUNCTION no_rewrite();

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-triggers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-triggers.html index 241b48f..2d20893 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/event-triggers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/event-triggers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 40. Event Triggers

    Chapter 40. Event Triggers

    +Chapter 40. Event Triggers

    Chapter 40. Event Triggers

    To supplement the trigger mechanism discussed in Chapter 39, PostgreSQL also provides event triggers. Unlike regular triggers, which are attached to a single table and capture only DML events, @@ -9,4 +9,4 @@ Like regular triggers, event triggers can be written in any procedural language that includes event trigger support, or in C, but not in plain SQL. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/executor.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/executor.html index e5e6c98..32ec2f2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/executor.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/executor.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -52.6. Executor

    52.6. Executor

    +52.6. Executor

    52.6. Executor

    The executor takes the plan created by the planner/optimizer and recursively processes it to extract the required set of rows. This is essentially a demand-pull pipeline mechanism. @@ -75,4 +75,4 @@ trivial plan tree consisting of a single Result node, which computes just one result row, feeding that up to ModifyTable to perform the insertion. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-joins.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-joins.html index 8e98484..cd98a58 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-joins.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-joins.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -14.3. Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses

    14.3. Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses

    +14.3. Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses

    14.3. Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses

    It is possible to control the query planner to some extent by using the explicit JOIN syntax. To see why this matters, we first need some background. @@ -141,4 +141,4 @@ SELECT * FROM x, y, a, b, c WHERE something AND somethingelse; to control join order with explicit joins). But you might set them differently if you are trying to fine-tune the trade-off between planning time and run time. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-locking.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-locking.html index 9a28c47..728395b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-locking.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/explicit-locking.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -13.3. Explicit Locking

    13.3. Explicit Locking

    +13.3. Explicit Locking

    13.3. Explicit Locking

    PostgreSQL provides various lock modes to control concurrent access to data in tables. These modes can be used for application-controlled locking in situations where @@ -393,4 +393,4 @@ SELECT pg_advisory_lock(q.id) FROM

    The functions provided to manipulate advisory locks are described in Section 9.27.10. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-extensions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-extensions.html index 7c68f3e..6a33771 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-extensions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-extensions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension

    38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension

    +38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension

    38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension

    A useful extension to PostgreSQL typically includes multiple SQL objects; for example, a new data type will require new functions, new operators, and probably new index operator classes. @@ -623,4 +623,4 @@ include $(PGXS) Once the files are installed, use the CREATE EXTENSION command to load the objects into any particular database. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-how.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-how.html index e3aeac9..6097327 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-how.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-how.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.1. How Extensibility Works

    38.1. How Extensibility Works

    +38.1. How Extensibility Works

    38.1. How Extensibility Works

    PostgreSQL is extensible because its operation is catalog-driven. If you are familiar with standard relational database systems, you know that they store information @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@ fly” makes PostgreSQL uniquely suited for rapid prototyping of new applications and storage structures. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-pgxs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-pgxs.html index 3ca6899..ef591c2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-pgxs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-pgxs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure

    38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure

    +38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure

    38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure

    If you are thinking about distributing your PostgreSQL extension modules, setting up a portable build system for them can be fairly difficult. Therefore @@ -227,4 +227,4 @@ make VPATH=/path/to/extension/source/tree install output_iso/results/ directory (for tests in ISOLATION), then copy them to expected/ if they match what you expect from the test. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-type-system.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-type-system.html index 2de46d4..ba0bac5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-type-system.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend-type-system.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System

    38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System

    +38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System

    38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System

    PostgreSQL data types can be divided into base types, container types, domains, and pseudo-types.

    38.2.1. Base Types

    @@ -219,4 +219,4 @@ RETURNS anycompatible AS ... the same as if you had written the appropriate number of anynonarray or anycompatiblenonarray parameters. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend.html index 0bb90ac..352f787 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/extend.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/extend.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 38. Extending SQL

    Chapter 38. Extending SQL

    Table of Contents

    38.1. How Extensibility Works
    38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System
    38.2.1. Base Types
    38.2.2. Container Types
    38.2.3. Domains
    38.2.4. Pseudo-Types
    38.2.5. Polymorphic Types
    38.3. User-Defined Functions
    38.4. User-Defined Procedures
    38.5. Query Language (SQL) Functions
    38.5.1. Arguments for SQL Functions
    38.5.2. SQL Functions on Base Types
    38.5.3. SQL Functions on Composite Types
    38.5.4. SQL Functions with Output Parameters
    38.5.5. SQL Procedures with Output Parameters
    38.5.6. SQL Functions with Variable Numbers of Arguments
    38.5.7. SQL Functions with Default Values for Arguments
    38.5.8. SQL Functions as Table Sources
    38.5.9. SQL Functions Returning Sets
    38.5.10. SQL Functions Returning TABLE
    38.5.11. Polymorphic SQL Functions
    38.5.12. SQL Functions with Collations
    38.6. Function Overloading
    38.7. Function Volatility Categories
    38.8. Procedural Language Functions
    38.9. Internal Functions
    38.10. C-Language Functions
    38.10.1. Dynamic Loading
    38.10.2. Base Types in C-Language Functions
    38.10.3. Version 1 Calling Conventions
    38.10.4. Writing Code
    38.10.5. Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
    38.10.6. Composite-Type Arguments
    38.10.7. Returning Rows (Composite Types)
    38.10.8. Returning Sets
    38.10.9. Polymorphic Arguments and Return Types
    38.10.10. Shared Memory and LWLocks
    38.10.11. Using C++ for Extensibility
    38.11. Function Optimization Information
    38.12. User-Defined Aggregates
    38.12.1. Moving-Aggregate Mode
    38.12.2. Polymorphic and Variadic Aggregates
    38.12.3. Ordered-Set Aggregates
    38.12.4. Partial Aggregation
    38.12.5. Support Functions for Aggregates
    38.13. User-Defined Types
    38.13.1. TOAST Considerations
    38.14. User-Defined Operators
    38.15. Operator Optimization Information
    38.15.1. COMMUTATOR
    38.15.2. NEGATOR
    38.15.3. RESTRICT
    38.15.4. JOIN
    38.15.5. HASHES
    38.15.6. MERGES
    38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes
    38.16.1. Index Methods and Operator Classes
    38.16.2. Index Method Strategies
    38.16.3. Index Method Support Routines
    38.16.4. An Example
    38.16.5. Operator Classes and Operator Families
    38.16.6. System Dependencies on Operator Classes
    38.16.7. Ordering Operators
    38.16.8. Special Features of Operator Classes
    38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension
    38.17.1. Extension Files
    38.17.2. Extension Relocatability
    38.17.3. Extension Configuration Tables
    38.17.4. Extension Updates
    38.17.5. Installing Extensions Using Update Scripts
    38.17.6. Security Considerations for Extensions
    38.17.7. Extension Example
    38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure

    +Chapter 38. Extending SQL

    Chapter 38. Extending SQL

    Table of Contents

    38.1. How Extensibility Works
    38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System
    38.2.1. Base Types
    38.2.2. Container Types
    38.2.3. Domains
    38.2.4. Pseudo-Types
    38.2.5. Polymorphic Types
    38.3. User-Defined Functions
    38.4. User-Defined Procedures
    38.5. Query Language (SQL) Functions
    38.5.1. Arguments for SQL Functions
    38.5.2. SQL Functions on Base Types
    38.5.3. SQL Functions on Composite Types
    38.5.4. SQL Functions with Output Parameters
    38.5.5. SQL Procedures with Output Parameters
    38.5.6. SQL Functions with Variable Numbers of Arguments
    38.5.7. SQL Functions with Default Values for Arguments
    38.5.8. SQL Functions as Table Sources
    38.5.9. SQL Functions Returning Sets
    38.5.10. SQL Functions Returning TABLE
    38.5.11. Polymorphic SQL Functions
    38.5.12. SQL Functions with Collations
    38.6. Function Overloading
    38.7. Function Volatility Categories
    38.8. Procedural Language Functions
    38.9. Internal Functions
    38.10. C-Language Functions
    38.10.1. Dynamic Loading
    38.10.2. Base Types in C-Language Functions
    38.10.3. Version 1 Calling Conventions
    38.10.4. Writing Code
    38.10.5. Compiling and Linking Dynamically-Loaded Functions
    38.10.6. Composite-Type Arguments
    38.10.7. Returning Rows (Composite Types)
    38.10.8. Returning Sets
    38.10.9. Polymorphic Arguments and Return Types
    38.10.10. Shared Memory and LWLocks
    38.10.11. Using C++ for Extensibility
    38.11. Function Optimization Information
    38.12. User-Defined Aggregates
    38.12.1. Moving-Aggregate Mode
    38.12.2. Polymorphic and Variadic Aggregates
    38.12.3. Ordered-Set Aggregates
    38.12.4. Partial Aggregation
    38.12.5. Support Functions for Aggregates
    38.13. User-Defined Types
    38.13.1. TOAST Considerations
    38.14. User-Defined Operators
    38.15. Operator Optimization Information
    38.15.1. COMMUTATOR
    38.15.2. NEGATOR
    38.15.3. RESTRICT
    38.15.4. JOIN
    38.15.5. HASHES
    38.15.6. MERGES
    38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes
    38.16.1. Index Methods and Operator Classes
    38.16.2. Index Method Strategies
    38.16.3. Index Method Support Routines
    38.16.4. An Example
    38.16.5. Operator Classes and Operator Families
    38.16.6. System Dependencies on Operator Classes
    38.16.7. Ordering Operators
    38.16.8. Special Features of Operator Classes
    38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension
    38.17.1. Extension Files
    38.17.2. Extension Relocatability
    38.17.3. Extension Configuration Tables
    38.17.4. Extension Updates
    38.17.5. Installing Extensions Using Update Scripts
    38.17.6. Security Considerations for Extensions
    38.17.7. Extension Example
    38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure

    In the sections that follow, we will discuss how you can extend the PostgreSQL SQL query language by adding: @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@

  • packages of related objects (starting in Section 38.17)

  • -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-admin-tools.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-admin-tools.html index e5206b1..72bfaab 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-admin-tools.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-admin-tools.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -H.2. Administration Tools

    H.2. Administration Tools

    +H.2. Administration Tools

    H.2. Administration Tools

    There are several administration tools available for PostgreSQL. The most popular is pgAdmin, and there are several commercially available ones as well. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-extensions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-extensions.html index 7d142dd..ef86722 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-extensions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-extensions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -H.4. Extensions

    H.4. Extensions

    +H.4. Extensions

    H.4. Extensions

    PostgreSQL is designed to be easily extensible. For this reason, extensions loaded into the database can function just like features that are built in. The @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ externally. For example, Slony-I is a popular primary/standby replication solution that is developed independently from the core project. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-interfaces.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-interfaces.html index 0a89b94..04cf5e7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-interfaces.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-interfaces.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -H.1. Client Interfaces

    H.1. Client Interfaces

    +H.1. Client Interfaces

    H.1. Client Interfaces

    There are only two client interfaces included in the base PostgreSQL distribution:

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-pl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-pl.html index 4e60555..3baf39a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-pl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-pl.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -H.3. Procedural Languages

    H.3. Procedural Languages

    +H.3. Procedural Languages

    H.3. Procedural Languages

    PostgreSQL includes several procedural languages with the base distribution: PL/pgSQL, PL/Tcl, PL/Perl, and PL/Python. @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ and documentation.

    https://wiki.postgresql.org/wiki/PL_Matrix -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-projects.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-projects.html index f4c9706..5bd461e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/external-projects.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/external-projects.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -Appendix H. External Projects

    Appendix H. External Projects

    +Appendix H. External Projects

    Appendix H. External Projects

    PostgreSQL is a complex software project, and managing the project is difficult. We have found that many enhancements to PostgreSQL can be more efficiently developed separately from the core project. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-callbacks.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-callbacks.html index a515df6..940f2f0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-callbacks.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-callbacks.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -59.2. Foreign Data Wrapper Callback Routines

    59.2. Foreign Data Wrapper Callback Routines

    +59.2. Foreign Data Wrapper Callback Routines

    59.2. Foreign Data Wrapper Callback Routines

    The FDW handler function returns a palloc'd FdwRoutine struct containing pointers to the callback functions described below. The scan-related functions are required, the rest are optional. @@ -1254,4 +1254,4 @@ ReparameterizeForeignPathByChild(PlannerInfo *root, List *fdw_private, callback may use reparameterize_path_by_child, adjust_appendrel_attrs or adjust_appendrel_attrs_multilevel as required. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-functions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-functions.html index ab19bdc..25e6ce3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-functions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-functions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -59.1. Foreign Data Wrapper Functions

    59.1. Foreign Data Wrapper Functions

    +59.1. Foreign Data Wrapper Functions

    59.1. Foreign Data Wrapper Functions

    The FDW author needs to implement a handler function, and optionally a validator function. Both functions must be written in a compiled language such as C, using the version-1 interface. @@ -24,13 +24,10 @@ foreign tables using the wrapper. The validator function must be registered as taking two arguments, a text array containing the options to be validated, and an OID - representing the type of object the options are associated with (in - the form of the OID of the system catalog the object would be stored - in, either - ForeignDataWrapperRelationId, - ForeignServerRelationId, - UserMappingRelationId, - or ForeignTableRelationId). + representing the type of object the options are associated with. The + latter corresponds to the OID of the system catalog the object + would be stored in, one of: +

    • AttributeRelationId

    • ForeignDataWrapperRelationId

    • ForeignServerRelationId

    • ForeignTableRelationId

    • UserMappingRelationId

    If no validator function is supplied, options are not checked at object creation time or object alteration time. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-helpers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-helpers.html index b77c43a..8efa389 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-helpers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-helpers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -59.3. Foreign Data Wrapper Helper Functions

    59.3. Foreign Data Wrapper Helper Functions

    +59.3. Foreign Data Wrapper Helper Functions

    59.3. Foreign Data Wrapper Helper Functions

    Several helper functions are exported from the core server so that authors of foreign data wrappers can get easy access to attributes of FDW-related objects, such as FDW options. @@ -111,4 +111,4 @@ GetForeignServerByName(const char *name, bool missing_ok); This function returns a ForeignServer object for the foreign server with the given name. If the server is not found, return NULL if missing_ok is true, otherwise raise an error. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-planning.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-planning.html index 314efb4..019c475 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-planning.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-planning.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -59.4. Foreign Data Wrapper Query Planning

    59.4. Foreign Data Wrapper Query Planning

    +59.4. Foreign Data Wrapper Query Planning

    59.4. Foreign Data Wrapper Query Planning

    The FDW callback functions GetForeignRelSize, GetForeignPaths, GetForeignPlan, PlanForeignModify, GetForeignJoinPaths, @@ -188,4 +188,4 @@ exclusion constraints on remote tables are not locally known. This in turn implies that ON CONFLICT DO UPDATE is not supported, since the specification is mandatory there. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-row-locking.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-row-locking.html index d41ffc3..9cf237f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-row-locking.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdw-row-locking.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -59.5. Row Locking in Foreign Data Wrappers

    59.5. Row Locking in Foreign Data Wrappers

    +59.5. Row Locking in Foreign Data Wrappers

    59.5. Row Locking in Foreign Data Wrappers

    If an FDW's underlying storage mechanism has a concept of locking individual rows to prevent concurrent updates of those rows, it is usually worthwhile for the FDW to perform row-level locking with as @@ -90,4 +90,4 @@ in src/include/nodes/plannodes.h, and the comments for ExecRowMark in src/include/nodes/execnodes.h for additional information. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdwhandler.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdwhandler.html index 264c262..4a1c33b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/fdwhandler.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/fdwhandler.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 59. Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper

    Chapter 59. Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper

    +Chapter 59. Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/features-sql-standard.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/features-sql-standard.html index 14d7f5f..c66611a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/features-sql-standard.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/features-sql-standard.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -D.1. Supported Features

    D.1. Supported Features

    +D.1. Supported Features

    D.1. Supported Features

    IdentifierCore?DescriptionComment
    B012 Embedded C 
    B021 Direct SQL 
    B128 Routine language SQL 
    E011CoreNumeric data types 
    E011-01CoreINTEGER and SMALLINT data types 
    E011-02CoreREAL, DOUBLE PRECISION, and FLOAT data types 
    E011-03CoreDECIMAL and NUMERIC data types 
    E011-04CoreArithmetic operators 
    E011-05CoreNumeric comparison 
    E011-06CoreImplicit casting among the numeric data types 
    E021CoreCharacter data types 
    E021-01CoreCHARACTER data type 
    E021-02CoreCHARACTER VARYING data type 
    E021-03CoreCharacter literals 
    E021-04CoreCHARACTER_LENGTH functiontrims trailing spaces from CHARACTER values before counting
    E021-05CoreOCTET_LENGTH function 
    E021-06CoreSUBSTRING function 
    E021-07CoreCharacter concatenation 
    E021-08CoreUPPER and LOWER functions 
    E021-09CoreTRIM function 
    E021-10CoreImplicit casting among the character string types 
    E021-11CorePOSITION function 
    E021-12CoreCharacter comparison 
    E031CoreIdentifiers 
    E031-01CoreDelimited identifiers 
    E031-02CoreLower case identifiers 
    E031-03CoreTrailing underscore 
    E051CoreBasic query specification 
    E051-01CoreSELECT DISTINCT 
    E051-02CoreGROUP BY clause 
    E051-04CoreGROUP BY can contain columns not in <select list> 
    E051-05CoreSelect list items can be renamed 
    E051-06CoreHAVING clause 
    E051-07CoreQualified * in select list 
    E051-08CoreCorrelation names in the FROM clause 
    E051-09CoreRename columns in the FROM clause 
    E061CoreBasic predicates and search conditions 
    E061-01CoreComparison predicate 
    E061-02CoreBETWEEN predicate 
    E061-03CoreIN predicate with list of values 
    E061-04CoreLIKE predicate 
    E061-05CoreLIKE predicate ESCAPE clause 
    E061-06CoreNULL predicate 
    E061-07CoreQuantified comparison predicate 
    E061-08CoreEXISTS predicate 
    E061-09CoreSubqueries in comparison predicate 
    E061-11CoreSubqueries in IN predicate 
    E061-12CoreSubqueries in quantified comparison predicate 
    E061-13CoreCorrelated subqueries 
    E061-14CoreSearch condition 
    E071CoreBasic query expressions 
    E071-01CoreUNION DISTINCT table operator 
    E071-02CoreUNION ALL table operator 
    E071-03CoreEXCEPT DISTINCT table operator 
    E071-05CoreColumns combined via table operators need not have exactly the same data type 
    E071-06CoreTable operators in subqueries 
    E081CoreBasic Privileges 
    E081-01CoreSELECT privilege 
    E081-02CoreDELETE privilege 
    E081-03CoreINSERT privilege at the table level 
    E081-04CoreUPDATE privilege at the table level 
    E081-05CoreUPDATE privilege at the column level 
    E081-06CoreREFERENCES privilege at the table level 
    E081-07CoreREFERENCES privilege at the column level 
    E081-08CoreWITH GRANT OPTION 
    E081-09CoreUSAGE privilege 
    E081-10CoreEXECUTE privilege 
    E091CoreSet functions 
    E091-01CoreAVG 
    E091-02CoreCOUNT 
    E091-03CoreMAX 
    E091-04CoreMIN 
    E091-05CoreSUM 
    E091-06CoreALL quantifier 
    E091-07CoreDISTINCT quantifier 
    E101CoreBasic data manipulation 
    E101-01CoreINSERT statement 
    E101-03CoreSearched UPDATE statement 
    E101-04CoreSearched DELETE statement 
    E111CoreSingle row SELECT statement 
    E121CoreBasic cursor support 
    E121-01CoreDECLARE CURSOR 
    E121-02CoreORDER BY columns need not be in select list 
    E121-03CoreValue expressions in ORDER BY clause 
    E121-04CoreOPEN statement 
    E121-06CorePositioned UPDATE statement 
    E121-07CorePositioned DELETE statement 
    E121-08CoreCLOSE statement 
    E121-10CoreFETCH statement implicit NEXT 
    E121-17CoreWITH HOLD cursors 
    E131CoreNull value support (nulls in lieu of values) 
    E141CoreBasic integrity constraints 
    E141-01CoreNOT NULL constraints 
    E141-02CoreUNIQUE constraints of NOT NULL columns 
    E141-03CorePRIMARY KEY constraints 
    E141-04CoreBasic FOREIGN KEY constraint with the NO ACTION default for both referential delete action and referential update action 
    E141-06CoreCHECK constraints 
    E141-07CoreColumn defaults 
    E141-08CoreNOT NULL inferred on PRIMARY KEY 
    E141-10CoreNames in a foreign key can be specified in any order 
    E151CoreTransaction support 
    E151-01CoreCOMMIT statement 
    E151-02CoreROLLBACK statement 
    E152CoreBasic SET TRANSACTION statement 
    E152-01CoreSET TRANSACTION statement: ISOLATION LEVEL SERIALIZABLE clause 
    E152-02CoreSET TRANSACTION statement: READ ONLY and READ WRITE clauses 
    E153CoreUpdatable queries with subqueries 
    E161CoreSQL comments using leading double minus 
    E171CoreSQLSTATE support 
    E182CoreHost language binding 
    F021CoreBasic information schema 
    F021-01CoreCOLUMNS view 
    F021-02CoreTABLES view 
    F021-03CoreVIEWS view 
    F021-04CoreTABLE_CONSTRAINTS view 
    F021-05CoreREFERENTIAL_CONSTRAINTS view 
    F021-06CoreCHECK_CONSTRAINTS view 
    F031CoreBasic schema manipulation 
    F031-01CoreCREATE TABLE statement to create persistent base tables 
    F031-02CoreCREATE VIEW statement 
    F031-03CoreGRANT statement 
    F031-04CoreALTER TABLE statement: ADD COLUMN clause 
    F031-13CoreDROP TABLE statement: RESTRICT clause 
    F031-16CoreDROP VIEW statement: RESTRICT clause 
    F031-19CoreREVOKE statement: RESTRICT clause 
    F032 CASCADE drop behavior 
    F033 ALTER TABLE statement: DROP COLUMN clause 
    F034 Extended REVOKE statement 
    F034-01 REVOKE statement performed by other than the owner of a schema object 
    F034-02 REVOKE statement: GRANT OPTION FOR clause 
    F034-03 REVOKE statement to revoke a privilege that the grantee has WITH GRANT OPTION 
    F041CoreBasic joined table 
    F041-01CoreInner join (but not necessarily the INNER keyword) 
    F041-02CoreINNER keyword 
    F041-03CoreLEFT OUTER JOIN 
    F041-04CoreRIGHT OUTER JOIN 
    F041-05CoreOuter joins can be nested 
    F041-07CoreThe inner table in a left or right outer join can also be used in an inner join 
    F041-08CoreAll comparison operators are supported (rather than just =) 
    F051CoreBasic date and time 
    F051-01CoreDATE data type (including support of DATE literal) 
    F051-02CoreTIME data type (including support of TIME literal) with fractional seconds precision of at least 0 
    F051-03CoreTIMESTAMP data type (including support of TIMESTAMP literal) with fractional seconds precision of at least 0 and 6 
    F051-04CoreComparison predicate on DATE, TIME, and TIMESTAMP data types 
    F051-05CoreExplicit CAST between datetime types and character string types 
    F051-06CoreCURRENT_DATE 
    F051-07CoreLOCALTIME 
    F051-08CoreLOCALTIMESTAMP 
    F052 Intervals and datetime arithmetic 
    F053 OVERLAPS predicate 
    F081CoreUNION and EXCEPT in views 
    F111 Isolation levels other than SERIALIZABLE 
    F111-01 READ UNCOMMITTED isolation level 
    F111-02 READ COMMITTED isolation level 
    F111-03 REPEATABLE READ isolation level 
    F131CoreGrouped operations 
    F131-01CoreWHERE, GROUP BY, and HAVING clauses supported in queries with grouped views 
    F131-02CoreMultiple tables supported in queries with grouped views 
    F131-03CoreSet functions supported in queries with grouped views 
    F131-04CoreSubqueries with GROUP BY and HAVING clauses and grouped views 
    F131-05CoreSingle row SELECT with GROUP BY and HAVING clauses and grouped views 
    F171 Multiple schemas per user 
    F181CoreMultiple module support 
    F191 Referential delete actions 
    F200 TRUNCATE TABLE statement 
    F201CoreCAST function 
    F202 TRUNCATE TABLE: identity column restart option 
    F221CoreExplicit defaults 
    F222 INSERT statement: DEFAULT VALUES clause 
    F231 Privilege tables 
    F231-01 TABLE_PRIVILEGES view 
    F231-02 COLUMN_PRIVILEGES view 
    F231-03 USAGE_PRIVILEGES view 
    F251 Domain support 
    F261CoreCASE expression 
    F261-01CoreSimple CASE 
    F261-02CoreSearched CASE 
    F261-03CoreNULLIF 
    F261-04CoreCOALESCE 
    F262 Extended CASE expression 
    F271 Compound character literals 
    F281 LIKE enhancements 
    F292 UNIQUE null treatmentSQL:202x draft
    F302 INTERSECT table operator 
    F302-01 INTERSECT DISTINCT table operator 
    F302-02 INTERSECT ALL table operator 
    F304 EXCEPT ALL table operator 
    F311CoreSchema definition statement 
    F311-01CoreCREATE SCHEMA 
    F311-02CoreCREATE TABLE for persistent base tables 
    F311-03CoreCREATE VIEW 
    F311-04CoreCREATE VIEW: WITH CHECK OPTION 
    F311-05CoreGRANT statement 
    F312 MERGE statement 
    F313 Enhanced MERGE statement 
    F314 MERGE statement with DELETE branch 
    F321 User authorization 
    F341 Usage tables 
    F361 Subprogram support 
    F381 Extended schema manipulation 
    F381-01 ALTER TABLE statement: ALTER COLUMN clause 
    F381-02 ALTER TABLE statement: ADD CONSTRAINT clause 
    F381-03 ALTER TABLE statement: DROP CONSTRAINT clause 
    F382 Alter column data type 
    F383 Set column not null clause 
    F384 Drop identity property clause 
    F385 Drop column generation expression clause 
    F386 Set identity column generation clause 
    F391 Long identifiers 
    F392 Unicode escapes in identifiers 
    F393 Unicode escapes in literals 
    F394 Optional normal form specification 
    F401 Extended joined table 
    F401-01 NATURAL JOIN 
    F401-02 FULL OUTER JOIN 
    F401-04 CROSS JOIN 
    F402 Named column joins for LOBs, arrays, and multisets 
    F404 Range variable for common column names 
    F411 Time zone specificationdifferences regarding literal interpretation
    F421 National character 
    F431 Read-only scrollable cursors 
    F431-01 FETCH with explicit NEXT 
    F431-02 FETCH FIRST 
    F431-03 FETCH LAST 
    F431-04 FETCH PRIOR 
    F431-05 FETCH ABSOLUTE 
    F431-06 FETCH RELATIVE 
    F441 Extended set function support 
    F442 Mixed column references in set functions 
    F471CoreScalar subquery values 
    F481CoreExpanded NULL predicate 
    F491 Constraint management 
    F501CoreFeatures and conformance views 
    F501-01CoreSQL_FEATURES view 
    F501-02CoreSQL_SIZING view 
    F502 Enhanced documentation tables 
    F531 Temporary tables 
    F555 Enhanced seconds precision 
    F561 Full value expressions 
    F571 Truth value tests 
    F591 Derived tables 
    F611 Indicator data types 
    F641 Row and table constructors 
    F651 Catalog name qualifiers 
    F661 Simple tables 
    F672 Retrospective check constraints 
    F690 Collation supportbut no character set support
    F692 Extended collation support 
    F701 Referential update actions 
    F711 ALTER domain 
    F731 INSERT column privileges 
    F751 View CHECK enhancements 
    F761 Session management 
    F762 CURRENT_CATALOG 
    F763 CURRENT_SCHEMA 
    F771 Connection management 
    F781 Self-referencing operations 
    F791 Insensitive cursors 
    F801 Full set function 
    F850 Top-level <order by clause> in <query expression> 
    F851 <order by clause> in subqueries 
    F852 Top-level <order by clause> in views 
    F855 Nested <order by clause> in <query expression> 
    F856 Nested <fetch first clause> in <query expression> 
    F857 Top-level <fetch first clause> in <query expression> 
    F858 <fetch first clause> in subqueries 
    F859 Top-level <fetch first clause> in views 
    F860 <fetch first row count> in <fetch first clause> 
    F861 Top-level <result offset clause> in <query expression> 
    F862 <result offset clause> in subqueries 
    F863 Nested <result offset clause> in <query expression> 
    F864 Top-level <result offset clause> in views 
    F865 <offset row count> in <result offset clause> 
    F867 FETCH FIRST clause: WITH TIES option 
    S071 SQL paths in function and type name resolution 
    S091-01 Arrays of built-in data types 
    S091-03 Array expressions 
    S092 Arrays of user-defined types 
    S095 Array constructors by query 
    S096 Optional array bounds 
    S098 ARRAY_AGG 
    S111 ONLY in query expressions 
    S201 SQL-invoked routines on arrays 
    S201-01 Array parameters 
    S201-02 Array as result type of functions 
    S211 User-defined cast functions 
    S301 Enhanced UNNEST 
    S404 TRIM_ARRAY 
    T031 BOOLEAN data type 
    T071 BIGINT data type 
    T121 WITH (excluding RECURSIVE) in query expression 
    T122 WITH (excluding RECURSIVE) in subquery 
    T131 Recursive query 
    T132 Recursive query in subquery 
    T133 Enhanced cycle mark valuesSQL:202x draft
    T141 SIMILAR predicate 
    T151 DISTINCT predicate 
    T152 DISTINCT predicate with negation 
    T171 LIKE clause in table definition 
    T172 AS subquery clause in table definition 
    T173 Extended LIKE clause in table definition 
    T174 Identity columns 
    T177 Sequence generator support: simple restart option 
    T178 Identity columns: simple restart option 
    T191 Referential action RESTRICT 
    T201 Comparable data types for referential constraints 
    T211-01 Triggers activated on UPDATE, INSERT, or DELETE of one base table 
    T211-02 BEFORE triggers 
    T211-03 AFTER triggers 
    T211-04 FOR EACH ROW triggers 
    T211-05 Ability to specify a search condition that must be true before the trigger is invoked 
    T211-07 TRIGGER privilege 
    T212 Enhanced trigger capability 
    T213 INSTEAD OF triggers 
    T241 START TRANSACTION statement 
    T261 Chained transactions 
    T271 Savepoints 
    T281 SELECT privilege with column granularity 
    T285 Enhanced derived column names 
    T312 OVERLAY function 
    T321-01CoreUser-defined functions with no overloading 
    T321-02CoreUser-defined stored procedures with no overloading 
    T321-03CoreFunction invocation 
    T321-04CoreCALL statement 
    T321-05CoreRETURN statement 
    T321-06CoreROUTINES view 
    T321-07CorePARAMETERS view 
    T323 Explicit security for external routines 
    T325 Qualified SQL parameter references 
    T331 Basic roles 
    T332 Extended roles 
    T341 Overloading of SQL-invoked functions and procedures 
    T351 Bracketed SQL comments (/*...*/ comments) 
    T431 Extended grouping capabilities 
    T432 Nested and concatenated GROUPING SETS 
    T433 Multiargument GROUPING function 
    T434 GROUP BY DISTINCT 
    T441 ABS and MOD functions 
    T461 Symmetric BETWEEN predicate 
    T491 LATERAL derived table 
    T501 Enhanced EXISTS predicate 
    T521 Named arguments in CALL statement 
    T523 Default values for INOUT parameters of SQL-invoked procedures 
    T524 Named arguments in routine invocations other than a CALL statement 
    T525 Default values for parameters of SQL-invoked functions 
    T551 Optional key words for default syntax 
    T581 Regular expression substring function 
    T591 UNIQUE constraints of possibly null columns 
    T611 Elementary OLAP operations 
    T612 Advanced OLAP operations 
    T613 Sampling 
    T614 NTILE function 
    T615 LEAD and LAG functions 
    T617 FIRST_VALUE and LAST_VALUE function 
    T620 WINDOW clause: GROUPS option 
    T621 Enhanced numeric functions 
    T622 Trigonometric functions 
    T623 General logarithm functions 
    T624 Common logarithm functions 
    T631CoreIN predicate with one list element 
    T651 SQL-schema statements in SQL routines 
    T653 SQL-schema statements in external routines 
    T655 Cyclically dependent routines 
    T831 SQL/JSON path language: strict mode 
    T832 SQL/JSON path language: item method 
    T833 SQL/JSON path language: multiple subscripts 
    T834 SQL/JSON path language: wildcard member accessor 
    T835 SQL/JSON path language: filter expressions 
    T836 SQL/JSON path language: starts with predicate 
    T837 SQL/JSON path language: regex_like predicate 
    X010 XML type 
    X011 Arrays of XML type 
    X014 Attributes of XML type 
    X016 Persistent XML values 
    X020 XMLConcat 
    X031 XMLElement 
    X032 XMLForest 
    X034 XMLAgg 
    X035 XMLAgg: ORDER BY option 
    X036 XMLComment 
    X037 XMLPI 
    X040 Basic table mapping 
    X041 Basic table mapping: nulls absent 
    X042 Basic table mapping: null as nil 
    X043 Basic table mapping: table as forest 
    X044 Basic table mapping: table as element 
    X045 Basic table mapping: with target namespace 
    X046 Basic table mapping: data mapping 
    X047 Basic table mapping: metadata mapping 
    X048 Basic table mapping: base64 encoding of binary strings 
    X049 Basic table mapping: hex encoding of binary strings 
    X050 Advanced table mapping 
    X051 Advanced table mapping: nulls absent 
    X052 Advanced table mapping: null as nil 
    X053 Advanced table mapping: table as forest 
    X054 Advanced table mapping: table as element 
    X055 Advanced table mapping: with target namespace 
    X056 Advanced table mapping: data mapping 
    X057 Advanced table mapping: metadata mapping 
    X058 Advanced table mapping: base64 encoding of binary strings 
    X059 Advanced table mapping: hex encoding of binary strings 
    X060 XMLParse: character string input and CONTENT option 
    X061 XMLParse: character string input and DOCUMENT option 
    X070 XMLSerialize: character string serialization and CONTENT option 
    X071 XMLSerialize: character string serialization and DOCUMENT option 
    X072 XMLSerialize: character string serialization 
    X090 XML document predicate 
    X120 XML parameters in SQL routines 
    X121 XML parameters in external routines 
    X221 XML passing mechanism BY VALUE 
    X301 XMLTable: derived column list option 
    X302 XMLTable: ordinality column option 
    X303 XMLTable: column default option 
    X304 XMLTable: passing a context itemmust be XML DOCUMENT
    X400 Name and identifier mapping 
    X410 Alter column data type: XML type 

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/features.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/features.html index e332e1d..fa08f62 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/features.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/features.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix D. SQL Conformance

    Appendix D. SQL Conformance

    +Appendix D. SQL Conformance

    Appendix D. SQL Conformance

    This section attempts to outline to what extent PostgreSQL conforms to the current SQL standard. The following information is not a full statement of @@ -70,4 +70,4 @@ Feature codes containing a hyphen are subfeatures. Therefore, if a particular subfeature is not supported, the main feature is listed as unsupported even if some other subfeatures are supported. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/file-fdw.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/file-fdw.html index 4e39a51..61fdd76 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/file-fdw.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/file-fdw.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.16. file_fdw

    F.16. file_fdw

    +F.16. file_fdw

    F.16. file_fdw

    The file_fdw module provides the foreign-data wrapper file_fdw, which can be used to access data files in the server's file system, or to execute programs on the server @@ -142,4 +142,4 @@ OPTIONS ( filename 'log/pglog.csv', format 'csv' );

    That's it — now you can query your log directly. In production, of course, you would need to define some way to deal with log rotation. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-admin.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-admin.html index d24c26f..c1e0715 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-admin.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-admin.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.27. System Administration Functions

    9.27. System Administration Functions

    +9.27. System Administration Functions

    9.27. System Administration Functions

    The functions described in this section are used to control and monitor a PostgreSQL installation.

    9.27.1. Configuration Settings Functions

    @@ -1645,4 +1645,4 @@ SELECT convert_from(pg_read_binary_file('file_in_utf8.txt'), 'UTF8'); This will either obtain the lock immediately and return true, or return false without waiting if the lock cannot be acquired immediately. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-aggregate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-aggregate.html index 2485533..1723136 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-aggregate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-aggregate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.21. Aggregate Functions

    9.21. Aggregate Functions

    +9.21. Aggregate Functions

    9.21. Aggregate Functions

    Aggregate functions compute a single result from a set of input values. The built-in general-purpose aggregate functions are listed in Table 9.58 @@ -726,4 +726,4 @@ SELECT count(*) FROM sometable; neither make nor model was grouped by in the last row (which therefore is an aggregate over all the input rows). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-array.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-array.html index 2eeb231..ec1cc4f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-array.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-array.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.19. Array Functions and Operators

    9.19. Array Functions and Operators

    +9.19. Array Functions and Operators

    9.19. Array Functions and Operators

    Table 9.52 shows the specialized operators available for array types. In addition to those, the usual comparison operators shown in Table 9.1 are available for @@ -382,4 +382,4 @@


    See also Section 9.21 about the aggregate function array_agg for use with arrays. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-binarystring.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-binarystring.html index b1a536e..ba0b67f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-binarystring.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-binarystring.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators

    9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators

    +9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators

    9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators

    This section describes functions and operators for examining and manipulating binary strings, that is values of type bytea. Many of these are equivalent, in purpose and syntax, to the @@ -507,4 +507,4 @@ See also the aggregate function string_agg in Section 9.21 and the large object functions in Section 35.4. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-bitstring.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-bitstring.html index 9a0ffe1..265b296 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-bitstring.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-bitstring.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators

    9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators

    +9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators

    9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators

    This section describes functions and operators for examining and manipulating bit strings, that is values of the types bit and bit varying. (While only @@ -232,4 +232,4 @@ cast(-44 as bit(12)) bit means casting to bit(1), and so will deliver only the least significant bit of the integer. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparison.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparison.html index 9a4661c..6c9e82b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparison.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparison.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators

    9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators

    +9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators

    9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators

    The usual comparison operators are available, as shown in Table 9.1.

    Table 9.1. Comparison Operators

    OperatorDescription
    datatype < datatype @@ -397,4 +397,4 @@

    num_nulls(1, NULL, 2)1 -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparisons.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparisons.html index c36de4c..1e08113 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparisons.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-comparisons.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.24. Row and Array Comparisons

    9.24. Row and Array Comparisons

    +9.24. Row and Array Comparisons

    9.24. Row and Array Comparisons

    This section describes several specialized constructs for making multiple comparisons between groups of values. These forms are syntactically related to the subquery forms of the previous section, @@ -212,4 +212,4 @@ AND for materialized views and might be useful for other specialized purposes such as replication and B-Tree deduplication (see Section 67.4.3). They are not intended to be generally useful for writing queries, though. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-conditional.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-conditional.html index 0ce4001..8db014d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-conditional.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-conditional.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.18. Conditional Expressions

    9.18. Conditional Expressions

    +9.18. Conditional Expressions

    9.18. Conditional Expressions

    This section describes the SQL-compliant conditional expressions available in PostgreSQL.

    Tip

    @@ -184,4 +184,4 @@ SELECT NULLIF(value, '(none)') ... the SQL standard, but are a common extension. Some other databases make them return NULL if any argument is NULL, rather than only when all are NULL. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-datetime.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-datetime.html index a5b5eed..9523015 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-datetime.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-datetime.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators

    9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators

    +9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators

    9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators

    Table 9.33 shows the available functions for date/time value processing, with details appearing in the following subsections. Table 9.32 illustrates the behaviors of @@ -1313,4 +1313,4 @@ SELECT pg_sleep_until('tomorrow 03:00'); when calling pg_sleep or its variants. Otherwise other sessions might have to wait for your sleeping process, slowing down the entire system. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-enum.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-enum.html index 1e55029..7f4e134 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-enum.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-enum.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.10. Enum Support Functions

    9.10. Enum Support Functions

    +9.10. Enum Support Functions

    9.10. Enum Support Functions

    For enum types (described in Section 8.7), there are several functions that allow cleaner programming without hard-coding particular values of an enum type. @@ -81,4 +81,4 @@ CREATE TYPE rainbow AS ENUM ('red', 'orange', 'yellow', 'green', 'blue', 'purple the type can be passed, with the same result. It is more common to apply these functions to a table column or function argument than to a hardwired type name as used in the examples. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-event-triggers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-event-triggers.html index de23b5f..d5e41a6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-event-triggers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-event-triggers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.29. Event Trigger Functions

    9.29. Event Trigger Functions

    +9.29. Event Trigger Functions

    9.29. Event Trigger Functions

    PostgreSQL provides these helper functions to retrieve information from event triggers.

    @@ -130,4 +130,4 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER test_table_rewrite_oid ON table_rewrite EXECUTE FUNCTION test_event_trigger_table_rewrite_oid();

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-formatting.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-formatting.html index 089e24e..a509eee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-formatting.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-formatting.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions

    9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions

    +9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions

    9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions

    The PostgreSQL formatting functions provide a powerful set of tools for converting various data types (date/time, integer, floating point, numeric) to formatted strings @@ -407,4 +407,4 @@

    Table 9.30. Template Pattern Modifiers for Numeric Formatting

    ModifierDescriptionExample
    FM prefixfill mode (suppress trailing zeroes and padding blanks)FM99.99
    TH suffixupper case ordinal number suffix999TH
    th suffixlower case ordinal number suffix999th

    Table 9.31 shows some examples of the use of the to_char function. -

    Table 9.31. to_char Examples

    ExpressionResult
    to_char(current_timestamp, 'Day, DD  HH12:MI:SS')'Tuesday  , 06  05:39:18'
    to_char(current_timestamp, 'FMDay, FMDD  HH12:MI:SS')'Tuesday, 6  05:39:18'
    to_char(-0.1, '99.99')'  -.10'
    to_char(-0.1, 'FM9.99')'-.1'
    to_char(-0.1, 'FM90.99')'-0.1'
    to_char(0.1, '0.9')' 0.1'
    to_char(12, '9990999.9')'    0012.0'
    to_char(12, 'FM9990999.9')'0012.'
    to_char(485, '999')' 485'
    to_char(-485, '999')'-485'
    to_char(485, '9 9 9')' 4 8 5'
    to_char(1485, '9,999')' 1,485'
    to_char(1485, '9G999')' 1 485'
    to_char(148.5, '999.999')' 148.500'
    to_char(148.5, 'FM999.999')'148.5'
    to_char(148.5, 'FM999.990')'148.500'
    to_char(148.5, '999D999')' 148,500'
    to_char(3148.5, '9G999D999')' 3 148,500'
    to_char(-485, '999S')'485-'
    to_char(-485, '999MI')'485-'
    to_char(485, '999MI')'485 '
    to_char(485, 'FM999MI')'485'
    to_char(485, 'PL999')'+485'
    to_char(485, 'SG999')'+485'
    to_char(-485, 'SG999')'-485'
    to_char(-485, '9SG99')'4-85'
    to_char(-485, '999PR')'<485>'
    to_char(485, 'L999')'DM 485'
    to_char(485, 'RN')'        CDLXXXV'
    to_char(485, 'FMRN')'CDLXXXV'
    to_char(5.2, 'FMRN')'V'
    to_char(482, '999th')' 482nd'
    to_char(485, '"Good number:"999')'Good number: 485'
    to_char(485.8, '"Pre:"999" Post:" .999')'Pre: 485 Post: .800'
    to_char(12, '99V999')' 12000'
    to_char(12.4, '99V999')' 12400'
    to_char(12.45, '99V9')' 125'
    to_char(0.0004859, '9.99EEEE')' 4.86e-04'

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table 9.31. to_char Examples

    ExpressionResult
    to_char(current_timestamp, 'Day, DD  HH12:MI:SS')'Tuesday  , 06  05:39:18'
    to_char(current_timestamp, 'FMDay, FMDD  HH12:MI:SS')'Tuesday, 6  05:39:18'
    to_char(-0.1, '99.99')'  -.10'
    to_char(-0.1, 'FM9.99')'-.1'
    to_char(-0.1, 'FM90.99')'-0.1'
    to_char(0.1, '0.9')' 0.1'
    to_char(12, '9990999.9')'    0012.0'
    to_char(12, 'FM9990999.9')'0012.'
    to_char(485, '999')' 485'
    to_char(-485, '999')'-485'
    to_char(485, '9 9 9')' 4 8 5'
    to_char(1485, '9,999')' 1,485'
    to_char(1485, '9G999')' 1 485'
    to_char(148.5, '999.999')' 148.500'
    to_char(148.5, 'FM999.999')'148.5'
    to_char(148.5, 'FM999.990')'148.500'
    to_char(148.5, '999D999')' 148,500'
    to_char(3148.5, '9G999D999')' 3 148,500'
    to_char(-485, '999S')'485-'
    to_char(-485, '999MI')'485-'
    to_char(485, '999MI')'485 '
    to_char(485, 'FM999MI')'485'
    to_char(485, 'PL999')'+485'
    to_char(485, 'SG999')'+485'
    to_char(-485, 'SG999')'-485'
    to_char(-485, '9SG99')'4-85'
    to_char(-485, '999PR')'<485>'
    to_char(485, 'L999')'DM 485'
    to_char(485, 'RN')'        CDLXXXV'
    to_char(485, 'FMRN')'CDLXXXV'
    to_char(5.2, 'FMRN')'V'
    to_char(482, '999th')' 482nd'
    to_char(485, '"Good number:"999')'Good number: 485'
    to_char(485.8, '"Pre:"999" Post:" .999')'Pre: 485 Post: .800'
    to_char(12, '99V999')' 12000'
    to_char(12.4, '99V999')' 12400'
    to_char(12.45, '99V9')' 125'
    to_char(0.0004859, '9.99EEEE')' 4.86e-04'

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-geometry.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-geometry.html index 6379b7a..756d40b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-geometry.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-geometry.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators

    9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators

    +9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators

    9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators

    The geometric types point, box, lseg, line, path, polygon, and circle have a large set of @@ -883,4 +883,4 @@ UPDATE t SET p[1] = ... changes the Y coordinate. In the same way, a value of type box or lseg can be treated as an array of two point values. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-info.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-info.html index 51268ad..6f16acd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-info.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-info.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.26. System Information Functions and Operators

    9.26. System Information Functions and Operators

    +9.26. System Information Functions and Operators

    9.26. System Information Functions and Operators

    Table 9.66 shows several functions that extract session and system information.

    @@ -1771,4 +1771,4 @@ SELECT collation for ('foo' COLLATE "de_DE");

    Returns information about recovery state, as shown in Table 9.86. -


    Table 9.83. pg_control_checkpoint Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    checkpoint_lsnpg_lsn
    redo_lsnpg_lsn
    redo_wal_filetext
    timeline_idinteger
    prev_timeline_idinteger
    full_page_writesboolean
    next_xidtext
    next_oidoid
    next_multixact_idxid
    next_multi_offsetxid
    oldest_xidxid
    oldest_xid_dbidoid
    oldest_active_xidxid
    oldest_multi_xidxid
    oldest_multi_dbidoid
    oldest_commit_ts_xidxid
    newest_commit_ts_xidxid
    checkpoint_timetimestamp with time zone

    Table 9.84. pg_control_system Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    pg_control_versioninteger
    catalog_version_nointeger
    system_identifierbigint
    pg_control_last_modifiedtimestamp with time zone

    Table 9.85. pg_control_init Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    max_data_alignmentinteger
    database_block_sizeinteger
    blocks_per_segmentinteger
    wal_block_sizeinteger
    bytes_per_wal_segmentinteger
    max_identifier_lengthinteger
    max_index_columnsinteger
    max_toast_chunk_sizeinteger
    large_object_chunk_sizeinteger
    float8_pass_by_valueboolean
    data_page_checksum_versioninteger

    Table 9.86. pg_control_recovery Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    min_recovery_end_lsnpg_lsn
    min_recovery_end_timelineinteger
    backup_start_lsnpg_lsn
    backup_end_lsnpg_lsn
    end_of_backup_record_requiredboolean

    \ No newline at end of file +


    Table 9.83. pg_control_checkpoint Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    checkpoint_lsnpg_lsn
    redo_lsnpg_lsn
    redo_wal_filetext
    timeline_idinteger
    prev_timeline_idinteger
    full_page_writesboolean
    next_xidtext
    next_oidoid
    next_multixact_idxid
    next_multi_offsetxid
    oldest_xidxid
    oldest_xid_dbidoid
    oldest_active_xidxid
    oldest_multi_xidxid
    oldest_multi_dbidoid
    oldest_commit_ts_xidxid
    newest_commit_ts_xidxid
    checkpoint_timetimestamp with time zone

    Table 9.84. pg_control_system Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    pg_control_versioninteger
    catalog_version_nointeger
    system_identifierbigint
    pg_control_last_modifiedtimestamp with time zone

    Table 9.85. pg_control_init Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    max_data_alignmentinteger
    database_block_sizeinteger
    blocks_per_segmentinteger
    wal_block_sizeinteger
    bytes_per_wal_segmentinteger
    max_identifier_lengthinteger
    max_index_columnsinteger
    max_toast_chunk_sizeinteger
    large_object_chunk_sizeinteger
    float8_pass_by_valueboolean
    data_page_checksum_versioninteger

    Table 9.86. pg_control_recovery Output Columns

    Column NameData Type
    min_recovery_end_lsnpg_lsn
    min_recovery_end_timelineinteger
    backup_start_lsnpg_lsn
    backup_end_lsnpg_lsn
    end_of_backup_record_requiredboolean

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-json.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-json.html index 5f454a1..fc43dd4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-json.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-json.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.16. JSON Functions and Operators

    9.16. JSON Functions and Operators

    +9.16. JSON Functions and Operators

    9.16. JSON Functions and Operators

    This section describes:

    • @@ -1778,4 +1778,4 @@ $[*] ? (@ like_regex "^[aeiou]" flag "i")

       $.* ? (@ like_regex "^\\d+$")
       

      -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-logical.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-logical.html index 452db72..a835ec8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-logical.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-logical.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.1. Logical Operators

    9.1. Logical Operators

    +9.1. Logical Operators

    9.1. Logical Operators

    The usual logical operators are available: @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ without affecting the result. (However, it is not guaranteed that the left operand is evaluated before the right operand. See Section 4.2.14 for more information about the order of evaluation of subexpressions.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-matching.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-matching.html index 840fa71..47d57e3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-matching.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-matching.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.7. Pattern Matching

    9.7. Pattern Matching

    +9.7. Pattern Matching

    9.7. Pattern Matching

    There are three separate approaches to pattern matching provided by PostgreSQL: the traditional SQL LIKE operator, the @@ -1412,4 +1412,4 @@ SELECT regexp_match('abc01234xyz', '(?:(.*?)(\d+)(.*)){1,1}'); backslash.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-math.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-math.html index c748a0d..6fb0086 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-math.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-math.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators

    9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators

    +9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators

    9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators

    Mathematical operators are provided for many PostgreSQL types. For types without standard mathematical conventions @@ -998,4 +998,4 @@

    atanh(0.5)0.5493061443340548 -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-net.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-net.html index e26739b..3f466ee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-net.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-net.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators

    9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators

    +9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators

    9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators

    The IP network address types, cidr and inet, support the usual comparison operators shown in Table 9.1 @@ -394,4 +394,4 @@

    macaddr8_set7bit(macaddr8 '00:34:56:ab:cd:ef')02:34:56:ff:fe:ab:cd:ef -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-range.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-range.html index e6c161a..c931d3c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-range.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-range.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators

    9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators

    +9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators

    9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators

    See Section 8.17 for an overview of range types.

    Table 9.54 shows the specialized operators @@ -704,4 +704,4 @@ The lower_inc, upper_inc, lower_inf, and upper_inf functions all return false for an empty range or multirange. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-sequence.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-sequence.html index 612edd4..a641ed1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-sequence.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-sequence.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions

    9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions

    +9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions

    9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions

    This section describes functions for operating on sequence objects, also called sequence generators or just sequences. Sequence objects are special single-row tables created with CREATE SEQUENCE. @@ -136,4 +136,4 @@ SELECT setval('myseq', 42, false); regclass data type's input converter will do the work for you. See Section 8.19 for details. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-srf.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-srf.html index 2bc266c..e9994fd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-srf.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-srf.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.25. Set Returning Functions

    9.25. Set Returning Functions

    +9.25. Set Returning Functions

    9.25. Set Returning Functions

    This section describes functions that possibly return more than one row. The most widely used functions in this class are series generating functions, as detailed in Table 9.64 and @@ -215,4 +215,4 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_ls_dir('.') WITH ORDINALITY AS t(ls,n); pg_subtrans | 19 (19 rows)

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-statistics.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-statistics.html index 210bb3f..8ca7a84 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-statistics.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-statistics.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.30. Statistics Information Functions

    9.30. Statistics Information Functions

    +9.30. Statistics Information Functions

    9.30. Statistics Information Functions

    PostgreSQL provides a function to inspect complex statistics defined using the CREATE STATISTICS command.

    9.30.1. Inspecting MCV Lists

    @@ -21,4 +21,4 @@ SELECT m.* FROM pg_statistic_ext join pg_statistic_ext_data on (oid = stxoid),
         Values of the pg_mcv_list type can be obtained only from the
         pg_statistic_ext_data.stxdmcv
         column.
    -   

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-string.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-string.html index 8f480d1..07f40c9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-string.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-string.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.4. String Functions and Operators

    9.4. String Functions and Operators

    +9.4. String Functions and Operators

    9.4. String Functions and Operators

    This section describes functions and operators for examining and manipulating string values. Strings in this context include values of the types character, character varying, @@ -1205,4 +1205,4 @@ SELECT format('Testing %3$s, %2$s, %s', 'one', 'two', 'three'); The %I and %L format specifiers are particularly useful for safely constructing dynamic SQL statements. See Example 43.1. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-subquery.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-subquery.html index addb6f2..25373c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-subquery.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-subquery.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.23. Subquery Expressions

    9.23. Subquery Expressions

    +9.23. Subquery Expressions

    9.23. Subquery Expressions

    This section describes the SQL-compliant subquery expressions available in PostgreSQL. All of the expression forms documented in this section return @@ -210,4 +210,4 @@ WHERE EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM tab2 WHERE col2 = tab1.col2);

    See Section 9.24.5 for details about the meaning of a row constructor comparison. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-textsearch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-textsearch.html index 5dd4f66..b40b9a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-textsearch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-textsearch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators

    9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators

    +9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators

    9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators

    Table 9.42, Table 9.43 and Table 9.44 @@ -760,4 +760,4 @@

    ts_stat('SELECT vector FROM apod')(foo,10,15) ... -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-trigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-trigger.html index a631e94..82f9950 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-trigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-trigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.28. Trigger Functions

    9.28. Trigger Functions

    +9.28. Trigger Functions

    9.28. Trigger Functions

    While many uses of triggers involve user-written trigger functions, PostgreSQL provides a few built-in trigger functions that can be used directly in user-defined triggers. These @@ -90,4 +90,4 @@ FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE FUNCTION suppress_redundant_updates_trigger(); choose a trigger name that comes after the name of any other trigger you might have on the table. (Hence the z prefix in the example.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-uuid.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-uuid.html index 57e46a2..c6dc609 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-uuid.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-uuid.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.14. UUID Functions

    9.14. UUID Functions

    +9.14. UUID Functions

    9.14. UUID Functions

    PostgreSQL includes one function to generate a UUID:

     gen_random_uuid () → uuid
    @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@
        PostgreSQL also provides the usual comparison
        operators shown in Table 9.1 for
        UUIDs.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-window.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-window.html index 0e4f272..74ac321 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-window.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-window.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.22. Window Functions

    9.22. Window Functions

    +9.22. Window Functions

    9.22. Window Functions

    Window functions provide the ability to perform calculations across sets of rows that are related to the current query row. See Section 3.5 for an introduction to this @@ -179,4 +179,4 @@ default FROM FIRST behavior is supported. (You can achieve the result of FROM LAST by reversing the ORDER BY ordering.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-xml.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-xml.html index 86bc911..6780308 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-xml.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions-xml.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -9.15. XML Functions

    9.15. XML Functions

    +9.15. XML Functions

    9.15. XML Functions

    The functions and function-like expressions described in this section operate on values of type xml. See Section 8.13 for information about the xml type. The function-like expressions xmlparse @@ -909,4 +909,4 @@ table2-mapping will be put into content form with each such disallowed node replaced by its string value, as defined for the XPath 1.0 string function. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions.html index dd1de51..1f13502 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/functions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/functions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 9. Functions and Operators

    Chapter 9. Functions and Operators

    Table of Contents

    9.1. Logical Operators
    9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators
    9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators
    9.4. String Functions and Operators
    9.4.1. format
    9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators
    9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators
    9.7. Pattern Matching
    9.7.1. LIKE
    9.7.2. SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions
    9.7.3. POSIX Regular Expressions
    9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions
    9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators
    9.9.1. EXTRACT, date_part
    9.9.2. date_trunc
    9.9.3. date_bin
    9.9.4. AT TIME ZONE
    9.9.5. Current Date/Time
    9.9.6. Delaying Execution
    9.10. Enum Support Functions
    9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators
    9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators
    9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators
    9.14. UUID Functions
    9.15. XML Functions
    9.15.1. Producing XML Content
    9.15.2. XML Predicates
    9.15.3. Processing XML
    9.15.4. Mapping Tables to XML
    9.16. JSON Functions and Operators
    9.16.1. Processing and Creating JSON Data
    9.16.2. The SQL/JSON Path Language
    9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions
    9.18. Conditional Expressions
    9.18.1. CASE
    9.18.2. COALESCE
    9.18.3. NULLIF
    9.18.4. GREATEST and LEAST
    9.19. Array Functions and Operators
    9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
    9.21. Aggregate Functions
    9.22. Window Functions
    9.23. Subquery Expressions
    9.23.1. EXISTS
    9.23.2. IN
    9.23.3. NOT IN
    9.23.4. ANY/SOME
    9.23.5. ALL
    9.23.6. Single-Row Comparison
    9.24. Row and Array Comparisons
    9.24.1. IN
    9.24.2. NOT IN
    9.24.3. ANY/SOME (array)
    9.24.4. ALL (array)
    9.24.5. Row Constructor Comparison
    9.24.6. Composite Type Comparison
    9.25. Set Returning Functions
    9.26. System Information Functions and Operators
    9.27. System Administration Functions
    9.27.1. Configuration Settings Functions
    9.27.2. Server Signaling Functions
    9.27.3. Backup Control Functions
    9.27.4. Recovery Control Functions
    9.27.5. Snapshot Synchronization Functions
    9.27.6. Replication Management Functions
    9.27.7. Database Object Management Functions
    9.27.8. Index Maintenance Functions
    9.27.9. Generic File Access Functions
    9.27.10. Advisory Lock Functions
    9.28. Trigger Functions
    9.29. Event Trigger Functions
    9.29.1. Capturing Changes at Command End
    9.29.2. Processing Objects Dropped by a DDL Command
    9.29.3. Handling a Table Rewrite Event
    9.30. Statistics Information Functions
    9.30.1. Inspecting MCV Lists

    +Chapter 9. Functions and Operators

    Chapter 9. Functions and Operators

    Table of Contents

    9.1. Logical Operators
    9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators
    9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators
    9.4. String Functions and Operators
    9.4.1. format
    9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators
    9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators
    9.7. Pattern Matching
    9.7.1. LIKE
    9.7.2. SIMILAR TO Regular Expressions
    9.7.3. POSIX Regular Expressions
    9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions
    9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators
    9.9.1. EXTRACT, date_part
    9.9.2. date_trunc
    9.9.3. date_bin
    9.9.4. AT TIME ZONE
    9.9.5. Current Date/Time
    9.9.6. Delaying Execution
    9.10. Enum Support Functions
    9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators
    9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators
    9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators
    9.14. UUID Functions
    9.15. XML Functions
    9.15.1. Producing XML Content
    9.15.2. XML Predicates
    9.15.3. Processing XML
    9.15.4. Mapping Tables to XML
    9.16. JSON Functions and Operators
    9.16.1. Processing and Creating JSON Data
    9.16.2. The SQL/JSON Path Language
    9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions
    9.18. Conditional Expressions
    9.18.1. CASE
    9.18.2. COALESCE
    9.18.3. NULLIF
    9.18.4. GREATEST and LEAST
    9.19. Array Functions and Operators
    9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
    9.21. Aggregate Functions
    9.22. Window Functions
    9.23. Subquery Expressions
    9.23.1. EXISTS
    9.23.2. IN
    9.23.3. NOT IN
    9.23.4. ANY/SOME
    9.23.5. ALL
    9.23.6. Single-Row Comparison
    9.24. Row and Array Comparisons
    9.24.1. IN
    9.24.2. NOT IN
    9.24.3. ANY/SOME (array)
    9.24.4. ALL (array)
    9.24.5. Row Constructor Comparison
    9.24.6. Composite Type Comparison
    9.25. Set Returning Functions
    9.26. System Information Functions and Operators
    9.27. System Administration Functions
    9.27.1. Configuration Settings Functions
    9.27.2. Server Signaling Functions
    9.27.3. Backup Control Functions
    9.27.4. Recovery Control Functions
    9.27.5. Snapshot Synchronization Functions
    9.27.6. Replication Management Functions
    9.27.7. Database Object Management Functions
    9.27.8. Index Maintenance Functions
    9.27.9. Generic File Access Functions
    9.27.10. Advisory Lock Functions
    9.28. Trigger Functions
    9.29. Event Trigger Functions
    9.29.1. Capturing Changes at Command End
    9.29.2. Processing Objects Dropped by a DDL Command
    9.29.3. Handling a Table Rewrite Event
    9.30. Statistics Information Functions
    9.30.1. Inspecting MCV Lists

    PostgreSQL provides a large number of functions and operators for the built-in data types. This chapter describes most of them, although additional special-purpose functions @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@ repeat('Pg', 4) → PgPgPgPg is present in other SQL database management systems, and in many cases this functionality is compatible and consistent between the various implementations. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/fuzzystrmatch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/fuzzystrmatch.html index e8efbaf..18e23de 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/fuzzystrmatch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/fuzzystrmatch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.17. fuzzystrmatch

    F.17. fuzzystrmatch

    +F.17. fuzzystrmatch

    F.17. fuzzystrmatch

    The fuzzystrmatch module provides several functions to determine similarities and distance between strings.

    Caution

    @@ -135,4 +135,4 @@ test=# SELECT dmetaphone('gumbo'); ------------ KMP (1 row) -

    \ No newline at end of file +
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/generic-wal.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/generic-wal.html index 14cadc6..dbc702e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/generic-wal.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/generic-wal.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 65. Generic WAL Records

    Chapter 65. Generic WAL Records

    +Chapter 65. Generic WAL Records

    Chapter 65. Generic WAL Records

    Although all built-in WAL-logged modules have their own types of WAL records, there is also a generic WAL record type, which describes changes to pages in a generic way. This is useful for extensions that provide @@ -99,4 +99,4 @@ comparison. This is not very compact for the case of moving data within a page, and might be improved in the future.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-biblio.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-biblio.html index 07416a5..7fa0437 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-biblio.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-biblio.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -62.4. Further Reading

    62.4. Further Reading

    +62.4. Further Reading

    62.4. Further Reading

    The following resources contain additional information about genetic algorithms: @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@

  • [fong]

  • -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro.html index bfbf675..3a7b39b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -62.1. Query Handling as a Complex Optimization Problem

    62.1. Query Handling as a Complex Optimization Problem

    +62.1. Query Handling as a Complex Optimization Problem

    62.1. Query Handling as a Complex Optimization Problem

    Among all relational operators the most difficult one to process and optimize is the join. The number of possible query plans grows exponentially with the @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ genetic algorithm to solve the join ordering problem in a manner that is efficient for queries involving large numbers of joins. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro2.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro2.html index 75c54ca..bad186c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro2.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-intro2.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -62.2. Genetic Algorithms

    62.2. Genetic Algorithms

    +62.2. Genetic Algorithms

    62.2. Genetic Algorithms

    The genetic algorithm (GA) is a heuristic optimization method which operates through randomized search. The set of possible solutions for the optimization problem is considered as a @@ -24,4 +24,4 @@ strongly that a GA is not a pure random search for a solution to a problem. A GA uses stochastic processes, but the result is distinctly non-random (better than random). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-pg-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-pg-intro.html index 991acc1..1f39468 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-pg-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo-pg-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -62.3. Genetic Query Optimization (GEQO) in PostgreSQL

    62.3. Genetic Query Optimization (GEQO) in PostgreSQL

    62.3.1. Generating Possible Plans with GEQO
    62.3.2. Future Implementation Tasks for +62.3. Genetic Query Optimization (GEQO) in PostgreSQL

    62.3. Genetic Query Optimization (GEQO) in PostgreSQL

    The GEQO module approaches the query optimization problem as though it were the well-known traveling salesman @@ -104,4 +104,4 @@ of the rest of the tour, but this is certainly not true for query optimization. Thus it is questionable whether edge recombination crossover is the most effective mutation procedure. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo.html index 70adc1c..89aef06 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/geqo.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -Chapter 62. Genetic Query Optimizer

    Chapter 62. Genetic Query Optimizer

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-builtin-opclasses.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-builtin-opclasses.html index ee1b76c..dfaaf8e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-builtin-opclasses.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-builtin-opclasses.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -70.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    70.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    +70.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    70.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    The core PostgreSQL distribution includes the GIN operator classes shown in Table 70.1. @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ is the default. jsonb_path_ops supports fewer operators but offers better performance for those operators. See Section 8.14.4 for details. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-examples.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-examples.html index 7b97169..5c11957 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-examples.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-examples.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -70.7. Examples

    70.7. Examples

    +70.7. Examples

    70.7. Examples

    The core PostgreSQL distribution includes the GIN operator classes previously shown in Table 70.1. @@ -7,4 +7,4 @@ GIN operator classes:

    btree_gin

    B-tree equivalent functionality for several data types

    hstore

    Module for storing (key, value) pairs

    intarray

    Enhanced support for int[]

    pg_trgm

    Text similarity using trigram matching

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-extensibility.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-extensibility.html index f7ec4d4..deaa381 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-extensibility.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-extensibility.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -70.3. Extensibility

    70.3. Extensibility

    +70.3. Extensibility

    70.3. Extensibility

    The GIN interface has a high level of abstraction, requiring the access method implementer only to implement the semantics of the data type being accessed. The GIN layer itself @@ -234,4 +234,4 @@ recommended that the SQL declarations of these three support functions use the opclass's indexed data type for the query argument, even though the actual type might be something else depending on the operator. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-implementation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-implementation.html index e0b1853..d25e2f7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-implementation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-implementation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -70.4. Implementation

    70.4. Implementation

    +70.4. Implementation

    70.4. Implementation

    Internally, a GIN index contains a B-tree index constructed over keys, where each key is an element of one or more indexed items (a member of an array, for example) and where each tuple in a leaf @@ -61,4 +61,4 @@ index key, less than zero for a non-match that is still within the range to be searched, or greater than zero if the index key is past the range that could match. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-intro.html index 715fc6a..2159803 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -70.1. Introduction

    70.1. Introduction

    +70.1. Introduction

    70.1. Introduction

    GIN stands for Generalized Inverted Index. GIN is designed for handling cases where the items to be indexed are composite values, and the queries to be handled by @@ -37,4 +37,4 @@ maintained by Teodor Sigaev and Oleg Bartunov. There is more information about GIN on their website. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-limit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-limit.html index 5d9a32d..296e2fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-limit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-limit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -70.6. Limitations

    70.6. Limitations

    +70.6. Limitations

    70.6. Limitations

    GIN assumes that indexable operators are strict. This means that extractValue will not be called at all on a null item value (instead, a placeholder index entry is created automatically), @@ -7,4 +7,4 @@ value either (instead, the query is presumed to be unsatisfiable). Note however that null key values contained within a non-null composite item or query value are supported. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-tips.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-tips.html index 2f51799..b5edd64 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-tips.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin-tips.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -70.5. GIN Tips and Tricks

    70.5. GIN Tips and Tricks

    Create vs. insert

    +70.5. GIN Tips and Tricks

    70.5. GIN Tips and Tricks

    Create vs. insert

    Insertion into a GIN index can be slow due to the likelihood of many keys being inserted for each item. So, for bulk insertions into a table it is advisable to drop the GIN @@ -55,4 +55,4 @@

    From experience, values in the thousands (e.g., 5000 — 20000) work well. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin.html index 06062bc..03e10f6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gin.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gin.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 70. GIN Indexes \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 70. GIN Indexes \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-builtin-opclasses.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-builtin-opclasses.html index 1fba3d7..7f31d62 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-builtin-opclasses.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-builtin-opclasses.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -68.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    68.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    +68.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    68.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    The core PostgreSQL distribution includes the GiST operator classes shown in Table 68.1. @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@

     CREATE INDEX ON my_table USING GIST (my_inet_column inet_ops);
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-examples.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-examples.html index 91b8c72..6a7a338 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-examples.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-examples.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -68.5. Examples

    68.5. Examples

    +68.5. Examples

    68.5. Examples

    The PostgreSQL source distribution includes several examples of index methods implemented using GiST. The core system currently provides text search @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ operator classes:

    btree_gist

    B-tree equivalent functionality for several data types

    cube

    Indexing for multidimensional cubes

    hstore

    Module for storing (key, value) pairs

    intarray

    RD-Tree for one-dimensional array of int4 values

    ltree

    Indexing for tree-like structures

    pg_trgm

    Text similarity using trigram matching

    seg

    Indexing for float ranges

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-extensibility.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-extensibility.html index b9af0e8..d2b4e52 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-extensibility.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-extensibility.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -68.3. Extensibility

    68.3. Extensibility

    +68.3. Extensibility

    68.3. Extensibility

    Traditionally, implementing a new index access method meant a lot of difficult work. It was necessary to understand the inner workings of the database, such as the lock manager and Write-Ahead Log. The @@ -810,4 +810,4 @@ my_sortsupport(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS) index scan, index build, or index tuple insertion). Be careful to pfree the previous value when replacing a fn_extra value, or the leak will accumulate for the duration of the operation. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-implementation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-implementation.html index 2ac2b9e..c3b1548 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-implementation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-implementation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -68.4. Implementation

    68.4. Implementation

    68.4.1. GiST Index Build Methods

    +68.4. Implementation

    68.4. Implementation

    68.4.1. GiST Index Build Methods

    The simplest way to build a GiST index is just to insert all the entries, one by one. This tends to be slow for large indexes, because if the index tuples are scattered across the index and the index is large enough @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ CREATE INDEX command. The default behavior is good for most cases, but turning buffering off might speed up the build somewhat if the input data is ordered. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-intro.html index c0589cf..1a86c60 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -68.1. Introduction

    68.1. Introduction

    +68.1. Introduction

    68.1. Introduction

    GiST stands for Generalized Search Tree. It is a balanced, tree-structured access method, that acts as a base template in which to implement arbitrary indexing schemes. B-trees, R-trees and many @@ -20,4 +20,4 @@ maintained by Teodor Sigaev and Oleg Bartunov, and there is more information on their web site. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist.html index b433703..6206348 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gist.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gist.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 68. GiST Indexes \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 68. GiST Indexes \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/git.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/git.html index 975e1ab..687849f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/git.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/git.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -I.1. Getting the Source via Git

    I.1. Getting the Source via Git

    +I.1. Getting the Source via Git

    I.1. Getting the Source via Git

    With Git you will make a copy of the entire code repository on your local machine, so you will have access to all history and branches offline. This is the fastest and most flexible way to develop or test @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ git fetch Git can do a lot more things than just fetch the source. For more information, consult the Git man pages, or see the website at https://git-scm.com. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/glossary.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/glossary.html index 0ca28c0..d740b71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/glossary.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/glossary.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix M. Glossary

    Appendix M. Glossary

    +Appendix M. Glossary

    Appendix M. Glossary

    This is a list of terms and their meaning in the context of PostgreSQL and relational database systems in general. @@ -497,11 +497,20 @@ (just like a view), but stores data in the same way that a table does. It cannot be - modified via INSERT, UPDATE, or - DELETE operations. + modified via INSERT, UPDATE, + DELETE, or MERGE operations.

    For more information, see CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW. +

    Merge

    + An SQL command used to conditionally add, modify, + or remove rows + in a given table, + using data from a source + relation. +

    + For more information, see + MERGE.

    Multi-version concurrency control (MVCC)

    A mechanism designed to allow several transactions to be @@ -1058,4 +1067,4 @@ It comprises many individual WAL records written sequentially to WAL files. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-auth.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-auth.html index ff292bc..1122ada 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-auth.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-auth.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.6. GSSAPI Authentication

    21.6. GSSAPI Authentication

    +21.6. GSSAPI Authentication

    21.6. GSSAPI Authentication

    GSSAPI is an industry-standard protocol for secure authentication defined in RFC 2743. @@ -115,4 +115,4 @@ parameter. If that is set to true, client principals are matched to user map entries case-insensitively. krb_realm, if set, is also matched case-insensitively. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-enc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-enc.html index 026d1e7..fa613f6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-enc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/gssapi-enc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.10. Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption

    19.10. Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption

    +19.10. Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption

    19.10. Secure TCP/IP Connections with GSSAPI Encryption

    PostgreSQL also has native support for using GSSAPI to encrypt client/server communications for increased security. Support requires that a GSSAPI @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ behavior, GSSAPI encryption requires no setup beyond that which is necessary for GSSAPI authentication. (For more information on configuring that, see Section 21.6.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-implementation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-implementation.html index ea547a2..66104bc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-implementation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-implementation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -72.2. Implementation

    72.2. Implementation

    +72.2. Implementation

    72.2. Implementation

    There are four kinds of pages in a hash index: the meta page (page zero), which contains statically allocated control information; primary bucket pages; overflow pages; and bitmap pages, which keep track of overflow @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ src/backend/access/hash/README. The split algorithm is crash safe and can be restarted if not completed successfully. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-index.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-index.html index 23bea86..349462a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-index.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-index.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 72. Hash Indexes

    Chapter 72. Hash Indexes

    \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 72. Hash Indexes

    Chapter 72. Hash Indexes

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-intro.html index ce9232b..f73c5a1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/hash-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -72.1. Overview

    72.1. Overview

    +72.1. Overview

    72.1. Overview

    PostgreSQL includes an implementation of persistent on-disk hash indexes, which are fully crash recoverable. Any data type can be indexed by a @@ -74,4 +74,4 @@ The expansion occurs in the foreground, which could increase execution time for user inserts. Thus, hash indexes may not be suitable for tables with rapidly increasing number of rows. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/high-availability.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/high-availability.html index 608f0ac..4074fb3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/high-availability.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/high-availability.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication

    Chapter 27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication

    +Chapter 27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication

    Chapter 27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication

    Database servers can work together to allow a second server to take over quickly if the primary server fails (high availability), or to allow several computers to serve the same @@ -54,4 +54,4 @@

    The remainder of this section outlines various failover, replication, and load balancing solutions. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/history.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/history.html index 737e231..78e9d71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/history.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/history.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2. A Brief History of PostgreSQL

    2. A Brief History of PostgreSQL

    +2. A Brief History of PostgreSQL

    2. A Brief History of PostgreSQL

    The object-relational database management system now known as PostgreSQL is derived from the POSTGRES package written at the @@ -137,4 +137,4 @@

    Details about what has happened in PostgreSQL since then can be found in Appendix E. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/hot-standby.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/hot-standby.html index adab809..44443c8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/hot-standby.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/hot-standby.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -27.4. Hot Standby

    27.4. Hot Standby

    +27.4. Hot Standby

    27.4. Hot Standby

    Hot standby is the term used to describe the ability to connect to the server and run read-only queries while the server is in archive recovery or standby mode. This @@ -572,4 +572,4 @@ HINT: You can then restart the server after making the necessary configuration hot standby mode will generate an error.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/how-parallel-query-works.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/how-parallel-query-works.html index 92a0e2d..740aa11 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/how-parallel-query-works.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/how-parallel-query-works.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -15.1. How Parallel Query Works

    15.1. How Parallel Query Works

    +15.1. How Parallel Query Works

    15.1. How Parallel Query Works

    When the optimizer determines that parallel query is the fastest execution strategy for a particular query, it will create a query plan that includes a Gather or Gather Merge @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT * FROM pgbench_accounts WHERE filler LIKE '%x%'; order-preserving merge. In contrast, Gather reads tuples from the workers in whatever order is convenient, destroying any sort order that may have existed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/hstore.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/hstore.html index 1b5c7ff..ea788bb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/hstore.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/hstore.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.18. hstore

    F.18. hstore

    +F.18. hstore

    F.18. hstore

    This module implements the hstore data type for storing sets of key/value pairs within a single PostgreSQL value. This can be useful in various scenarios, such as rows with many attributes @@ -696,4 +696,4 @@ ALTER TABLE tablename ALTER hstorecol TYPE hstore USING hstorecol || '';

    Additional enhancements by Andrew Gierth , United Kingdom -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-api.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-api.html index a6bd971..ec365e2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-api.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-api.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -64.1. Basic API Structure for Indexes

    64.1. Basic API Structure for Indexes

    +64.1. Basic API Structure for Indexes

    64.1. Basic API Structure for Indexes

    Each index access method is described by a row in the pg_am system catalog. The pg_am entry @@ -177,4 +177,4 @@ typedef struct IndexAmRoutine sensible: it means that there can only be one key column, but there can also be included column(s). Also, included columns must be allowed to be null, independently of amoptionalkey. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-cost-estimation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-cost-estimation.html index fe706e8..197d688 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-cost-estimation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-cost-estimation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -64.6. Index Cost Estimation Functions

    64.6. Index Cost Estimation Functions

    +64.6. Index Cost Estimation Functions

    64.6. Index Cost Estimation Functions

    The amcostestimate function is given information describing a possible index scan, including lists of WHERE and ORDER BY clauses that have been determined to be usable with the index. It must return estimates @@ -139,4 +139,4 @@ cost_qual_eval(&index_qual_cost, path->indexquals, root);

    Examples of cost estimator functions can be found in src/backend/utils/adt/selfuncs.c. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-functions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-functions.html index 8e748fc..fbbd95e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-functions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-functions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -64.2. Index Access Method Functions

    64.2. Index Access Method Functions

    +64.2. Index Access Method Functions

    64.2. Index Access Method Functions

    The index construction and maintenance functions that an index access method must provide in IndexAmRoutine are:

    @@ -484,4 +484,4 @@ amparallelrescan (IndexScanDesc scan); must be restarted. It should reset any shared state set up by aminitparallelscan such that the scan will be restarted from the beginning. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-locking.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-locking.html index b744013..8bf3ae1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-locking.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-locking.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -64.4. Index Locking Considerations

    64.4. Index Locking Considerations

    +64.4. Index Locking Considerations

    64.4. Index Locking Considerations

    Index access methods must handle concurrent updates of the index by multiple processes. The core PostgreSQL system obtains @@ -88,4 +88,4 @@ integrity. When the flag is set, it indicates that the index access method implements finer-grained predicate locking, which will tend to reduce the frequency of such transaction cancellations. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-scanning.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-scanning.html index 5d3fdd5..6ba0e2e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-scanning.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-scanning.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -64.3. Index Scanning

    64.3. Index Scanning

    +64.3. Index Scanning

    64.3. Index Scanning

    In an index scan, the index access method is responsible for regurgitating the TIDs of all the tuples it has been told about that match the scan keys. The access method is not involved in @@ -120,4 +120,4 @@ Note that it is permitted for an access method to implement only amgetbitmap and not amgettuple, or vice versa, if its internal implementation is unsuited to one API or the other. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-unique-checks.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-unique-checks.html index d136039..07a62e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/index-unique-checks.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/index-unique-checks.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -64.5. Index Uniqueness Checks

    64.5. Index Uniqueness Checks

    +64.5. Index Uniqueness Checks

    64.5. Index Uniqueness Checks

    PostgreSQL enforces SQL uniqueness constraints using unique indexes, which are indexes that disallow multiple entries with identical keys. An access method that supports this @@ -106,4 +106,4 @@ target row is found in the recheck verifies that we are scanning for the same tuple values as were used in the original insertion.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/index.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/index.html index a86ab7b..4d7b437 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/index.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/index.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation

    PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation

    The PostgreSQL Global Development Group


    Table of Contents

    Preface
    1. What Is PostgreSQL?
    2. A Brief History of PostgreSQL
    3. Conventions
    4. Further Information
    5. Bug Reporting Guidelines
    I. Tutorial
    1. Getting Started
    2. The SQL Language
    3. Advanced Features
    II. The SQL Language
    4. SQL Syntax
    5. Data Definition
    6. Data Manipulation
    7. Queries
    8. Data Types
    9. Functions and Operators
    10. Type Conversion
    11. Indexes
    12. Full Text Search
    13. Concurrency Control
    14. Performance Tips
    15. Parallel Query
    III. Server Administration
    16. Installation from Binaries
    17. Installation from Source Code
    18. Installation from Source Code on Windows
    19. Server Setup and Operation
    20. Server Configuration
    21. Client Authentication
    22. Database Roles
    23. Managing Databases
    24. Localization
    25. Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
    26. Backup and Restore
    27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
    28. Monitoring Database Activity
    29. Monitoring Disk Usage
    30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log
    31. Logical Replication
    32. Just-in-Time Compilation (JIT)
    33. Regression Tests
    IV. Client Interfaces
    34. libpq — C Library
    35. Large Objects
    36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
    37. The Information Schema
    V. Server Programming
    38. Extending SQL
    39. Triggers
    40. Event Triggers
    41. The Rule System
    42. Procedural Languages
    43. PL/pgSQLSQL Procedural Language
    44. PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
    45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
    46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language
    47. Server Programming Interface
    48. Background Worker Processes
    49. Logical Decoding
    50. Replication Progress Tracking
    51. Archive Modules
    VI. Reference
    I. SQL Commands
    II. PostgreSQL Client Applications
    III. PostgreSQL Server Applications
    VII. Internals
    52. Overview of PostgreSQL Internals
    53. System Catalogs
    54. System Views
    55. Frontend/Backend Protocol
    56. PostgreSQL Coding Conventions
    57. Native Language Support
    58. Writing a Procedural Language Handler
    59. Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper
    60. Writing a Table Sampling Method
    61. Writing a Custom Scan Provider
    62. Genetic Query Optimizer
    63. Table Access Method Interface Definition
    64. Index Access Method Interface Definition
    65. Generic WAL Records
    66. Custom WAL Resource Managers
    67. B-Tree Indexes
    68. GiST Indexes
    69. SP-GiST Indexes
    70. GIN Indexes
    71. BRIN Indexes
    72. Hash Indexes
    73. Database Physical Storage
    74. System Catalog Declarations and Initial Contents
    75. How the Planner Uses Statistics
    76. Backup Manifest Format
    VIII. Appendixes
    A. PostgreSQL Error Codes
    B. Date/Time Support
    C. SQL Key Words
    D. SQL Conformance
    E. Release Notes
    F. Additional Supplied Modules
    G. Additional Supplied Programs
    H. External Projects
    I. The Source Code Repository
    J. Documentation
    K. PostgreSQL Limits
    L. Acronyms
    M. Glossary
    N. Color Support
    O. Obsolete or Renamed Features
    Bibliography
    Index
    \ No newline at end of file +PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation

    PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation

    The PostgreSQL Global Development Group


    Table of Contents

    Preface
    1. What Is PostgreSQL?
    2. A Brief History of PostgreSQL
    3. Conventions
    4. Further Information
    5. Bug Reporting Guidelines
    I. Tutorial
    1. Getting Started
    2. The SQL Language
    3. Advanced Features
    II. The SQL Language
    4. SQL Syntax
    5. Data Definition
    6. Data Manipulation
    7. Queries
    8. Data Types
    9. Functions and Operators
    10. Type Conversion
    11. Indexes
    12. Full Text Search
    13. Concurrency Control
    14. Performance Tips
    15. Parallel Query
    III. Server Administration
    16. Installation from Binaries
    17. Installation from Source Code
    18. Installation from Source Code on Windows
    19. Server Setup and Operation
    20. Server Configuration
    21. Client Authentication
    22. Database Roles
    23. Managing Databases
    24. Localization
    25. Routine Database Maintenance Tasks
    26. Backup and Restore
    27. High Availability, Load Balancing, and Replication
    28. Monitoring Database Activity
    29. Monitoring Disk Usage
    30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log
    31. Logical Replication
    32. Just-in-Time Compilation (JIT)
    33. Regression Tests
    IV. Client Interfaces
    34. libpq — C Library
    35. Large Objects
    36. ECPG — Embedded SQL in C
    37. The Information Schema
    V. Server Programming
    38. Extending SQL
    39. Triggers
    40. Event Triggers
    41. The Rule System
    42. Procedural Languages
    43. PL/pgSQLSQL Procedural Language
    44. PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
    45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
    46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language
    47. Server Programming Interface
    48. Background Worker Processes
    49. Logical Decoding
    50. Replication Progress Tracking
    51. Archive Modules
    VI. Reference
    I. SQL Commands
    II. PostgreSQL Client Applications
    III. PostgreSQL Server Applications
    VII. Internals
    52. Overview of PostgreSQL Internals
    53. System Catalogs
    54. System Views
    55. Frontend/Backend Protocol
    56. PostgreSQL Coding Conventions
    57. Native Language Support
    58. Writing a Procedural Language Handler
    59. Writing a Foreign Data Wrapper
    60. Writing a Table Sampling Method
    61. Writing a Custom Scan Provider
    62. Genetic Query Optimizer
    63. Table Access Method Interface Definition
    64. Index Access Method Interface Definition
    65. Generic WAL Records
    66. Custom WAL Resource Managers
    67. B-Tree Indexes
    68. GiST Indexes
    69. SP-GiST Indexes
    70. GIN Indexes
    71. BRIN Indexes
    72. Hash Indexes
    73. Database Physical Storage
    74. System Catalog Declarations and Initial Contents
    75. How the Planner Uses Statistics
    76. Backup Manifest Format
    VIII. Appendixes
    A. PostgreSQL Error Codes
    B. Date/Time Support
    C. SQL Key Words
    D. SQL Conformance
    E. Release Notes
    F. Additional Supplied Modules
    G. Additional Supplied Programs
    H. External Projects
    I. The Source Code Repository
    J. Documentation
    K. PostgreSQL Limits
    L. Acronyms
    M. Glossary
    N. Color Support
    O. Obsolete or Renamed Features
    Bibliography
    Index
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexam.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexam.html index b77c2eb..6a495f8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexam.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexam.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 64. Index Access Method Interface Definition

    Chapter 64. Index Access Method Interface Definition

    +Chapter 64. Index Access Method Interface Definition

    Chapter 64. Index Access Method Interface Definition

    This chapter defines the interface between the core PostgreSQL system and index access methods, which manage individual index types. The core system @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ statement; but indexes do not deal with those, either.) Index entries for dead tuples are reclaimed (by vacuuming) when the dead tuples themselves are reclaimed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-bitmap-scans.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-bitmap-scans.html index 4793b13..71986de 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-bitmap-scans.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-bitmap-scans.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.5. Combining Multiple Indexes

    11.5. Combining Multiple Indexes

    +11.5. Combining Multiple Indexes

    11.5. Combining Multiple Indexes

    A single index scan can only use query clauses that use the index's columns with operators of its operator class and are joined with AND. For example, given an index on (a, b) @@ -58,4 +58,4 @@ common. If one of the types of query is much less common than the others, you'd probably settle for creating just the two indexes that best match the common types. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-collations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-collations.html index 32221f1..80ab030 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-collations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-collations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.11. Indexes and Collations

    11.11. Indexes and Collations

    +11.11. Indexes and Collations

    11.11. Indexes and Collations

    An index can support only one collation per index column. If multiple collations are of interest, multiple indexes may be needed.

    @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ SELECT * FROM test1c WHERE content > constant

     CREATE INDEX test1c_content_y_index ON test1c (content COLLATE "y");
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-examine.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-examine.html index 487d9ae..0077928 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-examine.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-examine.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.12. Examining Index Usage

    11.12. Examining Index Usage

    +11.12. Examining Index Usage

    11.12. Examining Index Usage

    Although indexes in PostgreSQL do not need maintenance or tuning, it is still important to check which indexes are actually used by the real-life query workload. @@ -79,4 +79,4 @@ appropriate, then you might have to resort to forcing index usage explicitly. You might also want to contact the PostgreSQL developers to examine the issue. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-expressional.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-expressional.html index d3b643c..f3e3d0a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-expressional.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-expressional.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.7. Indexes on Expressions

    11.7. Indexes on Expressions

    +11.7. Indexes on Expressions

    11.7. Indexes on Expressions

    An index column need not be just a column of the underlying table, but can be a function or scalar expression computed from one or more columns of the table. This feature is useful to obtain fast @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ CREATE INDEX people_names ON people ((first_name || ' ' || last_name)); and so the speed of the search is equivalent to any other simple index query. Thus, indexes on expressions are useful when retrieval speed is more important than insertion and update speed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-index-only-scans.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-index-only-scans.html index f9a4e11..18089c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-index-only-scans.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-index-only-scans.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.9. Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes

    11.9. Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes

    +11.9. Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes

    11.9. Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes

    All indexes in PostgreSQL are secondary indexes, meaning that each index is stored separately from the table's main data area (which is called the @@ -206,4 +206,4 @@ SELECT target FROM tests WHERE subject = 'some-subject' AND success; checked in the plan. PostgreSQL versions 9.6 and later will recognize such cases and allow index-only scans to be generated, but older versions will not. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-intro.html index acdb0c6..2dadf9a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.1. Introduction

    11.1. Introduction

    +11.1. Introduction

    11.1. Introduction

    Suppose we have a table similar to this:

     CREATE TABLE test1 (
    @@ -58,6 +58,35 @@ CREATE INDEX test1_id_index ON test1 (id);
        Indexes can moreover be used in join searches.  Thus,
        an index defined on a column that is part of a join condition can
        also significantly speed up queries with joins.
    +  

    + In general, PostgreSQL indexes can be used + to optimize queries that contain one or more WHERE + or JOIN clauses of the form + +

    +indexed-column indexable-operator comparison-value
    +

    + + Here, the indexed-column is whatever + column or expression the index has been defined on. + The indexable-operator is an operator that + is a member of the index's operator class for + the indexed column. (More details about that appear below.) + And the comparison-value can be any + expression that is not volatile and does not reference the index's + table. +

    + In some cases the query planner can extract an indexable clause of + this form from another SQL construct. A simple example is that if + the original clause was + +

    +comparison-value operator indexed-column
    +

    + + then it can be flipped around into indexable form if the + original operator has a commutator + operator that is a member of the index's operator class.

    Creating an index on a large table can take a long time. By default, PostgreSQL allows reads (SELECT statements) to occur @@ -74,4 +103,4 @@ CREATE INDEX test1_id_index ON test1 (id); tuples. Therefore indexes that are seldom or never used in queries should be removed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-multicolumn.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-multicolumn.html index e0d0182..063e0b8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-multicolumn.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-multicolumn.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.3. Multicolumn Indexes

    11.3. Multicolumn Indexes

    +11.3. Multicolumn Indexes

    11.3. Multicolumn Indexes

    An index can be defined on more than one column of a table. For example, if you have a table of this form:

    @@ -79,4 +79,4 @@ CREATE INDEX test2_mm_idx ON test2 (major, minor);
        Section 11.5 and
        Section 11.9 for some discussion of the
        merits of different index configurations.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-opclass.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-opclass.html index b7fd890..f837067 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-opclass.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-opclass.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.10. Operator Classes and Operator Families

    11.10. Operator Classes and Operator Families

    +11.10. Operator Classes and Operator Families

    11.10. Operator Classes and Operator Families

    An index definition can specify an operator class for each column of an index.

    @@ -104,4 +104,4 @@ SELECT am.amname AS index_method,
         commands \dAc, \dAf,
         and \dAo, which provide slightly more sophisticated
         versions of these queries.
    -   

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-ordering.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-ordering.html index d465eb3..3ad0c58 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-ordering.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-ordering.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.4. Indexes and ORDER BY

    11.4. Indexes and ORDER BY

    +11.4. Indexes and ORDER BY

    11.4. Indexes and ORDER BY

    In addition to simply finding the rows to be returned by a query, an index may be able to deliver them in a specific sorted order. This allows a query's ORDER BY specification to be honored @@ -61,4 +61,4 @@ CREATE INDEX test3_desc_index ON test3 (id DESC NULLS LAST); speedups for certain queries. Whether it's worth maintaining such an index depends on how often you use queries that require a special sort ordering. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-partial.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-partial.html index 5199cf0..9b752b5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-partial.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-partial.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.8. Partial Indexes

    11.8. Partial Indexes

    +11.8. Partial Indexes

    11.8. Partial Indexes

    A partial index is an index built over a subset of a table; the subset is defined by a conditional expression (called the predicate of the @@ -209,4 +209,4 @@ CREATE INDEX mytable_cat_data ON mytable (category, data); far better performance is possible.


    More information about partial indexes can be found in [ston89b], [olson93], and [seshadri95]. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-types.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-types.html index e043b7b..c5c8e25 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-types.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-types.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -11.2. Index Types

    11.2. Index Types

    +11.2. Index Types

    11.2. Index Types

    PostgreSQL provides several index types: B-tree, Hash, GiST, SP-GiST, GIN, BRIN, and the extension bloom. Each index type uses a different - algorithm that is best suited to different types of queries. + algorithm that is best suited to different types of indexable clauses. By default, the CREATE INDEX command creates B-tree indexes, which fit the most common situations. @@ -159,4 +159,4 @@ SELECT * FROM places ORDER BY location <-> point '(101,456)' LIMIT 10; The BRIN operator classes included in the standard distribution are documented in Table 71.1. For more information see Chapter 71. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-unique.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-unique.html index 0292b08..e7bc514 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-unique.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes-unique.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -11.6. Unique Indexes

    11.6. Unique Indexes

    +11.6. Unique Indexes

    11.6. Unique Indexes

    Indexes can also be used to enforce uniqueness of a column's value, or the uniqueness of the combined values of more than one column.

    @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ CREATE UNIQUE INDEX name ON 
    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes.html index 9435142..423ef9b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/indexes.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -Chapter 11. Indexes \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/information-schema.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/information-schema.html index 4a67c76..da50149 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/information-schema.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/information-schema.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 37. The Information Schema

    Chapter 37. The Information Schema

    Table of Contents

    37.1. The Schema
    37.2. Data Types
    37.3. information_schema_catalog_name
    37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations
    37.5. applicable_roles
    37.6. attributes
    37.7. character_sets
    37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage
    37.9. check_constraints
    37.10. collations
    37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability
    37.12. column_column_usage
    37.13. column_domain_usage
    37.14. column_options
    37.15. column_privileges
    37.16. column_udt_usage
    37.17. columns
    37.18. constraint_column_usage
    37.19. constraint_table_usage
    37.20. data_type_privileges
    37.21. domain_constraints
    37.22. domain_udt_usage
    37.23. domains
    37.24. element_types
    37.25. enabled_roles
    37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options
    37.27. foreign_data_wrappers
    37.28. foreign_server_options
    37.29. foreign_servers
    37.30. foreign_table_options
    37.31. foreign_tables
    37.32. key_column_usage
    37.33. parameters
    37.34. referential_constraints
    37.35. role_column_grants
    37.36. role_routine_grants
    37.37. role_table_grants
    37.38. role_udt_grants
    37.39. role_usage_grants
    37.40. routine_column_usage
    37.41. routine_privileges
    37.42. routine_routine_usage
    37.43. routine_sequence_usage
    37.44. routine_table_usage
    37.45. routines
    37.46. schemata
    37.47. sequences
    37.48. sql_features
    37.49. sql_implementation_info
    37.50. sql_parts
    37.51. sql_sizing
    37.52. table_constraints
    37.53. table_privileges
    37.54. tables
    37.55. transforms
    37.56. triggered_update_columns
    37.57. triggers
    37.58. udt_privileges
    37.59. usage_privileges
    37.60. user_defined_types
    37.61. user_mapping_options
    37.62. user_mappings
    37.63. view_column_usage
    37.64. view_routine_usage
    37.65. view_table_usage
    37.66. views

    +Chapter 37. The Information Schema

    Chapter 37. The Information Schema

    Table of Contents

    37.1. The Schema
    37.2. Data Types
    37.3. information_schema_catalog_name
    37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations
    37.5. applicable_roles
    37.6. attributes
    37.7. character_sets
    37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage
    37.9. check_constraints
    37.10. collations
    37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability
    37.12. column_column_usage
    37.13. column_domain_usage
    37.14. column_options
    37.15. column_privileges
    37.16. column_udt_usage
    37.17. columns
    37.18. constraint_column_usage
    37.19. constraint_table_usage
    37.20. data_type_privileges
    37.21. domain_constraints
    37.22. domain_udt_usage
    37.23. domains
    37.24. element_types
    37.25. enabled_roles
    37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options
    37.27. foreign_data_wrappers
    37.28. foreign_server_options
    37.29. foreign_servers
    37.30. foreign_table_options
    37.31. foreign_tables
    37.32. key_column_usage
    37.33. parameters
    37.34. referential_constraints
    37.35. role_column_grants
    37.36. role_routine_grants
    37.37. role_table_grants
    37.38. role_udt_grants
    37.39. role_usage_grants
    37.40. routine_column_usage
    37.41. routine_privileges
    37.42. routine_routine_usage
    37.43. routine_sequence_usage
    37.44. routine_table_usage
    37.45. routines
    37.46. schemata
    37.47. sequences
    37.48. sql_features
    37.49. sql_implementation_info
    37.50. sql_parts
    37.51. sql_sizing
    37.52. table_constraints
    37.53. table_privileges
    37.54. tables
    37.55. transforms
    37.56. triggered_update_columns
    37.57. triggers
    37.58. udt_privileges
    37.59. usage_privileges
    37.60. user_defined_types
    37.61. user_mapping_options
    37.62. user_mappings
    37.63. view_column_usage
    37.64. view_routine_usage
    37.65. view_table_usage
    37.66. views

    The information schema consists of a set of views that contain information about the objects defined in the current database. The information schema is defined in the SQL standard and can therefore @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ issues but contain the table name to help distinguish duplicate rows, e.g., constraint_column_usage, constraint_table_usage, table_constraints. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-administrable-role-authorizations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-administrable-role-authorizations.html index fd33aa2..ebdf439 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-administrable-role-authorizations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-administrable-role-authorizations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations

    37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations

    +37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations

    37.4. administrable_role_​authorizations

    The view administrable_role_authorizations identifies all roles that the current user has the admin option for. @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@

    Always YES -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-applicable-roles.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-applicable-roles.html index 0b2d49e..ee28362 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-applicable-roles.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-applicable-roles.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.5. applicable_roles

    37.5. applicable_roles

    +37.5. applicable_roles

    37.5. applicable_roles

    The view applicable_roles identifies all roles whose privileges the current user can use. This means there is some chain of role grants from the current user to the role in @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@

    YES if the grantee has the admin option on the role, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-attributes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-attributes.html index 30c039d..fd6a733 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-attributes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-attributes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.6. attributes

    37.6. attributes

    +37.6. attributes

    37.6. attributes

    The view attributes contains information about the attributes of composite data types defined in the database. (Note that the view does not give information about table columns, @@ -223,4 +223,4 @@


    See also under Section 37.17, a similarly structured view, for further information on some of the columns. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-character-sets.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-character-sets.html index ea75a22..ef3ad3c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-character-sets.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-character-sets.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.7. character_sets

    37.7. character_sets

    +37.7. character_sets

    37.7. character_sets

    The view character_sets identifies the character sets available in the current database. Since PostgreSQL does not support multiple character sets within one database, this view only @@ -14,8 +14,8 @@

    character encoding form

    An encoding of some character repertoire. Most older character repertoires only use one encoding form, and so there are no - separate names for them (e.g., LATIN1 is an - encoding form applicable to the LATIN1 + separate names for them (e.g., LATIN2 is an + encoding form applicable to the LATIN2 repertoire). But for example Unicode has the encoding forms UTF8, UTF16, etc. (not all supported by PostgreSQL). Encoding forms are not exposed @@ -83,4 +83,4 @@ settings of the current database. If there is no such collation, then this column and the associated schema and catalog columns are null. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraint-routine-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraint-routine-usage.html index e11d7e1..ab27fe1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraint-routine-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraint-routine-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage

    37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage

    +37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage

    37.8. check_constraint_routine_usage

    The view check_constraint_routine_usage identifies routines (functions and procedures) that are used by a check constraint. Only those routines are shown that are owned by @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@

    The specific name of the function. See Section 37.45 for more information. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraints.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraints.html index 54aa4d6..14263be 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraints.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-check-constraints.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.9. check_constraints

    37.9. check_constraints

    +37.9. check_constraints

    37.9. check_constraints

    The view check_constraints contains all check constraints, either defined on a table or on a domain, that are owned by a currently enabled role. (The owner of the table or @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@

    The check expression of the check constraint -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collation-character-set-applicab.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collation-character-set-applicab.html index 852b699..af15061 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collation-character-set-applicab.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collation-character-set-applicab.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability

    37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability

    +37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability

    37.11. collation_character_set_​applicability

    The view collation_character_set_applicability identifies which character set the available collations are applicable to. In PostgreSQL, there is only one character set per @@ -41,4 +41,4 @@

    Name of the character set -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collations.html index 5b7cdaa..f5256b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-collations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.10. collations

    37.10. collations

    +37.10. collations

    37.10. collations

    The view collations contains the collations available in the current database.

    Table 37.8. collations Columns

    @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@

    Always NO PAD (The alternative PAD SPACE is not supported by PostgreSQL.) -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-column-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-column-usage.html index a2e6bc4..62c87f3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-column-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-column-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.12. column_column_usage

    37.12. column_column_usage

    +37.12. column_column_usage

    37.12. column_column_usage

    The view column_column_usage identifies all generated columns that depend on another base column in the same table. Only tables owned by a currently enabled role are included. @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@

    Name of the generated column -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-domain-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-domain-usage.html index f0ba135..10badd9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-domain-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-domain-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.13. column_domain_usage

    37.13. column_domain_usage

    +37.13. column_domain_usage

    37.13. column_domain_usage

    The view column_domain_usage identifies all columns (of a table or a view) that make use of some domain defined in the current database and owned by a currently enabled role. @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@

    Name of the column -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-options.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-options.html index faf5fdb..2a07508 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-options.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-options.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.14. column_options

    37.14. column_options

    +37.14. column_options

    37.14. column_options

    The view column_options contains all the options defined for foreign table columns in the current database. Only those foreign table columns are shown that the current user has access to @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@

    Value of the option -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-privileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-privileges.html index d54c026..ea0738d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-privileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-privileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.15. column_privileges

    37.15. column_privileges

    +37.15. column_privileges

    37.15. column_privileges

    The view column_privileges identifies all privileges granted on columns to a currently enabled role or by a currently enabled role. There is one row for each combination of @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-udt-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-udt-usage.html index 14a7cd3..879f8c6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-udt-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-column-udt-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.16. column_udt_usage

    37.16. column_udt_usage

    +37.16. column_udt_usage

    37.16. column_udt_usage

    The view column_udt_usage identifies all columns that use data types owned by a currently enabled role. Note that in PostgreSQL, built-in data types behave @@ -49,4 +49,4 @@

    Name of the column -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-columns.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-columns.html index f17f323..21a5428 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-columns.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-columns.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.17. columns

    37.17. columns

    +37.17. columns

    37.17. columns

    The view columns contains information about all table columns (or view columns) in the database. System columns (ctid, etc.) are not included. Only those columns are @@ -334,4 +334,4 @@ columns with their associated data types and treat domains as separate types, you could write coalesce(domain_name, udt_name), etc. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-column-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-column-usage.html index c19d338..52b4c5d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-column-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-column-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.18. constraint_column_usage

    37.18. constraint_column_usage

    +37.18. constraint_column_usage

    37.18. constraint_column_usage

    The view constraint_column_usage identifies all columns in the current database that are used by some constraint. Only those columns are shown that are contained in a table owned by @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@

    Name of the constraint -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-table-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-table-usage.html index 9899278..0a97df2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-table-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-constraint-table-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.19. constraint_table_usage

    37.19. constraint_table_usage

    +37.19. constraint_table_usage

    37.19. constraint_table_usage

    The view constraint_table_usage identifies all tables in the current database that are used by some constraint and are owned by a currently enabled role. (This is different from the @@ -47,4 +47,4 @@

    Name of the constraint -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-data-type-privileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-data-type-privileges.html index 811ab2d..dd49680 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-data-type-privileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-data-type-privileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.20. data_type_privileges

    37.20. data_type_privileges

    +37.20. data_type_privileges

    37.20. data_type_privileges

    The view data_type_privileges identifies all data type descriptors that the current user has access to, by way of being the owner of the described object or having some privilege @@ -49,4 +49,4 @@

    The identifier of the data type descriptor, which is unique among the data type descriptors for that same object. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-datatypes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-datatypes.html index be6021e..fd5e1ba 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-datatypes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-datatypes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.2. Data Types

    37.2. Data Types

    +37.2. Data Types

    37.2. Data Types

    The columns of the information schema views use special data types that are defined in the information schema. These are defined as simple domains over ordinary built-in types. You should not use @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@

    Every column in the information schema has one of these five types. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-constraints.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-constraints.html index a46a0e7..1a70548 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-constraints.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-constraints.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.21. domain_constraints

    37.21. domain_constraints

    +37.21. domain_constraints

    37.21. domain_constraints

    The view domain_constraints contains all constraints belonging to domains defined in the current database. Only those domains are shown that the current user has access to (by way of being the owner or @@ -49,4 +49,4 @@

    YES if the constraint is deferrable and initially deferred, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-udt-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-udt-usage.html index 5335780..eed587e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-udt-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domain-udt-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.22. domain_udt_usage

    37.22. domain_udt_usage

    +37.22. domain_udt_usage

    37.22. domain_udt_usage

    The view domain_udt_usage identifies all domains that are based on data types owned by a currently enabled role. Note that in PostgreSQL, built-in data @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@

    Name of the domain -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domains.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domains.html index f829624..07354c6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domains.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-domains.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.23. domains

    37.23. domains

    +37.23. domains

    37.23. domains

    The view domains contains all domains defined in the current database. Only those domains are shown that the current user has @@ -194,4 +194,4 @@ instances of such identifiers. (The specific format of the identifier is not defined and not guaranteed to remain the same in future versions.) -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-element-types.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-element-types.html index c513cc3..c8b17c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-element-types.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-element-types.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.24. element_types

    37.24. element_types

    +37.24. element_types

    37.24. element_types

    The view element_types contains the data type descriptors of the elements of arrays. When a table column, composite-type attribute, domain, function parameter, or function return value is defined to @@ -191,4 +191,4 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position;

    An identifier of the data type descriptor of the element. This is currently not useful. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-enabled-roles.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-enabled-roles.html index 9143758..1d13b01 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-enabled-roles.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-enabled-roles.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.25. enabled_roles

    37.25. enabled_roles

    +37.25. enabled_roles

    37.25. enabled_roles

    The view enabled_roles identifies the currently enabled roles. The enabled roles are recursively defined as the current user together with all roles that have been @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@

    Name of a role -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrapper-options.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrapper-options.html index eef12cd..b1d0596 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrapper-options.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrapper-options.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options

    37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options

    +37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options

    37.26. foreign_data_wrapper_options

    The view foreign_data_wrapper_options contains all the options defined for foreign-data wrappers in the current database. Only those foreign-data wrappers are shown that the @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@

    Value of the option -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrappers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrappers.html index e8405b9..34473d8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrappers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-data-wrappers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.27. foreign_data_wrappers

    37.27. foreign_data_wrappers

    +37.27. foreign_data_wrappers

    37.27. foreign_data_wrappers

    The view foreign_data_wrappers contains all foreign-data wrappers defined in the current database. Only those foreign-data wrappers are shown that the current user has access to @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@

    Language used to implement this foreign-data wrapper -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-server-options.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-server-options.html index 9f7315e..4e56271 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-server-options.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-server-options.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.28. foreign_server_options

    37.28. foreign_server_options

    +37.28. foreign_server_options

    37.28. foreign_server_options

    The view foreign_server_options contains all the options defined for foreign servers in the current database. Only those foreign servers are shown that the current user has access to @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@

    Value of the option -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-servers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-servers.html index 7929bb5..dd26a06 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-servers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-servers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.29. foreign_servers

    37.29. foreign_servers

    +37.29. foreign_servers

    37.29. foreign_servers

    The view foreign_servers contains all foreign servers defined in the current database. Only those foreign servers are shown that the current user has access to (by way of @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@

    Name of the owner of the foreign server -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-table-options.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-table-options.html index 157e0b5..3a8e6b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-table-options.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-table-options.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.30. foreign_table_options

    37.30. foreign_table_options

    +37.30. foreign_table_options

    37.30. foreign_table_options

    The view foreign_table_options contains all the options defined for foreign tables in the current database. Only those foreign tables are shown that the current user has access to @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@

    Value of the option -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-tables.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-tables.html index f77ada4..6126087 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-tables.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-foreign-tables.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.31. foreign_tables

    37.31. foreign_tables

    +37.31. foreign_tables

    37.31. foreign_tables

    The view foreign_tables contains all foreign tables defined in the current database. Only those foreign tables are shown that the current user has access to (by way of @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@

    Name of the foreign server -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-information-schema-catalog-name.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-information-schema-catalog-name.html index cf30a9f..e741318 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-information-schema-catalog-name.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-information-schema-catalog-name.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.3. information_schema_catalog_name

    37.3. information_schema_catalog_name

    +37.3. information_schema_catalog_name

    37.3. information_schema_catalog_name

    information_schema_catalog_name is a table that always contains one row and one column containing the name of the current database (current catalog, in SQL terminology). @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@

    Name of the database that contains this information schema -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-key-column-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-key-column-usage.html index 0c4546e..485b6fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-key-column-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-key-column-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.32. key_column_usage

    37.32. key_column_usage

    +37.32. key_column_usage

    37.32. key_column_usage

    The view key_column_usage identifies all columns in the current database that are restricted by some unique, primary key, or foreign key constraint. Check constraints are not included @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ For a foreign-key constraint, ordinal position of the referenced column within its unique constraint (count starts at 1); otherwise null -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-parameters.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-parameters.html index 9125f99..1724aca 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-parameters.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-parameters.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.33. parameters

    37.33. parameters

    +37.33. parameters

    37.33. parameters

    The view parameters contains information about the parameters (arguments) of all functions in the current database. Only those functions are shown that the current user has access to @@ -185,4 +185,4 @@

    The default expression of the parameter, or null if none or if the function is not owned by a currently enabled role. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-referential-constraints.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-referential-constraints.html index 788c124..1e0ad61 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-referential-constraints.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-referential-constraints.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.34. referential_constraints

    37.34. referential_constraints

    +37.34. referential_constraints

    37.34. referential_constraints

    The view referential_constraints contains all referential (foreign key) constraints in the current database. Only those constraints are shown for which the current user has @@ -67,4 +67,4 @@ CASCADE, SET NULL, SET DEFAULT, RESTRICT, or NO ACTION. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-column-grants.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-column-grants.html index 65b794a..fe86dbb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-column-grants.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-column-grants.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.35. role_column_grants

    37.35. role_column_grants

    +37.35. role_column_grants

    37.35. role_column_grants

    The view role_column_grants identifies all privileges granted on columns where the grantor or grantee is a currently enabled role. Further information can be found under @@ -55,4 +55,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-routine-grants.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-routine-grants.html index 055e656..be46900 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-routine-grants.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-routine-grants.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.36. role_routine_grants

    37.36. role_routine_grants

    +37.36. role_routine_grants

    37.36. role_routine_grants

    The view role_routine_grants identifies all privileges granted on functions where the grantor or grantee is a currently enabled role. Further information can be found under @@ -63,4 +63,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-table-grants.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-table-grants.html index f809778..3a5089b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-table-grants.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-table-grants.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.37. role_table_grants

    37.37. role_table_grants

    +37.37. role_table_grants

    37.37. role_table_grants

    The view role_table_grants identifies all privileges granted on tables or views where the grantor or grantee is a currently enabled role. Further information can be found @@ -61,4 +61,4 @@ in the SELECT privilege, so this column shows YES if the privilege is SELECT, else NO. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-udt-grants.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-udt-grants.html index b82614c..46ab82e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-udt-grants.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-udt-grants.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.38. role_udt_grants

    37.38. role_udt_grants

    +37.38. role_udt_grants

    37.38. role_udt_grants

    The view role_udt_grants is intended to identify USAGE privileges granted on user-defined types where the grantor or grantee is a currently enabled role. Further @@ -50,4 +50,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-usage-grants.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-usage-grants.html index 4c12b77..8af5c68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-usage-grants.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-role-usage-grants.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.39. role_usage_grants

    37.39. role_usage_grants

    +37.39. role_usage_grants

    37.39. role_usage_grants

    The view role_usage_grants identifies USAGE privileges granted on various kinds of objects where the grantor or grantee is a currently enabled role. @@ -54,4 +54,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-column-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-column-usage.html index f093e7b..795463b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-column-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-column-usage.html @@ -1,8 +1,10 @@ -37.40. routine_column_usage

    37.40. routine_column_usage

    - The view routine_column_usage is meant to identify all - columns that are used by a function or procedure. This information is - currently not tracked by PostgreSQL. +37.40. routine_column_usage

    37.40. routine_column_usage

    + The view routine_column_usage identifies all columns + that are used by a function or procedure, either in the SQL body or in + parameter default expressions. (This only works for unquoted SQL bodies, + not quoted bodies or functions in other languages.) A column is only + included if its table is owned by a currently enabled role.

    Table 37.38. routine_column_usage Columns

    Column Type

    @@ -59,4 +61,4 @@

    Name of the column that is used by the function -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-privileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-privileges.html index 216a21c..a325dda 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-privileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-privileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.41. routine_privileges

    37.41. routine_privileges

    +37.41. routine_privileges

    37.41. routine_privileges

    The view routine_privileges identifies all privileges granted on functions to a currently enabled role or by a currently enabled role. There is one row for each combination of function, @@ -59,4 +59,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-routine-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-routine-usage.html index f6ffe71..35e62a7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-routine-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-routine-usage.html @@ -1,11 +1,11 @@ -37.42. routine_routine_usage

    37.42. routine_routine_usage

    - The view routine_routine_usage is meant to identify all - functions or procedures that are used by another (or the same) function or - procedure, either in the body or in parameter default expressions. - Currently, only functions used in parameter default expressions are - tracked. An entry is included here only if the used function is owned by a - currently enabled role. (There is no such restriction on the using +37.42. routine_routine_usage

    37.42. routine_routine_usage

    + The view routine_routine_usage identifies all functions + or procedures that are used by another (or the same) function or procedure, + either in the SQL body or in parameter default expressions. (This only + works for unquoted SQL bodies, not quoted bodies or functions in other + languages.) An entry is included here only if the used function is owned + by a currently enabled role. (There is no such restriction on the using function.)

    Note that the entries for both functions in the view refer to the @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@

    The specific name of the function that is used by the first function. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-sequence-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-sequence-usage.html index b560633..1a6d952 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-sequence-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-sequence-usage.html @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ -37.43. routine_sequence_usage

    37.43. routine_sequence_usage

    - The view routine_sequence_usage is meant to identify all - sequences that are used by a function or procedure, either in the body or - in parameter default expressions. Currently, only sequences used in - parameter default expressions are tracked. A sequence is only included if - that sequence is owned by a currently enabled role. +37.43. routine_sequence_usage

    37.43. routine_sequence_usage

    + The view routine_sequence_usage identifies all sequences + that are used by a function or procedure, either in the SQL body or in + parameter default expressions. (This only works for unquoted SQL bodies, + not quoted bodies or functions in other languages.) A sequence is only + included if that sequence is owned by a currently enabled role.

    Table 37.41. routine_sequence_usage Columns

    Column Type

    @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@

    Name of the sequence that is used by the function -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-table-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-table-usage.html index 85227cb..970360e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-table-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routine-table-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.44. routine_table_usage

    37.44. routine_table_usage

    +37.44. routine_table_usage

    37.44. routine_table_usage

    The view routine_table_usage is meant to identify all tables that are used by a function or procedure. This information is currently not tracked by PostgreSQL. @@ -54,4 +54,4 @@

    Name of the table that is used by the function -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routines.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routines.html index d394434..fc2b3d2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routines.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-routines.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.45. routines

    37.45. routines

    +37.45. routines

    37.45. routines

    The view routines contains all functions and procedures in the current database. Only those functions and procedures are shown that the current user has access to (by way of being the owner or having some @@ -461,4 +461,4 @@

    Applies to a feature not available in PostgreSQL -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schema.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schema.html index 9bfbb93..c572991 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schema.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schema.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.1. The Schema

    37.1. The Schema

    +37.1. The Schema

    37.1. The Schema

    The information schema itself is a schema named information_schema. This schema automatically exists in all databases. The owner of this schema is the initial @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ schema are generic names that might occur in user applications, you should be careful if you want to put the information schema in the path. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schemata.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schemata.html index 13f314d..2858d63 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schemata.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-schemata.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.46. schemata

    37.46. schemata

    +37.46. schemata

    37.46. schemata

    The view schemata contains all schemas in the current database that the current user has access to (by way of being the owner or having some privilege). @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@

    Applies to a feature not available in PostgreSQL -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sequences.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sequences.html index 57bb6ff..9b69690 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sequences.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sequences.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.47. sequences

    37.47. sequences

    +37.47. sequences

    37.47. sequences

    The view sequences contains all sequences defined in the current database. Only those sequences are shown that the current user has access to (by way of being the owner or @@ -84,4 +84,4 @@


    Note that in accordance with the SQL standard, the start, minimum, maximum, and increment values are returned as character strings. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-features.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-features.html index 4bf038d..a4d94dd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-features.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-features.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.48. sql_features

    37.48. sql_features

    +37.48. sql_features

    37.48. sql_features

    The table sql_features contains information about which formal features defined in the SQL standard are supported by PostgreSQL. This is the @@ -47,4 +47,4 @@

    Possibly a comment about the supported status of the feature -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-implementation-info.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-implementation-info.html index 8419995..623dc4a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-implementation-info.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-implementation-info.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.49. sql_implementation_info

    37.49. sql_implementation_info

    +37.49. sql_implementation_info

    37.49. sql_implementation_info

    The table sql_implementation_info contains information about various aspects that are left implementation-defined by the SQL standard. This information is @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@

    Possibly a comment pertaining to the implementation information item -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-parts.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-parts.html index fe8b191..b648e55 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-parts.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-parts.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.50. sql_parts

    37.50. sql_parts

    +37.50. sql_parts

    37.50. sql_parts

    The table sql_parts contains information about which of the several parts of the SQL standard are supported by PostgreSQL. @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@

    Possibly a comment about the supported status of the part -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-sizing.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-sizing.html index ed78ef9..f862662 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-sizing.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-sql-sizing.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.51. sql_sizing

    37.51. sql_sizing

    +37.51. sql_sizing

    37.51. sql_sizing

    The table sql_sizing contains information about various size limits and maximum values in PostgreSQL. This information is @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@

    Possibly a comment pertaining to the sizing item -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-constraints.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-constraints.html index a82b03c..dfb87c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-constraints.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-constraints.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.52. table_constraints

    37.52. table_constraints

    +37.52. table_constraints

    37.52. table_constraints

    The view table_constraints contains all constraints belonging to tables that the current user owns or has some privilege other than SELECT on. @@ -70,4 +70,4 @@ if the constraint treats nulls as distinct or NO if it treats nulls as not distinct, otherwise null for other types of constraints. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-privileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-privileges.html index 291f778..c1869b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-privileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-table-privileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.53. table_privileges

    37.53. table_privileges

    +37.53. table_privileges

    37.53. table_privileges

    The view table_privileges identifies all privileges granted on tables or views to a currently enabled role or by a currently enabled role. There is one row for each @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@ in the SELECT privilege, so this column shows YES if the privilege is SELECT, else NO. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-tables.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-tables.html index 384efd2..088970c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-tables.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-tables.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.54. tables

    37.54. tables

    +37.54. tables

    37.54. tables

    The view tables contains all tables and views defined in the current database. Only those tables and views are shown that the current user has access to (by way of being the @@ -79,4 +79,4 @@

    Not yet implemented -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-transforms.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-transforms.html index c3676d1..ed0d401 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-transforms.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-transforms.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.55. transforms

    37.55. transforms

    +37.55. transforms

    37.55. transforms

    The view transforms contains information about the transforms defined in the current database. More precisely, it contains a row for each function contained in a transform (the from SQL @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@

    FROM SQL or TO SQL -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggered-update-columns.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggered-update-columns.html index 3a510d8..178aea9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggered-update-columns.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggered-update-columns.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.56. triggered_update_columns

    37.56. triggered_update_columns

    +37.56. triggered_update_columns

    37.56. triggered_update_columns

    For triggers in the current database that specify a column list (like UPDATE OF column1, column2), the view triggered_update_columns identifies these @@ -48,4 +48,4 @@

    Name of the column that the trigger is defined on -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggers.html index c91b404..148fedd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-triggers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.57. triggers

    37.57. triggers

    +37.57. triggers

    37.57. triggers

    The view triggers contains all triggers defined in the current database on tables and views that the current user owns or has some privilege other than SELECT on. @@ -147,4 +147,4 @@ respectively. That was how they were named in the SQL:1999 standard. The new naming conforms to SQL:2003 and later. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-udt-privileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-udt-privileges.html index f5d6ba4..3df1745 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-udt-privileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-udt-privileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.58. udt_privileges

    37.58. udt_privileges

    +37.58. udt_privileges

    37.58. udt_privileges

    The view udt_privileges identifies USAGE privileges granted on user-defined types to a currently enabled role or by a currently enabled role. There is one row for @@ -47,4 +47,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-usage-privileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-usage-privileges.html index ea56254..cf0c9cf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-usage-privileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-usage-privileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.59. usage_privileges

    37.59. usage_privileges

    +37.59. usage_privileges

    37.59. usage_privileges

    The view usage_privileges identifies USAGE privileges granted on various kinds of objects to a currently enabled role or by a currently enabled role. @@ -63,4 +63,4 @@

    YES if the privilege is grantable, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-defined-types.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-defined-types.html index 3f7ca33..2b6ea5e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-defined-types.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-defined-types.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.60. user_defined_types

    37.60. user_defined_types

    +37.60. user_defined_types

    37.60. user_defined_types

    The view user_defined_types currently contains all composite types defined in the current database. Only those types are shown that the current user has access to (by way @@ -165,4 +165,4 @@

    Applies to a feature not available in PostgreSQL -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mapping-options.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mapping-options.html index 0abde01..09f02df 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mapping-options.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mapping-options.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.61. user_mapping_options

    37.61. user_mapping_options

    +37.61. user_mapping_options

    37.61. user_mapping_options

    The view user_mapping_options contains all the options defined for user mappings in the current database. Only those user mappings are shown where the current user has access to @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ server owner, or the current user is a superuser. The intent is to protect password information stored as user mapping option. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mappings.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mappings.html index de98c45..7b8698e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mappings.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-user-mappings.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.62. user_mappings

    37.62. user_mappings

    +37.62. user_mappings

    37.62. user_mappings

    The view user_mappings contains all user mappings defined in the current database. Only those user mappings are shown where the current user has access to the corresponding @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@

    Name of the foreign server used by this mapping -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-column-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-column-usage.html index 0313df6..7467765 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-column-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-column-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.63. view_column_usage

    37.63. view_column_usage

    +37.63. view_column_usage

    37.63. view_column_usage

    The view view_column_usage identifies all columns that are used in the query expression of a view (the SELECT statement that defines the view). A @@ -51,4 +51,4 @@

    Name of the column that is used by the view -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-routine-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-routine-usage.html index fb87806..5e52ae3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-routine-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-routine-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.64. view_routine_usage

    37.64. view_routine_usage

    +37.64. view_routine_usage

    37.64. view_routine_usage

    The view view_routine_usage identifies all routines (functions and procedures) that are used in the query expression of a view (the SELECT statement that @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@

    The specific name of the function. See Section 37.45 for more information. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-table-usage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-table-usage.html index 511b2c6..a2bcb89 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-table-usage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-view-table-usage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.65. view_table_usage

    37.65. view_table_usage

    +37.65. view_table_usage

    37.65. view_table_usage

    The view view_table_usage identifies all tables that are used in the query expression of a view (the SELECT statement that defines the view). A @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@

    Name of the table that is used by the view -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-views.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-views.html index bf61004..6052a95 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-views.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/infoschema-views.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -37.66. views

    37.66. views

    +37.66. views

    37.66. views

    The view views contains all views defined in the current database. Only those views are shown that the current user has access to (by way of being the owner or having some privilege). @@ -67,4 +67,4 @@

    YES if the view has an INSTEAD OF INSERT trigger defined on it, NO if not -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-binaries.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-binaries.html index 12bbf70..50c3500 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-binaries.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-binaries.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 16. Installation from Binaries

    Chapter 16. Installation from Binaries

    +Chapter 16. Installation from Binaries

    Chapter 16. Installation from Binaries

    PostgreSQL is available in the form of binary packages for most common operating systems today. When available, this is the recommended way to install PostgreSQL for users of the system. Building @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ the download section on the PostgreSQL website at https://www.postgresql.org/download/ and follow the instructions for the specific platform. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-getsource.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-getsource.html index 6cdf477..bcacaad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-getsource.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-getsource.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -17.3. Getting the Source

    17.3. Getting the Source

    +17.3. Getting the Source

    17.3. Getting the Source

    The PostgreSQL source code for released versions can be obtained from the download section of our website: https://www.postgresql.org/ftp/source/. @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@

    Alternatively, you can use the Git version control system; see Section I.1 for more information. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-post.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-post.html index f443757..3f7f0df 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-post.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-post.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -17.5. Post-Installation Setup

    17.5. Post-Installation Setup

    17.5.1. Shared Libraries

    +17.5. Post-Installation Setup

    17.5. Post-Installation Setup

    17.5.1. Shared Libraries

    On some systems with shared libraries you need to tell the system how to find the newly installed shared libraries. The systems on which this is @@ -100,4 +100,4 @@ export MANPATH user that plans to use the database sets PGHOST. This is not required, however; the settings can be communicated via command line options to most client programs. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-procedure.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-procedure.html index 6dbc451..c6ca127 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-procedure.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-procedure.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -17.4. Installation Procedure

    17.4. Installation Procedure

    1. Configuration

      +17.4. Installation Procedure

      17.4. Installation Procedure

      1. Configuration

        The first step of the installation procedure is to configure the source tree for your system and choose the options you would like. This is done by running the configure script. For a @@ -815,4 +815,4 @@ build-postgresql: makefiles. Which to use is a matter of preference, but a common habit among developers is to use PROFILE for one-time flag adjustments, while COPT might be kept set all the time. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-requirements.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-requirements.html index 4921e5d..0ccce68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-requirements.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-requirements.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -17.2. Requirements

    17.2. Requirements

    +17.2. Requirements

    17.2. Requirements

    In general, a modern Unix-compatible platform should be able to run PostgreSQL. The platforms that had received specific testing at the @@ -194,4 +194,4 @@ run the regression tests you will temporarily need up to an extra 300 MB. Use the df command to check free disk space. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-short.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-short.html index 700f5de..c52018a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-short.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-short.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -17.1. Short Version

    17.1. Short Version

    +17.1. Short Version

    17.1. Short Version

     ./configure
     make
    @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ su - postgres
     

    The long version is the rest of this chapter. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows-full.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows-full.html index ba963fa..70010d3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows-full.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows-full.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ 18.1. Building with Visual C++ or the Microsoft Windows SDK

    18.1. Building with Visual C++ or the + Microsoft Windows SDKPrev UpChapter 18. Installation from Source Code on WindowsHome Next

    18.1. Building with Visual C++ or the Microsoft Windows SDK

    PostgreSQL can be built using the Visual C++ compiler suite from Microsoft. These compilers can be either from Visual Studio, @@ -338,4 +338,4 @@ $ENV{PROVE_TESTS}='t/020*.pl t/010*.pl' zstd, which will search for a command by that name in the configured PATH.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows.html index 0ac486d..11eba83 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/install-windows.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 18. Installation from Source Code on Windows

    Chapter 18. Installation from Source Code on Windows

    Table of Contents

    18.1. Building with Visual C++ or the +Chapter 18. Installation from Source Code on Windows

    Chapter 18. Installation from Source Code on Windows

    It is recommended that most users download the binary distribution for Windows, available as a graphical installer package @@ -40,5 +40,5 @@ line editing. The Cygwin build does support command line editing, so it should be used where psql is needed for interactive use on Windows. -


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring.html index 5ab0adf..354b2af 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/monitoring.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 28. Monitoring Database Activity

    Chapter 28. Monitoring Database Activity

    +Chapter 28. Monitoring Database Activity

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/multibyte.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/multibyte.html index 1a15f68..896e77d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/multibyte.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/multibyte.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -24.3. Character Set Support

    24.3. Character Set Support

    +24.3. Character Set Support

    24.3. Character Set Support

    The character set support in PostgreSQL allows you to store text in a variety of character sets (also called encodings), including @@ -348,4 +348,4 @@ RESET client_encoding; UTF-8 (8-bit UCS/Unicode Transformation Format) is defined here.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/multivariate-statistics-examples.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/multivariate-statistics-examples.html index 62c0ba3..bc318f5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/multivariate-statistics-examples.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/multivariate-statistics-examples.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -75.2. Multivariate Statistics Examples

    75.2. Multivariate Statistics Examples

    75.2.1. Functional Dependencies

    +75.2. Multivariate Statistics Examples

    75.2. Multivariate Statistics Examples

    75.2.1. Functional Dependencies

    Multivariate correlation can be demonstrated with a very simple data set — a table with two columns, both containing the same values: @@ -207,4 +207,4 @@ EXPLAIN (ANALYZE, TIMING OFF) SELECT * FROM t WHERE a <= 49 AND b > 49; Rows Removed by Filter: 10000

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-caveats.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-caveats.html index 086d6a7..4468e8b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-caveats.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-caveats.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -13.6. Caveats

    13.6. Caveats

    +13.6. Caveats

    13.6. Caveats

    Some DDL commands, currently only TRUNCATE and the table-rewriting forms of ALTER TABLE, are not MVCC-safe. This means that after the truncation or rewrite commits, the @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ contrast, queries that explicitly examine the system catalogs don't see rows representing concurrently created database objects, in the higher isolation levels. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-intro.html index b8e498c..cecb7ea 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -13.1. Introduction

    13.1. Introduction

    +13.1. Introduction

    13.1. Introduction

    PostgreSQL provides a rich set of tools for developers to manage concurrent access to data. Internally, data consistency is maintained by using a multiversion @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ performance than locks. In addition, application-defined advisory locks provide a mechanism for acquiring locks that are not tied to a single transaction. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-serialization-failure-handling.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-serialization-failure-handling.html index bca37b2..d3b0281 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-serialization-failure-handling.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc-serialization-failure-handling.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -13.5. Serialization Failure Handling

    13.5. Serialization Failure Handling

    +13.5. Serialization Failure Handling

    13.5. Serialization Failure Handling

    Both Repeatable Read and Serializable isolation levels can produce errors that are designed to prevent serialization anomalies. As previously stated, applications using these levels must be prepared to @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@ many attempts. In cases involving a conflicting prepared transaction, it may not be possible to make progress until the prepared transaction commits or rolls back. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc.html index 2fa8478..3de2cc6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/mvcc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 13. Concurrency Control

    Chapter 13. Concurrency Control

    +Chapter 13. Concurrency Control

    Chapter 13. Concurrency Control

    This chapter describes the behavior of the PostgreSQL database system when two or more sessions try to access the same data at the same time. The @@ -7,4 +7,4 @@ sessions while maintaining strict data integrity. Every developer of database applications should be familiar with the topics covered in this chapter. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-programmer.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-programmer.html index d64c217..c039385 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-programmer.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-programmer.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -57.2. For the Programmer

    57.2. For the Programmer

    57.2.1. Mechanics

    +57.2. For the Programmer

    57.2. For the Programmer

    57.2.1. Mechanics

    This section describes how to implement native language support in a program or library that is part of the PostgreSQL distribution. @@ -151,4 +151,4 @@ errmsg_plural("copied %d file", These comments are copied to the message catalog files so that the translators can see them.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-translator.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-translator.html index d3292bb..c50c9b5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-translator.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/nls-translator.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -57.1. For the Translator

    57.1. For the Translator

    +57.1. For the Translator

    57.1. For the Translator

    PostgreSQL programs (server and client) can issue their messages in your favorite language — if the messages have been translated. @@ -215,4 +215,4 @@ msgstr "Die Datei %2$s hat %1$u Zeichen." speaking end users might also not understand it or find it ambiguous, so it's best to improve the message.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/nls.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/nls.html index ee828ee..5c67952 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/nls.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/nls.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 57. Native Language Support \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 57. Native Language Support \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/non-durability.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/non-durability.html index b47dd75..dc0db28 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/non-durability.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/non-durability.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -14.5. Non-Durable Settings

    14.5. Non-Durable Settings

    +14.5. Non-Durable Settings

    14.5. Non-Durable Settings

    Durability is a database feature that guarantees the recording of committed transactions even if the server crashes or loses power. However, durability adds significant database overhead, @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@ tables to avoid WAL writes, though it makes the tables non-crash-safe.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/notation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/notation.html index 218d748..4316356 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/notation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/notation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3. Conventions

    3. Conventions

    +3. Conventions

    3. Conventions

    The following conventions are used in the synopsis of a command: brackets ([ and ]) indicate optional parts. Braces @@ -19,4 +19,4 @@ PostgreSQL system. These terms should not be interpreted too narrowly; this book does not have fixed presumptions about system administration procedures. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/oid2name.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/oid2name.html index 50d1835..27188af 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/oid2name.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/oid2name.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -oid2name

    oid2name

    oid2name — resolve OIDs and file nodes in a PostgreSQL data directory

    Synopsis

    oid2name [option...]

    Description

    +oid2name

    oid2name

    oid2name — resolve OIDs and file nodes in a PostgreSQL data directory

    Synopsis

    oid2name [option...]

    Description

    oid2name is a utility program that helps administrators to examine the file structure used by PostgreSQL. To make use of it, you need to be familiar with the database file structure, which is described in @@ -189,4 +189,4 @@ From database "alvherre": 155156 foo

    Author

    B. Palmer -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/oldsnapshot.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/oldsnapshot.html index 51a77a7..c663c62 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/oldsnapshot.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/oldsnapshot.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.24. old_snapshot

    F.24. old_snapshot

    +F.24. old_snapshot

    F.24. old_snapshot

    The old_snapshot module allows inspection of the server state that is used to implement old_snapshot_threshold. @@ -7,4 +7,4 @@ Returns all of the entries in the server's timestamp to XID mapping. Each entry represents the newest xmin of any snapshot taken in the corresponding minute. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/overview.html index dda4d14..12bdad7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/overview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 52. Overview of PostgreSQL Internals

    Chapter 52. Overview of PostgreSQL Internals

    Author

    +Chapter 52. Overview of PostgreSQL Internals

    Chapter 52. Overview of PostgreSQL Internals

    Author

    This chapter originated as part of [sim98] Stefan Simkovics' Master's Thesis prepared at Vienna University of Technology under the direction @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ understand the general sequence of operations that occur within the backend from the point at which a query is received, to the point at which the results are returned to the client. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pageinspect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pageinspect.html index 4c34e37..7c0a658 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pageinspect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pageinspect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.25. pageinspect

    F.25. pageinspect

    +F.25. pageinspect

    F.25. pageinspect

    The pageinspect module provides functions that allow you to inspect the contents of database pages at a low level, which is useful for debugging purposes. All of these functions may be used only by superusers. @@ -564,4 +564,4 @@ procid | 450 spares | {0,0,0,0,0,0,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,1,3,4,4,4,45,55,58,59,​508,567,628,704,1193,1202,1204} mapp | {65}

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-plans.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-plans.html index 771bac3..7af33cd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-plans.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-plans.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -15.3. Parallel Plans

    15.3. Parallel Plans

    +15.3. Parallel Plans

    15.3. Parallel Plans

    Because each worker executes the parallel portion of the plan to completion, it is not possible to simply take an ordinary query plan and run it using multiple workers. Each worker would produce a full @@ -152,4 +152,4 @@ This may be useful in determining whether the work is being evenly distributed between all plan nodes and more generally in understanding the performance characteristics of the plan. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-query.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-query.html index 0ae2614..8d1c60a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-query.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-query.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 15. Parallel Query

    Chapter 15. Parallel Query

    +Chapter 15. Parallel Query

    Chapter 15. Parallel Query

    PostgreSQL can devise query plans that can leverage multiple CPUs in order to answer queries faster. This feature is known as parallel query. Many queries cannot benefit from parallel query, either @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ few rows to the user will typically benefit most. This chapter explains some details of how parallel query works and in which situations it can be used so that users who wish to make use of it can understand what to expect. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-safety.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-safety.html index a7f874b..51d31e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-safety.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/parallel-safety.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -15.4. Parallel Safety

    15.4. Parallel Safety

    +15.4. Parallel Safety

    15.4. Parallel Safety

    The planner classifies operations involved in a query as either parallel safe, parallel restricted, or parallel unsafe. A parallel safe operation is one that @@ -80,4 +80,4 @@ the parallel portion of the query and defer the evaluation of the WHERE clause so that it happens above the Gather node. However, the planner does not do this. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/parser-stage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/parser-stage.html index 2e41c9a..7aa4f59 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/parser-stage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/parser-stage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -52.3. The Parser Stage

    52.3. The Parser Stage

    +52.3. The Parser Stage

    52.3. The Parser Stage

    The parser stage consists of two parts:

    • @@ -88,4 +88,4 @@ name turns out to be an ordinary function or an aggregate function. Also, information about the actual data types of columns and expression results is added to the query tree. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/passwordcheck.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/passwordcheck.html index 2f86e30..43beaea 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/passwordcheck.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/passwordcheck.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.26. passwordcheck

    F.26. passwordcheck

    +F.26. passwordcheck

    F.26. passwordcheck

    The passwordcheck module checks users' passwords whenever they are set with CREATE ROLE or @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ Alternatively, you could modify passwordcheck to reject pre-encrypted passwords, but forcing users to set their passwords in clear text carries its own security risks. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/performance-tips.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/performance-tips.html index b50a10b..60d4fda 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/performance-tips.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/performance-tips.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -Chapter 14. Performance Tips

    Chapter 14. Performance Tips

    +Chapter 14. Performance Tips

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/perm-functions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/perm-functions.html index 4cb60f0..cbd4e82 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/perm-functions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/perm-functions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -22.6. Function Security

    22.6. Function Security

    +22.6. Function Security

    22.6. Function Security

    Functions, triggers and row-level security policies allow users to insert code into the backend server that other users might execute unintentionally. Hence, these mechanisms permit users to Trojan @@ -19,4 +19,4 @@ are considered untrusted, and PostgreSQL allows only superusers to create functions written in those languages. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgarchivecleanup.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgarchivecleanup.html index c96ee74..b684221 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgarchivecleanup.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgarchivecleanup.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_archivecleanup

    pg_archivecleanup

    pg_archivecleanup — clean up PostgreSQL WAL archive files

    Synopsis

    pg_archivecleanup [option...] archivelocation oldestkeptwalfile

    Description

    +pg_archivecleanup

    pg_archivecleanup

    pg_archivecleanup — clean up PostgreSQL WAL archive files

    Synopsis

    pg_archivecleanup [option...] archivelocation oldestkeptwalfile

    Description

    pg_archivecleanup is designed to be used as an archive_cleanup_command to clean up WAL file archives when running as a standby server (see Section 27.2). @@ -91,4 +91,4 @@ archive_cleanup_command = 'pg_archivecleanup -d /mnt/standby/archive %r 2>> produce debugging output in cleanup.log

  • remove no-longer-needed files from the archive directory -

  • \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbench.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbench.html index a7386e0..dde8d04 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbench.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbench.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pgbench

    pgbench

    pgbench — run a benchmark test on PostgreSQL

    Synopsis

    pgbench -i [option...] [dbname]

    pgbench [option...] [dbname]

    Description

    +pgbench

    pgbench

    pgbench — run a benchmark test on PostgreSQL

    Synopsis

    pgbench -i [option...] [dbname]

    pgbench [option...] [dbname]

    Description

    pgbench is a simple program for running benchmark tests on PostgreSQL. It runs the same sequence of SQL commands over and over, possibly in multiple concurrent database sessions, @@ -1718,4 +1718,4 @@ statement latencies in milliseconds, failures and retries: do not run pgbench in that database. pgbench uses unqualified names and does not manipulate the search path. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbuffercache.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbuffercache.html index a1c8139..cb1ac2b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbuffercache.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgbuffercache.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.27. pg_buffercache

    F.27. pg_buffercache

    +F.27. pg_buffercache

    F.27. pg_buffercache

    The pg_buffercache module provides a means for examining what's happening in the shared buffer cache in real time.

    @@ -115,4 +115,4 @@ regression=# SELECT n.nspname, c.relname, count(*) AS buffers Design suggestions: Neil Conway

    Debugging advice: Tom Lane -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgcrypto.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgcrypto.html index 582ac48..fa60b93 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgcrypto.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgcrypto.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.28. pgcrypto

    F.28. pgcrypto

    +F.28. pgcrypto

    F.28. pgcrypto

    The pgcrypto module provides cryptographic functions for PostgreSQL.

    @@ -541,4 +541,4 @@ gen_random_uuid() returns uuid Marko Kreen

    pgcrypto uses code from the following sources: -

    AlgorithmAuthorSource origin
    DES cryptDavid Burren and othersFreeBSD libcrypt
    MD5 cryptPoul-Henning KampFreeBSD libcrypt
    Blowfish cryptSolar Designerwww.openwall.com
    \ No newline at end of file +

    AlgorithmAuthorSource origin
    DES cryptDavid Burren and othersFreeBSD libcrypt
    MD5 cryptPoul-Henning KampFreeBSD libcrypt
    Blowfish cryptSolar Designerwww.openwall.com
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgfreespacemap.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgfreespacemap.html index 72483cc..2213b0e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgfreespacemap.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgfreespacemap.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.29. pg_freespacemap

    F.29. pg_freespacemap

    +F.29. pg_freespacemap

    F.29. pg_freespacemap

    The pg_freespacemap module provides a means for examining the free space map (FSM). It provides a function called pg_freespace, or two @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ postgres=# SELECT * FROM pg_freespace('foo', 7); Original version by Mark Kirkwood . Rewritten in version 8.4 to suit new FSM implementation by Heikki Linnakangas -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgprewarm.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgprewarm.html index 4d9a4a2..b863d04 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgprewarm.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgprewarm.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.30. pg_prewarm

    F.30. pg_prewarm

    +F.30. pg_prewarm

    F.30. pg_prewarm

    The pg_prewarm module provides a convenient way to load relation data into either the operating system buffer cache or the PostgreSQL buffer cache. Prewarming @@ -79,4 +79,4 @@ pg_prewarm.autoprewarm_interval = 300s

    F.30.3. Author

    Robert Haas -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgrowlocks.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgrowlocks.html index 54e4e0b..e569763 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgrowlocks.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgrowlocks.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.31. pgrowlocks

    F.31. pgrowlocks

    +F.31. pgrowlocks

    F.31. pgrowlocks

    The pgrowlocks module provides a function to show row locking information for a specified table.

    @@ -48,4 +48,4 @@ SELECT * FROM accounts AS a, pgrowlocks('accounts') AS p (4 rows)

    F.31.3. Author

    Tatsuo Ishii -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstatstatements.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstatstatements.html index c4766c4..5a45f07 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstatstatements.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstatstatements.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.32. pg_stat_statements

    F.32. pg_stat_statements

    +F.32. pg_stat_statements

    F.32. pg_stat_statements

    The pg_stat_statements module provides a means for tracking planning and execution statistics of all SQL statements executed by a server. @@ -610,4 +610,4 @@ hit_percent |

    F.32.6. Authors

    Takahiro Itagaki . Query normalization added by Peter Geoghegan . -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstattuple.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstattuple.html index decbc32..20b5bf5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstattuple.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgstattuple.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.33. pgstattuple

    F.33. pgstattuple

    +F.33. pgstattuple

    F.33. pgstattuple

    The pgstattuple module provides various functions to obtain tuple-level statistics.

    @@ -196,4 +196,4 @@ approx_free_percent | 2.09 accurate to the byte.

    F.33.2. Authors

    Tatsuo Ishii, Satoshi Nagayasu and Abhijit Menon-Sen -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgsurgery.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgsurgery.html index 80f0497..4890efa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgsurgery.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgsurgery.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.34. pg_surgery

    F.34. pg_surgery

    +F.34. pg_surgery

    F.34. pg_surgery

    The pg_surgery module provides various functions to perform surgery on a damaged relation. These functions are unsafe by design and using them may corrupt (or further corrupt) your database. For example, @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ test=# select ctid from t1 where xmin = 2;

    F.34.2. Authors

    Ashutosh Sharma -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtestfsync.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtestfsync.html index 28dca2d..fb96259 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtestfsync.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtestfsync.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_test_fsync

    pg_test_fsync

    pg_test_fsync — determine fastest wal_sync_method for PostgreSQL

    Synopsis

    pg_test_fsync [option...]

    Description

    +pg_test_fsync

    pg_test_fsync

    pg_test_fsync — determine fastest wal_sync_method for PostgreSQL

    Synopsis

    pg_test_fsync [option...]

    Description

    pg_test_fsync is intended to give you a reasonable idea of what the fastest wal_sync_method is on your specific system, @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@ color in diagnostic messages. Possible values are always, auto and never. -

    See Also

    postgres
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    postgres
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtesttiming.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtesttiming.html index 46e2442..c55b3b9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtesttiming.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtesttiming.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_test_timing

    pg_test_timing

    pg_test_timing — measure timing overhead

    Synopsis

    pg_test_timing [option...]

    Description

    +pg_test_timing

    pg_test_timing

    pg_test_timing — measure timing overhead

    Synopsis

    pg_test_timing [option...]

    Description

    pg_test_timing is a tool to measure the timing overhead on your system and confirm that the system time never moves backwards. Systems that are slow to collect timing data can give less accurate @@ -176,4 +176,4 @@ Histogram of timing durations: Timer (PIT), the real-time clock (RTC), the Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC) timer, and the Cyclone timer. These timers aim for millisecond resolution. -

    See Also

    EXPLAIN
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    EXPLAIN
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtrgm.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtrgm.html index dbdf95c..bb25cf4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtrgm.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgtrgm.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.35. pg_trgm

    F.35. pg_trgm

    +F.35. pg_trgm

    F.35. pg_trgm

    The pg_trgm module provides functions and operators for determining the similarity of alphanumeric text based on trigram matching, as @@ -421,4 +421,4 @@ CREATE INDEX words_idx ON words USING GIN (word gin_trgm_ops); Documentation: Christopher Kings-Lynne

    This module is sponsored by Delta-Soft Ltd., Moscow, Russia. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgupgrade.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgupgrade.html index 6920586..cd04b09 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgupgrade.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgupgrade.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_upgrade

    pg_upgrade

    pg_upgrade — upgrade a PostgreSQL server instance

    Synopsis

    pg_upgrade -b oldbindir [-B newbindir] -d oldconfigdir -D newconfigdir [option...]

    Description

    +pg_upgrade

    pg_upgrade

    pg_upgrade — upgrade a PostgreSQL server instance

    Synopsis

    pg_upgrade -b oldbindir [-B newbindir] -d oldconfigdir -D newconfigdir [option...]

    Description

    pg_upgrade (formerly called pg_migrator) allows data stored in PostgreSQL data files to be upgraded to a later PostgreSQL major version without the data dump/restore typically required for @@ -429,4 +429,4 @@ psql --username=postgres --file=script.sql postgres to make a backup of the old cluster and tablespaces, though the snapshot and copies must be created simultaneously or while the database server is down. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgvisibility.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgvisibility.html index 64ef650..5c353f7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgvisibility.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgvisibility.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.36. pg_visibility

    F.36. pg_visibility

    +F.36. pg_visibility

    F.36. pg_visibility

    The pg_visibility module provides a means for examining the visibility map (VM) and page-level visibility information of a table. It also provides functions to check the integrity of a visibility map and to @@ -66,4 +66,4 @@ be executed by superusers.

    F.36.2. Author

    Robert Haas -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwaldump.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwaldump.html index 9346c1b..4e6fac0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwaldump.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwaldump.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -pg_waldump

    pg_waldump

    pg_waldump — display a human-readable rendering of the write-ahead log of a PostgreSQL database cluster

    Synopsis

    pg_waldump [option...] [startseg [endseg]]

    Description

    +pg_waldump

    pg_waldump

    pg_waldump — display a human-readable rendering of the write-ahead log of a PostgreSQL database cluster

    Synopsis

    pg_waldump [option...] [startseg [endseg]]

    Description

    pg_waldump displays the write-ahead log (WAL) and is mainly useful for debugging or educational purposes.

    @@ -105,4 +105,4 @@ pg_waldump cannot read WAL files with suffix .partial. If those files need to be read, .partial suffix needs to be removed from the file name. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwalinspect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwalinspect.html index b26b30c..d5cdb38 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwalinspect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgwalinspect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.37. pg_walinspect

    F.37. pg_walinspect

    +F.37. pg_walinspect

    F.37. pg_walinspect

    The pg_walinspect module provides SQL functions that allow you to inspect the contents of write-ahead log of a running PostgreSQL database cluster at a low @@ -127,4 +127,4 @@ combined_size_percentage | 2.8634072910530795 start_lsn till end of WAL.

    F.37.2. Author

    Bharath Rupireddy -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgxlogdump.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgxlogdump.html index 1680f69..afbaa42 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pgxlogdump.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pgxlogdump.html @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ -O.3. pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump

    O.3. pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump

    +O.3. pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump

    O.3. pg_xlogdump renamed to pg_waldump

    PostgreSQL 9.6 and below provided a command named pg_xlogdump to read write-ahead-log (WAL) files. This command was renamed to pg_waldump, see pg_waldump for documentation of pg_waldump and see - the release notes for PostgreSQL 10 for details + the release notes for PostgreSQL 10 for details on this change. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-optimizer.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-optimizer.html index da8e3a1..b1980c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-optimizer.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-optimizer.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -52.5. Planner/Optimizer

    52.5. Planner/Optimizer

    +52.5. Planner/Optimizer

    52.5. Planner/Optimizer

    The task of the planner/optimizer is to create an optimal execution plan. A given SQL query (and hence, a query tree) can be actually executed in a wide variety of @@ -108,4 +108,4 @@ WHERE clause and computation of required output expressions to the most appropriate nodes of the plan tree. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-details.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-details.html index d6be293..e7b655a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-details.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-details.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 75. How the Planner Uses Statistics

    Chapter 75. How the Planner Uses Statistics

    +Chapter 75. How the Planner Uses Statistics

    Chapter 75. How the Planner Uses Statistics

    This chapter builds on the material covered in Section 14.1 and Section 14.2 to show some additional details about how the planner uses the system statistics to estimate the number of rows each part of a query might @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ but to present an overview of how it works. This will perhaps ease the learning curve for someone who subsequently wishes to read the code. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-security.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-security.html index ce79081..e1b78c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-security.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats-security.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -75.3. Planner Statistics and Security

    75.3. Planner Statistics and Security

    +75.3. Planner Statistics and Security

    75.3. Planner Statistics and Security

    Access to the table pg_statistic is restricted to superusers, so that ordinary users cannot learn about the contents of the tables of other users from it. Some selectivity estimation functions will @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ Selectivity estimation functions contained in third-party extensions that potentially operate on statistics with user-defined operators should follow the same security rules. Consult the PostgreSQL source code for guidance. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats.html index 7cff365..96eb821 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/planner-stats.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -14.2. Statistics Used by the Planner

    14.2. Statistics Used by the Planner

    14.2.1. Single-Column Statistics

    +14.2. Statistics Used by the Planner

    14.2. Statistics Used by the Planner

    14.2.1. Single-Column Statistics

    As we saw in the previous section, the query planner needs to estimate the number of rows retrieved by a query in order to make good choices of query plans. This section provides a quick look at the statistics @@ -333,4 +333,4 @@ SELECT m.* FROM pg_statistic_ext join pg_statistic_ext_data on (oid = stxoid), and for which misestimation of the number of groups is resulting in bad plans. Otherwise, the ANALYZE and planning cycles are just wasted. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plhandler.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plhandler.html index 8eaec1a..a515f58 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plhandler.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plhandler.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 58. Writing a Procedural Language Handler

    Chapter 58. Writing a Procedural Language Handler

    +Chapter 58. Writing a Procedural Language Handler

    Chapter 58. Writing a Procedural Language Handler

    All calls to functions that are written in a language other than the current version 1 interface for compiled languages (this includes functions in user-defined procedural languages @@ -153,4 +153,4 @@ Look into the src/pl subdirectory of the source tree. The CREATE LANGUAGE reference page also has some useful details. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-builtins.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-builtins.html index 5d7e60e..78a3f9a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-builtins.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-builtins.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.3. Built-in Functions

    45.3. Built-in Functions

    45.3.1. Database Access from PL/Perl

    +45.3. Built-in Functions

    45.3. Built-in Functions

    45.3.1. Database Access from PL/Perl

    Access to the database itself from your Perl function can be done via the following functions:

    @@ -357,4 +357,4 @@ CALL transaction_test1(); Returns a true value if the given argument may be treated as an array reference, that is, if ref of the argument is ARRAY or PostgreSQL::InServer::ARRAY. Returns false otherwise. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-data.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-data.html index 821eda1..2640863 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-data.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-data.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.2. Data Values in PL/Perl

    45.2. Data Values in PL/Perl

    +45.2. Data Values in PL/Perl

    45.2. Data Values in PL/Perl

    The argument values supplied to a PL/Perl function's code are simply the input arguments converted to text form (just as if they had been displayed by a SELECT statement). @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ improved by using a transform, as already illustrated for bool values. Several examples of transform modules are included in the PostgreSQL distribution. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-event-triggers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-event-triggers.html index c9abe40..0e54318 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-event-triggers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-event-triggers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.7. PL/Perl Event Triggers

    45.7. PL/Perl Event Triggers

    +45.7. PL/Perl Event Triggers

    45.7. PL/Perl Event Triggers

    PL/Perl can be used to write event trigger functions. In an event trigger function, the hash reference $_TD contains information about the current trigger event. $_TD is a global variable, @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER perl_a_snitch ON ddl_command_start EXECUTE FUNCTION perlsnitch();

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-funcs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-funcs.html index ce13b69..abd88e7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-funcs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-funcs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.1. PL/Perl Functions and Arguments

    45.1. PL/Perl Functions and Arguments

    +45.1. PL/Perl Functions and Arguments

    45.1. PL/Perl Functions and Arguments

    To create a function in the PL/Perl language, use the standard CREATE FUNCTION syntax: @@ -305,4 +305,4 @@ use strict; at the top of the function body.

    The feature pragma is also available to use if your Perl is version 5.10.0 or higher. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-global.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-global.html index da913c2..347df24 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-global.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-global.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.4. Global Values in PL/Perl

    45.4. Global Values in PL/Perl

    +45.4. Global Values in PL/Perl

    45.4. Global Values in PL/Perl

    You can use the global hash %_SHARED to store data, including code references, between function calls for the lifetime of the current session. @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plperl; functions that should communicate are owned by the same user, and mark them SECURITY DEFINER. You must of course take care that such functions can't be used to do anything unintended. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-triggers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-triggers.html index 3043a8f..10551b3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-triggers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-triggers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.6. PL/Perl Triggers

    45.6. PL/Perl Triggers

    +45.6. PL/Perl Triggers

    45.6. PL/Perl Triggers

    PL/Perl can be used to write trigger functions. In a trigger function, the hash reference $_TD contains information about the current trigger event. $_TD is a global variable, @@ -71,4 +71,4 @@ CREATE TRIGGER test_valid_id_trig BEFORE INSERT OR UPDATE ON test FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE FUNCTION valid_id();

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-trusted.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-trusted.html index 1f90526..8e584ee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-trusted.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-trusted.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.5. Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl

    45.5. Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl

    +45.5. Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl

    45.5. Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl

    Normally, PL/Perl is installed as a trusted programming language named plperl. In this setup, certain Perl operations are disabled to preserve security. In general, the @@ -69,4 +69,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plperl; session, and so any one session can only execute either PL/PerlU functions, or PL/Perl functions that are all called by the same SQL role. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-under-the-hood.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-under-the-hood.html index 0987d6b..aa4b486 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-under-the-hood.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl-under-the-hood.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -45.8. PL/Perl Under the Hood

    45.8. PL/Perl Under the Hood

    45.8.1. Configuration

    +45.8. PL/Perl Under the Hood

    45.8. PL/Perl Under the Hood

    45.8.1. Configuration

    This section lists configuration parameters that affect PL/Perl.

    plperl.on_init (string) @@ -108,4 +108,4 @@ DO 'elog(WARNING, join ", ", sort keys %INC)' LANGUAGE plperl; file handles are not automatically flushed and objects are not automatically destroyed.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl.html index 47cf14d..a381bfd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plperl.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language

    Chapter 45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language

    +Chapter 45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language

    Chapter 45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language

    PL/Perl is a loadable procedural language that enables you to write PostgreSQL functions and procedures in the Perl programming language. @@ -19,4 +19,4 @@ Users of source packages must specially enable the build of PL/Perl during the installation process. (Refer to Chapter 17 for more information.) Users of binary packages might find PL/Perl in a separate subpackage. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-control-structures.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-control-structures.html index 4fa998e..0b87663 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-control-structures.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-control-structures.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.6. Control Structures

    43.6. Control Structures

    +43.6. Control Structures

    43.6. Control Structures

    Control structures are probably the most useful (and important) part of PL/pgSQL. With PL/pgSQL's control structures, @@ -940,4 +940,4 @@ CONTEXT: PL/pgSQL function outer_func() line 3 at RETURN GET STACKED DIAGNOSTICS ... PG_EXCEPTION_CONTEXT returns the same sort of stack trace, but describing the location at which an error was detected, rather than the current location. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-cursors.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-cursors.html index 9c5dfc0..4f860cb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-cursors.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-cursors.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.7. Cursors

    43.7. Cursors

    +43.7. Cursors

    43.7. Cursors

    Rather than executing a whole query at once, it is possible to set up a cursor that encapsulates the query, and then read the query result a few rows at a time. One reason for doing this is @@ -383,4 +383,4 @@ END LOOP [ label

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-declarations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-declarations.html index 6e208cf..aa631a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-declarations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-declarations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.3. Declarations

    43.3. Declarations

    +43.3. Declarations

    43.3. Declarations

    All variables used in a block must be declared in the declarations section of the block. (The only exceptions are that the loop variable of a FOR loop @@ -461,4 +461,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; This overrides the collations associated with the table columns, parameters, or local variables used in the expression, just as would happen in a plain SQL command. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-development-tips.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-development-tips.html index afadc4e..a8eeaae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-development-tips.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-development-tips.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.12. Tips for Developing in PL/pgSQL

    43.12. Tips for Developing in PL/pgSQL

    +43.12. Tips for Developing in PL/pgSQL

    43.12. Tips for Developing in PL/pgSQL

    One good way to develop in PL/pgSQL is to use the text editor of your choice to create your functions, and in another window, use @@ -225,4 +225,4 @@ HINT: Make sure the query returns the exact list of columns. (1 row)

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-errors-and-messages.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-errors-and-messages.html index 57c7030..21b7e73 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-errors-and-messages.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-errors-and-messages.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.9. Errors and Messages

    43.9. Errors and Messages

    43.9.1. Reporting Errors and Messages

    +43.9. Errors and Messages

    43.9. Errors and Messages

    43.9.1. Reporting Errors and Messages

    Use the RAISE statement to report messages and raise errors. @@ -145,4 +145,4 @@ ASSERT condition [ASSERT is meant for detecting program bugs, not for reporting ordinary error conditions. Use the RAISE statement, described above, for that. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-expressions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-expressions.html index 6d8e274..016b70c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-expressions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-expressions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.4. Expressions

    43.4. Expressions

    +43.4. Expressions

    43.4. Expressions

    All expressions used in PL/pgSQL statements are processed using the server's main SQL executor. For example, when you write @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@ IF count(*) > 0 FROM my_table THEN ... The SELECT must produce a single column, and not more than one row. (If it produces no rows, the result is taken as NULL.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-implementation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-implementation.html index 3c7418a..fb6422f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-implementation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-implementation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.11. PL/pgSQL under the Hood

    43.11. PL/pgSQL under the Hood

    +43.11. PL/pgSQL under the Hood

    43.11. PL/pgSQL under the Hood

    This section discusses some implementation details that are frequently important for PL/pgSQL users to know.

    43.11.1. Variable Substitution

    @@ -273,4 +273,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; on each execution as the programmer expects. Even though this happens to work as expected, it's not terribly efficient, so use of the now() function would still be a better idea. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-overview.html index 80e9251..1d5d656 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-overview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.1. Overview

    43.1. Overview

    +43.1. Overview

    43.1. Overview

    PL/pgSQL is a loadable procedural language for the PostgreSQL database system. The design goals of PL/pgSQL were to create @@ -100,4 +100,4 @@ Specific examples appear in Section 43.3.1 and Section 43.6.1. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-porting.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-porting.html index f6e09ee..654b25d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-porting.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-porting.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.13. Porting from Oracle PL/SQL

    43.13. Porting from Oracle PL/SQL

    +43.13. Porting from Oracle PL/SQL

    43.13. Porting from Oracle PL/SQL

    This section explains differences between PostgreSQL's PL/pgSQL language and Oracle's PL/SQL language, @@ -557,4 +557,4 @@ BEGIN END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql STRICT IMMUTABLE; -

    \ No newline at end of file + \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-statements.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-statements.html index 39dd1e1..865a732 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-statements.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-statements.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.5. Basic Statements

    43.5. Basic Statements

    +43.5. Basic Statements

    43.5. Basic Statements

    In this section and the following ones, we describe all the statement types that are explicitly understood by PL/pgSQL. @@ -595,4 +595,4 @@ END; NULL statements are required for situations such as this. PL/pgSQL allows you to just write nothing, instead. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-structure.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-structure.html index 1a0fefb..03c20cb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-structure.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-structure.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.2. Structure of PL/pgSQL

    43.2. Structure of PL/pgSQL

    +43.2. Structure of PL/pgSQL

    43.2. Structure of PL/pgSQL

    Functions written in PL/pgSQL are defined to the server by executing CREATE FUNCTION commands. Such a command would normally look like, say, @@ -105,4 +105,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; Also, a block containing an EXCEPTION clause effectively forms a subtransaction that can be rolled back without affecting the outer transaction. For more about that see Section 43.6.8. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-transactions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-transactions.html index 33d3281..54e4d48 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-transactions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-transactions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.8. Transaction Management

    43.8. Transaction Management

    +43.8. Transaction Management

    43.8. Transaction Management

    In procedures invoked by the CALL command as well as in anonymous code blocks (DO command), it is possible to end transactions using the @@ -79,4 +79,4 @@ CALL transaction_test2(); ... RETURNING).

    A transaction cannot be ended inside a block with exception handlers. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-trigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-trigger.html index 6a07fc1..57ef72c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-trigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql-trigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -43.10. Trigger Functions

    43.10. Trigger Functions

    +43.10. Trigger Functions

    43.10. Trigger Functions

    PL/pgSQL can be used to define trigger functions on data changes or database events. A trigger function is created with the CREATE FUNCTION @@ -513,4 +513,4 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; CREATE EVENT TRIGGER snitch ON ddl_command_start EXECUTE FUNCTION snitch(); -


    \ No newline at end of file +
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql.html index 9372249..26b128d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpgsql.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 43. PL/pgSQL — SQL Procedural Language

    Chapter 43. PL/pgSQLSQL Procedural Language

    \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 43. PL/pgSQL — SQL Procedural Language

    Chapter 43. PL/pgSQLSQL Procedural Language

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-data.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-data.html index 5e31573..260a058 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-data.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-data.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.2. Data Values

    46.2. Data Values

    +46.2. Data Values

    46.2. Data Values

    Generally speaking, the aim of PL/Python is to provide a natural mapping between the PostgreSQL and the Python worlds. This informs the data mapping rules described @@ -340,4 +340,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpython3u; SELECT * FROM multiout_simple_setof(3);

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-database.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-database.html index baa9dbf..8e59065 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-database.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-database.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.6. Database Access

    46.6. Database Access

    +46.6. Database Access

    46.6. Database Access

    The PL/Python language module automatically imports a Python module called plpy. The functions and constants in this module are available to you in the Python code as @@ -235,4 +235,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpython3u; the exception object. This attribute is a string value containing the SQLSTATE error code. This approach provides approximately the same functionality -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-do.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-do.html index dc8b4ae..9a639ef 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-do.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-do.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.4. Anonymous Code Blocks

    46.4. Anonymous Code Blocks

    +46.4. Anonymous Code Blocks

    46.4. Anonymous Code Blocks

    PL/Python also supports anonymous code blocks called with the DO statement: @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpython3u; An anonymous code block receives no arguments, and whatever value it might return is discarded. Otherwise it behaves just like a function. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-envar.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-envar.html index fb5385c..88cdd59 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-envar.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-envar.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.11. Environment Variables

    46.11. Environment Variables

    +46.11. Environment Variables

    46.11. Environment Variables

    Some of the environment variables that are accepted by the Python interpreter can also be used to affect PL/Python behavior. They would need to be set in the environment of the main PostgreSQL @@ -14,4 +14,4 @@ of PL/Python that some of the environment variables listed on the python man page are only effective in a command-line interpreter and not an embedded Python interpreter.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-funcs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-funcs.html index 16fe9c3..642afea 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-funcs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-funcs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.1. PL/Python Functions

    46.1. PL/Python Functions

    +46.1. PL/Python Functions

    46.1. PL/Python Functions

    Functions in PL/Python are declared via the standard CREATE FUNCTION syntax: @@ -85,4 +85,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpython3u; But it is advisable not to rely on this implementation detail of PL/Python. It is better to treat the function parameters as read-only. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-python23.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-python23.html index 9c9a970..f49a070 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-python23.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-python23.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -46.10. Python 2 vs. Python 3

    46.10. Python 2 vs. Python 3

    +46.10. Python 2 vs. Python 3

    46.10. Python 2 vs. Python 3

    PL/Python supports only Python 3. Past versions of PostgreSQL supported Python 2, using the plpythonu and plpython2u language names. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-sharing.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-sharing.html index f3841a5..070ace4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-sharing.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-sharing.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.3. Sharing Data

    46.3. Sharing Data

    +46.3. Sharing Data

    46.3. Sharing Data

    The global dictionary SD is available to store private data between repeated calls to the same function. The global dictionary GD is public data, @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ myfunc are not available to myfunc2. The exception is the data in the GD dictionary, as mentioned above. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-subtransaction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-subtransaction.html index 5481342..73ee1fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-subtransaction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-subtransaction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.7. Explicit Subtransactions

    46.7. Explicit Subtransactions

    +46.7. Explicit Subtransactions

    46.7. Explicit Subtransactions

    Recovering from errors caused by database access as described in Section 46.6.2 can lead to an undesirable situation where some operations succeed before one of them fails, @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ plan = plpy.prepare("INSERT INTO operations (result) VALUES ($1)", ["text"]) plpy.execute(plan, [result]) $$ LANGUAGE plpython3u;

    - Note that the use of try/catch is still + Note that the use of try/except is still required. Otherwise the exception would propagate to the top of the Python stack and would cause the whole function to abort with a PostgreSQL error, so that the @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE plpython3u; database access. A regular Python exception raised inside an explicit subtransaction block would also cause the subtransaction to be rolled back. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-transactions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-transactions.html index df37548..c24f5e7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-transactions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-transactions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.8. Transaction Management

    46.8. Transaction Management

    +46.8. Transaction Management

    46.8. Transaction Management

    In a procedure called from the top level or an anonymous code block (DO command) called from the top level it is possible to control transactions. To commit the current transaction, call @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ CALL transaction_test1();

    Transactions cannot be ended when an explicit subtransaction is active. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-trigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-trigger.html index a291a9e..45df466 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-trigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-trigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.5. Trigger Functions

    46.5. Trigger Functions

    +46.5. Trigger Functions

    46.5. Trigger Functions

    When a function is used as a trigger, the dictionary TD contains trigger-related values:

    TD["event"]

    @@ -37,4 +37,4 @@ is INSERT or UPDATE you can return "MODIFY" to indicate you've modified the new row. Otherwise the return value is ignored. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-util.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-util.html index 0e3bc21..e76294e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-util.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython-util.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -46.9. Utility Functions

    46.9. Utility Functions

    +46.9. Utility Functions

    46.9. Utility Functions

    The plpy module also provides the functions

    plpy.debug(msg, **kwargs)
    plpy.log(msg, **kwargs)
    plpy.info(msg, **kwargs)
    plpy.notice(msg, **kwargs)
    plpy.warning(msg, **kwargs)
    plpy.error(msg, **kwargs)
    plpy.fatal(msg, **kwargs)

    @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@ plpy.execute("UPDATE tbl SET %s = %s WHERE key = %s" % ( plpy.quote_nullable(newvalue), plpy.quote_literal(keyvalue)))

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython.html index be8fc63..0df2f7a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/plpython.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language

    Chapter 46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language

    +Chapter 46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language

    Chapter 46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language

    The PL/Python procedural language allows PostgreSQL functions and procedures to be written in the Python language. @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ PL/Python during the installation process. (Refer to the installation instructions for more information.) Users of binary packages might find PL/Python in a separate subpackage. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-config.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-config.html index 656f505..4293585 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-config.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-config.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.11. PL/Tcl Configuration

    44.11. PL/Tcl Configuration

    +44.11. PL/Tcl Configuration

    44.11. PL/Tcl Configuration

    This section lists configuration parameters that affect PL/Tcl.

    @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ This parameter is exactly like pltcl.start_proc, except that it applies to PL/TclU. The referenced function must be written in the pltclu language. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-data.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-data.html index e6409bf..57e3f71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-data.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-data.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -44.3. Data Values in PL/Tcl

    44.3. Data Values in PL/Tcl

    +44.3. Data Values in PL/Tcl

    44.3. Data Values in PL/Tcl

    The argument values supplied to a PL/Tcl function's code are simply the input arguments converted to text form (just as if they had been displayed by a SELECT statement). Conversely, the return and return_next commands will accept any string that is acceptable input format for the function's declared result type, or for the specified column of a composite result type. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-dbaccess.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-dbaccess.html index 025d849..a230750 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-dbaccess.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-dbaccess.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.5. Database Access from PL/Tcl

    44.5. Database Access from PL/Tcl

    +44.5. Database Access from PL/Tcl

    44.5. Database Access from PL/Tcl

    In this section, we follow the usual Tcl convention of using question marks, rather than brackets, to indicate an optional element in a syntax synopsis. The following commands are available to access @@ -190,4 +190,4 @@ SELECT 'doesn''t' AS ret and Section 44.8 for more information.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-error-handling.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-error-handling.html index 1076c2c..13809cd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-error-handling.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-error-handling.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.8. Error Handling in PL/Tcl

    44.8. Error Handling in PL/Tcl

    +44.8. Error Handling in PL/Tcl

    44.8. Error Handling in PL/Tcl

    Tcl code within or called from a PL/Tcl function can raise an error, either by executing some invalid operation or by generating an error using the Tcl error command or @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@ if {[catch { spi_exec $sql_command }]} {

    (The double colons explicitly specify that errorCode is a global variable.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-event-trigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-event-trigger.html index e821c66..1af7928 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-event-trigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-event-trigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.7. Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    44.7. Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    +44.7. Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    44.7. Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    Event trigger functions can be written in PL/Tcl. PostgreSQL requires that a function that is to be called as an event trigger must be declared as a function with no @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE pltcl; CREATE EVENT TRIGGER tcl_a_snitch ON ddl_command_start EXECUTE FUNCTION tclsnitch();

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-functions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-functions.html index 6e78564..161f883 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-functions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-functions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.2. PL/Tcl Functions and Arguments

    44.2. PL/Tcl Functions and Arguments

    +44.2. PL/Tcl Functions and Arguments

    44.2. PL/Tcl Functions and Arguments

    To create a function in the PL/Tcl language, use the standard CREATE FUNCTION syntax: @@ -138,4 +138,4 @@ CREATE FUNCTION table_of_squares(int, int) RETURNS TABLE (x int, x2 int) AS $$ } $$ LANGUAGE pltcl;

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-global.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-global.html index 8a08a31..9664105 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-global.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-global.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.4. Global Data in PL/Tcl

    44.4. Global Data in PL/Tcl

    +44.4. Global Data in PL/Tcl

    44.4. Global Data in PL/Tcl

    Sometimes it is useful to have some global data that is held between two calls to a function or is shared between different functions. @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@

    An example of using GD appears in the spi_execp example below. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-overview.html index 0815851..74254fe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-overview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.1. Overview

    44.1. Overview

    +44.1. Overview

    44.1. Overview

    PL/Tcl offers most of the capabilities a function writer has in the C language, with a few restrictions, and with the addition of the powerful string processing libraries that are available for @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ CREATE EXTENSION command, for example CREATE EXTENSION pltcl or CREATE EXTENSION pltclu. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-procnames.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-procnames.html index c39d052..75549b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-procnames.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-procnames.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.12. Tcl Procedure Names

    44.12. Tcl Procedure Names

    +44.12. Tcl Procedure Names

    44.12. Tcl Procedure Names

    In PostgreSQL, the same function name can be used for different function definitions as long as the number of arguments or their types differ. Tcl, however, requires all procedure names to be distinct. @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ and different argument types will be different Tcl procedures, too. This is not normally a concern for a PL/Tcl programmer, but it might be visible when debugging. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-subtransactions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-subtransactions.html index f2b9db1..14a487d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-subtransactions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-subtransactions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.9. Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl

    44.9. Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl

    +44.9. Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl

    44.9. Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl

    Recovering from errors caused by database access as described in Section 44.8 can lead to an undesirable situation where some operations succeed before one of them fails, @@ -64,4 +64,4 @@ $$ LANGUAGE pltcl; subtransaction to be rolled back. However, non-error exits out of the contained Tcl code (for instance, due to return) do not cause a rollback. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-transactions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-transactions.html index 7be56f6..b3ce64f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-transactions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-transactions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.10. Transaction Management

    44.10. Transaction Management

    +44.10. Transaction Management

    44.10. Transaction Management

    In a procedure called from the top level or an anonymous code block (DO command) called from the top level it is possible to control transactions. To commit the current transaction, call the @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@ CALL transaction_test1();

    Transactions cannot be ended when an explicit subtransaction is active. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-trigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-trigger.html index 2845a81..a6b9c89 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-trigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl-trigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -44.6. Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    44.6. Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    +44.6. Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    44.6. Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl

    Trigger functions can be written in PL/Tcl. PostgreSQL requires that a function that is to be called as a trigger must be declared as a function with no arguments @@ -112,4 +112,4 @@ CREATE TRIGGER trig_mytab_modcount BEFORE INSERT OR UPDATE ON mytab Notice that the trigger function itself does not know the column name; that's supplied from the trigger arguments. This lets the trigger function be reused with different tables. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl.html index 53af887..5ae1c7d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/pltcl.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -Chapter 44. PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/populate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/populate.html index 35c379d..696d7ec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/populate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/populate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -14.4. Populating a Database

    14.4. Populating a Database

    +14.4. Populating a Database

    14.4. Populating a Database

    One might need to insert a large amount of data when first populating a database. This section contains some suggestions on how to make this process as efficient as possible. @@ -203,4 +203,4 @@ the --disable-triggers option — but realize that that eliminates, rather than just postpones, foreign key validation, and so it is possible to insert bad data if you use it. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-fdw.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-fdw.html index 7f7b197..6d9adee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-fdw.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-fdw.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.38. postgres_fdw

    F.38. postgres_fdw

    +F.38. postgres_fdw

    F.38. postgres_fdw

    The postgres_fdw module provides the foreign-data wrapper postgres_fdw, which can be used to access data stored in external PostgreSQL servers. @@ -674,4 +674,4 @@ CREATE FOREIGN TABLE foreign_table ( preferable to constructing foreign table definitions manually.

    F.38.10. Author

    Shigeru Hanada -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-user.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-user.html index c2e1ec4..8bcbc54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-user.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/postgres-user.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.1. The PostgreSQL User Account

    19.1. The PostgreSQL User Account

    +19.1. The PostgreSQL User Account

    19.1. The PostgreSQL User Account

    As with any server daemon that is accessible to the outside world, it is advisable to run PostgreSQL under a separate user account. This user account should only own the data @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ useradd or adduser. The user name postgres is often used, and is assumed throughout this book, but you can use another name if you like. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/predefined-roles.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/predefined-roles.html index bb525bc..4de7f62 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/predefined-roles.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/predefined-roles.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -22.5. Predefined Roles

    22.5. Predefined Roles

    +22.5. Predefined Roles

    22.5. Predefined Roles

    PostgreSQL provides a set of predefined roles that provide access to certain, commonly needed, privileged capabilities and information. Administrators (including roles that have the @@ -76,4 +76,4 @@

     GRANT pg_signal_backend TO admin_user;
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/preface.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/preface.html index 1c0da57..358a369 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/preface.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/preface.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Preface \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/preventing-server-spoofing.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/preventing-server-spoofing.html index 87dd039..029b07b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/preventing-server-spoofing.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/preventing-server-spoofing.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.7. Preventing Server Spoofing

    19.7. Preventing Server Spoofing

    +19.7. Preventing Server Spoofing

    19.7. Preventing Server Spoofing

    While the server is running, it is not possible for a malicious user to take the place of the normal database server. However, when the server is down, it is possible for a local user to spoof the normal @@ -41,4 +41,4 @@ (Section 21.1) and use gss authentication with them. The TCP client must connect using gssencmode=require. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/progress-reporting.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/progress-reporting.html index 7a88820..aeca080 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/progress-reporting.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/progress-reporting.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -28.4. Progress Reporting

    28.4. Progress Reporting

    +28.4. Progress Reporting

    28.4. Progress Reporting

    PostgreSQL has the ability to report the progress of certain commands during command execution. Currently, the only commands which support progress reporting are ANALYZE, @@ -648,4 +648,4 @@

    Number of tuples not processed because they were excluded by the WHERE clause of the COPY command. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-changes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-changes.html index ce309d1..4f2c09d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-changes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-changes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.10. Summary of Changes since Protocol 2.0

    55.10. Summary of Changes since Protocol 2.0

    +55.10. Summary of Changes since Protocol 2.0

    55.10. Summary of Changes since Protocol 2.0

    This section provides a quick checklist of changes, for the benefit of developers trying to update existing client libraries to protocol 3.0.

    @@ -70,4 +70,4 @@

    The EmptyQueryResponse ('I') message used to include an empty string parameter; this has been removed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-error-fields.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-error-fields.html index ed9df3c..eee8be8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-error-fields.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-error-fields.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.8. Error and Notice Message Fields

    55.8. Error and Notice Message Fields

    +55.8. Error and Notice Message Fields

    55.8. Error and Notice Message Fields

    This section describes the fields that can appear in ErrorResponse and NoticeResponse messages. Each field type has a single-byte identification token. Note that any given field type should appear at most once per @@ -96,4 +96,4 @@ needs; in particular it should break long lines as needed. Newline characters appearing in the error message fields should be treated as paragraph breaks, not line breaks. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-flow.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-flow.html index ce94fe3..b6b82dd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-flow.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-flow.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.2. Message Flow

    55.2. Message Flow

    +55.2. Message Flow

    55.2. Message Flow

    This section describes the message flow and the semantics of each message type. (Details of the exact representation of each message appear in Section 55.7.) There are @@ -972,4 +972,4 @@ SELCT 1/0; force GSSAPI encryption, the administrator can configure the server to reject unencrypted sessions as a byproduct of authentication checking. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logical-replication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logical-replication.html index e8619da..21017f4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logical-replication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logical-replication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.5. Logical Streaming Replication Protocol

    55.5. Logical Streaming Replication Protocol

    +55.5. Logical Streaming Replication Protocol

    55.5. Logical Streaming Replication Protocol

    This section describes the logical replication protocol, which is the message flow started by the START_REPLICATION SLOT slot_name @@ -7,15 +7,19 @@

    The logical streaming replication protocol builds on the primitives of the physical streaming replication protocol. +

    + PostgreSQL logical decoding supports output + plugins. pgoutput is the standard one used for + the built-in logical replication.

    55.5.1. Logical Streaming Replication Parameters

    - The logical replication START_REPLICATION command - accepts following parameters: + Using the START_REPLICATION command, + pgoutput accepts the following options:

    proto_version

    Protocol version. Currently versions 1, 2, - and 3 are supported. + and 3 are supported. A valid version is required.

    Version 2 is supported only for server version 14 and above, and it allows streaming of large in-progress transactions. @@ -28,6 +32,27 @@ Comma separated list of publication names for which to subscribe (receive changes). The individual publication names are treated as standard objects names and can be quoted the same as needed. + At least one publication name is required. +

    + binary +

    + Boolean option to use binary transfer mode. Binary mode is faster + than the text mode but slightly less robust. +

    + messages +

    + Boolean option to enable sending the messages that are written + by pg_logical_emit_message. +

    + streaming +

    + Boolean option to enable streaming of in-progress transactions. + Minimum protocol version 2 is required to turn it on. +

    + two_phase +

    + Boolean option to enable two-phase transactions. Minimum protocol + version 3 is required to turn it on.

    55.5.2. Logical Replication Protocol Messages

    @@ -81,4 +106,4 @@ cache the contents of Type messages, and first consult that cache to see if the type OID is defined there. If not, look up the type OID locally. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logicalrep-message-formats.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logicalrep-message-formats.html index 570ef9c..4ab5d53 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logicalrep-message-formats.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-logicalrep-message-formats.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.9. Logical Replication Message Formats

    55.9. Logical Replication Message Formats

    +55.9. Logical Replication Message Formats

    55.9. Logical Replication Message Formats

    This section describes the detailed format of each logical replication message. These messages are either returned by the replication slot SQL interface or are sent by a walsender. In the case of a walsender, they are @@ -304,4 +304,4 @@ (As specified in the preceding format byte). n is the above length.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-formats.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-formats.html index 6c01814..ae4519c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-formats.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-formats.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.7. Message Formats

    55.7. Message Formats

    +55.7. Message Formats

    55.7. Message Formats

    This section describes the detailed format of each message. Each is marked to indicate that it can be sent by a frontend (F), a backend (B), or both (F & B). @@ -673,4 +673,4 @@ Identifies the message as a termination.

    Int32(4)

    Length of message contents in bytes, including self. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-types.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-types.html index 66da871..9210844 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-types.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-message-types.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.6. Message Data Types

    55.6. Message Data Types

    +55.6. Message Data Types

    55.6. Message Data Types

    This section describes the base data types used in messages.

    Intn(i)

    An n-bit integer in network byte @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ always determinable from an earlier field in the message. If c is specified it is the exact value. Eg. Byte2, Byte1('\n'). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-overview.html index 4c35fc3..e3d1de9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-overview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.1. Overview

    55.1. Overview

    +55.1. Overview

    55.1. Overview

    The protocol has separate phases for startup and normal operation. In the startup phase, the frontend opens a connection to the server and authenticates itself to the satisfaction of the server. (This might @@ -109,4 +109,4 @@ or source code to learn about the binary representation. Keep in mind that binary representations for complex data types might change across server versions; the text format is usually the more portable choice. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-replication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-replication.html index 6d4dfd4..0e842d4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-replication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol-replication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.4. Streaming Replication Protocol

    55.4. Streaming Replication Protocol

    +55.4. Streaming Replication Protocol

    55.4. Streaming Replication Protocol

    To initiate streaming replication, the frontend sends the replication parameter in the startup message. A Boolean value of true (or on, @@ -292,7 +292,10 @@ psql "dbname=postgres replication=database" -c "IDENTIFY_SYSTEM;"

    XXX/XXX

    The WAL location to begin streaming at.

    option_name

    - The name of an option passed to the slot's logical decoding plugin. + The name of an option passed to the slot's logical decoding output + plugin. See Section 55.5 for + options that are accepted by the standard (pgoutput) + plugin.

    option_value

    Optional value, in the form of a string constant, associated with the specified option. @@ -526,4 +529,4 @@ psql "dbname=postgres replication=database" -c "IDENTIFY_SYSTEM;" Owner, group, and file mode are set if the underlying file system on the server supports it.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol.html index 0dd9eb4..125e754 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/protocol.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 55. Frontend/Backend Protocol

    Chapter 55. Frontend/Backend Protocol

    +Chapter 55. Frontend/Backend Protocol

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-limit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-limit.html index d2880bd..e781004 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-limit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-limit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.6. LIMIT and OFFSET

    7.6. LIMIT and OFFSET

    +7.6. LIMIT and OFFSET

    7.6. LIMIT and OFFSET

    LIMIT and OFFSET allow you to retrieve just a portion of the rows that are generated by the rest of the query:

    @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ SELECT select_list
        The rows skipped by an OFFSET clause still have to be
        computed inside the server; therefore a large OFFSET
        might be inefficient.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-order.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-order.html index 8823e99..fedd6bd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-order.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-order.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.5. Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)

    7.5. Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)

    +7.5. Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)

    7.5. Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)

    After a query has produced an output table (after the select list has been processed) it can optionally be sorted. If sorting is not chosen, the rows will be returned in an unspecified order. The actual @@ -73,4 +73,4 @@ SELECT a + b AS sum, c FROM table1 ORDER BY sum + c; -- wrong > operators correspond to this sort ordering, but a user-defined data type's designer could choose to do something different. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-overview.html index e52ccd0..779fada 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-overview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.1. Overview

    7.1. Overview

    +7.1. Overview

    7.1. Overview

    The process of retrieving or the command to retrieve data from a database is called a query. In SQL the SELECT command is @@ -50,4 +50,4 @@ SELECT 3 * 4;

     SELECT random();
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-select-lists.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-select-lists.html index f3ece84..83cca56 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-select-lists.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-select-lists.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.3. Select Lists

    7.3. Select Lists

    +7.3. Select Lists

    7.3. Select Lists

    As shown in the previous section, the table expression in the SELECT command constructs an intermediate virtual table by possibly combining @@ -119,4 +119,4 @@ SELECT DISTINCT ON (expression [GROUP BY and subqueries in FROM, this construct can be avoided, but it is often the most convenient alternative. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-table-expressions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-table-expressions.html index 7ef400f..fc501ee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-table-expressions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-table-expressions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.2. Table Expressions

    7.2. Table Expressions

    +7.2. Table Expressions

    7.2. Table Expressions

    A table expression computes a table. The table expression contains a FROM clause that is optionally followed by WHERE, GROUP BY, and @@ -1027,4 +1027,4 @@ GROUP BY GROUPING SETS ( It is not recommended to rely on this, however. Use an explicit top-level ORDER BY clause if you want to be sure the results are sorted in a particular way. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-union.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-union.html index 24f26ba..6ee40d0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-union.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-union.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.4. Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)

    7.4. Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)

    +7.4. Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)

    7.4. Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)

    The results of two queries can be combined using the set operations union, intersection, and difference. The syntax is

    @@ -73,4 +73,4 @@ SELECT a FROM b UNION SELECT x FROM y LIMIT 10
     

     SELECT a FROM b UNION (SELECT x FROM y LIMIT 10)
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-values.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-values.html index fc90277..a2dbf0e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-values.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-values.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.7. VALUES Lists

    7.7. VALUES Lists

    +7.7. VALUES Lists

    7.7. VALUES Lists

    VALUES provides a way to generate a constant table that can be used in a query without having to actually create and populate a table on-disk. The syntax is @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@ SELECT select_list FROM VALUES. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-with.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-with.html index 799b40d..b7990c6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-with.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries-with.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -7.8. WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions)

    7.8. WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions)

    +7.8. WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions)

    7.8. WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions)

    WITH provides a way to write auxiliary statements for use in a larger query. These statements, which are often referred to as Common Table Expressions or CTEs, can be thought of as defining @@ -561,4 +561,4 @@ SELECT * FROM t; At present, any table used as the target of a data-modifying statement in WITH must not have a conditional rule, nor an ALSO rule, nor an INSTEAD rule that expands to multiple statements. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries.html index efc5136..2b1145c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/queries.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/queries.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ -Chapter 7. Queries

    Chapter 7. Queries

    +Chapter 7. Queries

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/query-path.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/query-path.html index e8efce7..2fc5d23 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/query-path.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/query-path.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -52.1. The Path of a Query

    52.1. The Path of a Query

    +52.1. The Path of a Query

    52.1. The Path of a Query

    Here we give a short overview of the stages a query has to pass to obtain a result.

    1. @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@ In the following sections we will cover each of the above listed items in more detail to give a better understanding of PostgreSQL's internal control and data structures. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/querytree.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/querytree.html index 4f51320..892622f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/querytree.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/querytree.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -41.1. The Query Tree

    41.1. The Query Tree

    +41.1. The Query Tree

    41.1. The Query Tree

    To understand how the rule system works it is necessary to know when it is invoked and what its input and results are.

    @@ -149,4 +149,4 @@ doesn't have much to do with the fundamentals of the rule system.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rangetypes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rangetypes.html index 0ad4a55..12ee0e7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rangetypes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rangetypes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.17. Range Types \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/recovery-config.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/recovery-config.html index 4f3c4d6..1d4bcc1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/recovery-config.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/recovery-config.html @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ -O.1. recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf

    O.1. recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf

    +O.1. recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf

    O.1. recovery.conf file merged into postgresql.conf

    PostgreSQL 11 and below used a configuration file named recovery.conf to manage replicas and standbys. Support for this file was removed in PostgreSQL 12. See - the release notes for PostgreSQL 12 for details + the release notes for PostgreSQL 12 for details on this change.

    On PostgreSQL 12 and above, @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ setting has been removed. A standby.signal file in the data directory is used instead. See Standby Server Operation for details. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-client.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-client.html index 56bd649..e5b8e20 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-client.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-client.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -PostgreSQL Client Applications

    PostgreSQL Client Applications


    +PostgreSQL Client Applications

    PostgreSQL Client Applications


    This part contains reference information for PostgreSQL client applications and utilities. Not all of these commands are of general utility; some @@ -21,4 +21,4 @@

    pg_verifybackup — verify the integrity of a base backup of a PostgreSQL cluster
    psqlPostgreSQL interactive terminal -
    reindexdb — reindex a PostgreSQL database
    vacuumdb — garbage-collect and analyze a PostgreSQL database
    \ No newline at end of file +
    reindexdb — reindex a PostgreSQL database
    vacuumdb — garbage-collect and analyze a PostgreSQL database
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-server.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-server.html index 8f556e3..9d2dab9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-server.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/reference-server.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -PostgreSQL Server Applications

    PostgreSQL Server Applications


    +PostgreSQL Server Applications

    PostgreSQL Server Applications


    This part contains reference information for PostgreSQL server applications and support utilities. These commands can only be run usefully on the host where the database server resides. Other utility programs are listed in PostgreSQL Client Applications. -

    Table of Contents

    initdb — create a new PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_archivecleanup — clean up PostgreSQL WAL archive files
    pg_checksums — enable, disable or check data checksums in a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_controldata — display control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_ctl — initialize, start, stop, or control a PostgreSQL server
    pg_resetwal — reset the write-ahead log and other control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_rewind — synchronize a PostgreSQL data directory with another data directory that was forked from it
    pg_test_fsync — determine fastest wal_sync_method for PostgreSQL
    pg_test_timing — measure timing overhead
    pg_upgrade — upgrade a PostgreSQL server instance
    pg_waldump — display a human-readable rendering of the write-ahead log of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    postgresPostgreSQL database server
    postmasterPostgreSQL database server
    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table of Contents

    initdb — create a new PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_archivecleanup — clean up PostgreSQL WAL archive files
    pg_checksums — enable, disable or check data checksums in a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_controldata — display control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_ctl — initialize, start, stop, or control a PostgreSQL server
    pg_resetwal — reset the write-ahead log and other control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_rewind — synchronize a PostgreSQL data directory with another data directory that was forked from it
    pg_test_fsync — determine fastest wal_sync_method for PostgreSQL
    pg_test_timing — measure timing overhead
    pg_upgrade — upgrade a PostgreSQL server instance
    pg_waldump — display a human-readable rendering of the write-ahead log of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    postgresPostgreSQL database server
    postmasterPostgreSQL database server
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/reference.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/reference.html index f24d745..3864ecd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/reference.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/reference.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Part VI. Reference

    Part VI. Reference

    +Part VI. Reference

    Part VI. Reference

    The entries in this Reference are meant to provide in reasonable length an authoritative, complete, and formal summary about their respective subjects. More information about the use of @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@

    pg_verifybackup — verify the integrity of a base backup of a PostgreSQL cluster
    psqlPostgreSQL interactive terminal -
    reindexdb — reindex a PostgreSQL database
    vacuumdb — garbage-collect and analyze a PostgreSQL database
    III. PostgreSQL Server Applications
    initdb — create a new PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_archivecleanup — clean up PostgreSQL WAL archive files
    pg_checksums — enable, disable or check data checksums in a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_controldata — display control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_ctl — initialize, start, stop, or control a PostgreSQL server
    pg_resetwal — reset the write-ahead log and other control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_rewind — synchronize a PostgreSQL data directory with another data directory that was forked from it
    pg_test_fsync — determine fastest wal_sync_method for PostgreSQL
    pg_test_timing — measure timing overhead
    pg_upgrade — upgrade a PostgreSQL server instance
    pg_waldump — display a human-readable rendering of the write-ahead log of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    postgresPostgreSQL database server
    postmasterPostgreSQL database server
    \ No newline at end of file +
    reindexdb — reindex a PostgreSQL database
    vacuumdb — garbage-collect and analyze a PostgreSQL database
    III. PostgreSQL Server Applications
    initdb — create a new PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_archivecleanup — clean up PostgreSQL WAL archive files
    pg_checksums — enable, disable or check data checksums in a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_controldata — display control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_ctl — initialize, start, stop, or control a PostgreSQL server
    pg_resetwal — reset the write-ahead log and other control information of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    pg_rewind — synchronize a PostgreSQL data directory with another data directory that was forked from it
    pg_test_fsync — determine fastest wal_sync_method for PostgreSQL
    pg_test_timing — measure timing overhead
    pg_upgrade — upgrade a PostgreSQL server instance
    pg_waldump — display a human-readable rendering of the write-ahead log of a PostgreSQL database cluster
    postgresPostgreSQL database server
    postmasterPostgreSQL database server
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-coverage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-coverage.html index c89f070..b95d458 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-coverage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-coverage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -33.5. Test Coverage Examination

    33.5. Test Coverage Examination

    +33.5. Test Coverage Examination

    33.5. Test Coverage Examination

    The PostgreSQL source code can be compiled with coverage testing instrumentation, so that it becomes possible to examine which parts of the code are covered by the regression tests or any other @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ make coverage-clean report for only a portion of the code tree.

    Use make distclean to clean up when done. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-evaluation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-evaluation.html index 13fc3df..638dc55 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-evaluation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-evaluation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -33.2. Test Evaluation

    33.2. Test Evaluation

    +33.2. Test Evaluation

    33.2. Test Evaluation

    Some properly installed and fully functional PostgreSQL installations can fail some of these regression tests due to @@ -163,4 +163,4 @@ diff results/random.out expected/random.out parameters such as enable_seqscan or enable_indexscan could cause plan changes that would affect the results of tests that use EXPLAIN. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-run.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-run.html index 44543f3..aee3c68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-run.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-run.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -33.1. Running the Tests

    33.1. Running the Tests

    +33.1. Running the Tests

    33.1. Running the Tests

    The regression tests can be run against an already installed and running server, or using a temporary installation within the build tree. Furthermore, there is a parallel and a @@ -255,4 +255,4 @@ make check EXTRA_REGRESS_OPTS="--temp-config=test_postgresql.conf"

     make check EXTRA_TESTS=numeric_big
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-tap.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-tap.html index 4640c5f..198c1c4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-tap.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-tap.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -33.4. TAP Tests

    33.4. TAP Tests

    +33.4. TAP Tests

    33.4. TAP Tests

    Various tests, particularly the client program tests under src/bin, use the Perl TAP tools and are run using the Perl testing program prove. You can pass @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ make check PROVE_TESTS='t/001_test1.pl t/003_test3.pl' subdirectories contain both traditional-style and TAP-style tests, meaning that make installcheck will produce a mix of results from temporary servers and the already-running test server. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-variant.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-variant.html index 6326d82..7c20e67 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-variant.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress-variant.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -33.3. Variant Comparison Files

    33.3. Variant Comparison Files

    +33.3. Variant Comparison Files

    33.3. Variant Comparison Files

    Since some of the tests inherently produce environment-dependent results, we have provided ways to specify alternate expected result files. Each regression test can have several comparison files @@ -74,4 +74,4 @@ float4:out:hppa.*-hp-hpux10.*=float4-misrounded-input.out the variant that seems to work best. Therefore it is safest to use this mechanism only for variant results that you are willing to consider equally valid in all contexts. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress.html index 46292d6..285046c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/regress.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/regress.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -Chapter 33. Regression Tests

    Chapter 33. Regression Tests

    +Chapter 33. Regression Tests

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-1.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-1.html index 48c6ab2..0d0fedd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-1.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-1.html @@ -1,14 +1,14 @@ -E.5. Release 15.1

    E.5. Release 15.1

    Release date: 2022-11-10

    +E.6. Release 15.1

    E.6. Release 15.1

    Release date: 2022-11-10

    This release contains a variety of fixes from 15.0. For information about new features in major release 15, see - Section E.6. -

    E.5.1. Migration to Version 15.1

    + Section E.7. +

    E.6.1. Migration to Version 15.1

    A dump/restore is not required for those running 15.X.

    However, if you regularly create and drop tables exceeding 1GB, see the first changelog entry below. -

    E.5.2. Changes

    • +

    E.6.2. Changes

    • Fix failure to remove non-first segments of large tables (Tom Lane)

      @@ -221,4 +221,4 @@ tzdb's backwards-compatibility options (see their PACKRATDATA and PACKRATLIST options). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-2.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-2.html index 4d61e7e..440ddaf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-2.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-2.html @@ -1,14 +1,14 @@ -E.4. Release 15.2

    E.4. Release 15.2

    Release date: 2023-02-09

    +E.5. Release 15.2

    E.5. Release 15.2

    Release date: 2023-02-09

    This release contains a variety of fixes from 15.1. For information about new features in major release 15, see - Section E.6. -

    E.4.1. Migration to Version 15.2

    + Section E.7. +

    E.5.1. Migration to Version 15.2

    A dump/restore is not required for those running 15.X.

    However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 15.1, - see Section E.5. -

    E.4.2. Changes

    E.5.2. Changes

    • libpq can leak memory contents after GSSAPI transport encryption initiation fails (Jacob Champion)

      @@ -430,4 +430,4 @@

      Notably, a new timezone America/Ciudad_Juarez has been split off from America/Ojinaga. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-3.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-3.html index ee11279..3b7747b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-3.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-3.html @@ -1,14 +1,14 @@ -E.3. Release 15.3

    E.3. Release 15.3

    Release date: 2023-05-11

    +E.4. Release 15.3

    E.4. Release 15.3

    Release date: 2023-05-11

    This release contains a variety of fixes from 15.2. For information about new features in major release 15, see - Section E.6. -

    E.3.1. Migration to Version 15.3

    + Section E.7. +

    E.4.1. Migration to Version 15.3

    A dump/restore is not required for those running 15.X.

    However, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 15.1, - see Section E.5. -

    E.3.2. Changes

    E.4.2. Changes

    • Prevent CREATE SCHEMA from defeating changes in search_path (Alexander Lakhin)

      @@ -600,4 +600,4 @@ for consistency with other timezones observing Moscow time. Also, America/Yellowknife is no longer distinct from America/Edmonton; this affects some pre-1948 timestamps in that area. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-4.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-4.html index 67f56e0..be9f570 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-4.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-4.html @@ -1,24 +1,24 @@ -E.2. Release 15.4

    E.2. Release 15.4

    Release date: 2023-08-10

    +E.3. Release 15.4

    E.3. Release 15.4

    Release date: 2023-08-10

    This release contains a variety of fixes from 15.3. For information about new features in major release 15, see - Section E.6. -

    E.2.1. Migration to Version 15.4

    + Section E.7. +

    E.3.1. Migration to Version 15.4

    A dump/restore is not required for those running 15.X.

    However, if you use BRIN indexes, it may be advisable to reindex them; see the third changelog entry below.

    Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 15.1, - see Section E.5. -

    E.2.2. Changes

    E.3.2. Changes

    • Disallow substituting a schema or owner name into an extension script if the name contains a quote, backslash, or dollar sign (Noah Misch)

      This restriction guards against SQL-injection hazards for trusted extensions.

      - The PostgreSQL Project thanks Micah Gate, + The PostgreSQL Project thanks Micah Gates, Valerie Woolard, Tim Carey-Smith, and Christoph Berg for reporting this problem. (CVE-2023-39417) @@ -348,4 +348,4 @@

    • Fix make_etags script to work with non-Exuberant ctags (Masahiko Sawada) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-5.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-5.html index 2f887fd..7aa2b7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-5.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-5.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -E.1. Release 15.5

    E.1. Release 15.5

    Release date: 2023-11-09

    +E.2. Release 15.5

    E.2. Release 15.5

    Release date: 2023-11-09

    This release contains a variety of fixes from 15.4. For information about new features in major release 15, see - Section E.6. -

    E.1.1. Migration to Version 15.5

    + Section E.7. +

    E.2.1. Migration to Version 15.5

    A dump/restore is not required for those running 15.X.

    However, several mistakes have been discovered that could lead to @@ -14,8 +14,8 @@ entries below.

    Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 15.4, - see Section E.2. -

    E.1.2. Changes

    E.2.2. Changes

    • Fix handling of unknown-type arguments in DISTINCT "any" aggregate functions (Tom Lane) @@ -465,4 +465,4 @@ abbreviation for a zone with a total human population of about two dozen, it seems unlikely that anyone will miss it. If someone does, they can put it back via a custom abbreviations file. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-6.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-6.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000..262e9bb --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15-6.html @@ -0,0 +1,454 @@ + +E.1. Release 15.6

    E.1. Release 15.6

    Release date: 2024-02-08

    + This release contains a variety of fixes from 15.5. + For information about new features in major release 15, see + Section E.7. +

    E.1.1. Migration to Version 15.6

    + A dump/restore is not required for those running 15.X. +

    + However, one bug was fixed that could have resulted in corruption of + GIN indexes during concurrent updates. If you suspect such + corruption, reindex affected indexes after installing this update. +

    + Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 15.5, + see Section E.2. +

    E.1.2. Changes

    • + Tighten security restrictions within REFRESH MATERIALIZED + VIEW CONCURRENTLY (Heikki Linnakangas) +

      + One step of a concurrent refresh command was run under weak security + restrictions. If a materialized view's owner could persuade a + superuser or other high-privileged user to perform a concurrent + refresh on that view, the view's owner could control code executed + with the privileges of the user running REFRESH. + Fix things so that all user-determined code is run as the view's + owner, as expected. +

      + The only known exploit for this error does not work + in PostgreSQL 16.0 and later, so it may + be that v16 is not vulnerable in practice. +

      + The PostgreSQL Project thanks Pedro + Gallegos for reporting this problem. + (CVE-2024-0985) +

    • + Fix memory leak when performing JIT inlining (Andres Freund, + Daniel Gustafsson) +

      + There have been multiple reports of backend processes suffering + out-of-memory conditions after sufficiently many JIT compilations. + This fix should resolve that. +

    • + When dequeueing from an LWLock, avoid needing to search the list of + waiting processes (Andres Freund) +

      + This fixes O(N^2) behavior when the list of waiters is long. In + some use-cases this results in substantial throughput improvements. +

    • + Avoid generating incorrect partitioned-join plans (Richard Guo) +

      + Some uncommon situations involving lateral references could create + incorrect plans. Affected queries could produce wrong answers, or + odd failures such as variable not found in subplan target + list, or executor crashes. +

    • + Fix incorrect wrapping of subquery output expressions in + PlaceHolderVars (Tom Lane) +

      + This fixes incorrect results when a subquery is underneath an outer + join and has an output column that laterally references something + outside the outer join's scope. The output column might not appear + as NULL when it should do so due to the action of the outer join. +

    • + Fix misprocessing of window function run conditions (Richard Guo) +

      + This oversight could lead to WindowFunc not found in subplan + target lists errors. +

    • + Skip inappropriate actions when MERGE causes a + cross-partition update (Dean Rasheed) +

      + When executing a MERGE UPDATE action on a + partitioned table, if the UPDATE is turned into + a DELETE and INSERT due to + changing a partition key column, skip firing AFTER + UPDATE ROW triggers, as well as other post-update actions + such as RLS checks. These actions would typically fail, which is + why a regular UPDATE doesn't do them in such + cases; MERGE shouldn't either. +

    • + Cope with BEFORE ROW DELETE triggers in + cross-partition MERGE updates (Dean Rasheed) +

      + If such a trigger attempted to prevent the update by returning + NULL, MERGE would suffer an error or assertion + failure. +

    • + Prevent access to a no-longer-pinned buffer in BEFORE ROW + UPDATE triggers (Alexander Lakhin, Tom Lane) +

      + If the tuple being updated had just been updated and moved to + another page by another session, there was a narrow window where + we would attempt to fetch data from the new tuple version without + any pin on its buffer. In principle this could result in garbage + data appearing in non-updated columns of the proposed new tuple. + The odds of problems in practice seem rather low, however. +

    • + Avoid requesting an oversize shared-memory area in parallel hash + join (Thomas Munro, Andrei Lepikhov, Alexander Korotkov) +

      + The limiting value was too large, allowing invalid DSA memory + alloc request size errors to occur with sufficiently large + expected hash table sizes. +

    • + Avoid assertion failures in heap_update() + and heap_delete() when a tuple to be updated by + a foreign-key enforcement trigger fails the extra visibility + crosscheck (Alexander Lakhin) +

      + This error had no impact in non-assert builds. +

    • + Fix possible failure during ALTER TABLE ADD + COLUMN on a complex inheritance tree (Tender Wang) +

      + If a grandchild table would inherit the new column via multiple + intermediate parents, the command failed with tuple already + updated by self. +

    • + Fix problems with duplicate token names in ALTER TEXT + SEARCH CONFIGURATION ... MAPPING commands (Tender Wang, + Michael Paquier) +

    • + Properly lock the associated table during DROP + STATISTICS (Tomas Vondra) +

      + Failure to acquire the lock could result in tuple + concurrently deleted errors if the DROP + executes concurrently with ANALYZE. +

    • + Fix function volatility checking for GENERATED + and DEFAULT expressions (Tom Lane) +

      + These places could fail to detect insertion of a volatile function + default-argument expression, or decide that a polymorphic function + is volatile although it is actually immutable on the datatype of + interest. This could lead to improperly rejecting or accepting + a GENERATED clause, or to mistakenly applying the + constant-default-value optimization in ALTER TABLE ADD + COLUMN. +

    • + Detect that a new catalog cache entry became stale while detoasting + its fields (Tom Lane) +

      + We expand any out-of-line fields in a catalog tuple before inserting + it into the catalog caches. That involves database access which + might cause invalidation of catalog cache entries — but the + new entry isn't in the cache yet, so we would miss noticing that it + should get invalidated. The result is a race condition in which an + already-stale cache entry could get made, and then persist + indefinitely. This would lead to hard-to-predict misbehavior. + Fix by rechecking the tuple's visibility after detoasting. +

    • + Fix edge-case integer overflow detection bug on some platforms (Dean + Rasheed) +

      + Computing 0 - INT64_MIN should result in an + overflow error, and did on most platforms. However, platforms with + neither integer overflow builtins nor 128-bit integers would fail to + spot the overflow, instead returning INT64_MIN. +

    • + Detect Julian-date overflow when adding or subtracting + an interval to/from a timestamp (Tom Lane) +

      + Some cases that should cause an out-of-range error produced an + incorrect result instead. +

    • + Add more checks for overflow in interval_mul() + and interval_div() (Dean Rasheed) +

      + Some cases that should cause an out-of-range error produced an + incorrect result instead. +

    • + Ensure cached statistics are discarded after a change + to stats_fetch_consistency (Shinya Kato) +

      + In some code paths, it was possible for stale statistics to be + returned. +

    • + Make the pg_file_settings view check + validity of unapplied values for settings + with backend + or superuser-backend context (Tom Lane) +

      + Invalid values were not noted in the view as intended. This escaped + detection because there are very few settings in these groups. +

    • + Match collation too when matching an existing index to a new + partitioned index (Peter Eisentraut) +

      + Previously we could accept an index that has a different collation + from the corresponding element of the partition key, possibly + leading to misbehavior. +

    • + Avoid failure if a child index is dropped concurrently + with REINDEX INDEX on a partitioned index + (Fei Changhong) +

    • + Fix insufficient locking when cleaning up an incomplete split of + a GIN index's internal page (Fei Changhong, Heikki Linnakangas) +

      + The code tried to do this with shared rather than exclusive lock on + the buffer. This could lead to index corruption if two processes + attempted the cleanup concurrently. +

    • + Avoid premature release of buffer pin in GIN index insertion + (Tom Lane) +

      + If an index root page split occurs concurrently with our own + insertion, the code could fail with buffer NNNN is not owned + by resource owner. +

    • + Avoid failure with partitioned SP-GiST indexes (Tom Lane) +

      + Trying to use an index of this kind could lead to No such + file or directory errors. +

    • + Fix ownership change reporting for large objects (Tom Lane) +

      + A no-op ALTER LARGE OBJECT OWNER command (that + is, one selecting the existing owner) passed the wrong class ID to + the PostAlterHook, probably confusing any + extension using that hook. +

    • + Fix reporting of I/O timing data in EXPLAIN + (BUFFERS) (Michael Paquier) +

      + The numbers labeled as shared/local actually refer + only to shared buffers, so change that label + to shared. +

    • + Ensure durability of CREATE DATABASE (Noah Misch) +

      + If an operating system crash occurred during or shortly + after CREATE DATABASE, recovery could fail, or + subsequent connections to the new database could fail. If a base + backup was taken in that window, similar problems could be observed + when trying to use the backup. The symptom would be that the + database directory, PG_VERSION file, or + pg_filenode.map file was missing or empty. +

    • + Add more LOG messages when starting and ending + recovery from a backup (Andres Freund) +

      + This change provides additional information in the postmaster log + that may be useful for diagnosing recovery problems. +

    • + Prevent standby servers from incorrectly processing dead index + tuples during subtransactions (Fei Changhong) +

      + The startedInRecovery flag was not + correctly set for a subtransaction. This affects only processing of + dead index tuples. It could allow a query in a subtransaction to + ignore index entries that it should return (if they are already dead + on the primary server, but not dead to the standby transaction), or + to prematurely mark index entries as dead that are not yet dead on + the primary. It is not clear that the latter case has any serious + consequences, but it's not the intended behavior. +

    • + Fix integer overflow hazard in checking whether a record will fit + into the WAL decoding buffer (Thomas Munro) +

      + This bug appears to be only latent except when running a + 32-bit PostgreSQL build on a 64-bit + platform. +

    • + Fix deadlock between a logical replication apply worker, its + tablesync worker, and a session process trying to alter the + subscription (Shlok Kyal) +

      + One edge of the deadlock loop did not involve a lock wait, so the + deadlock went undetected and would persist until manual + intervention. +

    • + Ensure that column default values are correctly transmitted by + the pgoutput logical replication plugin + (Nikhil Benesch) +

      + ALTER TABLE ADD COLUMN with a constant default + value for the new column avoids rewriting existing tuples, instead + expecting that reading code will insert the correct default into a + tuple that lacks that column. If replication was subsequently + initiated on the table, pgoutput would + transmit NULL instead of the correct default for such a column, + causing incorrect replication on the subscriber. +

    • + Fix failure of logical replication's initial sync for a table with + no columns (Vignesh C) +

      + This case generated an improperly-formatted COPY + command. +

    • + Prevent examining system catalogs with the wrong snapshot during + logical decoding (Fei Changhong) +

      + If decoding begins partway through a transaction that modifies + system catalogs, the decoder may not recognize that, causing it to + fail to treat that transaction as in-progress for catalog lookups. + This fix deals with the case that a top-level transaction is already + marked as containing catalog changes, but its subtransaction(s) are + not. +

    • + Return the correct status code when a new client disconnects without + responding to the server's password challenge (Liu Lang, Tom Lane) +

      + In some cases we'd treat this as a loggable error, which was not the + intention and tends to create log spam, since common clients + like psql frequently do this. It may + also confuse extensions that + use ClientAuthentication_hook. +

    • + Fix incompatibility with OpenSSL 3.2 + (Tristan Partin, Bo Andreson) +

      + Use the BIO app_data field for our private storage, + instead of assuming it's okay to use the data field. + This mistake didn't cause problems before, but with 3.2 it leads + to crashes and complaints about double frees. +

    • + Be more wary about OpenSSL not + setting errno on error (Tom Lane) +

      + If errno isn't set, assume the cause of the + reported failure is read EOF. This fixes rare cases of strange + error reports like could not accept SSL connection: + Success. +

    • + Fix file descriptor leakage when a foreign data + wrapper's ForeignAsyncRequest function fails + (Heikki Linnakangas) +

    • + Report ENOMEM errors from file-related system + calls as ERRCODE_OUT_OF_MEMORY, + not ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR (Alexander Kuzmenkov) +

    • + In PL/pgSQL, support SQL commands that + are CREATE FUNCTION/CREATE + PROCEDURE with SQL-standard bodies (Tom Lane) +

      + Previously, such cases failed with parsing errors due to the + semicolon(s) appearing in the function body. +

    • + Fix libpq's + handling of errors in pipelines (Álvaro Herrera) +

      + The pipeline state could get out of sync if an error is returned + for reasons other than a query problem (for example, if the + connection is lost). Potentially this would lead to a busy-loop in + the calling application. +

    • + Make libpq's + PQsendFlushRequest() function flush the client + output buffer under the same rules as + other PQsend functions (Jelte Fennema-Nio) +

      + In pipeline mode, it may still be necessary to + call PQflush() as well; but this change removes + some inconsistency. +

    • + Avoid race condition when libpq + initializes OpenSSL support concurrently in two different threads + (Willi Mann, Michael Paquier) +

    • + Fix timing-dependent failure in GSSAPI data transmission (Tom Lane) +

      + When using GSSAPI encryption in non-blocking + mode, libpq sometimes failed + with GSSAPI caller failed to retransmit all data needing to + be retried. +

    • + In pg_dump, don't dump RLS policies or + security labels for extension member objects (Tom Lane, Jacob + Champion) +

      + Previously, commands would be included in the dump to set these + properties, which is really incorrect since they should be + considered as internal affairs of the extension. Moreover, the + restoring user might not have adequate privilege to set them, and + indeed the dumping user might not have enough privilege to dump them + (since dumping RLS policies requires acquiring lock on their table). +

    • + In pg_dump, don't dump an extended + statistics object if its underlying table isn't being dumped + (Rian McGuire, Tom Lane) +

      + This conforms to the behavior for other dependent objects such as + indexes. +

    • + Make it an error for a pgbench script to + end with an open pipeline (Anthonin Bonnefoy) +

      + Previously, pgbench would behave oddly if + a \startpipeline command lacked a + matching \endpipeline. This seems like a + scripting mistake rather than a case + that pgbench needs to handle nicely, so + throw an error. +

    • + In contrib/bloom, fix overly tight assertion + about false_positive_rate (Alexander Lakhin) +

    • + Fix crash in contrib/intarray if an array with + an element equal to INT_MAX is inserted into + a gist__int_ops index + (Alexander Lakhin, Tom Lane) +

    • + Report a better error + when contrib/pageinspect's + hash_bitmap_info() function is applied to a + partitioned hash index (Alexander Lakhin, Michael Paquier) +

    • + Report a better error + when contrib/pgstattuple's + pgstathashindex() function is applied to a + partitioned hash index (Alexander Lakhin) +

    • + On Windows, suppress autorun options when launching subprocesses + in pg_ctl + and pg_regress (Kyotaro Horiguchi) +

      + When launching a child process via cmd.exe, + pass the /D flag to prevent executing any autorun + commands specified in the registry. This avoids possibly-surprising + side effects. +

    • + Move is_valid_ascii() + from mb/pg_wchar.h + to utils/ascii.h (Jubilee Young) +

      + This change avoids the need to + include <simd.h> + in pg_wchar.h, which was causing problems for + some third-party code. +

    • + Fix compilation failures with libxml2 + version 2.12.0 and later (Tom Lane) +

    • + Fix compilation failure of WAL_DEBUG code on + Windows (Bharath Rupireddy) +

    • + Suppress compiler warnings from Python's header files + (Peter Eisentraut, Tom Lane) +

      + Our preferred compiler options provoke warnings about constructs + appearing in recent versions of Python's header files. When using + gcc, we can suppress these warnings with + a pragma. +

    • + Avoid deprecation warning when compiling with LLVM 18 (Thomas Munro) +

    • + Update time zone data files to tzdata + release 2024a for DST law changes in Greenland, Kazakhstan, and + Palestine, plus corrections for the Antarctic stations Casey and + Vostok. Also historical corrections for Vietnam, Toronto, and + Miquelon. +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15.html index c2e72f8..6214c57 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-15.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -E.6. Release 15

    E.6. Release 15

    Release date: 2022-10-13

    E.6.1. Overview

    +E.7. Release 15

    E.7. Release 15

    Release date: 2022-10-13

    E.7.1. Overview

    PostgreSQL 15 contains many new features and enhancements, including:

    • @@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ The above items and other new features of PostgreSQL 15 are explained in more detail in the sections below. -

    E.6.2. Migration to Version 15

    +

    E.7.2. Migration to Version 15

    A dump/restore using pg_dumpall or use of pg_upgrade or logical replication is required for those wishing to migrate data from any previous release. See Section 19.6 for general information on migrating to new @@ -262,11 +262,11 @@ The default is now that custom scan providers are assumed to not support projections; those that do will need to be updated for this release. -

    E.6.3. Changes

    +

    E.7.3. Changes

    Below you will find a detailed account of the changes between PostgreSQL 15 and the previous major release. -

    E.6.3.1. Server

    • +

      E.7.3.1. Server

      • Record and check the collation version of each database (Peter Eisentraut)

        This feature is designed to detect collation version @@ -289,7 +289,7 @@ Add system view pg_ident_file_mappings to report pg_ident.conf information (Julien Rouhaud) -

      E.6.3.1.1. Partitioning
      • +

      E.7.3.1.1. Partitioning
      • Improve planning time for queries referencing partitioned tables (David Rowley)

        @@ -319,7 +319,7 @@ triggers on all partitions (Arne Roland, Álvaro Herrera)

        Also prohibit cloned triggers from being renamed. -

      E.6.3.1.2. Indexes
      • +

      E.7.3.1.2. Indexes
      • Allow btree indexes on system and TOAST tables to efficiently store duplicates (Peter Geoghegan)

        @@ -343,7 +343,7 @@ function to use btree indexes if using the C collation (Tom Lane)

        Previously these could only use SP-GiST indexes. -

      E.6.3.1.3. Optimizer
      • +

      E.7.3.1.3. Optimizer
      • Allow extended statistics to record statistics for a parent with all its children (Tomas Vondra, Justin Pryzby) @@ -355,7 +355,7 @@ to allow the user to specify the expected size of the working table of a recursive query (Simon Riggs) -

      E.6.3.1.4. General Performance
      • +

      E.7.3.1.4. General Performance
      • Allow hash lookup for NOT IN clauses with many constants (David Rowley, James Coleman)

        @@ -409,7 +409,7 @@

      • Improve the performance of spinlocks on high-core-count ARM64 systems (Geoffrey Blake) -

      E.6.3.1.5. Monitoring
      • +

      E.7.3.1.5. Monitoring
      • Enable default logging of checkpoints and slow autovacuum operations (Bharath Rupireddy)

        @@ -459,7 +459,7 @@ archive_cleanup_command, restore_command and recovery_end_command. -

      E.6.3.1.6. Privileges
      • +

      E.7.3.1.6. Privileges
      • Allow table accesses done by a view to optionally be controlled by privileges of the view's caller (Christoph Heiss) @@ -499,7 +499,7 @@ (Jeff Davis)

        Previously this function could only be run by superusers. -

      E.6.3.1.7. Server Configuration
      • +

      E.7.3.1.7. Server Configuration
      • Add server variable shared_memory_size to report the size of allocated shared memory (Nathan Bossart)

      • @@ -531,7 +531,7 @@ and data_directory_mode would report values that would not be accurate on the running server. However, this does not work on a running server. -

      E.6.3.2. Streaming Replication and Recovery

      • +

      E.7.3.2. Streaming Replication and Recovery

      • Add support for LZ4 and Zstandard compression of server-side base backups (Jeevan Ladhe, Robert Haas)

      • @@ -553,7 +553,7 @@

      • No longer require IDENTIFY_SYSTEM to be run before START_REPLICATION (Jeff Davis) -

      • +

      • Allow publication of all tables in a schema (Vignesh C, Hou Zhijie, Amit Kapila)

        @@ -620,7 +620,7 @@ system view (Hou Zhijie)

        In some cases a partition could appear more than once. -

      E.6.3.3. Utility Commands

      • +

      E.7.3.3. Utility Commands

      • Add SQL MERGE command to adjust one table to match another (Simon Riggs, Pavan Deolasee, Álvaro Herrera, Amit Langote) @@ -678,7 +678,7 @@ in later use of the view or rule. The column-level dependency is now also noted, so that dropping such a column will be rejected unless the view is changed or dropped. -

      E.6.3.4. Data Types

      • +

      E.7.3.4. Data Types

      • Allow the scale of a numeric value to be negative, or greater than its precision (Dean Rasheed, @@ -697,7 +697,7 @@

        Also update from Unicode 5.0 to 14.0.0. There is now an automated way to keep Postgres updated with Unicode releases. -

      E.6.3.5. Functions

      • +

      E.7.3.5. Functions

      • Add multirange input to range_agg() (Paul Jungwirth)

      • @@ -748,14 +748,14 @@ Previously this function reported all temporary schemas as pg_temp, but it's misleading to use that for any but the current session's temporary schema. -

      E.6.3.6. PL/pgSQL

      • +

      E.7.3.6. PL/pgSQL

      • Fix enforcement of PL/pgSQL variable CONSTANT markings (Tom Lane)

        Previously, a variable could be used as a CALL output parameter or refcursor OPEN variable despite being marked CONSTANT. -

      E.6.3.7. libpq

      • +

      E.7.3.7. libpq

      • Allow IP address matching against a server certificate's Subject Alternative Name (Jacob Champion)

      • @@ -772,11 +772,11 @@

      • Prevent libpq event callback failures from forcing an error result (Tom Lane) -

      E.6.3.8. Client Applications

      • +

      E.7.3.8. Client Applications

      • Allow pgbench to retry after serialization and deadlock failures (Yugo Nagata, Marina Polyakova) -

      E.6.3.8.1. psql
      • +

      E.7.3.8.1. psql
      • Improve performance of psql's \copy command, by sending data in larger chunks (Heikki Linnakangas) @@ -849,7 +849,7 @@ Remove code that was only used when running with an older server. Commands that do not require any version-specific adjustments compared to 9.2 will still work. -

      E.6.3.8.2. pg_dump
      • +

      E.7.3.8.2. pg_dump
      • Make pg_dump dump public schema ownership changes and security labels (Noah Misch) @@ -869,7 +869,7 @@ Limit support of pg_dump and pg_dumpall to servers running PostgreSQL 9.2 or later (Tom Lane) -

      E.6.3.9. Server Applications

      • +

      E.7.3.9. Server Applications

      • Add new pg_basebackup option --target to control the base backup location (Robert Haas) @@ -924,7 +924,7 @@ option --config-file to simplify use when server configuration files are stored outside the data directory (Gunnar Bluth) -

      E.6.3.9.1. pg_upgrade
      • +

      E.7.3.9.1. pg_upgrade
      • Store pg_upgrade's log and temporary files in a subdirectory of the new cluster called pg_upgrade_output.d (Justin Pryzby) @@ -958,7 +958,7 @@ Limit support of pg_upgrade to old servers running PostgreSQL 9.2 or later (Tom Lane) -

      E.6.3.9.2. pg_waldump
      • +

      E.7.3.9.2. pg_waldump
      • Allow pg_waldump output to be filtered by relation file node, block number, fork number, and full page images (David Christensen, Thomas Munro) @@ -979,14 +979,14 @@

        This is enabled by specifying the --rmgr option multiple times. -

      E.6.3.10. Documentation

      • +

      E.7.3.10. Documentation

      • Add documentation for pg_encoding_to_char() and pg_char_to_encoding() (Ian Lawrence Barwick)

      • Document the ^@ starts-with operator (Tom Lane) -

      E.6.3.11. Source Code

      • +

      E.7.3.11. Source Code

      • Add support for continuous integration testing using cirrus-ci (Andres Freund, Thomas Munro, Melanie Plageman)

      • @@ -1048,7 +1048,7 @@

      • Require Python version 3.2 or later (Andres Freund) -

      E.6.3.12. Additional Modules

      • +

      E.7.3.12. Additional Modules

      • Allow amcheck to check sequences (Mark Dilger)

      • @@ -1086,7 +1086,7 @@

      • Indicate the permissive/enforcing state in sepgsql log messages (Dave Page) -

      E.6.3.12.1. postgres_fdw
      • +

      E.7.3.12.1. postgres_fdw
      • Allow postgres_fdw to push down CASE expressions (Alexander Pyhalov)

      • @@ -1106,8 +1106,8 @@

        This is enabled with the CREATE SERVER option parallel_commit. -

      E.6.4. Acknowledgments

      +

    E.7.4. Acknowledgments

    The following individuals (in alphabetical order) have contributed to this release as patch authors, committers, reviewers, testers, or reporters of issues. -

    Abhijit Menon-Sen
    Adam Brusselback
    Adam Mackler
    Adrian Ho
    Ahsan Hadi
    Ajin Cherian
    Alastair McKinley
    Aleksander Alekseev
    Ales Zeleny
    Alex Kingsborough
    Alex Kozhemyakin
    Alexander Korotkov
    Alexander Kukushkin
    Alexander Lakhin
    Alexander Nawratil
    Alexander Pyhalov
    Alexey Borzov
    Alexey Ermakov
    Aliaksandr Kalenik
    Álvaro Herrera
    Amit Kapila
    Amit Khandekar
    Amit Langote
    Amul Sul
    Anastasia Lubennikova
    Anders Kaseorg
    Andreas Dijkman
    Andreas Grob
    Andreas Seltenreich
    Andrei Zubkov
    Andres Freund
    Andrew Alsup
    Andrew Bille
    Andrew Dunstan
    Andrew Gierth
    Andrew Kesper
    Andrey Borodin
    Andrey Lepikhov
    Andrey Sokolov
    Andy Fan
    Anton Melnikov
    Anton Voloshin
    Antonin Houska
    Arjan van de Ven
    Arne Roland
    Arthur Zakirov
    Ashutosh Bapat
    Ashutosh Sharma
    Ashwin Agrawal
    Asif Rehman
    Asim Praveen
    Atsushi Torikoshi
    Aya Iwata
    Bauyrzhan Sakhariyev
    Benoit Lobréau
    Bernd Dorn
    Bertrand Drouvot
    Bharath Rupireddy
    Björn Harrtell
    Boris Kolpackov
    Boris Korzun
    Brad Nicholson
    Brar Piening
    Bruce Momjian
    Bruno da Silva
    Bryn Llewellyn
    Carl Sopchak
    Cary Huang
    Chapman Flack
    Chen Jiaoqian
    Chris Bandy
    Chris Lowder
    Christian Quest
    Christoph Berg
    Christoph Heiss
    Christophe Pettus
    Christopher Painter-Wakefield
    Claudio Freire
    Clemens Zeidler
    Corey Huinker
    Dag Lem
    Dagfinn Ilmari Mannsåker
    Dan Kubb
    Daniel Cherniy
    Daniel Gustafsson
    Daniel Polski
    Daniel Vérité
    Daniel Westermann
    Daniele Varrazzo
    Daniil Anisimov
    Danny Shemesh
    Darafei Praliaskouski
    Daria Lepikhova
    Dave Cramer
    Dave Page
    David Christensen
    David Fetter
    David G. Johnston
    David Rowley
    David Steele
    David Zhang
    Dean Rasheed
    Dian Fay
    Dilip Kumar
    Dipesh Pandit
    Dmitry Dolgov
    Dmitry Koval
    Dmitry Marakasov
    Dominique Devienne
    Dong Wook
    Drew DeVault
    Eduard Català
    Egor Chindyaskin
    Egor Rogov
    Ekaterina Kiryanova
    Elena Indrupskaya
    Elvis Pranskevichus
    Emmanuel Quincerot
    Emre Hasegeli
    Eric Mutta
    Erica Zhang
    Erik Rijkers
    Erki Eessaar
    Etsuro Fujita
    Euler Taveira
    Fabien Coelho
    Fabrice Chapuis
    Fabrice Fontaine
    Fabrízio de Royes Mello
    Feike Steenbergen
    Filip Gospodinov
    Florin Irion
    Floris Van Nee
    Frédéric Yhuel
    Gabriela Serventi
    Gaurab Dey
    Geoff Winkless
    Geoffrey Blake
    Georgios Kokolatos
    Gilles Darold
    Greg Nancarrow
    Greg Rychlewski
    Greg Sabino Mullane
    Greg Stark
    Gregory Smith
    Guillaume Lelarge
    Gunnar Bluth
    Gurjeet Singh
    Haiyang Wang
    Haiying Tang
    Hannu Krosing
    Hans Buschmann
    Hayato Kuroda
    Heath Lord
    Heikki Linnakangas
    Herwig Goemans
    Himanshu Upadhyaya
    Holly Roberts
    Hou Zhijie
    Hubert Lubaczewski
    Ian Barwick
    Ian Campbell
    Ibrar Ahmed
    Ildus Kurbangaliev
    Ilya Anfimov
    Itamar Gafni
    Jacob Champion
    Jaime Casanova
    Jakub Wartak
    James Coleman
    James Hilliard
    James Inform
    Jan Piotrowski
    Japin Li
    Jason Harvey
    Jason Kim
    Jean-Christophe Arnu
    Jeevan Ladhe
    Jeff Davis
    Jeff Janes
    Jehan-Guillaume de Rorthais
    Jelte Fennema
    Jeremy Evans
    Jeremy Schneider
    Jian Guo
    Jian He
    Jimmy Yih
    Jiri Fejfar
    Jitka Plesníková
    Joe Conway
    Joe Wildish
    Joel Jacobson
    Joey Bodoia
    John Naylor
    Jonathan Katz
    Josef Simanek
    Joseph Koshakow
    Josh Soref
    Joshua Brindle
    Juan José Santamaría Flecha
    Julien Rouhaud
    Julien Roze
    Junwang Zhao
    Jürgen Purtz
    Justin Pryzby
    Ken Kato
    Kevin Burke
    Kevin Grittner
    Kevin Humphreys
    Kevin McKibbin
    Kevin Sweet
    Kevin Zheng
    Klaudie Willis
    Konstantin Knizhnik
    Konstantina Skovola
    Kosei Masumura
    Kotaro Kawamoto
    Koyu Tanigawa
    Kuntal Ghosh
    Kyotaro Horiguchi
    Lars Kanis
    Lauren Fliksteen
    Laurent Hasson
    Laurenz Albe
    Leslie Lemaire
    Liam Bowen
    Lingjie Qiang
    Liu Huailing
    Louis Jachiet
    Lukas Fittl
    Ma Liangzhu
    Maciek Sakrejda
    Magnus Hagander
    Mahendra Singh Thalor
    Maksim Milyutin
    Marc Bachmann
    Marcin Krupowicz
    Marcus Gartner
    Marek Szuba
    Marina Polyakova
    Mario Emmenlauer
    Mark Dilger
    Mark Murawski
    Mark Wong
    Markus Wanner
    Markus Winand
    Martijn van Oosterhout
    Martin Jurca
    Martin Kalcher
    Martín Marqués
    Masahiko Sawada
    Masahiro Ikeda
    Masao Fujii
    Masaya Kawamoto
    Masayuki Hirose
    Matthias van de Meent
    Matthijs van der Vleuten
    Maxim Orlov
    Maxim Yablokov
    Melanie Plageman
    Michael Banck
    Michael Harris
    Michael J. Sullivan
    Michael Meskes
    Michael Mühlbeyer
    Michael Paquier
    Michael Powers
    Mike Fiedler
    Mike Oh
    Mikhail Kulagin
    Miles Delahunty
    Naoki Okano
    Nathan Bossart
    Nathan Long
    Nazir Bilal Yavuz
    Neha Sharma
    Neil Chen
    Nicola Contu
    Nicolas Lutic
    Nikhil Benesch
    Nikhil Shetty
    Nikhil Sontakke
    Nikita Glukhov
    Nikolai Berkoff
    Nikolay Samokhvalov
    Nikolay Shaplov
    Nitin Jadhav
    Noah Misch
    Noboru Saito
    Noriyoshi Shinoda
    Olaf Bohlen
    Olly Betts
    Onder Kalaci
    Oskar Stenberg
    Otto Kekalainen
    Paul Guo
    Paul Jungwirth
    Paul Martinez
    Pavan Deolasee
    Pavel Borisov
    Pavel Luzanov
    Pavel Stehule
    Peter Eisentraut
    Peter Geoghegan
    Peter Slavov
    Peter Smith
    Petr Jelínek
    Phil Florent
    Phil Krylov
    Pierre-Aurélien Georges
    Prabhat Sahu
    Quan Zongliang
    Rachel Heaton
    Rahila Syed
    Rajakavitha Kodhandapani
    Rajkumar Raghuwanshi
    Ranier Vilela
    Rei Kamigishi
    Reid Thompson
    Rémi Lapeyre
    Renan Soares Lopes
    Richard Guo
    Richard Wesley
    RKN Sai Krishna
    Robert Haas
    Robert Treat
    Roberto Mello
    Robins Tharakan
    Roger Mason
    Roman Zharkov
    Ronan Dunklau
    Rui Zhao
    Ryan Kelly
    Ryo Matsumura
    Ryohei Takahashi
    Sadhuprasad Patro
    Sait Talha Nisanci
    Sami Imseih
    Sandeep Thakkar
    Sebastian Kemper
    Sehrope Sarkuni
    Sergei Kornilov
    Sergei Shoulbakov
    Sergey Shinderuk
    Shay Rojansky
    Shenhao Wang
    Shi Yu
    Shinya Kato
    Shruthi Gowda
    Simon Perepelitsa
    Simon Riggs
    Sirisha Chamarthi
    Soumyadeep Chakraborty
    Stan Hu
    Stas Kelvich
    Stefen Hillman
    Stephen Frost
    Steve Chavez
    Sumanta Mukherjee
    Suraj Khamkar
    Suraj Kharage
    Sven Klemm
    Takamichi Osumi
    Takayuki Tsunakawa
    Takeshi Ideriha
    Tatsuhiro Nakamori
    Tatsuhito Kasahara
    Tatsuo Ishii
    Tatsuro Yamada
    Teja Mupparti
    Teodor Sigaev
    Thibaud Walkowiak
    Thom Brown
    Thomas McKay
    Thomas Munro
    Tim McNamara
    Timo Stolz
    Timur Khanjanov
    Tom Lane
    Tomas Barton
    Tomas Vondra
    Tony Reix
    Troy Frericks
    Tushar Ahuja
    Victor Wagner
    Victor Yegorov
    Vignesh C
    Vik Fearing
    Vincas Dargis
    Vitaly Burovoy
    Vitaly Voronov
    Vladimir Sitnikov
    Wang Ke
    Wei Sun
    Wei Wang
    Whale Song
    Will Mortensen
    Wolfgang Walther
    Yanliang Lei
    Yaoguang Chen
    Yogendra Suralkar
    YoungHwan Joo
    Yugo Nagata
    Yukun Wang
    Yura Sokolov
    Yusuke Egashira
    Yuzuko Hosoya
    Zhang Mingli
    Zhang Wenjie
    Zhihong Yu
    Zhiyong Wu
    \ No newline at end of file +

    Abhijit Menon-Sen
    Adam Brusselback
    Adam Mackler
    Adrian Ho
    Ahsan Hadi
    Ajin Cherian
    Alastair McKinley
    Aleksander Alekseev
    Ales Zeleny
    Alex Kingsborough
    Alex Kozhemyakin
    Alexander Korotkov
    Alexander Kukushkin
    Alexander Lakhin
    Alexander Nawratil
    Alexander Pyhalov
    Alexey Borzov
    Alexey Ermakov
    Aliaksandr Kalenik
    Álvaro Herrera
    Amit Kapila
    Amit Khandekar
    Amit Langote
    Amul Sul
    Anastasia Lubennikova
    Anders Kaseorg
    Andreas Dijkman
    Andreas Grob
    Andreas Seltenreich
    Andrei Zubkov
    Andres Freund
    Andrew Alsup
    Andrew Bille
    Andrew Dunstan
    Andrew Gierth
    Andrew Kesper
    Andrey Borodin
    Andrey Lepikhov
    Andrey Sokolov
    Andy Fan
    Anton Melnikov
    Anton Voloshin
    Antonin Houska
    Arjan van de Ven
    Arne Roland
    Arthur Zakirov
    Ashutosh Bapat
    Ashutosh Sharma
    Ashwin Agrawal
    Asif Rehman
    Asim Praveen
    Atsushi Torikoshi
    Aya Iwata
    Bauyrzhan Sakhariyev
    Benoit Lobréau
    Bernd Dorn
    Bertrand Drouvot
    Bharath Rupireddy
    Björn Harrtell
    Boris Kolpackov
    Boris Korzun
    Brad Nicholson
    Brar Piening
    Bruce Momjian
    Bruno da Silva
    Bryn Llewellyn
    Carl Sopchak
    Cary Huang
    Chapman Flack
    Chen Jiaoqian
    Chris Bandy
    Chris Lowder
    Christian Quest
    Christoph Berg
    Christoph Heiss
    Christophe Pettus
    Christopher Painter-Wakefield
    Claudio Freire
    Clemens Zeidler
    Corey Huinker
    Dag Lem
    Dagfinn Ilmari Mannsåker
    Dan Kubb
    Daniel Cherniy
    Daniel Gustafsson
    Daniel Polski
    Daniel Vérité
    Daniel Westermann
    Daniele Varrazzo
    Daniil Anisimov
    Danny Shemesh
    Darafei Praliaskouski
    Daria Lepikhova
    Dave Cramer
    Dave Page
    David Christensen
    David Fetter
    David G. Johnston
    David Rowley
    David Steele
    David Zhang
    Dean Rasheed
    Dian Fay
    Dilip Kumar
    Dipesh Pandit
    Dmitry Dolgov
    Dmitry Koval
    Dmitry Marakasov
    Dominique Devienne
    Dong Wook
    Drew DeVault
    Eduard Català
    Egor Chindyaskin
    Egor Rogov
    Ekaterina Kiryanova
    Elena Indrupskaya
    Elvis Pranskevichus
    Emmanuel Quincerot
    Emre Hasegeli
    Eric Mutta
    Erica Zhang
    Erik Rijkers
    Erki Eessaar
    Etsuro Fujita
    Euler Taveira
    Fabien Coelho
    Fabrice Chapuis
    Fabrice Fontaine
    Fabrízio de Royes Mello
    Feike Steenbergen
    Filip Gospodinov
    Florin Irion
    Floris Van Nee
    Frédéric Yhuel
    Gabriela Serventi
    Gaurab Dey
    Geoff Winkless
    Geoffrey Blake
    Georgios Kokolatos
    Gilles Darold
    Greg Nancarrow
    Greg Rychlewski
    Greg Sabino Mullane
    Greg Stark
    Gregory Smith
    Guillaume Lelarge
    Gunnar Bluth
    Gurjeet Singh
    Haiyang Wang
    Haiying Tang
    Hannu Krosing
    Hans Buschmann
    Hayato Kuroda
    Heath Lord
    Heikki Linnakangas
    Herwig Goemans
    Himanshu Upadhyaya
    Holly Roberts
    Hou Zhijie
    Hubert Lubaczewski
    Ian Barwick
    Ian Campbell
    Ibrar Ahmed
    Ildus Kurbangaliev
    Ilya Anfimov
    Itamar Gafni
    Jacob Champion
    Jaime Casanova
    Jakub Wartak
    James Coleman
    James Hilliard
    James Inform
    Jan Piotrowski
    Japin Li
    Jason Harvey
    Jason Kim
    Jean-Christophe Arnu
    Jeevan Ladhe
    Jeff Davis
    Jeff Janes
    Jehan-Guillaume de Rorthais
    Jelte Fennema
    Jeremy Evans
    Jeremy Schneider
    Jian Guo
    Jian He
    Jimmy Yih
    Jiri Fejfar
    Jitka Plesníková
    Joe Conway
    Joe Wildish
    Joel Jacobson
    Joey Bodoia
    John Naylor
    Jonathan Katz
    Josef Simanek
    Joseph Koshakow
    Josh Soref
    Joshua Brindle
    Juan José Santamaría Flecha
    Julien Rouhaud
    Julien Roze
    Junwang Zhao
    Jürgen Purtz
    Justin Pryzby
    Ken Kato
    Kevin Burke
    Kevin Grittner
    Kevin Humphreys
    Kevin McKibbin
    Kevin Sweet
    Kevin Zheng
    Klaudie Willis
    Konstantin Knizhnik
    Konstantina Skovola
    Kosei Masumura
    Kotaro Kawamoto
    Koyu Tanigawa
    Kuntal Ghosh
    Kyotaro Horiguchi
    Lars Kanis
    Lauren Fliksteen
    Laurent Hasson
    Laurenz Albe
    Leslie Lemaire
    Liam Bowen
    Lingjie Qiang
    Liu Huailing
    Louis Jachiet
    Lukas Fittl
    Ma Liangzhu
    Maciek Sakrejda
    Magnus Hagander
    Mahendra Singh Thalor
    Maksim Milyutin
    Marc Bachmann
    Marcin Krupowicz
    Marcus Gartner
    Marek Szuba
    Marina Polyakova
    Mario Emmenlauer
    Mark Dilger
    Mark Murawski
    Mark Wong
    Markus Wanner
    Markus Winand
    Martijn van Oosterhout
    Martin Jurca
    Martin Kalcher
    Martín Marqués
    Masahiko Sawada
    Masahiro Ikeda
    Masao Fujii
    Masaya Kawamoto
    Masayuki Hirose
    Matthias van de Meent
    Matthijs van der Vleuten
    Maxim Orlov
    Maxim Yablokov
    Melanie Plageman
    Michael Banck
    Michael Harris
    Michael J. Sullivan
    Michael Meskes
    Michael Mühlbeyer
    Michael Paquier
    Michael Powers
    Mike Fiedler
    Mike Oh
    Mikhail Kulagin
    Miles Delahunty
    Naoki Okano
    Nathan Bossart
    Nathan Long
    Nazir Bilal Yavuz
    Neha Sharma
    Neil Chen
    Nicola Contu
    Nicolas Lutic
    Nikhil Benesch
    Nikhil Shetty
    Nikhil Sontakke
    Nikita Glukhov
    Nikolai Berkoff
    Nikolay Samokhvalov
    Nikolay Shaplov
    Nitin Jadhav
    Noah Misch
    Noboru Saito
    Noriyoshi Shinoda
    Olaf Bohlen
    Olly Betts
    Onder Kalaci
    Oskar Stenberg
    Otto Kekalainen
    Paul Guo
    Paul Jungwirth
    Paul Martinez
    Pavan Deolasee
    Pavel Borisov
    Pavel Luzanov
    Pavel Stehule
    Peter Eisentraut
    Peter Geoghegan
    Peter Slavov
    Peter Smith
    Petr Jelínek
    Phil Florent
    Phil Krylov
    Pierre-Aurélien Georges
    Prabhat Sahu
    Quan Zongliang
    Rachel Heaton
    Rahila Syed
    Rajakavitha Kodhandapani
    Rajkumar Raghuwanshi
    Ranier Vilela
    Rei Kamigishi
    Reid Thompson
    Rémi Lapeyre
    Renan Soares Lopes
    Richard Guo
    Richard Wesley
    RKN Sai Krishna
    Robert Haas
    Robert Treat
    Roberto Mello
    Robins Tharakan
    Roger Mason
    Roman Zharkov
    Ronan Dunklau
    Rui Zhao
    Ryan Kelly
    Ryo Matsumura
    Ryohei Takahashi
    Sadhuprasad Patro
    Sait Talha Nisanci
    Sami Imseih
    Sandeep Thakkar
    Sebastian Kemper
    Sehrope Sarkuni
    Sergei Kornilov
    Sergei Shoulbakov
    Sergey Shinderuk
    Shay Rojansky
    Shenhao Wang
    Shi Yu
    Shinya Kato
    Shruthi Gowda
    Simon Perepelitsa
    Simon Riggs
    Sirisha Chamarthi
    Soumyadeep Chakraborty
    Stan Hu
    Stas Kelvich
    Stefen Hillman
    Stephen Frost
    Steve Chavez
    Sumanta Mukherjee
    Suraj Khamkar
    Suraj Kharage
    Sven Klemm
    Takamichi Osumi
    Takayuki Tsunakawa
    Takeshi Ideriha
    Tatsuhiro Nakamori
    Tatsuhito Kasahara
    Tatsuo Ishii
    Tatsuro Yamada
    Teja Mupparti
    Teodor Sigaev
    Thibaud Walkowiak
    Thom Brown
    Thomas McKay
    Thomas Munro
    Tim McNamara
    Timo Stolz
    Timur Khanjanov
    Tom Lane
    Tomas Barton
    Tomas Vondra
    Tony Reix
    Troy Frericks
    Tushar Ahuja
    Victor Wagner
    Victor Yegorov
    Vignesh C
    Vik Fearing
    Vincas Dargis
    Vitaly Burovoy
    Vitaly Voronov
    Vladimir Sitnikov
    Wang Ke
    Wei Sun
    Wei Wang
    Whale Song
    Will Mortensen
    Wolfgang Walther
    Yanliang Lei
    Yaoguang Chen
    Yogendra Suralkar
    YoungHwan Joo
    Yugo Nagata
    Yukun Wang
    Yura Sokolov
    Yusuke Egashira
    Yuzuko Hosoya
    Zhang Mingli
    Zhang Wenjie
    Zhihong Yu
    Zhiyong Wu
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-prior.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-prior.html index 327a972..fb5dd2b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release-prior.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release-prior.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -E.7. Prior Releases

    E.7. Prior Releases

    +E.8. Prior Releases

    E.8. Prior Releases

    Release notes for prior release branches can be found at https://www.postgresql.org/docs/release/ -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/release.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/release.html index 943ee30..f41804b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/release.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/release.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix E. Release Notes

    Appendix E. Release Notes

    +Appendix E. Release Notes

    Appendix E. Release Notes

    The release notes contain the significant changes in each PostgreSQL release, with major features and migration issues listed at the top. The release notes do not contain changes @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ The name appearing next to each item represents the major developer for that item. Of course all changes involve community discussion and patch review, so each item is truly a community effort. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/replication-origins.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/replication-origins.html index ab687ef..34484c2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/replication-origins.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/replication-origins.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 50. Replication Progress Tracking

    Chapter 50. Replication Progress Tracking

    +Chapter 50. Replication Progress Tracking

    Chapter 50. Replication Progress Tracking

    Replication origins are intended to make it easier to implement logical replication solutions on top of logical decoding. @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ to filter the logical decoding change stream based on the source. While less flexible, filtering via that callback is considerably more efficient than doing it in the output plugin. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/resources.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/resources.html index 32397d6..888a625 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/resources.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/resources.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -4. Further Information

    4. Further Information

    +4. Further Information

    4. Further Information

    Besides the documentation, that is, this book, there are other resources about PostgreSQL: @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@ up and contribute it. If you add features to the code, contribute them.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/role-attributes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/role-attributes.html index 8db141c..ac3b6a5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/role-attributes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/role-attributes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -22.2. Role Attributes

    22.2. Role Attributes

    +22.2. Role Attributes

    22.2. Role Attributes

    A database role can have a number of attributes that define its privileges and interact with the client authentication system. @@ -117,4 +117,4 @@ ALTER ROLE myname SET enable_indexscan TO off; Note that role-specific defaults attached to roles without LOGIN privilege are fairly useless, since they will never be invoked. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/role-membership.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/role-membership.html index 3f2150a..5302fcf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/role-membership.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/role-membership.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -22.3. Role Membership

    22.3. Role Membership

    +22.3. Role Membership

    22.3. Role Membership

    It is frequently convenient to group users together to ease management of privileges: that way, privileges can be granted to, or revoked from, a group as a whole. In PostgreSQL @@ -104,4 +104,4 @@ DROP ROLE name;

    Any memberships in the group role are automatically revoked (but the member roles are not otherwise affected). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/role-removal.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/role-removal.html index d444827..0f64eeb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/role-removal.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/role-removal.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -22.4. Dropping Roles

    22.4. Dropping Roles

    +22.4. Dropping Roles

    22.4. Dropping Roles

    Because roles can own database objects and can hold privileges to access other objects, dropping a role is often not just a matter of a quick DROP ROLE. Any objects owned by the role must @@ -51,4 +51,4 @@ DROP ROLE doomed_role; If DROP ROLE is attempted while dependent objects still remain, it will issue messages identifying which objects need to be reassigned or dropped. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-reindex.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-reindex.html index e6195e0..d3aa96c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-reindex.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-reindex.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -25.2. Routine Reindexing

    25.2. Routine Reindexing

    +25.2. Routine Reindexing

    25.2. Routine Reindexing

    In some situations it is worthwhile to rebuild indexes periodically with the REINDEX command or a series of individual rebuilding steps. @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ default, hence it is often preferable to execute it with its CONCURRENTLY option, which requires only a SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE lock. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-vacuuming.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-vacuuming.html index 88ca08b..1c39f6b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-vacuuming.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/routine-vacuuming.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -25.1. Routine Vacuuming

    25.1. Routine Vacuuming

    +25.1. Routine Vacuuming

    25.1. Routine Vacuuming

    PostgreSQL databases require periodic maintenance known as vacuuming. For many installations, it is sufficient to let vacuuming be performed by the autovacuum @@ -692,4 +692,4 @@ analyze threshold = analyze base threshold + analyze scale factor * number of tu Regularly running commands that acquire locks conflicting with a SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE lock (e.g., ANALYZE) can effectively prevent autovacuums from ever completing. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/row-estimation-examples.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/row-estimation-examples.html index 641970f..0bc6d75 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/row-estimation-examples.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/row-estimation-examples.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -75.1. Row Estimation Examples

    75.1. Row Estimation Examples

    +75.1. Row Estimation Examples

    75.1. Row Estimation Examples

    The examples shown below use tables in the PostgreSQL regression test database. The outputs shown are taken from version 8.3. @@ -396,4 +396,4 @@ rows = (outer_cardinality * inner_cardinality) * selectivity src/backend/optimizer/path/clausesel.c. The operator-specific selectivity functions are mostly found in src/backend/utils/adt/selfuncs.c. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rowtypes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rowtypes.html index a904f0f..86509ed 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rowtypes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rowtypes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -8.16. Composite Types

    8.16. Composite Types

    +8.16. Composite Types

    8.16. Composite Types

    A composite type represents the structure of a row or record; it is essentially just a list of field names and their data types. PostgreSQL allows composite types to be @@ -421,4 +421,4 @@ INSERT ... VALUES ('("\"\\")'); commands. In ROW, individual field values are written the same way they would be written when not members of a composite. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rule-system.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rule-system.html index 7d4f062..3ff1d3c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rule-system.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rule-system.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -52.4. The PostgreSQL Rule System

    52.4. The PostgreSQL Rule System

    +52.4. The PostgreSQL Rule System

    52.4. The PostgreSQL Rule System

    PostgreSQL supports a powerful rule system for the specification of views and ambiguous view updates. @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ rewriter are query trees, that is, there is no change in the representation or level of semantic detail in the trees. Rewriting can be thought of as a form of macro expansion. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-materializedviews.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-materializedviews.html index 899c987..d274922 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-materializedviews.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-materializedviews.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -41.3. Materialized Views

    41.3. Materialized Views

    +41.3. Materialized Views

    41.3. Materialized Views

    Materialized views in PostgreSQL use the rule system like views do, but persist the results in a table-like form. The main differences between: @@ -179,4 +179,4 @@ SELECT word FROM words ORDER BY word <-> 'caterpiler' LIMIT 10; If you can tolerate periodic update of the remote data to the local database, the performance benefit can be substantial. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-privileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-privileges.html index ddf23e4..643eb93 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-privileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-privileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -41.5. Rules and Privileges

    41.5. Rules and Privileges

    +41.5. Rules and Privileges

    41.5. Rules and Privileges

    Due to rewriting of queries by the PostgreSQL rule system, other tables/views than those used in the original query get accessed. When update rules are used, this can include write access @@ -157,4 +157,4 @@ CREATE VIEW phone_number WITH (security_barrier) AS the optimizer statistics, the choice of plan). If these types of "covert channel" attacks are of concern, it is probably unwise to grant any access to the data at all. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-status.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-status.html index 81ce991..4372ee8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-status.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-status.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -41.6. Rules and Command Status

    41.6. Rules and Command Status

    +41.6. Rules and Command Status

    41.6. Rules and Command Status

    The PostgreSQL server returns a command status string, such as INSERT 149592 1, for each command it receives. This is simple enough when there are no rules @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ that sets the command status in the second case, by giving it the alphabetically last rule name among the active rules, so that it gets applied last. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-triggers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-triggers.html index f46f65f..16961a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-triggers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-triggers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -41.7. Rules Versus Triggers

    41.7. Rules Versus Triggers

    +41.7. Rules Versus Triggers

    41.7. Rules Versus Triggers

    Many things that can be done using triggers can also be implemented using the PostgreSQL rule system. One of the things that cannot be implemented by @@ -175,4 +175,4 @@ Nestloop The summary is, rules will only be significantly slower than triggers if their actions result in large and badly qualified joins, a situation where the planner fails. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-update.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-update.html index 27d60c8..b1d6352 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-update.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-update.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -41.4. Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE

    41.4. Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE

    +41.4. Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE

    41.4. Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE

    Rules that are defined on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE are significantly different from the view rules described in the previous section. First, their CREATE @@ -747,4 +747,4 @@ SELECT * FROM shoelace; There are probably only a few situations out in the real world where such a construct is necessary. But it makes you feel comfortable that it works. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-views.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-views.html index 41bb926..a49c074 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-views.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules-views.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -41.2. Views and the Rule System

    41.2. Views and the Rule System

    +41.2. Views and the Rule System

    41.2. Views and the Rule System

    Views in PostgreSQL are implemented using the rule system. In fact, there is essentially no difference between: @@ -503,4 +503,4 @@ SELECT t1.a, t2.b, t1.ctid FROM t1, t2 WHERE t1.a = t2.a; triggers for the view, and the rewriter cannot automatically rewrite the query as an update on the underlying base relation, an error will be thrown because the executor cannot update a view as such. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules.html index 44bd352..e4a416c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/rules.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/rules.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 41. The Rule System

    Chapter 41. The Rule System

    +Chapter 41. The Rule System

    Chapter 41. The Rule System

    This chapter discusses the rule system in PostgreSQL. Production rule systems are conceptually simple, but there are many subtle points @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ such as query language procedures, views, and versions. The theoretical foundations and the power of this rule system are also discussed in [ston90b] and [ong90]. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-autovacuum.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-autovacuum.html index 91718f9..dd98f7d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-autovacuum.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-autovacuum.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.10. Automatic Vacuuming

    20.10. Automatic Vacuuming

    +20.10. Automatic Vacuuming

    20.10. Automatic Vacuuming

    These settings control the behavior of the autovacuum feature. Refer to Section 25.1.6 for more information. Note that many of these settings can be overridden on a per-table @@ -160,4 +160,4 @@ file or on the server command line; but the setting can be overridden for individual tables by changing table storage parameters. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-client.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-client.html index 7e65f65..d336666 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-client.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-client.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.11. Client Connection Defaults

    20.11. Client Connection Defaults

    20.11.1. Statement Behavior

    client_min_messages (enum) +20.11. Client Connection Defaults

    20.11. Client Connection Defaults

    20.11.1. Statement Behavior

    client_min_messages (enum)

    Controls which @@ -851,4 +851,4 @@ dynamic_library_path = 'C:\tools\postgresql;H:\my_project\lib;$libdir'

    Soft upper limit of the size of the set returned by GIN index scans. For more information see Section 70.5. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-compatible.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-compatible.html index b285411..05c8efa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-compatible.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-compatible.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility

    20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility

    20.13.1. Previous PostgreSQL Versions

    array_nulls (boolean) +20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility

    20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility

    20.13.1. Previous PostgreSQL Versions

    array_nulls (boolean)

    This controls whether the array input parser recognizes @@ -140,4 +140,4 @@ Thus, this option is not a general fix for bad programming.

    Refer to Section 9.2 for related information. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-connection.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-connection.html index 3faa9b4..3221314 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-connection.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-connection.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.3. Connections and Authentication

    20.3. Connections and Authentication

    20.3.1. Connection Settings

    listen_addresses (string) +20.3. Connections and Authentication

    20.3. Connections and Authentication

    20.3.1. Connection Settings

    listen_addresses (string)

    Specifies the TCP/IP address(es) on which the server is @@ -543,4 +543,4 @@

    This parameter can only be set in the postgresql.conf file or on the server command line. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-custom.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-custom.html index ef35e38..b029859 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-custom.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-custom.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.16. Customized Options

    20.16. Customized Options

    +20.16. Customized Options

    20.16. Customized Options

    This feature was designed to allow parameters not normally known to PostgreSQL to be added by add-on modules (such as procedural languages). This allows extension modules to be @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ those definitions. If there are any unrecognized placeholders that begin with its extension name, warnings are issued and those placeholders are removed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-developer.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-developer.html index f7fa53c..0492df8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-developer.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-developer.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.17. Developer Options

    20.17. Developer Options

    +20.17. Developer Options

    20.17. Developer Options

    The following parameters are intended for developer testing, and should never be used on a production database. However, some of them can be used to assist with the recovery of severely damaged @@ -374,4 +374,4 @@ LOG: CleanUpLock: deleting: lock(0xb7acd844) id(24688,24696,0,0,0,1) may however result in accumulation of useless files. This parameter can only be set in the postgresql.conf file or on the server command line. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-error-handling.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-error-handling.html index b6db726..eb93548 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-error-handling.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-error-handling.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.14. Error Handling

    20.14. Error Handling

    exit_on_error (boolean) +20.14. Error Handling

    20.14. Error Handling

    exit_on_error (boolean)

    If on, any error will terminate the current session. By default, @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@

    This parameter can only be set in the postgresql.conf file or on the server command line. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-file-locations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-file-locations.html index 67a2e84..ce2ab32 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-file-locations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-file-locations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.2. File Locations

    20.2. File Locations

    +20.2. File Locations

    20.2. File Locations

    In addition to the postgresql.conf file already mentioned, PostgreSQL uses two other manually-edited configuration files, which control @@ -71,4 +71,4 @@ When setting any of these parameters, a relative path will be interpreted with respect to the directory in which postgres is started. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-locks.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-locks.html index c17c875..bea09cc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-locks.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-locks.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.12. Lock Management

    20.12. Lock Management

    deadlock_timeout (integer) +20.12. Lock Management

    20.12. Lock Management

    deadlock_timeout (integer) @@ -81,4 +81,4 @@ before the lock is promoted to covering the whole page. The default is 2. This parameter can only be set in the postgresql.conf file or on the server command line. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-logging.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-logging.html index e84abaa..77226a7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-logging.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-logging.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.8. Error Reporting and Logging

    20.8. Error Reporting and Logging

    20.8.1. Where to Log

    log_destination (string) +20.8. Error Reporting and Logging

    20.8. Error Reporting and Logging

    20.8.1. Where to Log

    log_destination (string)

    PostgreSQL supports several methods @@ -935,4 +935,4 @@ COPY postgres_log FROM '/full/path/to/logfile.csv' WITH csv; overhead for updating the process title. Only superusers and users with the appropriate SET privilege can change this setting. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-preset.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-preset.html index ae4d3da..02db1f1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-preset.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-preset.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.15. Preset Options

    20.15. Preset Options

    +20.15. Preset Options

    20.15. Preset Options

    The following parameters are read-only. As such, they have been excluded from the sample postgresql.conf file. These options report @@ -149,4 +149,4 @@

    Reports the size of write ahead log segments. The default value is 16MB. See Section 30.5 for more information. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-query.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-query.html index 71b2ccd..a4d1cdb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-query.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-query.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.7. Query Planning

    20.7. Query Planning

    20.7.1. Planner Method Configuration

    +20.7. Query Planning

    20.7. Query Planning

    20.7.1. Planner Method Configuration

    These configuration parameters provide a crude method of influencing the query plans chosen by the query optimizer. If the default plan chosen by the optimizer for a particular query @@ -541,4 +541,4 @@ SELECT * FROM parent WHERE key = 2400; has low fan-out from one step to the next, as for example in shortest-path queries. Graph analytics queries may benefit from larger-than-default values. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-replication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-replication.html index 85c2656..a01d4e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-replication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-replication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.6. Replication

    20.6. Replication

    +20.6. Replication

    20.6. Replication

    These settings control the behavior of the built-in streaming replication feature (see Section 27.2.5). Servers will be either a @@ -559,4 +559,4 @@ ANY num_sync ( postgresql.conf file or on the server command line. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-resource.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-resource.html index f184318..7a0ad07 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-resource.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-resource.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.4. Resource Consumption

    20.4. Resource Consumption

    20.4.1. Memory

    shared_buffers (integer) +20.4. Resource Consumption

    20.4. Resource Consumption

    20.4.1. Memory

    shared_buffers (integer)

    Sets the amount of memory the database server uses for shared @@ -711,4 +711,4 @@ affected by this setting, such as system catalogs. For such tables this setting will neither reduce bloat nor create a possibility of a snapshot too old error on scanning. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-short.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-short.html index e48cf46..0b2be8d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-short.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-short.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.18. Short Options

    20.18. Short Options

    +20.18. Short Options

    20.18. Short Options

    For convenience there are also single letter command-line option switches available for some parameters. They are described in Table 20.4. Some of these @@ -21,4 +21,4 @@ enable_tidscan = off -Ffsync = off-h xlisten_addresses = x-ilisten_addresses = '*'-k xunix_socket_directories = x-lssl = on-N xmax_connections = x-Oallow_system_table_mods = on-p xport = x-Pignore_system_indexes = on-slog_statement_stats = on-S xwork_mem = x-tpa, -tpl, -telog_parser_stats = on, log_planner_stats = on, - log_executor_stats = on-W xpost_auth_delay = x


    \ No newline at end of file + log_executor_stats = on-W xpost_auth_delay = x
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-statistics.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-statistics.html index e9f9279..6067e71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-statistics.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-statistics.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.9. Run-time Statistics

    20.9. Run-time Statistics

    20.9.1. Cumulative Query and Index Statistics

    +20.9. Run-time Statistics

    20.9. Run-time Statistics

    20.9.1. Cumulative Query and Index Statistics

    These parameters control the server-wide cumulative statistics system. When enabled, the data that is collected can be accessed via the pg_stat and pg_statio @@ -146,4 +146,4 @@ default. Only superusers and users with the appropriate SET privilege can change these settings. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-wal.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-wal.html index 5103255..83b3d80 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-wal.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config-wal.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -20.5. Write Ahead Log

    20.5. Write Ahead Log

    +20.5. Write Ahead Log

    20.5. Write Ahead Log

    For additional information on tuning these settings, see Section 30.5.

    20.5.1. Settings

    wal_level (enum) @@ -827,4 +827,4 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows In any case, if a recovery target is configured but the archive recovery ends before the target is reached, the server will shut down with a fatal error. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config.html index b3781f6..1aae27b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime-config.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -Chapter 20. Server Configuration

    Chapter 20. Server Configuration

    Table of Contents

    20.1. Setting Parameters
    20.1.1. Parameter Names and Values
    20.1.2. Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File
    20.1.3. Parameter Interaction via SQL
    20.1.4. Parameter Interaction via the Shell
    20.1.5. Managing Configuration File Contents
    20.2. File Locations
    20.3. Connections and Authentication
    20.3.1. Connection Settings
    20.3.2. Authentication
    20.3.3. SSL
    20.4. Resource Consumption
    20.4.1. Memory
    20.4.2. Disk
    20.4.3. Kernel Resource Usage
    20.4.4. Cost-based Vacuum Delay
    20.4.5. Background Writer
    20.4.6. Asynchronous Behavior
    20.5. Write Ahead Log
    20.5.1. Settings
    20.5.2. Checkpoints
    20.5.3. Archiving
    20.5.4. Recovery
    20.5.5. Archive Recovery
    20.5.6. Recovery Target
    20.6. Replication
    20.6.1. Sending Servers
    20.6.2. Primary Server
    20.6.3. Standby Servers
    20.6.4. Subscribers
    20.7. Query Planning
    20.7.1. Planner Method Configuration
    20.7.2. Planner Cost Constants
    20.7.3. Genetic Query Optimizer
    20.7.4. Other Planner Options
    20.8. Error Reporting and Logging
    20.8.1. Where to Log
    20.8.2. When to Log
    20.8.3. What to Log
    20.8.4. Using CSV-Format Log Output
    20.8.5. Using JSON-Format Log Output
    20.8.6. Process Title
    20.9. Run-time Statistics
    20.9.1. Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
    20.9.2. Statistics Monitoring
    20.10. Automatic Vacuuming
    20.11. Client Connection Defaults
    20.11.1. Statement Behavior
    20.11.2. Locale and Formatting
    20.11.3. Shared Library Preloading
    20.11.4. Other Defaults
    20.12. Lock Management
    20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility
    20.13.1. Previous PostgreSQL Versions
    20.13.2. Platform and Client Compatibility
    20.14. Error Handling
    20.15. Preset Options
    20.16. Customized Options
    20.17. Developer Options
    20.18. Short Options

    +Chapter 20. Server Configuration

    Chapter 20. Server Configuration

    Table of Contents

    20.1. Setting Parameters
    20.1.1. Parameter Names and Values
    20.1.2. Parameter Interaction via the Configuration File
    20.1.3. Parameter Interaction via SQL
    20.1.4. Parameter Interaction via the Shell
    20.1.5. Managing Configuration File Contents
    20.2. File Locations
    20.3. Connections and Authentication
    20.3.1. Connection Settings
    20.3.2. Authentication
    20.3.3. SSL
    20.4. Resource Consumption
    20.4.1. Memory
    20.4.2. Disk
    20.4.3. Kernel Resource Usage
    20.4.4. Cost-based Vacuum Delay
    20.4.5. Background Writer
    20.4.6. Asynchronous Behavior
    20.5. Write Ahead Log
    20.5.1. Settings
    20.5.2. Checkpoints
    20.5.3. Archiving
    20.5.4. Recovery
    20.5.5. Archive Recovery
    20.5.6. Recovery Target
    20.6. Replication
    20.6.1. Sending Servers
    20.6.2. Primary Server
    20.6.3. Standby Servers
    20.6.4. Subscribers
    20.7. Query Planning
    20.7.1. Planner Method Configuration
    20.7.2. Planner Cost Constants
    20.7.3. Genetic Query Optimizer
    20.7.4. Other Planner Options
    20.8. Error Reporting and Logging
    20.8.1. Where to Log
    20.8.2. When to Log
    20.8.3. What to Log
    20.8.4. Using CSV-Format Log Output
    20.8.5. Using JSON-Format Log Output
    20.8.6. Process Title
    20.9. Run-time Statistics
    20.9.1. Cumulative Query and Index Statistics
    20.9.2. Statistics Monitoring
    20.10. Automatic Vacuuming
    20.11. Client Connection Defaults
    20.11.1. Statement Behavior
    20.11.2. Locale and Formatting
    20.11.3. Shared Library Preloading
    20.11.4. Other Defaults
    20.12. Lock Management
    20.13. Version and Platform Compatibility
    20.13.1. Previous PostgreSQL Versions
    20.13.2. Platform and Client Compatibility
    20.14. Error Handling
    20.15. Preset Options
    20.16. Customized Options
    20.17. Developer Options
    20.18. Short Options

    There are many configuration parameters that affect the behavior of the database system. In the first section of this chapter we describe how to interact with configuration parameters. The subsequent sections discuss each parameter in detail. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime.html index a892217..94f2840 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/runtime.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 19. Server Setup and Operation

    Chapter 19. Server Setup and Operation

    +Chapter 19. Server Setup and Operation

    \ No newline at end of file + Microsoft Windows SDK Home 19.1. The PostgreSQL User Account
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sasl-authentication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sasl-authentication.html index aa8d232..dd0e364 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sasl-authentication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sasl-authentication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -55.3. SASL Authentication

    55.3. SASL Authentication

    +55.3. SASL Authentication

    55.3. SASL Authentication

    SASL is a framework for authentication in connection-oriented protocols. At the moment, PostgreSQL implements two SASL authentication mechanisms, SCRAM-SHA-256 and SCRAM-SHA-256-PLUS. More @@ -101,4 +101,4 @@ Server sends an AuthenticationSASLFinal message, with the SCRAM server-final-message, followed immediately by an AuthenticationOk message. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/seg.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/seg.html index e6e1b4b..d6b358c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/seg.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/seg.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.39. seg

    F.39. seg

    +F.39. seg

    F.39. seg

    This module implements a data type seg for representing line segments, or floating point intervals. seg can represent uncertainty in the interval endpoints, @@ -219,4 +219,4 @@ postgres=> select '10(+-)1'::seg as seg; myself to create my own world and live undisturbed in it. And I would like to acknowledge my gratitude to Argonne Lab and to the U.S. Department of Energy for the years of faithful support of my database research. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sepgsql.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sepgsql.html index 94488fd..f6768d3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sepgsql.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sepgsql.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.40. sepgsql

    F.40. sepgsql

    +F.40. sepgsql

    F.40. sepgsql

    sepgsql is a loadable module that supports label-based mandatory access control (MAC) based on SELinux security policy. @@ -517,4 +517,4 @@ ERROR: SELinux: security policy violation It focuses primarily on Fedora, but is not limited to Fedora.

    F.40.9. Author

    KaiGai Kohei -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/server-programming.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/server-programming.html index 5c180b8..4a1cc11 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/server-programming.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/server-programming.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Part V. Server Programming

    Part V. Server Programming

    +Part V. Server Programming

    Part V. Server Programming

    This part is about extending the server functionality with user-defined functions, data types, triggers, etc. These are advanced topics which should probably be approached only after all @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ general issues concerning server-side programming languages. It is essential to read at least the earlier sections of Chapter 38 (covering functions) before diving into the material about server-side programming languages. -

    Table of Contents

    38. Extending SQL
    38.1. How Extensibility Works
    38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System
    38.3. User-Defined Functions
    38.4. User-Defined Procedures
    38.5. Query Language (SQL) Functions
    38.6. Function Overloading
    38.7. Function Volatility Categories
    38.8. Procedural Language Functions
    38.9. Internal Functions
    38.10. C-Language Functions
    38.11. Function Optimization Information
    38.12. User-Defined Aggregates
    38.13. User-Defined Types
    38.14. User-Defined Operators
    38.15. Operator Optimization Information
    38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes
    38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension
    38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure
    39. Triggers
    39.1. Overview of Trigger Behavior
    39.2. Visibility of Data Changes
    39.3. Writing Trigger Functions in C
    39.4. A Complete Trigger Example
    40. Event Triggers
    40.1. Overview of Event Trigger Behavior
    40.2. Event Trigger Firing Matrix
    40.3. Writing Event Trigger Functions in C
    40.4. A Complete Event Trigger Example
    40.5. A Table Rewrite Event Trigger Example
    41. The Rule System
    41.1. The Query Tree
    41.2. Views and the Rule System
    41.3. Materialized Views
    41.4. Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE
    41.5. Rules and Privileges
    41.6. Rules and Command Status
    41.7. Rules Versus Triggers
    42. Procedural Languages
    42.1. Installing Procedural Languages
    43. PL/pgSQLSQL Procedural Language
    43.1. Overview
    43.2. Structure of PL/pgSQL
    43.3. Declarations
    43.4. Expressions
    43.5. Basic Statements
    43.6. Control Structures
    43.7. Cursors
    43.8. Transaction Management
    43.9. Errors and Messages
    43.10. Trigger Functions
    43.11. PL/pgSQL under the Hood
    43.12. Tips for Developing in PL/pgSQL
    43.13. Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
    44. PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
    44.1. Overview
    44.2. PL/Tcl Functions and Arguments
    44.3. Data Values in PL/Tcl
    44.4. Global Data in PL/Tcl
    44.5. Database Access from PL/Tcl
    44.6. Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
    44.7. Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
    44.8. Error Handling in PL/Tcl
    44.9. Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl
    44.10. Transaction Management
    44.11. PL/Tcl Configuration
    44.12. Tcl Procedure Names
    45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
    45.1. PL/Perl Functions and Arguments
    45.2. Data Values in PL/Perl
    45.3. Built-in Functions
    45.4. Global Values in PL/Perl
    45.5. Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
    45.6. PL/Perl Triggers
    45.7. PL/Perl Event Triggers
    45.8. PL/Perl Under the Hood
    46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language
    46.1. PL/Python Functions
    46.2. Data Values
    46.3. Sharing Data
    46.4. Anonymous Code Blocks
    46.5. Trigger Functions
    46.6. Database Access
    46.7. Explicit Subtransactions
    46.8. Transaction Management
    46.9. Utility Functions
    46.10. Python 2 vs. Python 3
    46.11. Environment Variables
    47. Server Programming Interface
    47.1. Interface Functions
    47.2. Interface Support Functions
    47.3. Memory Management
    47.4. Transaction Management
    47.5. Visibility of Data Changes
    47.6. Examples
    48. Background Worker Processes
    49. Logical Decoding
    49.1. Logical Decoding Examples
    49.2. Logical Decoding Concepts
    49.3. Streaming Replication Protocol Interface
    49.4. Logical Decoding SQL Interface
    49.5. System Catalogs Related to Logical Decoding
    49.6. Logical Decoding Output Plugins
    49.7. Logical Decoding Output Writers
    49.8. Synchronous Replication Support for Logical Decoding
    49.9. Streaming of Large Transactions for Logical Decoding
    49.10. Two-phase Commit Support for Logical Decoding
    50. Replication Progress Tracking
    51. Archive Modules
    51.1. Initialization Functions
    51.2. Archive Module Callbacks
    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table of Contents

    38. Extending SQL
    38.1. How Extensibility Works
    38.2. The PostgreSQL Type System
    38.3. User-Defined Functions
    38.4. User-Defined Procedures
    38.5. Query Language (SQL) Functions
    38.6. Function Overloading
    38.7. Function Volatility Categories
    38.8. Procedural Language Functions
    38.9. Internal Functions
    38.10. C-Language Functions
    38.11. Function Optimization Information
    38.12. User-Defined Aggregates
    38.13. User-Defined Types
    38.14. User-Defined Operators
    38.15. Operator Optimization Information
    38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes
    38.17. Packaging Related Objects into an Extension
    38.18. Extension Building Infrastructure
    39. Triggers
    39.1. Overview of Trigger Behavior
    39.2. Visibility of Data Changes
    39.3. Writing Trigger Functions in C
    39.4. A Complete Trigger Example
    40. Event Triggers
    40.1. Overview of Event Trigger Behavior
    40.2. Event Trigger Firing Matrix
    40.3. Writing Event Trigger Functions in C
    40.4. A Complete Event Trigger Example
    40.5. A Table Rewrite Event Trigger Example
    41. The Rule System
    41.1. The Query Tree
    41.2. Views and the Rule System
    41.3. Materialized Views
    41.4. Rules on INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE
    41.5. Rules and Privileges
    41.6. Rules and Command Status
    41.7. Rules Versus Triggers
    42. Procedural Languages
    42.1. Installing Procedural Languages
    43. PL/pgSQLSQL Procedural Language
    43.1. Overview
    43.2. Structure of PL/pgSQL
    43.3. Declarations
    43.4. Expressions
    43.5. Basic Statements
    43.6. Control Structures
    43.7. Cursors
    43.8. Transaction Management
    43.9. Errors and Messages
    43.10. Trigger Functions
    43.11. PL/pgSQL under the Hood
    43.12. Tips for Developing in PL/pgSQL
    43.13. Porting from Oracle PL/SQL
    44. PL/Tcl — Tcl Procedural Language
    44.1. Overview
    44.2. PL/Tcl Functions and Arguments
    44.3. Data Values in PL/Tcl
    44.4. Global Data in PL/Tcl
    44.5. Database Access from PL/Tcl
    44.6. Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
    44.7. Event Trigger Functions in PL/Tcl
    44.8. Error Handling in PL/Tcl
    44.9. Explicit Subtransactions in PL/Tcl
    44.10. Transaction Management
    44.11. PL/Tcl Configuration
    44.12. Tcl Procedure Names
    45. PL/Perl — Perl Procedural Language
    45.1. PL/Perl Functions and Arguments
    45.2. Data Values in PL/Perl
    45.3. Built-in Functions
    45.4. Global Values in PL/Perl
    45.5. Trusted and Untrusted PL/Perl
    45.6. PL/Perl Triggers
    45.7. PL/Perl Event Triggers
    45.8. PL/Perl Under the Hood
    46. PL/Python — Python Procedural Language
    46.1. PL/Python Functions
    46.2. Data Values
    46.3. Sharing Data
    46.4. Anonymous Code Blocks
    46.5. Trigger Functions
    46.6. Database Access
    46.7. Explicit Subtransactions
    46.8. Transaction Management
    46.9. Utility Functions
    46.10. Python 2 vs. Python 3
    46.11. Environment Variables
    47. Server Programming Interface
    47.1. Interface Functions
    47.2. Interface Support Functions
    47.3. Memory Management
    47.4. Transaction Management
    47.5. Visibility of Data Changes
    47.6. Examples
    48. Background Worker Processes
    49. Logical Decoding
    49.1. Logical Decoding Examples
    49.2. Logical Decoding Concepts
    49.3. Streaming Replication Protocol Interface
    49.4. Logical Decoding SQL Interface
    49.5. System Catalogs Related to Logical Decoding
    49.6. Logical Decoding Output Plugins
    49.7. Logical Decoding Output Writers
    49.8. Synchronous Replication Support for Logical Decoding
    49.9. Streaming of Large Transactions for Logical Decoding
    49.10. Two-phase Commit Support for Logical Decoding
    50. Replication Progress Tracking
    51. Archive Modules
    51.1. Initialization Functions
    51.2. Archive Module Callbacks
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/server-shutdown.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/server-shutdown.html index 61b0827..a32398f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/server-shutdown.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/server-shutdown.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.5. Shutting Down the Server

    19.5. Shutting Down the Server

    +19.5. Shutting Down the Server

    19.5. Shutting Down the Server

    There are several ways to shut down the database server. Under the hood, they all reduce to sending a signal to the supervisor postgres process. @@ -63,4 +63,4 @@ $ kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postm continue, use pg_terminate_backend() (see Table 9.88) or send a SIGTERM signal to the child process associated with the session. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/server-start.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/server-start.html index ca959a9..d5b158e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/server-start.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/server-start.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.3. Starting the Database Server

    19.3. Starting the Database Server

    +19.3. Starting the Database Server

    19.3. Starting the Database Server

    Before anyone can access the database, you must start the database server. The database server program is called postgres. @@ -256,4 +256,4 @@ psql: error: connection to server on socket "/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432" failed: No such such as Connection timed out might indicate more fundamental problems, like lack of network connectivity, or a firewall blocking the connection. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/source-conventions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/source-conventions.html index 6e4d362..3e5bb51 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/source-conventions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/source-conventions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -56.4. Miscellaneous Coding Conventions

    56.4. Miscellaneous Coding Conventions

    C Standard

    +56.4. Miscellaneous Coding Conventions

    56.4. Miscellaneous Coding Conventions

    C Standard

    Code in PostgreSQL should only rely on language features available in the C99 standard. That means a conforming C99 compiler has to be able to compile postgres, at least aside @@ -103,4 +103,4 @@ handle_sighup(SIGNAL_ARGS)

     paramInfo->paramFetch(paramInfo, paramId);
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/source-format.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/source-format.html index 19adbb1..5e20c62 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/source-format.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/source-format.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -56.1. Formatting

    56.1. Formatting

    +56.1. Formatting

    56.1. Formatting

    Source code formatting uses 4 column tab spacing, with tabs preserved (i.e., tabs are not expanded to spaces). Each logical indentation level is one additional tab stop. @@ -60,4 +60,4 @@ more -x4 less -x4

    to make them show tabs appropriately. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/source.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/source.html index 9e6c58d..91e94ae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/source.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/source.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 56. PostgreSQL Coding Conventions \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 56. PostgreSQL Coding Conventions \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sourcerepo.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sourcerepo.html index 61aa752..1da8f8e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sourcerepo.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sourcerepo.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Appendix I. The Source Code Repository

    Appendix I. The Source Code Repository

    +Appendix I. The Source Code Repository

    Appendix I. The Source Code Repository

    The PostgreSQL source code is stored and managed using the Git version control system. A public mirror of the master repository is available; it is updated within a minute @@ -14,4 +14,4 @@ to build from a distribution tarball, because the files that these tools are used to build are included in the tarball. Other tool requirements are the same as shown in Section 17.2. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-builtin-opclasses.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-builtin-opclasses.html index c1430a9..43acd60 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-builtin-opclasses.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-builtin-opclasses.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -69.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    69.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    +69.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    69.2. Built-in Operator Classes

    The core PostgreSQL distribution includes the SP-GiST operator classes shown in Table 69.1. @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ poly_ops operator classes support the <-> ordering operator, which enables the k-nearest neighbor (k-NN) search over indexed point or polygon data sets. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-examples.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-examples.html index 65f6e16..e926579 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-examples.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-examples.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -69.5. Examples

    69.5. Examples

    +69.5. Examples

    69.5. Examples

    The PostgreSQL source distribution includes several examples of index operator classes for SP-GiST, as described in Table 69.1. Look into src/backend/access/spgist/ and src/backend/utils/adt/ to see the code. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-extensibility.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-extensibility.html index 177cb3d..4fdf4ec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-extensibility.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-extensibility.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -69.3. Extensibility

    69.3. Extensibility

    +69.3. Extensibility

    69.3. Extensibility

    SP-GiST offers an interface with a high level of abstraction, requiring the access method developer to implement only methods specific to a given data type. The SP-GiST core @@ -618,4 +618,4 @@ LANGUAGE C STRICT; If the indexed column is of a collatable data type, the index collation will be passed to all the support methods, using the standard PG_GET_COLLATION() mechanism. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-implementation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-implementation.html index fb96869..7ed226b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-implementation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-implementation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -69.4. Implementation

    69.4. Implementation

    +69.4. Implementation

    69.4. Implementation

    This section covers implementation details and other tricks that are useful for implementers of SP-GiST operator classes to know. @@ -87,4 +87,4 @@ all equivalent. This may or may not require any special-case code, depending on how much the inner_consistent function normally assumes about the meaning of the nodes. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-intro.html index b676795..02e98e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -69.1. Introduction

    69.1. Introduction

    +69.1. Introduction

    69.1. Introduction

    SP-GiST is an abbreviation for space-partitioned GiST. SP-GiST supports partitioned search trees, which facilitate development of a wide range of different @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ Sigaev and Oleg Bartunov, and there is more information on their web site. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist.html index f504e43..d098df0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spgist.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 69. SP-GiST Indexes \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 69. SP-GiST Indexes \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-examples.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-examples.html index 5f8e6aa..c48a1a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-examples.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-examples.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -47.6. Examples

    47.6. Examples

    +47.6. Examples

    47.6. Examples

    This section contains a very simple example of SPI usage. The C function execq takes an SQL command as its first argument and a row count as its second, executes the command @@ -167,4 +167,4 @@ INSERT 0 2 6 -- 3 rows (2 + 1 just inserted) * 2 (x in second row) (4 rows)

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface-support.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface-support.html index 57d0af8..53513e7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface-support.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface-support.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -47.2. Interface Support Functions

    47.2. Interface Support Functions

    SPI_fname — determine the column name for the specified column number
    SPI_fnumber — determine the column number for the specified column name
    SPI_getvalue — return the string value of the specified column
    SPI_getbinval — return the binary value of the specified column
    SPI_gettype — return the data type name of the specified column
    SPI_gettypeid — return the data type OID of the specified column
    SPI_getrelname — return the name of the specified relation
    SPI_getnspname — return the namespace of the specified relation
    SPI_result_code_string — return error code as string

    +47.2. Interface Support Functions

    47.2. Interface Support Functions

    SPI_fname — determine the column name for the specified column number
    SPI_fnumber — determine the column number for the specified column name
    SPI_getvalue — return the string value of the specified column
    SPI_getbinval — return the binary value of the specified column
    SPI_gettype — return the data type name of the specified column
    SPI_gettypeid — return the data type OID of the specified column
    SPI_getrelname — return the name of the specified relation
    SPI_getnspname — return the namespace of the specified relation
    SPI_result_code_string — return error code as string

    The functions described here provide an interface for extracting information from result sets returned by SPI_execute and other SPI functions.

    All functions described in this section can be used by both connected and unconnected C functions. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface.html index 4dc6b67..b222e45 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-interface.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ -47.1. Interface Functions

    47.1. Interface Functions

    SPI_connect — connect a C function to the SPI manager
    SPI_finish — disconnect a C function from the SPI manager
    SPI_execute — execute a command
    SPI_exec — execute a read/write command
    SPI_execute_extended — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_execute_with_args — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_prepare — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_cursor — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_extended — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_params — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_getargcount — return the number of arguments needed by a statement +47.1. Interface Functions

    47.1. Interface Functions

    SPI_connect — connect a C function to the SPI manager
    SPI_finish — disconnect a C function from the SPI manager
    SPI_execute — execute a command
    SPI_exec — execute a read/write command
    SPI_execute_extended — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_execute_with_args — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_prepare — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_cursor — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_extended — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_params — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_getargcount — return the number of arguments needed by a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_getargtypeid — return the data type OID for an argument of a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_is_cursor_plan — return true if a statement prepared by SPI_prepare can be used with - SPI_cursor_open
    SPI_execute_plan — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_execute_plan_extended — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_execp — execute a statement in read/write mode
    SPI_cursor_open — set up a cursor using a statement created with SPI_prepare
    SPI_cursor_open_with_args — set up a cursor using a query and parameters
    SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist — set up a cursor using parameters
    SPI_cursor_parse_open — set up a cursor using a query string and parameters
    SPI_cursor_find — find an existing cursor by name
    SPI_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor
    SPI_cursor_move — move a cursor
    SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor
    SPI_scroll_cursor_move — move a cursor
    SPI_cursor_close — close a cursor
    SPI_keepplan — save a prepared statement
    SPI_saveplan — save a prepared statement
    SPI_register_relation — make an ephemeral named relation available by name in SPI queries
    SPI_unregister_relation — remove an ephemeral named relation from the registry
    SPI_register_trigger_data — make ephemeral trigger data available in SPI queries
    \ No newline at end of file + SPI_cursor_open
    SPI_execute_plan — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_execute_plan_extended — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_execp — execute a statement in read/write mode
    SPI_cursor_open — set up a cursor using a statement created with SPI_prepare
    SPI_cursor_open_with_args — set up a cursor using a query and parameters
    SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist — set up a cursor using parameters
    SPI_cursor_parse_open — set up a cursor using a query string and parameters
    SPI_cursor_find — find an existing cursor by name
    SPI_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor
    SPI_cursor_move — move a cursor
    SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor
    SPI_scroll_cursor_move — move a cursor
    SPI_cursor_close — close a cursor
    SPI_keepplan — save a prepared statement
    SPI_saveplan — save a prepared statement
    SPI_register_relation — make an ephemeral named relation available by name in SPI queries
    SPI_unregister_relation — remove an ephemeral named relation from the registry
    SPI_register_trigger_data — make ephemeral trigger data available in SPI queries
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-memory.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-memory.html index 4081783..b88ca1e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-memory.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-memory.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -47.3. Memory Management

    47.3. Memory Management

    SPI_palloc — allocate memory in the upper executor context
    SPI_repalloc — reallocate memory in the upper executor context
    SPI_pfree — free memory in the upper executor context
    SPI_copytuple — make a copy of a row in the upper executor context
    SPI_returntuple — prepare to return a tuple as a Datum
    SPI_modifytuple — create a row by replacing selected fields of a given row
    SPI_freetuple — free a row allocated in the upper executor context
    SPI_freetuptable — free a row set created by SPI_execute or a similar +47.3. Memory Management

    47.3. Memory Management

    SPI_palloc — allocate memory in the upper executor context
    SPI_repalloc — reallocate memory in the upper executor context
    SPI_pfree — free memory in the upper executor context
    SPI_copytuple — make a copy of a row in the upper executor context
    SPI_returntuple — prepare to return a tuple as a Datum
    SPI_modifytuple — create a row by replacing selected fields of a given row
    SPI_freetuple — free a row allocated in the upper executor context
    SPI_freetuptable — free a row set created by SPI_execute or a similar function
    SPI_freeplan — free a previously saved prepared statement

    PostgreSQL allocates memory within @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@ SPI_finish) the current context is restored to the upper executor context, and all allocations made in the C function memory context are freed and cannot be used any more. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-realloc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-realloc.html index 530ea69..979a739 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-realloc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-realloc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_repalloc

    SPI_repalloc

    SPI_repalloc — reallocate memory in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

    +SPI_repalloc

    SPI_repalloc

    SPI_repalloc — reallocate memory in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

     void * SPI_repalloc(void * pointer, Size size)
     

    Description

    SPI_repalloc changes the size of a memory @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ void * SPI_repalloc(void * pointer, Size

    Return Value

    pointer to new storage space of specified size with the contents copied from the existing area -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-commit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-commit.html index b857555..21c4a9f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-commit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-commit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_commit

    SPI_commit

    SPI_commit, SPI_commit_and_chain — commit the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +SPI_commit

    SPI_commit

    SPI_commit, SPI_commit_and_chain — commit the current transaction

    Synopsis

     void SPI_commit(void)
     
     void SPI_commit_and_chain(void)
    @@ -20,4 +20,4 @@ void SPI_commit_and_chain(void)
       

    These functions can only be executed if the SPI connection has been set as nonatomic in the call to SPI_connect_ext. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-connect.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-connect.html index f657819..8b89e4b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-connect.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-connect.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_connect

    SPI_connect

    SPI_connect, SPI_connect_ext — connect a C function to the SPI manager

    Synopsis

    +SPI_connect

    SPI_connect

    SPI_connect, SPI_connect_ext — connect a C function to the SPI manager

    Synopsis

     int SPI_connect(void)
     
     int SPI_connect_ext(int options)
    @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ int SPI_connect_ext(int options)
           on success
          

    SPI_ERROR_CONNECT

    on error -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-copytuple.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-copytuple.html index 2ebb159..a0f8041 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-copytuple.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-copytuple.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_copytuple

    SPI_copytuple

    SPI_copytuple — make a copy of a row in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

    +SPI_copytuple

    SPI_copytuple

    SPI_copytuple — make a copy of a row in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

     HeapTuple SPI_copytuple(HeapTuple row)
     

    Description

    SPI_copytuple makes a copy of a row in the @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ HeapTuple SPI_copytuple(HeapTuple row)

    Return Value

    the copied row, or NULL on error (see SPI_result for an error indication) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-close.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-close.html index 14c6fd2..0ff25e8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-close.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-close.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_close

    SPI_cursor_close

    SPI_cursor_close — close a cursor

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_close

    SPI_cursor_close

    SPI_cursor_close — close a cursor

    Synopsis

     void SPI_cursor_close(Portal portal)
     

    Description

    SPI_cursor_close closes a previously created @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ void SPI_cursor_close(Portal portal) invoked if it is desirable to release resources sooner.

    Arguments

    Portal portal

    portal containing the cursor -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-fetch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-fetch.html index a47f8a4..f4425f1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-fetch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-fetch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_fetch

    SPI_cursor_fetch

    SPI_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_fetch

    SPI_cursor_fetch

    SPI_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor

    Synopsis

     void SPI_cursor_fetch(Portal portal, bool forward, long count)
     

    Description

    SPI_cursor_fetch fetches some rows from a @@ -19,4 +19,4 @@ void SPI_cursor_fetch(Portal portal, boo

    Notes

    Fetching backward may fail if the cursor's plan was not created with the CURSOR_OPT_SCROLL option. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-find.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-find.html index d3a19f3..d546854 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-find.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-find.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_find

    SPI_cursor_find

    SPI_cursor_find — find an existing cursor by name

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_find

    SPI_cursor_find

    SPI_cursor_find — find an existing cursor by name

    Synopsis

     Portal SPI_cursor_find(const char * name)
     

    Description

    SPI_cursor_find finds an existing portal by @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ Portal SPI_cursor_find(const char * name to other SPI functions, they can defend themselves against such cases, but caution is appropriate when directly inspecting the Portal. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-move.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-move.html index 6d6f419..8ad4d5e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-move.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-move.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_move

    SPI_cursor_move

    SPI_cursor_move — move a cursor

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_move

    SPI_cursor_move

    SPI_cursor_move — move a cursor

    Synopsis

     void SPI_cursor_move(Portal portal, bool forward, long count)
     

    Description

    SPI_cursor_move skips over some number of rows @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ void SPI_cursor_move(Portal portal, bool

    Notes

    Moving backward may fail if the cursor's plan was not created with the CURSOR_OPT_SCROLL option. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-args.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-args.html index e02a37d..948fdfe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-args.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-args.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_open_with_args

    SPI_cursor_open_with_args

    SPI_cursor_open_with_args — set up a cursor using a query and parameters

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_open_with_args

    SPI_cursor_open_with_args

    SPI_cursor_open_with_args — set up a cursor using a query and parameters

    Synopsis

     Portal SPI_cursor_open_with_args(const char *name,
                                      const char *command,
                                      int nargs, Oid *argtypes,
    @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@ Portal SPI_cursor_open_with_args(const char *name

    Return Value

    Pointer to portal containing the cursor. Note there is no error return convention; any error will be reported via elog. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-paramlist.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-paramlist.html index 1fb599a..f239378 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-paramlist.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open-with-paramlist.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist

    SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist

    SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist — set up a cursor using parameters

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist

    SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist

    SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist — set up a cursor using parameters

    Synopsis

     Portal SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist(const char *name,
                                           SPIPlanPtr plan,
                                           ParamListInfo params,
    @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ Portal SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist(const char *na
          

    bool read_only

    true for read-only execution

    Return Value

    Pointer to portal containing the cursor. Note there is no error return convention; any error will be reported via elog. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open.html index ec028a9..93fc56f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-open.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_open

    SPI_cursor_open

    SPI_cursor_open — set up a cursor using a statement created with SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_open

    SPI_cursor_open

    SPI_cursor_open — set up a cursor using a statement created with SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

     Portal SPI_cursor_open(const char * name, SPIPlanPtr plan,
                            Datum * values, const char * nulls,
                            bool read_only)
    @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@ Portal SPI_cursor_open(const char * name
          

    bool read_only

    true for read-only execution

    Return Value

    Pointer to portal containing the cursor. Note there is no error return convention; any error will be reported via elog. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-parse-open.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-parse-open.html index 2cdad11..807a03b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-parse-open.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-cursor-parse-open.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_cursor_parse_open

    SPI_cursor_parse_open

    SPI_cursor_parse_open — set up a cursor using a query string and parameters

    Synopsis

    +SPI_cursor_parse_open

    SPI_cursor_parse_open

    SPI_cursor_parse_open — set up a cursor using a query string and parameters

    Synopsis

     Portal SPI_cursor_parse_open(const char *name,
                                  const char *command,
                                  const SPIParseOpenOptions * options)
    @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@ Portal SPI_cursor_parse_open(const char *name
          

    bool read_only

    true for read-only execution

    Return Value

    Pointer to portal containing the cursor. Note there is no error return convention; any error will be reported via elog. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-exec.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-exec.html index ae5ad01..52a35dc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-exec.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-exec.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_exec

    SPI_exec

    SPI_exec — execute a read/write command

    Synopsis

    +SPI_exec

    SPI_exec

    SPI_exec — execute a read/write command

    Synopsis

     int SPI_exec(const char * command, long count)
     

    Description

    SPI_exec is the same as @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ int SPI_exec(const char * command, long or 0 for no limit

    Return Value

    See SPI_execute. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execp.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execp.html index 23faf7b..17b26bc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execp.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execp.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_execp

    SPI_execp

    SPI_execp — execute a statement in read/write mode

    Synopsis

    +SPI_execp

    SPI_execp

    SPI_execp — execute a statement in read/write mode

    Synopsis

     int SPI_execp(SPIPlanPtr plan, Datum * values, const char * nulls, long count)
     

    Description

    SPI_execp is the same as @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ int SPI_execp(SPIPlanPtr plan, Datum * < SPI_processed and SPI_tuptable are set as in SPI_execute if successful. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-extended.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-extended.html index 3f59e37..4b99c54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-extended.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-extended.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_execute_extended

    SPI_execute_extended

    SPI_execute_extended — execute a command with out-of-line parameters

    Synopsis

    +SPI_execute_extended

    SPI_execute_extended

    SPI_execute_extended — execute a command with out-of-line parameters

    Synopsis

     int SPI_execute_extended(const char *command,
                              const SPIExecuteOptions * options)
     

    Description

    @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ int SPI_execute_extended(const char *command< SPI_tuptable is set to NULL. If a tuple count is required, the caller's DestReceiver object must calculate it. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-extended.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-extended.html index 05a2463..f6cb2a3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-extended.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-extended.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_execute_plan_extended

    SPI_execute_plan_extended

    SPI_execute_plan_extended — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

    +SPI_execute_plan_extended

    SPI_execute_plan_extended

    SPI_execute_plan_extended — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

     int SPI_execute_plan_extended(SPIPlanPtr plan,
                                   const SPIExecuteOptions * options)
     

    Description

    @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ int SPI_execute_plan_extended(SPIPlanPtr plan SPI_tuptable is set to NULL. If a tuple count is required, the caller's DestReceiver object must calculate it. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-with-paramlist.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-with-paramlist.html index 6c8a625..309d083 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-with-paramlist.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan-with-paramlist.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist

    SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist

    SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

    +SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist

    SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist

    SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

     int SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist(SPIPlanPtr plan,
                                         ParamListInfo params,
                                         bool read_only,
    @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@ int SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist(SPIPlanPtr plan<
        SPI_processed and
        SPI_tuptable are set as in
        SPI_execute_plan if successful.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan.html index 05b4a45..317bc72 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-plan.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_execute_plan

    SPI_execute_plan

    SPI_execute_plan — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

    +SPI_execute_plan

    SPI_execute_plan

    SPI_execute_plan — execute a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

     int SPI_execute_plan(SPIPlanPtr plan, Datum * values, const char * nulls,
                          bool read_only, long count)
     

    Description

    @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@ int SPI_execute_plan(SPIPlanPtr plan, Da SPI_processed and SPI_tuptable are set as in SPI_execute if successful. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-with-args.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-with-args.html index cdae2f2..d32f6d4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-with-args.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute-with-args.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_execute_with_args

    SPI_execute_with_args

    SPI_execute_with_args — execute a command with out-of-line parameters

    Synopsis

    +SPI_execute_with_args

    SPI_execute_with_args

    SPI_execute_with_args — execute a command with out-of-line parameters

    Synopsis

     int SPI_execute_with_args(const char *command,
                               int nargs, Oid *argtypes,
                               Datum *values, const char *nulls,
    @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@ int SPI_execute_with_args(const char *command
        SPI_processed and
        SPI_tuptable are set as in
        SPI_execute if successful.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute.html index bd93b62..817746c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-execute.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_execute

    SPI_execute

    SPI_execute — execute a command

    Synopsis

    +SPI_execute

    SPI_execute

    SPI_execute — execute a command

    Synopsis

     int SPI_execute(const char * command, bool read_only, long count)
     

    Description

    SPI_execute executes the specified SQL command @@ -176,4 +176,4 @@ typedef struct SPITupleTable C function variables if you need to access the result table of SPI_execute or another query-execution function across later calls. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-finish.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-finish.html index c56c351..39a44a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-finish.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-finish.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_finish

    SPI_finish

    SPI_finish — disconnect a C function from the SPI manager

    Synopsis

    +SPI_finish

    SPI_finish

    SPI_finish — disconnect a C function from the SPI manager

    Synopsis

     int SPI_finish(void)
     

    Description

    SPI_finish closes an existing connection to @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ int SPI_finish(void) if properly disconnected

    SPI_ERROR_UNCONNECTED

    if called from an unconnected C function -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fname.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fname.html index 3ee00fd..82adfc8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fname.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fname.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_fname

    SPI_fname

    SPI_fname — determine the column name for the specified column number

    Synopsis

    +SPI_fname

    SPI_fname

    SPI_fname — determine the column name for the specified column number

    Synopsis

     char * SPI_fname(TupleDesc rowdesc, int colnumber)
     

    Description

    SPI_fname returns a copy of the column name of the @@ -14,4 +14,4 @@ char * SPI_fname(TupleDesc rowdesc, int colnumber is out of range. SPI_result set to SPI_ERROR_NOATTRIBUTE on error. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fnumber.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fnumber.html index b4e2a65..cff9ab4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fnumber.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-fnumber.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_fnumber

    SPI_fnumber

    SPI_fnumber — determine the column number for the specified column name

    Synopsis

    +SPI_fnumber

    SPI_fnumber

    SPI_fnumber — determine the column number for the specified column name

    Synopsis

     int SPI_fnumber(TupleDesc rowdesc, const char * colname)
     

    Description

    SPI_fnumber returns the column number for the @@ -19,4 +19,4 @@ int SPI_fnumber(TupleDesc rowdesc, const Column number (count starts at 1 for user-defined columns), or SPI_ERROR_NOATTRIBUTE if the named column was not found. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freeplan.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freeplan.html index 6482eaa..3bf4ea3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freeplan.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freeplan.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_freeplan

    SPI_freeplan

    SPI_freeplan — free a previously saved prepared statement

    Synopsis

    +SPI_freeplan

    SPI_freeplan

    SPI_freeplan — free a previously saved prepared statement

    Synopsis

     int SPI_freeplan(SPIPlanPtr plan)
     

    Description

    SPI_freeplan releases a prepared statement @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ int SPI_freeplan(SPIPlanPtr plan) 0 on success; SPI_ERROR_ARGUMENT if plan is NULL or invalid -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetuple.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetuple.html index 3f99549..71b0c48 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetuple.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetuple.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_freetuple

    SPI_freetuple

    SPI_freetuple — free a row allocated in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

    +SPI_freetuple

    SPI_freetuple

    SPI_freetuple — free a row allocated in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

     void SPI_freetuple(HeapTuple row)
     

    Description

    SPI_freetuple frees a row previously allocated @@ -10,4 +10,4 @@ void SPI_freetuple(HeapTuple row) compatibility of existing code.

    Arguments

    HeapTuple row

    row to free -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetupletable.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetupletable.html index fde1df8..1d2c944 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetupletable.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-freetupletable.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_freetuptable

    SPI_freetuptable

    SPI_freetuptable — free a row set created by SPI_execute or a similar +SPI_freetuptable

    SPI_freetuptable

    SPI_freetuptable — free a row set created by SPI_execute or a similar function

    Synopsis

     void SPI_freetuptable(SPITupleTable * tuptable)
     

    Description

    @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ void SPI_freetuptable(SPITupleTable * tuptable

    Arguments

    SPITupleTable * tuptable

    pointer to row set to free, or NULL to do nothing -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargcount.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargcount.html index 95792cd..56b2050 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargcount.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargcount.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_getargcount

    SPI_getargcount

    SPI_getargcount — return the number of arguments needed by a statement +SPI_getargcount

    SPI_getargcount

    SPI_getargcount — return the number of arguments needed by a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

     int SPI_getargcount(SPIPlanPtr plan)
     

    Description

    @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ int SPI_getargcount(SPIPlanPtr plan) If the plan is NULL or invalid, SPI_result is set to SPI_ERROR_ARGUMENT and -1 is returned. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargtypeid.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargtypeid.html index 4cf8c64..dc50c3c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargtypeid.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getargtypeid.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_getargtypeid

    SPI_getargtypeid

    SPI_getargtypeid — return the data type OID for an argument of +SPI_getargtypeid

    SPI_getargtypeid

    SPI_getargtypeid — return the data type OID for an argument of a statement prepared by SPI_prepare

    Synopsis

     Oid SPI_getargtypeid(SPIPlanPtr plan, int argIndex)
     

    Description

    @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ Oid SPI_getargtypeid(SPIPlanPtr plan, in plan, SPI_result is set to SPI_ERROR_ARGUMENT and InvalidOid is returned. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getbinval.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getbinval.html index 282e3b3..7c97182 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getbinval.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getbinval.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_getbinval

    SPI_getbinval

    SPI_getbinval — return the binary value of the specified column

    Synopsis

    +SPI_getbinval

    SPI_getbinval

    SPI_getbinval — return the binary value of the specified column

    Synopsis

     Datum SPI_getbinval(HeapTuple row, TupleDesc rowdesc, int colnumber,
                         bool * isnull)
     

    Description

    @@ -24,4 +24,4 @@ Datum SPI_getbinval(HeapTuple row, Tuple

    SPI_result is set to SPI_ERROR_NOATTRIBUTE on error. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getnspname.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getnspname.html index 2cf3e72..59bd3f6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getnspname.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getnspname.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_getnspname

    SPI_getnspname

    SPI_getnspname — return the namespace of the specified relation

    Synopsis

    +SPI_getnspname

    SPI_getnspname

    SPI_getnspname — return the namespace of the specified relation

    Synopsis

     char * SPI_getnspname(Relation rel)
     

    Description

    SPI_getnspname returns a copy of the name of @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ char * SPI_getnspname(Relation rel) input relation

    Return Value

    The name of the specified relation's namespace. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getrelname.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getrelname.html index c970e83..050c46d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getrelname.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getrelname.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_getrelname

    SPI_getrelname

    SPI_getrelname — return the name of the specified relation

    Synopsis

    +SPI_getrelname

    SPI_getrelname

    SPI_getrelname — return the name of the specified relation

    Synopsis

     char * SPI_getrelname(Relation rel)
     

    Description

    SPI_getrelname returns a copy of the name of the @@ -9,4 +9,4 @@ char * SPI_getrelname(Relation rel) input relation

    Return Value

    The name of the specified relation. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettype.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettype.html index 4b5bff1..d448fc2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettype.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettype.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_gettype

    SPI_gettype

    SPI_gettype — return the data type name of the specified column

    Synopsis

    +SPI_gettype

    SPI_gettype

    SPI_gettype — return the data type name of the specified column

    Synopsis

     char * SPI_gettype(TupleDesc rowdesc, int colnumber)
     

    Description

    SPI_gettype returns a copy of the data type name of the @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ char * SPI_gettype(TupleDesc rowdesc, in The data type name of the specified column, or NULL on error. SPI_result is set to SPI_ERROR_NOATTRIBUTE on error. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettypeid.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettypeid.html index 004598f..c582fde 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettypeid.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-gettypeid.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_gettypeid

    SPI_gettypeid

    SPI_gettypeid — return the data type OID of the specified column

    Synopsis

    +SPI_gettypeid

    SPI_gettypeid

    SPI_gettypeid — return the data type OID of the specified column

    Synopsis

     Oid SPI_gettypeid(TupleDesc rowdesc, int colnumber)
     

    Description

    SPI_gettypeid returns the @@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ Oid SPI_gettypeid(TupleDesc rowdesc, int or InvalidOid on error. On error, SPI_result is set to SPI_ERROR_NOATTRIBUTE. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getvalue.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getvalue.html index 182d1c6..11d2939 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getvalue.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-getvalue.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_getvalue

    SPI_getvalue

    SPI_getvalue — return the string value of the specified column

    Synopsis

    +SPI_getvalue

    SPI_getvalue

    SPI_getvalue — return the string value of the specified column

    Synopsis

     char * SPI_getvalue(HeapTuple row, TupleDesc rowdesc, int colnumber)
     

    Description

    SPI_getvalue returns the string representation @@ -22,4 +22,4 @@ char * SPI_getvalue(HeapTuple row, Tuple SPI_ERROR_NOATTRIBUTE), or no output function is available (SPI_result is set to SPI_ERROR_NOOUTFUNC). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-is-cursor-plan.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-is-cursor-plan.html index 51a0f3b..21daaa7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-is-cursor-plan.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-is-cursor-plan.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_is_cursor_plan

    SPI_is_cursor_plan

    SPI_is_cursor_plan — return true if a statement +SPI_is_cursor_plan

    SPI_is_cursor_plan

    SPI_is_cursor_plan — return true if a statement prepared by SPI_prepare can be used with SPI_cursor_open

    Synopsis

     bool SPI_is_cursor_plan(SPIPlanPtr plan)
    @@ -24,4 +24,4 @@ bool SPI_is_cursor_plan(SPIPlanPtr plan)
         or if called when not connected to SPI), then
         SPI_result is set to a suitable error code
         and false is returned.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-keepplan.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-keepplan.html index 804f22c..6cad334 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-keepplan.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-keepplan.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_keepplan

    SPI_keepplan

    SPI_keepplan — save a prepared statement

    Synopsis

    +SPI_keepplan

    SPI_keepplan

    SPI_keepplan — save a prepared statement

    Synopsis

     int SPI_keepplan(SPIPlanPtr plan)
     

    Description

    SPI_keepplan saves a passed statement (prepared by @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ int SPI_keepplan(SPIPlanPtr plan) The passed-in statement is relocated to permanent storage by means of pointer adjustment (no data copying is required). If you later wish to delete it, use SPI_freeplan on it. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-modifytuple.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-modifytuple.html index 96bc78d..912c92e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-modifytuple.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-modifytuple.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_modifytuple

    SPI_modifytuple

    SPI_modifytuple — create a row by replacing selected fields of a given row

    Synopsis

    +SPI_modifytuple

    SPI_modifytuple

    SPI_modifytuple — create a row by replacing selected fields of a given row

    Synopsis

     HeapTuple SPI_modifytuple(Relation rel, HeapTuple row, int ncols,
                               int * colnum, Datum * values, const char * nulls)
     

    Description

    @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@ HeapTuple SPI_modifytuple(Relation rel,

    SPI_ERROR_UNCONNECTED

    if SPI is not active

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-palloc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-palloc.html index 298c605..2199a80 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-palloc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-palloc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_palloc

    SPI_palloc

    SPI_palloc — allocate memory in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

    +SPI_palloc

    SPI_palloc

    SPI_palloc — allocate memory in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

     void * SPI_palloc(Size size)
     

    Description

    SPI_palloc allocates memory in the upper @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ void * SPI_palloc(Size size) size in bytes of storage to allocate

    Return Value

    pointer to new storage space of the specified size -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-pfree.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-pfree.html index 3120281..992ced6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-pfree.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-pfree.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_pfree

    SPI_pfree

    SPI_pfree — free memory in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

    +SPI_pfree

    SPI_pfree

    SPI_pfree — free memory in the upper executor context

    Synopsis

     void SPI_pfree(void * pointer)
     

    Description

    SPI_pfree frees memory previously allocated @@ -11,4 +11,4 @@ void SPI_pfree(void * pointer) compatibility of existing code.

    Arguments

    void * pointer

    pointer to existing storage to free -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-cursor.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-cursor.html index 9975f88..d480255 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-cursor.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-cursor.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_prepare_cursor

    SPI_prepare_cursor

    SPI_prepare_cursor — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

    +SPI_prepare_cursor

    SPI_prepare_cursor

    SPI_prepare_cursor — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

     SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare_cursor(const char * command, int nargs,
                                   Oid * argtypes, int cursorOptions)
     

    Description

    @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare_cursor(const char * commandCURSOR_OPT_GENERIC_PLAN, and CURSOR_OPT_CUSTOM_PLAN. Note in particular that CURSOR_OPT_HOLD is ignored. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-extended.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-extended.html index c517aa2..92c4a88 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-extended.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-extended.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_prepare_extended

    SPI_prepare_extended

    SPI_prepare_extended — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

    +SPI_prepare_extended

    SPI_prepare_extended

    SPI_prepare_extended — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

     SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare_extended(const char * command,
                                     const SPIPrepareOptions * options)
     

    Description

    @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare_extended(const char * command

    Return Value

    SPI_prepare_extended has the same return conventions as SPI_prepare. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-params.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-params.html index c367fd8..04992bf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-params.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare-params.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_prepare_params

    SPI_prepare_params

    SPI_prepare_params — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

    +SPI_prepare_params

    SPI_prepare_params

    SPI_prepare_params — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

     SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare_params(const char * command,
                                   ParserSetupHook parserSetup,
                                   void * parserSetupArg,
    @@ -24,4 +24,4 @@ SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare_params(const char * command

    Return Value

    SPI_prepare_params has the same return conventions as SPI_prepare. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare.html index 1183414..7ce72d4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-prepare.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_prepare

    SPI_prepare

    SPI_prepare — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

    +SPI_prepare

    SPI_prepare

    SPI_prepare — prepare a statement, without executing it yet

    Synopsis

     SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare(const char * command, int nargs, Oid * argtypes)
     

    Description

    SPI_prepare creates and returns a prepared @@ -81,4 +81,4 @@ SPIPlanPtr SPI_prepare(const char * command

    The name SPIPlanPtr is somewhat historical, since the data structure no longer necessarily contains an execution plan. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-relation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-relation.html index 3466d37..c9136aa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-relation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-relation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_register_relation

    SPI_register_relation

    SPI_register_relation — make an ephemeral named relation available by name in SPI queries

    Synopsis

    +SPI_register_relation

    SPI_register_relation

    SPI_register_relation — make an ephemeral named relation available by name in SPI queries

    Synopsis

     int SPI_register_relation(EphemeralNamedRelation enr)
     

    Description

    SPI_register_relation makes an ephemeral named @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ int SPI_register_relation(EphemeralNamedRelation enr if the name specified in the name field of enr is already registered for this connection

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-trigger-data.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-trigger-data.html index 7693763..c692ddf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-trigger-data.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-register-trigger-data.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_register_trigger_data

    SPI_register_trigger_data

    SPI_register_trigger_data — make ephemeral trigger data available in SPI queries

    Synopsis

    +SPI_register_trigger_data

    SPI_register_trigger_data

    SPI_register_trigger_data — make ephemeral trigger data available in SPI queries

    Synopsis

     int SPI_register_trigger_data(TriggerData *tdata)
     

    Description

    SPI_register_trigger_data makes any ephemeral @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@ int SPI_register_trigger_data(TriggerData *tdata

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-result-code-string.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-result-code-string.html index 67988cb..898ed11 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-result-code-string.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-result-code-string.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_result_code_string

    SPI_result_code_string

    SPI_result_code_string — return error code as string

    Synopsis

    +SPI_result_code_string

    SPI_result_code_string

    SPI_result_code_string — return error code as string

    Synopsis

     const char * SPI_result_code_string(int code);
     

    Description

    SPI_result_code_string returns a string representation @@ -9,4 +9,4 @@ const char * SPI_result_code_string(int code< result code

    Return Value

    A string representation of the result code. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-returntuple.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-returntuple.html index 026070b..70606b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-returntuple.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-returntuple.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_returntuple

    SPI_returntuple

    SPI_returntuple — prepare to return a tuple as a Datum

    Synopsis

    +SPI_returntuple

    SPI_returntuple

    SPI_returntuple — prepare to return a tuple as a Datum

    Synopsis

     HeapTupleHeader SPI_returntuple(HeapTuple row, TupleDesc rowdesc)
     

    Description

    SPI_returntuple makes a copy of a row in @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ HeapTupleHeader SPI_returntuple(HeapTuple row HeapTupleHeader pointing to copied row, or NULL on error (see SPI_result for an error indication) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-rollback.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-rollback.html index 91ae900..07d7ce0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-rollback.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-rollback.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_rollback

    SPI_rollback

    SPI_rollback, SPI_rollback_and_chain — abort the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +SPI_rollback

    SPI_rollback

    SPI_rollback, SPI_rollback_and_chain — abort the current transaction

    Synopsis

     void SPI_rollback(void)
     
     void SPI_rollback_and_chain(void)
    @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ void SPI_rollback_and_chain(void)
       

    These functions can only be executed if the SPI connection has been set as nonatomic in the call to SPI_connect_ext. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-saveplan.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-saveplan.html index e3a825d..ed041c4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-saveplan.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-saveplan.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_saveplan

    SPI_saveplan

    SPI_saveplan — save a prepared statement

    Synopsis

    +SPI_saveplan

    SPI_saveplan

    SPI_saveplan — save a prepared statement

    Synopsis

     SPIPlanPtr SPI_saveplan(SPIPlanPtr plan)
     

    Description

    SPI_saveplan copies a passed statement (prepared by @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ SPIPlanPtr SPI_saveplan(SPIPlanPtr plan) In most cases, SPI_keepplan is preferred to this function, since it accomplishes largely the same result without needing to physically copy the prepared statement's data structures. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-fetch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-fetch.html index ddd25b3..58d5617 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-fetch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-fetch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch

    SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch

    SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor

    Synopsis

    +SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch

    SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch

    SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch — fetch some rows from a cursor

    Synopsis

     void SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch(Portal portal, FetchDirection direction,
                                  long count)
     

    Description

    @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ void SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch(Portal portalFETCH_FORWARD may fail if the cursor's plan was not created with the CURSOR_OPT_SCROLL option. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-move.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-move.html index ed37da8..24ab443 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-move.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-scroll-cursor-move.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_scroll_cursor_move

    SPI_scroll_cursor_move

    SPI_scroll_cursor_move — move a cursor

    Synopsis

    +SPI_scroll_cursor_move

    SPI_scroll_cursor_move

    SPI_scroll_cursor_move — move a cursor

    Synopsis

     void SPI_scroll_cursor_move(Portal portal, FetchDirection direction,
                                 long count)
     

    Description

    @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ void SPI_scroll_cursor_move(Portal portalFETCH_FORWARD may fail if the cursor's plan was not created with the CURSOR_OPT_SCROLL option. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-start-transaction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-start-transaction.html index 7367fbf..eda9142 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-start-transaction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-start-transaction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_start_transaction

    SPI_start_transaction

    SPI_start_transaction — obsolete function

    Synopsis

    +SPI_start_transaction

    SPI_start_transaction

    SPI_start_transaction — obsolete function

    Synopsis

     void SPI_start_transaction(void)
     

    Description

    SPI_start_transaction does nothing, and exists @@ -8,4 +8,4 @@ void SPI_start_transaction(void) be required after calling SPI_commit or SPI_rollback, but now those functions start a new transaction automatically. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-unregister-relation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-unregister-relation.html index 453d69a..e5cbfde 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-unregister-relation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-spi-unregister-relation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SPI_unregister_relation

    SPI_unregister_relation

    SPI_unregister_relation — remove an ephemeral named relation from the registry

    Synopsis

    +SPI_unregister_relation

    SPI_unregister_relation

    SPI_unregister_relation — remove an ephemeral named relation from the registry

    Synopsis

     int SPI_unregister_relation(const char * name)
     

    Description

    SPI_unregister_relation removes an ephemeral named @@ -24,4 +24,4 @@ int SPI_unregister_relation(const char * name if name is not found in the registry for the current connection

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-transaction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-transaction.html index 2c2eab5..3bf14fd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-transaction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-transaction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -47.4. Transaction Management

    47.4. Transaction Management

    SPI_commit — commit the current transaction
    SPI_rollback — abort the current transaction
    SPI_start_transaction — obsolete function

    +47.4. Transaction Management

    47.4. Transaction Management

    SPI_commit — commit the current transaction
    SPI_rollback — abort the current transaction
    SPI_start_transaction — obsolete function

    It is not possible to run transaction control commands such as COMMIT and ROLLBACK through SPI functions such as SPI_execute. There are, however, @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ command, taking the context of the CALL invocation into account. SPI-using procedures implemented in C can implement the same logic, but the details of that are beyond the scope of this documentation. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-visibility.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-visibility.html index 101334d..9f58a80 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-visibility.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi-visibility.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -47.5. Visibility of Data Changes

    47.5. Visibility of Data Changes

    +47.5. Visibility of Data Changes

    47.5. Visibility of Data Changes

    The following rules govern the visibility of data changes in functions that use SPI (or any other C function): @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ INSERT INTO a SELECT * FROM a;

    The next section contains an example that illustrates the application of these rules. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi.html index e681931..1e1cf8f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/spi.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/spi.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 47. Server Programming Interface

    Chapter 47. Server Programming Interface

    Table of Contents

    47.1. Interface Functions
    SPI_connect — connect a C function to the SPI manager
    SPI_finish — disconnect a C function from the SPI manager
    SPI_execute — execute a command
    SPI_exec — execute a read/write command
    SPI_execute_extended — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_execute_with_args — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_prepare — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_cursor — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_extended — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_params — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_getargcount — return the number of arguments needed by a statement +Chapter 47. Server Programming Interface

    Chapter 47. Server Programming Interface

    Table of Contents

    47.1. Interface Functions
    SPI_connect — connect a C function to the SPI manager
    SPI_finish — disconnect a C function from the SPI manager
    SPI_execute — execute a command
    SPI_exec — execute a read/write command
    SPI_execute_extended — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_execute_with_args — execute a command with out-of-line parameters
    SPI_prepare — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_cursor — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_extended — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_prepare_params — prepare a statement, without executing it yet
    SPI_getargcount — return the number of arguments needed by a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_getargtypeid — return the data type OID for an argument of a statement prepared by SPI_prepare
    SPI_is_cursor_plan — return true if a statement prepared by SPI_prepare can be used with @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@

    Source code files that use SPI must include the header file executor/spi.h. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-abort.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-abort.html index f85a92d..db2909f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-abort.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-abort.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ABORT

    ABORT

    ABORT — abort the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +ABORT

    ABORT

    ABORT — abort the current transaction

    Synopsis

     ABORT [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ AND [ NO ] CHAIN ]
     

    Description

    ABORT rolls back the current transaction and causes @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ ABORT; This command is a PostgreSQL extension present for historical reasons. ROLLBACK is the equivalent standard SQL command. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteraggregate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteraggregate.html index fb1de03..18c2839 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteraggregate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteraggregate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER AGGREGATE

    ALTER AGGREGATE

    ALTER AGGREGATE — change the definition of an aggregate function

    Synopsis

    +ALTER AGGREGATE

    ALTER AGGREGATE

    ALTER AGGREGATE — change the definition of an aggregate function

    Synopsis

     ALTER AGGREGATE name ( aggregate_signature ) RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER AGGREGATE name ( aggregate_signature )
                     OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
    @@ -80,4 +80,4 @@ ALTER AGGREGATE mypercentile(float8, integer) SET SCHEMA myschema;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER AGGREGATE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altercollation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altercollation.html index 1293dce..5c1b9a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altercollation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altercollation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER COLLATION

    ALTER COLLATION

    ALTER COLLATION — change the definition of a collation

    Synopsis

    +ALTER COLLATION

    ALTER COLLATION

    ALTER COLLATION — change the definition of a collation

    Synopsis

     ALTER COLLATION name REFRESH VERSION
     
     ALTER COLLATION name RENAME TO new_name
    @@ -95,4 +95,4 @@ ALTER COLLATION "en_US" OWNER TO joe;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER COLLATION statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterconversion.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterconversion.html index 7f840f2..ceabd3b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterconversion.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterconversion.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER CONVERSION

    ALTER CONVERSION

    ALTER CONVERSION — change the definition of a conversion

    Synopsis

    +ALTER CONVERSION

    ALTER CONVERSION

    ALTER CONVERSION — change the definition of a conversion

    Synopsis

     ALTER CONVERSION name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER CONVERSION name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
     ALTER CONVERSION name SET SCHEMA new_schema
    @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@ ALTER CONVERSION iso_8859_1_to_utf8 OWNER TO joe;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER CONVERSION statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdatabase.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdatabase.html index 94ef74b..cbbbe2d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdatabase.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdatabase.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER DATABASE

    ALTER DATABASE

    ALTER DATABASE — change a database

    Synopsis

    +ALTER DATABASE

    ALTER DATABASE

    ALTER DATABASE — change a database

    Synopsis

     ALTER DATABASE name [ [ WITH ] option [ ... ] ]
     
     where option can be:
    @@ -109,4 +109,4 @@ ALTER DATABASE test SET enable_indexscan TO off;
     

    Compatibility

    The ALTER DATABASE statement is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdefaultprivileges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdefaultprivileges.html index ce7f496..31669d8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdefaultprivileges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdefaultprivileges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES

    ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES

    ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES — define default access privileges

    Synopsis

    +ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES

    ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES

    ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES — define default access privileges

    Synopsis

     ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES
         [ FOR { ROLE | USER } target_role [, ...] ]
         [ IN SCHEMA schema_name [, ...] ]
    @@ -160,4 +160,4 @@ ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES IN SCHEMA public REVOKE EXECUTE ON FUNCTIONS FROM PUBLI
       

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES statement in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    GRANT, REVOKE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    GRANT, REVOKE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdomain.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdomain.html index d8bcb6e..bf054ea 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdomain.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterdomain.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER DOMAIN

    ALTER DOMAIN

    ALTER DOMAIN — +ALTER DOMAIN

    ALTER DOMAIN

    ALTER DOMAIN — change the definition of a domain

    Synopsis

     ALTER DOMAIN name
    @@ -149,4 +149,4 @@ ALTER DOMAIN zipcode SET SCHEMA customers;
        PostgreSQL extensions.  The NOT VALID
        clause of the ADD CONSTRAINT variant is also a
        PostgreSQL extension.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altereventtrigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altereventtrigger.html index c580e0b..647d0a5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altereventtrigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altereventtrigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER EVENT TRIGGER

    ALTER EVENT TRIGGER

    ALTER EVENT TRIGGER — change the definition of an event trigger

    Synopsis

    +ALTER EVENT TRIGGER

    ALTER EVENT TRIGGER

    ALTER EVENT TRIGGER — change the definition of an event trigger

    Synopsis

     ALTER EVENT TRIGGER name DISABLE
     ALTER EVENT TRIGGER name ENABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ]
     ALTER EVENT TRIGGER name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
    @@ -15,11 +15,11 @@ ALTER EVENT TRIGGER name RENAME TO 
    new_name

    The new name of the event trigger. -

    DISABLE/ENABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ] TRIGGER

    +

    DISABLE/ENABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ]

    These forms configure the firing of event triggers. A disabled trigger is still known to the system, but is not executed when its triggering event occurs. See also session_replication_role.

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER EVENT TRIGGER statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterextension.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterextension.html index 3f709d4..1732026 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterextension.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterextension.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER EXTENSION

    ALTER EXTENSION

    ALTER EXTENSION — +ALTER EXTENSION

    ALTER EXTENSION

    ALTER EXTENSION — change the definition of an extension

    Synopsis

     ALTER EXTENSION name UPDATE [ TO new_version ]
    @@ -138,4 +138,4 @@ ALTER EXTENSION hstore ADD FUNCTION populate_record(anyelement, hstore);
     

    Compatibility

    ALTER EXTENSION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigndatawrapper.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigndatawrapper.html index 843019d..7ee1c70 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigndatawrapper.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigndatawrapper.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — change the definition of a foreign-data wrapper

    Synopsis

    +ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — change the definition of a foreign-data wrapper

    Synopsis

     ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER name
         [ HANDLER handler_function | NO HANDLER ]
         [ VALIDATOR validator_function | NO VALIDATOR ]
    @@ -53,7 +53,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER name RENAME
        Change a foreign-data wrapper dbi, add
        option foo, drop bar:
     

    -ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi OPTIONS (ADD foo '1', DROP 'bar');
    +ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi OPTIONS (ADD foo '1', DROP bar);
     

    Change the foreign-data wrapper dbi validator @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi VALIDATOR bob.myvalidator; 9075-9 (SQL/MED), except that the HANDLER, VALIDATOR, OWNER TO, and RENAME clauses are extensions. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigntable.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigntable.html index f49de80..a2036d2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigntable.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterforeigntable.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER FOREIGN TABLE

    ALTER FOREIGN TABLE

    ALTER FOREIGN TABLE — change the definition of a foreign table

    Synopsis

    +ALTER FOREIGN TABLE

    ALTER FOREIGN TABLE

    ALTER FOREIGN TABLE — change the definition of a foreign table

    Synopsis

     ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] [ ONLY ] name [ * ]
         action [, ... ]
     ALTER FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] [ ONLY ] name [ * ]
    @@ -233,4 +233,4 @@ ALTER FOREIGN TABLE myschema.distributors OPTIONS (ADD opt1 'value', SET opt2 'v
        ALTER FOREIGN TABLE DROP COLUMN can be used to drop the only
        column of a foreign table, leaving a zero-column table.  This is an
        extension of SQL, which disallows zero-column foreign tables.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterfunction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterfunction.html index 54944e3..f066e55 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterfunction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterfunction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER FUNCTION

    ALTER FUNCTION

    ALTER FUNCTION — change the definition of a function

    Synopsis

    +ALTER FUNCTION

    ALTER FUNCTION

    ALTER FUNCTION — change the definition of a function

    Synopsis

     ALTER FUNCTION name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ]
         action [ ... ] [ RESTRICT ]
     ALTER FUNCTION name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ]
    @@ -171,4 +171,4 @@ ALTER FUNCTION check_password(text) RESET search_path;
        or change the owner, schema, or volatility of a function. The standard also
        requires the RESTRICT key word, which is optional in
        PostgreSQL.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altergroup.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altergroup.html index 50c0ed7..0341c3f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altergroup.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altergroup.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER GROUP

    ALTER GROUP

    ALTER GROUP — change role name or membership

    Synopsis

    +ALTER GROUP

    ALTER GROUP

    ALTER GROUP — change role name or membership

    Synopsis

     ALTER GROUP role_specification ADD USER user_name [, ... ]
     ALTER GROUP role_specification DROP USER user_name [, ... ]
     
    @@ -50,4 +50,4 @@ ALTER GROUP workers DROP USER beth;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER GROUP statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterindex.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterindex.html index fb1d3ef..a7873ec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterindex.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterindex.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER INDEX

    ALTER INDEX

    ALTER INDEX — change the definition of an index

    Synopsis

    +ALTER INDEX

    ALTER INDEX

    ALTER INDEX — change the definition of an index

    Synopsis

     ALTER INDEX [ IF EXISTS ] name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER INDEX [ IF EXISTS ] name SET TABLESPACE tablespace_name
     ALTER INDEX name ATTACH PARTITION index_name
    @@ -135,4 +135,4 @@ ALTER INDEX coord_idx ALTER COLUMN 3 SET STATISTICS 1000;
     

    Compatibility

    ALTER INDEX is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlanguage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlanguage.html index bbd6ead..23403a1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlanguage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlanguage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER LANGUAGE

    ALTER LANGUAGE

    ALTER LANGUAGE — change the definition of a procedural language

    Synopsis

    +ALTER LANGUAGE

    ALTER LANGUAGE

    ALTER LANGUAGE — change the definition of a procedural language

    Synopsis

     ALTER [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
     

    Description

    @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ ALTER [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE name OWN

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER LANGUAGE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlargeobject.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlargeobject.html index 75d442a..d48a929 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlargeobject.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterlargeobject.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER LARGE OBJECT

    ALTER LARGE OBJECT

    ALTER LARGE OBJECT — change the definition of a large object

    Synopsis

    +ALTER LARGE OBJECT

    ALTER LARGE OBJECT

    ALTER LARGE OBJECT — change the definition of a large object

    Synopsis

     ALTER LARGE OBJECT large_object_oid OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
     

    Description

    ALTER LARGE OBJECT changes the definition of a @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ ALTER LARGE OBJECT large_object_oid OW

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER LARGE OBJECT statement in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    Chapter 35
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    Chapter 35
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altermaterializedview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altermaterializedview.html index 97abf62..31955e4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altermaterializedview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altermaterializedview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW

    ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW

    ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW — change the definition of a materialized view

    Synopsis

    +ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW

    ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW

    ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW — change the definition of a materialized view

    Synopsis

     ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] name
         action [, ... ]
     ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW name
    @@ -72,4 +72,4 @@ ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW foo RENAME TO bar;
     

    Compatibility

    ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropclass.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropclass.html index f063ab7..d56800b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropclass.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropclass.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER OPERATOR CLASS

    ALTER OPERATOR CLASS

    ALTER OPERATOR CLASS — change the definition of an operator class

    Synopsis

    +ALTER OPERATOR CLASS

    ALTER OPERATOR CLASS

    ALTER OPERATOR CLASS — change the definition of an operator class

    Synopsis

     ALTER OPERATOR CLASS name USING index_method
         RENAME TO new_name
     
    @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ ALTER OPERATOR CLASS name USING 

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER OPERATOR CLASS statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteroperator.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteroperator.html index efb5eaa..c98f21d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteroperator.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteroperator.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER OPERATOR

    ALTER OPERATOR

    ALTER OPERATOR — change the definition of an operator

    Synopsis

    +ALTER OPERATOR

    ALTER OPERATOR

    ALTER OPERATOR — change the definition of an operator

    Synopsis

     ALTER OPERATOR name ( { left_type | NONE } , right_type )
         OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
     
    @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ ALTER OPERATOR && (_int4, _int4) SET (RESTRICT = _int_contsel, JOIN = _i
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER OPERATOR statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropfamily.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropfamily.html index fc0e6b2..79def25 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropfamily.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteropfamily.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY

    ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY

    ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY — change the definition of an operator family

    Synopsis

    +ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY

    ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY

    ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY — change the definition of an operator family

    Synopsis

     ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY name USING index_method ADD
       {  OPERATOR strategy_number operator_name ( op_type, op_type )
                   [ FOR SEARCH | FOR ORDER BY sort_family_name ]
    @@ -178,4 +178,4 @@ ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY integer_ops USING btree DROP
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpolicy.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpolicy.html index 03557d5..6f09795 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpolicy.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpolicy.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER POLICY

    ALTER POLICY

    ALTER POLICY — change the definition of a row-level security policy

    Synopsis

    +ALTER POLICY

    ALTER POLICY

    ALTER POLICY — change the definition of a row-level security policy

    Synopsis

     ALTER POLICY name ON table_name RENAME TO new_name
     
     ALTER POLICY name ON table_name
    @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ ALTER POLICY name ON CREATE POLICY for details.
          

    Compatibility

    ALTER POLICY is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterprocedure.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterprocedure.html index 80cffd1..55f6d5c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterprocedure.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterprocedure.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER PROCEDURE

    ALTER PROCEDURE

    ALTER PROCEDURE — change the definition of a procedure

    Synopsis

    +ALTER PROCEDURE

    ALTER PROCEDURE

    ALTER PROCEDURE — change the definition of a procedure

    Synopsis

     ALTER PROCEDURE name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ]
         action [ ... ] [ RESTRICT ]
     ALTER PROCEDURE name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ]
    @@ -130,4 +130,4 @@ ALTER PROCEDURE check_password(text) RESET search_path;
        or change the owner, schema, or volatility of a procedure. The standard also
        requires the RESTRICT key word, which is optional in
        PostgreSQL.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpublication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpublication.html index 2b83701..80b5ffd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpublication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterpublication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER PUBLICATION

    ALTER PUBLICATION

    ALTER PUBLICATION — change the definition of a publication

    Synopsis

    +ALTER PUBLICATION

    ALTER PUBLICATION

    ALTER PUBLICATION — change the definition of a publication

    Synopsis

     ALTER PUBLICATION name ADD publication_object [, ...]
     ALTER PUBLICATION name SET publication_object [, ...]
     ALTER PUBLICATION name DROP publication_object [, ...]
    @@ -109,4 +109,4 @@ ALTER PUBLICATION production_publication ADD TABLE users, departments, TABLES IN
     

    Compatibility

    ALTER PUBLICATION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrole.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrole.html index 42d0e56..5e8e78e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrole.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrole.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER ROLE

    ALTER ROLE

    ALTER ROLE — change a database role

    Synopsis

    +ALTER ROLE

    ALTER ROLE

    ALTER ROLE — change a database role

    Synopsis

     ALTER ROLE role_specification [ WITH ] option [ ... ]
     
     where option can be:
    @@ -186,4 +186,4 @@ ALTER ROLE fred IN DATABASE devel SET client_min_messages = DEBUG;
     

    Compatibility

    The ALTER ROLE statement is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterroutine.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterroutine.html index d28c780..1b73df4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterroutine.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterroutine.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER ROUTINE

    ALTER ROUTINE

    ALTER ROUTINE — change the definition of a routine

    Synopsis

    +ALTER ROUTINE

    ALTER ROUTINE

    ALTER ROUTINE — change the definition of a routine

    Synopsis

     ALTER ROUTINE name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ]
         action [ ... ] [ RESTRICT ]
     ALTER ROUTINE name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ]
    @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ ALTER ROUTINE foo(integer) RENAME TO foobar;
        a PostgreSQL extension.
       

    See Also

    ALTER AGGREGATE, ALTER FUNCTION, ALTER PROCEDURE, DROP ROUTINE

    Note that there is no CREATE ROUTINE command. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrule.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrule.html index 8c56d6e..a246fce 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrule.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterrule.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER RULE

    ALTER RULE

    ALTER RULE — change the definition of a rule

    Synopsis

    +ALTER RULE

    ALTER RULE

    ALTER RULE — change the definition of a rule

    Synopsis

     ALTER RULE name ON table_name RENAME TO new_name
     

    Description

    ALTER RULE changes properties of an existing @@ -22,4 +22,4 @@ ALTER RULE notify_all ON emp RENAME TO notify_me; ALTER RULE is a PostgreSQL language extension, as is the entire query rewrite system. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterschema.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterschema.html index 9593f50..8669297 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterschema.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterschema.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER SCHEMA

    ALTER SCHEMA

    ALTER SCHEMA — change the definition of a schema

    Synopsis

    +ALTER SCHEMA

    ALTER SCHEMA

    ALTER SCHEMA — change the definition of a schema

    Synopsis

     ALTER SCHEMA name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER SCHEMA name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
     

    Description

    @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ ALTER SCHEMA name OWNER TO {

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER SCHEMA statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersequence.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersequence.html index 7bed788..4a695ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersequence.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersequence.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER SEQUENCE

    ALTER SEQUENCE

    ALTER SEQUENCE — +ALTER SEQUENCE

    ALTER SEQUENCE

    ALTER SEQUENCE — change the definition of a sequence generator

    Synopsis

     ALTER SEQUENCE [ IF EXISTS ] name
    @@ -162,4 +162,4 @@ ALTER SEQUENCE serial RESTART WITH 105;
        OWNED BY, OWNER TO, RENAME TO, and
        SET SCHEMA clauses, which are
        PostgreSQL extensions.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterserver.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterserver.html index 619b20c..67ca3f3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterserver.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterserver.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER SERVER

    ALTER SERVER

    ALTER SERVER — change the definition of a foreign server

    Synopsis

    +ALTER SERVER

    ALTER SERVER

    ALTER SERVER — change the definition of a foreign server

    Synopsis

     ALTER SERVER name [ VERSION 'new_version' ]
         [ OPTIONS ( [ ADD | SET | DROP ] option ['value'] [, ... ] ) ]
     ALTER SERVER name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
    @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ ALTER SERVER foo VERSION '8.4' OPTIONS (SET host 'baz');
        ALTER SERVER conforms to ISO/IEC 9075-9 (SQL/MED).
        The OWNER TO and RENAME forms are
        PostgreSQL extensions.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterstatistics.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterstatistics.html index 8f9a3e8..51efe7c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterstatistics.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterstatistics.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER STATISTICS

    ALTER STATISTICS

    ALTER STATISTICS — +ALTER STATISTICS

    ALTER STATISTICS

    ALTER STATISTICS — change the definition of an extended statistics object

    Synopsis

     ALTER STATISTICS name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
    @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@ ALTER STATISTICS name SET STATISTICS <
            

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER STATISTICS command in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersubscription.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersubscription.html index a412cd7..4b573c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersubscription.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersubscription.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER SUBSCRIPTION

    ALTER SUBSCRIPTION

    ALTER SUBSCRIPTION — change the definition of a subscription

    Synopsis

    +ALTER SUBSCRIPTION

    ALTER SUBSCRIPTION

    ALTER SUBSCRIPTION — change the definition of a subscription

    Synopsis

     ALTER SUBSCRIPTION name CONNECTION 'conninfo'
     ALTER SUBSCRIPTION name SET PUBLICATION publication_name [, ...] [ WITH ( publication_option [= value] [, ... ] ) ]
     ALTER SUBSCRIPTION name ADD PUBLICATION publication_name [, ...] [ WITH ( publication_option [= value] [, ... ] ) ]
    @@ -144,4 +144,4 @@ ALTER SUBSCRIPTION mysub DISABLE;
     

    Compatibility

    ALTER SUBSCRIPTION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersystem.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersystem.html index b0b072e..df7b4f3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersystem.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altersystem.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER SYSTEM

    ALTER SYSTEM

    ALTER SYSTEM — change a server configuration parameter

    Synopsis

    +ALTER SYSTEM

    ALTER SYSTEM

    ALTER SYSTEM — change a server configuration parameter

    Synopsis

     ALTER SYSTEM SET configuration_parameter { TO | = } { value [, ...] | DEFAULT }
     
     ALTER SYSTEM RESET configuration_parameter
    @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ ALTER SYSTEM RESET wal_level;
     

    Compatibility

    The ALTER SYSTEM statement is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    See Also

    SET, SHOW
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    SET, SHOW
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertable.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertable.html index ed859ce..e7c240b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertable.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertable.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TABLE

    ALTER TABLE

    ALTER TABLE — change the definition of a table

    Synopsis

    +ALTER TABLE

    ALTER TABLE

    ALTER TABLE — change the definition of a table

    Synopsis

     ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] [ ONLY ] name [ * ]
         action [, ... ]
     ALTER TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] [ ONLY ] name [ * ]
    @@ -1091,4 +1091,4 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement
        ALTER TABLE DROP COLUMN can be used to drop the only
        column of a table, leaving a zero-column table.  This is an
        extension of SQL, which disallows zero-column tables.
    -  

    See Also

    CREATE TABLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CREATE TABLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertablespace.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertablespace.html index 08ba942..f9005ce 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertablespace.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertablespace.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TABLESPACE

    ALTER TABLESPACE

    ALTER TABLESPACE — change the definition of a tablespace

    Synopsis

    +ALTER TABLESPACE

    ALTER TABLESPACE

    ALTER TABLESPACE — change the definition of a tablespace

    Synopsis

     ALTER TABLESPACE name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER TABLESPACE name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
     ALTER TABLESPACE name SET ( tablespace_option = value [, ... ] )
    @@ -47,4 +47,4 @@ ALTER TABLESPACE index_space OWNER TO mary;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER TABLESPACE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertrigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertrigger.html index 51e2836..bdec136 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertrigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertrigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TRIGGER

    ALTER TRIGGER

    ALTER TRIGGER — change the definition of a trigger

    Synopsis

    +ALTER TRIGGER

    ALTER TRIGGER

    ALTER TRIGGER — change the definition of a trigger

    Synopsis

     ALTER TRIGGER name ON table_name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER TRIGGER name ON table_name [ NO ] DEPENDS ON EXTENSION extension_name
     

    Description

    @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ ALTER TRIGGER emp_stamp ON emp DEPENDS ON EXTENSION emplib;

    Compatibility

    ALTER TRIGGER is a PostgreSQL extension of the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    ALTER TABLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    ALTER TABLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsconfig.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsconfig.html index 52a7a04..1c08741 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsconfig.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsconfig.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — change the definition of a text search configuration

    Synopsis

    +ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — change the definition of a text search configuration

    Synopsis

     ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION name
         ADD MAPPING FOR token_type [, ... ] WITH dictionary_name [, ... ]
     ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION name
    @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION my_config
     

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsdictionary.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsdictionary.html index 70dc36b..ed0479b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsdictionary.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsdictionary.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — change the definition of a text search dictionary

    Synopsis

    +ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — change the definition of a text search dictionary

    Synopsis

     ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY name (
         option [ = value ] [, ... ]
     )
    @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY my_dict ( dummy );
       

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsparser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsparser.html index 63a109a..27a3d42 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsparser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertsparser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER — change the definition of a text search parser

    Synopsis

    +ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER — change the definition of a text search parser

    Synopsis

     ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER name SET SCHEMA new_schema
     

    Description

    @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER name SET SCHE

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertstemplate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertstemplate.html index 671adbe..000cf0b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertstemplate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertstemplate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — change the definition of a text search template

    Synopsis

    +ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — change the definition of a text search template

    Synopsis

     ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE name RENAME TO new_name
     ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE name SET SCHEMA new_schema
     

    Description

    @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE name SET SC

    Compatibility

    There is no ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertype.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertype.html index 3068ee1..62d0819 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertype.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-altertype.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER TYPE

    ALTER TYPE

    ALTER TYPE — +ALTER TYPE

    ALTER TYPE

    ALTER TYPE — change the definition of a type

    Synopsis

     ALTER TYPE name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
    @@ -223,4 +223,4 @@ ALTER TYPE mytype SET (
     

    Compatibility

    The variants to add and drop attributes are part of the SQL standard; the other variants are PostgreSQL extensions. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteruser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteruser.html index b84b8f3..23e24d4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteruser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alteruser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER USER

    ALTER USER

    ALTER USER — change a database role

    Synopsis

    +ALTER USER

    ALTER USER

    ALTER USER — change a database role

    Synopsis

     ALTER USER role_specification [ WITH ] option [ ... ]
     
     where option can be:
    @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ ALTER USER { role_specification | ALL
        The ALTER USER statement is a
        PostgreSQL extension.  The SQL standard
        leaves the definition of users to the implementation.
    -  

    See Also

    ALTER ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    ALTER ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterusermapping.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterusermapping.html index d7d5a07..fc156ec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterusermapping.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterusermapping.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER USER MAPPING

    ALTER USER MAPPING

    ALTER USER MAPPING — change the definition of a user mapping

    Synopsis

    +ALTER USER MAPPING

    ALTER USER MAPPING

    ALTER USER MAPPING — change the definition of a user mapping

    Synopsis

     ALTER USER MAPPING FOR { user_name | USER | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER | PUBLIC }
         SERVER server_name
         OPTIONS ( [ ADD | SET | DROP ] option ['value'] [, ... ] )
    @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ ALTER USER MAPPING FOR bob SERVER foo OPTIONS (SET password 'public');
        for ALTER USER MAPPING, PostgreSQL diverges from
        the standard here in the interest of consistency and
        interoperability.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterview.html index 89f10fb..28958ed 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-alterview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ALTER VIEW

    ALTER VIEW

    ALTER VIEW — change the definition of a view

    Synopsis

    +ALTER VIEW

    ALTER VIEW

    ALTER VIEW — change the definition of a view

    Synopsis

     ALTER VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] name ALTER [ COLUMN ] column_name SET DEFAULT expression
     ALTER VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] name ALTER [ COLUMN ] column_name DROP DEFAULT
     ALTER VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] name OWNER TO { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
    @@ -77,4 +77,4 @@ INSERT INTO a_view(id) VALUES(2);  -- ts will receive the current time
     

    Compatibility

    ALTER VIEW is a PostgreSQL extension of the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-analyze.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-analyze.html index 745addb..7e5bb68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-analyze.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-analyze.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ANALYZE

    ANALYZE

    ANALYZE — collect statistics about a database

    Synopsis

    +ANALYZE

    ANALYZE

    ANALYZE — collect statistics about a database

    Synopsis

     ANALYZE [ ( option [, ...] ) ] [ table_and_columns [, ...] ]
     ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ table_and_columns [, ...] ]
     
    @@ -184,4 +184,4 @@ ANALYZE [ VERBOSE ] [ table_and_columnsSection 28.4.1 for details.
       

    Compatibility

    There is no ANALYZE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-begin.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-begin.html index a773c15..fb8fb8e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-begin.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-begin.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -BEGIN

    BEGIN

    BEGIN — start a transaction block

    Synopsis

    +BEGIN

    BEGIN

    BEGIN — start a transaction block

    Synopsis

     BEGIN [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ transaction_mode [, ...] ]
     
     where transaction_mode is one of:
    @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@ BEGIN;
        Incidentally, the BEGIN key word is used for a
        different purpose in embedded SQL. You are advised to be careful
        about the transaction semantics when porting database applications.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-call.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-call.html index dcc87f7..17a8495 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-call.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-call.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CALL

    CALL

    CALL — invoke a procedure

    Synopsis

    +CALL

    CALL

    CALL — invoke a procedure

    Synopsis

     CALL name ( [ argument ] [, ...] )
     

    Description

    CALL executes a procedure. @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@ CALL do_db_maintenance(); except for the handling of output parameters. The standard says that users should write variables to receive the values of output parameters. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-checkpoint.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-checkpoint.html index 3eec682..362694d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-checkpoint.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-checkpoint.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CHECKPOINT

    CHECKPOINT

    CHECKPOINT — force a write-ahead log checkpoint

    Synopsis

    +CHECKPOINT

    CHECKPOINT

    CHECKPOINT — force a write-ahead log checkpoint

    Synopsis

     CHECKPOINT
     

    Description

    A checkpoint is a point in the write-ahead log sequence at which @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ CHECKPOINT

    Compatibility

    The CHECKPOINT command is a PostgreSQL language extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-close.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-close.html index 291862c..12e5a2f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-close.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-close.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CLOSE

    CLOSE

    CLOSE — close a cursor

    Synopsis

    +CLOSE

    CLOSE

    CLOSE — close a cursor

    Synopsis

     CLOSE { name | ALL }
     

    Description

    CLOSE frees the resources associated with an open cursor. @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ CLOSE liahona; CLOSE is fully conforming with the SQL standard. CLOSE ALL is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    See Also

    DECLARE, FETCH, MOVE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    DECLARE, FETCH, MOVE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-cluster.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-cluster.html index 0d9de20..5b78e84 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-cluster.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-cluster.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CLUSTER

    CLUSTER

    CLUSTER — cluster a table according to an index

    Synopsis

    +CLUSTER

    CLUSTER

    CLUSTER — cluster a table according to an index

    Synopsis

     CLUSTER [VERBOSE] table_name [ USING index_name ]
     CLUSTER ( option [, ...] ) table_name [ USING index_name ]
     CLUSTER [VERBOSE]
    @@ -134,4 +134,4 @@ CLUSTER index_name ON PostgreSQL
       versions.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commands.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commands.html index b3266c1..09dd38b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commands.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commands.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SQL Commands

    SQL Commands


    +SQL Commands

    SQL Commands


    This part contains reference information for the SQL commands supported by PostgreSQL. By SQL the @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ change the definition of an extended statistics object

    ALTER SUBSCRIPTION — change the definition of a subscription
    ALTER SYSTEM — change a server configuration parameter
    ALTER TABLE — change the definition of a table
    ALTER TABLESPACE — change the definition of a tablespace
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — change the definition of a text search configuration
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — change the definition of a text search dictionary
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER — change the definition of a text search parser
    ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — change the definition of a text search template
    ALTER TRIGGER — change the definition of a trigger
    ALTER TYPE — change the definition of a type -
    ALTER USER — change a database role
    ALTER USER MAPPING — change the definition of a user mapping
    ALTER VIEW — change the definition of a view
    ANALYZE — collect statistics about a database
    BEGIN — start a transaction block
    CALL — invoke a procedure
    CHECKPOINT — force a write-ahead log checkpoint
    CLOSE — close a cursor
    CLUSTER — cluster a table according to an index
    COMMENT — define or change the comment of an object
    COMMIT — commit the current transaction
    COMMIT PREPARED — commit a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit
    COPY — copy data between a file and a table
    CREATE ACCESS METHOD — define a new access method
    CREATE AGGREGATE — define a new aggregate function
    CREATE CAST — define a new cast
    CREATE COLLATION — define a new collation
    CREATE CONVERSION — define a new encoding conversion
    CREATE DATABASE — create a new database
    CREATE DOMAIN — define a new domain
    CREATE EVENT TRIGGER — define a new event trigger
    CREATE EXTENSION — install an extension
    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — define a new foreign-data wrapper
    CREATE FOREIGN TABLE — define a new foreign table
    CREATE FUNCTION — define a new function
    CREATE GROUP — define a new database role
    CREATE INDEX — define a new index
    CREATE LANGUAGE — define a new procedural language
    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW — define a new materialized view
    CREATE OPERATOR — define a new operator
    CREATE OPERATOR CLASS — define a new operator class
    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY — define a new operator family
    CREATE POLICY — define a new row-level security policy for a table
    CREATE PROCEDURE — define a new procedure
    CREATE PUBLICATION — define a new publication
    CREATE ROLE — define a new database role
    CREATE RULE — define a new rewrite rule
    CREATE SCHEMA — define a new schema
    CREATE SEQUENCE — define a new sequence generator
    CREATE SERVER — define a new foreign server
    CREATE STATISTICS — define extended statistics
    CREATE SUBSCRIPTION — define a new subscription
    CREATE TABLE — define a new table
    CREATE TABLE AS — define a new table from the results of a query
    CREATE TABLESPACE — define a new tablespace
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — define a new text search configuration
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — define a new text search dictionary
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER — define a new text search parser
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — define a new text search template
    CREATE TRANSFORM — define a new transform
    CREATE TRIGGER — define a new trigger
    CREATE TYPE — define a new data type
    CREATE USER — define a new database role
    CREATE USER MAPPING — define a new mapping of a user to a foreign server
    CREATE VIEW — define a new view
    DEALLOCATE — deallocate a prepared statement
    DECLARE — define a cursor
    DELETE — delete rows of a table
    DISCARD — discard session state
    DO — execute an anonymous code block
    DROP ACCESS METHOD — remove an access method
    DROP AGGREGATE — remove an aggregate function
    DROP CAST — remove a cast
    DROP COLLATION — remove a collation
    DROP CONVERSION — remove a conversion
    DROP DATABASE — remove a database
    DROP DOMAIN — remove a domain
    DROP EVENT TRIGGER — remove an event trigger
    DROP EXTENSION — remove an extension
    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — remove a foreign-data wrapper
    DROP FOREIGN TABLE — remove a foreign table
    DROP FUNCTION — remove a function
    DROP GROUP — remove a database role
    DROP INDEX — remove an index
    DROP LANGUAGE — remove a procedural language
    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW — remove a materialized view
    DROP OPERATOR — remove an operator
    DROP OPERATOR CLASS — remove an operator class
    DROP OPERATOR FAMILY — remove an operator family
    DROP OWNED — remove database objects owned by a database role
    DROP POLICY — remove a row-level security policy from a table
    DROP PROCEDURE — remove a procedure
    DROP PUBLICATION — remove a publication
    DROP ROLE — remove a database role
    DROP ROUTINE — remove a routine
    DROP RULE — remove a rewrite rule
    DROP SCHEMA — remove a schema
    DROP SEQUENCE — remove a sequence
    DROP SERVER — remove a foreign server descriptor
    DROP STATISTICS — remove extended statistics
    DROP SUBSCRIPTION — remove a subscription
    DROP TABLE — remove a table
    DROP TABLESPACE — remove a tablespace
    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — remove a text search configuration
    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — remove a text search dictionary
    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER — remove a text search parser
    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — remove a text search template
    DROP TRANSFORM — remove a transform
    DROP TRIGGER — remove a trigger
    DROP TYPE — remove a data type
    DROP USER — remove a database role
    DROP USER MAPPING — remove a user mapping for a foreign server
    DROP VIEW — remove a view
    END — commit the current transaction
    EXECUTE — execute a prepared statement
    EXPLAIN — show the execution plan of a statement
    FETCH — retrieve rows from a query using a cursor
    GRANT — define access privileges
    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA — import table definitions from a foreign server
    INSERT — create new rows in a table
    LISTEN — listen for a notification
    LOAD — load a shared library file
    LOCK — lock a table
    MERGE — conditionally insert, update, or delete rows of a table
    MOVE — position a cursor
    NOTIFY — generate a notification
    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution
    PREPARE TRANSACTION — prepare the current transaction for two-phase commit
    REASSIGN OWNED — change the ownership of database objects owned by a database role
    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW — replace the contents of a materialized view
    REINDEX — rebuild indexes
    RELEASE SAVEPOINT — destroy a previously defined savepoint
    RESET — restore the value of a run-time parameter to the default value
    REVOKE — remove access privileges
    ROLLBACK — abort the current transaction
    ROLLBACK PREPARED — cancel a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit
    ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT — roll back to a savepoint
    SAVEPOINT — define a new savepoint within the current transaction
    SECURITY LABEL — define or change a security label applied to an object
    SELECT — retrieve rows from a table or view
    SELECT INTO — define a new table from the results of a query
    SET — change a run-time parameter
    SET CONSTRAINTS — set constraint check timing for the current transaction
    SET ROLE — set the current user identifier of the current session
    SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION — set the session user identifier and the current user identifier of the current session
    SET TRANSACTION — set the characteristics of the current transaction
    SHOW — show the value of a run-time parameter
    START TRANSACTION — start a transaction block
    TRUNCATE — empty a table or set of tables
    UNLISTEN — stop listening for a notification
    UPDATE — update rows of a table
    VACUUM — garbage-collect and optionally analyze a database
    VALUES — compute a set of rows
    \ No newline at end of file +
    ALTER USER — change a database role
    ALTER USER MAPPING — change the definition of a user mapping
    ALTER VIEW — change the definition of a view
    ANALYZE — collect statistics about a database
    BEGIN — start a transaction block
    CALL — invoke a procedure
    CHECKPOINT — force a write-ahead log checkpoint
    CLOSE — close a cursor
    CLUSTER — cluster a table according to an index
    COMMENT — define or change the comment of an object
    COMMIT — commit the current transaction
    COMMIT PREPARED — commit a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit
    COPY — copy data between a file and a table
    CREATE ACCESS METHOD — define a new access method
    CREATE AGGREGATE — define a new aggregate function
    CREATE CAST — define a new cast
    CREATE COLLATION — define a new collation
    CREATE CONVERSION — define a new encoding conversion
    CREATE DATABASE — create a new database
    CREATE DOMAIN — define a new domain
    CREATE EVENT TRIGGER — define a new event trigger
    CREATE EXTENSION — install an extension
    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — define a new foreign-data wrapper
    CREATE FOREIGN TABLE — define a new foreign table
    CREATE FUNCTION — define a new function
    CREATE GROUP — define a new database role
    CREATE INDEX — define a new index
    CREATE LANGUAGE — define a new procedural language
    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW — define a new materialized view
    CREATE OPERATOR — define a new operator
    CREATE OPERATOR CLASS — define a new operator class
    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY — define a new operator family
    CREATE POLICY — define a new row-level security policy for a table
    CREATE PROCEDURE — define a new procedure
    CREATE PUBLICATION — define a new publication
    CREATE ROLE — define a new database role
    CREATE RULE — define a new rewrite rule
    CREATE SCHEMA — define a new schema
    CREATE SEQUENCE — define a new sequence generator
    CREATE SERVER — define a new foreign server
    CREATE STATISTICS — define extended statistics
    CREATE SUBSCRIPTION — define a new subscription
    CREATE TABLE — define a new table
    CREATE TABLE AS — define a new table from the results of a query
    CREATE TABLESPACE — define a new tablespace
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — define a new text search configuration
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — define a new text search dictionary
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER — define a new text search parser
    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — define a new text search template
    CREATE TRANSFORM — define a new transform
    CREATE TRIGGER — define a new trigger
    CREATE TYPE — define a new data type
    CREATE USER — define a new database role
    CREATE USER MAPPING — define a new mapping of a user to a foreign server
    CREATE VIEW — define a new view
    DEALLOCATE — deallocate a prepared statement
    DECLARE — define a cursor
    DELETE — delete rows of a table
    DISCARD — discard session state
    DO — execute an anonymous code block
    DROP ACCESS METHOD — remove an access method
    DROP AGGREGATE — remove an aggregate function
    DROP CAST — remove a cast
    DROP COLLATION — remove a collation
    DROP CONVERSION — remove a conversion
    DROP DATABASE — remove a database
    DROP DOMAIN — remove a domain
    DROP EVENT TRIGGER — remove an event trigger
    DROP EXTENSION — remove an extension
    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — remove a foreign-data wrapper
    DROP FOREIGN TABLE — remove a foreign table
    DROP FUNCTION — remove a function
    DROP GROUP — remove a database role
    DROP INDEX — remove an index
    DROP LANGUAGE — remove a procedural language
    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW — remove a materialized view
    DROP OPERATOR — remove an operator
    DROP OPERATOR CLASS — remove an operator class
    DROP OPERATOR FAMILY — remove an operator family
    DROP OWNED — remove database objects owned by a database role
    DROP POLICY — remove a row-level security policy from a table
    DROP PROCEDURE — remove a procedure
    DROP PUBLICATION — remove a publication
    DROP ROLE — remove a database role
    DROP ROUTINE — remove a routine
    DROP RULE — remove a rewrite rule
    DROP SCHEMA — remove a schema
    DROP SEQUENCE — remove a sequence
    DROP SERVER — remove a foreign server descriptor
    DROP STATISTICS — remove extended statistics
    DROP SUBSCRIPTION — remove a subscription
    DROP TABLE — remove a table
    DROP TABLESPACE — remove a tablespace
    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — remove a text search configuration
    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — remove a text search dictionary
    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER — remove a text search parser
    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — remove a text search template
    DROP TRANSFORM — remove a transform
    DROP TRIGGER — remove a trigger
    DROP TYPE — remove a data type
    DROP USER — remove a database role
    DROP USER MAPPING — remove a user mapping for a foreign server
    DROP VIEW — remove a view
    END — commit the current transaction
    EXECUTE — execute a prepared statement
    EXPLAIN — show the execution plan of a statement
    FETCH — retrieve rows from a query using a cursor
    GRANT — define access privileges
    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA — import table definitions from a foreign server
    INSERT — create new rows in a table
    LISTEN — listen for a notification
    LOAD — load a shared library file
    LOCK — lock a table
    MERGE — conditionally insert, update, or delete rows of a table
    MOVE — position a cursor
    NOTIFY — generate a notification
    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution
    PREPARE TRANSACTION — prepare the current transaction for two-phase commit
    REASSIGN OWNED — change the ownership of database objects owned by a database role
    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW — replace the contents of a materialized view
    REINDEX — rebuild indexes
    RELEASE SAVEPOINT — destroy a previously defined savepoint
    RESET — restore the value of a run-time parameter to the default value
    REVOKE — remove access privileges
    ROLLBACK — abort the current transaction
    ROLLBACK PREPARED — cancel a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit
    ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT — roll back to a savepoint
    SAVEPOINT — define a new savepoint within the current transaction
    SECURITY LABEL — define or change a security label applied to an object
    SELECT — retrieve rows from a table or view
    SELECT INTO — define a new table from the results of a query
    SET — change a run-time parameter
    SET CONSTRAINTS — set constraint check timing for the current transaction
    SET ROLE — set the current user identifier of the current session
    SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION — set the session user identifier and the current user identifier of the current session
    SET TRANSACTION — set the characteristics of the current transaction
    SHOW — show the value of a run-time parameter
    START TRANSACTION — start a transaction block
    TRUNCATE — empty a table or set of tables
    UNLISTEN — stop listening for a notification
    UPDATE — update rows of a table
    VACUUM — garbage-collect and optionally analyze a database
    VALUES — compute a set of rows
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-comment.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-comment.html index 172a4dc..adcb872 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-comment.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-comment.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -COMMENT

    COMMENT

    COMMENT — define or change the comment of an object

    Synopsis

    +COMMENT

    COMMENT

    COMMENT — define or change the comment of an object

    Synopsis

     COMMENT ON
     {
       ACCESS METHOD object_name |
    @@ -195,4 +195,4 @@ COMMENT ON TYPE complex IS 'Complex number data type';
     COMMENT ON VIEW my_view IS 'View of departmental costs';
     

    Compatibility

    There is no COMMENT command in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit-prepared.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit-prepared.html index eb81c31..b535640 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit-prepared.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit-prepared.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -COMMIT PREPARED

    COMMIT PREPARED

    COMMIT PREPARED — commit a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit

    Synopsis

    +COMMIT PREPARED

    COMMIT PREPARED

    COMMIT PREPARED — commit a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit

    Synopsis

     COMMIT PREPARED transaction_id
     

    Description

    COMMIT PREPARED commits a transaction that is in @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@ COMMIT PREPARED 'foobar'; external transaction management systems, some of which are covered by standards (such as X/Open XA), but the SQL side of those systems is not standardized. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit.html index 05952cc..35916c2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-commit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -COMMIT

    COMMIT

    COMMIT — commit the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +COMMIT

    COMMIT

    COMMIT — commit the current transaction

    Synopsis

     COMMIT [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ AND [ NO ] CHAIN ]
     

    Description

    COMMIT commits the current transaction. All @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ COMMIT;

    Compatibility

    The command COMMIT conforms to the SQL standard. The form COMMIT TRANSACTION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    See Also

    BEGIN, ROLLBACK
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    BEGIN, ROLLBACK
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-copy.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-copy.html index b3dca10..6aba899 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-copy.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-copy.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -COPY

    COPY

    COPY — copy data between a file and a table

    Synopsis

    +COPY

    COPY

    COPY — copy data between a file and a table

    Synopsis

     COPY table_name [ ( column_name [, ...] ) ]
         FROM { 'filename' | PROGRAM 'command' | STDIN }
         [ [ WITH ] ( option [, ...] ) ]
    @@ -69,10 +69,10 @@ COPY { table_name [ ( INSERT, UPDATE and
    -      DELETE queries a RETURNING clause must be provided,
    -      and the target relation must not have a conditional rule, nor
    -      an ALSO rule, nor an INSTEAD rule
    -      that expands to multiple statements.
    +      DELETE queries a RETURNING clause
    +      must be provided, and the target relation must not have a conditional
    +      rule, nor an ALSO rule, nor an
    +      INSTEAD rule that expands to multiple statements.
          

    filename

    The path name of the input or output file. An input file name can be an absolute or relative path, but an output file name must be an absolute @@ -638,4 +638,4 @@ COPY [ BINARY ] table_name TO { 'filename' | STDOUT } [ [USING] DELIMITERS 'delimiter_character' ] [ WITH NULL AS 'null_string' ] -

    \ No newline at end of file +
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-create-access-method.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-create-access-method.html index 18f82b5..b44a82f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-create-access-method.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-create-access-method.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE ACCESS METHOD

    CREATE ACCESS METHOD

    CREATE ACCESS METHOD — define a new access method

    Synopsis

    +CREATE ACCESS METHOD

    CREATE ACCESS METHOD

    CREATE ACCESS METHOD — define a new access method

    Synopsis

     CREATE ACCESS METHOD name
         TYPE access_method_type
         HANDLER handler_function
    @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@ CREATE ACCESS METHOD heptree TYPE INDEX HANDLER heptree_handler;
     

    Compatibility

    CREATE ACCESS METHOD is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createaggregate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createaggregate.html index f691383..3a6599c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createaggregate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createaggregate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE AGGREGATE

    CREATE AGGREGATE

    CREATE AGGREGATE — define a new aggregate function

    Synopsis

    +CREATE AGGREGATE

    CREATE AGGREGATE

    CREATE AGGREGATE — define a new aggregate function

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] AGGREGATE name ( [ argmode ] [ argname ] arg_data_type [ , ... ] ) (
         SFUNC = sfunc,
         STYPE = state_data_type
    @@ -507,4 +507,4 @@ SELECT col FROM tab ORDER BY col USING sortop LIMIT 1;
        CREATE AGGREGATE is a
        PostgreSQL language extension.  The SQL
        standard does not provide for user-defined aggregate functions.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcast.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcast.html index cc91355..09409b2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcast.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcast.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE CAST

    CREATE CAST

    CREATE CAST — define a new cast

    Synopsis

    +CREATE CAST

    CREATE CAST

    CREATE CAST — define a new cast

    Synopsis

     CREATE CAST (source_type AS target_type)
         WITH FUNCTION function_name [ (argument_type [, ...]) ]
         [ AS ASSIGNMENT | AS IMPLICIT ]
    @@ -253,4 +253,4 @@ CREATE CAST (bigint AS int4) WITH FUNCTION int4(bigint) AS ASSIGNMENT;
        CREATE FUNCTION,
        CREATE TYPE,
        DROP CAST
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcollation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcollation.html index 7e7b4dc..68905a4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcollation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createcollation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE COLLATION

    CREATE COLLATION

    CREATE COLLATION — define a new collation

    Synopsis

    +CREATE COLLATION

    CREATE COLLATION

    CREATE COLLATION — define a new collation

    Synopsis

     CREATE COLLATION [ IF NOT EXISTS ] name (
         [ LOCALE = locale, ]
         [ LC_COLLATE = lc_collate, ]
    @@ -106,4 +106,4 @@ CREATE COLLATION german FROM "de_DE";
        standard, but it is limited to copying an existing collation.  The
        syntax to create a new collation is
        a PostgreSQL extension.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createconversion.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createconversion.html index 9dae318..66f069e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createconversion.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createconversion.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE CONVERSION

    CREATE CONVERSION

    CREATE CONVERSION — define a new encoding conversion

    Synopsis

    +CREATE CONVERSION

    CREATE CONVERSION

    CREATE CONVERSION — define a new encoding conversion

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ DEFAULT ] CONVERSION name
         FOR source_encoding TO dest_encoding FROM function_name
     

    Description

    @@ -69,4 +69,4 @@ CREATE CONVERSION myconv FOR 'UTF8' TO 'LATIN1' FROM myfunc; There is no CREATE CONVERSION statement in the SQL standard, but a CREATE TRANSLATION statement that is very similar in purpose and syntax. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdatabase.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdatabase.html index 0f04e76..27277e2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdatabase.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdatabase.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE DATABASE

    CREATE DATABASE

    CREATE DATABASE — create a new database

    Synopsis

    +CREATE DATABASE

    CREATE DATABASE

    CREATE DATABASE — create a new database

    Synopsis

     CREATE DATABASE name
         [ WITH ] [ OWNER [=] user_name ]
                [ TEMPLATE [=] template ]
    @@ -237,4 +237,4 @@ CREATE DATABASE music2
        There is no CREATE DATABASE statement in the SQL
        standard.  Databases are equivalent to catalogs, whose creation is
        implementation-defined.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdomain.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdomain.html index a1cac63..0b49ab8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdomain.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createdomain.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE DOMAIN

    CREATE DOMAIN

    CREATE DOMAIN — define a new domain

    Synopsis

    +CREATE DOMAIN

    CREATE DOMAIN

    CREATE DOMAIN — define a new domain

    Synopsis

     CREATE DOMAIN name [ AS ] data_type
         [ COLLATE collation ]
         [ DEFAULT expression ]
    @@ -145,4 +145,4 @@ CREATE TABLE us_snail_addy (
     

    Compatibility

    The command CREATE DOMAIN conforms to the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createeventtrigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createeventtrigger.html index 1c3acd5..a086f71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createeventtrigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createeventtrigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE EVENT TRIGGER

    CREATE EVENT TRIGGER

    CREATE EVENT TRIGGER — define a new event trigger

    Synopsis

    +CREATE EVENT TRIGGER

    CREATE EVENT TRIGGER

    CREATE EVENT TRIGGER — define a new event trigger

    Synopsis

     CREATE EVENT TRIGGER name
         ON event
         [ WHEN filter_variable IN (filter_value [, ... ]) [ AND ... ] ]
    @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ CREATE EVENT TRIGGER abort_ddl ON ddl_command_start
     

    Compatibility

    There is no CREATE EVENT TRIGGER statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createextension.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createextension.html index ff9b4b3..3905c23 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createextension.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createextension.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE EXTENSION

    CREATE EXTENSION

    CREATE EXTENSION — install an extension

    Synopsis

    +CREATE EXTENSION

    CREATE EXTENSION

    CREATE EXTENSION — install an extension

    Synopsis

     CREATE EXTENSION [ IF NOT EXISTS ] extension_name
         [ WITH ] [ SCHEMA schema_name ]
                  [ VERSION version ]
    @@ -125,4 +125,4 @@ CREATE EXTENSION hstore;
     

    Compatibility

    CREATE EXTENSION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigndatawrapper.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigndatawrapper.html index 1942f19..c33cfb8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigndatawrapper.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigndatawrapper.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — define a new foreign-data wrapper

    Synopsis

    +CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — define a new foreign-data wrapper

    Synopsis

     CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER name
         [ HANDLER handler_function | NO HANDLER ]
         [ VALIDATOR validator_function | NO VALIDATOR ]
    @@ -74,4 +74,4 @@ CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER mywrapper
       

    Note, however, that the SQL/MED functionality as a whole is not yet conforming. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigntable.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigntable.html index 1572f71..2b16cfd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigntable.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createforeigntable.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE FOREIGN TABLE

    CREATE FOREIGN TABLE

    CREATE FOREIGN TABLE — define a new foreign table

    Synopsis

    +CREATE FOREIGN TABLE

    CREATE FOREIGN TABLE

    CREATE FOREIGN TABLE — define a new foreign table

    Synopsis

     CREATE FOREIGN TABLE [ IF NOT EXISTS ] table_name ( [
       { column_name data_type [ OPTIONS ( option 'value' [, ... ] ) ] [ COLLATE collation ] [ column_constraint [ ... ] ]
         | table_constraint }
    @@ -241,4 +241,4 @@ CREATE FOREIGN TABLE measurement_y2016m07
        The ability to specify column default values is also
        a PostgreSQL extension.  Table inheritance, in the form
        defined by PostgreSQL, is nonstandard.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createfunction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createfunction.html index db7a676..82a59fd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createfunction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createfunction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE FUNCTION

    CREATE FUNCTION

    CREATE FUNCTION — define a new function

    Synopsis

    +CREATE FUNCTION

    CREATE FUNCTION

    CREATE FUNCTION — define a new function

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] FUNCTION
         name ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [ { DEFAULT | = } default_expr ] [, ...] ] )
         [ RETURNS rettype
    @@ -551,4 +551,4 @@ COMMIT;
        More complex functions using advanced features, optimization attributes, or
        other languages will necessarily be specific to PostgreSQL in a significant
        way.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creategroup.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creategroup.html index de56202..c5a7ac4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creategroup.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creategroup.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE GROUP

    CREATE GROUP

    CREATE GROUP — define a new database role

    Synopsis

    +CREATE GROUP

    CREATE GROUP

    CREATE GROUP — define a new database role

    Synopsis

     CREATE GROUP name [ [ WITH ] option [ ... ] ]
     
     where option can be:
    @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ CREATE GROUP name [ [ WITH ] 

    Compatibility

    There is no CREATE GROUP statement in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    CREATE ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CREATE ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createindex.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createindex.html index 2c9a051..46f4942 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createindex.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createindex.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE INDEX

    CREATE INDEX

    CREATE INDEX — define a new index

    Synopsis

    +CREATE INDEX

    CREATE INDEX

    CREATE INDEX — define a new index

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ UNIQUE ] INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ [ IF NOT EXISTS ] name ] ON [ ONLY ] table_name [ USING method ]
         ( { column_name | ( expression ) } [ COLLATE collation ] [ opclass [ ( opclass_parameter = value [, ... ] ) ] ] [ ASC | DESC ] [ NULLS { FIRST | LAST } ] [, ...] )
         [ INCLUDE ( column_name [, ...] ) ]
    @@ -577,4 +577,4 @@ CREATE INDEX CONCURRENTLY sales_quantity_index ON sales_table (quantity);
        CREATE INDEX is a
        PostgreSQL language extension.  There
        are no provisions for indexes in the SQL standard.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createlanguage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createlanguage.html index b67a640..44b860c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createlanguage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createlanguage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE LANGUAGE

    CREATE LANGUAGE

    CREATE LANGUAGE — define a new procedural language

    Synopsis

    +CREATE LANGUAGE

    CREATE LANGUAGE

    CREATE LANGUAGE — define a new procedural language

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ TRUSTED ] [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE name
         HANDLER call_handler [ INLINE inline_handler ] [ VALIDATOR valfunction ]
     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ TRUSTED ] [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE name
    @@ -117,4 +117,4 @@ CREATE EXTENSION plsample;
     

    Compatibility

    CREATE LANGUAGE is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creatematerializedview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creatematerializedview.html index f3a842b..509c8e9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creatematerializedview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-creatematerializedview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW

    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW

    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW — define a new materialized view

    Synopsis

    +CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW

    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW

    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW — define a new materialized view

    Synopsis

     CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF NOT EXISTS ] table_name
         [ (column_name [, ...] ) ]
         [ USING method ]
    @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@ CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF NOT EXISTS ] table_n
          

    Compatibility

    CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopclass.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopclass.html index f42dd6f..2a9f02e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopclass.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopclass.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE OPERATOR CLASS

    CREATE OPERATOR CLASS

    CREATE OPERATOR CLASS — define a new operator class

    Synopsis

    +CREATE OPERATOR CLASS

    CREATE OPERATOR CLASS

    CREATE OPERATOR CLASS — define a new operator class

    Synopsis

     CREATE OPERATOR CLASS name [ DEFAULT ] FOR TYPE data_type
       USING index_method [ FAMILY family_name ] AS
       {  OPERATOR strategy_number operator_name [ ( op_type, op_type ) ] [ FOR SEARCH | FOR ORDER BY sort_family_name ]
    @@ -149,4 +149,4 @@ CREATE OPERATOR CLASS gist__int_ops
        PostgreSQL extension.  There is no
        CREATE OPERATOR CLASS statement in the SQL
        standard.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createoperator.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createoperator.html index 994a234..fe4b2a9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createoperator.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createoperator.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE OPERATOR

    CREATE OPERATOR

    CREATE OPERATOR — define a new operator

    Synopsis

    +CREATE OPERATOR

    CREATE OPERATOR

    CREATE OPERATOR — define a new operator

    Synopsis

     CREATE OPERATOR name (
         {FUNCTION|PROCEDURE} = function_name
         [, LEFTARG = left_type ] [, RIGHTARG = right_type ]
    @@ -133,4 +133,4 @@ CREATE OPERATOR === (
        CREATE OPERATOR is a
        PostgreSQL extension.  There are no
        provisions for user-defined operators in the SQL standard.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopfamily.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopfamily.html index 48e1e0c..8e56b78 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopfamily.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createopfamily.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY

    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY

    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY — define a new operator family

    Synopsis

    +CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY

    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY

    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY — define a new operator family

    Synopsis

     CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY name USING index_method
     

    Description

    CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY creates a new operator family. @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY name USING PostgreSQL extension. There is no CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpolicy.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpolicy.html index 3465759..17de4d8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpolicy.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpolicy.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE POLICY

    CREATE POLICY

    CREATE POLICY — define a new row-level security policy for a table

    Synopsis

    +CREATE POLICY

    CREATE POLICY

    CREATE POLICY — define a new row-level security policy for a table

    Synopsis

     CREATE POLICY name ON table_name
         [ AS { PERMISSIVE | RESTRICTIVE } ]
         [ FOR { ALL | SELECT | INSERT | UPDATE | DELETE } ]
    @@ -358,4 +358,4 @@ AND
       

    Compatibility

    CREATE POLICY is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createprocedure.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createprocedure.html index d819963..7bd34be 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createprocedure.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createprocedure.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE PROCEDURE

    CREATE PROCEDURE

    CREATE PROCEDURE — define a new procedure

    Synopsis

    +CREATE PROCEDURE

    CREATE PROCEDURE

    CREATE PROCEDURE — define a new procedure

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] PROCEDURE
         name ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [ { DEFAULT | = } default_expr ] [, ...] ] )
       { LANGUAGE lang_name
    @@ -205,4 +205,4 @@ CALL insert_data(1, 2);
        standard.  The PostgreSQL implementation can be
        used in a compatible way but has many extensions.  For details see also
        CREATE FUNCTION.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpublication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpublication.html index 01650b4..c2ddc1a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpublication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createpublication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE PUBLICATION

    CREATE PUBLICATION

    CREATE PUBLICATION — define a new publication

    Synopsis

    +CREATE PUBLICATION

    CREATE PUBLICATION

    CREATE PUBLICATION — define a new publication

    Synopsis

     CREATE PUBLICATION name
         [ FOR ALL TABLES
           | FOR publication_object [, ... ] ]
    @@ -229,4 +229,4 @@ CREATE PUBLICATION users_filtered FOR TABLE users (user_id, firstname);
     

    Compatibility

    CREATE PUBLICATION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrole.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrole.html index bdabf68..f0a1b82 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrole.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrole.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE ROLE

    CREATE ROLE

    CREATE ROLE — define a new database role

    Synopsis

    +CREATE ROLE

    CREATE ROLE

    CREATE ROLE — define a new database role

    Synopsis

     CREATE ROLE name [ [ WITH ] option [ ... ] ]
     
     where option can be:
    @@ -266,4 +266,4 @@ CREATE ROLE name [ WITH ADMIN NOINHERIT attribute, while roles are
        given the INHERIT attribute.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrule.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrule.html index e90a8f9..2ff6f42 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrule.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createrule.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE RULE

    CREATE RULE

    CREATE RULE — define a new rewrite rule

    Synopsis

    +CREATE RULE

    CREATE RULE

    CREATE RULE — define a new rewrite rule

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] RULE name AS ON event
         TO table_name [ WHERE condition ]
         DO [ ALSO | INSTEAD ] { NOTHING | command | ( command ; command ... ) }
    @@ -173,4 +173,4 @@ UPDATE mytable SET name = 'foo' WHERE id = 42;
        CREATE RULE is a
        PostgreSQL language extension, as is the
        entire query rewrite system.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createschema.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createschema.html index 70be55b..e44bd11 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createschema.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createschema.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE SCHEMA

    CREATE SCHEMA

    CREATE SCHEMA — define a new schema

    Synopsis

    +CREATE SCHEMA

    CREATE SCHEMA

    CREATE SCHEMA — define a new schema

    Synopsis

     CREATE SCHEMA schema_name [ AUTHORIZATION role_specification ] [ schema_element [ ... ] ]
     CREATE SCHEMA AUTHORIZATION role_specification [ schema_element [ ... ] ]
     CREATE SCHEMA IF NOT EXISTS schema_name [ AUTHORIZATION role_specification ]
    @@ -115,4 +115,4 @@ CREATE VIEW hollywood.winners AS
       

    The IF NOT EXISTS option is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsequence.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsequence.html index 5205ed0..8f612ea 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsequence.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsequence.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE SEQUENCE

    CREATE SEQUENCE

    CREATE SEQUENCE — define a new sequence generator

    Synopsis

    +CREATE SEQUENCE

    CREATE SEQUENCE

    CREATE SEQUENCE — define a new sequence generator

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] SEQUENCE [ IF NOT EXISTS ] name
         [ AS data_type ]
         [ INCREMENT [ BY ] increment ]
    @@ -211,4 +211,4 @@ END;
          

  • The OWNED BY clause is a PostgreSQL extension. -

  • \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createserver.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createserver.html index b92f23d..9b66bb9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createserver.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createserver.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE SERVER

    CREATE SERVER

    CREATE SERVER — define a new foreign server

    Synopsis

    +CREATE SERVER

    CREATE SERVER

    CREATE SERVER — define a new foreign server

    Synopsis

     CREATE SERVER [ IF NOT EXISTS ] server_name [ TYPE 'server_type' ] [ VERSION 'server_version' ]
         FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER fdw_name
         [ OPTIONS ( option 'value' [, ... ] ) ]
    @@ -53,4 +53,4 @@ CREATE SERVER myserver FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER postgres_fdw OPTIONS (host 'foo', db
        See postgres_fdw for more details.
       

    Compatibility

    CREATE SERVER conforms to ISO/IEC 9075-9 (SQL/MED). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createstatistics.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createstatistics.html index c5d23c2..a394cde 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createstatistics.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createstatistics.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE STATISTICS

    CREATE STATISTICS

    CREATE STATISTICS — define extended statistics

    Synopsis

    +CREATE STATISTICS

    CREATE STATISTICS

    CREATE STATISTICS — define extended statistics

    Synopsis

     CREATE STATISTICS [ IF NOT EXISTS ] statistics_name
         ON ( expression )
         FROM table_name
    @@ -207,4 +207,4 @@ EXPLAIN ANALYZE SELECT date_trunc('month', a), date_trunc('day', a)
        more accurate estimates.
       

    Compatibility

    There is no CREATE STATISTICS command in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsubscription.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsubscription.html index 66ff222..ff053f5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsubscription.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createsubscription.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE SUBSCRIPTION

    CREATE SUBSCRIPTION

    CREATE SUBSCRIPTION — define a new subscription

    Synopsis

    +CREATE SUBSCRIPTION

    CREATE SUBSCRIPTION

    CREATE SUBSCRIPTION — define a new subscription

    Synopsis

     CREATE SUBSCRIPTION subscription_name
         CONNECTION 'conninfo'
         PUBLICATION publication_name [, ...]
    @@ -214,4 +214,4 @@ CREATE SUBSCRIPTION mysub
     

    Compatibility

    CREATE SUBSCRIPTION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtable.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtable.html index 473703b..d902ffe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtable.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtable.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TABLE

    CREATE TABLE

    CREATE TABLE — define a new table

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TABLE

    CREATE TABLE

    CREATE TABLE — define a new table

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXISTS ] table_name ( [
       { column_name data_type [ COMPRESSION compression_method ] [ COLLATE collation ] [ column_constraint [ ... ] ]
         | table_constraint
    @@ -705,10 +705,11 @@ WITH ( MODULUS numeric_literal, REMAIN
           contain values that match values in the referenced
           column(s) of some row of the referenced table.  If the refcolumn list is omitted, the
           primary key of the reftable
    -      is used.  The referenced columns must be the columns of a non-deferrable
    -      unique or primary key constraint in the referenced table.  The user
    -      must have REFERENCES permission on the referenced table
    -      (either the whole table, or the specific referenced columns).  The
    +      is used.  Otherwise, the refcolumn
    +      list must refer to the columns of a non-deferrable unique or primary key
    +      constraint or be the columns of a non-partial unique index.  The user
    +      must have REFERENCES permission on the referenced
    +      table (either the whole table, or the specific referenced columns).  The
           addition of a foreign key constraint requires a
           SHARE ROW EXCLUSIVE lock on the referenced table.
           Note that foreign key constraints cannot be defined between temporary
    @@ -1389,10 +1390,14 @@ CREATE TABLE cities_partdef
        

    EXCLUDE Constraint

    The EXCLUDE constraint type is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    Foreign-Key Constraint Actions

    - The ability to specify column lists in the foreign-key actions +

    Foreign Key Constraints

    + The ability to specify column lists in the foreign key actions SET DEFAULT and SET NULL is a PostgreSQL extension. +

    + It is a PostgreSQL extension that a + foreign key constraint may reference columns of a unique index instead of + columns of a primary key or unique constraint.

    NULL Constraint

    The NULL constraint (actually a non-constraint) is a PostgreSQL @@ -1467,4 +1472,4 @@ CREATE TABLE cities_partdef

    PARTITION OF Clause

    The PARTITION OF clause is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtableas.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtableas.html index ccd08bd..67e975a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtableas.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtableas.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TABLE AS

    CREATE TABLE AS

    CREATE TABLE AS — define a new table from the results of a query

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TABLE AS

    CREATE TABLE AS

    CREATE TABLE AS — define a new table from the results of a query

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ [ GLOBAL | LOCAL ] { TEMPORARY | TEMP } | UNLOGGED ] TABLE [ IF NOT EXISTS ] table_name
         [ (column_name [, ...] ) ]
         [ USING method ]
    @@ -145,4 +145,4 @@ CREATE TEMP TABLE films_recent ON COMMIT DROP AS
           The PostgreSQL concept of tablespaces is not
           part of the standard.  Hence, the clause TABLESPACE
           is an extension.
    -     

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtablespace.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtablespace.html index df16fbf..e422abf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtablespace.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtablespace.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TABLESPACE

    CREATE TABLESPACE

    CREATE TABLESPACE — define a new tablespace

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TABLESPACE

    CREATE TABLESPACE

    CREATE TABLESPACE — define a new tablespace

    Synopsis

     CREATE TABLESPACE tablespace_name
         [ OWNER { new_owner | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER } ]
         LOCATION 'directory'
    @@ -77,4 +77,4 @@ CREATE TABLESPACE indexspace OWNER genevieve LOCATION '/data/indexes';
     

    Compatibility

    CREATE TABLESPACE is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtransform.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtransform.html index a237ad0..42ae69d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtransform.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtransform.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TRANSFORM

    CREATE TRANSFORM

    CREATE TRANSFORM — define a new transform

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TRANSFORM

    CREATE TRANSFORM

    CREATE TRANSFORM — define a new transform

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] TRANSFORM FOR type_name LANGUAGE lang_name (
         FROM SQL WITH FUNCTION from_sql_function_name [ (argument_type [, ...]) ],
         TO SQL WITH FUNCTION to_sql_function_name [ (argument_type [, ...]) ]
    @@ -103,4 +103,4 @@ CREATE TRANSFORM FOR hstore LANGUAGE plpython3u (
        CREATE LANGUAGE,
        CREATE TYPE,
        DROP TRANSFORM
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtrigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtrigger.html index 66d5fee..96d971e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtrigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtrigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TRIGGER

    CREATE TRIGGER

    CREATE TRIGGER — define a new trigger

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TRIGGER

    CREATE TRIGGER

    CREATE TRIGGER — define a new trigger

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ CONSTRAINT ] TRIGGER name { BEFORE | AFTER | INSTEAD OF } { event [ OR ... ] }
         ON table_name
         [ FROM referenced_table_name ]
    @@ -458,4 +458,4 @@ CREATE TRIGGER paired_items_update
        PostgreSQL extension of the SQL
        standard.
        So is the OR REPLACE option.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsconfig.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsconfig.html index da7e8bd..38378cf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsconfig.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsconfig.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — define a new text search configuration

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — define a new text search configuration

    Synopsis

     CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION name (
         PARSER = parser_name |
         COPY = source_config
    @@ -37,4 +37,4 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION name
       

    Compatibility

    There is no CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsdictionary.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsdictionary.html index 3d84e39..b0d85ad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsdictionary.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsdictionary.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — define a new text search dictionary

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — define a new text search dictionary

    Synopsis

     CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY name (
         TEMPLATE = template
         [, option = value [, ... ]]
    @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY my_russian (
     

    Compatibility

    There is no CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsparser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsparser.html index bb3bf12..5a4b9d2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsparser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtsparser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER — define a new text search parser

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER — define a new text search parser

    Synopsis

     CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER name (
         START = start_function ,
         GETTOKEN = gettoken_function ,
    @@ -48,4 +48,4 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER name (
        There is no
        CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER statement in the SQL
        standard.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtstemplate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtstemplate.html index a9beb76..f076c17 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtstemplate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtstemplate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — define a new text search template

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — define a new text search template

    Synopsis

     CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE name (
         [ INIT = init_function , ]
         LEXIZE = lexize_function
    @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE name (
        There is no
        CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE statement in the SQL
        standard.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtype.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtype.html index 207459e..576fb9b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtype.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createtype.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE TYPE

    CREATE TYPE

    CREATE TYPE — define a new data type

    Synopsis

    +CREATE TYPE

    CREATE TYPE

    CREATE TYPE — define a new data type

    Synopsis

     CREATE TYPE name AS
         ( [ attribute_name data_type [ COLLATE collation ] [, ... ] ] )
     
    @@ -652,4 +652,4 @@ CREATE TABLE big_objs (
        The ability to create a composite type with zero attributes is
        a PostgreSQL-specific deviation from the
        standard (analogous to the same case in CREATE TABLE).
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createuser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createuser.html index 90839be..4dc2433 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createuser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createuser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE USER

    CREATE USER

    CREATE USER — define a new database role

    Synopsis

    +CREATE USER

    CREATE USER

    CREATE USER — define a new database role

    Synopsis

     CREATE USER name [ [ WITH ] option [ ... ] ]
     
     where option can be:
    @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ CREATE USER name [ [ WITH ] CREATE USER statement is a
        PostgreSQL extension.  The SQL standard
        leaves the definition of users to the implementation.
    -  

    See Also

    CREATE ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CREATE ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createusermapping.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createusermapping.html index fd621d3..e9ae3bd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createusermapping.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createusermapping.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE USER MAPPING

    CREATE USER MAPPING

    CREATE USER MAPPING — define a new mapping of a user to a foreign server

    Synopsis

    +CREATE USER MAPPING

    CREATE USER MAPPING

    CREATE USER MAPPING — define a new mapping of a user to a foreign server

    Synopsis

     CREATE USER MAPPING [ IF NOT EXISTS ] FOR { user_name | USER | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | PUBLIC }
         SERVER server_name
         [ OPTIONS ( option 'value' [ , ... ] ) ]
    @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ CREATE USER MAPPING [ IF NOT EXISTS ] FOR { user_n
     CREATE USER MAPPING FOR bob SERVER foo OPTIONS (user 'bob', password 'secret');
     

    Compatibility

    CREATE USER MAPPING conforms to ISO/IEC 9075-9 (SQL/MED). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createview.html index 9cb89b9..5c46ac4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-createview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -CREATE VIEW

    CREATE VIEW

    CREATE VIEW — define a new view

    Synopsis

    +CREATE VIEW

    CREATE VIEW

    CREATE VIEW — define a new view

    Synopsis

     CREATE [ OR REPLACE ] [ TEMP | TEMPORARY ] [ RECURSIVE ] VIEW name [ ( column_name [, ...] ) ]
         [ WITH ( view_option_name [= view_option_value] [, ... ] ) ]
         AS query
    @@ -343,4 +343,4 @@ UNION ALL
        So is the concept of a temporary view.
        The WITH ( ... ) clause is an extension as well, as are
        security barrier views and security invoker views.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-deallocate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-deallocate.html index 231ad9c..cfd53b9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-deallocate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-deallocate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DEALLOCATE

    DEALLOCATE

    DEALLOCATE — deallocate a prepared statement

    Synopsis

    +DEALLOCATE

    DEALLOCATE

    DEALLOCATE — deallocate a prepared statement

    Synopsis

     DEALLOCATE [ PREPARE ] { name | ALL }
     

    Description

    DEALLOCATE is used to deallocate a previously @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ DEALLOCATE [ PREPARE ] { name | ALL }

    Compatibility

    The SQL standard includes a DEALLOCATE statement, but it is only for use in embedded SQL. -

    See Also

    EXECUTE, PREPARE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    EXECUTE, PREPARE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-declare.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-declare.html index b5f393a..0e6c2a7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-declare.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-declare.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DECLARE

    DECLARE

    DECLARE — define a cursor

    Synopsis

    +DECLARE

    DECLARE

    DECLARE — define a cursor

    Synopsis

     DECLARE name [ BINARY ] [ ASENSITIVE | INSENSITIVE ] [ [ NO ] SCROLL ]
         CURSOR [ { WITH | WITHOUT } HOLD ] FOR query
     

    Description

    @@ -197,4 +197,4 @@ DECLARE liahona CURSOR FOR SELECT * FROM films;

    Binary cursors are a PostgreSQL extension. -

    See Also

    CLOSE, FETCH, MOVE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CLOSE, FETCH, MOVE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-delete.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-delete.html index abb8449..1ab82e4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-delete.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-delete.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DELETE

    DELETE

    DELETE — delete rows of a table

    Synopsis

    +DELETE

    DELETE

    DELETE — delete rows of a table

    Synopsis

     [ WITH [ RECURSIVE ] with_query [, ...] ]
     DELETE FROM [ ONLY ] table_name [ * ] [ [ AS ] alias ]
         [ USING from_item [, ...] ]
    @@ -142,4 +142,4 @@ DELETE FROM tasks WHERE CURRENT OF c_tasks;
        that the USING and RETURNING clauses
        are PostgreSQL extensions, as is the ability
        to use WITH with DELETE.
    -  

    See Also

    TRUNCATE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    TRUNCATE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-discard.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-discard.html index 8496252..650c185 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-discard.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-discard.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DISCARD

    DISCARD

    DISCARD — discard session state

    Synopsis

    +DISCARD

    DISCARD

    DISCARD — discard session state

    Synopsis

     DISCARD { ALL | PLANS | SEQUENCES | TEMPORARY | TEMP }
     

    Description

    DISCARD releases internal resources associated with a @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@ DISCARD SEQUENCES; DISCARD ALL cannot be executed inside a transaction block.

    Compatibility

    DISCARD is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-do.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-do.html index f6c6de7..7176903 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-do.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-do.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DO

    DO

    DO — execute an anonymous code block

    Synopsis

    +DO

    DO

    DO — execute an anonymous code block

    Synopsis

     DO [ LANGUAGE lang_name ] code
     

    Description

    DO executes an anonymous code block, or in other @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ BEGIN END$$;

    Compatibility

    There is no DO statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-access-method.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-access-method.html index e896988..08a9ad0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-access-method.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-access-method.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP ACCESS METHOD

    DROP ACCESS METHOD

    DROP ACCESS METHOD — remove an access method

    Synopsis

    +DROP ACCESS METHOD

    DROP ACCESS METHOD

    DROP ACCESS METHOD — remove an access method

    Synopsis

     DROP ACCESS METHOD [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP ACCESS METHOD removes an existing access method. @@ -24,4 +24,4 @@ DROP ACCESS METHOD heptree;

    Compatibility

    DROP ACCESS METHOD is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-owned.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-owned.html index 5eb5a00..2d79223 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-owned.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-drop-owned.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP OWNED

    DROP OWNED

    DROP OWNED — remove database objects owned by a database role

    Synopsis

    +DROP OWNED

    DROP OWNED

    DROP OWNED — remove database objects owned by a database role

    Synopsis

     DROP OWNED BY { name | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER } [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP OWNED drops all the objects within the current @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@ DROP OWNED BY { name | CURRENT_ROLE |

    Compatibility

    The DROP OWNED command is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropaggregate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropaggregate.html index e598e9c..7fb42fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropaggregate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropaggregate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP AGGREGATE

    DROP AGGREGATE

    DROP AGGREGATE — remove an aggregate function

    Synopsis

    +DROP AGGREGATE

    DROP AGGREGATE

    DROP AGGREGATE — remove an aggregate function

    Synopsis

     DROP AGGREGATE [ IF EXISTS ] name ( aggregate_signature ) [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     
     where aggregate_signature is:
    @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ DROP AGGREGATE myavg(integer), myavg(bigint);
     

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP AGGREGATE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcast.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcast.html index 675e77b..13a4456 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcast.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcast.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP CAST

    DROP CAST

    DROP CAST — remove a cast

    Synopsis

    +DROP CAST

    DROP CAST

    DROP CAST — remove a cast

    Synopsis

     DROP CAST [ IF EXISTS ] (source_type AS target_type) [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP CAST removes a previously defined cast. @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ DROP CAST [ IF EXISTS ] (source_type A DROP CAST (text AS int);

    Compatibility

    The DROP CAST command conforms to the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    CREATE CAST
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CREATE CAST
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcollation.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcollation.html index 747a8b6..c3dc284 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcollation.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropcollation.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP COLLATION

    DROP COLLATION

    DROP COLLATION — remove a collation

    Synopsis

    +DROP COLLATION

    DROP COLLATION

    DROP COLLATION — remove a collation

    Synopsis

     DROP COLLATION [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP COLLATION removes a previously defined collation. @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ DROP COLLATION german; The DROP COLLATION command conforms to the SQL standard, apart from the IF EXISTS option, which is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropconversion.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropconversion.html index 2b9a7e2..f55d42e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropconversion.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropconversion.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP CONVERSION

    DROP CONVERSION

    DROP CONVERSION — remove a conversion

    Synopsis

    +DROP CONVERSION

    DROP CONVERSION

    DROP CONVERSION — remove a conversion

    Synopsis

     DROP CONVERSION [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP CONVERSION removes a previously defined conversion. @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ DROP CONVERSION myname; goes along with the CREATE TRANSLATION statement that is similar to the CREATE CONVERSION statement in PostgreSQL. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdatabase.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdatabase.html index 20f74d7..611b9b6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdatabase.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdatabase.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP DATABASE

    DROP DATABASE

    DROP DATABASE — remove a database

    Synopsis

    +DROP DATABASE

    DROP DATABASE

    DROP DATABASE — remove a database

    Synopsis

     DROP DATABASE [ IF EXISTS ] name [ [ WITH ] ( option [, ...] ) ]
     
     where option can be:
    @@ -41,4 +41,4 @@ DROP DATABASE [ IF EXISTS ] name [ [ W
        which is a wrapper around this command.
       

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP DATABASE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdomain.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdomain.html index c0410a1..584f74f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdomain.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropdomain.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP DOMAIN

    DROP DOMAIN

    DROP DOMAIN — remove a domain

    Synopsis

    +DROP DOMAIN

    DROP DOMAIN

    DROP DOMAIN — remove a domain

    Synopsis

     DROP DOMAIN [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP DOMAIN removes a domain. Only the owner of @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ DROP DOMAIN box; This command conforms to the SQL standard, except for the IF EXISTS option, which is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropeventtrigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropeventtrigger.html index 9137035..e432536 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropeventtrigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropeventtrigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP EVENT TRIGGER

    DROP EVENT TRIGGER

    DROP EVENT TRIGGER — remove an event trigger

    Synopsis

    +DROP EVENT TRIGGER

    DROP EVENT TRIGGER

    DROP EVENT TRIGGER — remove an event trigger

    Synopsis

     DROP EVENT TRIGGER [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP EVENT TRIGGER removes an existing event trigger. @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ DROP EVENT TRIGGER snitch;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP EVENT TRIGGER statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropextension.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropextension.html index 25e3b11..e696c28 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropextension.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropextension.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP EXTENSION

    DROP EXTENSION

    DROP EXTENSION — remove an extension

    Synopsis

    +DROP EXTENSION

    DROP EXTENSION

    DROP EXTENSION — remove an extension

    Synopsis

     DROP EXTENSION [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP EXTENSION removes extensions from the database. @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ DROP EXTENSION hstore;

    Compatibility

    DROP EXTENSION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigndatawrapper.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigndatawrapper.html index 36f8816..7a45a3f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigndatawrapper.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigndatawrapper.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — remove a foreign-data wrapper

    Synopsis

    +DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER

    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER — remove a foreign-data wrapper

    Synopsis

     DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER removes an existing @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi; DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER conforms to ISO/IEC 9075-9 (SQL/MED). The IF EXISTS clause is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigntable.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigntable.html index 15613fd..b63019b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigntable.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropforeigntable.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP FOREIGN TABLE

    DROP FOREIGN TABLE

    DROP FOREIGN TABLE — remove a foreign table

    Synopsis

    +DROP FOREIGN TABLE

    DROP FOREIGN TABLE

    DROP FOREIGN TABLE — remove a foreign table

    Synopsis

     DROP FOREIGN TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP FOREIGN TABLE removes a foreign table. @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ DROP FOREIGN TABLE films, distributors; standard only allows one foreign table to be dropped per command, and apart from the IF EXISTS option, which is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropfunction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropfunction.html index 619cb77..55097b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropfunction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropfunction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP FUNCTION

    DROP FUNCTION

    DROP FUNCTION — remove a function

    Synopsis

    +DROP FUNCTION

    DROP FUNCTION

    DROP FUNCTION — remove a function

    Synopsis

     DROP FUNCTION [ IF EXISTS ] name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ] [, ...]
         [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    @@ -64,4 +64,4 @@ DROP FUNCTION update_employee_salaries();

    Compatibility

    This command conforms to the SQL standard, with these PostgreSQL extensions: -

    • The standard only allows one function to be dropped per command.

    • The IF EXISTS option

    • The ability to specify argument modes and names

    \ No newline at end of file +

    • The standard only allows one function to be dropped per command.

    • The IF EXISTS option

    • The ability to specify argument modes and names

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropgroup.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropgroup.html index 91dbe76..125c103 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropgroup.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropgroup.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -DROP GROUP

    DROP GROUP

    DROP GROUP — remove a database role

    Synopsis

    +DROP GROUP

    DROP GROUP

    DROP GROUP — remove a database role

    Synopsis

     DROP GROUP [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...]
     

    Description

    DROP GROUP is now an alias for DROP ROLE.

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP GROUP statement in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    DROP ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    DROP ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropindex.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropindex.html index dd4d8d3..36fa793 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropindex.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropindex.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP INDEX

    DROP INDEX

    DROP INDEX — remove an index

    Synopsis

    +DROP INDEX

    DROP INDEX

    DROP INDEX — remove an index

    Synopsis

     DROP INDEX [ CONCURRENTLY ] [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP INDEX drops an existing index from the database @@ -47,4 +47,4 @@ DROP INDEX title_idx; DROP INDEX is a PostgreSQL language extension. There are no provisions for indexes in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    CREATE INDEX
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CREATE INDEX
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droplanguage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droplanguage.html index b45c987..e455ab9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droplanguage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droplanguage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP LANGUAGE

    DROP LANGUAGE

    DROP LANGUAGE — remove a procedural language

    Synopsis

    +DROP LANGUAGE

    DROP LANGUAGE

    DROP LANGUAGE — remove a procedural language

    Synopsis

     DROP [ PROCEDURAL ] LANGUAGE [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP LANGUAGE removes the definition of a @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ DROP LANGUAGE plsample;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP LANGUAGE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropmaterializedview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropmaterializedview.html index b9a2bbf..e81816f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropmaterializedview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropmaterializedview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW

    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW

    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW — remove a materialized view

    Synopsis

    +DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW

    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW

    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW — remove a materialized view

    Synopsis

     DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW drops an existing materialized @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW order_summary;

    Compatibility

    DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopclass.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopclass.html index c74596b..9aa000d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopclass.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopclass.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP OPERATOR CLASS

    DROP OPERATOR CLASS

    DROP OPERATOR CLASS — remove an operator class

    Synopsis

    +DROP OPERATOR CLASS

    DROP OPERATOR CLASS

    DROP OPERATOR CLASS — remove an operator class

    Synopsis

     DROP OPERATOR CLASS [ IF EXISTS ] name USING index_method [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP OPERATOR CLASS drops an existing operator class. @@ -44,4 +44,4 @@ DROP OPERATOR CLASS widget_ops USING btree;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP OPERATOR CLASS statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropoperator.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropoperator.html index e8dc11e..01c0f5c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropoperator.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropoperator.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP OPERATOR

    DROP OPERATOR

    DROP OPERATOR — remove an operator

    Synopsis

    +DROP OPERATOR

    DROP OPERATOR

    DROP OPERATOR — remove an operator

    Synopsis

     DROP OPERATOR [ IF EXISTS ] name ( { left_type | NONE } , right_type ) [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP OPERATOR drops an existing operator from @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ DROP OPERATOR ~ (none, bit); DROP OPERATOR ~ (none, bit), ^ (integer, integer);

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP OPERATOR statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopfamily.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopfamily.html index 5b57537..8f81043 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopfamily.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropopfamily.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP OPERATOR FAMILY

    DROP OPERATOR FAMILY

    DROP OPERATOR FAMILY — remove an operator family

    Synopsis

    +DROP OPERATOR FAMILY

    DROP OPERATOR FAMILY

    DROP OPERATOR FAMILY — remove an operator family

    Synopsis

     DROP OPERATOR FAMILY [ IF EXISTS ] name USING index_method [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP OPERATOR FAMILY drops an existing operator family. @@ -37,4 +37,4 @@ DROP OPERATOR FAMILY float_ops USING btree;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP OPERATOR FAMILY statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppolicy.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppolicy.html index 4ca62fd..0fe3894 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppolicy.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppolicy.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP POLICY

    DROP POLICY

    DROP POLICY — remove a row-level security policy from a table

    Synopsis

    +DROP POLICY

    DROP POLICY

    DROP POLICY — remove a row-level security policy from a table

    Synopsis

     DROP POLICY [ IF EXISTS ] name ON table_name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP POLICY removes the specified policy from the table. @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ DROP POLICY [ IF EXISTS ] name ON

    Compatibility

    DROP POLICY is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropprocedure.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropprocedure.html index e2e0b11..b45f53f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropprocedure.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropprocedure.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP PROCEDURE

    DROP PROCEDURE

    DROP PROCEDURE — remove a procedure

    Synopsis

    +DROP PROCEDURE

    DROP PROCEDURE

    DROP PROCEDURE — remove a procedure

    Synopsis

     DROP PROCEDURE [ IF EXISTS ] name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ] [, ...]
         [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    @@ -93,4 +93,4 @@ CREATE PROCEDURE do_db_maintenance(IN target_schema text, IN options text) ... This command conforms to the SQL standard, with these PostgreSQL extensions:

    • The standard only allows one procedure to be dropped per command.

    • The IF EXISTS option is an extension.

    • The ability to specify argument modes and names is an - extension, and the lookup rules differ when modes are given.

    \ No newline at end of file + extension, and the lookup rules differ when modes are given.

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppublication.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppublication.html index 53ca984..b84eacf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppublication.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droppublication.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP PUBLICATION

    DROP PUBLICATION

    DROP PUBLICATION — remove a publication

    Synopsis

    +DROP PUBLICATION

    DROP PUBLICATION

    DROP PUBLICATION — remove a publication

    Synopsis

     DROP PUBLICATION [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP PUBLICATION removes an existing publication from @@ -21,4 +21,4 @@ DROP PUBLICATION mypublication;

    Compatibility

    DROP PUBLICATION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprole.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprole.html index 1c78c64..4cdd267 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprole.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprole.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP ROLE

    DROP ROLE

    DROP ROLE — remove a database role

    Synopsis

    +DROP ROLE

    DROP ROLE

    DROP ROLE — remove a database role

    Synopsis

     DROP ROLE [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...]
     

    Description

    DROP ROLE removes the specified role(s). @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@ DROP ROLE jonathan; The SQL standard defines DROP ROLE, but it allows only one role to be dropped at a time, and it specifies different privilege requirements than PostgreSQL uses. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droproutine.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droproutine.html index e007c77..bdee1c9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droproutine.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droproutine.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP ROUTINE

    DROP ROUTINE

    DROP ROUTINE — remove a routine

    Synopsis

    +DROP ROUTINE

    DROP ROUTINE

    DROP ROUTINE — remove a routine

    Synopsis

     DROP ROUTINE [ IF EXISTS ] name [ ( [ [ argmode ] [ argname ] argtype [, ...] ] ) ] [, ...]
         [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ DROP ROUTINE foo(integer);

    • The standard only allows one routine to be dropped per command.

    • The IF EXISTS option is an extension.

    • The ability to specify argument modes and names is an extension, and the lookup rules differ when modes are given.

    • User-definable aggregate functions are an extension.

    See Also

    DROP AGGREGATE, DROP FUNCTION, DROP PROCEDURE, ALTER ROUTINE

    Note that there is no CREATE ROUTINE command. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprule.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprule.html index b09cbbd..424e42a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprule.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droprule.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP RULE

    DROP RULE

    DROP RULE — remove a rewrite rule

    Synopsis

    +DROP RULE

    DROP RULE

    DROP RULE — remove a rewrite rule

    Synopsis

     DROP RULE [ IF EXISTS ] name ON table_name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP RULE drops a rewrite rule. @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ DROP RULE newrule ON mytable; DROP RULE is a PostgreSQL language extension, as is the entire query rewrite system. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropschema.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropschema.html index 01ca42e..e5bfb74 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropschema.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropschema.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP SCHEMA

    DROP SCHEMA

    DROP SCHEMA — remove a schema

    Synopsis

    +DROP SCHEMA

    DROP SCHEMA

    DROP SCHEMA — remove a schema

    Synopsis

     DROP SCHEMA [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP SCHEMA removes schemas from the database. @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ DROP SCHEMA mystuff CASCADE; dropped per command, and apart from the IF EXISTS option, which is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsequence.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsequence.html index 332304d..1673ead 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsequence.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsequence.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP SEQUENCE

    DROP SEQUENCE

    DROP SEQUENCE — remove a sequence

    Synopsis

    +DROP SEQUENCE

    DROP SEQUENCE

    DROP SEQUENCE — remove a sequence

    Synopsis

     DROP SEQUENCE [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP SEQUENCE removes sequence number @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ DROP SEQUENCE serial; sequence to be dropped per command, and apart from the IF EXISTS option, which is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropserver.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropserver.html index b94b68c..a5de23e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropserver.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropserver.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP SERVER

    DROP SERVER

    DROP SERVER — remove a foreign server descriptor

    Synopsis

    +DROP SERVER

    DROP SERVER

    DROP SERVER — remove a foreign server descriptor

    Synopsis

     DROP SERVER [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP SERVER removes an existing foreign server @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ DROP SERVER IF EXISTS foo; DROP SERVER conforms to ISO/IEC 9075-9 (SQL/MED). The IF EXISTS clause is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropstatistics.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropstatistics.html index f3cd4f0..0e9c5fa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropstatistics.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropstatistics.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP STATISTICS

    DROP STATISTICS

    DROP STATISTICS — remove extended statistics

    Synopsis

    +DROP STATISTICS

    DROP STATISTICS

    DROP STATISTICS — remove extended statistics

    Synopsis

     DROP STATISTICS [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP STATISTICS removes statistics object(s) from the @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ DROP STATISTICS IF EXISTS public.grants_user_role;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP STATISTICS command in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsubscription.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsubscription.html index c41dfb3..a39c4fd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsubscription.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropsubscription.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP SUBSCRIPTION

    DROP SUBSCRIPTION

    DROP SUBSCRIPTION — remove a subscription

    Synopsis

    +DROP SUBSCRIPTION

    DROP SUBSCRIPTION

    DROP SUBSCRIPTION — remove a subscription

    Synopsis

     DROP SUBSCRIPTION [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP SUBSCRIPTION removes a subscription from the @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ DROP SUBSCRIPTION mysub;

    Compatibility

    DROP SUBSCRIPTION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptable.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptable.html index 6c8c47e..c8943aa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptable.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptable.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TABLE

    DROP TABLE

    DROP TABLE — remove a table

    Synopsis

    +DROP TABLE

    DROP TABLE

    DROP TABLE — remove a table

    Synopsis

     DROP TABLE [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TABLE removes tables from the database. @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ DROP TABLE films, distributors; allows one table to be dropped per command, and apart from the IF EXISTS option, which is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptablespace.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptablespace.html index 2e58cc2..2ac0f9f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptablespace.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptablespace.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TABLESPACE

    DROP TABLESPACE

    DROP TABLESPACE — remove a tablespace

    Synopsis

    +DROP TABLESPACE

    DROP TABLESPACE

    DROP TABLESPACE — remove a tablespace

    Synopsis

     DROP TABLESPACE [ IF EXISTS ] name
     

    Description

    DROP TABLESPACE removes a tablespace from the system. @@ -25,4 +25,4 @@ DROP TABLESPACE mystuff;

    Compatibility

    DROP TABLESPACE is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptransform.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptransform.html index 301f568..954f26f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptransform.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptransform.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TRANSFORM

    DROP TRANSFORM

    DROP TRANSFORM — remove a transform

    Synopsis

    +DROP TRANSFORM

    DROP TRANSFORM

    DROP TRANSFORM — remove a transform

    Synopsis

     DROP TRANSFORM [ IF EXISTS ] FOR type_name LANGUAGE lang_name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TRANSFORM removes a previously defined transform. @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ DROP TRANSFORM FOR hstore LANGUAGE plpython3u;

    Compatibility

    This form of DROP TRANSFORM is a PostgreSQL extension. See CREATE TRANSFORM for details. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptrigger.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptrigger.html index 1899fbd..0149446 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptrigger.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptrigger.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TRIGGER

    DROP TRIGGER

    DROP TRIGGER — remove a trigger

    Synopsis

    +DROP TRIGGER

    DROP TRIGGER

    DROP TRIGGER — remove a trigger

    Synopsis

     DROP TRIGGER [ IF EXISTS ] name ON table_name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TRIGGER removes an existing @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ DROP TRIGGER if_dist_exists ON films; standard. In the SQL standard, trigger names are not local to tables, so the command is simply DROP TRIGGER name. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsconfig.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsconfig.html index 17a49d3..5601da6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsconfig.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsconfig.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — remove a text search configuration

    Synopsis

    +DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION

    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION — remove a text search configuration

    Synopsis

     DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION drops an existing text @@ -32,4 +32,4 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION my_english;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsdictionary.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsdictionary.html index 6c1b2ee..04d7524 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsdictionary.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsdictionary.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — remove a text search dictionary

    Synopsis

    +DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY

    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY — remove a text search dictionary

    Synopsis

     DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY drops an existing text @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY english;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsparser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsparser.html index fd492d1..8c4f182 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsparser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptsparser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER — remove a text search parser

    Synopsis

    +DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER

    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER — remove a text search parser

    Synopsis

     DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER drops an existing text search @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER my_parser;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptstemplate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptstemplate.html index 0c0edae..7359985 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptstemplate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptstemplate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — remove a text search template

    Synopsis

    +DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE

    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE — remove a text search template

    Synopsis

     DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE [ IF EXISTS ] name [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE drops an existing text search @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@ DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE thesaurus;

    Compatibility

    There is no DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptype.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptype.html index 8d68fb0..3eb4dd7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptype.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-droptype.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP TYPE

    DROP TYPE

    DROP TYPE — remove a data type

    Synopsis

    +DROP TYPE

    DROP TYPE

    DROP TYPE — remove a data type

    Synopsis

     DROP TYPE [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP TYPE removes a user-defined data type. @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ DROP TYPE box; But note that much of the CREATE TYPE command and the data type extension mechanisms in PostgreSQL differ from the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropuser.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropuser.html index a8317a2..1d2a020 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropuser.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropuser.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP USER

    DROP USER

    DROP USER — remove a database role

    Synopsis

    +DROP USER

    DROP USER

    DROP USER — remove a database role

    Synopsis

     DROP USER [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...]
     

    Description

    DROP USER is simply an alternate spelling of @@ -8,4 +8,4 @@ DROP USER [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] The DROP USER statement is a PostgreSQL extension. The SQL standard leaves the definition of users to the implementation. -

    See Also

    DROP ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    DROP ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropusermapping.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropusermapping.html index 187051a..130d6f4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropusermapping.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropusermapping.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP USER MAPPING

    DROP USER MAPPING

    DROP USER MAPPING — remove a user mapping for a foreign server

    Synopsis

    +DROP USER MAPPING

    DROP USER MAPPING

    DROP USER MAPPING — remove a user mapping for a foreign server

    Synopsis

     DROP USER MAPPING [ IF EXISTS ] FOR { user_name | USER | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | PUBLIC } SERVER server_name
     

    Description

    DROP USER MAPPING removes an existing user @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ DROP USER MAPPING IF EXISTS FOR bob SERVER foo; DROP USER MAPPING conforms to ISO/IEC 9075-9 (SQL/MED). The IF EXISTS clause is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropview.html index 7316310..2e49c49 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-dropview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -DROP VIEW

    DROP VIEW

    DROP VIEW — remove a view

    Synopsis

    +DROP VIEW

    DROP VIEW

    DROP VIEW — remove a view

    Synopsis

     DROP VIEW [ IF EXISTS ] name [, ...] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    DROP VIEW drops an existing view. To execute @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ DROP VIEW kinds; allows one view to be dropped per command, and apart from the IF EXISTS option, which is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-end.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-end.html index 8ab9840..c4812ae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-end.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-end.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -END

    END

    END — commit the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +END

    END

    END — commit the current transaction

    Synopsis

     END [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ AND [ NO ] CHAIN ]
     

    Description

    END commits the current transaction. All changes @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ END; END is a PostgreSQL extension that provides functionality equivalent to COMMIT, which is specified in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-execute.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-execute.html index 8ef612f..2fceabe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-execute.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-execute.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -EXECUTE

    EXECUTE

    EXECUTE — execute a prepared statement

    Synopsis

    +EXECUTE

    EXECUTE

    EXECUTE — execute a prepared statement

    Synopsis

     EXECUTE name [ ( parameter [, ...] ) ]
     

    Description

    EXECUTE is used to execute a previously prepared @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ EXECUTE name [ ( EXECUTE statement also uses a somewhat different syntax. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-explain.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-explain.html index fb29950..f5c5f9f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-explain.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-explain.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -EXPLAIN

    EXPLAIN

    EXPLAIN — show the execution plan of a statement

    Synopsis

    +EXPLAIN

    EXPLAIN

    EXPLAIN — show the execution plan of a statement

    Synopsis

     EXPLAIN [ ( option [, ...] ) ] statement
     EXPLAIN [ ANALYZE ] [ VERBOSE ] statement
     
    @@ -303,4 +303,4 @@ EXPLAIN ANALYZE EXECUTE query(100, 200);
        in the table has not changed.
       

    Compatibility

    There is no EXPLAIN statement defined in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    ANALYZE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    ANALYZE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-expressions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-expressions.html index fc67755..0f86f9a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-expressions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-expressions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -4.2. Value Expressions \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-fetch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-fetch.html index 0dd70b5..e105480 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-fetch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-fetch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -FETCH

    FETCH

    FETCH — retrieve rows from a query using a cursor

    Synopsis

    +FETCH

    FETCH

    FETCH — retrieve rows from a query using a cursor

    Synopsis

     FETCH [ direction ] [ FROM | IN ] cursor_name
     
     where direction can be one of:
    @@ -187,4 +187,4 @@ COMMIT WORK;
        The SQL standard allows only FROM preceding the cursor
        name; the option to use IN, or to leave them out altogether, is
        an extension.
    -  

    See Also

    CLOSE, DECLARE, MOVE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CLOSE, DECLARE, MOVE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-grant.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-grant.html index 9d4a136..4641786 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-grant.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-grant.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -GRANT

    GRANT

    GRANT — define access privileges

    Synopsis

    +GRANT

    GRANT

    GRANT — define access privileges

    Synopsis

     GRANT { { SELECT | INSERT | UPDATE | DELETE | TRUNCATE | REFERENCES | TRIGGER }
         [, ...] | ALL [ PRIVILEGES ] }
         ON { [ TABLE ] table_name [, ...]
    @@ -315,4 +315,4 @@ GRANT admins TO joe;
         Privileges on databases, tablespaces, schemas, languages, and
         configuration parameters are
         PostgreSQL extensions.
    -   

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-importforeignschema.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-importforeignschema.html index bea69bf..9736f1f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-importforeignschema.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-importforeignschema.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA

    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA

    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA — import table definitions from a foreign server

    Synopsis

    +IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA

    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA

    IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA — import table definitions from a foreign server

    Synopsis

     IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA remote_schema
         [ { LIMIT TO | EXCEPT } ( table_name [, ...] ) ]
         FROM SERVER server_name
    @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@ IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA foreign_films LIMIT TO (actors, directors)
        The IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA command conforms to the
        SQL standard, except that the OPTIONS
        clause is a PostgreSQL extension.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-insert.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-insert.html index e840ddc..e340201 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-insert.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-insert.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -INSERT

    INSERT

    INSERT — create new rows in a table

    Synopsis

    +INSERT

    INSERT

    INSERT — create new rows in a table

    Synopsis

     [ WITH [ RECURSIVE ] with_query [, ...] ]
     INSERT INTO table_name [ AS alias ] [ ( column_name [, ...] ) ]
         [ OVERRIDING { SYSTEM | USER } VALUE ]
    @@ -485,4 +485,4 @@ INSERT INTO distributors (did, dname) VALUES (10, 'Conrad International')
       

    Possible limitations of the query clause are documented under SELECT. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-keywords-appendix.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-keywords-appendix.html index 742b82c..f40cfb1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-keywords-appendix.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-keywords-appendix.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -Appendix C. SQL Key Words

    Appendix C. SQL Key Words

    +Appendix C. SQL Key Words

    Appendix C. SQL Key Words

    Table C.1 lists all tokens that are key words in the SQL standard and in PostgreSQL - 15.5. Background information can be found in Section 4.1.1. + 15.6. Background information can be found in Section 4.1.1. (For space reasons, only the latest two versions of the SQL standard, and SQL-92 for historical comparison, are included. The differences between those and the other intermediate standard versions are small.) @@ -60,4 +60,4 @@ reserved in PostgreSQL does not mean that the feature related to the word is not implemented. Conversely, the presence of a key word does not indicate the existence of a feature. -

    Table C.1. SQL Key Words

    Key WordPostgreSQLSQL:2016SQL:2011SQL-92
    A non-reservednon-reserved 
    ABORTnon-reserved   
    ABS reservedreserved 
    ABSENT reservednon-reserved 
    ABSOLUTEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ACCESSnon-reserved   
    ACCORDING non-reservednon-reserved 
    ACOS reserved  
    ACTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ADA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    ADDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ADMINnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    AFTERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    AGGREGATEnon-reserved   
    ALLreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ALLOCATE reservedreservedreserved
    ALSOnon-reserved   
    ALTERnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ALWAYSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ANALYSEreserved   
    ANALYZEreserved   
    ANDreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ANYreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ARE reservedreservedreserved
    ARRAYreserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    ARRAY_AGG reservedreserved 
    ARRAY_​MAX_​CARDINALITY reservedreserved 
    ASreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ASCreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ASENSITIVEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ASIN reserved  
    ASSERTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ASSIGNMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ASYMMETRICreservedreservedreserved 
    ATnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ATAN reserved  
    ATOMICnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ATTACHnon-reserved   
    ATTRIBUTEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ATTRIBUTES non-reservednon-reserved 
    AUTHORIZATIONreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    AVG reservedreservedreserved
    BACKWARDnon-reserved   
    BASE64 non-reservednon-reserved 
    BEFOREnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    BEGINnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    BEGIN_FRAME reservedreserved 
    BEGIN_PARTITION reservedreserved 
    BERNOULLI non-reservednon-reserved 
    BETWEENnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    BIGINTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    BINARYreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    BITnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)  reserved
    BIT_LENGTH   reserved
    BLOB reservedreserved 
    BLOCKED non-reservednon-reserved 
    BOM non-reservednon-reserved 
    BOOLEANnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    BOTHreservedreservedreservedreserved
    BREADTHnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    BYnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    C non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CACHEnon-reserved   
    CALLnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    CALLEDnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    CARDINALITY reservedreserved 
    CASCADEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CASCADEDnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CASEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CASTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CATALOGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CATALOG_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CEIL reservedreserved 
    CEILING reservedreserved 
    CHAINnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    CHAINING non-reserved  
    CHARnon-reserved (cannot be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    CHARACTERnon-reserved (cannot be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    CHARACTERISTICSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    CHARACTERS non-reservednon-reserved 
    CHARACTER_LENGTH reservedreservedreserved
    CHARACTER_​SET_​CATALOG non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CHARACTER_SET_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CHARACTER_SET_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CHAR_LENGTH reservedreservedreserved
    CHECKreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CHECKPOINTnon-reserved   
    CLASSnon-reserved   
    CLASSIFIER reserved  
    CLASS_ORIGIN non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CLOB reservedreserved 
    CLOSEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CLUSTERnon-reserved   
    COALESCEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    COBOL non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLATEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    COLLATIONreserved (can be function or type)non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    COLLATION_CATALOG non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLATION_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLATION_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLECT reservedreserved 
    COLUMNreservedreservedreservedreserved
    COLUMNSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    COLUMN_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COMMAND_FUNCTION non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COMMAND_​FUNCTION_​CODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    COMMENTnon-reserved   
    COMMENTSnon-reserved   
    COMMITnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    COMMITTEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COMPRESSIONnon-reserved   
    CONCURRENTLYreserved (can be function or type)   
    CONDITION reservedreserved 
    CONDITIONAL non-reserved  
    CONDITION_NUMBER non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONFIGURATIONnon-reserved   
    CONFLICTnon-reserved   
    CONNECT reservedreservedreserved
    CONNECTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CONNECTION_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRAINTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CONSTRAINTSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CONSTRAINT_CATALOG non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRAINT_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRAINT_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRUCTOR non-reservednon-reserved 
    CONTAINS reservedreserved 
    CONTENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    CONTINUEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CONTROL non-reservednon-reserved 
    CONVERSIONnon-reserved   
    CONVERT reservedreservedreserved
    COPYnon-reservedreserved  
    CORR reservedreserved 
    CORRESPONDING reservedreservedreserved
    COS reserved  
    COSH reserved  
    COSTnon-reserved   
    COUNT reservedreservedreserved
    COVAR_POP reservedreserved 
    COVAR_SAMP reservedreserved 
    CREATEreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    CROSSreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    CSVnon-reserved   
    CUBEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    CUME_DIST reservedreserved 
    CURRENTnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_CATALOGreservedreservedreserved 
    CURRENT_DATEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_​DEFAULT_​TRANSFORM_​GROUP reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_PATH reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_ROLEreservedreservedreserved 
    CURRENT_ROW reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_SCHEMAreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_TIMEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_TIMESTAMPreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_​TRANSFORM_​GROUP_​FOR_​TYPE reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_USERreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURSORnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURSOR_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CYCLEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    DATAnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DATABASEnon-reserved   
    DATALINK reservedreserved 
    DATE reservedreservedreserved
    DATETIME_​INTERVAL_​CODE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DATETIME_​INTERVAL_​PRECISION non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DAYnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    DB non-reservednon-reserved 
    DEALLOCATEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DECnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    DECFLOAT reserved  
    DECIMALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    DECLAREnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DEFAULTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    DEFAULTSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DEFERRABLEreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DEFERREDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DEFINE reserved  
    DEFINED non-reservednon-reserved 
    DEFINERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DEGREE non-reservednon-reserved 
    DELETEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DELIMITERnon-reserved   
    DELIMITERSnon-reserved   
    DENSE_RANK reservedreserved 
    DEPENDSnon-reserved   
    DEPTHnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DEREF reservedreserved 
    DERIVED non-reservednon-reserved 
    DESCreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DESCRIBE reservedreservedreserved
    DESCRIPTOR non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DETACHnon-reserved   
    DETERMINISTIC reservedreserved 
    DIAGNOSTICS non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DICTIONARYnon-reserved   
    DISABLEnon-reserved   
    DISCARDnon-reserved   
    DISCONNECT reservedreservedreserved
    DISPATCH non-reservednon-reserved 
    DISTINCTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    DLNEWCOPY reservedreserved 
    DLPREVIOUSCOPY reservedreserved 
    DLURLCOMPLETE reservedreserved 
    DLURLCOMPLETEONLY reservedreserved 
    DLURLCOMPLETEWRITE reservedreserved 
    DLURLPATH reservedreserved 
    DLURLPATHONLY reservedreserved 
    DLURLPATHWRITE reservedreserved 
    DLURLSCHEME reservedreserved 
    DLURLSERVER reservedreserved 
    DLVALUE reservedreserved 
    DOreserved   
    DOCUMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DOMAINnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DOUBLEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DROPnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DYNAMIC reservedreserved 
    DYNAMIC_FUNCTION non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DYNAMIC_​FUNCTION_​CODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    EACHnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ELEMENT reservedreserved 
    ELSEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    EMPTY reservednon-reserved 
    ENABLEnon-reserved   
    ENCODINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ENCRYPTEDnon-reserved   
    ENDreservedreservedreservedreserved
    END-EXEC reservedreservedreserved
    END_FRAME reservedreserved 
    END_PARTITION reservedreserved 
    ENFORCED non-reservednon-reserved 
    ENUMnon-reserved   
    EQUALS reservedreserved 
    ERROR non-reserved  
    ESCAPEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    EVENTnon-reserved   
    EVERY reservedreserved 
    EXCEPTreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    EXCEPTION   reserved
    EXCLUDEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    EXCLUDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    EXCLUSIVEnon-reserved   
    EXEC reservedreservedreserved
    EXECUTEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    EXISTSnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    EXP reservedreserved 
    EXPLAINnon-reserved   
    EXPRESSIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    EXTENSIONnon-reserved   
    EXTERNALnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    EXTRACTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    FALSEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    FAMILYnon-reserved   
    FETCHreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    FILE non-reservednon-reserved 
    FILTERnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    FINAL non-reservednon-reserved 
    FINALIZEnon-reserved   
    FINISH non-reserved  
    FIRSTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    FIRST_VALUE reservedreserved 
    FLAG non-reservednon-reserved 
    FLOATnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    FLOOR reservedreserved 
    FOLLOWINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    FORreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    FORCEnon-reserved   
    FOREIGNreservedreservedreservedreserved
    FORMAT non-reserved  
    FORTRAN non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    FORWARDnon-reserved   
    FOUND non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    FRAME_ROW reservedreserved 
    FREE reservedreserved 
    FREEZEreserved (can be function or type)   
    FROMreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    FS non-reservednon-reserved 
    FULFILL non-reserved  
    FULLreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    FUNCTIONnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    FUNCTIONSnon-reserved   
    FUSION reservedreserved 
    G non-reservednon-reserved 
    GENERAL non-reservednon-reserved 
    GENERATEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    GET reservedreservedreserved
    GLOBALnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    GO non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    GOTO non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    GRANTreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    GRANTEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    GREATESTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    GROUPreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    GROUPINGnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    GROUPSnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    HANDLERnon-reserved   
    HAVINGreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    HEADERnon-reserved   
    HEX non-reservednon-reserved 
    HIERARCHY non-reservednon-reserved 
    HOLDnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    HOURnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ID non-reservednon-reserved 
    IDENTITYnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    IFnon-reserved   
    IGNORE non-reservednon-reserved 
    ILIKEreserved (can be function or type)   
    IMMEDIATEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    IMMEDIATELY non-reservednon-reserved 
    IMMUTABLEnon-reserved   
    IMPLEMENTATION non-reservednon-reserved 
    IMPLICITnon-reserved   
    IMPORTnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    INreservedreservedreservedreserved
    INCLUDEnon-reserved   
    INCLUDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    INCREMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    INDENT non-reservednon-reserved 
    INDEXnon-reserved   
    INDEXESnon-reserved   
    INDICATOR reservedreservedreserved
    INHERITnon-reserved   
    INHERITSnon-reserved   
    INITIAL reserved  
    INITIALLYreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    INLINEnon-reserved   
    INNERreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INOUTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    INPUTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    INSENSITIVEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    INSERTnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    INSTANCE non-reservednon-reserved 
    INSTANTIABLE non-reservednon-reserved 
    INSTEADnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    INTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INTEGERnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INTEGRITY non-reservednon-reserved 
    INTERSECTreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    INTERSECTION reservedreserved 
    INTERVALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INTOreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    INVOKERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ISreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    ISNULLreserved (can be function or type), requires AS   
    ISOLATIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    JOINreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    JSON_ARRAY reserved  
    JSON_ARRAYAGG reserved  
    JSON_EXISTS reserved  
    JSON_OBJECT reserved  
    JSON_OBJECTAGG reserved  
    JSON_QUERY reserved  
    JSON_TABLE reserved  
    JSON_TABLE_PRIMITIVE reserved  
    JSON_VALUE reserved  
    K non-reservednon-reserved 
    KEEP non-reserved  
    KEYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    KEYS non-reserved  
    KEY_MEMBER non-reservednon-reserved 
    KEY_TYPE non-reservednon-reserved 
    LABELnon-reserved   
    LAG reservedreserved 
    LANGUAGEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    LARGEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    LASTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    LAST_VALUE reservedreserved 
    LATERALreservedreservedreserved 
    LEAD reservedreserved 
    LEADINGreservedreservedreservedreserved
    LEAKPROOFnon-reserved   
    LEASTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    LEFTreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    LEVELnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    LIBRARY non-reservednon-reserved 
    LIKEreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    LIKE_REGEX reservedreserved 
    LIMITreserved, requires ASnon-reservednon-reserved 
    LINK non-reservednon-reserved 
    LISTAGG reserved  
    LISTENnon-reserved   
    LN reservedreserved 
    LOADnon-reserved   
    LOCALnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    LOCALTIMEreservedreservedreserved 
    LOCALTIMESTAMPreservedreservedreserved 
    LOCATIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    LOCATOR non-reservednon-reserved 
    LOCKnon-reserved   
    LOCKEDnon-reserved   
    LOG reserved  
    LOG10 reserved  
    LOGGEDnon-reserved   
    LOWER reservedreservedreserved
    M non-reservednon-reserved 
    MAP non-reservednon-reserved 
    MAPPINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MATCHnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    MATCHEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MATCHES reserved  
    MATCH_NUMBER reserved  
    MATCH_RECOGNIZE reserved  
    MATERIALIZEDnon-reserved   
    MAX reservedreservedreserved
    MAXVALUEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MEASURES reserved  
    MEMBER reservedreserved 
    MERGEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    MESSAGE_LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    MESSAGE_OCTET_LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    MESSAGE_TEXT non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    METHODnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    MIN reservedreservedreserved
    MINUTEnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    MINVALUEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MOD reservedreserved 
    MODEnon-reserved   
    MODIFIES reservedreserved 
    MODULE reservedreservedreserved
    MONTHnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    MORE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    MOVEnon-reserved   
    MULTISET reservedreserved 
    MUMPS non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NAMEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NAMESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    NAMESPACE non-reservednon-reserved 
    NATIONALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NATURALreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NCHARnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NCLOB reservedreserved 
    NESTED non-reserved  
    NESTING non-reservednon-reserved 
    NEWnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    NEXTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    NFCnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NFDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NFKCnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NFKDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NIL non-reservednon-reserved 
    NOnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    NONEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    NORMALIZEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    NORMALIZEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NOTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    NOTHINGnon-reserved   
    NOTIFYnon-reserved   
    NOTNULLreserved (can be function or type), requires AS   
    NOWAITnon-reserved   
    NTH_VALUE reservedreserved 
    NTILE reservedreserved 
    NULLreservedreservedreservedreserved
    NULLABLE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NULLIFnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NULLSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NULL_ORDERING non-reserved  
    NUMBER non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NUMERICnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    OBJECTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OCCURRENCE non-reserved  
    OCCURRENCES_REGEX reservedreserved 
    OCTETS non-reservednon-reserved 
    OCTET_LENGTH reservedreservedreserved
    OFnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    OFFnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OFFSETreserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    OIDSnon-reserved   
    OLDnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    OMIT reserved  
    ONreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ONE reserved  
    ONLYreservedreservedreservedreserved
    OPEN reservedreservedreserved
    OPERATORnon-reserved   
    OPTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    OPTIONSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ORreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ORDERreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ORDERING non-reservednon-reserved 
    ORDINALITYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OTHERSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OUTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    OUTERreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    OUTPUT non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    OVERnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    OVERFLOW non-reserved  
    OVERLAPSreserved (can be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    OVERLAYnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    OVERRIDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OWNEDnon-reserved   
    OWNERnon-reserved   
    P non-reservednon-reserved 
    PAD non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PARALLELnon-reserved   
    PARAMETERnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    PARAMETER_MODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​ORDINAL_​POSITION non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​SPECIFIC_​CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​SPECIFIC_​NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​SPECIFIC_​SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARSERnon-reserved   
    PARTIALnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PARTITIONnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    PASCAL non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    PASS non-reserved  
    PASSINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    PASSTHROUGH non-reservednon-reserved 
    PASSWORDnon-reserved   
    PAST non-reserved  
    PATH non-reservednon-reserved 
    PATTERN reserved  
    PER reserved  
    PERCENT reservedreserved 
    PERCENTILE_CONT reservedreserved 
    PERCENTILE_DISC reservedreserved 
    PERCENT_RANK reservedreserved 
    PERIOD reservedreserved 
    PERMISSION non-reservednon-reserved 
    PERMUTE reserved  
    PIPE non-reserved  
    PLACINGreservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    PLAN non-reserved  
    PLANSnon-reserved   
    PLI non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    POLICYnon-reserved   
    PORTION reservedreserved 
    POSITIONnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    POSITION_REGEX reservedreserved 
    POWER reservedreserved 
    PRECEDES reservedreserved 
    PRECEDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    PRECISIONnon-reserved (cannot be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    PREPAREnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    PREPAREDnon-reserved   
    PRESERVEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PREV non-reserved  
    PRIMARYreservedreservedreservedreserved
    PRIORnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PRIVATE non-reserved  
    PRIVILEGESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PROCEDURALnon-reserved   
    PROCEDUREnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    PROCEDURESnon-reserved   
    PROGRAMnon-reserved   
    PRUNE non-reserved  
    PTF reserved  
    PUBLIC non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PUBLICATIONnon-reserved   
    QUOTEnon-reserved   
    QUOTES non-reserved  
    RANGEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    RANK reservedreserved 
    READnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    READS reservedreserved 
    REALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    REASSIGNnon-reserved   
    RECHECKnon-reserved   
    RECOVERY non-reservednon-reserved 
    RECURSIVEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REFnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REFERENCESreservedreservedreservedreserved
    REFERENCINGnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REFRESHnon-reserved   
    REGR_AVGX reservedreserved 
    REGR_AVGY reservedreserved 
    REGR_COUNT reservedreserved 
    REGR_INTERCEPT reservedreserved 
    REGR_R2 reservedreserved 
    REGR_SLOPE reservedreserved 
    REGR_SXX reservedreserved 
    REGR_SXY reservedreserved 
    REGR_SYY reservedreserved 
    REINDEXnon-reserved   
    RELATIVEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    RELEASEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    RENAMEnon-reserved   
    REPEATABLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    REPLACEnon-reserved   
    REPLICAnon-reserved   
    REQUIRING non-reservednon-reserved 
    RESETnon-reserved   
    RESPECT non-reservednon-reserved 
    RESTARTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    RESTORE non-reservednon-reserved 
    RESTRICTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    RESULT reservedreserved 
    RETURNnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    RETURNED_CARDINALITY non-reservednon-reserved 
    RETURNED_LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    RETURNED_​OCTET_​LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    RETURNED_SQLSTATE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    RETURNINGreserved, requires ASnon-reservednon-reserved 
    RETURNSnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REVOKEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    RIGHTreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    ROLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ROLLBACKnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ROLLUPnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ROUTINEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ROUTINESnon-reserved   
    ROUTINE_CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    ROUTINE_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    ROUTINE_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    ROWnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    ROWSnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ROW_COUNT non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    ROW_NUMBER reservedreserved 
    RULEnon-reserved   
    RUNNING reserved  
    SAVEPOINTnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    SCALAR non-reserved  
    SCALE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SCHEMAnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SCHEMASnon-reserved   
    SCHEMA_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SCOPE reservedreserved 
    SCOPE_CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    SCOPE_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    SCOPE_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    SCROLLnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    SEARCHnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    SECONDnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    SECTION non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SECURITYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SEEK reserved  
    SELECTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    SELECTIVE non-reservednon-reserved 
    SELF non-reservednon-reserved 
    SEMANTICS non-reserved  
    SENSITIVE reservedreserved 
    SEQUENCEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SEQUENCESnon-reserved   
    SERIALIZABLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SERVERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SERVER_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SESSIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SESSION_USERreservedreservedreservedreserved
    SETnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    SETOFnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    SETSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SHAREnon-reserved   
    SHOWnon-reservedreserved  
    SIMILARreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    SIMPLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SIN reserved  
    SINH reserved  
    SIZE non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SKIPnon-reservedreserved  
    SMALLINTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    SNAPSHOTnon-reserved   
    SOMEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    SORT_DIRECTION non-reserved  
    SOURCE non-reservednon-reserved 
    SPACE non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SPECIFIC reservedreserved 
    SPECIFICTYPE reservedreserved 
    SPECIFIC_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    SQLnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    SQLCODE   reserved
    SQLERROR   reserved
    SQLEXCEPTION reservedreserved 
    SQLSTATE reservedreservedreserved
    SQLWARNING reservedreserved 
    SQRT reservedreserved 
    STABLEnon-reserved   
    STANDALONEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    STARTnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    STATE non-reservednon-reserved 
    STATEMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    STATIC reservedreserved 
    STATISTICSnon-reserved   
    STDDEV_POP reservedreserved 
    STDDEV_SAMP reservedreserved 
    STDINnon-reserved   
    STDOUTnon-reserved   
    STORAGEnon-reserved   
    STOREDnon-reserved   
    STRICTnon-reserved   
    STRING non-reserved  
    STRIPnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    STRUCTURE non-reservednon-reserved 
    STYLE non-reservednon-reserved 
    SUBCLASS_ORIGIN non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SUBMULTISET reservedreserved 
    SUBSCRIPTIONnon-reserved   
    SUBSET reserved  
    SUBSTRINGnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    SUBSTRING_REGEX reservedreserved 
    SUCCEEDS reservedreserved 
    SUM reservedreservedreserved
    SUPPORTnon-reserved   
    SYMMETRICreservedreservedreserved 
    SYSIDnon-reserved   
    SYSTEMnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    SYSTEM_TIME reservedreserved 
    SYSTEM_USER reservedreservedreserved
    T non-reservednon-reserved 
    TABLEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    TABLESnon-reserved   
    TABLESAMPLEreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    TABLESPACEnon-reserved   
    TABLE_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    TAN reserved  
    TANH reserved  
    TEMPnon-reserved   
    TEMPLATEnon-reserved   
    TEMPORARYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    TEXTnon-reserved   
    THENreservedreservedreservedreserved
    THROUGH non-reserved  
    TIESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    TIMEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    TIMESTAMPnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    TIMEZONE_HOUR reservedreservedreserved
    TIMEZONE_MINUTE reservedreservedreserved
    TOreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    TOKEN non-reservednon-reserved 
    TOP_LEVEL_COUNT non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRAILINGreservedreservedreservedreserved
    TRANSACTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    TRANSACTIONS_​COMMITTED non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSACTIONS_​ROLLED_​BACK non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSACTION_ACTIVE non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSFORMnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSFORMS non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSLATE reservedreservedreserved
    TRANSLATE_REGEX reservedreserved 
    TRANSLATION reservedreservedreserved
    TREATnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    TRIGGERnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    TRIGGER_CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRIGGER_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRIGGER_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRIMnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    TRIM_ARRAY reservedreserved 
    TRUEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    TRUNCATEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    TRUSTEDnon-reserved   
    TYPEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    TYPESnon-reserved   
    UESCAPEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    UNBOUNDEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    UNCOMMITTEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    UNCONDITIONAL non-reserved  
    UNDER non-reservednon-reserved 
    UNENCRYPTEDnon-reserved   
    UNIONreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    UNIQUEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    UNKNOWNnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    UNLINK non-reservednon-reserved 
    UNLISTENnon-reserved   
    UNLOGGEDnon-reserved   
    UNMATCHED reserved  
    UNNAMED non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    UNNEST reservedreserved 
    UNTILnon-reserved   
    UNTYPED non-reservednon-reserved 
    UPDATEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    UPPER reservedreservedreserved
    URI non-reservednon-reserved 
    USAGE non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    USERreservedreservedreservedreserved
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​CODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    USINGreservedreservedreservedreserved
    UTF16 non-reserved  
    UTF32 non-reserved  
    UTF8 non-reserved  
    VACUUMnon-reserved   
    VALIDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    VALIDATEnon-reserved   
    VALIDATORnon-reserved   
    VALUEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    VALUESnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    VALUE_OF reservedreserved 
    VARBINARY reservedreserved 
    VARCHARnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    VARIADICreserved   
    VARYINGnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    VAR_POP reservedreserved 
    VAR_SAMP reservedreserved 
    VERBOSEreserved (can be function or type)   
    VERSIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    VERSIONING reservedreserved 
    VIEWnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    VIEWSnon-reserved   
    VOLATILEnon-reserved   
    WHENreservedreservedreservedreserved
    WHENEVER reservedreservedreserved
    WHEREreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    WHITESPACEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    WIDTH_BUCKET reservedreserved 
    WINDOWreserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    WITHreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    WITHINnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    WITHOUTnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    WORKnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    WRAPPERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    WRITEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    XMLnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    XMLAGG reservedreserved 
    XMLATTRIBUTESnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLBINARY reservedreserved 
    XMLCAST reservedreserved 
    XMLCOMMENT reservedreserved 
    XMLCONCATnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLDECLARATION non-reservednon-reserved 
    XMLDOCUMENT reservedreserved 
    XMLELEMENTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLEXISTSnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLFORESTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLITERATE reservedreserved 
    XMLNAMESPACESnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLPARSEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLPInon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLQUERY reservedreserved 
    XMLROOTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    XMLSCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    XMLSERIALIZEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLTABLEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLTEXT reservedreserved 
    XMLVALIDATE reservedreserved 
    YEARnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    YESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ZONEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table C.1. SQL Key Words

    Key WordPostgreSQLSQL:2016SQL:2011SQL-92
    A non-reservednon-reserved 
    ABORTnon-reserved   
    ABS reservedreserved 
    ABSENT reservednon-reserved 
    ABSOLUTEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ACCESSnon-reserved   
    ACCORDING non-reservednon-reserved 
    ACOS reserved  
    ACTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ADA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    ADDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ADMINnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    AFTERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    AGGREGATEnon-reserved   
    ALLreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ALLOCATE reservedreservedreserved
    ALSOnon-reserved   
    ALTERnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ALWAYSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ANALYSEreserved   
    ANALYZEreserved   
    ANDreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ANYreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ARE reservedreservedreserved
    ARRAYreserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    ARRAY_AGG reservedreserved 
    ARRAY_​MAX_​CARDINALITY reservedreserved 
    ASreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ASCreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ASENSITIVEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ASIN reserved  
    ASSERTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    ASSIGNMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ASYMMETRICreservedreservedreserved 
    ATnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ATAN reserved  
    ATOMICnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ATTACHnon-reserved   
    ATTRIBUTEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ATTRIBUTES non-reservednon-reserved 
    AUTHORIZATIONreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    AVG reservedreservedreserved
    BACKWARDnon-reserved   
    BASE64 non-reservednon-reserved 
    BEFOREnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    BEGINnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    BEGIN_FRAME reservedreserved 
    BEGIN_PARTITION reservedreserved 
    BERNOULLI non-reservednon-reserved 
    BETWEENnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    BIGINTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    BINARYreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    BITnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)  reserved
    BIT_LENGTH   reserved
    BLOB reservedreserved 
    BLOCKED non-reservednon-reserved 
    BOM non-reservednon-reserved 
    BOOLEANnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    BOTHreservedreservedreservedreserved
    BREADTHnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    BYnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    C non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CACHEnon-reserved   
    CALLnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    CALLEDnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    CARDINALITY reservedreserved 
    CASCADEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CASCADEDnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CASEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CASTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CATALOGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CATALOG_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CEIL reservedreserved 
    CEILING reservedreserved 
    CHAINnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    CHAINING non-reserved  
    CHARnon-reserved (cannot be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    CHARACTERnon-reserved (cannot be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    CHARACTERISTICSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    CHARACTERS non-reservednon-reserved 
    CHARACTER_LENGTH reservedreservedreserved
    CHARACTER_​SET_​CATALOG non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CHARACTER_SET_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CHARACTER_SET_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CHAR_LENGTH reservedreservedreserved
    CHECKreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CHECKPOINTnon-reserved   
    CLASSnon-reserved   
    CLASSIFIER reserved  
    CLASS_ORIGIN non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CLOB reservedreserved 
    CLOSEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CLUSTERnon-reserved   
    COALESCEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    COBOL non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLATEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    COLLATIONreserved (can be function or type)non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    COLLATION_CATALOG non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLATION_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLATION_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COLLECT reservedreserved 
    COLUMNreservedreservedreservedreserved
    COLUMNSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    COLUMN_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COMMAND_FUNCTION non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COMMAND_​FUNCTION_​CODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    COMMENTnon-reserved   
    COMMENTSnon-reserved   
    COMMITnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    COMMITTEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    COMPRESSIONnon-reserved   
    CONCURRENTLYreserved (can be function or type)   
    CONDITION reservedreserved 
    CONDITIONAL non-reserved  
    CONDITION_NUMBER non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONFIGURATIONnon-reserved   
    CONFLICTnon-reserved   
    CONNECT reservedreservedreserved
    CONNECTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CONNECTION_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRAINTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CONSTRAINTSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CONSTRAINT_CATALOG non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRAINT_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRAINT_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CONSTRUCTOR non-reservednon-reserved 
    CONTAINS reservedreserved 
    CONTENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    CONTINUEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    CONTROL non-reservednon-reserved 
    CONVERSIONnon-reserved   
    CONVERT reservedreservedreserved
    COPYnon-reservedreserved  
    CORR reservedreserved 
    CORRESPONDING reservedreservedreserved
    COS reserved  
    COSH reserved  
    COSTnon-reserved   
    COUNT reservedreservedreserved
    COVAR_POP reservedreserved 
    COVAR_SAMP reservedreserved 
    CREATEreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    CROSSreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    CSVnon-reserved   
    CUBEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    CUME_DIST reservedreserved 
    CURRENTnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_CATALOGreservedreservedreserved 
    CURRENT_DATEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_​DEFAULT_​TRANSFORM_​GROUP reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_PATH reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_ROLEreservedreservedreserved 
    CURRENT_ROW reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_SCHEMAreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_TIMEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_TIMESTAMPreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURRENT_​TRANSFORM_​GROUP_​FOR_​TYPE reservedreserved 
    CURRENT_USERreservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURSORnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    CURSOR_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    CYCLEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    DATAnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DATABASEnon-reserved   
    DATALINK reservedreserved 
    DATE reservedreservedreserved
    DATETIME_​INTERVAL_​CODE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DATETIME_​INTERVAL_​PRECISION non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DAYnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    DB non-reservednon-reserved 
    DEALLOCATEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DECnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    DECFLOAT reserved  
    DECIMALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    DECLAREnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DEFAULTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    DEFAULTSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DEFERRABLEreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DEFERREDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DEFINE reserved  
    DEFINED non-reservednon-reserved 
    DEFINERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DEGREE non-reservednon-reserved 
    DELETEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DELIMITERnon-reserved   
    DELIMITERSnon-reserved   
    DENSE_RANK reservedreserved 
    DEPENDSnon-reserved   
    DEPTHnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DEREF reservedreserved 
    DERIVED non-reservednon-reserved 
    DESCreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DESCRIBE reservedreservedreserved
    DESCRIPTOR non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DETACHnon-reserved   
    DETERMINISTIC reservedreserved 
    DIAGNOSTICS non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DICTIONARYnon-reserved   
    DISABLEnon-reserved   
    DISCARDnon-reserved   
    DISCONNECT reservedreservedreserved
    DISPATCH non-reservednon-reserved 
    DISTINCTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    DLNEWCOPY reservedreserved 
    DLPREVIOUSCOPY reservedreserved 
    DLURLCOMPLETE reservedreserved 
    DLURLCOMPLETEONLY reservedreserved 
    DLURLCOMPLETEWRITE reservedreserved 
    DLURLPATH reservedreserved 
    DLURLPATHONLY reservedreserved 
    DLURLPATHWRITE reservedreserved 
    DLURLSCHEME reservedreserved 
    DLURLSERVER reservedreserved 
    DLVALUE reservedreserved 
    DOreserved   
    DOCUMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    DOMAINnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    DOUBLEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DROPnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    DYNAMIC reservedreserved 
    DYNAMIC_FUNCTION non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    DYNAMIC_​FUNCTION_​CODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    EACHnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ELEMENT reservedreserved 
    ELSEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    EMPTY reservednon-reserved 
    ENABLEnon-reserved   
    ENCODINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ENCRYPTEDnon-reserved   
    ENDreservedreservedreservedreserved
    END-EXEC reservedreservedreserved
    END_FRAME reservedreserved 
    END_PARTITION reservedreserved 
    ENFORCED non-reservednon-reserved 
    ENUMnon-reserved   
    EQUALS reservedreserved 
    ERROR non-reserved  
    ESCAPEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    EVENTnon-reserved   
    EVERY reservedreserved 
    EXCEPTreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    EXCEPTION   reserved
    EXCLUDEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    EXCLUDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    EXCLUSIVEnon-reserved   
    EXEC reservedreservedreserved
    EXECUTEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    EXISTSnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    EXP reservedreserved 
    EXPLAINnon-reserved   
    EXPRESSIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    EXTENSIONnon-reserved   
    EXTERNALnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    EXTRACTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    FALSEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    FAMILYnon-reserved   
    FETCHreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    FILE non-reservednon-reserved 
    FILTERnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    FINAL non-reservednon-reserved 
    FINALIZEnon-reserved   
    FINISH non-reserved  
    FIRSTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    FIRST_VALUE reservedreserved 
    FLAG non-reservednon-reserved 
    FLOATnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    FLOOR reservedreserved 
    FOLLOWINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    FORreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    FORCEnon-reserved   
    FOREIGNreservedreservedreservedreserved
    FORMAT non-reserved  
    FORTRAN non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    FORWARDnon-reserved   
    FOUND non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    FRAME_ROW reservedreserved 
    FREE reservedreserved 
    FREEZEreserved (can be function or type)   
    FROMreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    FS non-reservednon-reserved 
    FULFILL non-reserved  
    FULLreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    FUNCTIONnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    FUNCTIONSnon-reserved   
    FUSION reservedreserved 
    G non-reservednon-reserved 
    GENERAL non-reservednon-reserved 
    GENERATEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    GET reservedreservedreserved
    GLOBALnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    GO non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    GOTO non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    GRANTreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    GRANTEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    GREATESTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    GROUPreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    GROUPINGnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    GROUPSnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    HANDLERnon-reserved   
    HAVINGreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    HEADERnon-reserved   
    HEX non-reservednon-reserved 
    HIERARCHY non-reservednon-reserved 
    HOLDnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    HOURnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ID non-reservednon-reserved 
    IDENTITYnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    IFnon-reserved   
    IGNORE non-reservednon-reserved 
    ILIKEreserved (can be function or type)   
    IMMEDIATEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    IMMEDIATELY non-reservednon-reserved 
    IMMUTABLEnon-reserved   
    IMPLEMENTATION non-reservednon-reserved 
    IMPLICITnon-reserved   
    IMPORTnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    INreservedreservedreservedreserved
    INCLUDEnon-reserved   
    INCLUDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    INCREMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    INDENT non-reservednon-reserved 
    INDEXnon-reserved   
    INDEXESnon-reserved   
    INDICATOR reservedreservedreserved
    INHERITnon-reserved   
    INHERITSnon-reserved   
    INITIAL reserved  
    INITIALLYreservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    INLINEnon-reserved   
    INNERreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INOUTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    INPUTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    INSENSITIVEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    INSERTnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    INSTANCE non-reservednon-reserved 
    INSTANTIABLE non-reservednon-reserved 
    INSTEADnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    INTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INTEGERnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INTEGRITY non-reservednon-reserved 
    INTERSECTreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    INTERSECTION reservedreserved 
    INTERVALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    INTOreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    INVOKERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ISreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    ISNULLreserved (can be function or type), requires AS   
    ISOLATIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    JOINreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    JSON_ARRAY reserved  
    JSON_ARRAYAGG reserved  
    JSON_EXISTS reserved  
    JSON_OBJECT reserved  
    JSON_OBJECTAGG reserved  
    JSON_QUERY reserved  
    JSON_TABLE reserved  
    JSON_TABLE_PRIMITIVE reserved  
    JSON_VALUE reserved  
    K non-reservednon-reserved 
    KEEP non-reserved  
    KEYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    KEYS non-reserved  
    KEY_MEMBER non-reservednon-reserved 
    KEY_TYPE non-reservednon-reserved 
    LABELnon-reserved   
    LAG reservedreserved 
    LANGUAGEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    LARGEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    LASTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    LAST_VALUE reservedreserved 
    LATERALreservedreservedreserved 
    LEAD reservedreserved 
    LEADINGreservedreservedreservedreserved
    LEAKPROOFnon-reserved   
    LEASTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    LEFTreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    LEVELnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    LIBRARY non-reservednon-reserved 
    LIKEreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    LIKE_REGEX reservedreserved 
    LIMITreserved, requires ASnon-reservednon-reserved 
    LINK non-reservednon-reserved 
    LISTAGG reserved  
    LISTENnon-reserved   
    LN reservedreserved 
    LOADnon-reserved   
    LOCALnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    LOCALTIMEreservedreservedreserved 
    LOCALTIMESTAMPreservedreservedreserved 
    LOCATIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    LOCATOR non-reservednon-reserved 
    LOCKnon-reserved   
    LOCKEDnon-reserved   
    LOG reserved  
    LOG10 reserved  
    LOGGEDnon-reserved   
    LOWER reservedreservedreserved
    M non-reservednon-reserved 
    MAP non-reservednon-reserved 
    MAPPINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MATCHnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    MATCHEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MATCHES reserved  
    MATCH_NUMBER reserved  
    MATCH_RECOGNIZE reserved  
    MATERIALIZEDnon-reserved   
    MAX reservedreservedreserved
    MAXVALUEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MEASURES reserved  
    MEMBER reservedreserved 
    MERGEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    MESSAGE_LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    MESSAGE_OCTET_LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    MESSAGE_TEXT non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    METHODnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    MIN reservedreservedreserved
    MINUTEnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    MINVALUEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    MOD reservedreserved 
    MODEnon-reserved   
    MODIFIES reservedreserved 
    MODULE reservedreservedreserved
    MONTHnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    MORE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    MOVEnon-reserved   
    MULTISET reservedreserved 
    MUMPS non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NAMEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NAMESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    NAMESPACE non-reservednon-reserved 
    NATIONALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NATURALreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NCHARnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NCLOB reservedreserved 
    NESTED non-reserved  
    NESTING non-reservednon-reserved 
    NEWnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    NEXTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    NFCnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NFDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NFKCnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NFKDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NIL non-reservednon-reserved 
    NOnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    NONEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    NORMALIZEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    NORMALIZEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NOTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    NOTHINGnon-reserved   
    NOTIFYnon-reserved   
    NOTNULLreserved (can be function or type), requires AS   
    NOWAITnon-reserved   
    NTH_VALUE reservedreserved 
    NTILE reservedreserved 
    NULLreservedreservedreservedreserved
    NULLABLE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NULLIFnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    NULLSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    NULL_ORDERING non-reserved  
    NUMBER non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    NUMERICnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    OBJECTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OCCURRENCE non-reserved  
    OCCURRENCES_REGEX reservedreserved 
    OCTETS non-reservednon-reserved 
    OCTET_LENGTH reservedreservedreserved
    OFnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    OFFnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OFFSETreserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    OIDSnon-reserved   
    OLDnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    OMIT reserved  
    ONreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ONE reserved  
    ONLYreservedreservedreservedreserved
    OPEN reservedreservedreserved
    OPERATORnon-reserved   
    OPTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    OPTIONSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ORreservedreservedreservedreserved
    ORDERreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    ORDERING non-reservednon-reserved 
    ORDINALITYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OTHERSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OUTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    OUTERreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    OUTPUT non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    OVERnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    OVERFLOW non-reserved  
    OVERLAPSreserved (can be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    OVERLAYnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    OVERRIDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    OWNEDnon-reserved   
    OWNERnon-reserved   
    P non-reservednon-reserved 
    PAD non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PARALLELnon-reserved   
    PARAMETERnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    PARAMETER_MODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​ORDINAL_​POSITION non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​SPECIFIC_​CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​SPECIFIC_​NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARAMETER_​SPECIFIC_​SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    PARSERnon-reserved   
    PARTIALnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PARTITIONnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    PASCAL non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    PASS non-reserved  
    PASSINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    PASSTHROUGH non-reservednon-reserved 
    PASSWORDnon-reserved   
    PAST non-reserved  
    PATH non-reservednon-reserved 
    PATTERN reserved  
    PER reserved  
    PERCENT reservedreserved 
    PERCENTILE_CONT reservedreserved 
    PERCENTILE_DISC reservedreserved 
    PERCENT_RANK reservedreserved 
    PERIOD reservedreserved 
    PERMISSION non-reservednon-reserved 
    PERMUTE reserved  
    PIPE non-reserved  
    PLACINGreservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    PLAN non-reserved  
    PLANSnon-reserved   
    PLI non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    POLICYnon-reserved   
    PORTION reservedreserved 
    POSITIONnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    POSITION_REGEX reservedreserved 
    POWER reservedreserved 
    PRECEDES reservedreserved 
    PRECEDINGnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    PRECISIONnon-reserved (cannot be function or type), requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    PREPAREnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    PREPAREDnon-reserved   
    PRESERVEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PREV non-reserved  
    PRIMARYreservedreservedreservedreserved
    PRIORnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PRIVATE non-reserved  
    PRIVILEGESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PROCEDURALnon-reserved   
    PROCEDUREnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    PROCEDURESnon-reserved   
    PROGRAMnon-reserved   
    PRUNE non-reserved  
    PTF reserved  
    PUBLIC non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    PUBLICATIONnon-reserved   
    QUOTEnon-reserved   
    QUOTES non-reserved  
    RANGEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    RANK reservedreserved 
    READnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    READS reservedreserved 
    REALnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    REASSIGNnon-reserved   
    RECHECKnon-reserved   
    RECOVERY non-reservednon-reserved 
    RECURSIVEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REFnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REFERENCESreservedreservedreservedreserved
    REFERENCINGnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REFRESHnon-reserved   
    REGR_AVGX reservedreserved 
    REGR_AVGY reservedreserved 
    REGR_COUNT reservedreserved 
    REGR_INTERCEPT reservedreserved 
    REGR_R2 reservedreserved 
    REGR_SLOPE reservedreserved 
    REGR_SXX reservedreserved 
    REGR_SXY reservedreserved 
    REGR_SYY reservedreserved 
    REINDEXnon-reserved   
    RELATIVEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    RELEASEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    RENAMEnon-reserved   
    REPEATABLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    REPLACEnon-reserved   
    REPLICAnon-reserved   
    REQUIRING non-reservednon-reserved 
    RESETnon-reserved   
    RESPECT non-reservednon-reserved 
    RESTARTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    RESTORE non-reservednon-reserved 
    RESTRICTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    RESULT reservedreserved 
    RETURNnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    RETURNED_CARDINALITY non-reservednon-reserved 
    RETURNED_LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    RETURNED_​OCTET_​LENGTH non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    RETURNED_SQLSTATE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    RETURNINGreserved, requires ASnon-reservednon-reserved 
    RETURNSnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    REVOKEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    RIGHTreserved (can be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    ROLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ROLLBACKnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ROLLUPnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    ROUTINEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ROUTINESnon-reserved   
    ROUTINE_CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    ROUTINE_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    ROUTINE_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    ROWnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    ROWSnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    ROW_COUNT non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    ROW_NUMBER reservedreserved 
    RULEnon-reserved   
    RUNNING reserved  
    SAVEPOINTnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    SCALAR non-reserved  
    SCALE non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SCHEMAnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SCHEMASnon-reserved   
    SCHEMA_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SCOPE reservedreserved 
    SCOPE_CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    SCOPE_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    SCOPE_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    SCROLLnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    SEARCHnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    SECONDnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    SECTION non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SECURITYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SEEK reserved  
    SELECTreservedreservedreservedreserved
    SELECTIVE non-reservednon-reserved 
    SELF non-reservednon-reserved 
    SEMANTICS non-reserved  
    SENSITIVE reservedreserved 
    SEQUENCEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SEQUENCESnon-reserved   
    SERIALIZABLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SERVERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SERVER_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SESSIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SESSION_USERreservedreservedreservedreserved
    SETnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    SETOFnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    SETSnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SHAREnon-reserved   
    SHOWnon-reservedreserved  
    SIMILARreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    SIMPLEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    SIN reserved  
    SINH reserved  
    SIZE non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SKIPnon-reservedreserved  
    SMALLINTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    SNAPSHOTnon-reserved   
    SOMEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    SORT_DIRECTION non-reserved  
    SOURCE non-reservednon-reserved 
    SPACE non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    SPECIFIC reservedreserved 
    SPECIFICTYPE reservedreserved 
    SPECIFIC_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    SQLnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    SQLCODE   reserved
    SQLERROR   reserved
    SQLEXCEPTION reservedreserved 
    SQLSTATE reservedreservedreserved
    SQLWARNING reservedreserved 
    SQRT reservedreserved 
    STABLEnon-reserved   
    STANDALONEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    STARTnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    STATE non-reservednon-reserved 
    STATEMENTnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    STATIC reservedreserved 
    STATISTICSnon-reserved   
    STDDEV_POP reservedreserved 
    STDDEV_SAMP reservedreserved 
    STDINnon-reserved   
    STDOUTnon-reserved   
    STORAGEnon-reserved   
    STOREDnon-reserved   
    STRICTnon-reserved   
    STRING non-reserved  
    STRIPnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    STRUCTURE non-reservednon-reserved 
    STYLE non-reservednon-reserved 
    SUBCLASS_ORIGIN non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    SUBMULTISET reservedreserved 
    SUBSCRIPTIONnon-reserved   
    SUBSET reserved  
    SUBSTRINGnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    SUBSTRING_REGEX reservedreserved 
    SUCCEEDS reservedreserved 
    SUM reservedreservedreserved
    SUPPORTnon-reserved   
    SYMMETRICreservedreservedreserved 
    SYSIDnon-reserved   
    SYSTEMnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    SYSTEM_TIME reservedreserved 
    SYSTEM_USER reservedreservedreserved
    T non-reservednon-reserved 
    TABLEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    TABLESnon-reserved   
    TABLESAMPLEreserved (can be function or type)reservedreserved 
    TABLESPACEnon-reserved   
    TABLE_NAME non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    TAN reserved  
    TANH reserved  
    TEMPnon-reserved   
    TEMPLATEnon-reserved   
    TEMPORARYnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    TEXTnon-reserved   
    THENreservedreservedreservedreserved
    THROUGH non-reserved  
    TIESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    TIMEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    TIMESTAMPnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    TIMEZONE_HOUR reservedreservedreserved
    TIMEZONE_MINUTE reservedreservedreserved
    TOreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    TOKEN non-reservednon-reserved 
    TOP_LEVEL_COUNT non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRAILINGreservedreservedreservedreserved
    TRANSACTIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    TRANSACTIONS_​COMMITTED non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSACTIONS_​ROLLED_​BACK non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSACTION_ACTIVE non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSFORMnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSFORMS non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRANSLATE reservedreservedreserved
    TRANSLATE_REGEX reservedreserved 
    TRANSLATION reservedreservedreserved
    TREATnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    TRIGGERnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    TRIGGER_CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRIGGER_NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRIGGER_SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    TRIMnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    TRIM_ARRAY reservedreserved 
    TRUEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    TRUNCATEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    TRUSTEDnon-reserved   
    TYPEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    TYPESnon-reserved   
    UESCAPEnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    UNBOUNDEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    UNCOMMITTEDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    UNCONDITIONAL non-reserved  
    UNDER non-reservednon-reserved 
    UNENCRYPTEDnon-reserved   
    UNIONreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    UNIQUEreservedreservedreservedreserved
    UNKNOWNnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    UNLINK non-reservednon-reserved 
    UNLISTENnon-reserved   
    UNLOGGEDnon-reserved   
    UNMATCHED reserved  
    UNNAMED non-reservednon-reservednon-reserved
    UNNEST reservedreserved 
    UNTILnon-reserved   
    UNTYPED non-reservednon-reserved 
    UPDATEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    UPPER reservedreservedreserved
    URI non-reservednon-reserved 
    USAGE non-reservednon-reservedreserved
    USERreservedreservedreservedreserved
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​CATALOG non-reservednon-reserved 
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​CODE non-reservednon-reserved 
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​NAME non-reservednon-reserved 
    USER_​DEFINED_​TYPE_​SCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    USINGreservedreservedreservedreserved
    UTF16 non-reserved  
    UTF32 non-reserved  
    UTF8 non-reserved  
    VACUUMnon-reserved   
    VALIDnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    VALIDATEnon-reserved   
    VALIDATORnon-reserved   
    VALUEnon-reservedreservedreservedreserved
    VALUESnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    VALUE_OF reservedreserved 
    VARBINARY reservedreserved 
    VARCHARnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreservedreserved
    VARIADICreserved   
    VARYINGnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    VAR_POP reservedreserved 
    VAR_SAMP reservedreserved 
    VERBOSEreserved (can be function or type)   
    VERSIONnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    VERSIONING reservedreserved 
    VIEWnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    VIEWSnon-reserved   
    VOLATILEnon-reserved   
    WHENreservedreservedreservedreserved
    WHENEVER reservedreservedreserved
    WHEREreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    WHITESPACEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    WIDTH_BUCKET reservedreserved 
    WINDOWreserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    WITHreserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    WITHINnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    WITHOUTnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreserved 
    WORKnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    WRAPPERnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    WRITEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved
    XMLnon-reservedreservedreserved 
    XMLAGG reservedreserved 
    XMLATTRIBUTESnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLBINARY reservedreserved 
    XMLCAST reservedreserved 
    XMLCOMMENT reservedreserved 
    XMLCONCATnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLDECLARATION non-reservednon-reserved 
    XMLDOCUMENT reservedreserved 
    XMLELEMENTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLEXISTSnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLFORESTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLITERATE reservedreserved 
    XMLNAMESPACESnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLPARSEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLPInon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLQUERY reservedreserved 
    XMLROOTnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)   
    XMLSCHEMA non-reservednon-reserved 
    XMLSERIALIZEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLTABLEnon-reserved (cannot be function or type)reservedreserved 
    XMLTEXT reservedreserved 
    XMLVALIDATE reservedreserved 
    YEARnon-reserved, requires ASreservedreservedreserved
    YESnon-reservednon-reservednon-reserved 
    ZONEnon-reservednon-reservednon-reservedreserved

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-listen.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-listen.html index 9a61760..026c803 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-listen.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-listen.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -LISTEN

    LISTEN

    LISTEN — listen for a notification

    Synopsis

    +LISTEN

    LISTEN

    LISTEN — listen for a notification

    Synopsis

     LISTEN channel
     

    Description

    LISTEN registers the current session as a @@ -67,4 +67,4 @@ Asynchronous notification "virtual" received from server process with PID 8448.

    Compatibility

    There is no LISTEN statement in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    NOTIFY, UNLISTEN
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    NOTIFY, UNLISTEN
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-load.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-load.html index 2fa608a..348bf67 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-load.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-load.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -LOAD

    LOAD

    LOAD — load a shared library file

    Synopsis

    +LOAD

    LOAD

    LOAD — load a shared library file

    Synopsis

     LOAD 'filename'
     

    Description

    This command loads a shared library file into the PostgreSQL @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ LOAD 'filename' extension.

    See Also

    CREATE FUNCTION -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-lock.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-lock.html index b7e76ab..78cb6b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-lock.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-lock.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -LOCK

    LOCK

    LOCK — lock a table

    Synopsis

    +LOCK

    LOCK

    LOCK — lock a table

    Synopsis

     LOCK [ TABLE ] [ ONLY ] name [ * ] [, ...] [ IN lockmode MODE ] [ NOWAIT ]
     
     where lockmode is one of:
    @@ -164,4 +164,4 @@ COMMIT WORK;
        PostgreSQL lock modes and the
        LOCK TABLE syntax are compatible with those
        present in Oracle.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-merge.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-merge.html index 1aef4c7..373a7a6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-merge.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-merge.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -MERGE

    MERGE

    MERGE — conditionally insert, update, or delete rows of a table

    Synopsis

    +MERGE

    MERGE

    MERGE — conditionally insert, update, or delete rows of a table

    Synopsis

     [ WITH with_query [, ...] ]
     MERGE INTO [ ONLY ] target_table_name [ * ] [ [ AS ] target_alias ]
     USING data_source ON join_condition
    @@ -67,14 +67,14 @@ DELETE
        that are referred to in the SET clause.
        If you specify an insert action, you must have the INSERT
        privilege on the target_table_name.
    -   If you specify an delete action, you must have the DELETE
    +   If you specify a delete action, you must have the DELETE
        privilege on the target_table_name.
        Privileges are tested once at statement start and are checked
        whether or not particular WHEN clauses are executed.
    -   You will require the SELECT privilege on the
    -   data_source and any column(s)
    -   of the target_table_name
    -   referred to in a condition.
    +   You will require the SELECT privilege on any column(s)
    +   of the data_source and
    +   target_table_name referred to
    +   in any condition or expression.
       

    MERGE is not supported if the target_table_name is a @@ -375,6 +375,6 @@ WHEN MATCHED THEN

    Compatibility

    This command conforms to the SQL standard.

    - The WITH clause and DO NOTHING action are extensions to - the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file + The WITH clause and DO NOTHING + action are extensions to the SQL standard. +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-move.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-move.html index 09bb08b..841537a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-move.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-move.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -MOVE

    MOVE

    MOVE — position a cursor

    Synopsis

    +MOVE

    MOVE

    MOVE — position a cursor

    Synopsis

     MOVE [ direction ] [ FROM | IN ] cursor_name
     
     where direction can be one of:
    @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@ CLOSE liahona;
     COMMIT WORK;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no MOVE statement in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    CLOSE, DECLARE, FETCH
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    CLOSE, DECLARE, FETCH
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-notify.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-notify.html index 0c03195..2254d47 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-notify.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-notify.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -NOTIFY

    NOTIFY

    NOTIFY — generate a notification

    Synopsis

    +NOTIFY

    NOTIFY

    NOTIFY — generate a notification

    Synopsis

     NOTIFY channel [ , payload ]
     

    Description

    The NOTIFY command sends a notification event together @@ -129,4 +129,4 @@ Asynchronous notification "foo" with payload "payload" received from server proc

    Compatibility

    There is no NOTIFY statement in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    LISTEN, UNLISTEN
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    LISTEN, UNLISTEN
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare-transaction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare-transaction.html index 883395b..0e1f96f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare-transaction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare-transaction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -PREPARE TRANSACTION

    PREPARE TRANSACTION

    PREPARE TRANSACTION — prepare the current transaction for two-phase commit

    Synopsis

    +PREPARE TRANSACTION

    PREPARE TRANSACTION

    PREPARE TRANSACTION — prepare the current transaction for two-phase commit

    Synopsis

     PREPARE TRANSACTION transaction_id
     

    Description

    PREPARE TRANSACTION prepares the current transaction @@ -87,4 +87,4 @@ PREPARE TRANSACTION 'foobar'; external transaction management systems, some of which are covered by standards (such as X/Open XA), but the SQL side of those systems is not standardized. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare.html index dd6d3b1..746ec06 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-prepare.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -PREPARE

    PREPARE

    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution

    Synopsis

    +PREPARE

    PREPARE

    PREPARE — prepare a statement for execution

    Synopsis

     PREPARE name [ ( data_type [, ...] ) ] AS statement
     

    Description

    PREPARE creates a prepared statement. A prepared @@ -148,4 +148,4 @@ EXECUTE usrrptplan(1, current_date); but it is only for use in embedded SQL. This version of the PREPARE statement also uses a somewhat different syntax. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reassign-owned.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reassign-owned.html index 763e3a8..921caec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reassign-owned.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reassign-owned.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -REASSIGN OWNED

    REASSIGN OWNED

    REASSIGN OWNED — change the ownership of database objects owned by a database role

    Synopsis

    +REASSIGN OWNED

    REASSIGN OWNED

    REASSIGN OWNED — change the ownership of database objects owned by a database role

    Synopsis

     REASSIGN OWNED BY { old_role | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER } [, ...]
                    TO { new_role | CURRENT_ROLE | CURRENT_USER | SESSION_USER }
     

    Description

    @@ -39,4 +39,4 @@ REASSIGN OWNED BY { old_role | CURRENT

    Compatibility

    The REASSIGN OWNED command is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-refreshmaterializedview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-refreshmaterializedview.html index b33122b..0375992 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-refreshmaterializedview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-refreshmaterializedview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW

    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW

    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW — replace the contents of a materialized view

    Synopsis

    +REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW

    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW

    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW — replace the contents of a materialized view

    Synopsis

     REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW [ CONCURRENTLY ] name
         [ WITH [ NO ] DATA ]
     

    Description

    @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@ REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW annual_statistics_basis WITH NO DATA;

    Compatibility

    REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reindex.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reindex.html index 82a0ee2..006c607 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reindex.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reindex.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -REINDEX

    REINDEX

    REINDEX — rebuild indexes

    Synopsis

    +REINDEX

    REINDEX

    REINDEX — rebuild indexes

    Synopsis

     REINDEX [ ( option [, ...] ) ] { INDEX | TABLE | SCHEMA | DATABASE | SYSTEM } [ CONCURRENTLY ] name
     
     where option can be one of:
    @@ -324,4 +324,4 @@ broken_db=> \q
     REINDEX TABLE CONCURRENTLY my_broken_table;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no REINDEX command in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-release-savepoint.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-release-savepoint.html index 312aca2..98591e9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-release-savepoint.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-release-savepoint.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -RELEASE SAVEPOINT

    RELEASE SAVEPOINT

    RELEASE SAVEPOINT — destroy a previously defined savepoint

    Synopsis

    +RELEASE SAVEPOINT

    RELEASE SAVEPOINT

    RELEASE SAVEPOINT — destroy a previously defined savepoint

    Synopsis

     RELEASE [ SAVEPOINT ] savepoint_name
     

    Description

    RELEASE SAVEPOINT destroys a savepoint previously defined @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ COMMIT; specifies that the key word SAVEPOINT is mandatory, but PostgreSQL allows it to be omitted. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reset.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reset.html index 649aa6b..6bef9f5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reset.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-reset.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -RESET

    RESET

    RESET — restore the value of a run-time parameter to the default value

    Synopsis

    +RESET

    RESET

    RESET — restore the value of a run-time parameter to the default value

    Synopsis

     RESET configuration_parameter
     RESET ALL
     

    Description

    @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@ SET configuration_parameter TO DEFAULT RESET timezone;

    Compatibility

    RESET is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    See Also

    SET, SHOW
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    SET, SHOW
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-revoke.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-revoke.html index 085011c..fbf1a4a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-revoke.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-revoke.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -REVOKE

    REVOKE

    REVOKE — remove access privileges

    Synopsis

    +REVOKE

    REVOKE

    REVOKE — remove access privileges

    Synopsis

     REVOKE [ GRANT OPTION FOR ]
         { { SELECT | INSERT | UPDATE | DELETE | TRUNCATE | REFERENCES | TRIGGER }
         [, ...] | ALL [ PRIVILEGES ] }
    @@ -246,4 +246,4 @@ REVOKE admins FROM joe;
         The keyword RESTRICT or CASCADE
         is required according to the standard, but PostgreSQL
         assumes RESTRICT by default.
    -   

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-prepared.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-prepared.html index 36be571..7253177 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-prepared.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-prepared.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ROLLBACK PREPARED

    ROLLBACK PREPARED

    ROLLBACK PREPARED — cancel a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit

    Synopsis

    +ROLLBACK PREPARED

    ROLLBACK PREPARED

    ROLLBACK PREPARED — cancel a transaction that was earlier prepared for two-phase commit

    Synopsis

     ROLLBACK PREPARED transaction_id
     

    Description

    ROLLBACK PREPARED rolls back a transaction that is in @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@ ROLLBACK PREPARED 'foobar'; external transaction management systems, some of which are covered by standards (such as X/Open XA), but the SQL side of those systems is not standardized. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-to.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-to.html index 37218b2..11cfc96 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-to.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback-to.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT

    ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT

    ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT — roll back to a savepoint

    Synopsis

    +ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT

    ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT

    ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT — roll back to a savepoint

    Synopsis

     ROLLBACK [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] TO [ SAVEPOINT ] savepoint_name
     

    Description

    Roll back all commands that were executed after the savepoint was @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@ COMMIT; AND [ NO ] CHAIN which is not currently supported by PostgreSQL. Otherwise, this command conforms to the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback.html index af8f48e..16232fb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-rollback.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -ROLLBACK

    ROLLBACK

    ROLLBACK — abort the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +ROLLBACK

    ROLLBACK

    ROLLBACK — abort the current transaction

    Synopsis

     ROLLBACK [ WORK | TRANSACTION ] [ AND [ NO ] CHAIN ]
     

    Description

    ROLLBACK rolls back the current transaction and causes @@ -24,4 +24,4 @@ ROLLBACK;

    Compatibility

    The command ROLLBACK conforms to the SQL standard. The form ROLLBACK TRANSACTION is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-savepoint.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-savepoint.html index 8c32dcd..5f9c764 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-savepoint.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-savepoint.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SAVEPOINT

    SAVEPOINT

    SAVEPOINT — define a new savepoint within the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +SAVEPOINT

    SAVEPOINT

    SAVEPOINT — define a new savepoint within the current transaction

    Synopsis

     SAVEPOINT savepoint_name
     

    Description

    SAVEPOINT establishes a new savepoint within @@ -76,4 +76,4 @@ COMMIT; to again become accessible to ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT and RELEASE SAVEPOINT.) Otherwise, SAVEPOINT is fully SQL conforming. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-security-label.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-security-label.html index 47d0796..ef558c2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-security-label.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-security-label.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SECURITY LABEL

    SECURITY LABEL

    SECURITY LABEL — define or change a security label applied to an object

    Synopsis

    +SECURITY LABEL

    SECURITY LABEL

    SECURITY LABEL — define or change a security label applied to an object

    Synopsis

     SECURITY LABEL [ FOR provider ] ON
     {
       TABLE object_name |
    @@ -98,4 +98,4 @@ SECURITY LABEL FOR selinux ON TABLE mytable IS NULL;
     

    Compatibility

    There is no SECURITY LABEL command in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    sepgsql, src/test/modules/dummy_seclabel
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    sepgsql, src/test/modules/dummy_seclabel
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-select.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-select.html index 2cb7d85..9f17ba4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-select.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-select.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SELECT

    SELECT

    SELECT, TABLE, WITH — retrieve rows from a table or view

    Synopsis

    +SELECT

    SELECT

    SELECT, TABLE, WITH — retrieve rows from a table or view

    Synopsis

     [ WITH [ RECURSIVE ] with_query [, ...] ]
     SELECT [ ALL | DISTINCT [ ON ( expression [, ...] ) ] ]
         [ * | expression [ [ AS ] output_name ] [, ...] ]
    @@ -1421,8 +1421,7 @@ WITH t AS (
       )
     SELECT * FROM t
     UNION ALL
    -SELECT * FROM t
    -
    +SELECT * FROM t;
              x
     --------------------
       0.534150459803641
    @@ -1603,4 +1602,4 @@ SELECT 2+2;
         The MATERIALIZED and NOT
         MATERIALIZED options of WITH are extensions
         of the SQL standard.
    -   

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-selectinto.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-selectinto.html index b926f2c..e599826 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-selectinto.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-selectinto.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SELECT INTO

    SELECT INTO

    SELECT INTO — define a new table from the results of a query

    Synopsis

    +SELECT INTO

    SELECT INTO

    SELECT INTO — define a new table from the results of a query

    Synopsis

     [ WITH [ RECURSIVE ] with_query [, ...] ]
     SELECT [ ALL | DISTINCT [ ON ( expression [, ...] ) ] ]
         * | expression [ [ AS ] output_name ] [, ...]
    @@ -65,4 +65,4 @@ SELECT * INTO films_recent FROM films WHERE date_prod >= '2002-01-01';
        most SQL implementations support CREATE TABLE AS
        instead).  Apart from such compatibility considerations, it is best to use
        CREATE TABLE AS for this purpose in new code.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-constraints.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-constraints.html index 726fc0a..1a07d90 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-constraints.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-constraints.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET CONSTRAINTS

    SET CONSTRAINTS

    SET CONSTRAINTS — set constraint check timing for the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +SET CONSTRAINTS

    SET CONSTRAINTS

    SET CONSTRAINTS — set constraint check timing for the current transaction

    Synopsis

     SET CONSTRAINTS { ALL | name [, ...] } { DEFERRED | IMMEDIATE }
     

    Description

    SET CONSTRAINTS sets the behavior of constraint @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@ SET CONSTRAINTS { ALL | name [, ...] } Also, PostgreSQL checks non-deferrable uniqueness constraints immediately, not at end of statement as the standard would suggest. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-role.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-role.html index 6bbfe78..458c0f0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-role.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-role.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET ROLE

    SET ROLE

    SET ROLE — set the current user identifier of the current session

    Synopsis

    +SET ROLE

    SET ROLE

    SET ROLE — set the current user identifier of the current session

    Synopsis

     SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] ROLE role_name
     SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] ROLE NONE
     RESET ROLE
    @@ -82,4 +82,4 @@ SELECT SESSION_USER, CURRENT_USER;
        The SESSION and LOCAL modifiers are a
        PostgreSQL extension, as is the
        RESET syntax.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-session-authorization.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-session-authorization.html index 13a48c9..b66bf72 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-session-authorization.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-session-authorization.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION

    SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION

    SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION — set the session user identifier and the current user identifier of the current session

    Synopsis

    +SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION

    SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION

    SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION — set the session user identifier and the current user identifier of the current session

    Synopsis

     SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] SESSION AUTHORIZATION user_name
     SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] SESSION AUTHORIZATION DEFAULT
     RESET SESSION AUTHORIZATION
    @@ -61,4 +61,4 @@ SELECT SESSION_USER, CURRENT_USER;
       

    The privileges necessary to execute this command are left implementation-defined by the standard. -

    See Also

    SET ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    SET ROLE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-transaction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-transaction.html index 41dac01..418b273 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-transaction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set-transaction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET TRANSACTION

    SET TRANSACTION

    SET TRANSACTION — set the characteristics of the current transaction

    Synopsis

    +SET TRANSACTION

    SET TRANSACTION

    SET TRANSACTION — set the characteristics of the current transaction

    Synopsis

     SET TRANSACTION transaction_mode [, ...]
     SET TRANSACTION SNAPSHOT snapshot_id
     SET SESSION CHARACTERISTICS AS TRANSACTION transaction_mode [, ...]
    @@ -176,4 +176,4 @@ SET TRANSACTION SNAPSHOT '00000003-0000001B-1';
        The SQL standard requires commas between successive transaction_modes, but for historical
        reasons PostgreSQL allows the commas to be
        omitted.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set.html index 5850371..240d45f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-set.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SET

    SET

    SET — change a run-time parameter

    Synopsis

    +SET

    SET

    SET — change a run-time parameter

    Synopsis

     SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] configuration_parameter { TO | = } { value | 'value' | DEFAULT }
     SET [ SESSION | LOCAL ] TIME ZONE { value | 'value' | LOCAL | DEFAULT }
     

    Description

    @@ -152,4 +152,4 @@ SET TIME ZONE 'Europe/Rome'; PostgreSQL allows more flexible time-zone specifications. All other SET features are PostgreSQL extensions. -

    See Also

    RESET, SHOW
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    RESET, SHOW
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-show.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-show.html index f792633..c85f1a9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-show.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-show.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -SHOW

    SHOW

    SHOW — show the value of a run-time parameter

    Synopsis

    +SHOW

    SHOW

    SHOW — show the value of a run-time parameter

    Synopsis

     SHOW name
     SHOW ALL
     

    Description

    @@ -79,4 +79,4 @@ SHOW ALL;

    Compatibility

    The SHOW command is a PostgreSQL extension. -

    See Also

    SET, RESET
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    SET, RESET
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-start-transaction.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-start-transaction.html index 955abfe..077dc3b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-start-transaction.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-start-transaction.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -START TRANSACTION

    START TRANSACTION

    START TRANSACTION — start a transaction block

    Synopsis

    +START TRANSACTION

    START TRANSACTION

    START TRANSACTION — start a transaction block

    Synopsis

     START TRANSACTION [ transaction_mode [, ...] ]
     
     where transaction_mode is one of:
    @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ START TRANSACTION [ transaction_mode [
        omitted.
       

    See also the compatibility section of SET TRANSACTION. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-calling-funcs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-calling-funcs.html index 0280dd2..e87ef77 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-calling-funcs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-calling-funcs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -4.3. Calling Functions

    4.3. Calling Functions

    +4.3. Calling Functions

    4.3. Calling Functions

    PostgreSQL allows functions that have named parameters to be called using either positional or named notation. Named notation is especially @@ -129,4 +129,4 @@ SELECT concat_lower_or_upper('Hello', 'World', uppercase => true); Named and mixed call notations currently cannot be used when calling an aggregate function (but they do work when an aggregate function is used as a window function). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-lexical.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-lexical.html index 18b47df..b06c9ec 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-lexical.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax-lexical.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -4.1. Lexical Structure

    4.1. Lexical Structure

    +4.1. Lexical Structure

    4.1. Lexical Structure

    SQL input consists of a sequence of commands. A command is composed of a sequence of tokens, terminated by a @@ -611,7 +611,7 @@ CAST ( 'string' AS

    Table 4.2. Operator Precedence (highest to lowest)

    Operator/ElementAssociativityDescription
    .lefttable/column name separator
    ::leftPostgreSQL-style typecast
    [ ]leftarray element selection
    + -rightunary plus, unary minus
    ^leftexponentiation
    * / %leftmultiplication, division, modulo
    + -leftaddition, subtraction
    (any other operator)leftall other native and user-defined operators
    BETWEEN IN LIKE ILIKE SIMILAR range containment, set membership, string matching
    < > = <= >= <> +

    Table 4.2. Operator Precedence (highest to lowest)

    Operator/ElementAssociativityDescription
    .lefttable/column name separator
    ::leftPostgreSQL-style typecast
    [ ]leftarray element selection
    + -rightunary plus, unary minus
    COLLATEleftcollation selection
    ATleftAT TIME ZONE
    ^leftexponentiation
    * / %leftmultiplication, division, modulo
    + -leftaddition, subtraction
    (any other operator)leftall other native and user-defined operators
    BETWEEN IN LIKE ILIKE SIMILAR range containment, set membership, string matching
    < > = <= >= <>  comparison operators
    IS ISNULL NOTNULL IS TRUE, IS FALSE, IS NULL, IS DISTINCT FROM, etc.
    NOTrightlogical negation
    ANDleftlogical conjunction
    ORleftlogical disjunction

    Note that the operator precedence rules also apply to user-defined @@ -644,4 +644,4 @@ SELECT 3 OPERATOR(pg_catalog.+) 4; in no such operator failures which can be resolved by adding parentheses. However there are corner cases in which a query might change behavior without any parsing error being reported. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax.html index bbe1554..b1bcac6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-syntax.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 4. SQL Syntax

    Chapter 4. SQL Syntax

    +Chapter 4. SQL Syntax

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-truncate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-truncate.html index 9c2178c..3c6bc27 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-truncate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-truncate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -TRUNCATE

    TRUNCATE

    TRUNCATE — empty a table or set of tables

    Synopsis

    +TRUNCATE

    TRUNCATE

    TRUNCATE — empty a table or set of tables

    Synopsis

     TRUNCATE [ TABLE ] [ ONLY ] name [ * ] [, ... ]
         [ RESTART IDENTITY | CONTINUE IDENTITY ] [ CASCADE | RESTRICT ]
     

    Description

    @@ -116,4 +116,4 @@ TRUNCATE othertable CASCADE; meanings. Some of the concurrency behavior of this command is left implementation-defined by the standard, so the above notes should be considered and compared with other implementations if necessary. -

    See Also

    DELETE
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    DELETE
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-unlisten.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-unlisten.html index ae1499d..cebd1f2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-unlisten.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-unlisten.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -UNLISTEN

    UNLISTEN

    UNLISTEN — stop listening for a notification

    Synopsis

    +UNLISTEN

    UNLISTEN

    UNLISTEN — stop listening for a notification

    Synopsis

     UNLISTEN { channel | * }
     

    Description

    UNLISTEN is used to remove an existing @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ NOTIFY virtual; -- no NOTIFY event is received

    Compatibility

    There is no UNLISTEN command in the SQL standard. -

    See Also

    LISTEN, NOTIFY
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    LISTEN, NOTIFY
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-update.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-update.html index 8f54420..76b002f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-update.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-update.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -UPDATE

    UPDATE

    UPDATE — update rows of a table

    Synopsis

    +UPDATE

    UPDATE

    UPDATE — update rows of a table

    Synopsis

     [ WITH [ RECURSIVE ] with_query [, ...] ]
     UPDATE [ ONLY ] table_name [ * ] [ [ AS ] alias ]
         SET { column_name = { expression | DEFAULT } |
    @@ -287,4 +287,4 @@ UPDATE films SET kind = 'Dramatic' WHERE CURRENT OF c_films;
        constructor or a sub-SELECT.  An individual column's
        updated value can be specified as DEFAULT in the
        row-constructor case, but not inside a sub-SELECT.
    -  

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-vacuum.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-vacuum.html index 789ff56..e823120 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-vacuum.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-vacuum.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -VACUUM

    VACUUM

    VACUUM — garbage-collect and optionally analyze a database

    Synopsis

    +VACUUM

    VACUUM

    VACUUM — garbage-collect and optionally analyze a database

    Synopsis

     VACUUM [ ( option [, ...] ) ] [ table_and_columns [, ...] ]
     VACUUM [ FULL ] [ FREEZE ] [ VERBOSE ] [ ANALYZE ] [ table_and_columns [, ...] ]
     
    @@ -255,4 +255,4 @@ VACUUM [ FULL ] [ FREEZE ] [ VERBOSE ] [ ANALYZE ] [ 

    Compatibility

    There is no VACUUM statement in the SQL standard. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-values.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-values.html index ac0ad90..33ef960 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-values.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql-values.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -VALUES

    VALUES

    VALUES — compute a set of rows

    Synopsis

    +VALUES

    VALUES

    VALUES — compute a set of rows

    Synopsis

     VALUES ( expression [, ...] ) [, ...]
         [ ORDER BY sort_expression [ ASC | DESC | USING operator ] [, ...] ]
         [ LIMIT { count | ALL } ]
    @@ -135,4 +135,4 @@ WHERE ip_address IN (VALUES('192.168.0.1'::inet), ('192.168.0.10'), ('192.168.1.
        LIMIT and OFFSET are
        PostgreSQL extensions; see also
        under SELECT.
    -  

    See Also

    INSERT, SELECT
    \ No newline at end of file +

    See Also

    INSERT, SELECT
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql.html index 02521a2..e6f289d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sql.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sql.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Part II. The SQL Language

    Part II. The SQL Language

    +Part II. The SQL Language

    Part II. The SQL Language

    This part describes the use of the SQL language in PostgreSQL. We start with describing the general syntax of SQL, then @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ using the PostgreSQL interactive terminal psql, but other programs that have similar functionality can be used as well. -

    Table of Contents

    4. SQL Syntax
    4.1. Lexical Structure
    4.2. Value Expressions
    4.3. Calling Functions
    5. Data Definition
    5.1. Table Basics
    5.2. Default Values
    5.3. Generated Columns
    5.4. Constraints
    5.5. System Columns
    5.6. Modifying Tables
    5.7. Privileges
    5.8. Row Security Policies
    5.9. Schemas
    5.10. Inheritance
    5.11. Table Partitioning
    5.12. Foreign Data
    5.13. Other Database Objects
    5.14. Dependency Tracking
    6. Data Manipulation
    6.1. Inserting Data
    6.2. Updating Data
    6.3. Deleting Data
    6.4. Returning Data from Modified Rows
    7. Queries
    7.1. Overview
    7.2. Table Expressions
    7.3. Select Lists
    7.4. Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
    7.5. Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)
    7.6. LIMIT and OFFSET
    7.7. VALUES Lists
    7.8. WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions)
    8. Data Types
    8.1. Numeric Types
    8.2. Monetary Types
    8.3. Character Types
    8.4. Binary Data Types
    8.5. Date/Time Types
    8.6. Boolean Type
    8.7. Enumerated Types
    8.8. Geometric Types
    8.9. Network Address Types
    8.10. Bit String Types
    8.11. Text Search Types
    8.12. UUID Type
    8.13. XML Type
    8.14. JSON Types
    8.15. Arrays
    8.16. Composite Types
    8.17. Range Types
    8.18. Domain Types
    8.19. Object Identifier Types
    8.20. pg_lsn Type
    8.21. Pseudo-Types
    9. Functions and Operators
    9.1. Logical Operators
    9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators
    9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators
    9.4. String Functions and Operators
    9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators
    9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators
    9.7. Pattern Matching
    9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions
    9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators
    9.10. Enum Support Functions
    9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators
    9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators
    9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators
    9.14. UUID Functions
    9.15. XML Functions
    9.16. JSON Functions and Operators
    9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions
    9.18. Conditional Expressions
    9.19. Array Functions and Operators
    9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
    9.21. Aggregate Functions
    9.22. Window Functions
    9.23. Subquery Expressions
    9.24. Row and Array Comparisons
    9.25. Set Returning Functions
    9.26. System Information Functions and Operators
    9.27. System Administration Functions
    9.28. Trigger Functions
    9.29. Event Trigger Functions
    9.30. Statistics Information Functions
    10. Type Conversion
    10.1. Overview
    10.2. Operators
    10.3. Functions
    10.4. Value Storage
    10.5. UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
    10.6. SELECT Output Columns
    11. Indexes
    11.1. Introduction
    11.2. Index Types
    11.3. Multicolumn Indexes
    11.4. Indexes and ORDER BY
    11.5. Combining Multiple Indexes
    11.6. Unique Indexes
    11.7. Indexes on Expressions
    11.8. Partial Indexes
    11.9. Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
    11.10. Operator Classes and Operator Families
    11.11. Indexes and Collations
    11.12. Examining Index Usage
    12. Full Text Search
    12.1. Introduction
    12.2. Tables and Indexes
    12.3. Controlling Text Search
    12.4. Additional Features
    12.5. Parsers
    12.6. Dictionaries
    12.7. Configuration Example
    12.8. Testing and Debugging Text Search
    12.9. Preferred Index Types for Text Search
    12.10. psql Support
    12.11. Limitations
    13. Concurrency Control
    13.1. Introduction
    13.2. Transaction Isolation
    13.3. Explicit Locking
    13.4. Data Consistency Checks at the Application Level
    13.5. Serialization Failure Handling
    13.6. Caveats
    13.7. Locking and Indexes
    14. Performance Tips
    14.1. Using EXPLAIN
    14.2. Statistics Used by the Planner
    14.3. Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses
    14.4. Populating a Database
    14.5. Non-Durable Settings
    15. Parallel Query
    15.1. How Parallel Query Works
    15.2. When Can Parallel Query Be Used?
    15.3. Parallel Plans
    15.4. Parallel Safety
    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table of Contents

    4. SQL Syntax
    4.1. Lexical Structure
    4.2. Value Expressions
    4.3. Calling Functions
    5. Data Definition
    5.1. Table Basics
    5.2. Default Values
    5.3. Generated Columns
    5.4. Constraints
    5.5. System Columns
    5.6. Modifying Tables
    5.7. Privileges
    5.8. Row Security Policies
    5.9. Schemas
    5.10. Inheritance
    5.11. Table Partitioning
    5.12. Foreign Data
    5.13. Other Database Objects
    5.14. Dependency Tracking
    6. Data Manipulation
    6.1. Inserting Data
    6.2. Updating Data
    6.3. Deleting Data
    6.4. Returning Data from Modified Rows
    7. Queries
    7.1. Overview
    7.2. Table Expressions
    7.3. Select Lists
    7.4. Combining Queries (UNION, INTERSECT, EXCEPT)
    7.5. Sorting Rows (ORDER BY)
    7.6. LIMIT and OFFSET
    7.7. VALUES Lists
    7.8. WITH Queries (Common Table Expressions)
    8. Data Types
    8.1. Numeric Types
    8.2. Monetary Types
    8.3. Character Types
    8.4. Binary Data Types
    8.5. Date/Time Types
    8.6. Boolean Type
    8.7. Enumerated Types
    8.8. Geometric Types
    8.9. Network Address Types
    8.10. Bit String Types
    8.11. Text Search Types
    8.12. UUID Type
    8.13. XML Type
    8.14. JSON Types
    8.15. Arrays
    8.16. Composite Types
    8.17. Range Types
    8.18. Domain Types
    8.19. Object Identifier Types
    8.20. pg_lsn Type
    8.21. Pseudo-Types
    9. Functions and Operators
    9.1. Logical Operators
    9.2. Comparison Functions and Operators
    9.3. Mathematical Functions and Operators
    9.4. String Functions and Operators
    9.5. Binary String Functions and Operators
    9.6. Bit String Functions and Operators
    9.7. Pattern Matching
    9.8. Data Type Formatting Functions
    9.9. Date/Time Functions and Operators
    9.10. Enum Support Functions
    9.11. Geometric Functions and Operators
    9.12. Network Address Functions and Operators
    9.13. Text Search Functions and Operators
    9.14. UUID Functions
    9.15. XML Functions
    9.16. JSON Functions and Operators
    9.17. Sequence Manipulation Functions
    9.18. Conditional Expressions
    9.19. Array Functions and Operators
    9.20. Range/Multirange Functions and Operators
    9.21. Aggregate Functions
    9.22. Window Functions
    9.23. Subquery Expressions
    9.24. Row and Array Comparisons
    9.25. Set Returning Functions
    9.26. System Information Functions and Operators
    9.27. System Administration Functions
    9.28. Trigger Functions
    9.29. Event Trigger Functions
    9.30. Statistics Information Functions
    10. Type Conversion
    10.1. Overview
    10.2. Operators
    10.3. Functions
    10.4. Value Storage
    10.5. UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs
    10.6. SELECT Output Columns
    11. Indexes
    11.1. Introduction
    11.2. Index Types
    11.3. Multicolumn Indexes
    11.4. Indexes and ORDER BY
    11.5. Combining Multiple Indexes
    11.6. Unique Indexes
    11.7. Indexes on Expressions
    11.8. Partial Indexes
    11.9. Index-Only Scans and Covering Indexes
    11.10. Operator Classes and Operator Families
    11.11. Indexes and Collations
    11.12. Examining Index Usage
    12. Full Text Search
    12.1. Introduction
    12.2. Tables and Indexes
    12.3. Controlling Text Search
    12.4. Additional Features
    12.5. Parsers
    12.6. Dictionaries
    12.7. Configuration Example
    12.8. Testing and Debugging Text Search
    12.9. Preferred Index Types for Text Search
    12.10. psql Support
    12.11. Limitations
    13. Concurrency Control
    13.1. Introduction
    13.2. Transaction Isolation
    13.3. Explicit Locking
    13.4. Data Consistency Checks at the Application Level
    13.5. Serialization Failure Handling
    13.6. Caveats
    13.7. Locking and Indexes
    14. Performance Tips
    14.1. Using EXPLAIN
    14.2. Statistics Used by the Planner
    14.3. Controlling the Planner with Explicit JOIN Clauses
    14.4. Populating a Database
    14.5. Non-Durable Settings
    15. Parallel Query
    15.1. How Parallel Query Works
    15.2. When Can Parallel Query Be Used?
    15.3. Parallel Plans
    15.4. Parallel Safety
    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ssh-tunnels.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ssh-tunnels.html index 4ca453c..296aaf9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ssh-tunnels.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ssh-tunnels.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.11. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels

    19.11. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels

    +19.11. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels

    19.11. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSH Tunnels

    It is possible to use SSH to encrypt the network connection between clients and a PostgreSQL server. Done properly, this @@ -73,4 +73,4 @@ ssh -L 63333:db.foo.com:5432 joe@shell.foo.com

    Tip

    Several other applications exist that can provide secure tunnels using a procedure similar in concept to the one just described. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/ssl-tcp.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/ssl-tcp.html index 24aecfb..7ebcf43 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/ssl-tcp.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/ssl-tcp.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.9. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL

    19.9. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL

    +19.9. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL

    19.9. Secure TCP/IP Connections with SSL

    PostgreSQL has native support for using SSL connections to encrypt client/server communications for increased security. This requires that @@ -261,4 +261,4 @@ openssl x509 -req -in server.csr -text -days 365 \ by a chain of certificates linked to its trusted root certificate. root.key and intermediate.key should be stored offline for use in creating future certificates. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sslinfo.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sslinfo.html index b4dea33..9cff536 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sslinfo.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sslinfo.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.42. sslinfo

    F.42. sslinfo

    +F.42. sslinfo

    F.42. sslinfo

    The sslinfo module provides information about the SSL certificate that the current client provided when connecting to PostgreSQL. The module is useless (most functions @@ -132,4 +132,4 @@ emailAddress

    E-Mail of Cryptocom OpenSSL development group: -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/sspi-auth.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/sspi-auth.html index 8c4bd60..0dc08c9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/sspi-auth.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/sspi-auth.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -21.7. SSPI Authentication

    21.7. SSPI Authentication

    +21.7. SSPI Authentication

    21.7. SSPI Authentication

    SSPI is a Windows technology for secure authentication with single sign-on. PostgreSQL will use SSPI in @@ -67,4 +67,4 @@ users of any realm can connect, subject to whatever user name mapping is done.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-file-layout.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-file-layout.html index 9544f55..10e0544 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-file-layout.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-file-layout.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -73.1. Database File Layout

    73.1. Database File Layout

    +73.1. Database File Layout

    73.1. Database File Layout

    This section describes the storage format at the level of files and directories.

    @@ -130,4 +130,4 @@ The name of a temporary file has the form pgsql_tmpPPP.NNN, where PPP is the PID of the owning backend and NNN distinguishes different temporary files of that backend. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-fsm.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-fsm.html index 9b8bf9c..e856f75 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-fsm.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-fsm.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -73.3. Free Space Map

    73.3. Free Space Map

    +73.3. Free Space Map

    73.3. Free Space Map

    Each heap and index relation, except for hash indexes, has a Free Space Map (FSM) to keep track of available space in the relation. It's stored alongside the main relation data in a separate relation fork, @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ See src/backend/storage/freespace/README for more how the FSM is structured, and how it's updated and searched. The pg_freespacemap module can be used to examine the information stored in free space maps. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-hot.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-hot.html index 412e97d..c355b7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-hot.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-hot.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -73.7. Heap-Only Tuples (HOT)

    73.7. Heap-Only Tuples (HOT)

    +73.7. Heap-Only Tuples (HOT)

    73.7. Heap-Only Tuples (HOT)

    To allow for high concurrency, PostgreSQL uses multiversion concurrency control (MVCC) to store rows. However, @@ -42,4 +42,4 @@ new rows will naturally migrate to new pages and existing pages with sufficient free space for new row versions. The system view pg_stat_all_tables allows monitoring of the occurrence of HOT and non-HOT updates. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-init.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-init.html index ea7c633..48a3c16 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-init.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-init.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -73.5. The Initialization Fork

    73.5. The Initialization Fork

    +73.5. The Initialization Fork

    73.5. The Initialization Fork

    Each unlogged table, and each index on an unlogged table, has an initialization fork. The initialization fork is an empty table or index of the appropriate type. When an unlogged table must be reset to empty due to a crash, the initialization fork is copied over the main fork, and any other forks are erased (they will be recreated automatically as needed). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-page-layout.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-page-layout.html index e6fb04c..cbe10b6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-page-layout.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-page-layout.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -73.6. Database Page Layout

    73.6. Database Page Layout

    +73.6. Database Page Layout

    73.6. Database Page Layout

    This section provides an overview of the page format used within PostgreSQL tables and indexes.[17] Sequences and TOAST tables are formatted just like a regular table. @@ -154,4 +154,4 @@ data. Empty in ordinary tables.


    Prev Up Next
    73.5. The Initialization Fork Home 73.7. Heap-Only Tuples (HOT)
    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-toast.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-toast.html index 9ce0e1c..b4f693b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-toast.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-toast.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -73.2. TOAST

    73.2. TOAST

    +73.2. TOAST

    73.2. TOAST

    This section provides an overview of TOAST (The Oversized-Attribute Storage Technique).

    @@ -220,4 +220,4 @@ stored on disk. In-memory TOAST pointers are expanded to normal in-line varlena values before storage — and then possibly converted to on-disk TOAST pointers, if the containing tuple would otherwise be too big. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-vm.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-vm.html index 706d2ac..89bf62a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-vm.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage-vm.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -73.4. Visibility Map

    73.4. Visibility Map

    +73.4. Visibility Map

    73.4. Visibility Map

    Each heap relation has a Visibility Map (VM) to keep track of which pages contain only tuples that are known to be visible to all active transactions; it also keeps track of which pages contain @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ cleared by any data-modifying operations on a page.

    The pg_visibility module can be used to examine the information stored in the visibility map. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage.html index cb94e5d..f729cff 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/storage.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/storage.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 73. Database Physical Storage

    Chapter 73. Database Physical Storage

    +Chapter 73. Database Physical Storage

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/supported-platforms.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/supported-platforms.html index e42c106..229494d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/supported-platforms.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/supported-platforms.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -17.6. Supported Platforms

    17.6. Supported Platforms

    +17.6. Supported Platforms

    17.6. Supported Platforms

    A platform (that is, a CPU architecture and operating system combination) is considered supported by the PostgreSQL development community if the code contains provisions to work on that platform and @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@ in porting PostgreSQL to a new platform, is the appropriate place to discuss that. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-declarations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-declarations.html index bd8b6b4..ff09c07 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-declarations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-declarations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -74.1. System Catalog Declaration Rules

    74.1. System Catalog Declaration Rules

    +74.1. System Catalog Declaration Rules

    74.1. System Catalog Declaration Rules

    The key part of a catalog header file is a C structure definition describing the layout of each row of the catalog. This begins with a CATALOG macro, which so far as the C compiler is @@ -71,4 +71,4 @@ in pg_attribute, but fortunately genbki.pl handles that chore nowadays.) Avoid making new catalogs be bootstrap catalogs if at all possible. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-initial-data.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-initial-data.html index 4daa189..7d926e2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-initial-data.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/system-catalog-initial-data.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -74.2. System Catalog Initial Data

    74.2. System Catalog Initial Data

    +74.2. System Catalog Initial Data

    74.2. System Catalog Initial Data

    Each catalog that has any manually-created initial data (some do not) has a corresponding .dat file that contains its initial data in an editable format. @@ -401,4 +401,4 @@ $ perl rewrite_dat_with_prokind.pl pg_proc.dat and remove_pg_type_oid_symbols.pl attached to this message: https://www.postgresql.org/message-id/CAJVSVGVX8gXnPm+Xa=DxR7kFYprcQ1tNcCT5D0O3ShfnM6jehA@mail.gmail.com -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tableam.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tableam.html index a7bf924..0ab3db3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tableam.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tableam.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 63. Table Access Method Interface Definition

    Chapter 63. Table Access Method Interface Definition

    +Chapter 63. Table Access Method Interface Definition

    Chapter 63. Table Access Method Interface Definition

    This chapter explains the interface between the core PostgreSQL system and table access methods, which manage the storage for tables. The core system @@ -69,4 +69,4 @@ the existing heap implementation present in src/backend/access/heap/heapam_handler.c for details of its implementation. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tablefunc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tablefunc.html index 676f590..dbbf51f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tablefunc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tablefunc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.43. tablefunc

    F.43. tablefunc

    +F.43. tablefunc

    F.43. tablefunc

    The tablefunc module includes various functions that return tables (that is, multiple rows). These functions are useful both in their own right and as examples of how to write C functions that return @@ -610,4 +610,4 @@ SELECT * FROM connectby('connectby_tree', 'keyid', 'parent_keyid', 'pos', 'row2'

    F.43.2. Author

    Joe Conway -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-method.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-method.html index 7cb7736..c61f25f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-method.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-method.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 60. Writing a Table Sampling Method

    Chapter 60. Writing a Table Sampling Method

    +Chapter 60. Writing a Table Sampling Method

    Chapter 60. Writing a Table Sampling Method

    PostgreSQL's implementation of the TABLESAMPLE clause supports custom table sampling methods, in addition to the BERNOULLI and SYSTEM methods that are required @@ -54,4 +54,4 @@ method_name(internal) RETURNS tsm_handler the src/backend/access/tablesample subdirectory of the source tree for the built-in sampling methods, and into the contrib subdirectory for add-on methods. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-support-functions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-support-functions.html index efc28b2..306f8eb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-support-functions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tablesample-support-functions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -60.1. Sampling Method Support Functions

    60.1. Sampling Method Support Functions

    +60.1. Sampling Method Support Functions

    60.1. Sampling Method Support Functions

    The TSM handler function returns a palloc'd TsmRoutine struct containing pointers to the support functions described below. Most of the functions are required, but some are optional, and those pointers can @@ -160,4 +160,4 @@ EndSampleScan (SampleScanState *node); should be cleaned up. This function can be omitted (set the pointer to NULL) in the common case where no such resources exist. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tcn.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tcn.html index eda9f65..705243f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tcn.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tcn.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.44. tcn

    F.44. tcn

    +F.44. tcn

    F.44. tcn

    The tcn module provides a trigger function that notifies listeners of changes to any table on which it is attached. It must be used as an AFTER trigger FOR EACH ROW. @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@ test=# delete from tcndata where a = 1 and b = date '2012-12-22'; DELETE 1 Asynchronous notification "tcn" with payload ""tcndata",D,"a"='1',"b"='2012-12-22'" received from server process with PID 22770.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/test-decoding.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/test-decoding.html index 6734bbb..b98559b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/test-decoding.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/test-decoding.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.45. test_decoding

    F.45. test_decoding

    +F.45. test_decoding

    F.45. test_decoding

    test_decoding is an example of a logical decoding output plugin. It doesn't do anything especially useful, but can serve as a starting point for developing your own output plugin. @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ postgres[33712]=#* SELECT * FROM pg_logical_slot_get_changes('test_slot', NULL, 0/16BEBA0 | 503 | closing a streamed block for transaction TXN 503 (10 rows)

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-configuration.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-configuration.html index ab0b2e8..4ab0801 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-configuration.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-configuration.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.7. Configuration Example

    12.7. Configuration Example

    +12.7. Configuration Example

    12.7. Configuration Example

    A text search configuration specifies all options necessary to transform a document into a tsvector: the parser to use to break text into tokens, and the dictionaries to use to transform each token into a @@ -105,4 +105,4 @@ SHOW default_text_search_config; ---------------------------- public.pg

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-controls.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-controls.html index d6465b0..cebf8a4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-controls.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-controls.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.3. Controlling Text Search

    12.3. Controlling Text Search

    +12.3. Controlling Text Search

    12.3. Controlling Text Search

    To implement full text searching there must be a function to create a tsvector from a document and a tsquery from a user query. Also, we need to return results in a useful order, so we need @@ -547,4 +547,4 @@ occurrences to display in the result.', ts_headline uses the original document, not a tsvector summary, so it can be slow and should be used with care. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-debugging.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-debugging.html index 6ee63fa..00a52cc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-debugging.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-debugging.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.8. Testing and Debugging Text Search

    12.8. Testing and Debugging Text Search

    +12.8. Testing and Debugging Text Search

    12.8. Testing and Debugging Text Search

    The behavior of a custom text search configuration can easily become confusing. The functions described in this section are useful for testing text search objects. You can @@ -250,4 +250,4 @@ SELECT plainto_tsquery('supernovae stars'); ----------------- 'sn'

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-dictionaries.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-dictionaries.html index be0b365..c1863c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-dictionaries.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-dictionaries.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.6. Dictionaries

    12.6. Dictionaries

    +12.6. Dictionaries

    12.6. Dictionaries

    Dictionaries are used to eliminate words that should not be considered in a search (stop words), and to normalize words so that different derived forms of the same word will match. A successfully @@ -658,4 +658,4 @@ CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY english_stem ( at the end of the dictionary list. It is useless to have it before any other dictionary because a token will never pass through it to the next dictionary. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-features.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-features.html index 9e5ae4f..62a263c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-features.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-features.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.4. Additional Features

    12.4. Additional Features

    +12.4. Additional Features

    12.4. Additional Features

    This section describes additional functions and operators that are useful in connection with text search.

    12.4.1. Manipulating Documents

    @@ -389,4 +389,4 @@ SELECT * FROM ts_stat('SELECT vector FROM apod', 'ab') ORDER BY nentry DESC, ndoc DESC, word LIMIT 10;

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-indexes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-indexes.html index 8182546..c10fc90 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-indexes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-indexes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.9. Preferred Index Types for Text Search

    12.9. Preferred Index Types for Text Search

    +12.9. Preferred Index Types for Text Search

    12.9. Preferred Index Types for Text Search

    There are two kinds of indexes that can be used to speed up full text searches: GIN and @@ -77,4 +77,4 @@ servers and collecting external search results, e.g., via Foreign Data access. The latter is possible because ranking functions use only local information. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-intro.html index 01efe7b..730950c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.1. Introduction

    12.1. Introduction

    +12.1. Introduction

    12.1. Introduction

    Full Text Searching (or just text search) provides the capability to identify natural-language documents that satisfy a query, and optionally to sort them by @@ -336,4 +336,4 @@ SELECT phraseto_tsquery('the cats ate the rats'); parsers and templates, no special privilege is needed to create a new dictionary or configuration. Examples of creating custom dictionaries and configurations appear later in this chapter. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-limitations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-limitations.html index 57bdd7e..1a96d63 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-limitations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-limitations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.11. Limitations

    12.11. Limitations

    +12.11. Limitations

    12.11. Limitations

    The current limitations of PostgreSQL's text search features are:

    • The length of each lexeme must be less than 2 kilobytes

    • The length of a tsvector (lexemes + positions) must be @@ -18,4 +18,4 @@ Another example — the PostgreSQL mailing list archives contained 910,989 unique words with 57,491,343 lexemes in 461,020 messages. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-parsers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-parsers.html index 233e61b..6b2d994 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-parsers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-parsers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.5. Parsers

    12.5. Parsers

    +12.5. Parsers

    12.5. Parsers

    Text search parsers are responsible for splitting raw document text into tokens and identifying each token's type, where the set of possible types is defined by the parser itself. @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@ SELECT alias, description, token FROM ts_debug('http://example.com/stuff/index.h host | Host | example.com url_path | URL path | /stuff/index.html

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-psql.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-psql.html index 2c39344..ae77ed6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-psql.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-psql.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.10. psql Support

    12.10. psql Support

    +12.10. psql Support

    12.10. psql Support

    Information about text search configuration objects can be obtained in psql using a set of commands:

    @@ -162,4 +162,4 @@ Parser: "pg_catalog.default"
      pg_catalog | synonym   | synonym dictionary: replace word by its synonym
      pg_catalog | thesaurus | thesaurus dictionary: phrase by phrase substitution
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-tables.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-tables.html index 3cde56a..386dbf3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-tables.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch-tables.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -12.2. Tables and Indexes

    12.2. Tables and Indexes

    +12.2. Tables and Indexes

    12.2. Tables and Indexes

    The examples in the previous section illustrated full text matching using simple constant strings. This section shows how to search table data, optionally using indexes. @@ -136,4 +136,4 @@ LIMIT 10; important when using a GiST index than a GIN index; see Section 12.9.) The expression-index approach is simpler to set up, however, and it requires less disk space since the tsvector representation is not stored explicitly. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch.html index 250fcc4..0a1b9ff 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/textsearch.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 12. Full Text Search \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 12. Full Text Search \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/transaction-iso.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/transaction-iso.html index bcc71ae..fdf2b11 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/transaction-iso.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/transaction-iso.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -13.2. Transaction Isolation

    13.2. Transaction Isolation

    +13.2. Transaction Isolation

    13.2. Transaction Isolation

    The SQL standard defines four levels of transaction isolation. The most strict is Serializable, which is defined by the standard in a paragraph which says that any @@ -537,4 +537,4 @@ ERROR: could not serialize access due to read/write dependencies among transact Some differences in behavior and performance may be observed when compared with other systems that use a traditional locking technique. Please see [ports12] for detailed information. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-datachanges.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-datachanges.html index 68614aa..9379840 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-datachanges.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-datachanges.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -39.2. Visibility of Data Changes

    39.2. Visibility of Data Changes

    +39.2. Visibility of Data Changes

    39.2. Visibility of Data Changes

    If you execute SQL commands in your trigger function, and these commands access the table that the trigger is for, then you need to be aware of the data visibility rules, because they determine @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@

    Further information about data visibility rules can be found in Section 47.5. The example in Section 39.4 contains a demonstration of these rules. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-definition.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-definition.html index f791221..f0eae81 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-definition.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-definition.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -39.1. Overview of Trigger Behavior

    39.1. Overview of Trigger Behavior

    +39.1. Overview of Trigger Behavior

    39.1. Overview of Trigger Behavior

    A trigger is a specification that the database should automatically execute a particular function whenever a certain type of operation is performed. Triggers can be attached to tables (partitioned or not), @@ -312,4 +312,4 @@ that is being used, but the typical approach is to make the transition tables act like read-only temporary tables that can be accessed by SQL commands issued within the trigger function. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-example.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-example.html index 187baef..a753917 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-example.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-example.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -39.4. A Complete Trigger Example

    39.4. A Complete Trigger Example

    +39.4. A Complete Trigger Example

    39.4. A Complete Trigger Example

    Here is a very simple example of a trigger function written in C. (Examples of triggers written in procedural languages can be found in the documentation of the procedural languages.) @@ -177,4 +177,4 @@ DELETE 2 There are more complex examples in src/test/regress/regress.c and in spi. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-interface.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-interface.html index ed345ef..a0ae14f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-interface.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/trigger-interface.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -39.3. Writing Trigger Functions in C

    39.3. Writing Trigger Functions in C

    +39.3. Writing Trigger Functions in C

    39.3. Writing Trigger Functions in C

    This section describes the low-level details of the interface to a trigger function. This information is only needed when writing trigger functions in C. If you are using a higher-level language then @@ -181,4 +181,4 @@ typedef struct Trigger Be careful to return either tg_trigtuple or tg_newtuple, as appropriate, if you don't want to modify the row being operated on. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/triggers.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/triggers.html index 95aacdf..3d31e12 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/triggers.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/triggers.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 39. Triggers

    Chapter 39. Triggers

    +Chapter 39. Triggers

    Chapter 39. Triggers

    This chapter provides general information about writing trigger functions. Trigger functions can be written in most of the available procedural languages, including @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ most people find it easier to use one of the procedural languages. It is not currently possible to write a trigger function in the plain SQL function language. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-rows.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-rows.html index 8231086..c9389ee 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-rows.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-rows.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.46. tsm_system_rows

    F.46. tsm_system_rows

    +F.46. tsm_system_rows

    F.46. tsm_system_rows

    The tsm_system_rows module provides the table sampling method SYSTEM_ROWS, which can be used in the TABLESAMPLE clause of a SELECT @@ -36,4 +36,4 @@ SELECT * FROM my_table TABLESAMPLE SYSTEM_ROWS(100); This command will return a sample of 100 rows from the table my_table (unless the table does not have 100 visible rows, in which case all its rows are returned). -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-time.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-time.html index b3dadf7..016eb75 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-time.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tsm-system-time.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.47. tsm_system_time

    F.47. tsm_system_time

    +F.47. tsm_system_time

    F.47. tsm_system_time

    The tsm_system_time module provides the table sampling method SYSTEM_TIME, which can be used in the TABLESAMPLE clause of a SELECT @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@ SELECT * FROM my_table TABLESAMPLE SYSTEM_TIME(1000); This command will return as large a sample of my_table as it can read in 1 second (1000 milliseconds). Of course, if the whole table can be read in under 1 second, all its rows will be returned. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-accessdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-accessdb.html index 1566068..543fabe 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-accessdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-accessdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -1.4. Accessing a Database

    1.4. Accessing a Database

    +1.4. Accessing a Database

    1.4. Accessing a Database

    Once you have created a database, you can access it by:

    • @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ In psql, you will be greeted with the following message:

      -psql (15.5)
      +psql (15.6)
       Type "help" for help.
       
       mydb=>
      @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ mydb=#
       mydb=> SELECT version();
                                                version
       -------------------------------------------------------------------​-----------------------
      - PostgreSQL 15.5 on x86_64-pc-linux-gnu, compiled by gcc (Debian 4.9.2-10) 4.9.2, 64-bit
      + PostgreSQL 15.6 on x86_64-pc-linux-gnu, compiled by gcc (Debian 4.9.2-10) 4.9.2, 64-bit
       (1 row)
       
       mydb=> SELECT current_date;
      @@ -100,4 +100,4 @@ mydb=#
           full capabilities of psql are documented in
           psql.  In this tutorial we will not use these
           features explicitly, but you can use them yourself when it is helpful.
      -   

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced-intro.html index 2713a20..0c45035 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3.1. Introduction

    3.1. Introduction

    +3.1. Introduction

    3.1. Introduction

    In the previous chapter we have covered the basics of using SQL to store and access your data in PostgreSQL. We will now discuss some @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ file also contains some sample data to load, which is not repeated here. (Refer to Section 2.1 for how to use the file.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced.html index 3cc6e3b..e0e0f83 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-advanced.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 3. Advanced Features \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 3. Advanced Features \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-agg.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-agg.html index b89fd78..7351e14 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-agg.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-agg.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.7. Aggregate Functions

    2.7. Aggregate Functions

    +2.7. Aggregate Functions

    2.7. Aggregate Functions

    Like most other relational database products, PostgreSQL supports aggregate functions. @@ -169,4 +169,4 @@ SELECT city, count(*) FILTER (WHERE temp_lo < 45), max(temp_lo) rows with temp_lo below 45; but the max aggregate is still applied to all rows, so it still finds the reading of 46. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-arch.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-arch.html index f123008..222edd8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-arch.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-arch.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -1.2. Architectural Fundamentals

    1.2. Architectural Fundamentals

    +1.2. Architectural Fundamentals

    1.2. Architectural Fundamentals

    Before we proceed, you should understand the basic PostgreSQL system architecture. Understanding how the parts of @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@ client connections, whereas client and associated server processes come and go. (All of this is of course invisible to the user. We only mention it here for completeness.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-concepts.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-concepts.html index 02b8d65..8188a6e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-concepts.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-concepts.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.2. Concepts

    2.2. Concepts

    +2.2. Concepts

    2.2. Concepts

    @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ Tables are grouped into databases, and a collection of databases managed by a single PostgreSQL server instance constitutes a database cluster. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-conclusion.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-conclusion.html index 8a83182..7e76a00 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-conclusion.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-conclusion.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3.7. Conclusion

    3.7. Conclusion

    +3.7. Conclusion

    3.7. Conclusion

    PostgreSQL has many features not touched upon in this tutorial introduction, which has been oriented toward newer users of SQL. These @@ -9,4 +9,4 @@ If you feel you need more introductory material, please visit the PostgreSQL web site for links to more resources. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-createdb.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-createdb.html index e785b4a..9759325 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-createdb.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-createdb.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -1.3. Creating a Database

    1.3. Creating a Database

    +1.3. Creating a Database

    1.3. Creating a Database

    The first test to see whether you can access the database server is to try to create a database. A running PostgreSQL server can manage many @@ -115,4 +115,4 @@ createdb: error: database creation failed: ERROR: permission denied to create d create databases. Instead of logging in as that user you can also specify the -U option everywhere to select a PostgreSQL user name to connect as. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-delete.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-delete.html index 5fab888..6b7d291 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-delete.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-delete.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.9. Deletions

    2.9. Deletions

    +2.9. Deletions

    2.9. Deletions

    Rows can be removed from a table using the DELETE command. Suppose you are no longer interested in the weather of Hayward. @@ -31,4 +31,4 @@ DELETE FROM tablename; remove all rows from the given table, leaving it empty. The system will not request confirmation before doing this! -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-fk.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-fk.html index 2b52a23..d7affc8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-fk.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-fk.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3.3. Foreign Keys

    3.3. Foreign Keys

    +3.3. Foreign Keys

    3.3. Foreign Keys

    Recall the weather and cities tables from Chapter 2. Consider the following problem: You want to make sure that no one can insert rows in the @@ -48,4 +48,4 @@ DETAIL: Key (city)=(Berkeley) is not present in table "cities". for more information. Making correct use of foreign keys will definitely improve the quality of your database applications, so you are strongly encouraged to learn about them. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-inheritance.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-inheritance.html index 1481ae3..afb208c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-inheritance.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-inheritance.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3.6. Inheritance

    3.6. Inheritance

    +3.6. Inheritance

    3.6. Inheritance

    Inheritance is a concept from object-oriented databases. It opens up interesting new possibilities of database design.

    @@ -110,4 +110,4 @@ SELECT name, elevation Although inheritance is frequently useful, it has not been integrated with unique constraints or foreign keys, which limits its usefulness. See Section 5.10 for more detail. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-install.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-install.html index b37492b..bca7954 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-install.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-install.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -1.1. Installation

    1.1. Installation

    +1.1. Installation

    1.1. Installation

    Before you can use PostgreSQL you need to install it, of course. It is possible that PostgreSQL is already installed at your @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@ site administrator or, if that is you, the documentation to make sure that your environment is properly set up. If you did not understand the preceding paragraph then read the next section. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-join.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-join.html index 60b04bf..5bd3342 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-join.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-join.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.6. Joins Between Tables

    2.6. Joins Between Tables

    +2.6. Joins Between Tables

    2.6. Joins Between Tables

    Thus far, our queries have only accessed one table at a time. Queries can access multiple tables at once, or access the same table in such a way that multiple rows of the table are being @@ -159,4 +159,4 @@ SELECT * This is only a conceptual model. The join is usually performed in a more efficient manner than actually comparing each possible pair of rows, but this is invisible to the user. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-populate.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-populate.html index 53b0123..679397d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-populate.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-populate.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.4. Populating a Table With Rows

    2.4. Populating a Table With Rows

    +2.4. Populating a Table With Rows

    2.4. Populating a Table With Rows

    The INSERT statement is used to populate a table with rows: @@ -56,4 +56,4 @@ COPY weather FROM '/home/user/weather.txt'; machine running the backend process, not the client, since the backend process reads the file directly. You can read more about the COPY command in COPY. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-select.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-select.html index 16b3397..dba47c9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-select.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-select.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.5. Querying a Table

    2.5. Querying a Table

    +2.5. Querying a Table

    2.5. Querying a Table

    @@ -139,4 +139,4 @@ SELECT DISTINCT city required by the SQL standard, and current PostgreSQL does not guarantee that DISTINCT causes the rows to be ordered. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql-intro.html index bf49142..2ec92e5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.1. Introduction

    2.1. Introduction

    +2.1. Introduction

    2.1. Introduction

    This chapter provides an overview of how to use SQL to perform simple operations. This tutorial is only intended to give you an introduction and is in no @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ single step mode which pauses before sending each statement to the server. The commands used in this section are in the file basics.sql. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql.html index a232e0d..a313f4c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-sql.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 2. The SQL Language \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 2. The SQL Language \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-start.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-start.html index 33b1d4f..3046601 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-start.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-start.html @@ -1,2 +1,2 @@ -Chapter 1. Getting Started \ No newline at end of file +Chapter 1. Getting Started \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-table.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-table.html index 6c80b6f..e27cce4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-table.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-table.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.3. Creating a New Table

    2.3. Creating a New Table

    +2.3. Creating a New Table

    2.3. Creating a New Table

    You can create a new table by specifying the table name, along with all column names and their types: @@ -66,4 +66,4 @@ CREATE TABLE cities (

     DROP TABLE tablename;
     

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-transactions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-transactions.html index bb7779b..aa13a78 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-transactions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-transactions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3.4. Transactions

    3.4. Transactions

    +3.4. Transactions

    3.4. Transactions

    Transactions are a fundamental concept of all database systems. The essential point of a transaction is that it bundles multiple steps into a single, all-or-nothing operation. The intermediate @@ -139,4 +139,4 @@ COMMIT; transaction block that was put in aborted state by the system due to an error, short of rolling it back completely and starting again. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-update.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-update.html index d5879a2..9009c12 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-update.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-update.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -2.8. Updates

    2.8. Updates

    +2.8. Updates

    2.8. Updates

    You can update existing rows using the UPDATE command. Suppose you discover the temperature readings are @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ SELECT * FROM weather; Hayward | 35 | 52 | | 1994-11-29 (3 rows)

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-views.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-views.html index b99e785..dd1c11b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-views.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-views.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3.2. Views

    3.2. Views

    +3.2. Views

    3.2. Views

    Refer back to the queries in Section 2.6. Suppose the combined listing of weather records and city location is of particular interest to your application, but you do not want @@ -23,4 +23,4 @@ SELECT * FROM myview;

    Views can be used in almost any place a real table can be used. Building views upon other views is not uncommon. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-window.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-window.html index 1459518..2d7849b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-window.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial-window.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -3.5. Window Functions

    3.5. Window Functions

    +3.5. Window Functions

    3.5. Window Functions

    A window function performs a calculation across a set of table rows that are somehow related to the current row. This is comparable to the type of calculation that can be done with an aggregate function. @@ -199,4 +199,4 @@ SELECT sum(salary) OVER w, avg(salary) OVER w There are options to define the window frame in other ways, but this tutorial does not cover them. See Section 4.2.8 for details. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial.html index 988bd19..11ff8e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/tutorial.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Part I. Tutorial \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-func.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-func.html index 63be92a..7340db3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-func.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-func.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -10.3. Functions

    10.3. Functions

    +10.3. Functions

    10.3. Functions

    The specific function that is referenced by a function call is determined using the following procedure.

    Function Type Resolution

    1. @@ -265,4 +265,4 @@ SELECT substr(CAST (1234 AS text), 3); is no need to have a special case. See CREATE CAST for additional commentary. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-oper.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-oper.html index fbcb13c..e2173a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-oper.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-oper.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -10.2. Operators

    10.2. Operators

    +10.2. Operators

    10.2. Operators

    The specific operator that is referenced by an operator expression is determined using the following procedure. Note that this procedure is indirectly affected @@ -244,4 +244,4 @@ usable in all the same cases as a similarly-named operator on the base type. search path containing schemas that permit untrusted users to create objects is not a secure schema usage pattern. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-overview.html index 3f29ed5..e66390a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-overview.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -10.1. Overview

    10.1. Overview

    +10.1. Overview

    10.1. Overview

    SQL is a strongly typed language. That is, every data item has an associated data type which determines its behavior and allowed usage. PostgreSQL has an extensible type system that is @@ -110,4 +110,4 @@ Additionally, if a query usually requires an implicit conversion for a function, if then the user defines a new function with the correct argument types, the parser should use this new function and no longer do implicit conversion to use the old function.

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-query.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-query.html index e33a03c..5ce816c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-query.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-query.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -10.4. Value Storage

    10.4. Value Storage

    +10.4. Value Storage

    10.4. Value Storage

    Values to be inserted into a table are converted to the destination column's data type according to the following steps. @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@ not insert any real function call.) Finally, the sizing function and applied to the operator's result and the stored column length. This type-specific function performs the required length check and addition of padding spaces. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-select.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-select.html index bf4d5d8..c460781 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-select.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-select.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -10.6. SELECT Output Columns

    10.6. SELECT Output Columns

    +10.6. SELECT Output Columns

    10.6. SELECT Output Columns

    The rules given in the preceding sections will result in assignment of non-unknown data types to all expressions in an SQL query, except for unspecified-type literals that appear as simple output @@ -27,4 +27,4 @@ output lists for this purpose. unspecified-type literals in a SELECT output list were left as type unknown. That had assorted bad consequences, so it's been changed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-union-case.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-union-case.html index 93c451e..fd81125 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-union-case.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv-union-case.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -10.5. UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs

    10.5. UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs

    +10.5. UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs

    10.5. UNION, CASE, and Related Constructs

    SQL UNION constructs must match up possibly dissimilar types to become a single result set. The resolution algorithm is applied separately to each output column of a union query. The @@ -111,4 +111,4 @@ section consider all of their inputs in one resolution step. input, with the THEN clauses(s) considered after that. In all other cases, left to right means the order in which the expressions appear in the query text. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv.html index c38f58d..a0d5c82 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/typeconv.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 10. Type Conversion

    Chapter 10. Type Conversion

    +Chapter 10. Type Conversion

    Chapter 10. Type Conversion

    SQL statements can, intentionally or not, require the mixing of different data types in the same expression. PostgreSQL has extensive facilities for @@ -16,4 +16,4 @@ type conversion mechanisms and conventions. Refer to the relevant sections in Chapter 8 and Chapter 9 for more information on specific data types and allowed functions and operators. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/unaccent.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/unaccent.html index 79979cb..6cd8ea0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/unaccent.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/unaccent.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.48. unaccent

    F.48. unaccent

    +F.48. unaccent

    F.48. unaccent

    unaccent is a text search dictionary that removes accents (diacritic signs) from lexemes. It's a filtering dictionary, which means its output is @@ -128,4 +128,4 @@ unaccent([dictionary SELECT unaccent('unaccent', 'Hôtel'); SELECT unaccent('Hôtel');

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/unsupported-features-sql-standard.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/unsupported-features-sql-standard.html index 8754274..332a914 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/unsupported-features-sql-standard.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/unsupported-features-sql-standard.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -D.2. Unsupported Features

    D.2. Unsupported Features

    +D.2. Unsupported Features

    D.2. Unsupported Features

    The following features defined in SQL:2016 are not implemented in this release of PostgreSQL. In a few cases, equivalent functionality is available.

    IdentifierCore?DescriptionComment
    B011 Embedded Ada 
    B013 Embedded COBOL 
    B014 Embedded Fortran 
    B015 Embedded MUMPS 
    B016 Embedded Pascal 
    B017 Embedded PL/I 
    B031 Basic dynamic SQL 
    B032 Extended dynamic SQL 
    B032-01 <describe input statement> 
    B033 Untyped SQL-invoked function arguments 
    B034 Dynamic specification of cursor attributes 
    B035 Non-extended descriptor names 
    B041 Extensions to embedded SQL exception declarations 
    B051 Enhanced execution rights 
    B111 Module language Ada 
    B112 Module language C 
    B113 Module language COBOL 
    B114 Module language Fortran 
    B115 Module language MUMPS 
    B116 Module language Pascal 
    B117 Module language PL/I 
    B121 Routine language Ada 
    B122 Routine language C 
    B123 Routine language COBOL 
    B124 Routine language Fortran 
    B125 Routine language MUMPS 
    B126 Routine language Pascal 
    B127 Routine language PL/I 
    B200 Polymorphic table functions 
    B201 More than one PTF generic table parameter 
    B202 PTF Copartitioning 
    B203 More than one copartition specification 
    B204 PRUNE WHEN EMPTY 
    B205 Pass-through columns 
    B206 PTF descriptor parameters 
    B207 Cross products of partitionings 
    B208 PTF component procedure interface 
    B209 PTF extended names 
    B211 Module language Ada: VARCHAR and NUMERIC support 
    B221 Routine language Ada: VARCHAR and NUMERIC support 
    F054 TIMESTAMP in DATE type precedence list 
    F121 Basic diagnostics management 
    F121-01 GET DIAGNOSTICS statement 
    F121-02 SET TRANSACTION statement: DIAGNOSTICS SIZE clause 
    F122 Enhanced diagnostics management 
    F123 All diagnostics 
    F263 Comma-separated predicates in simple CASE expression 
    F291 UNIQUE predicate 
    F301 CORRESPONDING in query expressions 
    F403 Partitioned joined tables 
    F451 Character set definition 
    F461 Named character sets 
    F492 Optional table constraint enforcement 
    F521 Assertions 
    F671 Subqueries in CHECKintentionally omitted
    F673 Reads SQL-data routine invocations in CHECK constraints 
    F693 SQL-session and client module collations 
    F695 Translation support 
    F696 Additional translation documentation 
    F721 Deferrable constraintsforeign and unique keys only
    F741 Referential MATCH typesno partial match yet
    F812CoreBasic flagging 
    F813 Extended flagging 
    F821 Local table references 
    F831 Full cursor update 
    F831-01 Updatable scrollable cursors 
    F831-02 Updatable ordered cursors 
    F841 LIKE_REGEX predicateconsider regexp_like()
    F842 OCCURRENCES_REGEX functionconsider regexp_matches()
    F843 POSITION_REGEX functionconsider regexp_instr()
    F844 SUBSTRING_REGEX functionconsider regexp_substr()
    F845 TRANSLATE_REGEX functionconsider regexp_replace()
    F846 Octet support in regular expression operators 
    F847 Nonconstant regular expressions 
    F866 FETCH FIRST clause: PERCENT option 
    R010 Row pattern recognition: FROM clause 
    R020 Row pattern recognition: WINDOW clause 
    R030 Row pattern recognition: full aggregate support 
    S011CoreDistinct data types 
    S011-01CoreUSER_DEFINED_TYPES view 
    S023 Basic structured types 
    S024 Enhanced structured types 
    S025 Final structured types 
    S026 Self-referencing structured types 
    S027 Create method by specific method name 
    S028 Permutable UDT options list 
    S041 Basic reference types 
    S043 Enhanced reference types 
    S051 Create table of typepartially supported
    S081 Subtables 
    S091 Basic array supportpartially supported
    S091-02 Arrays of distinct types 
    S094 Arrays of reference types 
    S097 Array element assignment 
    S151 Type predicatesee pg_typeof()
    S161 Subtype treatment 
    S162 Subtype treatment for references 
    S202 SQL-invoked routines on multisets 
    S231 Structured type locators 
    S232 Array locators 
    S233 Multiset locators 
    S241 Transform functions 
    S242 Alter transform statement 
    S251 User-defined orderings 
    S261 Specific type method 
    S271 Basic multiset support 
    S272 Multisets of user-defined types 
    S274 Multisets of reference types 
    S275 Advanced multiset support 
    S281 Nested collection types 
    S291 Unique constraint on entire row 
    S401 Distinct types based on array types 
    S402 Distinct types based on distinct types 
    S403 ARRAY_MAX_CARDINALITY 
    T011 Timestamp in Information Schema 
    T021 BINARY and VARBINARY data types 
    T022 Advanced support for BINARY and VARBINARY data types 
    T023 Compound binary literal 
    T024 Spaces in binary literals 
    T041 Basic LOB data type support 
    T041-01 BLOB data type 
    T041-02 CLOB data type 
    T041-03 POSITION, LENGTH, LOWER, TRIM, UPPER, and SUBSTRING functions for LOB data types 
    T041-04 Concatenation of LOB data types 
    T041-05 LOB locator: non-holdable 
    T042 Extended LOB data type support 
    T043 Multiplier T 
    T044 Multiplier P 
    T051 Row types 
    T053 Explicit aliases for all-fields reference 
    T061 UCS support 
    T076 DECFLOAT data type 
    T101 Enhanced nullability determination 
    T111 Updatable joins, unions, and columns 
    T175 Generated columnsmostly supported
    T176 Sequence generator supportsupported except for NEXT VALUE FOR
    T180 System-versioned tables 
    T181 Application-time period tables 
    T211 Basic trigger capability 
    T211-06 Support for run-time rules for the interaction of triggers and constraints 
    T211-08 Multiple triggers for the same event are executed in the order in which they were created in the catalogintentionally omitted
    T231 Sensitive cursors 
    T251 SET TRANSACTION statement: LOCAL option 
    T272 Enhanced savepoint management 
    T301 Functional dependenciespartially supported
    T321CoreBasic SQL-invoked routinespartially supported
    T322 Declared data type attributes 
    T324 Explicit security for SQL routines 
    T326 Table functions 
    T471 Result sets return value 
    T472 DESCRIBE CURSOR 
    T495 Combined data change and retrievaldifferent syntax
    T502 Period predicates 
    T511 Transaction counts 
    T522 Default values for IN parameters of SQL-invoked proceduressupported except DEFAULT key word in invocation
    T561 Holdable locators 
    T571 Array-returning external SQL-invoked functions 
    T572 Multiset-returning external SQL-invoked functions 
    T601 Local cursor references 
    T616 Null treatment option for LEAD and LAG functions 
    T618 NTH_VALUE functionfunction exists, but some options missing
    T619 Nested window functions 
    T625 LISTAGG 
    T641 Multiple column assignmentonly some syntax variants supported
    T652 SQL-dynamic statements in SQL routines 
    T654 SQL-dynamic statements in external routines 
    T811 Basic SQL/JSON constructor functions 
    T812 SQL/JSON: JSON_OBJECTAGG 
    T813 SQL/JSON: JSON_ARRAYAGG with ORDER BY 
    T814 Colon in JSON_OBJECT or JSON_OBJECTAGG 
    T821 Basic SQL/JSON query operators 
    T822 SQL/JSON: IS JSON WITH UNIQUE KEYS predicate 
    T823 SQL/JSON: PASSING clause 
    T824 JSON_TABLE: specific PLAN clause 
    T825 SQL/JSON: ON EMPTY and ON ERROR clauses 
    T826 General value expression in ON ERROR or ON EMPTY clauses 
    T827 JSON_TABLE: sibling NESTED COLUMNS clauses 
    T828 JSON_QUERY 
    T829 JSON_QUERY: array wrapper options 
    T830 Enforcing unique keys in SQL/JSON constructor functions 
    T838 JSON_TABLE: PLAN DEFAULT clause 
    T839 Formatted cast of datetimes to/from character strings 
    M001 Datalinks 
    M002 Datalinks via SQL/CLI 
    M003 Datalinks via Embedded SQL 
    M004 Foreign data supportpartially supported
    M005 Foreign schema support 
    M006 GetSQLString routine 
    M007 TransmitRequest 
    M009 GetOpts and GetStatistics routines 
    M010 Foreign data wrapper supportdifferent API
    M011 Datalinks via Ada 
    M012 Datalinks via C 
    M013 Datalinks via COBOL 
    M014 Datalinks via Fortran 
    M015 Datalinks via M 
    M016 Datalinks via Pascal 
    M017 Datalinks via PL/I 
    M018 Foreign data wrapper interface routines in Ada 
    M019 Foreign data wrapper interface routines in Cdifferent API
    M020 Foreign data wrapper interface routines in COBOL 
    M021 Foreign data wrapper interface routines in Fortran 
    M022 Foreign data wrapper interface routines in MUMPS 
    M023 Foreign data wrapper interface routines in Pascal 
    M024 Foreign data wrapper interface routines in PL/I 
    M030 SQL-server foreign data support 
    M031 Foreign data wrapper general routines 
    X012 Multisets of XML type 
    X013 Distinct types of XML type 
    X015 Fields of XML type 
    X025 XMLCast 
    X030 XMLDocument 
    X038 XMLText 
    X065 XMLParse: BLOB input and CONTENT option 
    X066 XMLParse: BLOB input and DOCUMENT option 
    X068 XMLSerialize: BOM 
    X069 XMLSerialize: INDENT 
    X073 XMLSerialize: BLOB serialization and CONTENT option 
    X074 XMLSerialize: BLOB serialization and DOCUMENT option 
    X075 XMLSerialize: BLOB serialization 
    X076 XMLSerialize: VERSION 
    X077 XMLSerialize: explicit ENCODING option 
    X078 XMLSerialize: explicit XML declaration 
    X080 Namespaces in XML publishing 
    X081 Query-level XML namespace declarations 
    X082 XML namespace declarations in DML 
    X083 XML namespace declarations in DDL 
    X084 XML namespace declarations in compound statements 
    X085 Predefined namespace prefixes 
    X086 XML namespace declarations in XMLTable 
    X091 XML content predicate 
    X096 XMLExistsXPath 1.0 only
    X100 Host language support for XML: CONTENT option 
    X101 Host language support for XML: DOCUMENT option 
    X110 Host language support for XML: VARCHAR mapping 
    X111 Host language support for XML: CLOB mapping 
    X112 Host language support for XML: BLOB mapping 
    X113 Host language support for XML: STRIP WHITESPACE option 
    X114 Host language support for XML: PRESERVE WHITESPACE option 
    X131 Query-level XMLBINARY clause 
    X132 XMLBINARY clause in DML 
    X133 XMLBINARY clause in DDL 
    X134 XMLBINARY clause in compound statements 
    X135 XMLBINARY clause in subqueries 
    X141 IS VALID predicate: data-driven case 
    X142 IS VALID predicate: ACCORDING TO clause 
    X143 IS VALID predicate: ELEMENT clause 
    X144 IS VALID predicate: schema location 
    X145 IS VALID predicate outside check constraints 
    X151 IS VALID predicate with DOCUMENT option 
    X152 IS VALID predicate with CONTENT option 
    X153 IS VALID predicate with SEQUENCE option 
    X155 IS VALID predicate: NAMESPACE without ELEMENT clause 
    X157 IS VALID predicate: NO NAMESPACE with ELEMENT clause 
    X160 Basic Information Schema for registered XML Schemas 
    X161 Advanced Information Schema for registered XML Schemas 
    X170 XML null handling options 
    X171 NIL ON NO CONTENT option 
    X181 XML(DOCUMENT(UNTYPED)) type 
    X182 XML(DOCUMENT(ANY)) type 
    X190 XML(SEQUENCE) type 
    X191 XML(DOCUMENT(XMLSCHEMA)) type 
    X192 XML(CONTENT(XMLSCHEMA)) type 
    X200 XMLQuery 
    X201 XMLQuery: RETURNING CONTENT 
    X202 XMLQuery: RETURNING SEQUENCE 
    X203 XMLQuery: passing a context item 
    X204 XMLQuery: initializing an XQuery variable 
    X205 XMLQuery: EMPTY ON EMPTY option 
    X206 XMLQuery: NULL ON EMPTY option 
    X211 XML 1.1 support 
    X222 XML passing mechanism BY REFparser accepts BY REF but ignores it; passing is always BY VALUE
    X231 XML(CONTENT(UNTYPED)) type 
    X232 XML(CONTENT(ANY)) type 
    X241 RETURNING CONTENT in XML publishing 
    X242 RETURNING SEQUENCE in XML publishing 
    X251 Persistent XML values of XML(DOCUMENT(UNTYPED)) type 
    X252 Persistent XML values of XML(DOCUMENT(ANY)) type 
    X253 Persistent XML values of XML(CONTENT(UNTYPED)) type 
    X254 Persistent XML values of XML(CONTENT(ANY)) type 
    X255 Persistent XML values of XML(SEQUENCE) type 
    X256 Persistent XML values of XML(DOCUMENT(XMLSCHEMA)) type 
    X257 Persistent XML values of XML(CONTENT(XMLSCHEMA)) type 
    X260 XML type: ELEMENT clause 
    X261 XML type: NAMESPACE without ELEMENT clause 
    X263 XML type: NO NAMESPACE with ELEMENT clause 
    X264 XML type: schema location 
    X271 XMLValidate: data-driven case 
    X272 XMLValidate: ACCORDING TO clause 
    X273 XMLValidate: ELEMENT clause 
    X274 XMLValidate: schema location 
    X281 XMLValidate with DOCUMENT option 
    X282 XMLValidate with CONTENT option 
    X283 XMLValidate with SEQUENCE option 
    X284 XMLValidate: NAMESPACE without ELEMENT clause 
    X286 XMLValidate: NO NAMESPACE with ELEMENT clause 
    X300 XMLTableXPath 1.0 only
    X305 XMLTable: initializing an XQuery variable 

    -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/upgrading.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/upgrading.html index 7cb184b..2c3615e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/upgrading.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/upgrading.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -19.6. Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster

    19.6. Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster

    +19.6. Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster

    19.6. Upgrading a PostgreSQL Cluster

    This section discusses how to upgrade your database data from one PostgreSQL release to a newer one.

    @@ -100,7 +100,7 @@ To make the backup, you can use the pg_dumpall command from the version you are currently running; see Section 26.1.2 for more details. For best results, however, try to use the pg_dumpall - command from PostgreSQL 15.5, + command from PostgreSQL 15.6, since this version contains bug fixes and improvements over older versions. While this advice might seem idiosyncratic since you haven't installed the new version yet, it is advisable to follow @@ -192,4 +192,4 @@ pg_dumpall -p 5432 | psql -d postgres -p 5433 systems such as pglogical, Slony, Londiste, and Bucardo. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/user-manag.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/user-manag.html index b49ec9a..d1d1919 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/user-manag.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/user-manag.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 22. Database Roles

    Chapter 22. Database Roles

    +Chapter 22. Database Roles

    Chapter 22. Database Roles

    PostgreSQL manages database access permissions using the concept of roles. A role can be thought of as either a database user, or a group of database users, depending on how @@ -17,4 +17,4 @@ This chapter describes how to create and manage roles. More information about the effects of role privileges on various database objects can be found in Section 5.7. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/using-explain.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/using-explain.html index 66145e7..d3deaa9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/using-explain.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/using-explain.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -14.1. Using EXPLAIN

    14.1. Using EXPLAIN

    +14.1. Using EXPLAIN

    14.1. Using EXPLAIN

    PostgreSQL devises a query plan for each query it receives. Choosing the right plan to match the query structure and the properties of the data @@ -801,4 +801,4 @@ EXPLAIN ANALYZE SELECT * FROM tenk1 WHERE unique1 < 100 AND unique2 > 9000 the EXPLAIN output and a Subplans Removed: N annotation appears instead. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/uuid-ossp.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/uuid-ossp.html index cafa95a..f528382 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/uuid-ossp.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/uuid-ossp.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.49. uuid-ossp

    F.49. uuid-ossp

    +F.49. uuid-ossp

    F.49. uuid-ossp

    The uuid-ossp module provides functions to generate universally unique identifiers (UUIDs) using one of several standard algorithms. There are also functions to produce certain special UUID constants. @@ -141,4 +141,4 @@ SELECT uuid_generate_v3(uuid_ns_url(), 'http://www.postgresql.org'); machine, so configure does not automatically choose one.

    F.49.3. Author

    Peter Eisentraut -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/vacuumlo.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/vacuumlo.html index 16e6b05..34adc54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/vacuumlo.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/vacuumlo.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -vacuumlo

    vacuumlo

    vacuumlo — remove orphaned large objects from a PostgreSQL database

    Synopsis

    vacuumlo [option...] dbname...

    Description

    +vacuumlo

    vacuumlo

    vacuumlo — remove orphaned large objects from a PostgreSQL database

    Synopsis

    vacuumlo [option...] dbname...

    Description

    vacuumlo is a simple utility program that will remove any orphaned large objects from a PostgreSQL database. An orphaned large object (LO) is @@ -71,4 +71,4 @@ temporary table identify orphaned LOs. These are removed.

    Author

    Peter Mount -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extension-versions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extension-versions.html index cf3406d..c1ac8e4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extension-versions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extension-versions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.3. pg_available_extension_versions

    54.3. pg_available_extension_versions

    +54.3. pg_available_extension_versions

    54.3. pg_available_extension_versions

    The pg_available_extension_versions view lists the specific extension versions that are available for installation. See also the pg_extension @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@


    The pg_available_extension_versions view is read-only. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extensions.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extensions.html index 66414e4..ed2b54c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extensions.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-available-extensions.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.2. pg_available_extensions

    54.2. pg_available_extensions

    +54.2. pg_available_extensions

    54.2. pg_available_extensions

    The pg_available_extensions view lists the extensions that are available for installation. See also the @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ Comment string from the extension's control file


    The pg_available_extensions view is read-only. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-backend-memory-contexts.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-backend-memory-contexts.html index 35d64a3..953a9a3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-backend-memory-contexts.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-backend-memory-contexts.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.4. pg_backend_memory_contexts

    54.4. pg_backend_memory_contexts

    +54.4. pg_backend_memory_contexts

    54.4. pg_backend_memory_contexts

    The view pg_backend_memory_contexts displays all the memory contexts of the server process attached to the current session.

    @@ -59,4 +59,4 @@ By default, the pg_backend_memory_contexts view can be read only by superusers or roles with the privileges of the pg_read_all_stats role. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-config.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-config.html index 14e66e5..3b74fa0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-config.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-config.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.5. pg_config

    54.5. pg_config

    +54.5. pg_config

    54.5. pg_config

    The view pg_config describes the compile-time configuration parameters of the currently installed version of PostgreSQL. It is intended, for example, to @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@

    The parameter value -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-cursors.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-cursors.html index ccda25f..cdbc5d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-cursors.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-cursors.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.6. pg_cursors

    54.6. pg_cursors

    +54.6. pg_cursors

    54.6. pg_cursors

    The pg_cursors view lists the cursors that are currently available. Cursors can be defined in several ways:

    • @@ -69,4 +69,4 @@ The time at which the cursor was declared


    The pg_cursors view is read-only. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-file-settings.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-file-settings.html index 611f252..67af931 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-file-settings.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-file-settings.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.7. pg_file_settings

    54.7. pg_file_settings

    +54.7. pg_file_settings

    54.7. pg_file_settings

    The view pg_file_settings provides a summary of the contents of the server's configuration file(s). A row appears in this view for each name = value entry appearing in the files, @@ -74,4 +74,4 @@

    See Section 20.1 for more information about the various ways to change run-time parameters. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-group.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-group.html index a1b4259..c12f19f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-group.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-group.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.8. pg_group

    54.8. pg_group

    +54.8. pg_group

    54.8. pg_group

    The view pg_group exists for backwards compatibility: it emulates a catalog that existed in PostgreSQL before version 8.1. @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@

    An array containing the IDs of the roles in this group -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-hba-file-rules.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-hba-file-rules.html index 3a1de1d..0671c35 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-hba-file-rules.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-hba-file-rules.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.9. pg_hba_file_rules

    54.9. pg_hba_file_rules

    +54.9. pg_hba_file_rules

    54.9. pg_hba_file_rules

    The view pg_hba_file_rules provides a summary of the contents of the client authentication configuration file, pg_hba.conf. @@ -73,4 +73,4 @@

    See Chapter 21 for more information about client authentication configuration. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-ident-file-mappings.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-ident-file-mappings.html index be8d3be..a73f3b9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-ident-file-mappings.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-ident-file-mappings.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.10. pg_ident_file_mappings

    54.10. pg_ident_file_mappings

    +54.10. pg_ident_file_mappings

    54.10. pg_ident_file_mappings

    The view pg_ident_file_mappings provides a summary of the contents of the client user name mapping configuration file, pg_ident.conf. @@ -50,4 +50,4 @@

    See Chapter 21 for more information about client authentication configuration. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-indexes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-indexes.html index 8f8cb53..b9e7431 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-indexes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-indexes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.11. pg_indexes

    54.11. pg_indexes

    +54.11. pg_indexes

    54.11. pg_indexes

    The view pg_indexes provides access to useful information about each index in the database.

    Table 54.11. pg_indexes Columns

    @@ -37,4 +37,4 @@

    Index definition (a reconstructed CREATE INDEX command) -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-locks.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-locks.html index 1dfd859..8ddece6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-locks.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-locks.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.12. pg_locks

    54.12. pg_locks

    +54.12. pg_locks

    54.12. pg_locks

    The view pg_locks provides access to information about the locks held by active processes within the database server. See Chapter 13 for more discussion @@ -252,4 +252,4 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_locks pl LEFT JOIN pg_prepared_xacts ppx The locks are held only for the minimum amount of time necessary to obtain data from the lock managers, but this does not completely eliminate the possibility of a performance impact. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-matviews.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-matviews.html index a14ec1c..8038d4f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-matviews.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-matviews.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.13. pg_matviews

    54.13. pg_matviews

    +54.13. pg_matviews

    54.13. pg_matviews

    The view pg_matviews provides access to useful information about each materialized view in the database.

    Table 54.13. pg_matviews Columns

    @@ -46,4 +46,4 @@

    Materialized view definition (a reconstructed SELECT query) -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-policies.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-policies.html index c123ca8..e626073 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-policies.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-policies.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.14. pg_policies

    54.14. pg_policies

    +54.14. pg_policies

    54.14. pg_policies

    The view pg_policies provides access to useful information about each row-level security policy in the database.

    Table 54.14. pg_policies Columns

    @@ -52,4 +52,4 @@

    The expression added to the WITH CHECK qualifications for queries that attempt to add rows to this table -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-statements.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-statements.html index c75aa8f..f45cbb4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-statements.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-statements.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.15. pg_prepared_statements

    54.15. pg_prepared_statements

    +54.15. pg_prepared_statements

    54.15. pg_prepared_statements

    The pg_prepared_statements view displays all the prepared statements that are available in the current session. See PREPARE for more information about prepared @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ Number of times custom plan was chosen


    The pg_prepared_statements view is read-only. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-xacts.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-xacts.html index 4d91b46..c169cc2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-xacts.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-prepared-xacts.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.16. pg_prepared_xacts

    54.16. pg_prepared_xacts

    +54.16. pg_prepared_xacts

    54.16. pg_prepared_xacts

    The view pg_prepared_xacts displays information about transactions that are currently prepared for two-phase commit (see PREPARE TRANSACTION for details). @@ -47,4 +47,4 @@ normal operations longer than necessary. Nonetheless there could be some impact on database performance if this view is frequently accessed. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-publication-tables.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-publication-tables.html index 6b9705a..fe2ef5b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-publication-tables.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-publication-tables.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.17. pg_publication_tables

    54.17. pg_publication_tables

    +54.17. pg_publication_tables

    54.17. pg_publication_tables

    The view pg_publication_tables provides information about the mapping between publications and information of tables they contain. Unlike the underlying catalog @@ -43,4 +43,4 @@

    Expression for the table's publication qualifying condition -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-origin-status.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-origin-status.html index 8787673..b4c8f90 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-origin-status.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-origin-status.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.18. pg_replication_origin_status

    54.18. pg_replication_origin_status

    +54.18. pg_replication_origin_status

    54.18. pg_replication_origin_status

    The pg_replication_origin_status view contains information about how far replay for a certain origin has progressed. For more on replication origins @@ -33,4 +33,4 @@ This node's LSN at which remote_lsn has been replicated. Used to flush commit records before persisting data to disk when using asynchronous commits. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-slots.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-slots.html index bdb96f1..a672e99 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-slots.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-replication-slots.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.19. pg_replication_slots

    54.19. pg_replication_slots

    +54.19. pg_replication_slots

    54.19. pg_replication_slots

    The pg_replication_slots view provides a listing of all replication slots that currently exist on the database cluster, along with their current state. @@ -128,4 +128,4 @@

    True if the slot is enabled for decoding prepared transactions. Always false for physical slots. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-roles.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-roles.html index 4fede12..6c0e07f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-roles.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-roles.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.20. pg_roles

    54.20. pg_roles

    +54.20. pg_roles

    54.20. pg_roles

    The view pg_roles provides access to information about database roles. This is simply a publicly readable view of @@ -82,4 +82,4 @@

    ID of role -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-rules.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-rules.html index 8aed34b..08c78e3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-rules.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-rules.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.21. pg_rules

    54.21. pg_rules

    +54.21. pg_rules

    54.21. pg_rules

    The view pg_rules provides access to useful information about query rewrite rules.

    Table 54.21. pg_rules Columns

    @@ -34,4 +34,4 @@ The pg_rules view excludes the ON SELECT rules of views and materialized views; those can be seen in pg_views and pg_matviews. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-seclabels.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-seclabels.html index e1e41ff..9e07f9c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-seclabels.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-seclabels.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.22. pg_seclabels

    54.22. pg_seclabels

    +54.22. pg_seclabels

    54.22. pg_seclabels

    The view pg_seclabels provides information about security labels. It as an easier-to-query version of the pg_seclabel catalog. @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@

    The security label applied to this object. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-sequences.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-sequences.html index 4e4a5e7..82ad439 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-sequences.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-sequences.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.23. pg_sequences

    54.23. pg_sequences

    +54.23. pg_sequences

    54.23. pg_sequences

    The view pg_sequences provides access to useful information about each sequence in the database.

    Table 54.23. pg_sequences Columns

    @@ -71,4 +71,4 @@ the current user does not have USAGE or SELECT privilege on the sequence, the value is null. -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-settings.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-settings.html index 0d00543..121bff0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-settings.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-settings.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.24. pg_settings

    54.24. pg_settings

    +54.24. pg_settings

    54.24. pg_settings

    The view pg_settings provides access to run-time parameters of the server. It is essentially an alternative interface to the SHOW @@ -198,4 +198,4 @@ this view will not display any customized options defined by such modules unless special action is taken to load them into the backend process executing the query. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shadow.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shadow.html index a3308f7..e0fea72 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shadow.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shadow.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.25. pg_shadow

    54.25. pg_shadow

    +54.25. pg_shadow

    54.25. pg_shadow

    The view pg_shadow exists for backwards compatibility: it emulates a catalog that existed in PostgreSQL before version 8.1. @@ -68,4 +68,4 @@

    Session defaults for run-time configuration variables -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shmem-allocations.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shmem-allocations.html index 90d270c..631b2b6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shmem-allocations.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-shmem-allocations.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.26. pg_shmem_allocations

    54.26. pg_shmem_allocations

    +54.26. pg_shmem_allocations

    54.26. pg_shmem_allocations

    The pg_shmem_allocations view shows allocations made from the server's main shared memory segment. This includes both memory allocated by PostgreSQL itself and memory @@ -49,4 +49,4 @@ By default, the pg_shmem_allocations view can be read only by superusers or roles with privileges of the pg_read_all_stats role. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext-exprs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext-exprs.html index 9b281a7..34b5574 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext-exprs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext-exprs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.29. pg_stats_ext_exprs

    54.29. pg_stats_ext_exprs

    +54.29. pg_stats_ext_exprs

    54.29. pg_stats_ext_exprs

    The view pg_stats_ext_exprs provides access to information about all expressions included in extended statistics objects, combining information stored in the pg_statistic_ext @@ -144,4 +144,4 @@ column-by-column basis using the ALTER TABLE SET STATISTICS command, or globally by setting the default_statistics_target run-time parameter. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext.html index da67620..92b7a49 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats-ext.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.28. pg_stats_ext

    54.28. pg_stats_ext

    +54.28. pg_stats_ext

    54.28. pg_stats_ext

    The view pg_stats_ext provides access to information about each extended statistics object in the database, combining information stored in the pg_statistic_ext @@ -121,4 +121,4 @@ column-by-column basis using the ALTER TABLE SET STATISTICS command, or globally by setting the default_statistics_target run-time parameter. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats.html index 1a9b34f..d6d93a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-stats.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.27. pg_stats

    54.27. pg_stats

    +54.27. pg_stats

    54.27. pg_stats

    The view pg_stats provides access to the information stored in the pg_statistic catalog. This view allows access only to rows of @@ -125,4 +125,4 @@ TABLE SET STATISTICS command, or globally by setting the default_statistics_target run-time parameter. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-tables.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-tables.html index 21f4d9f..b6ff9da 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-tables.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-tables.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.30. pg_tables

    54.30. pg_tables

    +54.30. pg_tables

    54.30. pg_tables

    The view pg_tables provides access to useful information about each table in the database.

    Table 54.30. pg_tables Columns

    @@ -55,4 +55,4 @@

    True if row security is enabled on the table -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-abbrevs.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-abbrevs.html index b7ef98c..2e5765a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-abbrevs.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-abbrevs.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.31. pg_timezone_abbrevs

    54.31. pg_timezone_abbrevs

    +54.31. pg_timezone_abbrevs

    54.31. pg_timezone_abbrevs

    The view pg_timezone_abbrevs provides a list of time zone abbreviations that are currently recognized by the datetime input routines. The contents of this view change when the @@ -29,4 +29,4 @@ there are some that have historically varied in value (see Section B.4 for more information). In such cases this view presents their current meaning. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-names.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-names.html index bbcb17c..36d3faa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-names.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-timezone-names.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.32. pg_timezone_names

    54.32. pg_timezone_names

    +54.32. pg_timezone_names

    54.32. pg_timezone_names

    The view pg_timezone_names provides a list of time zone names that are recognized by SET TIMEZONE, along with their associated abbreviations, UTC offsets, @@ -35,4 +35,4 @@

    True if currently observing daylight savings -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user-mappings.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user-mappings.html index e55c2c1..7dbe225 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user-mappings.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user-mappings.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.34. pg_user_mappings

    54.34. pg_user_mappings

    +54.34. pg_user_mappings

    54.34. pg_user_mappings

    The view pg_user_mappings provides access to information about user mappings. This is essentially a publicly readable view of @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@

  • current user is a superuser

  • -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user.html index b91720a..1af16e7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-user.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.33. pg_user

    54.33. pg_user

    +54.33. pg_user

    54.33. pg_user

    The view pg_user provides access to information about database users. This is simply a publicly readable view of @@ -57,4 +57,4 @@

    Session defaults for run-time configuration variables -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-views.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-views.html index ce568db..12ac7b8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-views.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/view-pg-views.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -54.35. pg_views

    54.35. pg_views

    +54.35. pg_views

    54.35. pg_views

    The view pg_views provides access to useful information about each view in the database.

    Table 54.35. pg_views Columns

    @@ -30,4 +30,4 @@

    View definition (a reconstructed SELECT query) -


    \ No newline at end of file +


    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/views-overview.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/views-overview.html index 1133c80..1c5f79a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/views-overview.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/views-overview.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ -54.1. Overview

    54.1. Overview

    +54.1. Overview

    54.1. Overview

    Table 54.1 lists the system views. More detailed documentation of each catalog follows below. Except where noted, all the views described here are read-only. -

    Table 54.1. System Views

    View NamePurpose
    pg_available_extensionsavailable extensions
    pg_available_extension_versionsavailable versions of extensions
    pg_backend_memory_contextsbackend memory contexts
    pg_configcompile-time configuration parameters
    pg_cursorsopen cursors
    pg_file_settingssummary of configuration file contents
    pg_groupgroups of database users
    pg_hba_file_rulessummary of client authentication configuration file contents
    pg_ident_file_mappingssummary of client user name mapping configuration file contents
    pg_indexesindexes
    pg_lockslocks currently held or awaited
    pg_matviewsmaterialized views
    pg_policiespolicies
    pg_prepared_statementsprepared statements
    pg_prepared_xactsprepared transactions
    pg_publication_tablespublications and information of their associated tables
    pg_replication_origin_statusinformation about replication origins, including replication progress
    pg_replication_slotsreplication slot information
    pg_rolesdatabase roles
    pg_rulesrules
    pg_seclabelssecurity labels
    pg_sequencessequences
    pg_settingsparameter settings
    pg_shadowdatabase users
    pg_shmem_allocationsshared memory allocations
    pg_statsplanner statistics
    pg_stats_extextended planner statistics
    pg_stats_ext_exprsextended planner statistics for expressions
    pg_tablestables
    pg_timezone_abbrevstime zone abbreviations
    pg_timezone_namestime zone names
    pg_userdatabase users
    pg_user_mappingsuser mappings
    pg_viewsviews

    \ No newline at end of file +

    Table 54.1. System Views

    View NamePurpose
    pg_available_extensionsavailable extensions
    pg_available_extension_versionsavailable versions of extensions
    pg_backend_memory_contextsbackend memory contexts
    pg_configcompile-time configuration parameters
    pg_cursorsopen cursors
    pg_file_settingssummary of configuration file contents
    pg_groupgroups of database users
    pg_hba_file_rulessummary of client authentication configuration file contents
    pg_ident_file_mappingssummary of client user name mapping configuration file contents
    pg_indexesindexes
    pg_lockslocks currently held or awaited
    pg_matviewsmaterialized views
    pg_policiespolicies
    pg_prepared_statementsprepared statements
    pg_prepared_xactsprepared transactions
    pg_publication_tablespublications and information of their associated tables
    pg_replication_origin_statusinformation about replication origins, including replication progress
    pg_replication_slotsreplication slot information
    pg_rolesdatabase roles
    pg_rulesrules
    pg_seclabelssecurity labels
    pg_sequencessequences
    pg_settingsparameter settings
    pg_shadowdatabase users
    pg_shmem_allocationsshared memory allocations
    pg_statsplanner statistics
    pg_stats_extextended planner statistics
    pg_stats_ext_exprsextended planner statistics for expressions
    pg_tablestables
    pg_timezone_abbrevstime zone abbreviations
    pg_timezone_namestime zone names
    pg_userdatabase users
    pg_user_mappingsuser mappings
    pg_viewsviews

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/views.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/views.html index 33a09c6..4244356 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/views.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/views.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 54. System Views

    Chapter 54. System Views

    +Chapter 54. System Views

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-async-commit.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-async-commit.html index 8b5c55f..2b5ff28 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-async-commit.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-async-commit.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -30.4. Asynchronous Commit

    30.4. Asynchronous Commit

    +30.4. Asynchronous Commit

    30.4. Asynchronous Commit

    Asynchronous commit is an option that allows transactions to complete more quickly, at the cost that the most recent transactions may be lost if the database should crash. In many applications this is an @@ -96,4 +96,4 @@ setting can be thought of as a way of increasing the time window in which transactions can join a group about to participate in a single flush, to amortize the cost of the flush among multiple transactions. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-configuration.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-configuration.html index 45d4f2f..e83b0be 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-configuration.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-configuration.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -30.5. WAL Configuration

    30.5. WAL Configuration

    +30.5. WAL Configuration

    30.5. WAL Configuration

    There are several WAL-related configuration parameters that affect database performance. This section explains their use. Consult Chapter 20 for general information about @@ -292,4 +292,4 @@ concurrency and distance, respectively. By default, it is set to try, which enables the feature on systems where posix_fadvise is available. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-internals.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-internals.html index e692147..24700fd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-internals.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-internals.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -30.6. WAL Internals

    30.6. WAL Internals

    +30.6. WAL Internals

    30.6. WAL Internals

    WAL is automatically enabled; no action is required from the administrator except ensuring that the disk-space requirements for the WAL logs are met, @@ -67,4 +67,4 @@ to read pg_control itself. So while it is theoretically a weak spot, pg_control does not seem to be a problem in practice. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-intro.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-intro.html index fd36028..193c265 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-intro.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-intro.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -30.3. Write-Ahead Logging (WAL)

    30.3. Write-Ahead Logging (WAL)

    +30.3. Write-Ahead Logging (WAL)

    30.3. Write-Ahead Logging (WAL)

    Write-Ahead Logging (WAL) is a standard method for ensuring data integrity. A detailed description can be found in most (if not all) books about @@ -45,4 +45,4 @@ of the database state — if it is made over some period of time, then replaying the WAL log for that period will fix any internal inconsistencies. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-reliability.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-reliability.html index 84505e3..f80688a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-reliability.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal-reliability.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -30.1. Reliability

    30.1. Reliability

    +30.1. Reliability

    30.1. Reliability

    Reliability is an important property of any serious database system, and PostgreSQL does everything possible to guarantee reliable operation. One aspect of reliable operation is @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ to disable it.

  • On FreeBSD, IDE drives can be queried using - atacontrol and write caching turned off using + camcontrol identify and write caching turned off using hw.ata.wc=0 in /boot/loader.conf; SCSI drives can be queried using camcontrol identify, and the write cache both queried and changed using @@ -158,4 +158,4 @@ PostgreSQL does not protect against correctable memory errors and it is assumed you will operate using RAM that uses industry standard Error Correcting Codes (ECC) or better protection. -

  • \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal.html index db27ef2..1ae879c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/wal.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/wal.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log

    Chapter 30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log

    +Chapter 30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log

    Chapter 30. Reliability and the Write-Ahead Log

    This chapter explains how the Write-Ahead Log is used to obtain efficient, reliable operation. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby-failover.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby-failover.html index f3c1002..84cd504 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby-failover.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby-failover.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -27.3. Failover

    27.3. Failover

    +27.3. Failover

    27.3. Failover

    If the primary server fails then the standby server should begin failover procedures.

    @@ -62,4 +62,4 @@ setting up the reporting servers that are only used to offload read-only queries from the primary, not for high availability purposes, you don't need to promote it. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby.html index 88a2d47..7ac58c1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/warm-standby.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -27.2. Log-Shipping Standby Servers

    27.2. Log-Shipping Standby Servers

    +27.2. Log-Shipping Standby Servers

    27.2. Log-Shipping Standby Servers

    Continuous archiving can be used to create a high availability (HA) cluster configuration with one or more standby servers ready to take over operations if the @@ -103,7 +103,7 @@ later disconnected, the standby goes back to step 1 and tries to restore the file from the archive again. This loop of retries from the archive, pg_wal, and via streaming replication goes on until the server - is stopped or failover is triggered by a trigger file. + is stopped or is promoted.

    Standby mode is exited and the server switches to normal operation when pg_ctl promote is run, @@ -654,4 +654,4 @@ synchronous_standby_names = 'ANY 2 (s1, s2, s3)' are found in the archive, but not if streaming replication is enabled. When a server is not in recovery mode, there is no difference between on and always modes. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/when-can-parallel-query-be-used.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/when-can-parallel-query-be-used.html index 89e20b2..ab13b7c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/when-can-parallel-query-be-used.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/when-can-parallel-query-be-used.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -15.2. When Can Parallel Query Be Used?

    15.2. When Can Parallel Query Be Used?

    +15.2. When Can Parallel Query Be Used?

    15.2. When Can Parallel Query Be Used?

    There are several settings that can cause the query planner not to generate a parallel query plan under any circumstances. In order for any parallel query plans whatsoever to be generated, the following @@ -75,4 +75,4 @@ max_parallel_workers_per_gather to zero in sessions where it is likely, so as to avoid generating query plans that may be suboptimal when run serially. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xaggr.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xaggr.html index a1d582e..f5031d1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xaggr.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xaggr.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.12. User-Defined Aggregates

    38.12. User-Defined Aggregates

    +38.12. User-Defined Aggregates

    38.12. User-Defined Aggregates

    Aggregate functions in PostgreSQL are defined in terms of state values and state transition functions. @@ -525,4 +525,4 @@ if (AggCheckCallContext(fcinfo, NULL)) supposed to implement. Examples can be found in orderedsetaggs.c in the PostgreSQL source code. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-c.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-c.html index 061c566..24d2766 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-c.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-c.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.10. C-Language Functions \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-internal.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-internal.html index 033ece2..d8f6cc7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-internal.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-internal.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.9. Internal Functions

    38.9. Internal Functions

    +38.9. Internal Functions

    38.9. Internal Functions

    Internal functions are functions written in C that have been statically linked into the PostgreSQL server. The body of the function definition @@ -28,4 +28,4 @@ CREATE FUNCTION square_root(double precision) RETURNS double precision Not all predefined functions are internal in the above sense. Some predefined functions are written in SQL. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-optimization.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-optimization.html index d468dee..246d9d1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-optimization.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-optimization.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.11. Function Optimization Information

    38.11. Function Optimization Information

    +38.11. Function Optimization Information

    38.11. Function Optimization Information

    By default, a function is just a black box that the database system knows very little about the behavior of. However, that means that queries using the function may be executed much less @@ -91,4 +91,4 @@ supportfn(internal) returns internal the index to see if it really passes the WHERE condition or not. To create such conditions, the support function must implement the SupportRequestIndexCondition request type. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-overload.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-overload.html index 0556ad0..0406846 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-overload.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-overload.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.6. Function Overloading

    38.6. Function Overloading

    +38.6. Function Overloading

    38.6. Function Overloading

    More than one function can be defined with the same SQL name, so long as the arguments they take are different. In other words, function names can be overloaded. Whether or not @@ -64,4 +64,4 @@ CREATE FUNCTION test(int, int) RETURNS int LANGUAGE C;

    The names of the C functions here reflect one of many possible conventions. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-pl.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-pl.html index 06656fe..025827a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-pl.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-pl.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.8. Procedural Language Functions

    38.8. Procedural Language Functions

    +38.8. Procedural Language Functions

    38.8. Procedural Language Functions

    PostgreSQL allows user-defined functions to be written in other languages besides SQL and C. These other languages are generically called procedural @@ -9,4 +9,4 @@ by loadable modules. See Chapter 42 and following chapters for more information. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-sql.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-sql.html index d63b57b..8090e15 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-sql.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-sql.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.5. Query Language (SQL) Functions \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-volatility.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-volatility.html index db8ed70..a5c058f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-volatility.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc-volatility.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.7. Function Volatility Categories

    38.7. Function Volatility Categories

    +38.7. Function Volatility Categories

    38.7. Function Volatility Categories

    Every function has a volatility classification, with the possibilities being VOLATILE, STABLE, or IMMUTABLE. VOLATILE is the default if the @@ -104,4 +104,4 @@ If you do that, you will find that the STABLE or IMMUTABLE function does not notice the database changes applied by the called function, since they are hidden from its snapshot.) -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc.html index 2017086..2ffe8b1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xfunc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.3. User-Defined Functions

    38.3. User-Defined Functions

    +38.3. User-Defined Functions

    38.3. User-Defined Functions

    PostgreSQL provides four kinds of functions: @@ -40,4 +40,4 @@ funcs.c in the src/tutorial directory in the PostgreSQL source distribution. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xindex.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xindex.html index 2082c5c..7c505ef 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xindex.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xindex.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes

    38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes

    +38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes

    38.16. Interfacing Extensions to Indexes

    The procedures described thus far let you define new types, new functions, and new operators. However, we cannot yet define an index on a column of a new data type. To do this, we must define an @@ -769,4 +769,4 @@ CREATE OPERATOR CLASS polygon_ops type of the stored summary values, and operator classes' support procedures are responsible for interpreting the summary values correctly. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xml-limits-conformance.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xml-limits-conformance.html index 010d67d..b5863de 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xml-limits-conformance.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xml-limits-conformance.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -D.3. XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML

    D.3. XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML

    +D.3. XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML

    D.3. XML Limits and Conformance to SQL/XML

    Significant revisions to the XML-related specifications in ISO/IEC 9075-14 (SQL/XML) were introduced with SQL:2006. PostgreSQL's implementation of the XML data @@ -201,4 +201,4 @@ SELECT XMLQUERY('$a is $b' PASSING BY VALUE xDOCUMENT is the only form of XML value that PostgreSQL can supply as an XPath context item. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xml2.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xml2.html index dc2b870..902d844 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xml2.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xml2.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -F.50. xml2

    F.50. xml2

    +F.50. xml2

    F.50. xml2

    The xml2 module provides XPath querying and XSLT functionality.

    F.50.1. Deprecation Notice

    @@ -271,4 +271,4 @@ xslt_process(text document, text stylesheet, text paramlist) returns text

    Development of this module was sponsored by Torchbox Ltd. (www.torchbox.com). It has the same BSD license as PostgreSQL. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper-optimization.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper-optimization.html index 5d13846..cbeee0a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper-optimization.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper-optimization.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.15. Operator Optimization Information

    38.15. Operator Optimization Information

    +38.15. Operator Optimization Information

    38.15. Operator Optimization Information

    A PostgreSQL operator definition can include several optional clauses that tell the system useful things about how the operator behaves. These clauses should be provided whenever @@ -13,7 +13,7 @@

    Additional optimization clauses might be added in future versions of PostgreSQL. The ones described here are all - the ones that release 15.5 understands. + the ones that release 15.6 understands.

    It is also possible to attach a planner support function to the function that underlies an operator, providing another way of telling the system @@ -278,4 +278,4 @@ table1.column1 OP table2.column2 The function underlying a merge-joinable operator must be marked immutable or stable. If it is volatile, the system will never attempt to use the operator for a merge join. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper.html index ebd0f83..a38dcf4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xoper.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.14. User-Defined Operators

    38.14. User-Defined Operators

    +38.14. User-Defined Operators

    38.14. User-Defined Operators

    Every operator is syntactic sugar for a call to an underlying function that does the real work; so you must first create the underlying function before you can create @@ -55,4 +55,4 @@ SELECT (a + b) AS c FROM test_complex; clause shown in the example is an optional hint to the query optimizer. Further details about commutator and other optimizer hints appear in the next section. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang-install.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang-install.html index b1ec495..4f86da8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang-install.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang-install.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -42.1. Installing Procedural Languages

    42.1. Installing Procedural Languages

    +42.1. Installing Procedural Languages

    42.1. Installing Procedural Languages

    A procedural language must be installed into each database where it is to be used. But procedural languages installed in the database template1 are automatically available in all @@ -139,4 +139,4 @@ CREATE TRUSTED LANGUAGE plperl handlers are built and installed if Perl support is configured, and the PL/PythonU handler is installed if Python support is configured, but these languages are not installed by default. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang.html index 0a90173..2988bda 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xplang.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -Chapter 42. Procedural Languages

    Chapter 42. Procedural Languages

    +Chapter 42. Procedural Languages

    Chapter 42. Procedural Languages

    PostgreSQL allows user-defined functions to be written in other languages besides SQL and C. These other languages are generically called procedural @@ -26,4 +26,4 @@ has information about finding them. In addition other languages can be defined by users; the basics of developing a new procedural language are covered in Chapter 58. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xproc.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xproc.html index 1ec83a5..89b891e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xproc.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xproc.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.4. User-Defined Procedures

    38.4. User-Defined Procedures

    +38.4. User-Defined Procedures

    38.4. User-Defined Procedures

    A procedure is a database object similar to a function. The key differences are: @@ -38,4 +38,4 @@ and DROP ROUTINE that can operate on functions and procedures without having to know which kind it is. Note, however, that there is no CREATE ROUTINE command. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/html/xtypes.html b/doc/src/sgml/html/xtypes.html index c370c6f..03a82ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/html/xtypes.html +++ b/doc/src/sgml/html/xtypes.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -38.13. User-Defined Types

    38.13. User-Defined Types

    +38.13. User-Defined Types

    38.13. User-Defined Types

    As described in Section 38.2, PostgreSQL can be extended to support new data types. This section describes how to define new base types, @@ -299,4 +299,4 @@ CREATE TYPE complex ( For examples of working with expanded values, see the standard array infrastructure, particularly src/backend/utils/adt/array_expanded.c. -

    \ No newline at end of file +

    \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml index 5512212..a9bb0bf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/indices.sgml @@ -90,6 +90,39 @@ CREATE INDEX test1_id_index ON test1 (id); also significantly speed up queries with joins.
    + + In general, PostgreSQL indexes can be used + to optimize queries that contain one or more WHERE + or JOIN clauses of the form + + +indexed-column indexable-operator comparison-value + + + Here, the indexed-column is whatever + column or expression the index has been defined on. + The indexable-operator is an operator that + is a member of the index's operator class for + the indexed column. (More details about that appear below.) + And the comparison-value can be any + expression that is not volatile and does not reference the index's + table. + + + + In some cases the query planner can extract an indexable clause of + this form from another SQL construct. A simple example is that if + the original clause was + + +comparison-value operator indexed-column + + + then it can be flipped around into indexable form if the + original operator has a commutator + operator that is a member of the index's operator class. + + Creating an index on a large table can take a long time. By default, PostgreSQL allows reads (SELECT statements) to occur @@ -120,7 +153,7 @@ CREATE INDEX test1_id_index ON test1 (id); B-tree, Hash, GiST, SP-GiST, GIN, BRIN, and the extension bloom. Each index type uses a different - algorithm that is best suited to different types of queries. + algorithm that is best suited to different types of indexable clauses. By default, the CREATE INDEX command creates B-tree indexes, which fit the most common situations. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml index 350c75b..8f1c649 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/information_schema.sgml @@ -697,8 +697,8 @@ An encoding of some character repertoire. Most older character repertoires only use one encoding form, and so there are no - separate names for them (e.g., LATIN1 is an - encoding form applicable to the LATIN1 + separate names for them (e.g., LATIN2 is an + encoding form applicable to the LATIN2 repertoire). But for example Unicode has the encoding forms UTF8, UTF16, etc. (not all supported by PostgreSQL). Encoding forms are not exposed @@ -4846,9 +4846,11 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <literal>routine_column_usage</literal> - The view routine_column_usage is meant to identify all - columns that are used by a function or procedure. This information is - currently not tracked by PostgreSQL. + The view routine_column_usage identifies all columns + that are used by a function or procedure, either in the SQL body or in + parameter default expressions. (This only works for unquoted SQL bodies, + not quoted bodies or functions in other languages.) A column is only + included if its table is owned by a currently enabled role. @@ -5085,12 +5087,12 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <literal>routine_routine_usage</literal> - The view routine_routine_usage is meant to identify all - functions or procedures that are used by another (or the same) function or - procedure, either in the body or in parameter default expressions. - Currently, only functions used in parameter default expressions are - tracked. An entry is included here only if the used function is owned by a - currently enabled role. (There is no such restriction on the using + The view routine_routine_usage identifies all functions + or procedures that are used by another (or the same) function or procedure, + either in the SQL body or in parameter default expressions. (This only + works for unquoted SQL bodies, not quoted bodies or functions in other + languages.) An entry is included here only if the used function is owned + by a currently enabled role. (There is no such restriction on the using function.) @@ -5184,11 +5186,11 @@ ORDER BY c.ordinal_position; <literal>routine_sequence_usage</literal> - The view routine_sequence_usage is meant to identify all - sequences that are used by a function or procedure, either in the body or - in parameter default expressions. Currently, only sequences used in - parameter default expressions are tracked. A sequence is only included if - that sequence is owned by a currently enabled role. + The view routine_sequence_usage identifies all sequences + that are used by a function or procedure, either in the SQL body or in + parameter default expressions. (This only works for unquoted SQL bodies, + not quoted bodies or functions in other languages.) A sequence is only + included if that sequence is owned by a currently enabled role.
    diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/legal.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/legal.sgml index b4773b6..d6c77f3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/legal.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/legal.sgml @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -2023 +2024 - 1996–2023 + 1996–2024 The PostgreSQL Global Development Group @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ Legal Notice - PostgreSQL is Copyright © 1996–2023 + PostgreSQL is Copyright © 1996–2024 by the PostgreSQL Global Development Group. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml index 76afcff..8b51d9e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml @@ -4934,11 +4934,12 @@ int PQsetnonblocking(PGconn *conn, int arg); - In the nonblocking state, calls to + In the nonblocking state, successful calls to , , , , - and will not block but instead return - an error if they need to be called again. + and will not block; their changes + are stored in the local output buffer until they are flushed. + Unsuccessful calls will return an error and must be retried. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml index bc3f5ec..4abfb32 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/logical-replication.sgml @@ -1451,7 +1451,8 @@ CONTEXT: processing remote data for replication origin "pg_16395" during "INSER implemented by walsender and apply processes. The walsender process starts logical decoding (described in ) of the WAL and loads the standard - logical decoding plugin (pgoutput). The plugin transforms the changes read + logical decoding output plugin (pgoutput). The plugin + transforms the changes read from WAL to the logical replication protocol (see ) and filters the data according to the publication specification. The data is then continuously diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/clusterdb.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/clusterdb.1 index 66359f7..42f048f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/clusterdb.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/clusterdb.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: clusterdb .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CLUSTERDB" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CLUSTERDB" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/createdb.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/createdb.1 index 6fff086..2bbed97 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/createdb.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/createdb.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: createdb .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATEDB" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATEDB" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/createuser.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/createuser.1 index 810d558..2e519eb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/createuser.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/createuser.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: createuser .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATEUSER" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATEUSER" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropdb.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropdb.1 index bedf988..0f2fa83 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropdb.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropdb.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dropdb .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROPDB" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROPDB" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropuser.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropuser.1 index 5ba7454..1e082dc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropuser.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/dropuser.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dropuser .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROPUSER" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROPUSER" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/ecpg.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/ecpg.1 index bbebfd4..777f7cc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/ecpg.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/ecpg.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ecpg .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ECPG" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ECPG" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/initdb.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/initdb.1 index 4a486bf..d99af72 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/initdb.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/initdb.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: initdb .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "INITDB" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "INITDB" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/oid2name.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/oid2name.1 index a78adcc..c558791 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/oid2name.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/oid2name.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: oid2name .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "OID2NAME" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "OID2NAME" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_amcheck.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_amcheck.1 index b67c8a6..273586b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_amcheck.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_amcheck.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_amcheck .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_AMCHECK" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_AMCHECK" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_archivecleanup.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_archivecleanup.1 index 5aac780..140bb5c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_archivecleanup.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_archivecleanup.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_archivecleanup .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_ARCHIVECLEANUP" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_ARCHIVECLEANUP" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_basebackup.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_basebackup.1 index 9cad974..230c82a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_basebackup.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_basebackup.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_basebackup .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_BASEBACKUP" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_BASEBACKUP" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_checksums.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_checksums.1 index a20ca34..34f3acc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_checksums.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_checksums.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_checksums .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_CHECKSUMS" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_CHECKSUMS" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_config.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_config.1 index 6d82d1d..9bc154a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_config.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_config.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_config .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_CONFIG" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_CONFIG" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_controldata.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_controldata.1 index 811d9ac..c5656a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_controldata.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_controldata.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_controldata .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_CONTROLDATA" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_CONTROLDATA" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_ctl.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_ctl.1 index 18d8446..8473a50 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_ctl.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_ctl.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_ctl .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_CTL" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_CTL" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dump.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dump.1 index 29bdbbf..a575f75 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dump.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dump.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_dump .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_DUMP" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_DUMP" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dumpall.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dumpall.1 index 45e6fc3..d3fa8c2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dumpall.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_dumpall.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_dumpall .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_DUMPALL" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_DUMPALL" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_isready.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_isready.1 index f3c351f..b5e845e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_isready.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_isready.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_isready .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_ISREADY" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_ISREADY" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_receivewal.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_receivewal.1 index 97b19b9..747181f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_receivewal.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_receivewal.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_receivewal .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_RECEIVEWAL" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_RECEIVEWAL" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_recvlogical.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_recvlogical.1 index 83896e0..6c7aed6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_recvlogical.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_recvlogical.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_recvlogical .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_RECVLOGICAL" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_RECVLOGICAL" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_resetwal.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_resetwal.1 index 74f6b2f..66ee019 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_resetwal.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_resetwal.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_resetwal .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_RESETWAL" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_RESETWAL" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_restore.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_restore.1 index b344310..d404719 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_restore.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_restore.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_restore .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_RESTORE" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_RESTORE" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_rewind.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_rewind.1 index 48c2f7e..a039353 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_rewind.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_rewind.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_rewind .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_REWIND" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_REWIND" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_fsync.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_fsync.1 index aa14979..89d43bf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_fsync.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_fsync.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_test_fsync .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_TEST_FSYNC" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_TEST_FSYNC" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_timing.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_timing.1 index 58f7d8b..d1ae2db 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_timing.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_test_timing.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_test_timing .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_TEST_TIMING" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_TEST_TIMING" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_upgrade.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_upgrade.1 index 53f80de..d8e426b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_upgrade.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_upgrade.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_upgrade .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_UPGRADE" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_UPGRADE" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_verifybackup.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_verifybackup.1 index 38ec5c8..97b15c2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_verifybackup.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_verifybackup.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_verifybackup .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_VERIFYBACKUP" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_VERIFYBACKUP" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_waldump.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_waldump.1 index b89f74b..fd0e3d5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_waldump.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pg_waldump.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pg_waldump .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PG_WALDUMP" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PG_WALDUMP" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pgbench.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pgbench.1 index 9aaa5e8..152b2d7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/pgbench.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/pgbench.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: pgbench .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PGBENCH" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PGBENCH" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/postgres.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/postgres.1 index 1be2df0..06cf212 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/postgres.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/postgres.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: postgres .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "POSTGRES" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "POSTGRES" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/postmaster.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/postmaster.1 index 1c0a77a..c80662a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/postmaster.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/postmaster.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: postmaster .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "POSTMASTER" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "POSTMASTER" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/psql.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/psql.1 index 37025d6..21890e0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/psql.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/psql.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: psql .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PSQL" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PSQL" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -650,7 +650,7 @@ is currently connected, followed by the string .\} .nf $ \fBpsql testdb\fR -psql (15\&.5) +psql (15\&.6) Type "help" for help\&. testdb=> @@ -4157,7 +4157,7 @@ PostgreSQL major or minor release identifier to the file name, for example ~/\&.psqlrc\-15 or -~/\&.psqlrc\-15\&.5\&. The most specific version\-matching file will be read in preference to a non\-version\-specific file\&. These version suffixes are added after determining the file path as explained above\&. +~/\&.psqlrc\-15\&.6\&. The most specific version\-matching file will be read in preference to a non\-version\-specific file\&. These version suffixes are added after determining the file path as explained above\&. .RE .PP \&.psql_history diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/reindexdb.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/reindexdb.1 index 0bb2322..4518f6b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/reindexdb.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/reindexdb.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: reindexdb .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "REINDEXDB" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "REINDEXDB" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumdb.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumdb.1 index 179e79b..ad49522 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumdb.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumdb.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: vacuumdb .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "VACUUMDB" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "VACUUMDB" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumlo.1 b/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumlo.1 index e061f6a..be320b6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumlo.1 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man1/vacuumlo.1 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: vacuumlo .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "VACUUMLO" "1" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "VACUUMLO" "1" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_commit.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_commit.3 index f99d516..7e861ba 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_commit.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_commit.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_commit .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_COMMIT" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_COMMIT" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_connect.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_connect.3 index 6fa03d1..151bfde 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_connect.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_connect.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_connect .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CONNECT" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CONNECT" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_copytuple.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_copytuple.3 index c764804..3c598c6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_copytuple.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_copytuple.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_copytuple .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_COPYTUPLE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_COPYTUPLE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_close.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_close.3 index 6b13081..df1c513 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_close.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_close.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_close .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_CLOSE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_CLOSE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_fetch.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_fetch.3 index ce26633..99dafbf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_fetch.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_fetch.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_fetch .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_FETCH" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_FETCH" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_find.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_find.3 index e55bd6a..42503f7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_find.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_find.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_find .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_FIND" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_FIND" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_move.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_move.3 index 899fe2d..f3b1339 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_move.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_move.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_move .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_MOVE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_MOVE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open.3 index 072da84..43ff2da 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_open .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_OPEN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_OPEN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_args.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_args.3 index 5a87cab..5b149b4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_args.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_args.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_open_with_args .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_OPEN_WITH_ARGS" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_OPEN_WITH_ARGS" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist.3 index 3f8491d..d99a553 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_open_with_paramlist .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_OPEN_WITH_PARAMLIST" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_OPEN_WITH_PARAMLIST" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_parse_open.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_parse_open.3 index 086a535..d564b7b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_parse_open.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_cursor_parse_open.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_cursor_parse_open .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_CURSOR_PARSE_OPEN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_CURSOR_PARSE_OPEN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_exec.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_exec.3 index 98240a8..12a0570 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_exec.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_exec.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_exec .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXEC" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXEC" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execp.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execp.3 index 0d390ce..40379ae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execp.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execp.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_execp .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXECP" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXECP" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute.3 index 80efbcd..b89bc37 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_execute .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXECUTE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXECUTE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_extended.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_extended.3 index e985f57..e174c46 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_extended.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_extended.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_execute_extended .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_EXTENDED" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_EXTENDED" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan.3 index e248c31..1172a38 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_execute_plan .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_PLAN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_PLAN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_extended.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_extended.3 index 7eab384..0021032 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_extended.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_extended.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_execute_plan_extended .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_PLAN_EXTENDED" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_PLAN_EXTENDED" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist.3 index a0e0f64..e4b17a9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_execute_plan_with_paramlist .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_PLAN_WITH_PARAMLIST" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_PLAN_WITH_PARAMLIST" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_with_args.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_with_args.3 index e02aa55..20f4ce3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_with_args.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_execute_with_args.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_execute_with_args .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_WITH_ARGS" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_EXECUTE_WITH_ARGS" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_finish.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_finish.3 index 92e1d72..1f117b6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_finish.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_finish.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_finish .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_FINISH" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_FINISH" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fname.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fname.3 index 035b78e..b23ff23 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fname.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fname.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_fname .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_FNAME" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_FNAME" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fnumber.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fnumber.3 index 0bf9260..8882486 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fnumber.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_fnumber.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_fnumber .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_FNUMBER" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_FNUMBER" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freeplan.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freeplan.3 index e3e12aa..42d1c69 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freeplan.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freeplan.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_freeplan .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_FREEPLAN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_FREEPLAN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuple.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuple.3 index 6db0ee5..a03bd9c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuple.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuple.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_freetuple .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_FREETUPLE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_FREETUPLE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuptable.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuptable.3 index 0faa366..2e7f2c8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuptable.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_freetuptable.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_freetuptable .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_FREETUPTABLE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_FREETUPTABLE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargcount.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargcount.3 index bcb91d6..076bdf9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargcount.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargcount.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_getargcount .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETARGCOUNT" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETARGCOUNT" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargtypeid.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargtypeid.3 index 65069ff..6ade9cd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargtypeid.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getargtypeid.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_getargtypeid .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETARGTYPEID" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETARGTYPEID" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getbinval.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getbinval.3 index 9d5fc88..a49e252 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getbinval.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getbinval.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_getbinval .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETBINVAL" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETBINVAL" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getnspname.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getnspname.3 index 24e8170..cf12dd2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getnspname.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getnspname.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_getnspname .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETNSPNAME" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETNSPNAME" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getrelname.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getrelname.3 index ae53a5a..d5f464e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getrelname.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getrelname.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_getrelname .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETRELNAME" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETRELNAME" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettype.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettype.3 index 1a0f498..65df710 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettype.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettype.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_gettype .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETTYPE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETTYPE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettypeid.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettypeid.3 index 7df7b65..8e0ec89 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettypeid.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_gettypeid.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_gettypeid .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETTYPEID" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETTYPEID" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getvalue.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getvalue.3 index 375bc31..14c6024 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getvalue.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_getvalue.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_getvalue .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_GETVALUE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_GETVALUE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_is_cursor_plan.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_is_cursor_plan.3 index ee56992..ad61b36 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_is_cursor_plan.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_is_cursor_plan.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_is_cursor_plan .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_IS_CURSOR_PLAN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_IS_CURSOR_PLAN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_keepplan.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_keepplan.3 index 37c1205..6d2692a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_keepplan.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_keepplan.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_keepplan .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_KEEPPLAN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_KEEPPLAN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_modifytuple.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_modifytuple.3 index 563205b..1a5dc70 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_modifytuple.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_modifytuple.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_modifytuple .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_MODIFYTUPLE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_MODIFYTUPLE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_palloc.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_palloc.3 index f2ffd15..db335a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_palloc.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_palloc.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_palloc .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_PALLOC" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_PALLOC" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_pfree.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_pfree.3 index 21d748c..731c5f4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_pfree.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_pfree.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_pfree .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_PFREE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_PFREE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare.3 index 315ec75..830f666 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_prepare .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_PREPARE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_PREPARE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_cursor.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_cursor.3 index eeb35d4..ea1d510 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_cursor.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_cursor.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_prepare_cursor .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_PREPARE_CURSOR" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_PREPARE_CURSOR" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_extended.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_extended.3 index 9098a25..ef4ff13 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_extended.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_extended.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_prepare_extended .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_PREPARE_EXTENDED" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_PREPARE_EXTENDED" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_params.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_params.3 index 4500736..b859775 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_params.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_prepare_params.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_prepare_params .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_PREPARE_PARAMS" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_PREPARE_PARAMS" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_relation.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_relation.3 index 9ff9693..b2928f0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_relation.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_relation.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_register_relation .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_REGISTER_RELATION" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_REGISTER_RELATION" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_trigger_data.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_trigger_data.3 index 99f5b36..fcb91a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_trigger_data.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_register_trigger_data.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_register_trigger_data .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_REGISTER_TRIGGER_DATA" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_REGISTER_TRIGGER_DATA" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_repalloc.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_repalloc.3 index 0a5558b..36356fd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_repalloc.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_repalloc.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_repalloc .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_REPALLOC" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_REPALLOC" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_result_code_string.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_result_code_string.3 index fa76942..4780846 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_result_code_string.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_result_code_string.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_result_code_string .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_RESULT_CODE_STRING" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_RESULT_CODE_STRING" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_returntuple.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_returntuple.3 index 7d82491..945f923 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_returntuple.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_returntuple.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_returntuple .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_RETURNTUPLE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_RETURNTUPLE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_rollback.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_rollback.3 index 487e849..c2a6ee4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_rollback.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_rollback.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_rollback .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_ROLLBACK" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_ROLLBACK" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_saveplan.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_saveplan.3 index ea0df78..9fdfe8a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_saveplan.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_saveplan.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_saveplan .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_SAVEPLAN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_SAVEPLAN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch.3 index a303413..5c1e90e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_scroll_cursor_fetch .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_SCROLL_CURSOR_FETCH" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_SCROLL_CURSOR_FETCH" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_move.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_move.3 index 786822e..0906726 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_move.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_scroll_cursor_move.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_scroll_cursor_move .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_SCROLL_CURSOR_MOVE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_SCROLL_CURSOR_MOVE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_start_transaction.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_start_transaction.3 index c4319fd..193425b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_start_transaction.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_start_transaction.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_start_transaction .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_START_TRANSACTION" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_START_TRANSACTION" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_unregister_relation.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_unregister_relation.3 index 5ff5d20..7e4787c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_unregister_relation.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/SPI_unregister_relation.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SPI_unregister_relation .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SPI_UNREGISTER_RELATION" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SPI_UNREGISTER_RELATION" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink.3 index fb2463d..cecfa77 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_delete.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_delete.3 index 0c813f5..0e8e3b2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_delete.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_delete.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_build_sql_delete .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_BUILD_SQL_DELETE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_BUILD_SQL_DELETE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_insert.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_insert.3 index c01dcf8..fe59c8e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_insert.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_insert.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_build_sql_insert .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_BUILD_SQL_INSERT" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_BUILD_SQL_INSERT" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_update.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_update.3 index 2de7967..4245753 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_update.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_build_sql_update.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_build_sql_update .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_BUILD_SQL_UPDATE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_BUILD_SQL_UPDATE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_cancel_query.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_cancel_query.3 index 2ae393c..268d70e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_cancel_query.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_cancel_query.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_cancel_query .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_CANCEL_QUERY" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_CANCEL_QUERY" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_close.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_close.3 index 20e1cfd..9c4da13 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_close.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_close.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_close .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_CLOSE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_CLOSE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect.3 index 9e07450..d25f840 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_connect .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_CONNECT" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_CONNECT" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect_u.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect_u.3 index df1a9a7..decb4a2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect_u.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_connect_u.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_connect_u .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_CONNECT_U" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_CONNECT_U" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_disconnect.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_disconnect.3 index 55a77c6..9bad6b7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_disconnect.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_disconnect.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_disconnect .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_DISCONNECT" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_DISCONNECT" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_error_message.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_error_message.3 index cefdcd2..fb3fae9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_error_message.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_error_message.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_error_message .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_ERROR_MESSAGE" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_ERROR_MESSAGE" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_exec.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_exec.3 index 4af3189..5ea01dc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_exec.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_exec.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_exec .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_EXEC" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_EXEC" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_fetch.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_fetch.3 index d126722..35adb39 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_fetch.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_fetch.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_fetch .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_FETCH" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_FETCH" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_connections.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_connections.3 index d671ec8..e6c8996 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_connections.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_connections.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_get_connections .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_GET_CONNECTIONS" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_GET_CONNECTIONS" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_notify.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_notify.3 index 1195b90..5950ac4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_notify.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_notify.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_get_notify .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_GET_NOTIFY" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_GET_NOTIFY" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_pkey.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_pkey.3 index 7906a73..bf9b21d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_pkey.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_pkey.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_get_pkey .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_GET_PKEY" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_GET_PKEY" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_result.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_result.3 index 951a233..a34d97a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_result.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_get_result.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_get_result .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_GET_RESULT" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_GET_RESULT" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_is_busy.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_is_busy.3 index 86bc3d9..6da0f67 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_is_busy.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_is_busy.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_is_busy .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_IS_BUSY" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_IS_BUSY" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_open.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_open.3 index 8efb63f..2e9cf86 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_open.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_open.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_open .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_OPEN" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_OPEN" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_send_query.3 b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_send_query.3 index c8d7e59..4243bae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_send_query.3 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man3/dblink_send_query.3 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: dblink_send_query .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DBLINK_SEND_QUERY" "3" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DBLINK_SEND_QUERY" "3" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ABORT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ABORT.7 index 02b4299..fc2bdde 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ABORT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ABORT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ABORT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ABORT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ABORT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_AGGREGATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_AGGREGATE.7 index 377bbc1..60867f9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_AGGREGATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_AGGREGATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER AGGREGATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER AGGREGATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER AGGREGATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_COLLATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_COLLATION.7 index 131fd69..acb20d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_COLLATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_COLLATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER COLLATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER COLLATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER COLLATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_CONVERSION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_CONVERSION.7 index 630bc25..5e3f816 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_CONVERSION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_CONVERSION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER CONVERSION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER CONVERSION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER CONVERSION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DATABASE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DATABASE.7 index c9e2f76..c11d792 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DATABASE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DATABASE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER DATABASE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER DATABASE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER DATABASE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DEFAULT_PRIVILEGES.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DEFAULT_PRIVILEGES.7 index 7a09b50..3a8f7b1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DEFAULT_PRIVILEGES.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DEFAULT_PRIVILEGES.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER DEFAULT PRIVILEGES" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DOMAIN.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DOMAIN.7 index 9e62624..b295cfc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DOMAIN.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_DOMAIN.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER DOMAIN .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER DOMAIN" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER DOMAIN" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 index d06dcd7..62a6a43 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER EVENT TRIGGER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER EVENT TRIGGER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER EVENT TRIGGER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ The user name of the new owner of the event trigger\&. The new name of the event trigger\&. .RE .PP -DISABLE/ENABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ] TRIGGER +DISABLE/ENABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ] .RS 4 These forms configure the firing of event triggers\&. A disabled trigger is still known to the system, but is not executed when its triggering event occurs\&. See also session_replication_role\&. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EXTENSION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EXTENSION.7 index 9c12bc1..f8519b8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EXTENSION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_EXTENSION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER EXTENSION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER EXTENSION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER EXTENSION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 index 4a4728c..8de0f48 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -111,7 +111,7 @@ bar: .RS 4 .\} .nf -ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi OPTIONS (ADD foo \*(Aq1\*(Aq, DROP \*(Aqbar\*(Aq); +ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi OPTIONS (ADD foo \*(Aq1\*(Aq, DROP bar); .fi .if n \{\ .RE diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 index 49c2a9c..42fe590 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER FOREIGN TABLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER FOREIGN TABLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER FOREIGN TABLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FUNCTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FUNCTION.7 index d26b1fc..49eb0eb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FUNCTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_FUNCTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER FUNCTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER FUNCTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER FUNCTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_GROUP.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_GROUP.7 index 6ec91e5..2a350b6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_GROUP.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_GROUP.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER GROUP .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER GROUP" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER GROUP" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_INDEX.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_INDEX.7 index 79b3923..8453ee9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_INDEX.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_INDEX.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER INDEX .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER INDEX" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER INDEX" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LANGUAGE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LANGUAGE.7 index 92d7254..de592e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LANGUAGE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LANGUAGE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER LANGUAGE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER LANGUAGE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER LANGUAGE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LARGE_OBJECT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LARGE_OBJECT.7 index 9b8895f..cfc9b68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LARGE_OBJECT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_LARGE_OBJECT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER LARGE OBJECT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER LARGE OBJECT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER LARGE OBJECT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 index 7ed5e03..903d530 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR.7 index dc80e14..59e4edf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER OPERATOR .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER OPERATOR" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER OPERATOR" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 index b445edf..66f1bfc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER OPERATOR CLASS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER OPERATOR CLASS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER OPERATOR CLASS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 index 20713dc..bd74f86 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER OPERATOR FAMILY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_POLICY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_POLICY.7 index 4c18353..4570776 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_POLICY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_POLICY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER POLICY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER POLICY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER POLICY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PROCEDURE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PROCEDURE.7 index a78dde7..420449d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PROCEDURE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PROCEDURE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER PROCEDURE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER PROCEDURE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER PROCEDURE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PUBLICATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PUBLICATION.7 index 30f6ff8..7af932b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PUBLICATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_PUBLICATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER PUBLICATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER PUBLICATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER PUBLICATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROLE.7 index 3183de0..e2be499 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER ROLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER ROLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER ROLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROUTINE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROUTINE.7 index ba5ff03..7ece7ae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROUTINE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_ROUTINE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER ROUTINE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER ROUTINE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER ROUTINE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_RULE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_RULE.7 index 9f3d4e2..75064e9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_RULE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_RULE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER RULE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER RULE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER RULE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SCHEMA.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SCHEMA.7 index c19a474..1b01d6d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SCHEMA.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SCHEMA.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER SCHEMA .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER SCHEMA" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER SCHEMA" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SEQUENCE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SEQUENCE.7 index eb474c5..60cde7e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SEQUENCE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SEQUENCE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER SEQUENCE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER SEQUENCE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER SEQUENCE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SERVER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SERVER.7 index c087300..b753003 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SERVER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SERVER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER SERVER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER SERVER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER SERVER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_STATISTICS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_STATISTICS.7 index c88a7f5..0beac30 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_STATISTICS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_STATISTICS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER STATISTICS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER STATISTICS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER STATISTICS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SUBSCRIPTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SUBSCRIPTION.7 index 933f047..d6efae9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SUBSCRIPTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SUBSCRIPTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER SUBSCRIPTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER SUBSCRIPTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER SUBSCRIPTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SYSTEM.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SYSTEM.7 index ffc0c15..ab8594f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SYSTEM.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_SYSTEM.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER SYSTEM .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER SYSTEM" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER SYSTEM" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLE.7 index 2893cfc..4fa5c34 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TABLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TABLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TABLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLESPACE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLESPACE.7 index 7cc6fff..097ee57 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLESPACE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TABLESPACE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TABLESPACE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TABLESPACE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TABLESPACE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 index 0a5b189..ed2556d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 index 2183e7f..7f7e2b3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 index b1b365a..4346665 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH PARSER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 index 819cafc..6f754b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TRIGGER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TRIGGER.7 index 1e9840d..c6aa9c3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TRIGGER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TRIGGER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TRIGGER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TRIGGER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TRIGGER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TYPE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TYPE.7 index 58becdb..627bbb8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TYPE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_TYPE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER TYPE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER TYPE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER TYPE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER.7 index c2b6f04..f717905 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER USER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER USER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER USER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER_MAPPING.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER_MAPPING.7 index 9b13af8..d7324a9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER_MAPPING.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_USER_MAPPING.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER USER MAPPING .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER USER MAPPING" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER USER MAPPING" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_VIEW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_VIEW.7 index a5d58c1..925837e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_VIEW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ALTER_VIEW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ALTER VIEW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ALTER VIEW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ALTER VIEW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ANALYZE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ANALYZE.7 index f920228..a058ee5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ANALYZE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ANALYZE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ANALYZE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ANALYZE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ANALYZE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/BEGIN.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/BEGIN.7 index 2260340..60dd3e1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/BEGIN.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/BEGIN.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: BEGIN .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "BEGIN" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "BEGIN" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CALL.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CALL.7 index 63758cb..2267072 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CALL.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CALL.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CALL .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CALL" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CALL" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CHECKPOINT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CHECKPOINT.7 index 5065896..730447d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CHECKPOINT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CHECKPOINT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CHECKPOINT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CHECKPOINT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CHECKPOINT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLOSE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLOSE.7 index ca25c83..b1ab3d9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLOSE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLOSE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CLOSE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CLOSE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CLOSE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLUSTER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLUSTER.7 index 6453a8e..dc2c96e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLUSTER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CLUSTER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CLUSTER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CLUSTER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CLUSTER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMENT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMENT.7 index 293d0e9..4fe65c4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMENT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMENT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: COMMENT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "COMMENT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "COMMENT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT.7 index 9ef60c8..3db23d8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: COMMIT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "COMMIT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "COMMIT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT_PREPARED.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT_PREPARED.7 index affc11c..513c66b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT_PREPARED.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COMMIT_PREPARED.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: COMMIT PREPARED .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "COMMIT PREPARED" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "COMMIT PREPARED" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COPY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COPY.7 index 127bcbb..3daaa71 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/COPY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/COPY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: COPY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "COPY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "COPY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -130,7 +130,9 @@ For \fBUPDATE\fR and \fBDELETE\fR -queries a RETURNING clause must be provided, and the target relation must not have a conditional rule, nor an +queries a +RETURNING +clause must be provided, and the target relation must not have a conditional rule, nor an ALSO rule, nor an INSTEAD diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ACCESS_METHOD.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ACCESS_METHOD.7 index 92ee214..126ecc0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ACCESS_METHOD.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ACCESS_METHOD.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE ACCESS METHOD .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE ACCESS METHOD" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE ACCESS METHOD" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_AGGREGATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_AGGREGATE.7 index 3c158fc..5dae64c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_AGGREGATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_AGGREGATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE AGGREGATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE AGGREGATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE AGGREGATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CAST.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CAST.7 index 0b56d65..699f446 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CAST.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CAST.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE CAST .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE CAST" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE CAST" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_COLLATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_COLLATION.7 index 8d518ba..e7d5d20 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_COLLATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_COLLATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE COLLATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE COLLATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE COLLATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CONVERSION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CONVERSION.7 index 834af46..d634b11 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CONVERSION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_CONVERSION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE CONVERSION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE CONVERSION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE CONVERSION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DATABASE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DATABASE.7 index c1cb4e9..b5ecf76 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DATABASE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DATABASE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE DATABASE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE DATABASE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE DATABASE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DOMAIN.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DOMAIN.7 index d336701..b315f33 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DOMAIN.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_DOMAIN.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE DOMAIN .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE DOMAIN" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE DOMAIN" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 index e1ea71e..30c07cd 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE EVENT TRIGGER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE EVENT TRIGGER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE EVENT TRIGGER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EXTENSION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EXTENSION.7 index b3daa80..83c2cde 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EXTENSION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_EXTENSION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE EXTENSION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE EXTENSION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE EXTENSION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 index f3b3711..8022c36 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 index 7720a23..d7eaec2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE FOREIGN TABLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE FOREIGN TABLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE FOREIGN TABLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FUNCTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FUNCTION.7 index 0cb288a..84a56de 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FUNCTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_FUNCTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE FUNCTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE FUNCTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE FUNCTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_GROUP.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_GROUP.7 index ed6670f..a9473a3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_GROUP.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_GROUP.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE GROUP .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE GROUP" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE GROUP" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_INDEX.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_INDEX.7 index 3bbfaae..796d10c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_INDEX.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_INDEX.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE INDEX .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE INDEX" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE INDEX" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_LANGUAGE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_LANGUAGE.7 index ac45c43..8a8cea7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_LANGUAGE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_LANGUAGE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE LANGUAGE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE LANGUAGE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE LANGUAGE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 index 2ac8bb9..497df42 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR.7 index 235f688..eb75451 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE OPERATOR .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE OPERATOR" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE OPERATOR" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 index d0b9b3d..4c83f41 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE OPERATOR CLASS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE OPERATOR CLASS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE OPERATOR CLASS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 index af6e5f7..0c4fe2f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE OPERATOR FAMILY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_POLICY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_POLICY.7 index af93bbf..c293250 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_POLICY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_POLICY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE POLICY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE POLICY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE POLICY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PROCEDURE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PROCEDURE.7 index 7576d6a..fccf739 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PROCEDURE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PROCEDURE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE PROCEDURE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE PROCEDURE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE PROCEDURE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PUBLICATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PUBLICATION.7 index 75a0c83..950195a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PUBLICATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_PUBLICATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE PUBLICATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE PUBLICATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE PUBLICATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ROLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ROLE.7 index a3ae35e..49ba65e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ROLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_ROLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE ROLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE ROLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE ROLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_RULE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_RULE.7 index a7b6d42..1233029 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_RULE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_RULE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE RULE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE RULE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE RULE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SCHEMA.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SCHEMA.7 index 545f33e..4a09dc8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SCHEMA.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SCHEMA.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE SCHEMA .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE SCHEMA" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE SCHEMA" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SEQUENCE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SEQUENCE.7 index 2f1ee35..06e69fb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SEQUENCE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SEQUENCE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE SEQUENCE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE SEQUENCE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE SEQUENCE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SERVER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SERVER.7 index a28fbcb..8683add 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SERVER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SERVER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE SERVER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE SERVER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE SERVER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_STATISTICS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_STATISTICS.7 index e54c236..cfa9faf 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_STATISTICS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_STATISTICS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE STATISTICS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE STATISTICS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE STATISTICS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SUBSCRIPTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SUBSCRIPTION.7 index da24c31..51568a7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SUBSCRIPTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_SUBSCRIPTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE SUBSCRIPTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE SUBSCRIPTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE SUBSCRIPTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE.7 index 02af742..13d806e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TABLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TABLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TABLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -747,7 +747,9 @@ These clauses specify a foreign key constraint, which requires that a group of o \fIrefcolumn\fR list is omitted, the primary key of the \fIreftable\fR -is used\&. The referenced columns must be the columns of a non\-deferrable unique or primary key constraint in the referenced table\&. The user must have +is used\&. Otherwise, the +\fIrefcolumn\fR +list must refer to the columns of a non\-deferrable unique or primary key constraint or be the columns of a non\-partial unique index\&. The user must have REFERENCES permission on the referenced table (either the whole table, or the specific referenced columns)\&. The addition of a foreign key constraint requires a SHARE ROW EXCLUSIVE @@ -1673,15 +1675,19 @@ EXCLUDE constraint type is a PostgreSQL extension\&. -.SS "Foreign\-Key Constraint Actions" +.SS "Foreign Key Constraints" .PP -The ability to specify column lists in the foreign\-key actions +The ability to specify column lists in the foreign key actions SET DEFAULT and SET NULL is a PostgreSQL extension\&. +.PP +It is a +PostgreSQL +extension that a foreign key constraint may reference columns of a unique index instead of columns of a primary key or unique constraint\&. .SS "NULL \(lqConstraint\(rq" .PP The diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLESPACE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLESPACE.7 index cc9b4c0..302fce9 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLESPACE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLESPACE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TABLESPACE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TABLESPACE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TABLESPACE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE_AS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE_AS.7 index f808702..4eb787e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE_AS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TABLE_AS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TABLE AS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TABLE AS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TABLE AS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 index 78acd16..53b8926 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 index dc46c35..159872a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 index e0c003c..c908d16 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH PARSER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 index 7ae21ac..9ea5789 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRANSFORM.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRANSFORM.7 index 6358065..8120eaa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRANSFORM.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRANSFORM.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TRANSFORM .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TRANSFORM" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TRANSFORM" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRIGGER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRIGGER.7 index 6328eab..1e749b2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRIGGER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TRIGGER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TRIGGER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TRIGGER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TRIGGER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TYPE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TYPE.7 index 318c4ce..c409ae0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TYPE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_TYPE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE TYPE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE TYPE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE TYPE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER.7 index 04dc528..98e8e5f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE USER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE USER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE USER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER_MAPPING.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER_MAPPING.7 index c9f0ee2..6f852b1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER_MAPPING.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_USER_MAPPING.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE USER MAPPING .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE USER MAPPING" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE USER MAPPING" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_VIEW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_VIEW.7 index b40752e..9fa2f5b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_VIEW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/CREATE_VIEW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: CREATE VIEW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "CREATE VIEW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "CREATE VIEW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DEALLOCATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DEALLOCATE.7 index b383c31..3f58051 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DEALLOCATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DEALLOCATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DEALLOCATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DEALLOCATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DEALLOCATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DECLARE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DECLARE.7 index f5b13f9..6251279 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DECLARE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DECLARE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DECLARE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DECLARE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DECLARE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DELETE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DELETE.7 index 93676b8..5e13176 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DELETE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DELETE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DELETE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DELETE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DELETE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DISCARD.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DISCARD.7 index 1a80482..ee0919c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DISCARD.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DISCARD.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DISCARD .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DISCARD" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DISCARD" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DO.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DO.7 index 0bd4e2b..e7afd38 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DO.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DO.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DO .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DO" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DO" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ACCESS_METHOD.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ACCESS_METHOD.7 index 631a6ad..c051f66 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ACCESS_METHOD.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ACCESS_METHOD.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP ACCESS METHOD .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP ACCESS METHOD" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP ACCESS METHOD" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_AGGREGATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_AGGREGATE.7 index a3f8834..af7a945 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_AGGREGATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_AGGREGATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP AGGREGATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP AGGREGATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP AGGREGATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CAST.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CAST.7 index 7a7985d..ae29c79 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CAST.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CAST.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP CAST .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP CAST" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP CAST" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_COLLATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_COLLATION.7 index a6cf672..0833c5a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_COLLATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_COLLATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP COLLATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP COLLATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP COLLATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CONVERSION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CONVERSION.7 index 5f5006e..adcc955 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CONVERSION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_CONVERSION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP CONVERSION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP CONVERSION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP CONVERSION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DATABASE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DATABASE.7 index 87c805f..1683633 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DATABASE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DATABASE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP DATABASE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP DATABASE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP DATABASE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DOMAIN.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DOMAIN.7 index b2b0e14..29859d4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DOMAIN.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_DOMAIN.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP DOMAIN .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP DOMAIN" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP DOMAIN" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 index f9a6e1a..0f1ac0c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EVENT_TRIGGER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP EVENT TRIGGER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP EVENT TRIGGER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP EVENT TRIGGER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EXTENSION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EXTENSION.7 index 1921d74..ec96b68 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EXTENSION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_EXTENSION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP EXTENSION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP EXTENSION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP EXTENSION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 index 8bc2daf..63cfd80 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_DATA_WRAPPER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 index 80aba65..3a7140e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FOREIGN_TABLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP FOREIGN TABLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP FOREIGN TABLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP FOREIGN TABLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FUNCTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FUNCTION.7 index f026467..8da7370 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FUNCTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_FUNCTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP FUNCTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP FUNCTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP FUNCTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_GROUP.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_GROUP.7 index 9e29135..b556164 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_GROUP.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_GROUP.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP GROUP .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP GROUP" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP GROUP" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_INDEX.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_INDEX.7 index 2dec64a..b961c19 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_INDEX.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_INDEX.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP INDEX .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP INDEX" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP INDEX" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_LANGUAGE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_LANGUAGE.7 index 26f517e..d080f25 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_LANGUAGE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_LANGUAGE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP LANGUAGE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP LANGUAGE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP LANGUAGE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 index ef5b608..226d40d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR.7 index 6f7edc9..b2cc599 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP OPERATOR .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP OPERATOR" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP OPERATOR" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 index 7afcf2e..4315c5d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_CLASS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP OPERATOR CLASS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP OPERATOR CLASS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP OPERATOR CLASS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 index bb8c86e..29421ad 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OPERATOR_FAMILY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP OPERATOR FAMILY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP OPERATOR FAMILY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP OPERATOR FAMILY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OWNED.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OWNED.7 index 3fd2106..c53ae94 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OWNED.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_OWNED.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP OWNED .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP OWNED" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP OWNED" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_POLICY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_POLICY.7 index f5a9c56..57035aa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_POLICY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_POLICY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP POLICY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP POLICY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP POLICY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PROCEDURE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PROCEDURE.7 index 7be733e..2993449 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PROCEDURE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PROCEDURE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP PROCEDURE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP PROCEDURE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP PROCEDURE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PUBLICATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PUBLICATION.7 index 5cc2fe5..69505b3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PUBLICATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_PUBLICATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP PUBLICATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP PUBLICATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP PUBLICATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROLE.7 index f64c121..f0451f5 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP ROLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP ROLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP ROLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROUTINE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROUTINE.7 index 43acbac..25e7cb1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROUTINE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_ROUTINE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP ROUTINE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP ROUTINE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP ROUTINE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_RULE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_RULE.7 index 0f2a311..1ee014f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_RULE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_RULE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP RULE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP RULE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP RULE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SCHEMA.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SCHEMA.7 index d5d65fb..5c8d05e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SCHEMA.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SCHEMA.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP SCHEMA .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP SCHEMA" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP SCHEMA" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SEQUENCE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SEQUENCE.7 index 5993e60..6a6e5f1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SEQUENCE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SEQUENCE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP SEQUENCE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP SEQUENCE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP SEQUENCE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SERVER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SERVER.7 index 65412ee..ed2f5ae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SERVER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SERVER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP SERVER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP SERVER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP SERVER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_STATISTICS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_STATISTICS.7 index bc7675a..8c0935b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_STATISTICS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_STATISTICS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP STATISTICS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP STATISTICS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP STATISTICS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SUBSCRIPTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SUBSCRIPTION.7 index 1402b21..e872ffb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SUBSCRIPTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_SUBSCRIPTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP SUBSCRIPTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP SUBSCRIPTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP SUBSCRIPTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLE.7 index f282f33..737c52e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TABLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TABLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TABLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLESPACE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLESPACE.7 index 138c0fc..5cd4cf2 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLESPACE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TABLESPACE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TABLESPACE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TABLESPACE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TABLESPACE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 index 06b0eec..c3e906f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_CONFIGURATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH CONFIGURATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 index 92c7d74..39cf05d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_DICTIONARY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH DICTIONARY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 index 370a3aa..d9c899c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_PARSER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH PARSER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 index 400265b..555dfe3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TEXT_SEARCH_TEMPLATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TEXT SEARCH TEMPLATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRANSFORM.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRANSFORM.7 index d1cd290..77f09e4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRANSFORM.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRANSFORM.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TRANSFORM .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TRANSFORM" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TRANSFORM" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRIGGER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRIGGER.7 index 768d105..da7b4aa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRIGGER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TRIGGER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TRIGGER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TRIGGER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TRIGGER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TYPE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TYPE.7 index 94b140b..89b9e30 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TYPE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_TYPE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP TYPE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP TYPE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP TYPE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER.7 index 76656d1..c09f7bb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP USER .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP USER" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP USER" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER_MAPPING.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER_MAPPING.7 index 3777766..9f83780 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER_MAPPING.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_USER_MAPPING.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP USER MAPPING .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP USER MAPPING" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP USER MAPPING" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_VIEW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_VIEW.7 index 3875a18..a3a33d0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_VIEW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/DROP_VIEW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: DROP VIEW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "DROP VIEW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "DROP VIEW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/END.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/END.7 index 5ed3f9f..33bc79e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/END.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/END.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: END .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "END" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "END" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXECUTE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXECUTE.7 index 4ac1b6c..f44de16 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXECUTE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXECUTE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: EXECUTE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "EXECUTE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "EXECUTE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXPLAIN.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXPLAIN.7 index 36b134e..b5c5d8c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXPLAIN.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/EXPLAIN.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: EXPLAIN .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "EXPLAIN" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "EXPLAIN" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/FETCH.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/FETCH.7 index 6a0f85a..186c84e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/FETCH.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/FETCH.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: FETCH .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "FETCH" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "FETCH" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/GRANT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/GRANT.7 index 08fae60..d88a5aa 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/GRANT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/GRANT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: GRANT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "GRANT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "GRANT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/IMPORT_FOREIGN_SCHEMA.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/IMPORT_FOREIGN_SCHEMA.7 index aa9e50c..ba91d69 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/IMPORT_FOREIGN_SCHEMA.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/IMPORT_FOREIGN_SCHEMA.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "IMPORT FOREIGN SCHEMA" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/INSERT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/INSERT.7 index a88ba0f..583b296 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/INSERT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/INSERT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: INSERT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "INSERT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "INSERT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/LISTEN.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/LISTEN.7 index dd45c02..21c8738 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/LISTEN.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/LISTEN.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: LISTEN .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "LISTEN" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "LISTEN" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOAD.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOAD.7 index dc4b724..079dd2e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOAD.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOAD.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: LOAD .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "LOAD" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "LOAD" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOCK.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOCK.7 index c827a3f..54af0d6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOCK.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/LOCK.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: LOCK .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "LOCK" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "LOCK" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/MERGE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/MERGE.7 index f6abd55..65ff5c4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/MERGE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/MERGE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: MERGE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "MERGE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "MERGE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -120,19 +120,21 @@ SET clause\&. If you specify an insert action, you must have the INSERT privilege on the -\fItarget_table_name\fR\&. If you specify an delete action, you must have the +\fItarget_table_name\fR\&. If you specify a delete action, you must have the DELETE privilege on the \fItarget_table_name\fR\&. Privileges are tested once at statement start and are checked whether or not particular WHEN clauses are executed\&. You will require the SELECT -privilege on the +privilege on any column(s) of the \fIdata_source\fR -and any column(s) of the +and \fItarget_table_name\fR -referred to in a -condition\&. +referred to in any +condition +or +expression\&. .PP \fBMERGE\fR is not supported if the @@ -667,7 +669,9 @@ This command conforms to the SQL standard\&. .PP -The WITH clause and +The +WITH +clause and DO NOTHING action are extensions to the SQL diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/MOVE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/MOVE.7 index 3387f0c..b0d15b1 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/MOVE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/MOVE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: MOVE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "MOVE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "MOVE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/NOTIFY.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/NOTIFY.7 index c99fe41..f03d7d6 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/NOTIFY.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/NOTIFY.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: NOTIFY .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "NOTIFY" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "NOTIFY" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE.7 index 66e4675..397f4a4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: PREPARE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PREPARE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PREPARE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE_TRANSACTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE_TRANSACTION.7 index 14e1f87..6b76792 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE_TRANSACTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/PREPARE_TRANSACTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: PREPARE TRANSACTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "PREPARE TRANSACTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "PREPARE TRANSACTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REASSIGN_OWNED.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REASSIGN_OWNED.7 index 6ef51cb..e9a4a78 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REASSIGN_OWNED.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REASSIGN_OWNED.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: REASSIGN OWNED .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "REASSIGN OWNED" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "REASSIGN OWNED" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REFRESH_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REFRESH_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 index cb0cf0d..005d0c4 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REFRESH_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REFRESH_MATERIALIZED_VIEW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "REFRESH MATERIALIZED VIEW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REINDEX.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REINDEX.7 index 216f6db..1f96a61 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REINDEX.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REINDEX.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: REINDEX .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "REINDEX" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "REINDEX" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/RELEASE_SAVEPOINT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/RELEASE_SAVEPOINT.7 index 4307fd5..cb85114 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/RELEASE_SAVEPOINT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/RELEASE_SAVEPOINT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: RELEASE SAVEPOINT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "RELEASE SAVEPOINT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "RELEASE SAVEPOINT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/RESET.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/RESET.7 index 7d0cb8d..c0ad6ae 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/RESET.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/RESET.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: RESET .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "RESET" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "RESET" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REVOKE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REVOKE.7 index 34d702f..98c679b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/REVOKE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/REVOKE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: REVOKE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "REVOKE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "REVOKE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK.7 index d7048cf..35fe7da 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ROLLBACK .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ROLLBACK" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ROLLBACK" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_PREPARED.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_PREPARED.7 index c6d7dc5..cb3503e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_PREPARED.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_PREPARED.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ROLLBACK PREPARED .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ROLLBACK PREPARED" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ROLLBACK PREPARED" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_TO_SAVEPOINT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_TO_SAVEPOINT.7 index cb7e747..1e9a2a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_TO_SAVEPOINT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/ROLLBACK_TO_SAVEPOINT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SAVEPOINT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SAVEPOINT.7 index 87bbbe4..a1e19a7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SAVEPOINT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SAVEPOINT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SAVEPOINT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SAVEPOINT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SAVEPOINT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SECURITY_LABEL.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SECURITY_LABEL.7 index c92fea0..ed25e6f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SECURITY_LABEL.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SECURITY_LABEL.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SECURITY LABEL .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SECURITY LABEL" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SECURITY LABEL" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT.7 index 2ee94fc..2685817 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SELECT .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SELECT" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SELECT" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -2257,8 +2257,7 @@ WITH t AS ( ) SELECT * FROM t UNION ALL -SELECT * FROM t - +SELECT * FROM t; x \-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\-\- 0\&.534150459803641 diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT_INTO.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT_INTO.7 index 217ae85..236746b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT_INTO.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SELECT_INTO.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SELECT INTO .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SELECT INTO" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SELECT INTO" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET.7 index 7862c32..3f82483 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SET .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SET" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SET" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_CONSTRAINTS.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_CONSTRAINTS.7 index dc86e2a..aff801c 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_CONSTRAINTS.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_CONSTRAINTS.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SET CONSTRAINTS .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SET CONSTRAINTS" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SET CONSTRAINTS" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_ROLE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_ROLE.7 index 2f3f2c6..a58fac3 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_ROLE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_ROLE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SET ROLE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SET ROLE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SET ROLE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_SESSION_AUTHORIZATION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_SESSION_AUTHORIZATION.7 index 641b48e..3a3481a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_SESSION_AUTHORIZATION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_SESSION_AUTHORIZATION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SET SESSION AUTHORIZATION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_TRANSACTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_TRANSACTION.7 index acbe84a..8f51aef 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_TRANSACTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SET_TRANSACTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SET TRANSACTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SET TRANSACTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SET TRANSACTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SHOW.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SHOW.7 index 5b03064..096321f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/SHOW.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/SHOW.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: SHOW .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "SHOW" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "SHOW" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/START_TRANSACTION.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/START_TRANSACTION.7 index 675dc9d..a74eb17 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/START_TRANSACTION.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/START_TRANSACTION.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: START TRANSACTION .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "START TRANSACTION" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "START TRANSACTION" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/TRUNCATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/TRUNCATE.7 index 6e547c7..6df0026 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/TRUNCATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/TRUNCATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: TRUNCATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "TRUNCATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "TRUNCATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/UNLISTEN.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/UNLISTEN.7 index f73f740..2e2c857 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/UNLISTEN.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/UNLISTEN.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: UNLISTEN .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "UNLISTEN" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "UNLISTEN" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/UPDATE.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/UPDATE.7 index 5dcbdf6..fc2c5a0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/UPDATE.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/UPDATE.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: UPDATE .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "UPDATE" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "UPDATE" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/VACUUM.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/VACUUM.7 index 7e7d7f2..38ec6be 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/VACUUM.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/VACUUM.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: VACUUM .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "VACUUM" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "VACUUM" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/man7/VALUES.7 b/doc/src/sgml/man7/VALUES.7 index 0025e6d..e3ee9b0 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/man7/VALUES.7 +++ b/doc/src/sgml/man7/VALUES.7 @@ -2,12 +2,12 @@ .\" Title: VALUES .\" Author: The PostgreSQL Global Development Group .\" Generator: DocBook XSL Stylesheets vsnapshot -.\" Date: 2023 -.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation -.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.5 +.\" Date: 2024 +.\" Manual: PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation +.\" Source: PostgreSQL 15.6 .\" Language: English .\" -.TH "VALUES" "7" "2023" "PostgreSQL 15.5" "PostgreSQL 15.5 Documentation" +.TH "VALUES" "7" "2024" "PostgreSQL 15.6" "PostgreSQL 15.6 Documentation" .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- .\" * Define some portability stuff .\" ----------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml index c72ad60..84e6500 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/monitoring.sgml @@ -1519,6 +1519,11 @@ postgres 27093 0.0 0.0 30096 2752 ? Ss 11:34 0:00 postgres: ser TwophaseFileWrite Waiting for a write of a two phase state file. + + VersionFileSync + Waiting for the version file to reach durable storage while + creating a database. + VersionFileWrite Waiting for the version file to be written while creating a database. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml index 742d360..513db64 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/plpython.sgml @@ -1175,7 +1175,7 @@ plan = plpy.prepare("INSERT INTO operations (result) VALUES ($1)", ["text"]) plpy.execute(plan, [result]) $$ LANGUAGE plpython3u; - Note that the use of try/catch is still + Note that the use of try/except is still required. Otherwise the exception would propagate to the top of the Python stack and would cause the whole function to abort with a PostgreSQL error, so that the diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml index 405046f..fdd3d05 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/protocol.sgml @@ -2559,7 +2559,10 @@ psql "dbname=postgres replication=database" -c "IDENTIFY_SYSTEM;" option_name - The name of an option passed to the slot's logical decoding plugin. + The name of an option passed to the slot's logical decoding output + plugin. See for + options that are accepted by the standard (pgoutput) + plugin. @@ -3088,12 +3091,18 @@ psql "dbname=postgres replication=database" -c "IDENTIFY_SYSTEM;" the physical streaming replication protocol. + + PostgreSQL logical decoding supports output + plugins. pgoutput is the standard one used for + the built-in logical replication. + + Logical Streaming Replication Parameters - The logical replication START_REPLICATION command - accepts following parameters: + Using the START_REPLICATION command, + pgoutput accepts the following options: @@ -3103,7 +3112,7 @@ psql "dbname=postgres replication=database" -c "IDENTIFY_SYSTEM;" Protocol version. Currently versions 1, 2, - and 3 are supported. + and 3 are supported. A valid version is required. Version 2 is supported only for server version 14 @@ -3125,6 +3134,55 @@ psql "dbname=postgres replication=database" -c "IDENTIFY_SYSTEM;" Comma separated list of publication names for which to subscribe (receive changes). The individual publication names are treated as standard objects names and can be quoted the same as needed. + At least one publication name is required. + + + + + + + binary + + + + Boolean option to use binary transfer mode. Binary mode is faster + than the text mode but slightly less robust. + + + + + + + messages + + + + Boolean option to enable sending the messages that are written + by pg_logical_emit_message. + + + + + + + streaming + + + + Boolean option to enable streaming of in-progress transactions. + Minimum protocol version 2 is required to turn it on. + + + + + + + two_phase + + + + Boolean option to enable two-phase transactions. Minimum protocol + version 3 is required to turn it on. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml index ef5253b..139d74e 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_event_trigger.sgml @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ ALTER EVENT TRIGGER name RENAME TO - DISABLE/ENABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ] TRIGGER + DISABLE/ENABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ] These forms configure the firing of event triggers. A disabled trigger diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml index 54f34c2..dc0957d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/alter_foreign_data_wrapper.sgml @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER name REN Change a foreign-data wrapper dbi, add option foo, drop bar: -ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi OPTIONS (ADD foo '1', DROP 'bar'); +ALTER FOREIGN DATA WRAPPER dbi OPTIONS (ADD foo '1', DROP bar); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml index 63afa0d..51ce759 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/copy.sgml @@ -127,10 +127,10 @@ COPY { table_name [ ( For INSERT, UPDATE and - DELETE queries a RETURNING clause must be provided, - and the target relation must not have a conditional rule, nor - an ALSO rule, nor an INSTEAD rule - that expands to multiple statements. + DELETE queries a RETURNING clause + must be provided, and the target relation must not have a conditional + rule, nor an ALSO rule, nor an + INSTEAD rule that expands to multiple statements. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml index c1b6beb..0301dff 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/create_table.sgml @@ -1108,10 +1108,11 @@ WITH ( MODULUS numeric_literal, REM column(s) of some row of the referenced table. If the refcolumn list is omitted, the primary key of the reftable - is used. The referenced columns must be the columns of a non-deferrable - unique or primary key constraint in the referenced table. The user - must have REFERENCES permission on the referenced table - (either the whole table, or the specific referenced columns). The + is used. Otherwise, the refcolumn + list must refer to the columns of a non-deferrable unique or primary key + constraint or be the columns of a non-partial unique index. The user + must have REFERENCES permission on the referenced + table (either the whole table, or the specific referenced columns). The addition of a foreign key constraint requires a SHARE ROW EXCLUSIVE lock on the referenced table. Note that foreign key constraints cannot be defined between temporary @@ -2248,13 +2249,19 @@ CREATE TABLE cities_partdef - Foreign-Key Constraint Actions + Foreign Key Constraints - The ability to specify column lists in the foreign-key actions + The ability to specify column lists in the foreign key actions SET DEFAULT and SET NULL is a PostgreSQL extension. + + + It is a PostgreSQL extension that a + foreign key constraint may reference columns of a unique index instead of + columns of a primary key or unique constraint. + diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/merge.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/merge.sgml index 0995fe0..f643e62 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/merge.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/merge.sgml @@ -102,14 +102,14 @@ DELETE that are referred to in the SET clause. If you specify an insert action, you must have the INSERT privilege on the target_table_name. - If you specify an delete action, you must have the DELETE + If you specify a delete action, you must have the DELETE privilege on the target_table_name. Privileges are tested once at statement start and are checked whether or not particular WHEN clauses are executed. - You will require the SELECT privilege on the - data_source and any column(s) - of the target_table_name - referred to in a condition. + You will require the SELECT privilege on any column(s) + of the data_source and + target_table_name referred to + in any condition or expression. @@ -627,8 +627,8 @@ WHEN MATCHED THEN This command conforms to the SQL standard. - The WITH clause and DO NOTHING action are extensions to - the SQL standard. + The WITH clause and DO NOTHING + action are extensions to the SQL standard. diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml index 5df0d89..69056a8 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/select.sgml @@ -1918,8 +1918,7 @@ WITH t AS ( ) SELECT * FROM t UNION ALL -SELECT * FROM t - +SELECT * FROM t; x -------------------- 0.534150459803641 diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/release-15.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/release-15.sgml index 0b02ba5..c2b8122 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/release-15.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/release-15.sgml @@ -1,6 +1,1351 @@ + + Release 15.6 + + + Release date: + 2024-02-08 + + + + This release contains a variety of fixes from 15.5. + For information about new features in major release 15, see + . + + + + Migration to Version 15.6 + + + A dump/restore is not required for those running 15.X. + + + + However, one bug was fixed that could have resulted in corruption of + GIN indexes during concurrent updates. If you suspect such + corruption, reindex affected indexes after installing this update. + + + + Also, if you are upgrading from a version earlier than 15.5, + see . + + + + + Changes + + + + + + + Tighten security restrictions within REFRESH MATERIALIZED + VIEW CONCURRENTLY (Heikki Linnakangas) + + + + One step of a concurrent refresh command was run under weak security + restrictions. If a materialized view's owner could persuade a + superuser or other high-privileged user to perform a concurrent + refresh on that view, the view's owner could control code executed + with the privileges of the user running REFRESH. + Fix things so that all user-determined code is run as the view's + owner, as expected. + + + + The only known exploit for this error does not work + in PostgreSQL 16.0 and later, so it may + be that v16 is not vulnerable in practice. + + + + The PostgreSQL Project thanks Pedro + Gallegos for reporting this problem. + (CVE-2024-0985) + + + + + + + Fix memory leak when performing JIT inlining (Andres Freund, + Daniel Gustafsson) + + + + There have been multiple reports of backend processes suffering + out-of-memory conditions after sufficiently many JIT compilations. + This fix should resolve that. + + + + + + + When dequeueing from an LWLock, avoid needing to search the list of + waiting processes (Andres Freund) + + + + This fixes O(N^2) behavior when the list of waiters is long. In + some use-cases this results in substantial throughput improvements. + + + + + + + Avoid generating incorrect partitioned-join plans (Richard Guo) + + + + Some uncommon situations involving lateral references could create + incorrect plans. Affected queries could produce wrong answers, or + odd failures such as variable not found in subplan target + list, or executor crashes. + + + + + + + Fix incorrect wrapping of subquery output expressions in + PlaceHolderVars (Tom Lane) + + + + This fixes incorrect results when a subquery is underneath an outer + join and has an output column that laterally references something + outside the outer join's scope. The output column might not appear + as NULL when it should do so due to the action of the outer join. + + + + + + + Fix misprocessing of window function run conditions (Richard Guo) + + + + This oversight could lead to WindowFunc not found in subplan + target lists errors. + + + + + + + Skip inappropriate actions when MERGE causes a + cross-partition update (Dean Rasheed) + + + + When executing a MERGE UPDATE action on a + partitioned table, if the UPDATE is turned into + a DELETE and INSERT due to + changing a partition key column, skip firing AFTER + UPDATE ROW triggers, as well as other post-update actions + such as RLS checks. These actions would typically fail, which is + why a regular UPDATE doesn't do them in such + cases; MERGE shouldn't either. + + + + + + + Cope with BEFORE ROW DELETE triggers in + cross-partition MERGE updates (Dean Rasheed) + + + + If such a trigger attempted to prevent the update by returning + NULL, MERGE would suffer an error or assertion + failure. + + + + + + + Prevent access to a no-longer-pinned buffer in BEFORE ROW + UPDATE triggers (Alexander Lakhin, Tom Lane) + + + + If the tuple being updated had just been updated and moved to + another page by another session, there was a narrow window where + we would attempt to fetch data from the new tuple version without + any pin on its buffer. In principle this could result in garbage + data appearing in non-updated columns of the proposed new tuple. + The odds of problems in practice seem rather low, however. + + + + + + + Avoid requesting an oversize shared-memory area in parallel hash + join (Thomas Munro, Andrei Lepikhov, Alexander Korotkov) + + + + The limiting value was too large, allowing invalid DSA memory + alloc request size errors to occur with sufficiently large + expected hash table sizes. + + + + + + + Avoid assertion failures in heap_update() + and heap_delete() when a tuple to be updated by + a foreign-key enforcement trigger fails the extra visibility + crosscheck (Alexander Lakhin) + + + + This error had no impact in non-assert builds. + + + + + + + Fix possible failure during ALTER TABLE ADD + COLUMN on a complex inheritance tree (Tender Wang) + + + + If a grandchild table would inherit the new column via multiple + intermediate parents, the command failed with tuple already + updated by self. + + + + + + + Fix problems with duplicate token names in ALTER TEXT + SEARCH CONFIGURATION ... MAPPING commands (Tender Wang, + Michael Paquier) + + + + + + + Properly lock the associated table during DROP + STATISTICS (Tomas Vondra) + + + + Failure to acquire the lock could result in tuple + concurrently deleted errors if the DROP + executes concurrently with ANALYZE. + + + + + + + Fix function volatility checking for GENERATED + and DEFAULT expressions (Tom Lane) + + + + These places could fail to detect insertion of a volatile function + default-argument expression, or decide that a polymorphic function + is volatile although it is actually immutable on the datatype of + interest. This could lead to improperly rejecting or accepting + a GENERATED clause, or to mistakenly applying the + constant-default-value optimization in ALTER TABLE ADD + COLUMN. + + + + + + + Detect that a new catalog cache entry became stale while detoasting + its fields (Tom Lane) + + + + We expand any out-of-line fields in a catalog tuple before inserting + it into the catalog caches. That involves database access which + might cause invalidation of catalog cache entries — but the + new entry isn't in the cache yet, so we would miss noticing that it + should get invalidated. The result is a race condition in which an + already-stale cache entry could get made, and then persist + indefinitely. This would lead to hard-to-predict misbehavior. + Fix by rechecking the tuple's visibility after detoasting. + + + + + + + Fix edge-case integer overflow detection bug on some platforms (Dean + Rasheed) + + + + Computing 0 - INT64_MIN should result in an + overflow error, and did on most platforms. However, platforms with + neither integer overflow builtins nor 128-bit integers would fail to + spot the overflow, instead returning INT64_MIN. + + + + + + + Detect Julian-date overflow when adding or subtracting + an interval to/from a timestamp (Tom Lane) + + + + Some cases that should cause an out-of-range error produced an + incorrect result instead. + + + + + + + Add more checks for overflow in interval_mul() + and interval_div() (Dean Rasheed) + + + + Some cases that should cause an out-of-range error produced an + incorrect result instead. + + + + + + + Ensure cached statistics are discarded after a change + to stats_fetch_consistency (Shinya Kato) + + + + In some code paths, it was possible for stale statistics to be + returned. + + + + + + + Make the pg_file_settings view check + validity of unapplied values for settings + with backend + or superuser-backend context (Tom Lane) + + + + Invalid values were not noted in the view as intended. This escaped + detection because there are very few settings in these groups. + + + + + + + Match collation too when matching an existing index to a new + partitioned index (Peter Eisentraut) + + + + Previously we could accept an index that has a different collation + from the corresponding element of the partition key, possibly + leading to misbehavior. + + + + + + + Avoid failure if a child index is dropped concurrently + with REINDEX INDEX on a partitioned index + (Fei Changhong) + + + + + + + Fix insufficient locking when cleaning up an incomplete split of + a GIN index's internal page (Fei Changhong, Heikki Linnakangas) + + + + The code tried to do this with shared rather than exclusive lock on + the buffer. This could lead to index corruption if two processes + attempted the cleanup concurrently. + + + + + + + Avoid premature release of buffer pin in GIN index insertion + (Tom Lane) + + + + If an index root page split occurs concurrently with our own + insertion, the code could fail with buffer NNNN is not owned + by resource owner. + + + + + + + Avoid failure with partitioned SP-GiST indexes (Tom Lane) + + + + Trying to use an index of this kind could lead to No such + file or directory errors. + + + + + + + Fix ownership change reporting for large objects (Tom Lane) + + + + A no-op ALTER LARGE OBJECT OWNER command (that + is, one selecting the existing owner) passed the wrong class ID to + the PostAlterHook, probably confusing any + extension using that hook. + + + + + + + Fix reporting of I/O timing data in EXPLAIN + (BUFFERS) (Michael Paquier) + + + + The numbers labeled as shared/local actually refer + only to shared buffers, so change that label + to shared. + + + + + + + Ensure durability of CREATE DATABASE (Noah Misch) + + + + If an operating system crash occurred during or shortly + after CREATE DATABASE, recovery could fail, or + subsequent connections to the new database could fail. If a base + backup was taken in that window, similar problems could be observed + when trying to use the backup. The symptom would be that the + database directory, PG_VERSION file, or + pg_filenode.map file was missing or empty. + + + + + + + Add more LOG messages when starting and ending + recovery from a backup (Andres Freund) + + + + This change provides additional information in the postmaster log + that may be useful for diagnosing recovery problems. + + + + + + + Prevent standby servers from incorrectly processing dead index + tuples during subtransactions (Fei Changhong) + + + + The startedInRecovery flag was not + correctly set for a subtransaction. This affects only processing of + dead index tuples. It could allow a query in a subtransaction to + ignore index entries that it should return (if they are already dead + on the primary server, but not dead to the standby transaction), or + to prematurely mark index entries as dead that are not yet dead on + the primary. It is not clear that the latter case has any serious + consequences, but it's not the intended behavior. + + + + + + + Fix integer overflow hazard in checking whether a record will fit + into the WAL decoding buffer (Thomas Munro) + + + + This bug appears to be only latent except when running a + 32-bit PostgreSQL build on a 64-bit + platform. + + + + + + + Fix deadlock between a logical replication apply worker, its + tablesync worker, and a session process trying to alter the + subscription (Shlok Kyal) + + + + One edge of the deadlock loop did not involve a lock wait, so the + deadlock went undetected and would persist until manual + intervention. + + + + + + + Ensure that column default values are correctly transmitted by + the pgoutput logical replication plugin + (Nikhil Benesch) + + + + ALTER TABLE ADD COLUMN with a constant default + value for the new column avoids rewriting existing tuples, instead + expecting that reading code will insert the correct default into a + tuple that lacks that column. If replication was subsequently + initiated on the table, pgoutput would + transmit NULL instead of the correct default for such a column, + causing incorrect replication on the subscriber. + + + + + + + Fix failure of logical replication's initial sync for a table with + no columns (Vignesh C) + + + + This case generated an improperly-formatted COPY + command. + + + + + + + Prevent examining system catalogs with the wrong snapshot during + logical decoding (Fei Changhong) + + + + If decoding begins partway through a transaction that modifies + system catalogs, the decoder may not recognize that, causing it to + fail to treat that transaction as in-progress for catalog lookups. + This fix deals with the case that a top-level transaction is already + marked as containing catalog changes, but its subtransaction(s) are + not. + + + + + + + Return the correct status code when a new client disconnects without + responding to the server's password challenge (Liu Lang, Tom Lane) + + + + In some cases we'd treat this as a loggable error, which was not the + intention and tends to create log spam, since common clients + like psql frequently do this. It may + also confuse extensions that + use ClientAuthentication_hook. + + + + + + + Fix incompatibility with OpenSSL 3.2 + (Tristan Partin, Bo Andreson) + + + + Use the BIO app_data field for our private storage, + instead of assuming it's okay to use the data field. + This mistake didn't cause problems before, but with 3.2 it leads + to crashes and complaints about double frees. + + + + + + + Be more wary about OpenSSL not + setting errno on error (Tom Lane) + + + + If errno isn't set, assume the cause of the + reported failure is read EOF. This fixes rare cases of strange + error reports like could not accept SSL connection: + Success. + + + + + + + Fix file descriptor leakage when a foreign data + wrapper's ForeignAsyncRequest function fails + (Heikki Linnakangas) + + + + + + + Report ENOMEM errors from file-related system + calls as ERRCODE_OUT_OF_MEMORY, + not ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR (Alexander Kuzmenkov) + + + + + + + In PL/pgSQL, support SQL commands that + are CREATE FUNCTION/CREATE + PROCEDURE with SQL-standard bodies (Tom Lane) + + + + Previously, such cases failed with parsing errors due to the + semicolon(s) appearing in the function body. + + + + + + + Fix libpq's + handling of errors in pipelines (Álvaro Herrera) + + + + The pipeline state could get out of sync if an error is returned + for reasons other than a query problem (for example, if the + connection is lost). Potentially this would lead to a busy-loop in + the calling application. + + + + + + + Make libpq's + PQsendFlushRequest() function flush the client + output buffer under the same rules as + other PQsend functions (Jelte Fennema-Nio) + + + + In pipeline mode, it may still be necessary to + call PQflush() as well; but this change removes + some inconsistency. + + + + + + + Avoid race condition when libpq + initializes OpenSSL support concurrently in two different threads + (Willi Mann, Michael Paquier) + + + + + + + Fix timing-dependent failure in GSSAPI data transmission (Tom Lane) + + + + When using GSSAPI encryption in non-blocking + mode, libpq sometimes failed + with GSSAPI caller failed to retransmit all data needing to + be retried. + + + + + + + In pg_dump, don't dump RLS policies or + security labels for extension member objects (Tom Lane, Jacob + Champion) + + + + Previously, commands would be included in the dump to set these + properties, which is really incorrect since they should be + considered as internal affairs of the extension. Moreover, the + restoring user might not have adequate privilege to set them, and + indeed the dumping user might not have enough privilege to dump them + (since dumping RLS policies requires acquiring lock on their table). + + + + + + + In pg_dump, don't dump an extended + statistics object if its underlying table isn't being dumped + (Rian McGuire, Tom Lane) + + + + This conforms to the behavior for other dependent objects such as + indexes. + + + + + + + Make it an error for a pgbench script to + end with an open pipeline (Anthonin Bonnefoy) + + + + Previously, pgbench would behave oddly if + a \startpipeline command lacked a + matching \endpipeline. This seems like a + scripting mistake rather than a case + that pgbench needs to handle nicely, so + throw an error. + + + + + + + In contrib/bloom, fix overly tight assertion + about false_positive_rate (Alexander Lakhin) + + + + + + + Fix crash in contrib/intarray if an array with + an element equal to INT_MAX is inserted into + a gist__int_ops index + (Alexander Lakhin, Tom Lane) + + + + + + + Report a better error + when contrib/pageinspect's + hash_bitmap_info() function is applied to a + partitioned hash index (Alexander Lakhin, Michael Paquier) + + + + + + + Report a better error + when contrib/pgstattuple's + pgstathashindex() function is applied to a + partitioned hash index (Alexander Lakhin) + + + + + + + On Windows, suppress autorun options when launching subprocesses + in pg_ctl + and pg_regress (Kyotaro Horiguchi) + + + + When launching a child process via cmd.exe, + pass the flag to prevent executing any autorun + commands specified in the registry. This avoids possibly-surprising + side effects. + + + + + + + Move is_valid_ascii() + from mb/pg_wchar.h + to utils/ascii.h (Jubilee Young) + + + + This change avoids the need to + include <simd.h> + in pg_wchar.h, which was causing problems for + some third-party code. + + + + + + + Fix compilation failures with libxml2 + version 2.12.0 and later (Tom Lane) + + + + + + + Fix compilation failure of WAL_DEBUG code on + Windows (Bharath Rupireddy) + + + + + + + Suppress compiler warnings from Python's header files + (Peter Eisentraut, Tom Lane) + + + + Our preferred compiler options provoke warnings about constructs + appearing in recent versions of Python's header files. When using + gcc, we can suppress these warnings with + a pragma. + + + + + + + Avoid deprecation warning when compiling with LLVM 18 (Thomas Munro) + + + + + + + Update time zone data files to tzdata + release 2024a for DST law changes in Greenland, Kazakhstan, and + Palestine, plus corrections for the Antarctic stations Casey and + Vostok. Also historical corrections for Vietnam, Toronto, and + Miquelon. + + + + + + + + Release 15.5 @@ -1498,7 +2843,7 @@ Branch: REL_11_STABLE [919ebb023] 2023-08-07 06:06:01 -0700 - The PostgreSQL Project thanks Micah Gate, + The PostgreSQL Project thanks Micah Gates, Valerie Woolard, Tim Carey-Smith, and Christoph Berg for reporting this problem. (CVE-2023-39417) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml index 61abb42..c0af054 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/syntax.sgml @@ -1021,6 +1021,18 @@ CAST ( 'string' AS type ) unary plus, unary minus + + COLLATE + left + collation selection + + + + AT + left + AT TIME ZONE + + ^ left diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml index 27fb020..2514982 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/wal.sgml @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ On FreeBSD, IDE drives can be queried using - atacontrol and write caching turned off using + camcontrol identify and write caching turned off using hw.ata.wc=0 in /boot/loader.conf; SCSI drives can be queried using camcontrol identify, and the write cache both queried and changed using -- cgit v1.2.3